Engine Control System: Section

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 1924

EC-1

ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM


B ENGINE
CONTENTS
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
SECTION
A
EC
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
QG (WITH EURO-OBD)
INDEX FOR DTC ................................................... ... 23
Alphabetical Index ............................................... ... 23
DTC No. Index .................................................... ... 27
PRECAUTIONS ........................................................ 33
Precautions for Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) AIR BAG and SEAT BELT PRE-TEN-
SIONER ............................................................. ... 33
On Board Diagnostic (OBD) Systemof Engine and
A/T ....................................................................... ... 33
Precaution ........................................................... ... 33
Wiring Diagrams and Trouble Diagnosis ............. ... 36
PREPARATION ...................................................... ... 37
Special Service Tools .......................................... ... 37
Commercial Service Tools ................................... ... 37
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM .................................. 39
System Diagram - QG16DE Engine Models .......... 39
System Diagram - QG18DE Engine Models .......... 40
Vacuum Hose Drawing ........................................... 41
System Chart ...................................................... ... 42
Multiport Fuel Injection (MFI) System .................... 42
Electronic Ignition (EI) System ............................ ... 45
Air Conditioning Cut Control ................................ ... 45
Fuel Cut Control (at No Load and High Engine
Speed) ................................................................. ... 46
CAN communication .............................................. 46
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE ........................... ... 54
Idle Speed and Ignition Timing Check .................... 54
Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning ...... 55
Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning ............. ... 55
Idle Air Volume Learning ..................................... ... 55
Fuel Pressure Check .............................................. 58
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM ......... ... 60
Introduction ............................................................ 60
Two Trip Detection Logic ..................................... ... 60
Emission-related Diagnostic Information ............. ... 61
NATS (Nissan Anti-theft System) ........................... 75
Malfunction Indicator (MI) ....................................... 75
OBD System Operation Chart ................................ 79
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS ......................................... ... 84
Trouble Diagnosis Introduction ............................... 84
DTC Inspection Priority Chart .............................. ... 88
Fail-safe Chart ..................................................... ... 90
Basic Inspection .................................................. ... 92
Symptom Matrix Chart ......................................... ... 97
Engine Control Component Parts Location .......... 101
Circuit Diagram ..................................................... 105
ECM Harness Connector Terminal Layout ........... 107
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................. . 107
CONSULT-II Function ........................................... 121
Generic Scan Tool (GST) Function ...................... . 132
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 133
Major Sensor Reference Graph in Data Monitor
Mode ..................................................................... 136
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATIONVALUE. 139
Description ............................................................ 139
Testing Condition ................................................. . 139
Inspection Procedure ........................................... . 139
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 140
TROUBLEDIAGNOSISFORINTERMITTENTINCI-
DENT ...................................................................... . 143
Description ............................................................ 143
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 143
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM ................... 144
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 144
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 145
Component Inspection ......................................... . 149
DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE. 150
Description ............................................................ 150
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 150
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 150
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 151
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 152
DTC P0011 IVT CONTROL .................................... . 153
Description ............................................................ 153
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 153
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 154
EC-2
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 154
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 154
DTC P0031, P0032 HO2S1 HEATER (QG16DE) .. . 156
Description ........................................................... . 156
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 156
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 156
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 156
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 158
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 159
Component Inspection .......................................... 161
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 161
DTCP0031, P0032, P0051, P0052HO2S1HEATER
(QG18DE) ............................................................... . 162
Description ........................................................... . 162
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 162
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 162
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 162
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 164
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 167
Component Inspection .......................................... 169
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 169
DTC P0037, P0038 HO2S2 HEATER (QG16DE) .. . 170
Description ........................................................... . 170
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 170
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 170
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 170
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 172
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 173
Component Inspection .......................................... 174
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 174
DTCP0037, P0038, P0057, P0058HO2S2HEATER
(QG18DE) ............................................................... . 175
Description ........................................................... . 175
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 175
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 175
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 175
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 177
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 180
Component Inspection .......................................... 181
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 182
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR ......................... 183
Component Description ....................................... . 183
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 183
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 183
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 183
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 185
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 186
Component Inspection .......................................... 188
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 188
DTC P0112, P0113 IAT SENSOR .......................... . 189
Component Description ....................................... . 189
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 189
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 189
Wiring Diagram .....................................................191
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................192
Component Inspection ..........................................193
Removal and Installation ...................................... .193
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR ..........................194
Component Description ........................................194
On Board Diagnosis Logic ....................................194
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... .195
Wiring Diagram .....................................................196
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................197
Component Inspection ..........................................198
Removal and Installation ...................................... .198
DTC P0132 HO2S1 (QG16DE) ...............................199
Component Description ........................................199
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
.199
On Board Diagnosis Logic ....................................199
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... .200
Wiring Diagram .....................................................201
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................202
Component Inspection ..........................................203
Removal and Installation ...................................... .204
DTC P0132, P0152 HO2S1 (QG18DE) ...................205
Component Description ........................................205
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
.205
On Board Diagnosis Logic ....................................205
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... .206
Wiring Diagram .....................................................207
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................210
Component Inspection .......................................... 211
Removal and Installation ...................................... .213
DTC P0133 HO2S1 (QG16DE) ...............................214
Component Description ........................................214
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
.214
On Board Diagnosis Logic ....................................214
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... .215
Overall Function Check .........................................216
Wiring Diagram .....................................................217
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................218
Component Inspection ..........................................221
Removal and Installation ...................................... .222
DTC P0133, P0153, HO2S1 (QG18DE) ..................223
Component Description ........................................223
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
.223
On Board Diagnosis Logic ....................................223
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... .224
Overall Function Check .........................................225
Wiring Diagram .....................................................226
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................229
Component Inspection ..........................................232
Removal and Installation ...................................... .233
DTC P0134 HO2S1 (QG16DE) ...............................234
Component Description ........................................234
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
.234
EC-3
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
EC
A
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. . 234
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 235
Overall Function Check ....................................... . 235
Wiring Diagram ................................................... . 237
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 238
Component Inspection ......................................... 239
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 240
DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1 (QG18DE) .................. 241
Component Description ........................................ 241
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 241
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. . 241
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 242
Overall Function Check ....................................... . 243
Wiring Diagram ................................................... . 244
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 247
Component Inspection ......................................... 248
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 250
DTC P0138 HO2S2 (QG16DE) .............................. . 251
Component Description ........................................ 251
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 251
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. . 251
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 251
Overall Function Check ....................................... . 252
Wiring Diagram ................................................... . 253
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 254
Component Inspection ......................................... 256
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 257
DTC P0138, P0158 HO2S2 (QG18DE) .................. 258
Component Description ........................................ 258
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 258
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. . 258
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 258
Overall Function Check ....................................... . 259
Wiring Diagram ................................................... . 260
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 263
Component Inspection ......................................... 265
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 266
DTC P0139 HO2S2 (QG16DE) .............................. . 267
Component Description ........................................ 267
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 267
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. . 267
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 267
Overall Function Check ....................................... . 269
Wiring Diagram ................................................... . 270
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 271
Component Inspection ......................................... 273
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 274
DTC P0139, P0159 HO2S2 (QG18DE) .................. 275
Component Description ........................................ 275
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 275
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. . 275
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 275
Overall Function Check ....................................... . 277
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 278
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 281
Component Inspection ......................................... . 283
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 284
DTCP0171FUELINJECTIONSYSTEMFUNCTION
(QG16DE) ............................................................... . 285
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 285
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 285
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 287
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 288
DTC P0171, P0174 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
FUNCTION (QG18DE) ........................................... . 291
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 291
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 291
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 293
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 295
DTCP0172FUELINJECTIONSYSTEMFUNCTION
(QG16DE) ............................................................... . 299
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 299
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 299
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 301
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 302
DTC P0172, P0175 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
FUNCTION (QG18DE) ........................................... . 305
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 305
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 305
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 307
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 309
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR ....................................... . 312
Component Description ....................................... . 312
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 312
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 312
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 312
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 314
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 315
Component Inspection ......................................... . 317
Remove and Installation ...................................... . 317
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR ........................... . 318
Component Description ....................................... . 318
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 318
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 318
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 318
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 320
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 321
Component Inspection ......................................... . 323
Remove and Installation ...................................... . 323
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR .................................... . 324
Component Description ....................................... . 324
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 324
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 324
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 324
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 326
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 327
Component Inspection ......................................... . 329
Remove and Installation ...................................... . 330
EC-4
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR ......................... 331
Component Description ....................................... . 331
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 331
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 331
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 331
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 333
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 334
Component Inspection .......................................... 336
Remove and Installation ....................................... 337
DTC P0300 - P0304 MULTIPLE CYLINDER MIS-
FIRE, NO. 1 - 4 CYLINDER MISFIRE .................... . 338
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 338
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 338
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 339
DTC P0327, P0328 KS ............................................ 344
Component Description ....................................... . 344
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 344
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 344
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 345
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 346
Component Inspection .......................................... 347
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 347
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS) ......................... . 348
Component Description ....................................... . 348
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 348
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 348
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 348
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 350
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 351
Component Inspection .......................................... 353
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 354
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE) .................... . 355
Component Description ....................................... . 355
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 355
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 355
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 356
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 357
Component Inspection .......................................... 359
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 360
DTC P0420 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION
(QG16DE) ............................................................... . 361
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 361
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 361
Overall Function Check ....................................... . 362
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 363
DTCP0420, P0430THREEWAYCATALYSTFUNC-
TION (QG18DE) ..................................................... . 365
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 365
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 365
Overall Function Check ....................................... . 366
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 367
DTCP0444, P0445EVAPCANISTERPURGEVOL-
UME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE ...................... 369
Description ........................................................... . 369
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 369
On Board Diagnosis Logic ....................................370
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... .370
Wiring Diagram .....................................................371
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................372
Component Inspection ..........................................374
Removal and Installation ...................................... .374
DTC P0500 VSS ..................................................... .375
Description ............................................................375
On Board Diagnosis Logic ....................................375
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... .375
Overall Function Check .........................................375
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................376
DTC P0550 PSP SENSOR ..................................... .377
Component Description ........................................377
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
.377
On Board Diagnosis Logic ....................................377
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... .377
Wiring Diagram .....................................................378
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................379
Component Inspection ..........................................381
DTC P0605 ECM .....................................................382
Component Description ........................................382
On Board Diagnosis Logic ....................................382
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... .382
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................384
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY ........................385
Component Description ........................................385
On Board Diagnosis Logic ....................................385
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... .385
Wiring Diagram .....................................................386
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................387
DTC P1102 MAF SENSOR .................................... .389
Component Description ........................................389
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
.389
On Board Diagnosis Logic ....................................389
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... .389
Wiring Diagram .....................................................391
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................392
Component Inspection ..........................................394
Removal and Installation ...................................... .394
DTC P1111 IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE .... .395
Description ............................................................395
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
.395
On Board Diagnosis Logic ....................................396
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... .396
Wiring Diagram .....................................................397
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................398
Component Inspection ..........................................399
Removal and Installation ...................................... .399
DTC P1121 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL
ACTUATOR ............................................................ .400
Component Description ........................................400
On Board Diagnosis Logic ....................................400
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... .400
EC-5
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
EC
A
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 401
Remove and Installation ....................................... 401
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL
FUNCTION ............................................................. . 402
Description .......................................................... . 402
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. . 402
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 402
Wiring Diagram ................................................... . 403
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 404
Component Inspection ......................................... 408
Remove and Installation ....................................... 408
DTCP1124, P1126THROTTLECONTROLMOTOR
RELAY ................................................................... . 409
Component Description ........................................ 409
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 409
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. . 409
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 409
Wiring Diagram ................................................... .. 411
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 412
Component Inspection ......................................... 413
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR ........ 415
Component Description ........................................ 415
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. . 415
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 415
Wiring Diagram ................................................... . 416
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 417
Component Inspection ......................................... 418
Remove and Installation ....................................... 419
DTC P1143 HO2S1 (QG16DE) .............................. . 420
Component Description ........................................ 420
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 420
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. . 420
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 421
Overall Function Check ....................................... . 422
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 422
Component Inspection ......................................... 424
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 425
DTC P1143, P1163 HO2S1 (QG18DE) ................... 426
Component Description ........................................ 426
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 426
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. . 426
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 427
Overall Function Check ....................................... . 428
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 428
Component Inspection ......................................... 430
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 431
DTC P1144 HO2S1 (QG16DE) .............................. . 432
Component Description ........................................ 432
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 432
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. . 432
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 433
Overall Function Check ....................................... . 433
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 434
Component Inspection ......................................... . 436
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 437
DTC P1144, P1164 HO2S1 (QG18DE) .................. . 438
Component Description ....................................... . 438
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 438
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 438
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 439
Overall Function Check ....................................... . 440
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 440
Component Inspection ......................................... . 442
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 443
DTC P1146 HO2S2 (QG16DE) ............................... 444
Component Description ....................................... . 444
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 444
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 444
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 444
Overall Function Check ....................................... . 446
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 447
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 448
Component Inspection ......................................... . 450
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 451
DTC P1146, P1166 HO2S2 (QG18DE) .................. . 452
Component Description ....................................... . 452
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 452
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 452
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 452
Overall Function Check ....................................... . 454
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 455
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 458
Component Inspection ......................................... . 460
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 461
DTC P1147 HO2S2 (QG16DE) ............................... 462
Component Description ....................................... . 462
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 462
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 462
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 462
Overall Function Check ....................................... . 464
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 465
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 466
Component Inspection ......................................... . 468
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 469
DTC P1147, P1167 HO2S2 (QG18DE) .................. . 470
Component Description ....................................... . 470
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 470
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 470
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 470
Overall Function Check ....................................... . 472
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 473
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 476
Component Inspection ......................................... . 478
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 479
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE ........ 480
System Description .............................................. . 480
EC-6
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 480
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 481
Overall Function Check ....................................... . 481
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 483
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 484
Main 12 Causes of Overheating .......................... . 488
Component Inspection .......................................... 489
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR ........................... . 490
Component Description ....................................... . 490
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 490
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 490
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 490
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 492
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 493
Component Inspection .......................................... 495
Remove and Installation ....................................... 495
DTC P1225 TP SENSOR ....................................... . 496
Component Description ....................................... . 496
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 496
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 496
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 497
Remove and Installation ....................................... 497
DTC P1226 TP SENSOR ....................................... . 498
Component Description ....................................... . 498
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 498
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 498
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 499
Remove and Installation ....................................... 499
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR ......................... 500
Component Description ....................................... . 500
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 500
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 500
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 500
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 502
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 503
Component Inspection .......................................... 505
Remove and Installation ....................................... 506
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY ............... . 507
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 507
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 507
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 508
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 509
DTC P1706 PNP SWITCH ..................................... . 511
Component Description ....................................... . 511
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 511
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 511
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 511
Overall Function Check ....................................... . 512
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 513
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 514
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH ................................ . 515
Description ........................................................... . 515
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 515
On Board Diagnosis Logic ....................................515
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... .515
Wiring Diagram .....................................................516
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................517
Component Inspection ..........................................519
IGNITION SIGNAL ................................................. .520
Component Description ........................................520
Wiring Diagram .....................................................521
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................524
Component Inspection ..........................................528
Removal and Installation ...................................... .529
INJECTOR CIRCUIT .............................................. .530
Component Description ........................................530
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
.530
Wiring Diagram .....................................................531
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................532
Component Inspection ..........................................535
Removal and Installation ...................................... .535
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT .............................................536
Description ............................................................536
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
.536
Wiring Diagram .....................................................537
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................538
Component Inspection ..........................................540
Removal and Installation ...................................... .541
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR ................. .542
Component Description ........................................542
Wiring Diagram .....................................................543
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................544
Removal and Installation ...................................... .546
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL ............................... .547
Description ............................................................547
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
.547
Wiring Diagram .....................................................548
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................549
MI & DATA LINK CONNECTORS ...........................552
Wiring DiagramLHD Models ..............................552
Wiring DiagramRHD Models .............................553
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM .................... .554
Description ............................................................554
Component Inspection ..........................................556
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION ............... .557
Description ............................................................557
Component Inspection ..........................................557
SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS) ... .559
Fuel Pressure ....................................................... .559
Idle Speed and Ignition Timing ............................. .559
Calculated Load Value ......................................... .559
Mass Air Flow Sensor ...........................................559
Intake Air Temperature Sensor .............................559
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor ....................559
Heated Oxygen Sensor 1 Heater ......................... .559
Heated Oxygen sensor 2 Heater ..........................559
Crankshaft Position Sensor (POS) ...................... .559
Camshaft Position Sensor (PHASE) .................... .559
EC-7
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
EC
A
Throttle Control Motor ......................................... . 560
Injector ................................................................. 560
Fuel Pump ........................................................... . 560
QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)
INDEX FOR DTC ................................................... . 561
Alphabetical Index ............................................... . 561
DTC No. Index ..................................................... 563
PRECAUTIONS ...................................................... 567
Precautions for Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) AIR BAG and SEAT BELT PRE-TEN-
SIONER ............................................................. . 567
On Board Diagnostic (OBD) System of Engine .... 567
Precaution ........................................................... . 567
Wiring Diagrams and Trouble Diagnosis .............. 570
PREPARATION ...................................................... . 571
Special Service Tools .......................................... . 571
Commercial Service Tools ................................... . 571
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM ................................ 573
System Diagram - QG16DE Engine Models ........ 573
System Diagram - QG18DE Engine Models ........ 574
Vacuum Hose Drawing ......................................... 575
System Chart ...................................................... . 576
Multiport Fuel Injection (MFI) System .................. 576
Electronic Ignition (EI) System ............................ . 579
Air Conditioning Cut Control ................................ . 579
Fuel Cut Control (at No Load and High Engine
Speed) ................................................................. . 580
CAN communication ............................................ 580
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE ........................... . 588
Idle Speed and Ignition Timing Check .................. 588
Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning .... 589
Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning ............. . 589
Idle Air Volume Learning ..................................... . 589
Fuel Pressure Check ............................................ 591
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM ......... . 593
Introduction .......................................................... 593
Two Trip Detection Logic ..................................... . 593
Emission-related Diagnostic Information .............. 593
NATS (Nissan Anti-theft System) ......................... 595
Malfunction Indicator (MI) ..................................... 596
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS ......................................... . 600
Trouble Diagnosis Introduction ............................ . 600
DTC Inspection Priority Chart .............................. 604
Fail-safe Chart ..................................................... . 605
Basic Inspection ................................................... 607
Symptom Matrix Chart ........................................ . 612
Engine Control Component Parts Location .......... 616
Circuit Diagram ................................................... . 620
ECM Harness Connector Terminal Layout ........... 622
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................. 622
CONSULT-II Function ......................................... . 636
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 646
Major Sensor Reference Graph in Data Monitor
Mode ................................................................... . 649
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATIONVALUE. 652
Description ............................................................ 652
Testing Condition ................................................. . 652
Inspection Procedure ........................................... . 652
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 653
TROUBLEDIAGNOSISFORINTERMITTENTINCI-
DENT ...................................................................... . 656
Description ............................................................ 656
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 656
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM ................... 657
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 657
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 658
Component Inspection ......................................... . 662
DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE. 663
Description ............................................................ 663
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 663
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 663
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 664
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 665
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR ....................... . 666
Component Description ....................................... . 666
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 666
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 666
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 666
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 668
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 669
Component Inspection ......................................... . 671
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 671
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR ......................... 672
Component Description ....................................... . 672
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 672
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 673
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 674
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 675
Component Inspection ......................................... . 676
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 676
DTC P0132 HO2S1 (QG16DE) .............................. . 677
Component Description ....................................... . 677
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 677
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 677
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 678
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 679
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 680
Component Inspection ......................................... . 681
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 682
DTC P0132, P0152 HO2S1 (QG18DE) ................... 683
Component Description ....................................... . 683
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 683
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 683
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 684
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 685
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 688
Component Inspection ......................................... . 689
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 691
EC-8
DTC P0134 HO2S1 (QG16DE) .............................. . 692
Component Description ....................................... . 692
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 692
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 692
Overall Function Check ....................................... . 693
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 694
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 695
Component Inspection .......................................... 696
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 697
DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1 (QG18DE) .................. . 698
Component Description ....................................... . 698
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 698
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 698
Overall Function Check ....................................... . 699
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 700
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 703
Component Inspection .......................................... 704
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 706
DTC P0138 HO2S2 (QG16DE) .............................. . 707
Component Description ....................................... . 707
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 707
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 707
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 707
Overall Function Check ....................................... . 708
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 709
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 710
Component Inspection .......................................... 712
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 713
DTC P0138, P0158 HO2S2 (QG18DE) .................. . 714
Component Description ....................................... . 714
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 714
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 714
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 714
Overall Function Check ....................................... . 715
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 716
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 719
Component Inspection .......................................... 721
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 722
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR ....................................... . 723
Component Description ....................................... . 723
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 723
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 723
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 723
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 725
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 726
Component Inspection .......................................... 728
Remove and Installation ....................................... 728
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR ........................... . 729
Component Description ....................................... . 729
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 729
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... . 729
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 729
Wiring Diagram .....................................................731
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................732
Component Inspection ..........................................734
Remove and Installation ...................................... .734
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR ..................................... .735
Component Description ........................................735
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
.735
On Board Diagnosis Logic ....................................735
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... .735
Wiring Diagram .....................................................737
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................738
Component Inspection ..........................................740
Remove and Installation ...................................... .741
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR .........................742
Component Description ........................................742
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
.742
On Board Diagnosis Logic ....................................742
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... .742
Wiring Diagram .....................................................744
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................745
Component Inspection ..........................................747
Remove and Installation ...................................... .748
DTC P0327, P0328 KS ............................................749
Component Description ........................................749
On Board Diagnosis Logic ....................................749
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... .749
Wiring Diagram .....................................................750
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................751
Component Inspection ..........................................752
Removal and Installation ...................................... .752
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS) ......................... .753
Component Description ........................................753
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
.753
On Board Diagnosis Logic ....................................753
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... .753
Wiring Diagram .....................................................755
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................756
Component Inspection ..........................................758
Removal and Installation ...................................... .759
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE) .................... .760
Component Description ........................................760
On Board Diagnosis Logic ....................................760
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... .760
Wiring Diagram .....................................................762
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................763
Component Inspection ..........................................765
Removal and Installation ...................................... .766
DTC P0605 ECM .....................................................767
Component Description ........................................767
On Board Diagnosis Logic ....................................767
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... .767
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................769
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY ........................770
Component Description ........................................770
On Board Diagnosis Logic ....................................770
EC-9
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
EC
A
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 770
Wiring Diagram ................................................... . 771
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 772
DTC P1102 MAF SENSOR ..................................... 774
Component Description ........................................ 774
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 774
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. . 774
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 774
Wiring Diagram ................................................... . 776
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 777
Component Inspection ......................................... 779
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 779
DTC P1121 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL
ACTUATOR ........................................................... . 780
Component Description ........................................ 780
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. . 780
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 780
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 781
Remove and Installation ....................................... 782
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL
FUNCTION ............................................................. . 783
Description .......................................................... . 783
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. . 783
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 783
Wiring Diagram ................................................... . 784
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 785
Component Inspection ......................................... 789
Remove and Installation ....................................... 789
DTCP1124, P1126THROTTLECONTROLMOTOR
RELAY ................................................................... . 790
Component Description ........................................ 790
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 790
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. . 790
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 790
Wiring Diagram ................................................... . 792
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 793
Component Inspection ......................................... 794
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR ........ 796
Component Description ........................................ 796
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. . 796
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. . 796
Wiring Diagram ................................................... . 797
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 798
Component Inspection ......................................... 799
Remove and Installation ....................................... 800
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE ...... . 801
System Description .............................................. 801
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 801
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. . 802
Overall Function Check ....................................... . 802
Wiring Diagram ................................................... . 804
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 805
Main 12 Causes of Overheating ........................... 809
Component Inspection ......................................... 810
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR ............................ 811
Component Description ....................................... . 811
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 811
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 811
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 811
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 813
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 814
Component Inspection ......................................... . 816
Remove and Installation ...................................... . 816
DTC P1225 TP SENSOR ....................................... . 817
Component Description ....................................... . 817
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 817
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 817
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 818
Remove and Installation ...................................... . 818
DTC P1226 TP SENSOR ....................................... . 819
Component Description ....................................... . 819
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 819
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 819
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 820
Remove and Installation ...................................... . 820
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR ........................ . 821
Component Description ....................................... . 821
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 821
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 821
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 821
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 823
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 824
Component Inspection ......................................... . 826
Remove and Installation ...................................... . 827
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY ............... . 828
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 828
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 828
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 829
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 830
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH ................................ . 832
Description ............................................................ 832
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 832
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................... 832
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 832
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 833
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 834
Component Inspection ......................................... . 836
HO2S1 HEATER (QG16DE) .................................. . 837
Description ............................................................ 837
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 837
Wiring Diagram ..................................................... 838
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 839
Component Inspection ......................................... . 841
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 841
HO2S1 HEATER (QG18DE) .................................. . 842
Description ............................................................ 842
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 842
EC-10
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 843
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 846
Component Inspection .......................................... 848
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 848
HO2S2 HEATER (QG16DE) .................................. . 849
Description ........................................................... . 849
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 849
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 850
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 851
Component Inspection .......................................... 853
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 853
HO2S2 HEATER (QG18DE) .................................. . 854
Description ........................................................... . 854
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 854
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 855
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 858
Component Inspection .......................................... 860
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 860
IAT SENSOR .......................................................... . 861
Component Description ....................................... . 861
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 862
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 863
Component Inspection .......................................... 864
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 864
HO2S1 (QG16DE) ................................................... 865
Component Description ....................................... . 865
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 865
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 866
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 867
Component Inspection .......................................... 870
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 871
HO2S1 (QG18DE) ................................................... 872
Component Description ....................................... . 872
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 872
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 873
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 876
Component Inspection .......................................... 879
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 880
HO2S2 (QG16DE) ................................................... 881
Component Description ....................................... . 881
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 881
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 882
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 883
Component Inspection .......................................... 885
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 886
HO2S2 (QG18DE) ................................................... 887
Component Description ....................................... . 887
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 887
Wiring Diagram .................................................... . 888
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 891
Component Inspection .......................................... 893
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 894
IGNITION SIGNAL ................................................. .895
Component Description ........................................895
Wiring Diagram .....................................................896
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................899
Component Inspection ..........................................903
Removal and Installation ...................................... .904
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL
SOLENOID VALVE ................................................. .905
Description ............................................................905
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
.905
Wiring Diagram .....................................................906
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................908
Component Inspection .......................................... 911
Removal and Installation ...................................... . 911
VSS ..........................................................................912
Description ............................................................912
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................912
POWER STEERING PRESSURE SENSOR .......... .913
Component Description ........................................913
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
.913
Wiring Diagram .....................................................914
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................915
Component Inspection ..........................................917
IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE ....................... .918
Description ............................................................918
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
.918
Wiring Diagram .....................................................920
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................921
Component Inspection ..........................................923
Removal and Installation ...................................... .923
PNP SWITCH ......................................................... .924
Component Description ........................................924
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
.924
Wiring Diagram .....................................................925
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................926
INJECTOR CIRCUIT .............................................. .928
Component Description ........................................928
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
.928
Wiring Diagram .....................................................929
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................930
Component Inspection ..........................................933
Removal and Installation ...................................... .933
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT .............................................934
Description ............................................................934
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
.934
Wiring Diagram .....................................................935
Diagnostic Procedure ............................................936
Component Inspection ..........................................938
Removal and Installation ...................................... .939
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR ................. .940
Component Description ........................................940
Wiring Diagram .....................................................941
EC-11
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
EC
A
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 942
Removal and Installation ..................................... . 944
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL ................................ 945
Description .......................................................... . 945
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
. 945
Wiring Diagram ................................................... . 946
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... . 947
MI & DATA LINK CONNECTORS ......................... . 950
Wiring DiagramLHD Models ............................ . 950
Wiring DiagramRHD Models ............................ 951
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM .................... . 952
Description .......................................................... . 952
Component Inspection ......................................... 954
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION .............. . 955
Description .......................................................... . 955
Component Inspection ......................................... 955
SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS) .... 957
Fuel Pressure ...................................................... . 957
Idle Speed and Ignition Timing ............................ . 957
Calculated Load Value ........................................ . 957
Mass Air Flow Sensor ......................................... . 957
Intake Air Temperature Sensor ............................ 957
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor ................... 957
Heated Oxygen Sensor 1 Heater ......................... 957
Heated Oxygen sensor 2 Heater ......................... . 957
Crankshaft Position Sensor (POS) ....................... 957
Camshaft Position Sensor (PHASE) .................... 957
Throttle Control Motor ......................................... . 958
Injector ................................................................. 958
Fuel Pump ........................................................... . 958
QR (WITH EURO-OBD)
INDEX FOR DTC ................................................... . 959
Alphabetical Index ............................................... . 959
DTC No. Index ..................................................... 961
PRECAUTIONS ...................................................... 964
Precautions for Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) AIR BAG and SEAT BELT PRE-TEN-
SIONER ............................................................. . 964
On Board Diagnostic (OBD) Systemof Engine and
CVT ...................................................................... 964
Precaution ........................................................... . 964
Wiring Diagrams and Trouble Diagnosis .............. 967
PREPARATION ...................................................... . 968
Special Service Tools .......................................... . 968
Commercial Service Tools ................................... . 968
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM ................................ 970
System Diagram ................................................... 970
Vacuum Hose Drawing ......................................... 971
System Chart ...................................................... . 972
Multiport Fuel Injection (MFI) System .................. 972
Electronic Ignition (EI) System ............................ . 975
Air Conditioning Cut Control ................................ . 975
Fuel Cut Control (at No Load and High Engine
Speed) ................................................................. . 976
CAN communication ............................................ 976
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE ............................. 997
Idle Speed and Ignition Timing Check ................. . 997
Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning ... . 998
Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning ............... 998
Idle Air Volume Learning ..................................... . 999
Fuel Pressure Check ........................................... 1001
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM ......... 1004
Introduction .......................................................... 1004
Two Trip Detection Logic ..................................... 1004
Emission-related Diagnostic Information ............. 1005
NATS (Nissan Anti-theft System) ........................ 1016
Malfunction Indicator (MI) .................................... 1016
OBD System Operation Chart ............................. 1019
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS ......................................... 1025
Trouble Diagnosis Introduction ............................ 1025
DTC Inspection Priority Chart .............................. 1029
Fail-safe Chart ..................................................... 1030
Basic Inspection .................................................. 1032
Symptom Matrix Chart ......................................... 1037
Engine Control Component Parts Location ......... 1041
Circuit Diagram .................................................... 1045
ECM Harness Connector Terminal Layout .......... 1047
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................. 1047
CONSULT-II Function .......................................... 1054
Generic Scan Tool (GST) Function ...................... 1065
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1067
Major Sensor Reference Graph in Data Monitor
Mode .................................................................... 1070
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATIONVALUE1072
Description ........................................................... 1072
Testing Condition ................................................. 1072
Inspection Procedure ........................................... 1072
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1073
TROUBLEDIAGNOSISFORINTERMITTENTINCI-
DENT ...................................................................... 1076
Description ........................................................... 1076
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1076
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM .................. 1077
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1077
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1078
Component Inspection ......................................... 1082
DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE1083
Description ........................................................... 1083
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1083
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1083
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1084
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1085
DTC P0011 IVT CONTROL .................................... 1087
Description ........................................................... 1087
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1087
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1088
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1088
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1088
DTC P0031, P0032 HO2S1 HEATER .................... 1090
Description ........................................................... 1090
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
EC-12
1090
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1090
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1090
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1092
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1093
Component Inspection ......................................... 1094
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1094
DTC P0037, P0038 HO2S2 HEATER .................... 1095
Description ........................................................... 1095
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1095
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1095
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1095
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1097
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1098
Component Inspection ......................................... 1099
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1099
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR ........................ 1100
Component Description ....................................... 1100
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1100
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1100
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1100
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1102
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1103
Component Inspection ......................................... 1105
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1105
DTC P0112, P0113 IAT SENSOR .......................... 1106
Component Description ....................................... 1106
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1106
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1106
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1108
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1109
Component Inspection .........................................1110
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1110
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR .........................1111
Component Description .......................................1111
On Board Diagnosis Logic ...................................1111
DTC Confirmation Procedure ..............................1112
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1113
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1114
Component Inspection .........................................1115
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1115
DTC P0127 IAT SENSOR ...................................... 1116
Component Description ....................................... 1116
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1116
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1116
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1117
Component Inspection .........................................1117
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1118
DTC P0132 HO2S1 ................................................ 1119
Component Description ....................................... 1119
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1119
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1119
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1120
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1121
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1122
Component Inspection ......................................... 1123
Removal and Installation ...................................... 1124
DTC P0133 HO2S1 ................................................ 1125
Component Description ....................................... 1125
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1125
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1125
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 1126
Overall Function Check ........................................ 1127
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1128
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1129
Component Inspection ......................................... 1132
Removal and Installation ...................................... 1134
DTC P0134 HO2S1 ................................................ 1135
Component Description ....................................... 1135
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1135
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1135
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 1136
Overall Function Check ........................................ 1136
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1138
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1139
Component Inspection ......................................... 1140
Removal and Installation ...................................... 1141
DTC P0138 HO2S2 ................................................ 1142
Component Description ....................................... 1142
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1142
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1142
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 1142
Overall Function Check ........................................ 1143
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1144
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1145
Component Inspection ......................................... 1147
Removal and Installation ...................................... 1148
DTC P0139 HO2S2 ................................................ 1149
Component Description ....................................... 1149
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1149
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1149
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 1149
Overall Function Check ........................................ 1151
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1152
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1153
Component Inspection ......................................... 1155
Removal and Installation ...................................... 1156
DTCP0171FUELINJECTIONSYSTEMFUNCTION1157
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1157
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 1157
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1159
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1160
DTCP0172FUELINJECTIONSYSTEMFUNCTION1163
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1163
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 1163
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1165
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1166
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR ....................................... 1169
Component Description ....................................... 1169
EC-13
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
EC
A
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1169
On Board Diagnosis Logic ..................................1169
DTC Confirmation Procedure ..............................1169
Wiring Diagram ...................................................1171
Diagnostic Procedure ..........................................1172
Component Inspection ........................................1174
Remove and Installation ......................................1174
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR ..........................1175
Component Description .......................................1175
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1175
On Board Diagnosis Logic ..................................1175
DTC Confirmation Procedure ..............................1175
Wiring Diagram ...................................................1177
Diagnostic Procedure ..........................................1178
Component Inspection ........................................1180
Remove and Installation ......................................1180
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR ....................................1181
Component Description .......................................1181
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1181
On Board Diagnosis Logic ..................................1181
DTC Confirmation Procedure ..............................1181
Wiring Diagram ...................................................1183
Diagnostic Procedure ..........................................1184
Component Inspection ........................................1187
Remove and Installation ......................................1187
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR .......................1188
Component Description .......................................1188
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1188
On Board Diagnosis Logic ..................................1188
DTC Confirmation Procedure ..............................1188
Wiring Diagram ...................................................1190
Diagnostic Procedure ..........................................1191
Component Inspection ........................................1193
Remove and Installation ......................................1194
DTC P0300 - P0304 MULTIPLE CYLINDER MIS-
FIRE, NO. 1 - 4 CYLINDER MISFIRE ....................1195
On Board Diagnosis Logic ..................................1195
DTC Confirmation Procedure ..............................1195
Diagnostic Procedure ..........................................1196
DTC P0327, P0328 KS .......................................... 1201
Component Description .......................................1201
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. 1201
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1201
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1202
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1203
Component Inspection ........................................ 1204
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1204
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS) ......................... 1205
Component Description .......................................1205
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1205
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. 1205
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1205
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1207
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1208
Component Inspection ......................................... 1210
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1211
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE) .................... 1212
Component Description ....................................... 1212
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1212
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1212
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1213
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1214
Component Inspection ......................................... 1216
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1217
DTC P0420 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION1218
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1218
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1218
Overall Function Check ....................................... 1219
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1220
DTCP0444, P0445EVAPCANISTERPURGEVOL-
UME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE ..................... 1222
Description ........................................................... 1222
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1222
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1223
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1223
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1224
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1225
Component Inspection ......................................... 1227
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1227
DTC P0500 VSS ..................................................... 1228
Description ........................................................... 1228
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1228
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1228
Overall Function Check ....................................... 1228
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1229
DTC P0550 PSP SENSOR .................................... 1230
Component Description ....................................... 1230
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1230
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1230
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1230
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1231
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1232
Component Inspection ......................................... 1234
DTC P0605 ECM .................................................... 1235
Component Description ....................................... 1235
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1235
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1235
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1237
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY ...................... 1238
Component Description ....................................... 1238
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1238
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1238
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1239
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1240
DTC P1111 IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE .... 1242
Component Description ....................................... 1242
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1242
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1242
EC-14
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1242
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1243
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1244
Component Inspection ......................................... 1245
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1245
DTC P1121 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL
ACTUATOR ............................................................ 1246
Component Description ....................................... 1246
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1246
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1246
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1247
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1247
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL
FUNCTION ............................................................. 1248
Description ........................................................... 1248
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1248
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1248
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1249
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1250
Component Inspection ......................................... 1254
Remove and Installation ...................................... 1254
DTCP1124, P1126THROTTLECONTROLMOTOR
RELAY .................................................................... 1255
Component Description ....................................... 1255
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1255
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1255
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1255
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1257
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1258
Component Inspection ......................................... 1259
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR ........ 1261
Component Description ....................................... 1261
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1261
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1261
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1262
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1263
Component Inspection ......................................... 1264
Remove and Installation ...................................... 1265
DTC P1143 HO2S1 ................................................ 1266
Component Description ....................................... 1266
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1266
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1266
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1267
Overall Function Check ....................................... 1268
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1268
Component Inspection ......................................... 1270
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1271
DTC P1144 HO2S1 ................................................ 1272
Component Description ....................................... 1272
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1272
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1272
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1273
Overall Function Check ....................................... 1273
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1274
Component Inspection ......................................... 1276
Removal and Installation ...................................... 1277
DTC P1146 HO2S2 ................................................. 1278
Component Description ....................................... 1278
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1278
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1278
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 1278
Overall Function Check ........................................ 1280
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1281
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1282
Component Inspection ......................................... 1284
Removal and Installation ...................................... 1285
DTC P1147 HO2S2 ................................................. 1286
Component Description ....................................... 1286
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1286
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1286
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 1286
Overall Function Check ........................................ 1288
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1289
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1290
Component Inspection ......................................... 1292
Removal and Installation ...................................... 1293
DTC P1212 ESP/TCS/ABS COMMUNICATION
LINE ........................................................................ 1294
Description ........................................................... 1294
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1294
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 1294
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1294
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE ....... 1295
System Description .............................................. 1295
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1295
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1296
Overall Function Check ........................................ 1296
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1298
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1300
Main 12 Causes of Overheating .......................... 1310
Component Inspection ......................................... 1311
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR ........................... 1312
Component Description ....................................... 1312
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1312
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1312
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 1312
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1314
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1315
Component Inspection ......................................... 1317
Remove and Installation ...................................... 1317
DTC P1225 TP SENSOR ....................................... 1318
Component Description ....................................... 1318
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1318
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 1318
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1319
Remove and Installation ...................................... 1319
DTC P1226 TP SENSOR ....................................... 1320
Component Description ....................................... 1320
EC-15
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
EC
A
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. 1320
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1320
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1321
Remove and Installation ...................................... 1321
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR ....................... 1322
Component Description .......................................1322
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1322
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. 1322
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1322
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1324
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1325
Component Inspection ........................................ 1327
Remove and Installation ...................................... 1328
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY ............... 1329
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. 1329
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1329
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1330
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1331
DTC P1564 ICC STEERING SWITCH ...................1333
Component Description .......................................1333
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1333
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. 1333
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1333
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1335
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1337
Component Inspection ........................................ 1339
DTC P1568 ICC FUNCTION .................................. 1340
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. 1340
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1340
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1340
DTC P1572 ICC BRAKE SWITCH ........................ 1341
Component Description .......................................1341
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1341
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. 1341
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1341
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1343
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1344
Component Inspection ........................................ 1349
DTC P1574 ICC VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ....... 1351
Component Description .......................................1351
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. 1351
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1351
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1352
DTC P1706 PNP SWITCH ..................................... 1353
Component Description .......................................1353
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1353
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. 1353
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1353
Overall Function Check ....................................... 1354
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1355
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1356
DTC P1720 VSS .................................................... 1358
Description .......................................................... 1358
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1358
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1358
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1358
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1358
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH ................................ 1360
Description ........................................................... 1360
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1360
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1360
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1360
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1361
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1362
Component Inspection ......................................... 1363
IGNITION SIGNAL ................................................. 1365
Component Description ....................................... 1365
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1366
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1369
Component Inspection ......................................... 1373
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1374
INJECTOR CIRCUIT .............................................. 1375
Component Description ....................................... 1375
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1375
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1376
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1377
Component Inspection ......................................... 1380
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1380
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT ........................................... 1381
Description ........................................................... 1381
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1381
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1382
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1383
Component Inspection ......................................... 1385
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1386
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR ................. 1387
Component Description ....................................... 1387
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1388
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1389
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1391
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL ............................... 1392
Description ........................................................... 1392
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1392
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1393
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1394
ICC BRAKE SWITCH ............................................ 1397
Component Description ....................................... 1397
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1397
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1398
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1399
Component Inspection ......................................... 1404
MI & DATA LINK CONNECTORS .......................... 1406
Wiring Diagram (LHD Models) ............................. 1406
Wiring Diagram (RHD Models) ............................ 1407
EC-16
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM .................... 1408
Description ........................................................... 1408
Component Inspection ......................................... 1410
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION .............. 1411
Description ........................................................... 1411
Component Inspection ......................................... 1411
SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS) ... 1413
Fuel Pressure ...................................................... 1413
Idle Speed and Ignition Timing ............................ 1413
Calculated Load Value ......................................... 1413
Mass Air Flow Sensor .......................................... 1413
Intake Air Temperature Sensor ............................ 1413
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor .................. 1413
Heated Oxygen Sensor 1 Heater ........................ 1413
Heated Oxygen sensor 2 Heater ......................... 1413
Crankshaft Position Sensor (POS) ...................... 1413
Camshaft Position Sensor (PHASE) ................... 1413
Throttle Control Motor .......................................... 1414
Injector ................................................................. 1414
Fuel Pump ........................................................... 1414
QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)
INDEX FOR DTC .................................................... 1415
Alphabetical Index ............................................... 1415
DTC No. Index ..................................................... 1416
PRECAUTIONS ...................................................... 1418
Precautions for Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) AIR BAG and SEAT BELT PRE-TEN-
SIONER .............................................................. 1418
On Board Diagnostic (OBD) System of Engine ... 1418
Precaution ........................................................... 1418
Wiring Diagrams and Trouble Diagnosis ............. 1421
PREPARATION ...................................................... 1422
Special Service Tools .......................................... 1422
Commercial Service Tools ................................... 1422
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM ............................... 1424
System Diagram .................................................. 1424
Vacuum Hose Drawing ........................................ 1425
System Chart ....................................................... 1426
Multiport Fuel Injection (MFI) System .................. 1426
Electronic Ignition (EI) System ............................ 1429
Air Conditioning Cut Control ................................ 1429
Fuel Cut Control (at No Load and High Engine
Speed) ................................................................. 1430
CAN communication ............................................ 1430
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE ............................ 1439
Idle Speed and Ignition Timing Check ................. 1439
Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning ... 1440
Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning .............. 1440
Idle Air Volume Learning ..................................... 1440
Fuel Pressure Check ........................................... 1443
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM ......... 1445
Introduction .......................................................... 1445
Two Trip Detection Logic ..................................... 1445
Emission-related Diagnostic Information ............. 1445
NATS (Nissan Anti-theft System) ......................... 1447
Malfunction Indicator (MI) .................................... 1448
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS ......................................... 1451
Trouble Diagnosis Introduction ............................ 1451
DTC Inspection Priority Chart .............................. 1455
Fail-safe Chart ..................................................... 1456
Basic Inspection ................................................... 1457
Symptom Matrix Chart ......................................... 1462
Engine Control Component Parts Location .......... 1466
Circuit Diagram .................................................... 1470
ECM Harness Connector Terminal Layout ........... 1472
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................. 1472
CONSULT-II Function .......................................... 1479
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1489
Major Sensor Reference Graph in Data Monitor
Mode .................................................................... 1492
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATIONVALUE1494
Description ........................................................... 1494
Testing Condition ................................................. 1494
Inspection Procedure ........................................... 1494
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1495
TROUBLEDIAGNOSISFORINTERMITTENTINCI-
DENT ...................................................................... 1498
Description ........................................................... 1498
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1498
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM .................. 1499
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1499
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1500
Component Inspection ......................................... 1504
DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE1505
Description ........................................................... 1505
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1505
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 1505
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1506
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1507
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR ........................ 1508
Component Description ....................................... 1508
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1508
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1508
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 1508
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1510
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1511
Component Inspection ......................................... 1513
Removal and Installation ...................................... 1513
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR ......................... 1514
Component Description ....................................... 1514
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1514
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 1515
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1516
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1517
Component Inspection ......................................... 1518
Removal and Installation ...................................... 1518
DTC P0134 HO2S1 ................................................ 1519
Component Description ....................................... 1519
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1519
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1519
Overall Function Check ........................................ 1520
EC-17
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
EC
A
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1521
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1522
Component Inspection ........................................ 1523
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1524
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR ....................................... 1525
Component Description .......................................1525
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1525
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. 1525
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1525
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1527
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1528
Component Inspection ........................................ 1530
Remove and Installation ...................................... 1530
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR ..........................1531
Component Description .......................................1531
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1531
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. 1531
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1531
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1533
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1534
Component Inspection ........................................ 1536
Remove and Installation ...................................... 1536
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR .................................... 1537
Component Description .......................................1537
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1537
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. 1537
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1537
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1539
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1540
Component Inspection ........................................ 1543
Remove and Installation ...................................... 1543
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR ....................... 1544
Component Description .......................................1544
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1544
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. 1544
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1544
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1546
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1547
Component Inspection ........................................ 1549
Remove and Installation ...................................... 1550
DTC P0327, P0328 KS .......................................... 1551
Component Description .......................................1551
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. 1551
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1551
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1552
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1553
Component Inspection ........................................ 1554
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1554
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS) ......................... 1555
Component Description .......................................1555
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1555
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. 1555
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1555
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1557
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1558
Component Inspection ......................................... 1560
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1561
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE) .................... 1562
Component Description ....................................... 1562
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1562
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1562
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1564
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1565
Component Inspection ......................................... 1567
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1568
DTC P0500 VSS ..................................................... 1569
Description ........................................................... 1569
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1569
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1569
Overall Function Check ....................................... 1569
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1570
DTC P0550 PSP SENSOR .................................... 1571
Component Description ....................................... 1571
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1571
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1571
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1571
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1572
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1573
Component Inspection ......................................... 1575
DTC P0605 ECM .................................................... 1576
Component Description ....................................... 1576
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1576
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1576
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1578
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY ...................... 1579
Component Description ....................................... 1579
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1579
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1579
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1580
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1581
DTC P1121 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL
ACTUATOR ............................................................ 1583
Component Description ....................................... 1583
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1583
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1583
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1584
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1584
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL
FUNCTION ............................................................. 1585
Description ........................................................... 1585
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1585
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1585
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1586
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1587
Component Inspection ......................................... 1591
Remove and Installation ...................................... 1591
DTCP1124, P1126THROTTLECONTROLMOTOR
RELAY .................................................................... 1592
Component Description ....................................... 1592
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
EC-18
1592
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1592
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1592
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1594
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1595
Component Inspection ......................................... 1596
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR ........ 1598
Component Description ....................................... 1598
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1598
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1598
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1599
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1600
Component Inspection ......................................... 1601
Remove and Installation ...................................... 1602
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE ....... 1603
System Description .............................................. 1603
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1603
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1604
Overall Function Check ....................................... 1604
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1606
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1608
Main 12 Causes of Overheating .......................... 1618
Component Inspection ......................................... 1619
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR ........................... 1620
Component Description ....................................... 1620
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1620
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1620
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1620
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1622
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1623
Component Inspection ......................................... 1625
Remove and Installation ...................................... 1625
DTC P1225 TP SENSOR ....................................... 1626
Component Description ....................................... 1626
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1626
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1626
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1627
Remove and Installation ...................................... 1627
DTC P1226 TP SENSOR ....................................... 1628
Component Description ....................................... 1628
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1628
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1628
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1629
Remove and Installation ...................................... 1629
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR ........................ 1630
Component Description ....................................... 1630
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1630
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1630
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1630
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1632
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1633
Component Inspection ......................................... 1635
Remove and Installation ...................................... 1636
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY ............... 1637
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1637
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 1637
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1638
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1639
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH ................................ 1641
Description ........................................................... 1641
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1641
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1641
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 1641
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1642
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1643
Component Inspection ......................................... 1644
HO2S1 HEATER ..................................................... 1646
Description ........................................................... 1646
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1646
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1647
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1648
Component Inspection ......................................... 1650
Removal and Installation ...................................... 1650
HO2S2 HEATER ..................................................... 1651
Description ........................................................... 1651
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1651
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1652
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1653
Component Inspection ......................................... 1655
Removal and Installation ...................................... 1655
IAT SENSOR .......................................................... 1656
Component Description ....................................... 1656
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1657
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1658
Component Inspection ......................................... 1659
Removal and Installation ...................................... 1659
HO2S1 .................................................................... 1660
Component Description ....................................... 1660
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1660
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1661
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1662
Component Inspection ......................................... 1664
Removal and Installation ...................................... 1665
HO2S2 .................................................................... 1666
Component Description ....................................... 1666
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1666
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1667
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1668
Component Inspection ......................................... 1669
Removal and Installation ...................................... 1671
IGNITION SIGNAL ................................................. 1672
Component Description ....................................... 1672
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1673
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1676
Component Inspection ......................................... 1680
Removal and Installation ...................................... 1681
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL
EC-19
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
EC
A
SOLENOID VALVE ................................................ 1682
Description .......................................................... 1682
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1682
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1683
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1685
Component Inspection ........................................ 1688
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1688
IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE ....................... 1689
Description .......................................................... 1689
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1689
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1691
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1692
Component Inspection ........................................ 1694
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1694
PNP SWITCH ......................................................... 1695
Component Description .......................................1695
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1695
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1696
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1697
INJECTOR CIRCUIT .............................................. 1699
Component Description .......................................1699
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1699
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1700
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1701
Component Inspection ........................................ 1704
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1704
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT ...........................................1705
Description .......................................................... 1705
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1705
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1706
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1707
Component Inspection ........................................ 1709
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1710
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR ................1711
Component Description .......................................1711
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1712
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1713
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1715
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL ............................... 1716
Description .......................................................... 1716
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1716
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1717
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1718
MI & DATA LINK CONNECTORS ......................... 1721
Wiring Diagram (LHD Models) ............................ 1721
Wiring Diagram (RHD Models) ............................ 1722
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM .................... 1723
Description .......................................................... 1723
Component Inspection ........................................ 1725
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION .............. 1726
Description .......................................................... 1726
Component Inspection ........................................ 1726
SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS) ... 1728
Fuel Pressure ...................................................... 1728
Idle Speed and Ignition Timing ............................ 1728
Calculated Load Value ......................................... 1728
Mass Air Flow Sensor .......................................... 1728
Intake Air Temperature Sensor ............................ 1728
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor .................. 1728
Heated Oxygen Sensor 1 Heater ........................ 1728
Heated Oxygen sensor 2 Heater ......................... 1728
Crankshaft Position Sensor (POS) ...................... 1728
Camshaft Position Sensor (PHASE) ................... 1728
Throttle Control Motor .......................................... 1729
Injector ................................................................. 1729
Fuel Pump ........................................................... 1729
YD
INDEX FOR DTC .................................................... 1730
Alphabetical Index ............................................... 1730
DTC No. Index ..................................................... 1730
PRECAUTIONS ..................................................... 1732
Precautions for Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) AIR BAG and SEAT BELT PRE-TEN-
SIONER .............................................................. 1732
Precautions .......................................................... 1732
Wiring Diagrams and Trouble Diagnosis ............. 1734
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM ............................... 1735
System Diagram .................................................. 1735
Vacuum Hose Drawing ........................................ 1736
System Chart ....................................................... 1737
Fuel Injection Control System .............................. 1737
Fuel Injection Timing Control System .................. 1739
Air Conditioning Cut Control ................................ 1739
Fuel Cut Control (At NoLoad&HighEngineSpeed) 1739
Crankcase Ventilation System ............................. 1740
CAN communication ............................................ 1740
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE ............................ 1745
Fuel Filter ............................................................. 1745
Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning ... 1745
Fuel Pressure Relief Valve .................................. 1746
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM ......... 1748
DTC and MI Detection Logic ............................... 1748
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) .......................... 1748
NATS (Nissan Anti-theft System) ........................ 1748
Malfunction Indicator (MI) .................................... 1749
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS ......................................... 1751
Trouble Diagnosis Introduction ............................ 1751
Basic Inspection .................................................. 1754
Symptom Matrix Chart ......................................... 1758
Engine Control Component Parts Location ......... 1762
Circuit Diagram .................................................... 1765
ECM Harness Connector Terminal Layout .......... 1767
ECM Terminals And Reference Value ................. 1767
CONSULT-II Function .......................................... 1773
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1779
Major Sensor Reference Graph in Data Monitor
Mode .................................................................... 1781
EC-20
TROUBLEDIAGNOSISFORINTERMITTENTINCI-
DENT ...................................................................... 1783
Description ........................................................... 1783
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1783
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM .................. 1784
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................. 1784
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1785
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1786
Component Inspection ......................................... 1789
DTC U1000 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE ........... 1790
Description ........................................................... 1790
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1790
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1790
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1791
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1792
DTC P0100 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR (MAFS) . 1793
Component Description ....................................... 1793
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1793
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................. 1793
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1794
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1794
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1795
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1796
Component Inspection ......................................... 1797
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1797
DTC P0115 ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
(ECT) SENSOR (CIRCUIT) .................................... 1798
Description ........................................................... 1798
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1798
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1798
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1799
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1800
Component Inspection ......................................... 1801
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1801
DTC P0120 ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR ................................................................. 1802
Description ........................................................... 1802
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1802
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................. 1802
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1803
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1803
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1804
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1805
Component Inspection ......................................... 1809
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1809
DTC P0190 COMMON RAIL FUEL PRESSURE
SENSOR ................................................................. 1810
Description ........................................................... 1810
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1810
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................. 1810
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1810
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1810
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1811
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1812
Component Inspection ......................................... 1813
Removal and Installation ...................................... 1813
DTC P0201 - P0204 FUEL INJECTOR .................. 1814
Description ........................................................... 1814
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1814
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................. 1814
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1815
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 1816
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1817
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1819
Component Inspection ......................................... 1820
Removal and Installation ...................................... 1820
DTC P0235 CHARGE AIR PRESSURE SENSOR1821
Component Description ....................................... 1821
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................. 1821
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1821
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 1821
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1823
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1824
Component Inspection ......................................... 1826
Removal and Installation ...................................... 1826
DTC P0335 CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(TDC) ...................................................................... 1827
Description ........................................................... 1827
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1827
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................. 1827
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1828
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 1828
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1829
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1830
Component Inspection ......................................... 1830
Removal and Installation ...................................... 1831
DTC P0340 CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR ...... 1832
Description ........................................................... 1832
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................. 1832
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1832
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 1832
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1834
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1835
Component Inspection ......................................... 1835
Removal and Installation ...................................... 1836
DTC P0500 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (VSS) ..... 1837
Description ........................................................... 1837
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1837
Overall Function Check ........................................ 1837
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1837
DTC P1107 ABSOLUTE PRESSURE SENSOR .... 1838
Description ........................................................... 1838
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1838
DTC Confirmation Procedure ............................... 1838
Diagnostic Procedure ........................................... 1838
DTC P1180 FUEL TEMPERATURE SENSOR ....... 1840
Description ........................................................... 1840
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1840
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................. 1840
EC-21
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
EC
A
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. 1840
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1840
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1841
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1842
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1842
DTC P1216 EDU .................................................... 1843
Description .......................................................... 1843
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................1843
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. 1844
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1844
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1845
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1847
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1849
DTC P1217 OVERHEAT (COOLING SYSTEM) .... 1850
Description .......................................................... 1850
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1850
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................1850
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. 1851
Overall Function Check ....................................... 1851
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1853
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1855
Main 12 Causes of Overheating .......................... 1863
Component Inspection ........................................ 1864
DTC P1233 - P1234 SUCTION CONTROL VALVE1865
Description .......................................................... 1865
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1865
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................1865
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. 1866
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1866
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1867
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1868
Component Inspection ........................................ 1868
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1869
DTC P1301 - P1304 FUEL INJECTOR ADJUST-
MENT RESISTOR .................................................. 1870
Description .......................................................... 1870
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................1870
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. 1870
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1870
Wiring Diagram ................................................... 1871
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1872
Component Inspection ........................................ 1873
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1873
DTC P1305 FUEL LEAK ....................................... 1874
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. 1874
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1874
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1874
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1874
DTC P1510 ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED
POSITION SWITCH ............................................... 1876
Description .......................................................... 1876
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1876
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................1876
On Board Diagnosis Logic .................................. 1877
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1877
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1878
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1879
Component Inspection ......................................... 1880
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1880
DTC P1606 ECM .................................................... 1881
Description ........................................................... 1881
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1881
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1881
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1881
DTC P1621 ECM RELAY ....................................... 1883
ECM Terminals and Reference valve .................. 1883
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1883
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1883
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1884
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1885
Component Inspection ......................................... 1886
DTC P1660 BATTERY VOLTAGE ......................... 1887
On Board Diagnosis Logic ................................... 1887
DTC Confirmation Procedure .............................. 1887
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1887
GLOW CONTROL SYSTEM .................................. 1889
Description ........................................................... 1889
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................. 1889
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1890
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1891
Component Inspection ......................................... 1894
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1895
EGR VOLUME CONTROL SYSTEM ..................... 1896
Description ........................................................... 1896
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1896
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................. 1897
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1898
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1899
Component Inspection ......................................... 1901
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1902
VARIABLE NOZZLE TURBOCHARGER CON-
TROL SOLENOID VALVE ...................................... 1903
Description ........................................................... 1903
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................. 1903
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1904
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1905
Component Inspection ......................................... 1907
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1908
BRAKE SWITCH .................................................... 1909
Description ........................................................... 1909
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................. 1909
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1910
Diagnostic Procedure ..........................................1911
Component Inspection ......................................... 1912
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION (PNP) SWITCH ....... 1913
Description ........................................................... 1913
CONSULT-II ReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1913
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................. 1913
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1914
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1915
EC-22
START SIGNAL ..................................................... 1916
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1916
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1917
POWER STEERING OIL PRESSURE SWITCH .... 1918
Component Description ....................................... 1918
CONSULT-IIReferenceValueinDataMonitorMode
1918
ECM Terminals and Reference Value .................. 1918
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1919
Diagnostic Procedure .......................................... 1920
Component Inspection ......................................... 1921
Removal and Installation ..................................... 1921
MI & DATA LINK CONNECTORS .......................... 1922
Wiring Diagram .................................................... 1922
SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS) ... 1923
General Specifications ......................................... 1923
Mass Air Flow Sensor .......................................... 1923
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor ................... 1923
Common Rail Fuel Pressure Sensor ................... 1923
Crankshaft Position Sensor (TDC) ....................... 1923
Camshaft Position Sensor ................................... 1923
Glow Plug ............................................................. 1923
EGR Volume Control Valve .................................. 1923
INDEX FOR DTC
EC-23
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
INDEX FOR DTC PFP:00024
Alphabetical Index EBS00EL6
Check if the vehicle is a model with Euro-OBD (E-OBD) system or not by the Type approval number on the
identification plate. Refer to GI-46, "IDENTIFICATION PLATE" .
NOTE:
If DTC U1000 or U1001 is displayed with other DTC, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-150, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
QG16DE ENGINE MODELS
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC*
1
Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM*
3
APP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
P0227 0227 EC-331
APP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
P0228 0228 EC-331
APP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
P1227 1227 EC-500
APP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
P1228 1228 EC-500
APP SENSOR*
5
P0226 0226 EC-324
BRAKE SW/CIRCUIT P1805 1805 EC-515
CAN COMM CIRCUIT U1001 1001*
6
EC-150
CKP SEN/CIRCUIT P0335 0335 EC-348
CMP SEN/CIRC-B1 P0340 0340 EC-355
CTP LEARNING P1225 1225 EC-496
CTP LEARNING P1226 1226 EC-498
CYL 1 MISFIRE P0301 0301 EC-338
CYL 2 MISFIRE P0302 0302 EC-338
CYL 3 MISFIRE P0303 0303 EC-338
CYL 4 MISFIRE P0304 0304 EC-338
ECM P0605 0605 EC-382
ECM BACK UP/CIRC P1065 1065 EC-385
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
P0117 0117 EC-194
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
P0118 0118 EC-194
ENG OVER TEMP P1217 1217 EC-480
ETC ACTR*
5
P1121 1121 EC-400
ETC FUNCTION/CIRC*
5
P1122 1122 EC-402
ETC MOT
*5
P1128 1128 EC-415
ETC MOT PWR
*5
P1124 1124 EC-409
ETC MOT PWR*
5
P1126 1126 EC-409
FUEL SYS-LEAN-B1 P0171 0171 EC-285
FUEL SYS-RICH-B1 P0172 0172 EC-299
HO2S1 (B1) P0132 0132 EC-199
HO2S1 (B1) P0133 0133 EC-214
HO2S1 (B1) P0134 0134 EC-234
HO2S1 (B1) P1143 1143 EC-420
HO2S1 (B1) P1144 1144 EC-432
EC-24
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
INDEX FOR DTC
*1: 1st trip DTC No. is the same as DTC No.
*2: These numbers are prescribed by ISO 15031-5.
*3: In Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results), these numbers are controlled by NISSAN.
*4: When engine is running.
*5: When the fail-safe operation occurs, the MI illuminates.
*6: The troubleshooting for this DTC needs CONSULT-II.
HO2S1 HTR (B1) P0031 0031 EC-156
HO2S1 HTR (B1) P0032 0032 EC-156
HO2S2 (B1) P0138 0138 EC-251
HO2S2 (B1) P0139 0139 EC-267
HO2S2 (B1) P1146 1146 EC-444
HO2S2 (B1) P1147 1147 EC-462
HO2S2 HTR (B1) P0037 0037 EC-170
HO2S2 HTR (B1) P0038 0038 EC-170
IAT SEN/CIRCUIT P0112 0112 EC-189
IAT SEN/CIRCUIT P0113 0113 EC-189
INT/V TIM CONT-B1 P0011 0011 EC-153
INT/V TIM V/CIR-B1 P1111 1111 EC-395
KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 P0327 0327 EC-344
KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 P0328 0328 EC-344
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
P0102 0102 EC-183
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
P0103 0103 EC-183
MAF SENSOR*
5
P1102 1102 EC-389
MULTI CYL MISFIRE P0300 0300 EC-338
NATS MALFUNCTION P1610 - P1615 1610 - 1615 EC-75
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.
No DTC
Flashing*
4
EC-76
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.
P0000 0000
P-N POS SW/CIRCUIT P1706 1706 EC-511
PURG VOLUME CONT/V P0444 0444 EC-369
PURG VOLUME CONT/V P0445 0445 EC-369
PW ST P SEN/CIRC P0550 0550 EC-377
SENSOR POWER/CIRC*
5
P1229 1229 EC-507
TP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
P0222 0222 EC-318
TP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
P0223 0223 EC-318
TP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
P1223 1223 EC-490
TP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
P1224 1224 EC-490
TP SENSOR*
5
P0221 0221 EC-312
TW CATALYST SYS-B1 P0420 0420 EC-361
VEH SPEED SEN/CIRC P0500 0500 EC-375
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC*
1
Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM*
3
INDEX FOR DTC
EC-25
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
QR18DE ENGINE MODELS
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC*
1
Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM*
3
A/T 1ST GR FNCTN P0731 0731 AT-131
A/T 2ND GR FNCTN P0732 0732 AT-138
A/T 3RD GR FNCTN P0733 0733 AT-144
A/T 4TH GR FNCTN P0734 0734 AT-150
APP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
P0227 0227 EC-331
APP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
P0228 0228 EC-331
APP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
P1227 1227 EC-500
APP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
P1228 1228 EC-500
APP SENSOR*
5
P0226 0226 EC-324
ATF TEMP SEN/CIRC P0710 0710 AT-116
BRAKE SW/CIRCUIT P1805 1805 EC-515
CAN COMM CIRCUIT U1000 1000*
6
EC-150
CAN COMM CIRCUIT U1001 1001*
6
EC-150
CKP SEN/CIRCUIT P0335 0335 EC-348
CMP SEN/CIRC-B1 P0340 0340 EC-355
CTP LEARNING P1225 1225 EC-496
CTP LEARNING P1226 1226 EC-498
CYL 1 MISFIRE P0301 0301 EC-338
CYL 2 MISFIRE P0302 0302 EC-338
CYL 3 MISFIRE P0303 0303 EC-338
CYL 4 MISFIRE P0304 0304 EC-338
ECM P0605 0605 EC-382
ECM BACK UP/CIRC P1065 1065 EC-385
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
P0117 0117 EC-194
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
P0118 0118 EC-194
ENG OVER TEMP P1217 1217 EC-480
ENGINE SPEED SIG P0725 0725 AT-127
ETC ACTR*
5
P1121 1121 EC-400
ETC FUNCTION/CIRC*
5
P1122 1122 EC-402
ETC MOT
*5
P1128 1128 EC-415
ETC MOT PWR
*5
P1124 1124 EC-409
ETC MOT PWR*
5
P1126 1126 EC-409
FUEL SYS-LEAN-B1 P0171 0171 EC-291
FUEL SYS-LEAN-B2 P0174 0174 EC-291
FUEL SYS-RICH-B1 P0172 0172 EC-305
FUEL SYS-RICH-B2 P0175 0175 EC-305
HO2S1 (B1) P0132 0132 EC-205
HO2S1 (B1) P0133 0133 EC-223
HO2S1 (B1) P0134 0134 EC-241
EC-26
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
INDEX FOR DTC
HO2S1 (B1) P1143 1143 EC-426
HO2S1 (B1) P1144 1144 EC-438
HO2S1 (B2) P0152 0152 EC-205
HO2S1 (B2) P0153 0153 EC-223
HO2S1 (B2) P0154 0154 EC-241
HO2S1 (B2) P1163 1163 EC-426
HO2S1 (B2) P1164 1164 EC-438
HO2S1 HTR (B1) P0031 0031 EC-162
HO2S1 HTR (B1) P0032 0032 EC-162
HO2S1 HTR (B2) P0051 0051 EC-162
HO2S1 HTR (B2) P0052 0052 EC-162
HO2S2 (B1) P0138 0138 EC-258
HO2S2 (B1) P0139 0139 EC-275
HO2S2 (B1) P1146 1146 EC-452
HO2S2 (B1) P1147 1147 EC-470
HO2S2 (B2) P0158 0158 EC-258
HO2S2 (B2) P0159 0159 EC-275
HO2S2 (B2) P1166 1166 EC-452
HO2S2 (B2) P1167 1167 EC-470
HO2S2 HTR (B1) P0037 0037 EC-175
HO2S2 HTR (B1) P0038 0038 EC-175
HO2S2 HTR (B2) P0057 0057 EC-175
HO2S2 HTR (B2) P0058 0058 EC-175
IAT SEN/CIRCUIT P0112 0112 EC-189
IAT SEN/CIRCUIT P0113 0113 EC-189
INT/V TIM CONT-B1 P0011 0011 EC-153
INT/V TIM V/CIR-B1 P1111 1111 EC-395
KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 P0327 0327 EC-344
KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 P0328 0328 EC-344
L/PRESS SOL/CIRC P0745 0745 AT-163
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
P0102 0102 EC-183
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
P0103 0103 EC-183
MAF SENSOR*
5
P1102 1102 EC-389
MULTI CYL MISFIRE P0300 0300 EC-338
NATS MALFUNCTION P1610 - P1615 1610 - 1615 EC-75
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.
No DTC
Flashing*
4
EC-76
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.
P0000 0000
O/R CLTCH SOL/CIRC P1760 1760 AT-185
P-N POS SW/CIRCUIT P1706 1706 EC-511
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC*
1
Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM*
3
INDEX FOR DTC
EC-27
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
*1: 1st trip DTC No. is the same as DTC No.
*2: These numbers are prescribed by ISO 15031-5.
*3: In Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results), these numbers are controlled by NISSAN.
*4: When engine is running.
*5: When the fail-safe operation occurs, the MI illuminates.
*6: The trouble shooting for these DTCs needs CONSULT-II.
*7: When the fail-safe operations for both self-diagnoses occur, the MI illuminates.
NOTE:
Regarding P12 models with QG18DE engine, B1 indicates bank 1, B2 indicates bank 2.
DTC No. Index EBS00EL7
Check if the vehicle is a model with Euro-OBD (E-OBD) system or not by the Type approval number on the
identification plate. Refer to GI-46, "IDENTIFICATION PLATE" .
NOTE:
If DTC U1000 or U1001 is displayed with other DTC, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-150, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
QG16DE ENGINE MODELS
PNP SW/CIRC P0705 0705 AT-110
PURG VOLUME CONT/V P0444 0444 EC-369
PURG VOLUME CONT/V P0445 0445 EC-369
PW ST P SEN/CIRC P0550 0550 EC-377
SENSOR POWER/CIRC*
5
P1229 1229 EC-507
SFT SOL A/CIRC*
5
P0750 0750 AT-170
SFT SOL B/CIRC*
5
P0755 0755 AT-175
TCC SOLENOID/CIRC P0740 0740 AT-158
TP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
P0222 0222 EC-318
TP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
P0223 0223 EC-318
TP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
P1223 1223 EC-490
TP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
P1224 1224 EC-490
TP SENSOR*
5
P0221 0221 EC-312
TPV SEN/CIRC A/T P1705 1705 AT-180
TW CATALYST SYS-B1 P0420 0420 EC-365
TW CATALYST SYS-B2 P0430 0430 EC-365
VEH SPD SEN/CIR AT*
7
P0720 0720 AT-122
VEH SPEED SEN/CIRC*7 P0500 0500 EC-375
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC*
1
Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM*
3
DTC*
1
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM*
3
No DTC Flashing*
4
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.
EC-76
U1001
1001*
6
CAN COMM CIRCUIT EC-150
P0000 0000
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.

EC-28
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
INDEX FOR DTC
P0011 0011 INT/V TIM CONT-B1 EC-153
P0031 0031 HO2S1 HTR (B1) EC-156
P0032 0032 HO2S1 HTR (B1) EC-156
P0037 0037 HO2S2 HTR (B1) EC-170
P0038 0038 HO2S2 HTR (B1) EC-170
P0102 0102
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
EC-183
P0103 0103
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
EC-183
P0112 0112 IAT SEN/CIRCUIT EC-189
P0113 0113 IAT SEN/CIRCUIT EC-189
P0117 0117
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
EC-194
P0118 0118
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
EC-194
P0132 0132 HO2S1 (B1) EC-199
P0133 0133 HO2S1 (B1) EC-214
P0134 0134 HO2S1 (B1) EC-234
P0138 0138 HO2S2 (B1) EC-251
P0139 0139 HO2S2 (B1) EC-267
P0171 0171 FUEL SYS-LEAN-B1 EC-285
P0172 0172 FUEL SYS-RICH-B1 EC-299
P0221 0221
TP SENSOR*
5
EC-312
P0222 0222
TP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
EC-318
P0223 0223
TP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
EC-318
P0226 0226
APP SENSOR*
5
EC-324
P0227 0227
APP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
EC-331
P0228 0228
APP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
EC-331
P0300 0300 MULTI CYL MISFIRE EC-338
P0301 0301 CYL 1 MISFIRE EC-338
P0302 0302 CYL 2 MISFIRE EC-338
P0303 0303 CYL 3 MISFIRE EC-338
P0304 0304 CYL 4 MISFIRE EC-338
P0327 0327 KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 EC-344
P0328 0328 KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 EC-344
P0335 0335 CKP SEN/CIRCUIT EC-348
P0340 0340 CMP SEN/CIRC-B1 EC-355
P0420 0420 TW CATALYST SYS-B1 EC-361
P0444 0444 PURG VOLUME CONT/V EC-369
P0445 0445 PURG VOLUME CONT/V EC-369
P0500 0500 VEH SPEED SEN/CIRC EC-375
P0550 0550 PW ST P SEN/CIRC EC-377
P0605 0605 ECM EC-382
P1065 1065 ECM BACK UP/CIRC EC-385
DTC*
1
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM*
3
INDEX FOR DTC
EC-29
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
*1: 1st trip DTC No. is the same as DTC No.
*2: These numbers are prescribed by ISO 15031-5.
*3: In Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results), these numbers are controlled by NISSAN.
*4: When engine is running.
*5: When the fail-safe operation occurs, the MI illuminates.
*6: The trouble shooting for this DTC needs CONSULT-II.
QG18DE ENGINE MODELS
P1102 1102 MAF SENSOR*
5
EC-389
P1111 1111 INT/V TIM V/CIR-B1 EC-395
P1121 1121
ETC ACTR*
5
EC-400
P1122 1122
ETC FUNCTION/CIRC*
5
EC-402
P1124 1124
ETC MOT PWR
*5
EC-409
P1126 1126
ETC MOT PWR*
5
EC-409
P1128 1128 ETC MOT
*5
EC-415
P1143 1143 HO2S1 (B1) EC-420
P1144 1144 HO2S1 (B1) EC-432
P1146 1146 HO2S2 (B1) EC-444
P1147 1147 HO2S2 (B1) EC-462
P1217 1217 ENG OVER TEMP EC-480
P1223 1223
TP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
EC-490
P1224 1224
TP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
EC-490
P1225 1225 CTP LEARNING EC-496
P1226 1226 CTP LEARNING EC-498
P1227 1227
APP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
EC-500
P1228 1228
APP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
EC-500
P1229 1229
SENSOR POWER/CIRC*
5
EC-507
P1610 - P1615 1610 - 1615 NATS MALFUNCTION EC-75
P1706 1706 P-N POS SW/CIRCUIT EC-511
P1805 1805 BRAKE SW/CIRCUIT EC-515
DTC*
1
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM*
3
DTC*
1
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM*
3
No DTC
Flashing*
4
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.
EC-76
U1000 1000*
6
CAN COMM CIRCUIT EC-150
U1001 1001*
6
CAN COMM CIRCUIT EC-150
P0000 0000
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.

P0011 0011 INT/V TIM CONT-B1 EC-153


P0031 0031 HO2S1 HTR (B1) EC-162
EC-30
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
INDEX FOR DTC
P0032 0032 HO2S1 HTR (B1) EC-162
P0037 0037 HO2S2 HTR (B1) EC-175
P0038 0038 HO2S2 HTR (B1) EC-175
P0051 0051 HO2S1 HTR (B2) EC-162
P0052 0052 HO2S1 HTR (B2) EC-162
P0057 0057 HO2S2 HTR (B2) EC-175
P0058 0058 HO2S2 HTR (B2) EC-175
P0102 0102
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
EC-183
P0103 0103
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
EC-183
P0112 0112 IAT SEN/CIRCUIT EC-189
P0113 0113 IAT SEN/CIRCUIT EC-189
P0117 0117
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
EC-194
P0118 0118
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
EC-194
P0132 0132 HO2S1 (B1) EC-205
P0133 0133 HO2S1 (B1) EC-223
P0134 0134 HO2S1 (B1) EC-241
P0138 0138 HO2S2 (B1) EC-258
P0139 0139 HO2S2 (B1) EC-275
P0152 0152 HO2S1 (B2) EC-205
P0153 0153 HO2S1 (B2) EC-223
P0154 0154 HO2S1 (B2) EC-241
P0158 0158 HO2S2 (B2) EC-258
P0159 0159 HO2S2 (B2) EC-275
P0171 0171 FUEL SYS-LEAN-B1 EC-291
P0172 0172 FUEL SYS-RICH-B1 EC-305
P0174 0174 FUEL SYS-LEAN-B2 EC-291
P0175 0175 FUEL SYS-RICH-B2 EC-305
P0221 0221
TP SENSOR*
5
EC-312
P0222 0222
TP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
EC-318
P0223 0223 TP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
EC-318
P0226 0226 APP SENSOR*
5
EC-324
P0227 0227 APP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
EC-331
P0228 0228
APP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
EC-331
P0300 0300 MULTI CYL MISFIRE EC-338
P0301 0301 CYL 1 MISFIRE EC-338
P0302 0302 CYL 2 MISFIRE EC-338
P0303 0303 CYL 3 MISFIRE EC-338
P0304 0304 CYL 4 MISFIRE EC-338
P0327 0327 KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 EC-344
P0328 0328 KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 EC-344
DTC*
1
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM*
3
INDEX FOR DTC
EC-31
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
P0335 0335 CKP SEN/CIRCUIT EC-348
P0340 0340 CMP SEN/CIRC-B1 EC-355
P0420 0420 TW CATALYST SYS-B1 EC-365
P0430 0430 TW CATALYST SYS-B2 EC-365
P0444 0444 PURG VOLUME CONT/V EC-369
P0445 0445 PURG VOLUME CONT/V EC-369
P0500 0500 VEH SPEED SEN/CIRC*
7
EC-375
P0550 0550 PW ST P SEN/CIRC EC-377
P0605 0605 ECM EC-382
P0705 0705 PNP SW/CIRC AT-110
P0710 0710 ATF TEMP SEN/CIRC AT-116
P0720 0720 VEH SPD SEN/CIRC AT*
7
AT-122
P0725 0725 ENGINE SPEED SIG AT-127
P0731 0731 A/T 1ST GR FNCTN AT-131
P0732 0732 A/T 2ND GR FNCTN AT-138
P0733 0733 A/T 3RD GR FNCTN AT-144
P0734 0734 A/T 4TH GR FNCTN AT-150
P0740 0740 TCC SOLENOID/CIRC AT-158
P0745 0745 L/PRESS SOL/CIRC AT-163
P0750 0750
SFT SOL A/CIRC*
5
AT-170
P0755 0755
SFT SOL B/CIRC*
5
AT-175
P1065 1065 ECM BACK UP/CIRC EC-385
P1102 1102
MAF SENSOR*
5
EC-389
P1111 1111 INT/V TIM V/CIR-B1 EC-395
P1121 1121 ETC ACTR*
5
EC-400
P1122 1122 ETC FUNCTION/CIRC*
5
EC-402
P1124 1124 ETC MOT PWR*
5
EC-409
P1126 1126 ETC MOT PWR*
5
EC-409
P1128 1128
ETC MOT*
5
EC-415
P1143 1143 HO2S1 (B1) EC-426
P1144 1144 HO2S1 (B1) EC-438
P1146 1146 HO2S2 (B1) EC-452
P1147 1147 HO2S2 (B1) EC-470
P1163 1163 HO2S1 (B2) EC-426
P1164 1164 HO2S1 (B2) EC-438
P1166 1166 HO2S2 (B2) EC-452
P1167 1167 HO2S2 (B2) EC-470
P1217 1217 ENG OVER TEMP EC-480
P1223 1223
TP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
EC-490
P1224 1224
TP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
EC-490
DTC*
1
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM*
3
EC-32
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
INDEX FOR DTC
*1: 1st trip DTC No. is the same as DTC No.
*2: These numbers are prescribed by ISO 15031-5.
*3: In Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results), these numbers are controlled by NISSAN.
*4: When engine is running.
*5: When the fail-safe operation occurs, the MI illuminates.
*6: The trouble shooting for these DTCs need CONSULT-II.
*7: When the fail-safe operations for both self-diagnoses occur at the same time, the MI illuminates.
NOTE:
Regarding P12 models with QG18DE engine, B1 indicates bank 1, B2 indicates bank 2.
P1225 1225 CTP LEARNING EC-496
P1226 1226 CTP LEARNING EC-498
P1227 1227 APP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
EC-500
P1228 1228 APP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
EC-500
P1229 1229
SENSOR POWER/CIRC*
5
EC-507
P1610 - P1615 1610 - 1615 NATS MALFUNCTION EC-75
P1705 1705 TPV SEN/CIRC A/T AT-180
P1706 1706 P-N POS SW/CIRCUIT EC-511
P1760 1760 O/R CLTCH SOL/CIRC AT-185
P1805 1805 BRAKE SW/CIRCUIT EC-515
DTC*
1
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM*
3
PRECAUTIONS
EC-33
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
PRECAUTIONS PFP:00001
Precautions for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) AIR BAG and SEAT
BELT PRE-TENSIONER EBS00EL8
The Supplemental Restraint System such as "AIR BAG" and "SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER", used along
with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SRS and SB section of
this Service Manual.
WARNING:
G To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death
in the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be per-
formed by an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
G Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to per-
sonal injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air
Bag Module, see the SRS section.
G Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harness connec-
tors.
On Board Diagnostic (OBD) System of Engine and A/T EBS00EL9
The ECM has an on board diagnostic system. It will light up the malfunction indicator (MI) to warn the driver of
a malfunction causing emission deterioration.
CAUTION:
G Be sure to turn the ignition switch OFF and disconnect the battery ground cable before any repair
or inspection work. The open/short circuit of related switches, sensors, solenoid valves, etc. will
cause the MI to light up.
G Be sure to connect and lock the connectors securely after work. A loose (unlocked) connector will
cause the MI to light up due to the open circuit. (Be sure the connector is free from water, grease,
dirt, bent terminals, etc.)
G Certain systems and components, especially those related to OBD, may use a new style slide-
locking type harness connector. For description and how to disconnect, refer to PG-86, "HAR-
NESS CONNECTOR" .
G Be sure to route and secure the harnesses properly after work. The interference of the harness
with a bracket, etc. may cause the MI to light up due to the short circuit.
G Be sure to connect rubber tubes properly after work. A misconnected or disconnected rubber tube
may cause the MI to light up due to the malfunction of the fuel injection system, etc.
G Be sure to erase the unnecessary malfunction information (repairs completed) from the ECM and
TCM (Transmission control module) before returning the vehicle to the customer.
Precaution EBS00ELA
G Always use a 12 volt battery as power source.
G Do not attempt to disconnect battery cables while engine is
running.
G Before connecting or disconnecting the ECM harness con-
nector, turn ignition switch OFF and disconnect battery
ground cable. Failure to do so may damage the ECM
because battery voltage is applied to ECM even if ignition
switch is turned off.
G Before removing parts, turn ignition switch OFF and then
disconnect battery ground cable.
SEF289H
EC-34
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
PRECAUTIONS
G Do not disassemble ECM.
G If battery cable is disconnected, the memory will return to
the initial ECM values.
The ECM will now start to self-control at its initial values.
Engine operation can vary slightly when the cable is dis-
connected. However, this is not an indication of a problem.
Do not replace parts because of a slight variation.
G When connecting ECM harness connector, fasten it
securely with levers as far as they will go as shown at right.
G When connecting or disconnecting pin connectors into or
from ECM, take care not to damage pin terminals (bend or
break).
Make sure that there are not any bends or breaks on ECM
pin terminal, when connecting pin connectors.
G Securely connect ECM harness connectors.
A poor connection can cause an extremely high (surge)
voltage to develop in coil and condenser, thus resulting in
damage to ICs.
G Keep engine control system harness at least 10 cm (4 in)
away from adjacent harness, to prevent engine control sys-
tem malfunctions due to receiving external noise, degraded
operation of ICs, etc.
G Keep engine control system parts and harness dry.
G Before replacing ECM, perform ECM Terminals and Refer-
ence Value inspection and make sure ECM functions prop-
erly. Refer to EC-107, "ECM Terminals and Reference Value"
.
G Handle mass air flow sensor carefully to avoid damage.
G Do not disassemble mass air flow sensor.
G Do not clean mass air flow sensor with any type of deter-
gent.
G Do not disassemble electric throttle control actuator.
G Even a slight leak in the air intake system can cause seri-
ous problems.
G Do not shock or jar the camshaft position sensor (PHASE), crankshaft position sensor (POS).
SEF707Y
MBIB0145E
PBIB0090E
MEF040D
PRECAUTIONS
EC-35
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
G After performing each TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS, perform
DTC Confirmation Procedure or Overall Function
Check.
The DTC should not be displayed in the DTC Confirmation
Procedure if the repair is completed. The Overall Func-
tion Check should be a good result if the repair is com-
pleted.
G When measuring ECM signals with a circuit tester, connect
a break-out box (SST) and Y-cable adapter (SST) between
the ECM and ECM harness connector.
G When measuring ECM signals with a circuit tester, never
allow the two tester probes to contact.
Accidental contact of probes will cause a short circuit and
damage the ECM power transistor.
G Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/
output voltage. Doing so may result in damage to the ECM's
transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as
the ground.
G Do not operate fuel pump when there is no fuel in lines.
G Tighten fuel hose clamps to the specified torque.
SAT652J
SEF348N
MBIB0046E
EC-36
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
PRECAUTIONS
G Do not depress accelerator pedal when starting.
G Immediately after starting, do not rev up engine unneces-
sarily.
G Do not rev up engine just prior to shutdown.
G When installing C.B. ham radio or a mobile phone, be sure
to observe the following as it may adversely affect elec-
tronic control systems depending on installation location.
Keep the antenna as far as possible from the electronic
control units.
Keep the antenna feeder line more than 20 cm (8 in) away
from the harness of electronic controls.
Do not let them run parallel for a long distance.
Adjust the antenna and feeder line so that the standing-
wave radio can be kept smaller.
Be sure to ground the radio to vehicle body.
G Regarding P12 models with QG18DE engine, B1 indicates
bank 1 (cylinders number 1 and 4), B2 indicates bank 2
(cylinders number 2 and 3).
Wiring Diagrams and Trouble Diagnosis EBS00ELB
When you read wiring diagrams, refer to the following:
G GI-14, "How to Read Wiring Diagrams"
G PG-3, "POWER SUPPLY ROUTING" for power distribution circuit
When you perform trouble diagnosis, refer to the following:
G GI-11, "HOW TO FOLLOW TEST GROUPS IN TROUBLE DIAGNOSES"
G GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident"
SEF709Y
SEF708Y
SEF440Y
PREPARATION
EC-37
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
PREPARATION PFP:00002
Special Service Tools EBS00ELC
Commercial Service Tools EBS00ELD
Tool number
Tool name
Description
KV10117100
Heated oxygen
sensor wrench
Loosening or tightening heated oxygen sensors
with 22 mm (0.87 in) hexagon nut
KV10114400
Heated oxygen
sensor wrench
Loosening or tightening heated oxygen sensors
a: 22 mm (0.87 in)
KV109E0010
Break-out box
Measuring the ECM signals with a circuit tester
KV109E0080
Y-cable adapter
Measuring the ECM signals with a circuit tester
S-NT379
S-NT636
S-NT825
S-NT826
Tool name Description
Quick connector
release
Removing fuel tube quick connectors in engine
room
(Available in SEC. 164 of PARTS CATALOG:
Part No. 16441 6N210)
Fuel filler cap adapter Checking fuel tank vacuum relief valve opening
pressure
PBIC0198E
S-NT653
EC-38
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
PREPARATION
Socket wrench Removing and installing engine coolant
temperature sensor
Oxygen sensor
thread cleaner
ie: (J-43897-18)
(J-43897-12)
Reconditioning the exhaust system threads
before installing a new oxygen sensor. Use with
anti-seize lubricant shown below.
a: 18 mm diameter with pitch 1.5 mm for
Zirconia Oxygen Sensor
b: 12 mm diameter with pitch 1.25 mm for
Titania Oxygen Sensor
Anti-seize lubricant
ie: (Permatex
TM
133AR or equivalent
meeting MIL
specification MIL-A-
907)
Lubricating oxygen sensor thread cleaning tool
when reconditioning exhaust system threads.
Tool name Description
S-NT705
AEM488
S-NT779
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-39
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM PFP:23710
System Diagram - QG16DE Engine Models EBS00ELE
MBIB0011E
EC-40
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
System Diagram - QG18DE Engine Models EBS00GBC
MBIB0012E
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-41
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Vacuum Hose Drawing EBS00ELF
Refer to EC-39, "System Diagram - QG16DE Engine Models" or EC-40, "System Diagram - QG18DE
Engine Models" for Vacuum Control System.
MBIB0013E
EC-42
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
System Chart EBS00ELG
*1: This sensor is not used to control the engine system under normal conditions.
*2: The signals are sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
*3: The output signals are sent from the ECM through CAN communication line.
Multiport Fuel Injection (MFI) System EBS00ELH
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
*1: Under normal conditions, this sensor is not for engine control operation.
*2: This signal is sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
*3: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
Input (Sensor) ECM Function Output (Actuator)
G Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
G Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
G Mass air flow sensor
G Engine coolant temperature sensor
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
G Throttle position sensor
G Accelerator pedal position sensor
G Park/neutral position (PNP) switch
G Intake air temperature sensor
G Power steering pressure sensor
G Ignition switch
G Stop lamp switch
G Battery voltage
G Knock sensor
G Refrigerant pressure sensor
G Heated oxygen sensor 2
*1
G TCM (Transmission control module)
*2
G Air conditioner switch
*2
G Vehicle speed signal
*2
G Electrical load signal
*2
Fuel injection & mixture ratio control Fuel injectors
Electronic ignition system Power transistor
Fuel pump control Fuel pump relay
On board diagnostic system
MI (On the instrument panel)
*3
Intake valve timing control
Intake valve timing control solenoid
valve
Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater control Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater control Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
EVAP canister purge flow control
EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve
Air conditioning cut control
Air conditioner relay
*3
Cooling fan control
Cooling fan relay
*3
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
*3
and piston position
Fuel injection & mixture
ratio control
Fuel injectors
Mass air flow sensor Amount of intake air
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Heated oxygen sensor 1 Density of oxygen in exhaust gas
Throttle position sensor Throttle position
Accelerator pedal position sensor Accelerator pedal position
Park/neutral position (PNP) switch Gear position
Knock sensor Engine knocking condition
Battery
Battery voltage
*3
Power steering pressure sensor Power steering operation
Heated oxygen sensor 2
*2
Density of oxygen in exhaust gas
Vehicle speed signal
*2
Vehicle speed
Air conditioner switch
*2
Air conditioner operation
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-43
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The amount of fuel injected from the fuel injector is determined by the ECM. The ECM controls the length of
time the valve remains open (injection pulse duration). The amount of fuel injected is a program value in the
ECM memory. The program value is preset by engine operating conditions. These conditions are determined
by input signals (for engine speed and intake air) from the crankshaft position sensor (POS), the camshaft
position sensor (PHASE) and the mass air flow sensor.
VARIOUS FUEL INJECTION INCREASE/DECREASE COMPENSATION
In addition, the amount of fuel injected is compensated to improve engine performance under various operat-
ing conditions as listed below.
<Fuel increase>
G During warm-up
G When starting the engine
G During acceleration
G Hot-engine operation
G When selector lever is changed from N to D (A/T models)
G High-load, high-speed operation
<Fuel decrease>
G During deceleration
G During high engine speed operation
MIXTURE RATIO FEEDBACK CONTROL (CLOSED LOOP CONTROL)
The mixture ratio feedback system provides the best air-fuel mixture ratio for driveability and emission control.
The three way catalyst (manifold) can then better reduce CO, HC and NOx emissions. This system uses
heated oxygen sensor 1 in the exhaust manifold to monitor if the engine operation is rich or lean. The ECM
adjusts the injection pulse width according to the sensor voltage signal. For more information about heated
oxygen sensor 1, refer to EC-214 (QG16DE engine models) or EC-223 (QG18DE engine models). This main-
tains the mixture ratio within the range of stoichiometric (ideal air-fuel mixture).
This stage is referred to as the closed loop control condition.
Heated oxygen sensor 2 is located downstream of the three way catalyst (manifold). Even if the switching
characteristics of heated oxygen sensor 1 shift, the air-fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric by the signal
from heated oxygen sensor 2.
Open Loop Control
The open loop system condition refers to when the ECM detects any of the following conditions. Feedback
control stops in order to maintain stabilized fuel combustion.
G Deceleration and acceleration
G High-load, high-speed operation
G Malfunction of heated oxygen sensor 1 or its circuit
G Insufficient activation of heated oxygen sensor 1 at low engine coolant temperature
G High engine coolant temperature
G During warm-up
G After shifting from N to D (A/T models)
G When starting the engine
PBIB0121E
EC-44
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
MIXTURE RATIO SELF-LEARNING CONTROL
The mixture ratio feedback control system monitors the mixture ratio signal transmitted from heated oxygen
sensor 1. This feedback signal is then sent to the ECM. The ECM controls the basic mixture ratio as close to
the theoretical mixture ratio as possible. However, the basic mixture ratio is not necessarily controlled as orig-
inally designed. Both manufacturing differences (i.e., mass air flow sensor hot film) and characteristic changes
during operation (i.e., injector clogging) directly affect mixture ratio.
Accordingly, the difference between the basic and theoretical mixture ratios is monitored in this system. This is
then computed in terms of injection pulse duration to automatically compensate for the difference between
the two ratios.
Fuel trim refers to the feedback compensation value compared against the basic injection duration. Fuel trim
includes short term fuel trim and long term fuel trim.
Short term fuel trim is the short-term fuel compensation used to maintain the mixture ratio at its theoretical
value. The signal from heated oxygen sensor 1 indicates whether the mixture ratio is RICH or LEAN compared
to the theoretical value. The signal then triggers a reduction in fuel volume if the mixture ratio is rich, and an
increase in fuel volume if it is lean.
Long term fuel trim is overall fuel compensation carried out long-term to compensate for continual deviation
of the short term fuel trim from the central value. Such deviation will occur due to individual engine differences,
wear over time and changes in the usage environment.
FUEL INJECTION TIMING
Two types of systems are used.
Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection System
Fuel is injected into each cylinder during each engine cycle according to the firing order. This system is used
when the engine is running.
Simultaneous Multiport Fuel Injection System
Fuel is injected simultaneously into all four cylinders twice each engine cycle. In other words, pulse signals of
the same width are simultaneously transmitted from the ECM.
The four injectors will then receive the signals two times for each engine cycle.
This system is used when the engine is being started and/or if the fail-safe system (CPU) is operating.
FUEL SHUT-OFF
Fuel to each cylinder is cut off during deceleration or operation of the engine at excessively high speeds.
SEF337W
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-45
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Electronic Ignition (EI) System EBS00ELI
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
*1: This signal is sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
*2: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ignition timing is controlled by the ECM to maintain the best air-
fuel ratio for every running condition of the engine. The ignition tim-
ing data is stored in the ECM. This data forms the map shown.
The ECM receives information such as the injection pulse width and
camshaft position sensor signal. Computing this information, ignition
signals are transmitted to the power transistor.
e.g., N: 1,800 rpm, Tp: 1.50 msec
A BTDC
During the following conditions, the ignition timing is revised by the
ECM according to the other data stored in the ECM.
G At starting
G During warm-up
G At idle
G At low battery voltage
G During acceleration
The knock sensor retard system is designed only for emergencies. The basic ignition timing is programmed
within the anti-knocking zone, if recommended fuel is used under dry conditions. The retard system does not
operate under normal driving conditions. If engine knocking occurs, the knock sensor monitors the condition.
The signal is transmitted to the ECM. The ECM retards the ignition timing to eliminate the knocking condition.
Air Conditioning Cut Control EBS00ELJ
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
*1: These signals are sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
*2: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
*2
and piston position
Ignition timing control Power transistor
Mass air flow sensor Amount of intake air
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Throttle position sensor Throttle position
Accelerator pedal position sensor Accelerator pedal position
Knock sensor Engine knocking
Park/neutral position (PNP) switch Gear position
Battery
Battery voltage
*2
Vehicle speed signal
*1
Vehicle speed
SEF742M
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Air conditioner switch*
1
Air conditioner ON signal
Air conditioner
cut control
Air conditioner relay
Throttle position sensor Throttle valve opening angle
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
*2
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Battery
Battery voltage
*2
Refrigerant pressure sensor Refrigerant pressure
Power steering pressure sensor Power steering operation
Vehicle speed signal
*1
Vehicle speed
EC-46
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
This system improves engine operation when the air conditioner is used.
Under the following conditions, the air conditioner is turned off.
G When the accelerator pedal is fully depressed.
G When cranking the engine.
G At high engine speeds.
G When the engine coolant temperature becomes excessively high.
G When operating power steering during low engine speed or low vehicle speed.
G When engine speed is excessively low.
G When refrigerant pressure is excessively low or high.
Fuel Cut Control (at No Load and High Engine Speed) EBS00ELK
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
*1: This signal is sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
If the engine speed is above 3,950 rpm with no load (for example, in neutral and engine speed over 3,950
rpm) fuel will be cut off after some time. The exact time when the fuel is cut off varies based on engine speed.
Fuel cut will operate until the engine speed reaches 1,500 rpm, then fuel cut is cancelled.
NOTE:
This function is different from deceleration control listed under Multiport Fuel Injection (MFI) System, EC-42 .
CAN communication EBS00ELL
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real time application. It is an on-vehicle mul-
tiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent error detection ability. Many elec-
tronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links with other
control units during operation (not independent). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2
communication lines (CAN H line, CAN L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission with less wiring.
Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.
LHD MODELS WITH TYRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM
A/T Models
System diagram
Input/output signal chart
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Park/neutral position (PNP) switch Neutral position
Fuel cut control Fuel injectors
Throttle position sensor Throttle position
Accelerator pedal position sensor Accelerator pedal position
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
Vehicle speed signal
*1
Vehicle speed
SKIA1523E
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-47
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
T: Transmit R: Receive
M/T Models
System diagram
Input/output signal chart
T: Transmit R: Receive
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actua-
tor and
electric unit
(control
unit)
Smart
entrance
control unit
Tyre pres-
sure moni-
toring
control unit
Combina-
tion meter
Engine speed signal T R R
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
Signals ECM
ABS actuator
and electric
unit (control
unit)
Smart
entrance con-
trol unit
Tyre pres-
sure monitor-
ing control
unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R
Rear window defogger signal
R
*1
T
Heater fan switch signal
R
*1
T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
SKIA1525E
EC-48
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
*1: Except YD22DDTi engine model
*2: YD22DDTi engine model only
LHD MODELS WITHOUT TYRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM
A/T Models
System diagram
Input/output signal chart
T: Transmit R: Receive
MI signal T R
Glow lamp signal
*2
T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
Signals ECM
ABS actuator
and electric
unit (control
unit)
Smart
entrance con-
trol unit
Tyre pres-
sure monitor-
ing control
unit
Combination
meter
SKIA1530E
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actuator
andelectric unit
(control unit)
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R R
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-49
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
M/T Models
System diagram
Input/output signal chart
T: Transmit R: Receive
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actuator
and electric unit
(control unit)
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
SKIA1532E
Signals ECM
ABS actuator and
electric unit (con-
trol unit)
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R
Rear window defogger signal
R
*1
T
Heater fan switch signal
R
*1
T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Glow lamp signal
*2
T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
EC-50
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
*1: Except YD22DDTi engine model
*2:YD22DDTi engine model only
RHD MODELS WITH TYRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM
A/T Models
System diagram
Input/output signal chart
T: Transmit R: Receive
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Signals ECM
ABS actuator and
electric unit (con-
trol unit)
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actu-
ator and
electric
unit (con-
trol unit)
Tyre pres-
sure moni-
toring
control unit
Smart
entrance
control unit
Combina-
tion meter
Engine speed signal T R R
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
SKIA1537E
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-51
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
M/T Models
System diagram
Input/output signal chart
T: Transmit R: Receive
*1: Except YD22DDTi engine model
*2: YD22DDTi engine model only
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actu-
ator and
electric
unit (con-
trol unit)
Tyre pres-
sure moni-
toring
control unit
Smart
entrance
control unit
Combina-
tion meter
Signals ECM
ABS actua-
tor and elec-
tric unit
(control unit)
Tyre pres-
sure monitor-
ing control
unit
Smart
entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R
Rear window defogger signal R
*1
T
Heater fan switch signal R
*1
T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Glow lamp signal
*2
T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
SKIA1539E
EC-52
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
RHD MODELS WITHOUT TYRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM
A/T Models
System diagram
Input/output signal chart
T: Transmit R: Receive
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actuator
and electric
unit (control
unit)
Smart
entrance con-
trol unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R R
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
SKIA1544E
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-53
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
M/T Models
System diagram
Input/output signal chart
T: Transmit R: Receive
*1: Except YD22DDTi engine model
*2: YD22DDTi engine model only
SKIA1546E
Signals ECM
ABS actuator and
electric unit (con-
trol unit)
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R
Rear window defogger signal
R
*1
T
Heater fan switch signal
R
*1
T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Glow lamp signal
*2
T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
EC-54
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE PFP:00018
Idle Speed and Ignition Timing Check EBS00ELM
IDLE SPEED
With CONSULT-II
Check idle speed in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
With GST
Check idle speed in MODE 1 with GST.
IGNITION TIMING
Any of following two methods may be used.
Method A
1. Slide the harness protector of ignition coil No. 1 to clear the wires.
2. Attach timing light to the wires as shown.
3. Check ignition timing.
Method B
1. Remove No. 1 ignition coil.
SEF058Y
MBIB0047E
MBIB0048E
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
EC-55
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Connect No. 1 ignition coil and No. 1 spark plug with suitable
high-tension wire as shown, and attach timing light clamp to this
wire.
3. Check ignition timing.
Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning EBS00ELO
DESCRIPTION
Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning is an operation to learn the fully released position of the accel-
erator pedal by monitoring the accelerator pedal position sensor output signal. It must be performed each time
harness connector of accelerator pedal position sensor or ECM is disconnected.
OPERATION PROCEDURE
1. Make sure that accelerator pedal is fully released.
2. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF wait at least 10 seconds.
Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning EBS00ELP
DESCRIPTION
Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning is an operation to learn the fully closed position of the throttle valve
by monitoring the throttle position sensor output signal. It must be performed each time harness connector of
electric throttle control actuator or ECM is disconnected.
OPERATION PROCEDURE
1. Make sure that accelerator pedal is fully released.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF wait at least 10 seconds.
Make sure that throttle valve moves during above 10 seconds by confirming the operating sound.
Idle Air Volume Learning EBS00ELQ
DESCRIPTION
Idle Air Volume Learning is an operation to learn the idle air volume that keeps each engine within the spe-
cific range. It must be performed under any of the following conditions:
G Each time electric throttle control actuator or ECM is replaced.
G Idle speed or ignition timing is out of specification.
MBIB0049E
SEF166Y
EC-56
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
PREPARATION
Before performing Idle Air Volume Learning, make sure that all of the following conditions are satisfied.
Learning will be cancelled if any of the following conditions are missed for even a moment.
G Battery voltage: More than 12.9V (At idle)
G Engine coolant temperature: 70 - 95C (158 - 203F)
G PNP switch: ON
G Electric load switch: OFF
(Air conditioner, headlamp, rear window defogger)
On vehicles equipped with daytime light systems, set lighting switch to the 1st position to light
only small lamps.
G Steering wheel: Neutral (Straight-ahead position)
G Vehicle speed: Stopped
G Transmission: Warmed-up
For A/T models with CONSULT-II, drive vehicle until FLUID TEMP SE in DATA MONITOR mode of A/
T system indicates less than 0.9V.
For A/T models without CONSULT-II and M/T models, drive vehicle for 10 minutes.
OPERATION PROCEDURE
With CONSULT-II
1. Perform EC-55, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
2. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
4. Check that all items listed under the topic PRE-CONDITIONING (previously mentioned) are in good
order.
5. Select IDLE AIR VOL LEARN in WORK SUPPORT mode.
6. Touch START and wait 20 seconds.
SEF217Z
SEF454Y
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
EC-57
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
7. Make sure that CMPLT is displayed on CONSULT-II screen. If
INCMP is displayed, Idle Air Volume Learning will not be car-
ried out successfully. In this case, find the cause of the problem
by referring to the Diagnostic Procedure below.
8. Rev up the engine two or three times and make sure that idle
speed and ignition timing are within the specifications.
Without CONSULT-II
NOTE:
G It is better to count the time accurately with a clock.
G It is impossible to switch the diagnostic mode when an accelerator pedal position sensor circuit
has a malfunction.
1. Perform EC-55, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
2. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
4. Check that all items listed under the topic PRE-CONDITIONING (previously mentioned) are in good
order.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
6. Confirm that accelerator pedal is fully released, turn ignition switch ON and wait 3 seconds.
7. Repeat the following procedure quickly five times within 5 seconds.
a. Fully depress the accelerator pedal.
b. Fully release the accelerator pedal.
8. Wait 7 seconds, fully depress the accelerator pedal and keep it for approx. 20 seconds until the MI stops
blinking and turned ON.
9. Fully release the accelerator pedal within 3 seconds after the MI turned ON.
10. Start engine and let it idle.
11. Wait 20 seconds.
12. Rev up the engine two or three times and make sure that idle speed and ignition timing are within the
specifications.
13. If idle speed and ignition timing are not within the specification, the result will be incomplete. In this case,
find the cause of the problem by referring to the Diagnostic Procedure below.
ITEM SPECIFICATION
Idle speed M/T: 70050 rpm
A/T: 80050 rpm (in P or N position)
Ignition timing M/T: 85 BTDC
A/T: 105 BTDC (in P or N position)
SEF455Y
ITEM SPECIFICATION
Idle speed M/T: 70050 rpm
A/T: 80050 rpm (in P or N position)
Ignition timing M/T: 85 BTDC
A/T: 105 BTDC (in P or N position)
PBIB0665E
EC-58
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
If idle air volume learning cannot be performed successfully, proceed as follows:
1. Check that throttle valve is fully closed.
2. Check PCV valve operation.
3. Check that downstream of throttle valve is free from air leakage.
4. When the above three items check out OK, engine component parts and their installation condi-
tion are questionable. Check and eliminate the cause of the problem.
It is useful to perform EC-139, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE" .
5. If any of the following conditions occur after the engine has started, eliminate the cause of the
problem and perform Idle air volume learning all over again:
Engine stalls.
Erroneous idle.
Fuel Pressure Check EBS00ELR
FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE
Before disconnecting fuel line, release fuel pressure from fuel line to eliminate danger.
NOTE:
Prepare pans or saucers under the disconnected fuel line because the fuel may spill out. The fuel pres-
sure cannot be completely released because P12 models do not have fuel return system.
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Perform FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE in WORK SUPPORT
mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine.
4. After engine stalls, crank it two or three times to release all fuel
pressure.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Remove fuel pump fuse located in fuse box.
2. Start engine.
3. After engine stalls, crank it two or three times to release all fuel
pressure.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF.
5. Reinstall fuel pump fuse after servicing fuel system.
FUEL PRESSURE CHECK
NOTE:
G When reconnecting fuel line, always use new clamps.
G Make sure that clamp screw does not contact adjacent parts.
G Use a torque driver to tighten clamps.
G Use Pressure Gauge to check fuel pressure.
G Do not perform fuel pressure check with system operating. Fuel pressure gauge may indicate
false readings.
1. Release fuel pressure to zero. Refer to EC-58, "FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE" .
SEF214Y
MBIB0141E
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
EC-59
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Install the fuel pressure gauge into the fuel line as shown in the
figure.
3. Turn ignition switch ON, and check for fuel leakage.
4. Start engine and check for fuel leakage.
5. Read the indication of fuel pressure gauge.
6. If result is unsatisfactory, go to next step.
7. Check the following.
G Fuel hoses and fuel tubes for clogging
G Fuel filter for clogging
G Fuel pump
G Fuel pressure regulator for clogging
If OK, replace fuel pressure regulator.
If NG, repair or replace.
At idling:
Approximately 350 kPa (3.7 kg/cm
2
, 51 psi)
MBIB0050E
EC-60
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM PFP:00028
Introduction EBS00ELS
The ECM has an on board diagnostic system, which detects malfunctions related to engine sensors or actua-
tors. The ECM also records various emission-related diagnostic information including:
The above information can be checked using procedures listed in the table below.
: Applicable : Not applicable
*1: 1st trip DTCs for self-diagnoses concerning SRT items cannot be shown on the GST display.
*2: When DTC and 1st trip DTC simultaneously appear on the display, they cannot be clearly distinguished from each other.
The malfunction indicator (MI) on the instrument panel lights up when the same malfunction is detected in two
consecutive trips (Two trip detection logic), or when the ECM enters fail-safe mode. (Refer to EC-90 .)
Two Trip Detection Logic EBS00ELT
When a malfunction is detected for the first time, 1st trip DTC and 1st trip Freeze Frame data are stored in the
ECM memory. The MI will not light up at this stage. <1st trip>
If the same malfunction is detected again during the next drive, the DTC and Freeze Frame data are stored in
the ECM memory, and the MI lights up. The MI lights up at the same time when the DTC is stored. <2nd trip>
The trip in the Two Trip Detection Logic means a driving mode in which self-diagnosis is performed during
vehicle operation. Specific on board diagnostic items will cause the ECM to light up or blink the MI, and store
DTC and Freeze Frame data, even in the 1st trip, as shown below.
: Applicable : Not applicable
*1: Except ECM
Emission-related diagnostic information ISO Standard
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Mode 3 of ISO 15031-5
Freeze Frame data Mode 2 of ISO 15031-5
System Readiness Test (SRT) code Mode 1 of ISO 15031-5
1st Trip Diagnostic Trouble Code (1st Trip DTC) Mode 7 of ISO 15031-5
1st Trip Freeze Frame data
Test values and Test limits Mode 6 of ISO 15031-5
Calibration ID Mode 9 of ISO 15031-5
DTC 1st trip DTC
Freeze Frame
data
1st trip Freeze
Frame data
SRT code Test value
CONSULT-II
GST
*
1

ECM
*
2

Items
MI DTC 1st trip DTC
1st trip 2nd trip
1st trip
displaying
2nd trip
displaying
1st trip
displaying
2nd trip
display-
ing
Blinking
Lighting
up
Blinking
Lighting
up
Misfire (Possible three way cata-
lyst damage) DTC: P0300 -
P0304 is being detected

Misfire (Possible three way cata-
lyst damage) DTC: P0300 -
P0304 is being detected

Fail-safe items (Refer to EC-90 .)
*
1

*
1

Except above
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-61
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Emission-related Diagnostic Information EBS00ELU
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION ITEMS
QG16DE Engine Models
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC*
1
SRT code
Test Valve/
Test Limit
(GST only)
1st trip DTC Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM
CAN COMM CIRCUIT U1001
1001*
4
EC-150
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.
P0000 0000
INT/V TIM CONT-B1 P0011 0011 EC-153
HO2S1 HTR (B1) P0031 0031
*
5
EC-156
HO2S1 HTR (B1) P0032 0032
*
5
EC-156
HO2S2 HTR (B1) P0037 0037
*
5
EC-170
HO2S2 HTR (B1) P0038 0038
*
5
EC-170
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT*
3
P0102 0102 EC-183
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT*
3
P0103 0103 EC-183
IAT SEN/CIRCUIT P0112 0112 EC-189
IAT SEN/CIRCUIT P0113 0113 EC-189
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT*
3
P0117 0117 EC-194
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT*
3
P0118 0118 EC-194
HO2S1 (B1) P0132 0132
*
5
EC-199
HO2S1 (B1) P0133 0133 *
5
EC-214
HO2S1 (B1) P0134 0134 *
5
EC-234
HO2S2 (B1) P0138 0138 *
5
EC-251
HO2S2 (B1) P0139 0139 *
5
EC-267
FUEL SYS-LEAN-B1 P0171 0171 EC-285
FUEL SYS-RICH-B1 P0172 0172 EC-299
TP SENSOR*
3
P0221 0221 EC-312
TP SEN 1/CIRC*
3
P0222 0222 EC-318
TP SEN 1/CIRC*
3
P0223 0223 EC-318
APP SENSOR*
3
P0226 0226 EC-324
APP SEN 1/CIRC*
3
P0227 0227 EC-331
APP SEN 1/CIRC*
3
P0228 0228 EC-331
MULTI CYL MISFIRE P0300 0300 EC-338
CYL 1 MISFIRE P0301 0301 EC-338
CYL 2 MISFIRE P0302 0302 EC-338
CYL 3 MISFIRE P0303 0303 EC-338
CYL 4 MISFIRE P0304 0304 EC-338
KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 P0327 0327 EC-344
KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 P0328 0328 EC-344
CKP SEN/CIRCUIT P0335 0335 EC-348
CMP SEN/CIRC-B1 P0340 0340 EC-355
EC-62
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
*1: 1st trip DTC No. is the same as DTC No.
*2: These numbers are prescribed by ISO 15031-5.
*3: When the fail-safe operation occurs, the MI illuminates.
*4: The trouble shooting for this DTC needs CONSULT-II.
*5: These are not displayed with GST.
QG18DE Engine Models
TW CATALYST SYS-B1 P0420 0420 *
5
EC-361
PURG VOLUME CONT/V P0444 0444 EC-369
PURG VOLUME CONT/V P0445 0445 EC-369
VEH SPEED SEN/CIRC P0500 0500 EC-375
PW ST P SEN/CIRC P0550 0550 EC-377
ECM P0605 0605 EC-382
ECM BACK UP/CIRC P1065 1065 EC-385
MAF SENSOR*
3
P1102 1102 EC-389
INT/V TIM V/CIR-B1 P1111 1111 EC-395
ETC ACTR*
3
P1121 1121 EC-400
ETC FUNCTION/CIRC*
3
P1122 1122 EC-402
ETC MOT PWR
*3
P1124 1124 EC-409
ETC MOT PWR*
3
P1126 1126 EC-409
ETC MOT
*3
P1128 1128 EC-415
HO2S1 (B1) P1143 1143 *
5
EC-420
HO2S1 (B1) P1144 1144 *
5
EC-432
HO2S2 (B1) P1146 1146
*
5
EC-444
HO2S2 (B1) P1147 1147
*
5
EC-462
ENG OVER TEMP P1217 1217 EC-480
TP SEN 2/CIRC*
3
P1223 1223 EC-490
TP SEN 2/CIRC*
3
P1224 1224 EC-490
CTP LEARNING P1225 1225 EC-496
CTP LEARNING P1226 1226 EC-498
APP SEN 2/CIRC*
3
P1227 1227 EC-500
APP SEN 2/CIRC*
3
P1228 1228 EC-500
SENSOR POWER/CIRC*
3
P1229 1229 EC-507
NATS MALFUNCTION P1610 - P1615 1610 - 1615 EC-75
P-N POS SW/CIRCUIT P1706 1706 EC-511
BRAKE SW/CIRCUIT P1805 1805 EC-515
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC*
1
SRT code
Test Valve/
Test Limit
(GST only)
1st trip DTC Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC*
1
SRT code
Test Valve/
Test Limit
(GST only)
1st trip DTC Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM
CAN COMM CIRCUIT U1000 1000*
4
EC-150
CAN COMM CIRCUIT U1001 1001*
4
EC-150
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-63
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.
P0000 0000
INT/V TIM CONT-B1 P0011 0011 EC-153
HO2S1 HTR (B1) P0031 0031
*
5
EC-162
HO2S1 HTR (B1) P0032 0032
*
5
EC-162
HO2S2 HTR (B1) P0037 0037
*
5
EC-175
HO2S2 HTR (B1) P0038 0038 *
5
EC-175
HO2S1 HTR (B2) P0051 0051 *
5
EC-162
HO2S1 HTR (B2) P0052 0052 *
5
EC-162
HO2S2 HTR (B2) P0057 0057 *
5
EC-175
HO2S2 HTR (B2) P0058 0058
*
5
EC-175
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT*
3
P0102 0102 EC-183
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT*
3
P0103 0103 EC-183
IAT SEN/CIRCUIT P0112 0112 EC-189
IAT SEN/CIRCUIT P0113 0113 EC-189
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT*
3
P0117 0117 EC-194
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT*
3
P0118 0118 EC-194
HO2S1 (B1) P0132 0132
*
5
EC-205
HO2S1 (B1) P0133 0133
*
5
EC-223
HO2S1 (B1) P0134 0134
*
5
EC-241
HO2S2 (B1) P0138 0138
*
5
EC-258
HO2S2 (B1) P0139 0139 *
5
EC-275
HO2S1 (B2) P0152 0152 *
5
EC-205
HO2S1 (B2) P0153 0153 *
5
EC-223
HO2S1 (B2) P0154 0154 *
5
EC-241
HO2S2 (B2) P0158 0158
*
5
EC-258
HO2S2 (B2) P0159 0159
*
5
EC-275
FUEL SYS-LEAN-B1 P0171 0171 EC-291
FUEL SYS-RICH-B1 P0172 0172 EC-305
FUEL SYS-LEAN-B2 P0174 0174 EC-291
FUEL SYS-RICH-B2 P0175 0175 EC-305
TP SENSOR*
3
P0221 0221 EC-312
TP SEN 1/CIRC*
3
P0222 0222 EC-318
TP SEN 1/CIRC*
3
P0223 0223 EC-318
APP SENSOR*
3
P0226 0226 EC-324
APP SEN 1/CIRC*
3
P0227 0227 EC-331
APP SEN 1/CIRC*
3
P0228 0228 EC-331
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC*
1
SRT code
Test Valve/
Test Limit
(GST only)
1st trip DTC Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM
EC-64
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
MULTI CYL MISFIRE P0300 0300 EC-338
CYL 1 MISFIRE P0301 0301 EC-338
CYL 2 MISFIRE P0302 0302 EC-338
CYL 3 MISFIRE P0303 0303 EC-338
CYL 4 MISFIRE P0304 0304 EC-338
KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 P0327 0327 EC-344
KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 P0328 0328 EC-344
CKP SEN/CIRCUIT P0335 0335 EC-348
CMP SEN/CIRC-B1 P0340 0340 EC-355
TW CATALYST SYS-B1 P0420 0420
*
5
EC-365
TW CATALYST SYS-B2 P0430 0430
*
5
EC-365
PURG VOLUME CONT/V P0444 0444 EC-369
PURG VOLUME CONT/V P0445 0445 EC-369
VEH SPEED SEN/CIRC*
6
P0500 0500 EC-375
PW ST P SEN/CIRC P0550 0550 EC-377
ECM P0605 0605 EC-382
PNP SW/CIRC P0705 0705 AT-110
ATF TEMP SEN/CIRC P0710 0710 AT-116
VEH SPD SEN/CIRC AT*
6
P0720 0720 AT-122
ENGINE SPEED SIG P0725 0725 AT-127
A/T 1ST GR FNCTN P0731 0731 AT-131
A/T 2ND GR FNCTN P0732 0732 AT-138
A/T 3RD GR FNCTN P0733 0733 AT-144
A/T 4TH GR FNCTN P0734 0734 AT-150
TCC SOLENOID/CIRC P0740 0740 AT-158
L/PRESS SOL/CIRC P0745 0745 AT-163
SFT SOL A/CIRC*
3
P0750 0750 AT-170
SFT SOL B/CIRC*
3
P0755 0755 AT-175
ECM BACK UP/CIRC P1065 1065 EC-385
MAF SENSOR*
3
P1102 1102 EC-389
INT/V TIM V/CIR-B1 P1111 1111 EC-395
ETC ACTR*
3
P1121 1121 EC-400
ETC FUNCTION/CIRC*
3
P1122 1122 EC-402
ETC MOT PWR*
3
P1124 1124 EC-409
ETC MOT PWR*
3
P1126 1126 EC-409
ETC MOT*
3
P1128 1128 EC-415
HO2S1 (B1) P1143 1143 *
5
EC-426
HO2S1 (B1) P1144 1144 *
5
EC-438
HO2S2 (B1) P1146 1146 *
5
EC-452
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC*
1
SRT code
Test Valve/
Test Limit
(GST only)
1st trip DTC Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-65
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
*1: 1st trip DTC No. is the same as DTC No.
*2: These numbers are prescribed by ISO 15031-5.
*3: When the fail-safe operation occurs, the MI illuminates.
*4: The trouble shooting for these DTCs need CONSULT-II.
*5: These are not displayed with GST.
*6: When the fail-safe operations for both self-diagnoses occur at the same time, the MI illuminates.
NOTE:
Regarding P12 models with QG18DE engine, B1 indicates bank 1, B2 indicates bank 2.
DTC AND 1ST TRIP DTC
The 1st trip DTC (whose number is the same as the DTC number) is displayed for the latest self-diagnostic
result obtained. If the ECM memory was cleared previously, and the 1st trip DTC did not reoccur, the 1st trip
DTC will not be displayed.
If a malfunction is detected during the 1st trip, the 1st trip DTC is stored in the ECM memory. The MI will not
light up (two trip detection logic). If the same malfunction is not detected in the 2nd trip (meeting the required
driving pattern), the 1st trip DTC is cleared from the ECM memory. If the same malfunction is detected in the
2nd trip, both the 1st trip DTC and DTC are stored in the ECM memory and the MI lights up. In other words,
the DTC is stored in the ECM memory and the MI lights up when the same malfunction occurs in two consec-
utive trips. If a 1st trip DTC is stored and a non-diagnostic operation is performed between the 1st and 2nd
trips, only the 1st trip DTC will continue to be stored. For malfunctions that blink or light up the MI during the
1st trip, the DTC and 1st trip DTC are stored in the ECM memory.
Procedures for clearing the DTC and the 1st trip DTC from the ECM memory are described in EC-73, "HOW
TO ERASE EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
For malfunctions in which 1st trip DTCs are displayed, refer to EC-61, "EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC
INFORMATION ITEMS" . These items are required by legal regulations to continuously monitor the system/
component. In addition, the items monitored non-continuously are also displayed on CONSULT-II.
1st trip DTC is specified in Mode 7 of ISO 15031-5. 1st trip DTC detection occurs without lighting up the MI
and therefore does not warn the driver of a problem. However, 1st trip DTC detection will not prevent the vehi-
cle from being tested, for example during Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) tests.
HO2S2 (B1) P1147 1147 *
5
EC-470
HO2S1 (B2) P1163 1163 *
5
EC-426
HO2S1 (B2) P1164 1164
*
5
EC-438
HO2S2 (B2) P1166 1166
*
5
EC-452
HO2S2 (B2) P1167 1167
*
5
EC-470
ENG OVER TEMP P1217 1217 EC-480
TP SEN 2/CIRC*
3
P1223 1223 EC-490
TP SEN 2/CIRC*
3
P1224 1224 EC-490
CTP LEARNING P1225 1225 EC-496
CTP LEARNING P1226 1226 EC-498
APP SEN 2/CIRC*
3
P1227 1227 EC-500
APP SEN 2/CIRC*
3
P1228 1228 EC-500
SENSOR POWER/CIRC*
3
P1229 1229 EC-507
NATS MALFUNCTION P1610 - P1615 1610 - 1615 EC-75
TPV SEN/CIRC A/T P1705 1705 AT-180
P-N POS SW/CIRCUIT P1706 1706 EC-511
O/R CLTCH SOL/CIRC P1760 1760 AT-185
BRAKE SW/CIRCUIT P1805 1805 EC-515
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC*
1
SRT code
Test Valve/
Test Limit
(GST only)
1st trip DTC Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM
EC-66
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
When a 1st trip DTC is detected, check, print out or write down and erase (1st trip) DTC and Freeze Frame
data as specified in Work Flow procedure Step II, refer to EC-85, "WORK FLOW" . Then perform DTC Con-
firmation Procedure or Overall Function Check to try to duplicate the problem. If the malfunction is dupli-
cated, the item requires repair.
How to Read DTC and 1st Trip DTC
DTC and 1st trip DTC can be read by the following methods.
With CONSULT-II
With GST
CONSULT-II or GST (Generic Scan Tool) Examples: P0340, P0705, P0750, etc.
These DTCs are prescribed by ISO 15031-5.
(CONSULT-II also displays the malfunctioning component or system.)
No Tools
The number of blinks of the MI in the Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-Diagnostic Results) indicates the DTC.
Example: 0102, 0340 etc.
These DTCs are controlled by NISSAN.
G 1st trip DTC No. is the same as DTC No.
G Output of a DTC indicates a malfunction. However, GST or the Diagnostic Test Mode II do not indi-
cate whether the malfunction is still occurring or has occurred in the past and has returned to nor-
mal. CONSULT-II can identify malfunction status as shown below. Therefore, using CONSULT-II (if
available) is recommended.
A sample of CONSULT-II display for DTC and 1st trip DTC is shown below. DTC or 1st trip DTC of a malfunc-
tion is displayed in SELF-DIAGNOSTIC RESULTS mode of CONSULT-II. Time data indicates how many times
the vehicle was driven after the last detection of a DTC.
If the DTC is being detected currently, the time data will be 0.
If a 1st trip DTC is stored in the ECM, the time data will be [1t].
FREEZE FRAME DATA AND 1ST TRIP FREEZE FRAME DATA
The ECM records the driving conditions such as fuel system status, calculated load value, engine coolant tem-
perature, short term fuel trim, long term fuel trim, engine speed, vehicle speed, base fuel schedule and intake
air temperature at the moment a malfunction is detected.
Data which are stored in the ECM memory, along with the 1st trip DTC, are called 1st trip freeze frame data.
The data, stored together with the DTC data, are called freeze frame data and displayed on CONSULT-II or
GST. The 1st trip freeze frame data can only be displayed on the CONSULT-II screen, not on the GST. For
details, see EC-124, "Freeze Frame Data and 1st Trip Freeze Frame Data" .
Only one set of freeze frame data (either 1st trip freeze frame data or freeze frame data) can be stored in the
ECM. 1st trip freeze frame data is stored in the ECM memory along with the 1st trip DTC. There is no priority
for 1st trip freeze frame data and it is updated each time a different 1st trip DTC is detected. However, once
freeze frame data (2nd trip detection/MI on) is stored in the ECM memory, 1st trip freeze frame data is no
longer stored. Remember, only one set of freeze frame data can be stored in the ECM. The ECM has the fol-
lowing priorities to update the data.
PBIB0911E
Priority Items
1
Freeze frame data Misfire DTC: P0300 - P0304
Fuel Injection System Function DTC: P0171, P0172, P0174
*
, P0175
*
2 Except the above items (Includes A/T related items)
3 1st trip freeze frame data
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-67
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
*: For QG18DE engine models
For example, the EGR malfunction (Priority: 2) was detected and the freeze frame data was stored in the 2nd
trip. After that when the misfire (Priority: 1) is detected in another trip, the freeze frame data will be updated
from the EGR malfunction to the misfire. The 1st trip freeze frame data is updated each time a different mal-
function is detected. There is no priority for 1st trip freeze frame data. However, once freeze frame data is
stored in the ECM memory, 1st trip freeze data is no longer stored (because only one freeze frame data or 1st
trip freeze frame data can be stored in the ECM). If freeze frame data is stored in the ECM memory and freeze
frame data with the same priority occurs later, the first (original) freeze frame data remains unchanged in the
ECM memory.
Both 1st trip freeze frame data and freeze frame data (along with the DTCs) are cleared when the ECM mem-
ory is erased. Procedures for clearing the ECM memory are described in EC-73, "HOW TO ERASE EMIS-
SION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
SYSTEM READINESS TEST (SRT) CODE
System Readiness Test (SRT) code is specified in Mode 1 of ISO 15031-5.
As part of an enhanced emissions test for Inspection & Maintenance (I/M), certain states require the status of
SRT be used to indicate whether the ECM has completed self-diagnosis of major emission systems and com-
ponents. Completion must be verified in order for the emissions inspection to proceed.
If a vehicle is rejected for a State emissions inspection due to one or more SRT items indicating INCMP, use
the information in this Service Manual to set the SRT to CMPLT.
In most cases the ECM will automatically complete its self-diagnosis cycle during normal usage, and the SRT
status will indicate CMPLT for each application system. Once set as CMPLT, the SRT status remains
CMPLT until the self-diagnosis memory is erased.
Occasionally, certain portions of the self-diagnostic test may not be completed as a result of the customer's
normal driving pattern; the SRT will indicate INCMP for these items.
NOTE:
The SRT will also indicate INCMP if the self-diagnosis memory is erased for any reason or if the ECM mem-
ory power supply is interrupted for several hours.
If, during the state emissions inspection, the SRT indicates CMPLT for all test items, the inspector will con-
tinue with the emissions test. However, if the SRT indicates INCMP for one or more of the SRT items the
vehicle is returned to the customer untested.
NOTE:
If MI is ON during the state emissions inspection, the vehicle is also returned to the customer untested even
though the SRT indicates CMPLT for all test items. Therefore, it is important to check SRT (CMPLT) and
DTC (No DTCs) before the inspection.
SRT Item
The table below shows required self-diagnostic items to set the SRT to CMPLT.
SRT item
(CONSULT-II
indication)
Performance
Priority
*1
Required self-diagnostic items to set the SRT to CMPLT Corresponding DTC No.
QG16DE QG18DE
CATALYST 2 Three way catalyst function P0420 P0420, P0430
HO2S 1 Heated oxygen sensor 1 P0132 P0132, P0152
Heated oxygen sensor 1 P0133 P0133, P0153
Heated oxygen sensor 1 P0134 P0134, P0154
Heated oxygen sensor 1 P1143 P1143, P1163
Heated oxygen sensor 1 P1144 P1144, P1164
Heated oxygen sensor 2 P0138 P0138, P0158
Heated oxygen sensor 2 P0139 P0139, P0159
Heated oxygen sensor 2 P1146 P1146, P1166
Heated oxygen sensor 2 P1147 P1147, P1167
EC-68
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
*1: If completion of several SRTs is required, perform driving patterns (DTC confirmation procedure), one by one based on the priority for
models with CONSULT-II.
SRT Set Timing
SRT is set as CMPLT after self-diagnosis has been performed one or more times. Completion of SRT is
done regardless of whether the result is OK or NG. The set timing is different between OK and NG results and
is shown in the table below.
OK: Self-diagnosis is carried out and the result is OK.
NG: Self-diagnosis is carried out and the result is NG.
: Self-diagnosis is not carried out.
When all SRT related self-diagnoses showed OK results in a single cycle (Ignition OFF-ON-OFF), the SRT will
indicate CMPLT. Case 1 above
When all SRT related self-diagnoses showed OK results through several different cycles, the SRT will indicate
CMPLT at the time the respective self-diagnoses have at least one OK result. Case 2 above
If one or more SRT related self-diagnoses showed NG results in 2 consecutive cycles, the SRT will also indi-
cate CMPLT. Case 3 above
The table above shows that the minimum number of cycles for setting SRT as INCMP is one (1) for each
self-diagnosis (Case 1 & 2) or two (2) for one of self-diagnoses (Case 3). However, in preparation for the state
emissions inspection, it is unnecessary for each self-diagnosis to be executed twice (Case 3) for the following
reasons:
G The SRT will indicate CMPLT at the time the respective self-diagnoses have one (1) OK result.
G The emissions inspection requires CMPLT of the SRT only with OK self-diagnosis results.
G When, during SRT driving pattern, 1st trip DTC (NG) is detected prior to CMPLT of SRT, the self-diagno-
sis memory must be erased from ECM after repair.
G If the 1st trip DTC is erased, all the SRT will indicate INCMP.
HO2S HTR 1 Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
P0031, P0032
P0031, P0032,
P0051, P0052
Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
P0037, P0038
P0037, P0038,
P0057, P0058
SRT item
(CONSULT-II
indication)
Performance
Priority
*1
Required self-diagnostic items to set the SRT to CMPLT Corresponding DTC No.
QG16DE QG18DE
Self-diagnosis result
Example
Diagnosis
Ignition cycle
ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON
All OK Case 1 P0400 OK (1) (1) OK (2) (2)
P0402 OK (1) (1) (1) OK (2)
P1402 OK (1) OK (2) (2) (2)
SRT of EGR CMPLT CMPLT CMPLT CMPLT
Case 2 P0400 OK (1) (1) (1) (1)
P0402 (0) (0) OK (1) (1)
P1402 OK (1) OK (2) (2) (2)
SRT of EGR INCMP INCMP CMPLT CMPLT
NG exists Case 3 P0400 OK OK
P0402
P1402 NG NG
NG
(Consecutive
NG)
(1st trip)
DTC
1st trip DTC 1st trip DTC
DTC
(= MI ON)
SRT of EGR INCMP INCMP INCMP CMPLT
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-69
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
NOTE:
SRT can be set as CMPLT together with the DTC(s). Therefore, DTC check must always be carried out
prior to the state emission inspection even though the SRT indicates CMPLT.
SRT Service Procedure
If a vehicle has failed the state emissions inspection due to one or more SRT items indicating INCMP, review
the flowchart diagnostic sequence on the next page.
*1 EC-66 *2 EC-70 *3 EC-70
SEF573XB
EC-70
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
How to Display SRT Code
WITH CONSULT-II
Selecting SRT STATUS in DTC CONFIRMATION mode with
CONSULT-II.
For items whose SRT codes are set, a CMPLT is displayed on the
CONSULT-II screen; for items whose SRT codes are not set,
INCMP is displayed.
A sample of CONSULT-II display for SRT code is shown at right.
INCMP means the self-diagnosis is incomplete and SRT is not set.
CMPLT means the self-diagnosis is complete and SRT is set.
WITH GST
Selecting Mode 1 with GST (Generic Scan Tool)
How to Set SRT Code
To set all SRT codes, self-diagnosis for the items indicated above must be performed one or more times. Each
diagnosis may require a long period of actual driving under various conditions.
WITH CONSULT-II
Perform corresponding DTC Confirmation Procedure one by one based on Performance Priority in the table
on EC-67, "SRT Item" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
The most efficient driving pattern in which SRT codes can be properly set is explained on the next page. The
driving pattern should be performed one or more times to set all SRT codes.
PBIB0666E
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-71
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Driving Pattern
MBIB0044E
EC-72
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
G The time required for each diagnosis varies with road surface conditions, weather, altitude, individual driv-
ing habits, etc.
Zone A refers to the range where the time, required for the diagnosis under normal conditions*, is the
shortest.
Zone B refers to the range where the diagnosis can still be performed if the diagnosis is not completed
within zone A.
*: Normal conditions refer to the following:
G Sea level
G Flat road
G Ambient air temperature: 20 - 30C (68 - 86F)
G Diagnosis is performed as quickly as possible under normal conditions.
Under different conditions [For example: ambient air temperature other than 20 - 30C (68 - 86F)], diag-
nosis may also be performed.
Pattern 1:
G The engine is started at the engine coolant temperature of 10 to 35C (14 to 95F)
(where the voltage between the ECM terminal 72 and ground is 3.0 - 4.3V).
G The engine must be operated at idle speed until the engine coolant temperature is greater than
70C (158F) (where the voltage between the ECM terminal 72 and ground is lower than 1.4V).
Pattern 2:
G When steady-state driving is performed again even after it is interrupted, each diagnosis can be con-
ducted. In this case, the time required for diagnosis may be extended.
*1: Depress the accelerator pedal until vehicle speed is 90 km/h (56 MPH), then release the accelerator pedal
and keep it released for more than 10 seconds. Depress the accelerator pedal until vehicle speed is 90 km/h
(56 MPH) again.
*2: Checking the vehicle speed with GST is advised.
Suggested Transmission Gear Position for A/T Models
Set the selector lever in the D position with the overdrive switch turned ON.
TEST VALUE AND TEST LIMIT (GST ONLY NOT APPLICABLE TO CONSULT-II)
The following is the information specified in Mode 6 of ISO 15031-5.
The test value is a parameter used to determine whether a system/circuit diagnostic test is OK or NG while
being monitored by the ECM during self-diagnosis. The test limit is a reference value which is specified as the
maximum or minimum value and is compared with the test value being monitored.
Items for which these data (test value and test limit) are displayed are the same as SRT code items.
These data (test value and test limit) are specified by Test ID (TID) and Component ID (CID) and can be dis-
played on the GST screen.
QG16DE Engine Models
: Applicable : Not applicable
SRT item Self-diagnostic test item
Test value (GST display)
Test limit Application
TID CID
CATALYST Three way catalyst function 01H 01H Max.
HO2S
Heated oxygen sensor 1
09H 04H Max.
0AH 84H Min.
0BH 04H Max.
0CH 04H Max.
0DH 04H Max.
Heated oxygen sensor 2
19H 86H Min.
1AH 86H Min.
1BH 06H Max.
1CH 06H Max.
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-73
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
QG18DE Engine Models
: Applicable : Not applicable
HOW TO ERASE EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION
How to Erase DTC ( With CONSULT-II)
The emission related diagnostic information in the ECM can be erased by selecting ERASE in the SELF-
DIAG RESULTS mode with CONSULT-II.
If DTCs are displayed for both ECM and TCM (Transmission control module), they need to be erased individu-
ally from the ECM and TCM (Transmission control module).
HO2S HTR
Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
29H 08H Max.
2AH 88H Min.
Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
2DH 0AH Max.
2EH 8AH Min.
SRT item Self-diagnostic test item
Test value (GST display)
Test limit Application
TID CID
SRT item Self-diagnostic test item
Test value (GST display)
Test limit Application
TID CID
CATALYST
Three way catalyst function (Bank1)
01H 01H Max.
02H 81H Min.
Three way catalyst function (Bank2)
03H 02H Max.
04H 82H Min.
HO2S
Heated oxygen sensor 1 (Bank 1)
09H 04H Max.
0AH 84H Min.
0BH 04H Max.
0CH 04H Max.
0DH 04H Max.
Heated oxygen sensor 1 (Bank 2)
11H 05H Max.
12H 85H Min.
13H 05H Max.
14H 05H Max.
15H 05H Max.
Heated oxygen sensor 2 (Bank 1)
19H 86H Min.
1AH 86H Min.
1BH 06H Max.
1CH 06H Max.
Heated oxygen sensor 2 (Bank 2)
21H 87H Min.
22H 87H Min.
23H 07H Max.
24H 07H Max.
HO2S HTR
Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater (Bank 1)
29H 08H Max.
2AH 88H Min.
Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater (Bank 2)
2BH 09H Max.
2CH 89H Min.
Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater (Bank 1)
2DH 0AH Max.
2EH 8AH Min.
Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater (Bank 2)
2FH 0BH Max.
30H 8BH Min.
EC-74
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
NOTE:
If the DTC is not for A/T related items (see EC-23, "INDEX FOR DTC" ), skip steps 2 through 4.
1. If the ignition switch stays ON after repair work, be sure to turn ignition switch OFF once. Wait at least
10 seconds and then turn it ON (engine stopped) again.
2. Turn CONSULT-II ON and touch A/T.
3. Touch SELF-DIAG RESULTS.
4. Touch ERASE. [The DTC in the TCM (Transmission control module) will be erased.] Then touch BACK
twice.
5. Touch ENGINE.
6. Touch SELF-DIAG RESULTS.
7. Touch ERASE. (The DTC in the ECM will be erased.)
How to Erase DTC ( With GST)
The emission related diagnostic information in the ECM can be erased by selecting Mode 4 with GST.
NOTE:
If the DTC is not for A/T related items (see EC-23, "INDEX FOR DTC" ), skip step 2.
1. If the ignition switch stays ON after repair work, be sure to turn ignition switch OFF once. Wait at least
10 seconds and then turn it ON (engine stopped) again.
2. Perform SELF-DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE (Without CONSULT-II) in AT section titled TROUBLE
DIAGNOSIS, Self-diagnosis. (The engine warm-up step can be skipped when performing the diagnosis
only to erase the DTC.)
3. Select Mode 4 with GST (Generic Scan Tool).
How to Erase DTC ( No Tools)
1. If the ignition switch stays ON after repair work, be sure to turn ignition switch OFF once.
SEF966X
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-75
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Wait at least 10 seconds and then turn it ON (engine stopped) again.
3. Change the diagnostic test mode from Mode II to Mode I by depressing the accelerator pedal. Refer to
EC-76, "HOW TO SWITCH DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE" .
G If the battery is disconnected, the emission-related diagnostic information will be lost after
approx. 24 hours.
G The following data are cleared when the ECM memory is erased.
1. Diagnostic trouble codes
2. 1st trip diagnostic trouble codes
3. Freeze frame data
4. 1st trip freeze frame data
5. System readiness test (SRT) codes
6. Test values
7. Others
Actual work procedures are explained using a DTC as an example. Be careful so that not only the DTC, but all
of the data listed above, are cleared from the ECM memory during work procedures.
NATS (Nissan Anti-theft System) EBS00ELV
G If the security indicator lights up with the ignition switch in
the ON position or NATS MALFUNCTION is displayed
on SELF-DIAG RESULTS screen, perform self-diagnostic
results mode with CONSULT-II using NATS program card.
Refer to BL-156, "NATS (NISSAN ANTI-THEFT SYSTEM)" .
G Confirm no self-diagnostic results of NATS is displayed
before touching ERASE in SELF-DIAG RESULTS mode
with CONSULT-II.
G When replacing ECM, initialization of NATS system and reg-
istration of all NATS ignition key IDs must be carried out
with CONSULT-II using NATS program card.
Therefore, be sure to receive all keys from vehicle owner.
Regarding the procedures of NATS initialization and NATS ignition key ID registration, refer to
CONSULT-II operation manual, NATS.
Malfunction Indicator (MI) EBS00ELW
DESCRIPTION
The MI is located on the instrument panel.
1. The MI will light up when the ignition switch is turned ON without
the engine running. This is a bulb check.
G If the MI does not light up, refer to DI-95, "WARNING LAMPS" ,
or see EC-552 .
2. When the engine is started, the MI should go off.
If the MI remains on, the on board diagnostic system has
detected an engine system malfunction.
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEM FUNCTION
The on board diagnostic system has the following four functions.
SEF515Y
SAT652J
EC-76
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
MI Flashing without DTC
If the ECM is in Diagnostic Test Mode II, MI may flash when engine is running. In this case, check ECM diag-
nostic test mode, EC-76, "HOW TO SWITCH DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE" .
How to switch the diagnostic test (function) modes, and details of the above functions are described later, EC-
76, "HOW TO SWITCH DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE" .
The following emission-related diagnostic information is cleared when the ECM memory is erased.
1. Diagnostic trouble codes
2. 1st trip diagnostic trouble codes
3. Freeze frame data
4. 1st trip freeze frame data
5. System readiness test (SRT) codes
6. Test values
7. Others
HOW TO SWITCH DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE
NOTE:
G It is better to count the time accurately with a clock.
G It is impossible to switch the diagnostic mode when an accelerator pedal position sensor circuit
has a malfunction.
G Always ECM returns to Diagnostic Test Mode I after ignition switch is turned OFF.
How to Set Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)
1. Confirm that accelerator pedal is fully released, turn ignition switch ON and wait 3 seconds.
Diagnostic Test
Mode
KEY and ENG.
Status
Function Explanation of Function
Mode I Ignition switch in
ON position
Engine stopped
BULB CHECK This function checks the MI bulb for damage (blown, open
circuit, etc.).
If the MI does not come on, check MI circuit.
Engine running MALFUNCTION
WARNING
This is a usual driving condition. When a malfunction is
detected twice in two consecutive driving cycles (two trip
detection logic), the MI will light up to inform the driver that
a malfunction has been detected.
The following malfunctions will light up or blink the MI in
the 1st trip.
G Misfire (Possible three way catalyst damage)
G Fail-safe mode
Mode II Ignition switch in
ON position
Engine stopped
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC
RESULTS
This function allows DTCs and 1st trip DTCs to be read.
Engine running HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
MONITOR
This function allows the fuel mixture condition (lean or
rich), monitored by heated oxygen sensor 1, to be read.
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-77
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Repeat the following procedure quickly five times within 5 seconds.
a. Fully depress the accelerator pedal.
b. Fully release the accelerator pedal.
3. Wait 7 seconds, fully depress the accelerator pedal and keep it for approx. 10 seconds until the MI starts
blinking.
4. Fully release the accelerator pedal.
ECM has entered to Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results).
How to Set Diagnostic Test Mode II (Heated Oxygen Sensor 1 Monitor)
1. Set the ECM in Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results). Refer to EC-76, "How to Set Diagnostic
Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)" .
2. Start Engine.
ECM has entered to Diagnostic Test Mode II (Heated oxygen sensor 1 monitor).
ECM will start heated oxygen sensor 1 monitoring from the bank 1 sensor for QG18DE engine models.
How to Switch Monitored Sensor From Bank 1 to Bank 2 or Vice Versa
1. Fully depress the accelerator pedal quickly and then release it immediately.
2. Make sure that monitoring sensor has changed by MI blinking as follows.
How to Erase Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)
1. Set ECM in Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results). Refer to EC-76, "How to Set Diagnostic Test
Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)" .
2. Fully depress the accelerator pedal and keep it for more than 10 seconds.
The emission-related diagnostic information has been erased from the backup memory in the ECM.
3. Fully release the accelerator pedal, and confirm the DTC 0000 is displayed.
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE I BULB CHECK
In this mode, the MI on the instrument panel should stay ON. If it remains OFF, check the bulb. Refer to DI-95,
"WARNING LAMPS" or see EC-552 .
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE I MALFUNCTION WARNING
G These DTC numbers are clarified in Diagnostic Test Mode II (SELF-DIAGNOSTIC RESULTS)
PBIB0092E
PBIB0093E
MI Condition
ON When the malfunction is detected.
OFF No malfunction.
EC-78
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE II SELF-DIAGNOSTIC RESULTS
In this mode, the DTC and 1st trip DTC are indicated by the number of blinks of the MI as shown below.
The DTC and 1st trip DTC are displayed at the same time. If the MI does not illuminate in diagnostic test mode
I (Malfunction warning), all displayed items are 1st trip DTCs. If only one code is displayed when the MI illumi-
nates in diagnostic test mode II (SELF-DIAGNOSTIC RESULTS), it is a DTC; if two or more codes are dis-
played, they may be either DTCs or 1st trip DTCs. DTC No. is same as that of 1st trip DTC. These unidentified
codes can be identified by using the CONSULT-II or GST. A DTC will be used as an example for how to read a
code.
A particular trouble code can be identified by the number of four-digit numeral flashes. The zero is indicated
by the number of ten flashes. The length of time the 1,000th-digit numeral flashes on and off is 1.2 seconds
consisting of an ON (0.6-second) - OFF (0.6-second) cycle.
The 100th-digit numeral and lower digit numerals consist of a 0.3-second ON and 0.3-second OFF cycle.
A change from one digit numeral to another occurs at an interval of 1.0-second OFF. In other words, the later
numeral appears on the display 1.3 seconds after the former numeral has disappeared.
A change from one trouble code to another occurs at an interval of 1.8-second OFF.
In this way, all the detected malfunctions are classified by their DTC numbers. The DTC 0000 refers to no
malfunction. (See EC-23, "INDEX FOR DTC" )
How to Erase Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)
The DTC can be erased from the back up memory in the ECM by depressing accelerator pedal. Refer to EC-
76, "HOW TO SWITCH DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE" .
G If the battery is disconnected, the DTC will be lost from the backup memory after approx 24 hours.
G Be careful not to erase the stored memory before starting trouble diagnoses.
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE II HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 MONITOR
In this mode, the MI displays the condition of the fuel mixture (lean or rich) which is monitored by the heated
oxygen sensor 1.
*: Maintains conditions just before switching to open loop.
To check the heated oxygen sensor 1 function, start engine in the Diagnostic Test Mode II and warm it up until
engine coolant temperature indicator points to the middle of the gauge.
Next run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no-load conditions. Then make sure that the MI
comes ON more than 5 times within 10 seconds with engine running at 2,000 rpm under no-load.
SEF952W
MI Fuel mixture condition in the exhaust gas Air fuel ratio feedback control condition
ON Lean
Closed loop system
OFF Rich
*Remains ON or OFF Any condition Open loop system
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-79
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
OBD System Operation Chart EBS00ELX
RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN MI, 1ST TRIP DTC, DTC, AND DETECTABLE ITEMS
G When a malfunction is detected for the first time, the 1st trip DTC and the 1st trip freeze frame data are
stored in the ECM memory.
G When the same malfunction is detected in two consecutive trips, the DTC and the freeze frame data are
stored in the ECM memory, and the MI will come on. For details, refer to EC-60, "Two Trip Detection
Logic" .
G The MI will go off after the vehicle is driven 3 times with no malfunction. The drive is counted only when
the recorded driving pattern is met (as stored in the ECM). If another malfunction occurs while counting,
the counter will reset.
G The DTC and the freeze frame data will be stored until the vehicle is driven 40 times (driving pattern A)
without the same malfunction recurring (except for Misfire and Fuel Injection System). For Misfire and
Fuel Injection System, the DTC and freeze frame data will be stored until the vehicle is driven 80 times
(driving pattern C) without the same malfunction recurring. The TIME in SELF-DIAGNOSTIC
RESULTS mode of CONSULT-II will count the number of times the vehicle is driven.
G The 1st trip DTC is not displayed when the self-diagnosis results in OK for the 2nd trip.
SUMMARY CHART
For details about patterns B and C under Fuel Injection System and Misfire, see EC-81 .
For details about patterns A and B under Other, see EC-83 .
*1: Clear timing is at the moment OK is detected.
*2: Clear timing is when the same malfunction is detected in the 2nd trip.
Items Fuel Injection System Misfire Other
MI (goes off) 3 (pattern B) 3 (pattern B) 3 (pattern B)
DTC, Freeze Frame Data (no
display)
80 (pattern C) 80 (pattern C) 40 (pattern A)
1st Trip DTC (clear) 1 (pattern C), *1 1 (pattern C), *1 1 (pattern B)
1st Trip Freeze Frame Data
(clear)
*1, *2 *1, *2 1 (pattern B)
EC-80
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN MI, DTC, 1ST TRIP DTC AND DRIVING PATTERNS FOR MISFIRE
<EXHAUST QUALITY DETERIORATION>, FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
*1: When the same malfunction is
detected in two consecutive trips, MI
will light up.
*2: MI will go off after vehicle is driven 3
times (pattern B) without any malfunc-
tions.
*3: When the same malfunction is
detected in two consecutive trips, the
DTC and the freeze frame data will be
stored in ECM.
SEF392SA
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-81
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
EXPLANATION FOR DRIVING PATTERNS FOR MISFIRE <EXHAUST QUALITY DETERIORA-
TION>, FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
<Driving Pattern B>
Driving pattern B means the vehicle operation as follows:
All components and systems should be monitored at least once by the OBD system.
G The B counter will be cleared when the malfunction is detected once regardless of the driving pattern.
G The B counter will be counted up when driving pattern B is satisfied without any malfunction.
G The MI will go off when the B counter reaches 3. (*2 in OBD SYSTEM OPERATION CHART)
<Driving Pattern C>
Driving pattern C means the vehicle operation as follows:
1. The following conditions should be satisfied at the same time:
Engine speed: (Engine speed in the freeze frame data) 375 rpm
Calculated load value: (Calculated load value in the freeze frame data) x (10.1) [%]
Engine coolant temperature (T) condition:
G When the freeze frame data shows lower than 70C (158F), T should be lower than 70C (158F).
G When the freeze frame data shows higher than or equal to 70C (158F), T should be higher than or
equal to 70C (158F).
Example:
If the stored freeze frame data is as follows:
Engine speed: 850 rpm, Calculated load value: 30%, Engine coolant temperature: 80C (176F)
To be satisfied with driving pattern C, the vehicle should run under the following conditions:
Engine speed: 475 - 1,225 rpm, Calculated load value: 27 - 33%, Engine coolant temperature: more than 70C
(158F)
G The C counter will be cleared when the malfunction is detected regardless of (1).
G The C counter will be counted up when (1) is satisfied without the same malfunction.
G The DTC will not be displayed after C counter reaches 80.
G The 1st trip DTC will be cleared when C counter is counted once without the same malfunction after DTC
is stored in ECM.
*4: The DTC and the freeze frame data
will not be displayed any longer after
vehicle is driven 80 times (pattern C)
without the same malfunction. (The
DTC and the freeze frame data still
remain in ECM.)
*5: When a malfunction is detected for
the first time, the 1st trip DTC and the
1st trip freeze frame data will be
stored in ECM.
*6: The 1st trip DTC and the 1st trip
freeze frame data will be cleared at
the moment OK is detected.
*7: When the same malfunction is
detected in the 2nd trip, the 1st trip
freeze frame data will be cleared.
*8: 1st trip DTC will be cleared when
vehicle is driven once (pattern C)
without the same malfunction after
DTC is stored in ECM.
EC-82
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN MI, DTC, 1ST TRIP DTC AND DRIVING PATTERNS EXCEPT FOR
MISFIRE <EXHAUST QUALITY DETERIORATION>, FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
*1: When the same malfunction is
detected in two consecutive trips, MI
will light up.
*2: MI will go off after vehicle is driven 3
times (pattern B) without any malfunc-
tions.
*3: When the same malfunction is
detected in two consecutive trips, the
DTC and the freeze frame data will be
stored in ECM.
*4: The DTC and the freeze frame data
will not be displayed any longer after
vehicle is driven 40 times (pattern A)
without the same malfunction.
(The DTC and the freeze frame data
still remain in ECM.)
*5: When a malfunction is detected for
the first time, the 1st trip DTC and the
1st trip freeze frame data will be
stored in ECM.
*6: 1st trip DTC will be cleared after vehi-
cle is driven once (pattern B) without
the same malfunction.
*7: When the same malfunction is
detected in the 2nd trip, the 1st trip
freeze frame data will be cleared.
SEF393SA
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-83
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
EXPLANATION FOR DRIVING PATTERNS EXCEPT FOR MISFIRE <EXHAUST QUALITY
DETERIORATION>, FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM
<Driving Pattern A>
G The A counter will be cleared when the malfunction is detected regardless of (1) - (4).
G The A counter will be counted up when (1) - (4) are satisfied without the same malfunction.
G The DTC will not be displayed after the A counter reaches 40.
<Driving Pattern B>
Driving pattern B means the vehicle operation as follows:
All components and systems should be monitored at least once by the OBD system.
G The B counter will be cleared when the malfunction is detected once regardless of the driving pattern.
G The B counter will be counted up when driving pattern B is satisfied without any malfunctions.
G The MI will go off when the B counter reaches 3 (*2 in OBD SYSTEM OPERATION CHART).
AEC574
EC-84
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS PFP:00004
Trouble Diagnosis Introduction EBS00ELY
INTRODUCTION
The engine has an ECM to control major systems such as fuel con-
trol, ignition control, idle air control system, etc. The ECM accepts
input signals from sensors and instantly drives actuators. It is essen-
tial that both input and output signals are proper and stable. At the
same time, it is important that there are no problems such as vac-
uum leaks, fouled spark plugs, or other problems with the engine.
It is much more difficult to diagnose a problem that occurs intermit-
tently rather than continuously. Most intermittent problems are
caused by poor electric connections or improper wiring. In this case,
careful checking of suspected circuits may help prevent the replace-
ment of good parts.
A visual check only may not find the cause of the problems. A road
test with CONSULT-II (or GST) or a circuit tester connected should
be performed. Follow the Work Flow on EC-85 .
Before undertaking actual checks, take a few minutes to talk with a
customer who approaches with a driveability complaint. The cus-
tomer can supply good information about such problems, especially
intermittent ones. Find out what symptoms are present and under
what conditions they occur. A Diagnostic Worksheet like the exam-
ple on EC-88 should be used.
Start your diagnosis by looking for conventional problems first. This
will help troubleshoot driveability problems on an electronically con-
trolled engine vehicle.
MEF036D
SEF233G
SEF234G
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-85
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
WORK FLOW
Flow Chart
*1: If time data of SELF-DIAG
RESULTS is other than 0 or [1t],
perform EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAG-
NOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCI-
DENT" .
*2: If time data of SELF-DIAG
RESULTS is other than 0 or [1t],
perform EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAG-
NOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCI-
DENT" .
*3: If the on board diagnostic system can-
not be performed, check main power
supply and ground circuit. Refer to
EC-144, "POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
FOR ECM" .
*4: If malfunctioning part cannot be
detected, perform EC-143, "TROU-
BLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMIT-
TENT INCIDENT" .
*5: EC-71, "Driving Pattern" *6: EC-139, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS -
SPECIFICATION VALUE"
MBIB0159E
EC-86
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Description for Work Flow
STEP DESCRIPTION
STEP I
Get detailed information about the conditions and the environment when the incident/symptom occurred using the
DIAGNOSTIC WORK SHEET, EC-87 .
STEP II
Before confirming the concern, check and write down (print out using CONSULT-II or GST) the (1st trip) DTC and the
(1st trip) freeze frame data, then erase the DTC and the data. (Refer toEC-73, "HOW TO ERASE EMISSION-
RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .) The (1st trip) DTC and the (1st trip) freeze frame data can be used when
duplicating the incident at STEP III & IV.
If the incident cannot be verified, perform EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
Study the relationship between the cause, specified by (1st trip) DTC, and the symptom described by the customer.
(The Symptom Matrix Chart will be useful. See EC-97 .)
Also check related service bulletins for information.
STEP III
Try to confirm the symptom and under what conditions the incident occurs.
The DIAGNOSTIC WORK SHEET and the freeze frame data are useful to verify the incident. Connect CONSULT-II
to the vehicle in DATA MONITOR (AUTO TRIG) mode and check real time diagnosis results.
If the incident cannot be verified, perform EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
If the malfunction code is detected, skip STEP IV and perform STEP V.
STEP IV
Try to detect the (1st trip) DTC by driving in (or performing) the DTC Confirmation Procedure. Check and read the
(1st trip) DTC and (1st trip) freeze frame data by using CONSULT-II or GST.
During the (1st trip) DTC verification, be sure to connect CONSULT-II to the vehicle in DATA MONITOR (AUTO TRIG)
mode and check real time diagnosis results.
If the incident cannot be verified, perform EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
In case the DTC Confirmation Procedure is not available, perform the Overall Function Check instead. The (1st
trip) DTC cannot be displayed by this check, however, this simplified check is an effective alternative.
The NG result of the Overall Function Check is the same as the (1st trip) DTC detection.
STEP V
Take the appropriate action based on the results of STEP I through IV.
If the malfunction code is indicated, proceed to TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR DTC PXXXX.
If the normal code is indicated, proceed to the BASIC INSPECTION. (Refer to EC-92 .) If COSULT-II is available, per-
form DATA MONITOR (SPEC) mode with CONSULT-II and proceed to the TOROUBLE DIAGNOSIS SPECIFI-
CATION VALUE. (Refer to EC-139 .) (If malfunction is detected, proceed to PERAIR/REPLACE.) Then perform
inspections according to the Symptom Matrix Chart. (Refer to EC-97 .)
STEP VI
Identify where to begin diagnosis based on the relationship study between symptom and possible causes. Inspect the
system for mechanical binding, loose connectors or wiring damage using (tracing) Harness Layouts.
Gently shake the related connectors, components or wiring harness with CONSULT-II set in DATA MONITOR
(AUTO TRIG) mode.
Check the voltage of the related ECM terminals or monitor the output data from the related sensors with CONSULT-II.
Refer to EC-107 , EC-133 .
The Diagnostic Procedure in EC section contains a description based on open circuit inspection. A short circuit
inspection is also required for the circuit check in the Diagnostic Procedure. For details, refer to Circuit Inspection in
GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident" .
Repair or replace the malfunction parts.
If malfunctioning part cannot be detected, perform EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCI-
DENT" .
STEP VII
Once you have repaired the circuit or replaced a component, you need to run the engine in the same conditions and
circumstances which resulted in the customer's initial complaint.
Perform the DTC Confirmation Procedure and confirm the normal code [DTC No. P0000] is detected. If the incident
is still detected in the final check, perform STEP VI by using a method different from the previous one.
Before returning the vehicle to the customer, be sure to erase the unnecessary (already fixed) (1st trip) DTC in ECM
and TCM (Transmission control module). (Refer toEC-73, "HOW TO ERASE EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC
INFORMATION" and AT-37, "HOW TO ERASE DTC" .)
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-87
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DIAGNOSTIC WORKSHEET
Description
There are many operating conditions that lead to the malfunction of
engine components. A good grasp of such conditions can make trou-
bleshooting faster and more accurate.
In general, each customer feels differently about a problem. It is
important to fully understand the symptoms or conditions for a cus-
tomer complaint.
Utilize a diagnostic worksheet like the one on the next page in order
to organize all the information for troubleshooting.
Some conditions may cause the MI to come on steady or blink and
DTC to be detected. Examples:
G Vehicle ran out of fuel, which caused the engine to misfire.
G Fuel filler cap was left off or incorrectly screwed on, allowing fuel
to evaporate into the atmosphere.
SEF907L
EC-88
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Worksheet Sample
DTC Inspection Priority Chart EBS00ELZ
If some DTCs are displayed at the same time, perform inspections one by one based on the following priority
chart.
NOTE:
If DTC U1000 and/or U1001 is displayed with other DTC, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC
U1000 and U1001. Refer to EC-150, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
MTBL0017
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-89
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
QG16DE ENGINE
Priority Detected items (DTC)
1 G U1001 CAN communication line
G P0102 P0103 P1102 Mass air flow sensor
G P0112 P0113 Intake air temperature sensor
G P0117 P0118 Engine coolant temperature sensor
G P0221 P0222 P0223 P1223 P1224 P1225 P1226 P1229 Throttle position sensor
G P0226 P0227 P0228 P1227 P1228 Accelerator pedal position sensor
G P0327 P0328 Knock sensor
G P0335 Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
G P0340 Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
G P0500 Vehicle speed sensor
G P0605 ECM
G P1610-P1615 NATS
G P1706 Park/Neutral position (PNP) switch
2 G P0031 P0032 Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
G P0037 P0038 Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
G P0132 P0133 P0134 P1143 P1144 Heated oxygen sensor 1
G P0138 P0139 P1146 P1147 Heated oxygen sensor 2
G P0550 Power steering pressure sensor
G P1065 ECM power supply
G P1111 Intake valve timing control solenoid valve
G P1122 Electric throttle control function
G P1124 P1126 P1128 Electric throttle control actuator
G P1805 Brake switch
3 G P0011 Intake valve timing control
G P0171 P0172 Fuel injection system function
G P0300 - P0304 Misfire
G P0420 Three way catalyst function
G P0444 P0445 EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve
G P1121 Electric throttle control actuator
G P1217 Engine over temperature (OVERHEAT)
EC-90
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
QG18DE ENGINE
Fail-safe Chart EBS00EM0
When the DTC listed below is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
Priority Detected items (DTC)
1 G U1000 U1001 CAN communication line
G P0102 P0103 P1102 Mass air flow sensor
G P0112 P0113 Intake air temperature sensor
G P0117 P0118 Engine coolant temperature sensor
G P0221 P0222 P0223 P1223 P1224 P1225 P1226 P1229 Throttle position sensor
G P0226 P0227 P0228 P1227 P1228 Accelerator pedal position sensor
G P0327 P0328 Knock sensor
G P0335 Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
G P0340 Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
G P0500 Vehicle speed sensor
G P0605 ECM
G P0705 Park/Neutral position (PNP) switch
G P1610-P1615 NATS
G P1706 Park/Neutral position (PNP) switch
2 G P0031 P0032 P0051 P0052 Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
G P0037 P0038 P0057 P0058 Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
G P0132 P0133 P0134 P0152 P0153 P0154 P1143 P1144 P1163 P1164 Heated oxygen sensor 1
G P0138 P0139 P0158 P0159 P1146 P1147 P1166 P1167 Heated oxygen sensor 2
G P0550 Power steering pressure sensor
G P0710-P0725, P0740-P0755, P1705 P1760 A/T related sensors and solenoid valves
G P1065 ECM power supply
G P1111 Intake valve timing control solenoid valve
G P1122 Electric throttle control function
G P1124 P1126 P1128 Electric throttle control actuator
G P1805 Brake switch
3 G P0011 Intake valve timing control
G P0171 P0172 P0174 P0175 Fuel injection system function
G P0300 - P0304 Misfire
G P0420 P0430 Three way catalyst function
G P0444 P0445 EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve
G P0731-P0734 A/T function
G P1121 Electric throttle control actuator
G P1217 Engine over temperature (OVERHEAT)
DTC No. Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
P0102
P0103
P1102
Mass air flow sensor circuit Engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm due to the fuel cut.
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-91
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
P0117
P0118
Engine coolant tempera-
ture sensor circuit
Engine coolant temperature will be determined by ECM based on the time after turning
ignition switch ON or START.
CONSULT-II displays the engine coolant temperature decided by ECM.
Condition
Engine coolant temperature decided (CONSULT-
II display)
Just as ignition switch is turned
ON or Start
40C (104F)
More than approx. 4 minutes after
ignition ON or Start
80C (176F)
Except as shown above
40 - 80C (104 - 176F)
(Depends on the time)
When the fail-safe system for engine coolant temperature sensor is activated, the cool-
ing fan operates while engine is running.
P0221
P0222
P0223
P1223
P1224
Throttle position sensor The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening
in order for the idle position to be within +10 degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the nor-
mal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
P0226
P0227
P0228
P1227
P1228
Accelerator pedal position
sensor
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening
in order for the idle position to be within +10 degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the nor-
mal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
P1121 Electric throttle control actu-
ator
(ECM detect the throttle
valve is stuck open.)
While the vehicle is driving, it slows down gradually by fuel cut. After the vehicle stops,
the engine stalls.
The engine can restart in N or P position, and engine speed will not exceed 1,000
rpm or more.
P1122 Electric throttle control func-
tion
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.
P1124
P1126
Throttle control motor relay ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.
P1128
Throttle control motor
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring
P1229 Sensor power supply ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.
DTC No. Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
EC-92
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Basic Inspection EBS00EM1
1. INSPECTION START
1. Check service records for any recent repairs that may indicate a related problem, or a current need for
scheduled maintenance.
2. Open engine hood and check the following:
Harness connectors for improper connections
Wiring harness for improper connections, pinches and cut
Vacuum hoses for splits, kinks and improper connections
Hoses and ducts for leaks
Air cleaner clogging
Gasket
3. Confirm that electrical or mechanical loads are not applied.
Headlamp switch is OFF.
Air conditioner switch is OFF.
Rear window defogger switch is OFF.
Steering wheel is in the straight-ahead position, etc.
4. Start engine and warm it up until engine coolant temperature
indicator points the middle of gauge.
Ensure engine stays below 1,000 rpm.
5. Run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no-
load.
6. Make sure that no DTC is displayed with CONSULT-II or GST.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. REPAIR OR REPLACE
Repair or replace components as necessary according to corresponding Diagnostic Procedure.
>> GO TO 3.
SEF983U
SEF976U
SEF977U
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-93
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK TARGET IDLE SPEED
With CONSULT-II
1. Run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no-load.
2. Rev engine (2,000 to 3,000 rpm) two or three times under no-
load, then run engine at idle speed for about 1 minute.
3. Read idle speed in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no-load.
2. Rev engine (2,000 to 3,000 rpm) two or three times under no-load, then run engine at idle speed for about
1 minute.
3. Check idle speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. PERFORM ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION LEARNING
1. Stop engine.
2. Perform EC-55, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
>> GO TO 5.
5. PERFORM THROTTLE VALVE CLOSED POSITION LEARNING
Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
>> GO TO 6.
SEF978U
M/T: 700 50 rpm
A/T: 800 50 rpm (in P or N position)
SEF058Y
M/T: 700 50 rpm
A/T: 800 50 rpm (in P or N position)
EC-94
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
6. PERFORM IDLE AIR VOLUME LEARNING
Refer to EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
CMPLT or INCMP
CMPLT>> GO TO 7.
INCMP >> 1. Follow the construction of Idle Air Volume Learning.
2. GO TO 4.
7. CHECK TARGET IDLE SPEED AGAIN
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Read idle speed in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Check idle speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 8.
8. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Check camshaft position sensor (PHASE) and circuit. Refer to EC-355 .
G Check crankshaft position sensor (POS) and circuit. Refer to EC-348 .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> 1. Repair or replace.
2. GO TO 4.
9. CHECK ECM FUNCTION
1. Substitute another known-good ECM to check ECM function. (ECM may be the cause of a problem, but
this is the rarely the case.)
2. Perform initialization of NATS system and registration of NATS ignition key IDs. Refer to EC-75, "NATS
(Nissan Anti-theft System)" .
>> GO TO 4.
Which is the result CMPLT or INCMP?
M/T: 700 50 rpm
A/T: 800 50 rpm (in P or N position)
M/T: 700 50 rpm
A/T: 800 50 rpm (in P or N position)
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-95
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
10. CHECK IGNITION TIMING
1. Run engine at idle.
2. Check ignition timing with a timing light.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 11.
11. PERFORM ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION LEARNING
1. Stop engine.
2. Perform EC-55, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
>> GO TO 12.
12. PERFORM THROTTLE VALVE CLOSED POSITION LEARNING
Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
>> GO TO 13.
13. PERFORM IDLE AIR VOLUME LEARNING
Refer to EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
CMPLT or INCMP
CMPLT>> GO TO 14.
INCMP >> 1. Follow the construction of Idle Air Volume Learning.
2. GO TO 4.
14. CHECK TARGET IDLE SPEED AGAIN
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Read idle speed in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Check idle speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 15.
NG >> GO TO 17.
M/T: 8 5 BTDC
A/T: 10 5 BTDC (in P or N position)
Which is the result CMPLT or INCMP?
M/T: 700 50 rpm
A/T: 800 50 rpm (in P or N position)
M/T: 700 50 rpm
A/T: 800 50 rpm (in P or N position)
EC-96
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
15. CHECK IGNITION TIMING AGAIN
1. Run engine at idle.
2. Check ignition timing with a timing light.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 16.
16. CHECK TIMING CHAIN INSTALLATION
Check timing chain installation. Refer to EM-49, "TIMING CHAIN" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> 1. Repair the timing chain installation.
2. GO TO 4.
17. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Check camshaft position sensor (PHASE) and circuit. Refer to EC-355 .
G Check crankshaft position sensor (POS) and circuit. Refer to EC-348 .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 18.
NG >> 1. Repair or replace.
2. GO TO 4.
18. CHECK ECM FUNCTION
1. Substitute another known-good ECM to check ECM function. (ECM may be the cause of a problem, but
this is the rarely the case.)
2. Perform initialization of NATS system and registration of NATS ignition key IDs. Refer to EC-75, "NATS
(Nissan Anti-theft System)" .
>> GO TO 4.
M/T: 8 5 BTDC
A/T: 10 5 BTDC (in P or N position)
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-97
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Symptom Matrix Chart EBS00EM2
SYSTEM BASIC ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
SYMPTOM
Reference
page
H
A
R
D
/
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
/
R
E
S
T
A
R
T
(
E
X
C
P
.
H
A
)
E
N
G
I
N
E
S
T
A
L
L
H
E
S
I
T
A
T
I
O
N
/
S
U
R
G
I
N
G
/
F
L
A
T
S
P
O
T
S
P
A
R
K
K
N
O
C
K
/
D
E
T
O
N
A
T
I
O
N
L
A
C
K
O
F
P
O
W
E
R
/
P
O
O
R
A
C
C
E
L
E
R
A
T
I
O
N
H
I
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
L
O
W
I
D
L
E
R
O
U
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
H
U
N
T
I
N
G
I
D
L
I
N
G
V
I
B
R
A
T
I
O
N
S
L
O
W
/
N
O
R
E
T
U
R
N
T
O
I
D
L
E
O
V
E
R
H
E
A
T
S
/
W
A
T
E
R
T
E
M
P
E
R
A
T
U
R
E
H
I
G
H
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
F
U
E
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
O
I
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
B
A
T
T
E
R
Y
D
E
A
D
(
U
N
D
E
R
C
H
A
R
G
E
)
Warranty symptom code AA AB AC AD AE AF AG AH AJ AK AL AM HA
Fuel Fuel pump circuit 1 1 2 3 2 2 2 3 2 EC-536
Fuel pressure regulator system 3 3 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 EC-58
Injector circuit 1 1 2 3 2 2 2 2 EC-530
Evaporative emission system 3 3 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4
EC-369,
EC-554
Air Positive crankcase ventilation sys-
tem
3 3 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 1 EC-557
Incorrect idle speed adjustment 3 3 1 1 1 1 1 EC-92
Electric throttle control actuator 1 1 2 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 2
EC-400,
EC-402 ,
EC-409 ,
EC-415
Ignition Incorrect ignition timing adjustment 3 3 1 1 1 1 1 1 EC-92
Ignition circuit 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 EC-520
Main power supply and ground circuit 2 2 3 3 3 3 3 2 3 EC-144
Mass air flow sensor circuit 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2
EC-183,
EC-389
Engine coolant temperature sensor circuit 1 1 2 2 2 3 2 2 3 1 2 EC-194
Throttle position sensor circuit 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
EC-312,
EC-318 ,
EC-490 ,
EC-496 ,
EC-498 ,
EC-507
Accelerator pedal position sensor circuit 3 2 1 2 2
EC-324,
EC-331 ,
EC-500
EC-98
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
1 - 6: The numbers refer to the order of inspection.
(continued on next page)
Heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit 1 2 3 2 2 2 2
EC-199,
EC-205 ,
EC-214 ,
EC-223 ,
EC-234 ,
EC-241 ,
EC-420 ,
EC-426 ,
EC-432 ,
EC-438
Knock sensor circuit 2 2 3 EC-344
Crankshaft position sensor (POS) circuit 2 2 EC-348
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE) circuit 2 2 EC-355
Vehicle speed signal circuit 2 3 3 3 EC-375
Power steering pressure sensor circuit 2 3 3 3 3 EC-377
ECM 2 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3
EC-382,
EC-385
Intake valve timing control solenoid valve cir-
cuit
3 3 2 1 3 2 2 3 3 EC-395
PNP switch circuit 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 EC-511
Refrigerant pressure sensor circuit 2 3 3 3 3 4 EC-542
Electrical load signal circuit 3 3 3 3 EC-547
Air conditioner circuit 2 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 ATC-30
SYMPTOM
Reference
page
H
A
R
D
/
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
/
R
E
S
T
A
R
T
(
E
X
C
P
.
H
A
)
E
N
G
I
N
E
S
T
A
L
L
H
E
S
I
T
A
T
I
O
N
/
S
U
R
G
I
N
G
/
F
L
A
T
S
P
O
T
S
P
A
R
K
K
N
O
C
K
/
D
E
T
O
N
A
T
I
O
N
L
A
C
K
O
F
P
O
W
E
R
/
P
O
O
R
A
C
C
E
L
E
R
A
T
I
O
N
H
I
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
L
O
W
I
D
L
E
R
O
U
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
H
U
N
T
I
N
G
I
D
L
I
N
G
V
I
B
R
A
T
I
O
N
S
L
O
W
/
N
O
R
E
T
U
R
N
T
O
I
D
L
E
O
V
E
R
H
E
A
T
S
/
W
A
T
E
R
T
E
M
P
E
R
A
T
U
R
E
H
I
G
H
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
F
U
E
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
O
I
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
B
A
T
T
E
R
Y
D
E
A
D
(
U
N
D
E
R
C
H
A
R
G
E
)
Warranty symptom code AA AB AC AD AE AF AG AH AJ AK AL AM HA
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-99
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
SYSTEM ENGINE MECHANICAL & OTHER
SYMPTOM
Reference
page
H
A
R
D
/
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
/
R
E
S
T
A
R
T
(
E
X
C
P
.
H
A
)
E
N
G
I
N
E
S
T
A
L
L
H
E
S
I
T
A
T
I
O
N
/
S
U
R
G
I
N
G
/
F
L
A
T
S
P
O
T
S
P
A
R
K
K
N
O
C
K
/
D
E
T
O
N
A
T
I
O
N
L
A
C
K
O
F
P
O
W
E
R
/
P
O
O
R
A
C
C
E
L
E
R
A
T
I
O
N
H
I
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
L
O
W
I
D
L
E
R
O
U
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
H
U
N
T
I
N
G
I
D
L
I
N
G
V
I
B
R
A
T
I
O
N
S
L
O
W
/
N
O
R
E
T
U
R
N
T
O
I
D
L
E
O
V
E
R
H
E
A
T
S
/
W
A
T
E
R
T
E
M
P
E
R
A
T
U
R
E
H
I
G
H
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
F
U
E
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
O
I
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
B
A
T
T
E
R
Y
D
E
A
D
(
U
N
D
E
R
C
H
A
R
G
E
)
Warranty symptom code AA AB AC AD AE AF AG AH AJ AK AL AM HA
Fuel Fuel tank
5
5
FL-13
Fuel piping 5 5 5 5 5 5
FL-3, MA-
23
Vapor lock
Valve deposit
5 5 5 5 5 5 5

Poor fuel (Heavy weight gaso-


line, Low octane)

Air Air duct
5 5 5 5 5 5
EM-17
Air cleaner EM-17
Air leakage from air duct
(Mass air flow sensor electric
throttle control actuator)
5 5 5 5
EM-17
Electric throttle control actuator EM-19
Air leakage from intake manifold/
Collector/Gasket
EM-19
Cranking Battery
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
SC-3
Alternator circuit SC-12
Starter circuit 3 SC-22
Signal plate/Flywheel/Drive plate 6 EM-70
PNP switch
4
MT-14, MT-
62 or AT-
115
Engine Cylinder head
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 EM-57
Cylinder head gasket 4 3
Cylinder block
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6
4
EM-70
Piston
Piston ring
Connecting rod
Bearing
Crankshaft
EC-100
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
1 - 6: The numbers refer to the order of inspection.
Valve
mecha-
nism
Timing chain
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
EM-49
Camshaft EM-36
Intake valve timing control EM-49
Intake valve
3 EM-57
Exhaust valve
Exhaust Exhaust manifold/Tube/Muffler/
Gasket
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
EM-23, EX-
3
Three way catalyst
Lubrica-
tion
Oil pan/Oil strainer/Oil pump/Oil
filter/Oil gallery
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 2
EM-27, LU-
8 , LU-9 ,
LU-5
Oil level (Low)/Filthy oil LU-6
Cooling Radiator/Hose/Radiator filler cap
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 2 5
CO-11
Thermostat 5 CO-20
Water pump CO-18
Water gallery CO-7
Cooling fan 5 CO-11
Coolant level (low)/Contaminated
coolant
CO-8
NATS (Nissan Anti-Theft System) 1 1
EC-75 or
BL-156
SYMPTOM
Reference
page
H
A
R
D
/
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
/
R
E
S
T
A
R
T
(
E
X
C
P
.
H
A
)
E
N
G
I
N
E
S
T
A
L
L
H
E
S
I
T
A
T
I
O
N
/
S
U
R
G
I
N
G
/
F
L
A
T
S
P
O
T
S
P
A
R
K
K
N
O
C
K
/
D
E
T
O
N
A
T
I
O
N
L
A
C
K
O
F
P
O
W
E
R
/
P
O
O
R
A
C
C
E
L
E
R
A
T
I
O
N
H
I
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
L
O
W
I
D
L
E
R
O
U
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
H
U
N
T
I
N
G
I
D
L
I
N
G
V
I
B
R
A
T
I
O
N
S
L
O
W
/
N
O
R
E
T
U
R
N
T
O
I
D
L
E
O
V
E
R
H
E
A
T
S
/
W
A
T
E
R
T
E
M
P
E
R
A
T
U
R
E
H
I
G
H
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
F
U
E
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
O
I
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
B
A
T
T
E
R
Y
D
E
A
D
(
U
N
D
E
R
C
H
A
R
G
E
)
Warranty symptom code AA AB AC AD AE AF AG AH AJ AK AL AM HA
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-101
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Engine Control Component Parts Location EBS00EM3
MBIB0117E
EC-102
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
MBIB0118E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-103
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
MBIB0119E
EC-104
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
MBIB0120E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-105
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Circuit Diagram EBS00EM4
MBWA0042E
EC-106
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
MBWA0043E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-107
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
ECM Harness Connector Terminal Layout EBS00EM5
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00EM6
PREPARATION
1. ECM is located behind the glove box. For this inspection,
remove glove box.
2. Remove ECM harness protector.
3. When disconnecting ECM harness connector, loosen it with
levers as far as they will go as shown at right.
4. Connect a break-out box (SST) and Y-cable adapter (SST)
between the ECM and ECM harness connector.
G Use extreme care not to touch 2 pins at one time.
G Data is for comparison and may not be exact.
ECM INSPECTION TABLE
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
QG16DE Engine Models
MBIB0045E
MBIB0155E
MBIB0145E
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
1 B ECM ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Engine ground
EC-108
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
2 R/B
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm.
G After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of 70
km/h (43 MPH) or more
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
3 R
Throttle control motor power
supply
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
4 BR
Throttle control motor
(Close)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is 1st
G Accelerator pedal is releasing
0 - 14V
5 Y
Throttle control motor
(Open)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is 1st
G Accelerator pedal is depressing
0 - 14V
12 L
Power steering pressure
sensor
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is being turned
0.5 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is not being turned
0.4 - 0.8V
13 R
Crankshaft position sensor
(POS)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 3.0V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
Approximately 3.0V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0534E
PBIB0533E
PBIB0527E
PBIB0528E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-109
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
14 R
Camshaft position sensor
(PHASE)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.0 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
1.0 - 4.0V
15 W Knock sensor
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 2.5V
16 W Heated oxygen sensor 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
19 GY/L
EVAP canister purge
volume control solenoid
valve
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is about 2,000 rpm (More
than 100 seconds after starting engine)
Approximately 10V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0525E
PBIB0526E
PBIB0050E
PBIB0520E
EC-110
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
22
23
41
42
G/B
R/B
L/B
Y/B
Injector No. 3
Injector No. 1
Injector No. 4
Injector No. 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
24 G
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm.
Approximately 7.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped.
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
29 B
Camshaft position sensor
(PHASE) ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
30 B
Camshaft position sensor
(POS) ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
34 BR
Intake air temperature
sensor
[Engine is running]
Approximately 0 - 4.8V
Output voltage varies with
intake air temperature.
35 W Heated oxygen sensor 1
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
45 R
Sensor power supply
(Mass air flow sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
46 R
Sensor power supply
(Refrigerant pressure
sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
47 G
Sensor power supply
(Throttle position sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0529E
PBIB0530E
PBIB0519E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-111
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
49 W Throttle position sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is 1st
G Accelerator pedal fully released
More than 0.36V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is 1st
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
Less than 4.75V
50 Y Mass air flow sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.0 - 1.7V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,500 rpm.
1.5 - 2.1V
54 -
Sensor ground
(Knock sensor shield circuit)
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
57 B
Sensor ground
(Power steering pressure
sensor/Refrigerant pressure
sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
60
61
79
80
L/R
BR
GY/R
PU
Ignition signal No. 3
Ignition signal No. 1
Ignition signal No. 4
Ignition signal No. 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0 - 0.1V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - 0.2V
62 Y/R
Intake valve timing control
solenoid valve
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed 2,500 rpm
7 - 10V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0521E
PBIB0522E
MBIB0052E
PBIB0532E
EC-112
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
65 G
Sensor power supply
(Power steering pressure
sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
66 B
Sensor ground
(Throttle position sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
67 B
Sensor ground
(Mass air flow sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
68 R Throttle position sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is 1st
G Accelerator pedal fully released
Less than 4.75V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is 1st
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 0.36V
69 R/L Refrigerant pressure sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Both A/C switch and blower switch are
ON
(Compressor operates.)
1.0 - 4.0V
72 BR/W
Engine coolant temperature
sensor
[Engine is running]
Approximately 0 - 4.8V
Output voltage varies with
engine coolant temperature.
73 B
Sensor ground
(Engine coolant temperature
sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
74 B
Sensor ground
(Heated oxygen sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
82 B
Sensor ground
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
83 B
Sensor ground
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
85 LG DATA link connector
[Ignition switch ON]
G CONSULT-II or GST is disconnected.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
86 R CAN communication line [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 2.3V
90 R
Sensor power supply
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
91 G
Sensor power supply
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
94 L CAN communication line [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 2.8V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-113
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
98 LG
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is 1st
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.175 - 0.335V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is 1st
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 1.95V
101 R/G Stop lamp switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Brake pedal fully released
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Brake pedal fully depressed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
102 G/OR PNP switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Gear position is neutral
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Except the above gear position
Approximately 5V
104 OR Throttle control motor relay
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch ON] 0 - 1.0V
106 L
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is 1st
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.35 - 0.67V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is 1st
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.9V
109 B/R Ignition switch
[Ignition switch OFF] 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
111 W/G ECM relay (Self shut-off)
[Engine is running]
[Ignition switch OFF]
G For 5 seconds after turning ignition switch
OFF
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch OFF]
G 5 seconds passed after turning ignition
switch OFF
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
113 B/P Fuel pump relay
[Ignition switch ON]
G For 1 second after turning ignition switch
ON
[Engine is running]
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G More than 1 second after turning ignition
switch ON.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
115
116
B
B
ECM ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Engine ground
119
120
W
W
Power supply for ECM [Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
121 W/L
Power supply for ECM
(Buck-up)
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
EC-114
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
QG18DE Engine Models
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
1 B ECM ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Engine ground
2 L
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater (bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm.
G After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of 70
km/h (43 MPH) or more
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
3 R
Throttle control motor power
supply
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
4 BR
Throttle control motor
(Close)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is releasing
0 - 14V
5 Y
Throttle control motor
(Open)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is depressing
0 - 14V
7 W/R
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater (bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm
G After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of 70
km/h (43 MPH) or more
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14)
12 L
Power steering pressure
sensor
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is being turned
Approximately 3.6V
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is not being turned
Approximately 0.6V
PBIB0534E
PBIB0533E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-115
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
13 R
Crankshaft position sensor
(POS)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 3.0V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
Approximately 3.0V
14 R
Camshaft position sensor
(PHASE)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.0 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
1.0 - 4.0V
15 W Knock sensor
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 2.5V
16 Y
Heated oxygen sensor 2
(bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
17 L
Heated oxygen sensor 2
(bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0527E
PBIB0528E
PBIB0525E
PBIB0526E
EC-116
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
19 GY/L
EVAP canister purge
volume control solenoid
valve
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is about 2,000 rpm (More
than 100 seconds after starting engine)
Approximately 10V
22
23
41
42
G/B
R/B
L/B
Y/B
Injector No. 3
Injector No. 1
Injector No. 4
Injector No. 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
24 G
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater (bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm (M/T
model)
G Engine speed is below 3,200 rpm (A/T
model)
Approximately 7.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,200 rpm (M/T
model)
G Engine speed is above 3,200 rpm (A/T
model)
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0050E
PBIB0520E
PBIB0529E
PBIB0530E
PBIB0519E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-117
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
25 R/B
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater (bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm (M/T
model)
G Engine speed is below 3,200 rpm (A/T
model)
Approximately 7.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm (M/T
model)
G Engine speed is above 3,200 rpm (A/T
model)
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
29 B
Camshaft position sensor
(PHASE) ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
30 B
Camshaft position sensor
(POS) ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
34 BR
Intake air temperature
sensor
[Engine is running]
Approximately 0 - 4.8V
Output voltage varies with
intake air temperature.
35 W
Heated oxygen sensor 1
(bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
36 W
Heated oxygen sensor 1
(bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
45 R
Sensor power supply
(Mass air flow sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
46 R
Sensor power supply
(Refrigerant pressure
sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
47 G
Sensor power supply
(Throttle position sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
49 W Throttle position sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
More than 0.36V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
Less than 4.75V
50 Y Mass air flow sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.0 - 1.7V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,500 rpm
1.5 - 2.1V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0519E
EC-118
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
54 -
Sensor ground
(Knock sensor shield circuit)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
57 B
Sensor ground
(Power steering pressure
sensor/Refrigerant pressure
sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
60
61
79
80
L/R
BR
GY/R
PU
Ignition signal No. 3
Ignition signal No. 1
Ignition signal No. 4
Ignition signal No. 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0 - 0.1V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
0 - 0.2V
62 Y/R
Intake valve timing control
solenoid valve
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,500 rpm
7 - 10V
65 G
Sensor power supply
(Power steering pressure
sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
66 B
Sensor ground
(Throttle position sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
67 B
Sensor ground
(Mass air flow sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0521E
PBIB0522E
MBIB0052E
PBIB0532E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-119
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
68 R Throttle position sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
Less than 4.75V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 0.36V
69 R/L Refrigerant pressure sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Both A/C switch and blower switch are
ON
(Compressor operates.)
1.0 - 4.0V
72 BR/W
Engine coolant temperature
sensor
[Engine is running]
Approximately 0 - 4.8V
Output voltage varies with
engine coolant temperature.
73 B
Sensor ground
(Engine coolant temperature
sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
74 B
Sensor ground
(Heated oxygen sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
82 B
Sensor ground
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
83 B
Sensor ground
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
85 LG DATA link connector
[Ignition switch ON]
G CONSULT-II or GST is disconnected.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
86 R CAN communication line [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 2.3V
90 R
Sensor power supply
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
91 G
Sensor power supply
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
92
Accelerator pedal position
sensor signal output
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.35 - 0.67V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.9V
94 L CAN communication line [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 2.8V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
EC-120
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
98 LG
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.175 - 0.335V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 1.95V
101 R/G Stop lamp switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Brake pedal fully released
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Brake pedal fully depressed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
102
P
(A/T)
G/OR
(M/T)
PNP switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Gear position is P or N
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Except the above gear position
A/T models
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
M/T models
Approximately 5V
103 Tachometer signal output
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
10 - 11V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
10 - 11V
104 OR Throttle control motor relay
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch ON] 0 - 1.0V
106 L
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
More than 0.36V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
Less than 4.75V
109 B/R Ignition switch
[Ignition switch OFF] 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
MBIB0053E
MBIB0054E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-121
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
CONSULT-II Function EBS00EM7
FUNCTION
*1: The following emission-related diagnostic information is cleared when the ECM memory is erased.
1. Diagnostic trouble codes
2. 1st trip diagnostic trouble codes
3. Freeze frame data
4. 1st trip freeze frame data
5. System readiness test (SRT) codes
6. Test values
7. Others
111 W/G ECM relay (Self shut-off)
[Engine is running]
[Ignition switch OFF]
G For 5 seconds after turning ignition switch
OFF
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch OFF]
G 5 seconds passed after turning ignition
switch OFF
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
113 B/P Fuel pump relay
[Ignition switch ON]
G For 1 second after turning ignition switch
ON
[Engine is running]
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G More than 1 second after turning ignition
switch ON.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
115
116
B
B
ECM ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Engine ground
119
120
W
W
Power supply for ECM [Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
121 W/L
Power supply for ECM
(Buck-up)
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
Diagnostic test mode Function
Work support
This mode enables a technician to adjust some devices faster and more accurately by following the
indications on the CONSULT-II unit.
Self-diagnostic results
Self-diagnostic results such as 1st trip DTC, DTCs and 1st trip freeze frame data or freeze frame data
can be read and erased quickly.
*1
Data monitor Input/Output data in the ECM can be read.
Data monitor (SPEC)
Input/Output of the specification for Basic fuel schedule, AFM, A/F feedback control value and the
other data monitor items can be read.
Active test
Diagnostic Test Mode in which CONSULT-II drives some actuators apart from the ECMs and also
shifts some parameters in a specified range.
Function test This mode is used to inform customers when their vehicle condition requires periodic maintenance.
DTC & SRT confirmation The status of system monitoring tests and the self-diagnosis status/result can be confirmed.
ECM part number ECM part number can be read.
EC-122
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
ENGINE CONTROL COMPONENT PARTS/CONTROL SYSTEMS APPLICATION
X: Applicable
*1: This item includes 1st trip DTCs.
*2: This mode includes 1st trip freeze frame data or freeze frame data. The items appear on CONSULT-II screen in freeze frame data
mode only if a 1st trip DTC or DTC is detected. For details, refer to EC-66, "FREEZE FRAME DATA AND 1ST TRIP FREEZE FRAME
DATA" .
Item
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE
WORK
SUP-
PORT
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC
RESULTS
DATA
MONI-
TOR
DATA
MONI-
TOR
(SPEC)
ACTIVE
TEST
DTC & SRT
CONFIRMATION
DTC
*1
FREEZE
FRAME
DATA
*2
SRT
STATUS
DTC
WORK
SUP-
PORT
E
N
G
I
N
E
C
O
N
T
R
O
L
C
O
M
P
O
N
E
N
T
P
A
R
T
S
I
N
P
U
T
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Mass air flow sensor
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Heated oxygen sensor 1
Heated oxygen sensor 2
Vehicle speed signal
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Throttle position sensor
Intake air temperature sensor
Knock sensor
Refrigerant pressure sensor
Closed throttle position switch
(accelerator pedal position sensor
signal)

Air conditioner switch
Park/neutral position (PNP) switch
Stop lamp switch
Power steering pressure sensor
Battery voltage
Electrical load signal
O
U
T
P
U
T
Injectors
Power transistor (Ignition timing)
Throttle control motor relay
Throttle control motor
EVAP canister purge volume con-
trol solenoid valve

Air conditioner relay
Fuel pump relay
Cooling fan relay
Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
Intake valve timing control solenoid
valve

Calculated load value
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-123
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
CONSULT-II INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Connect CONSULT-II to data link connector, which is located
under the drivers side dash panel.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Touch START.
5. Touch ENGINE.
6. Perform each diagnostic test mode according to each service
procedure.
For further information, see the CONSULT-II Operation Manual.
MBIB0156E
PBR455D
SEF995X
SEF824Y
EC-124
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
WORK SUPPORT MODE
Work Item
*: This function is not necessary in the usual service procedure.
SELF-DIAG RESULTS MODE
Self Diagnostic Item
Regarding items of DTC and 1st trip DTC, refer to EC-23, "INDEX FOR DTC" .)
Freeze Frame Data and 1st Trip Freeze Frame Data
*1: The items are the same as those of 1st trip freeze frame data.
WORK ITEM CONDITION USAGE
FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE G FUEL PUMP WILL STOP BY TOUCHING START DUR-
ING IDLING.
CRANK A FEW TIMES AFTER ENGINE STALLS.
When releasing fuel pressure
from fuel line
IDLE AIR VOL LEARN G THE IDLE AIR VOLUME THAT KEEPS THE ENGINE
WITHIN THE SPECIFIED RANGE IS MEMORIZED IN
ECM.
When learning the idle air volume
SELF-LEARNING CONT G THE COEFFICIENT OF SELF-LEARNING CONTROL
MIXTURE RATIO RETURNS TO THE ORIGINAL COEF-
FICIENT.
When clearing the coefficient of
self-learning control value
TARGET IDLE RPM ADJ
*
G IDLE CONDITION When setting target idle speed
TARGET IGN TIM ADJ
*
G IDLE CONDITION When adjusting target ignition tim-
ing
After adjustment, confirm target
ignition timing with a timing light.
Freeze frame data
item
*1
Description
DIAG TROUBLE
CODE
[PXXXX]
G The engine control component part/control system has a trouble code, it is displayed as PXXXX. (Refer
to EC-23, "INDEX FOR DTC" .)
FUEL SYS-B1
G Fuel injection system status at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
G One mode in the following is displayed.
MODE 2: Open loop due to detected system malfunction
MODE 3: Open loop due to driving conditions (power enrichment, deceleration enrichment)
MODE 4: Closed loop - using oxygen sensor(s) as feedback for fuel control
MODE 5: Open loop - has not yet satisfied condition to go to closed loop
CAL/LD VALUE [%] G The calculated load value at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
COOLANT TEMP [C]
or [F]
G The engine coolant temperature at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
L-FUEL TRIM-B1 [%]
G Long-term fuel trim at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
G The long-term fuel trim indicates much more gradual feedback compensation to the base fuel schedule
than short-term fuel trim.
S-FUEL TRIM-B1 [%]
G Short-term fuel trim at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
G The short-term fuel trim indicates dynamic or instantaneous feedback compensation to the base fuel
schedule.
ENGINE SPEED
[rpm]
G The engine speed at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
VHCL SPEED [km/h]
or [mph]
G The vehicle speed at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
B/FUEL SCHDL
[msec]
G The base fuel schedule at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
INT/A TEMP SE [C]
or [F]
G The intake air temperature at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-125
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DATA MONITOR MODE
Monitored Item
: Applicable
Monitored item
[Unit]
ECM
INPUT
SIG-
NALS
MAIN
SIG-
NALS
CAN
DIAG
SUP-
PORT
MNTR
Description Remarks
ENG SPEED [rpm]
G Indicates the engine speed computed
from the signals of the crankshaft posi-
tion sensor (POS) and camshaft posi-
tion sensor (PHASE).
G Accuracy becomes poor if engine
speed drops below the idle rpm.
G If the signal is interrupted while the
engine is running, an abnormal
value may be indicated.
MAS A/F SE-B1 [V]
G The signal voltage of the mass air flow
sensor is displayed.
G When the engine is stopped, a
certain value is indicated.
B/FUEL SCHDL
[msec]

G Base fuel schedule indicates the fuel
injection pulse width programmed into
ECM, prior to any learned on board cor-
rection.
A/F ALPHA-B1 [%]
G The mean value of the air-fuel ratio
feedback correction factor per cycle is
indicated.
G When the engine is stopped, a
certain value is indicated.
G This data also includes the data
for the air-fuel ratio learning con-
trol.
A/F ALPHA-B2
[%]
*1

COOLAN TEMP/S
[C] or [F]

G The engine coolant temperature (deter-
mined by the signal voltage of the
engine coolant temperature sensor) is
displayed.
G When the engine coolant tempera-
ture sensor is open or short-cir-
cuited, ECM enters fail-safe mode.
The engine coolant temperature
determined by the ECM is dis-
played.
HO2S1 (B1) [V]
G The signal voltage of the heated oxygen
sensor 1 is displayed.
HO2S1 (B2) [V]
*1

HO2S2 (B1) [V]


G The signal voltage of the heated oxygen
sensor 2 is displayed.
HO2S2 (B2) [V]
*1

HO2S1 MNTR(B1)
[RICH/LEAN]

G Display of heated oxygen sensor 1 sig-
nal during air-fuel ratio feedback control:
RICH ... means the mixture became
rich, and control is being affected
toward a leaner mixture.
LEAN ... means the mixture became
lean, and control is being affected
toward a rich mixture.
G After turning ON the ignition
switch, RICH is displayed until
air-fuel mixture ratio feedback
control begins.
G When the air-fuel ratio feedback is
clamped, the value just before the
clamping is displayed continu-
ously.
HO2S1 MNTR(B2)
[RICH/LEAN]
*1

HO2S2 MNTR(B1)
[RICH/LEAN]

G Display of heated oxygen sensor 2 sig-
nal:
RICH ... means the amount of oxygen
after three way catalyst is relatively
small.
LEAN ... means the amount of oxygen
after three way catalyst is relatively
large.
G When the engine is stopped, a
certain value is indicated. HO2S2 MNTR(B2)
[RICH/LEAN]
*1

VHCL SPEED SE
[km/h] or [mph]

G The vehicle speed computed from the
vehicle speed signal is displayed.
BATTERY VOLT
[V]

G The power supply voltage of ECM is dis-
played.
EC-126
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
ACCEL SEN 1 [V]
G The accelerator pedal position sensor
signal voltage is displayed.
ACCEL SEN 2 [V]
THRTL SEN 1 [V]
G The throttle position sensor signal volt-
age is displayed.
THRTL SEN 2 [V]
INT/A TEMP SE
[C] or [F]

G The intake air temperature (determined
by the signal voltage of the intake air
temperature sensor) is indicated.
START SIGNAL
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition of the
starter signal computed from the signals
of the crankshaft position sensor (POS),
camshaft position sensor (PHASE) and
battery voltage.
G After starting the engine, [OFF] is
displayed regardless of the starter
signal.
CLSD THL POS
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates idle position [ON/OFF] com-
puted by ECM according to the acceler-
ator pedal position sensor signal.
AIR COND SIG
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition of the air
conditioner switch as determined by the
air conditioner signal.
P/N POSI SW
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from the
park/neutral position (PNP) switch sig-
nal.
PW/ST SIGNAL
[ON/OFF]

G [ON/OFF] condition of the power steer-
ing oil pressure switch as determined by
the power steering oil pressure signal is
indicated.
LOAD SIGNAL
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from the
electrical load signal.
ON ... Rear window defogger switch is
ON and/or lighting switch is in 2nd posi-
tion.
OFF ... Both rear window defogger
switch and lighting switch are OFF.
IGNITION SW
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from igni-
tion switch.
HEATER FAN SW
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from the
heater fan switch signal.
BRAKE SW
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from the
stop lamp switch signal.
INJ PULSE-B1
[msec]

G Indicates the actual fuel injection pulse
width compensated by ECM according
to the input signals.
G When the engine is stopped, a
certain computed value is indi-
cated.
INJ PULSE-B2
[msec]
*1
IGN TIMING
[BTDC]

G Indicates the ignition timing computed
by ECM according to the input signals.
G When the engine is stopped, a
certain value is indicated.
CAL/LD VALUE [%]
G Calculated load value indicates the
value of the current airflow divided by
peak airflow.
MASS AIRFLOW
[gm/s]
G Indicates the mass airflow computed by
ECM according to the signal voltage of
the mass air flow sensor.
Monitored item
[Unit]
ECM
INPUT
SIG-
NALS
MAIN
SIG-
NALS
CAN
DIAG
SUP-
PORT
MNTR
Description Remarks
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-127
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
PURG VOL C/V
[%]
G Indicates the EVAP canister purge vol-
ume control solenoid valve control value
computed by the ECM according to the
input signals.
G The opening becomes larger as the
value increases.
INT/V TIM (B1)
[CA]
G Indicates [CA] of intake camshaft
advanced angle.
INT/V SOL (B1) [%]
G The control condition of the intake valve
timing control solenoid valve (deter-
mined by ECM according to the input
signals) is indicated.
ON ... intake valve timing control is oper-
ating.
OFF ... Intake valve timing control is not
operating.
AIR COND RLY
[ON/OFF]

G The air conditioner relay control condi-
tion (determined by ECM according to
the input signals) is indicated.
FUEL PUMP RLY
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates the fuel pump relay control
condition determined by ECM according
to the input signals.
THRTL RELAY
[ON/OFF]

*2
G Indicates the throttle control motor relay
control condition determined by the
ECM according to the input signals.
COOLING FAN
[ON/OFF]
G Indicates the condition of the cooling fan
(determined by ECM according to the
input signals).
ON ... Operation
OFF ... Stop
HO2S1 HTR (B1)
[ON/OFF]
G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition of heated
oxygen sensor 1 heater determined by
ECM according to the input signals.
HO2S1 HTR (B2)
[ON/OFF]
*1
HO2S2 HTR (B1)
[ON/OFF]
G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition of heated
oxygen sensor 2 heater determined by
ECM according to the input signals.
HO2S2 HTR (B2)
[ON/OFF]
*1
VEHICLE SPEED
[km/h] or [mph]

G The vehicle speed computed from the
vehicle speed signal sent from TCM is
displayed.
IDL A/V LEARN
[YET/CMPLT/
INCMP]
G Display the condition of idle air volume
learning
YET ... Idle air volume learning has not
been performed yet.
CMPLT ... Idle air volume learning has
already been performed successfully.
INCMP ... Idle air volume learning has
not been performed successfully.
TRVL AFTER MIL
[km] or [mile]
G Distance traveled while MI is activated.
Monitored item
[Unit]
ECM
INPUT
SIG-
NALS
MAIN
SIG-
NALS
CAN
DIAG
SUP-
PORT
MNTR
Description Remarks
EC-128
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
*1: For QG18 engine models.
*2: For QG16 engine models.
NOTE:
G Any monitored item that does not match the vehicle being diagnosed is deleted from the display automatically.
DATA MONITOR (SPEC) MODE
Monitored Item
O2SEN HTR DTY
[%]
G Indicates the heated oxygen sensor 1
heater control value computed by the
ECM according to the input signals.
AC PRESS SEN
[V]

*2
G The signal voltage from the refrigerant
pressure sensor is displayed.
Voltage [V]
G Voltage, frequency, duty cycle or pulse
width measured by the probe.
G Only # is displayed if item is
unable to be measured.
G Figures with #s are temporary
ones. They are the same figures
as an actual piece of data which
was just previously measured.
Frequency
[msec], [Hz] or [%]
DUTY-HI
DUTY-LOW
PLS WIDTH-HI
PLS WIDTH-LOW
CAN COMM
[OK/NG]

G Indicates the communication condition
of CAN communication line.
G These items are not displayed in
SELECTION FROM MENU
mode.
CAN CIRC 1
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 2
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 3
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 4
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 5
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 6
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 7
[OK/UNKWN]

Monitored item
[Unit]
ECM
INPUT
SIG-
NALS
MAIN
SIG-
NALS
CAN
DIAG
SUP-
PORT
MNTR
Description Remarks
Monitored item [Unit]
ECM
input
signals
Main
signals
Description Remarks
ENG SPEED [rpm]
G Indicates the engine speed computed
from the signal of the crankshaft position
sensor (POS).
MAS A/F SE-B1 [V]
G The signal voltage of the mass air flow
sensor specification is displayed.
G When engine is running specification
range is indicated.
B/FUEL SCHDL
[msec]

G Base fuel schedule indicates the fuel
injection pulse width programmed into
ECM, prior to any learned on board cor-
rection.
G When engine is running specification
range is indicated.
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-129
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
*1: For QG18 engine models
NOTE:
G Any monitored item that does not match the vehicle being diagnosed is deleted from the display automatically.
ACTIVE TEST MODE
Test Item
A/F ALPHA-B1 [%]
G The mean value of the air-fuel ratio feed-
back correction factor per cycle is indi-
cated.
G When engine is running specification
range is indicated.
G This data also includes the data for the
air-fuel ratio learning control.
A/F ALPHA-B2 [%]
*1

Monitored item [Unit]


ECM
input
signals
Main
signals
Description Remarks
TEST ITEM CONDITION JUDGEMENT CHECK ITEM (REMEDY)
FUEL INJEC-
TION
G Engine: Return to the original
trouble condition
G Change the amount of fuel injec-
tion using CONSULT-II.
If trouble symptom disappears, see
CHECK ITEM.
G Harness and connectors
G Fuel injectors
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
IGNITION TIM-
ING
G Engine: Return to the original
trouble condition
G Timing light: Set
G Retard the ignition timing using
CONSULT-II.
If trouble symptom disappears, see
CHECK ITEM.
G Perform Idle Air Volume Learn-
ing.
POWER BAL-
ANCE
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine.
G A/C switch OFF
G Shift lever N
G Cut off each injector signal one at
a time using CONSULT-II.
Engine runs rough or dies.
G Harness and connectors
G Compression
G Fuel injectors
G Power transistor
G Spark plugs
G Ignition coils
COOLING FAN
G Ignition switch: ON
G Turn the cooling fan ON and
OFF with CONSULT-II.
Cooling fan moves and stops.
G Harness and connectors
G Cooling fan relay
G Cooling fan motor
ENG COOLANT
TEMP
G Engine: Return to the original
trouble condition
G Change the engine coolant tem-
perature using CONSULT-II.
If trouble symptom disappears, see
CHECK ITEM.
G Harness and connectors
G Engine coolant temperature sen-
sor
G Fuel injectors
FUEL PUMP
RELAY
G Ignition switch: ON (Engine
stopped)
G Turn the fuel pump relay ON
and OFF using CONSULT-II
and listen to operating sound.
Fuel pump relay makes the operat-
ing sound.
G Harness and connectors
G Fuel pump relay
PURG VOL
CONT/V
G Engine: After warming up, run
engine at 1,500 rpm.
G Change the EVAP canister purge
volume control solenoid valve
opening percent using CON-
SULT-II.
Engine speed changes according to
the opening percent.
G Harness and connectors
G Solenoid valve
V/T ASSIGN
ANGLE
G Engine: Return to the original
trouble condition
G Change intake valve timing using
CONSULT-II.
If trouble symptom disappears, see
CHECK ITEM.
G Harness and connectors
G Intake valve timing control sole-
noid valve
EC-130
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
DTC & SRT CONFIRMATION MODE
SRT STATUS Mode
For details, refer to EC-67, "SYSTEM READINESS TEST (SRT) CODE" .
SRT Work Support Mode
This mode enables a technician to drive a vehicle to set the SRT while monitoring the SRT status.
DTC Work Support Mode
QG16 engine models
QG18 engine models
REAL TIME DIAGNOSIS IN DATA MONITOR MODE (RECORDING VEHICLE DATA)
Description
CONSULT-II has two kinds of triggers and they can be selected by touching SETTING in DATA MONITOR
mode.
1. AUTO TRIG (Automatic trigger):
G The malfunction will be identified on the CONSULT-II screen
in real time.
In other words, DTC/1st trip DTC and malfunction item will be
displayed if the malfunction is detected by ECM.
At the moment a malfunction is detected by ECM, MONI-
TOR in DATA MONITOR screen is changed to Recording
Data ... xx% as shown at right, and the data after the mal-
function detection is recorded. Then when the percentage
reached 100%, REAL-TIME DIAG screen is displayed. If
STOP is touched on the screen during Recording Data ...
xx%, REAL-TIME DIAG screen is also displayed.
The recording time after the malfunction detection and the
Test mode Test item Condition Reference page
HO2S1
HO2S1 (B1) P0133
Refer to corresponding
trouble diagnosis for
DTC.
EC-214
HO2S1 (B1) P0134 EC-234
HO2S1 (B1) P1143 EC-420
HO2S1 (B1) P1144 EC-432
H02S2
HO2S2 (B1) P0139 EC-267
HO2S2 (B1) P1146 EC-444
HO2S2 (B1) P1147 EC-462
Test mode Test item Condition Reference page
HO2S1
HO2S1 (B1) P0133, P0153
Refer to corresponding
trouble diagnosis for
DTC.
EC-223
HO2S1 (B1) P0134, P0154 EC-241
HO2S1 (B1) P1143, P1163 EC-426
HO2S1 (B1) P1144, P1164 EC-438
H02S2
HO2S2 (B1) P0139, P0159 EC-275
HO2S2 (B1) P1146, P1166 EC-452
HO2S2 (B1) P1147, P1167 EC-470
SEF705Y
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-131
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
recording speed can be changed by TRIGGER POINT and
Recording Speed. Refer to CONSULT-II OPERATION MAN-
UAL.
2. MANU TRIG (Manual trigger):
G DTC/1st trip DTC and malfunction item will not be displayed
automatically on CONSULT-II screen even though a malfunc-
tion is detected by ECM.
DATA MONITOR can be performed continuously even though
a malfunction is detected.
Operation
1. AUTO TRIG
G While trying to detect the DTC/1st trip DTC by performing the DTC Confirmation Procedure, be sure
to select to DATA MONITOR (AUTO TRIG) mode. You can confirm the malfunction at the moment it is
detected.
G While narrowing down the possible causes, CONSULT-II should be set in DATA MONITOR (AUTO
TRIG) mode, especially in case the incident is intermittent.
When you are inspecting the circuit by gently shaking (or twisting) the suspicious connectors, compo-
nents and harness in the DTC Confirmation Procedure, the moment a malfunction is found the DTC/
1st trip DTC will be displayed. (Refer to Incident Simulation Tests in GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient
Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident" .)
2. MANU TRIG
G If the malfunction is displayed as soon as DATA MONITOR is selected, reset CONSULT-II to MANU
TRIG. By selecting MANU TRIG you can monitor and store the data. The data can be utilized for fur-
ther diagnosis, such as a comparison with the value for the normal operating condition.
SEF707X
PBIB0197E
EC-132
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Generic Scan Tool (GST) Function EBS00EM8
DESCRIPTION
Generic Scan Tool (OBDII scan tool) complying with ISO 15031-4
has 8 different functions explained below.
ISO9141 is used as the protocol.
The name GST or Generic Scan Tool is used in this service man-
ual.
FUNCTION
GST INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Connect GST to data link connector, which is located under the
driver side dash panel near the fuse box cover.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
SEF139P
Diagnostic test mode Function
MODE 1 READINESS TESTS
This mode gains access to current emission-related data values, including analog inputs
and outputs, digital inputs and outputs, and system status information.
MODE 2 (FREEZE DATA)
This mode gains access to emission-related data value which were stored by ECM during
the freeze frame. For details, refer to EC-66, "FREEZE FRAME DATA AND 1ST TRIP
FREEZE FRAME DATA" .
MODE 3 DTCs
This mode gains access to emission-related power train trouble codes which were stored
by ECM.
MODE 4 CLEAR DIAG INFO
This mode can clear all emission-related diagnostic information. This includes:
G Clear number of diagnostic trouble codes (MODE 1)
G Clear diagnostic trouble codes (MODE 3)
G Clear trouble code for freeze frame data (MODE 1)
G Clear freeze frame data (MODE 2)
G Reset status of system monitoring test (MODE 1)
G Clear on board monitoring test results (MODE 6 and 7)
MODE 6 (ON BOARD TESTS)
This mode accesses the results of on board diagnostic monitoring tests of specific com-
ponents/systems that are not continuously monitored.
MODE 7 (ON BOARD TESTS)
This mode enables the off board test drive to obtain test results for emission-related pow-
ertrain components/systems that are continuously monitored during normal driving condi-
tions.
MODE 8 This mode is not applicable on this vehicle.
MODE 9 (CALIBRATION ID)
This mode enables the off-board test device to request specific vehicle information such
as Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) and Calibration IDs.
MBIB0156E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-133
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. Enter the program according to instruction on the screen or in
the operation manual.
(*: Regarding GST screens in this section, sample screens are
shown.)
5. Perform each diagnostic mode according to each service proce-
dure.
For further information, see the GST Operation Manual of the
tool maker.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EM9
Remarks:
G Specification data are reference values.
G Specification data are output/input values which are detected or supplied by the ECM at the connector.
* Specification data may not be directly related to their components signals/values/operations.
i.e. Adjust ignition timing with a timing light before monitoring IGN TIMING, because the monitor may show the specification data in
spite of the ignition timing not being adjusted to the specification data. This IGN TIMING monitors the data calculated by the ECM
according to the signals input from the camshaft position sensor and other ignition timing related sensors.
SEF398S
SEF416S
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
ENG SPEED
G Tachometer: Connect
G Run engine and compare tachometer indication with the CONSULT-II
value.
Almost the same speed as the
CONSULT-II value.
MAS A/F SE-B1
G Engine: After warming up
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Shift lever: N
G No-load
Idle Approx. 1.0 - 1.7V
2,500 rpm Approx. 1.5 - 2.1V
B/FUEL SCHDL
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 1.5 - 3.0 msec
2,000 rpm 1.2 - 3.0 msec
A/F ALPHA-B1
A/F ALPHA-B2
*
G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
75% - 125%
COOLAN TEMP/S G Engine: After warming up More than 70C (158F)
HO2S1 (B1)
HO2S1 (B2)
*
G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S2 (B1)
HO2S2 (B2)
*
G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1)
HO2S1 MNTR (B2)
*
G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times dur-
ing 10 seconds.
HO2S2 MNTR (B1)
HO2S2 MNTR (B2)
*
G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
LEAN RICH
EC-134
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
VEH SPEED SE
G Turn drive wheels and compare speedometer indication with the CON-
SULT-II value.
Almost the same speed as the
CONSULT-II value
BATTERY VOLT G Ignition switch: ON (Engine stopped) 11 - 14V
ACCEL SEN1
ACCEL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed More than 3.9V
THRTL SEN1
THRTL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released More than 0.36V
G Shift lever:
D (A/T model)
1st (M/T model)
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
START SIGNAL G Ignition switch: ON START ON OFF ON OFF
CLSD THL POS G Ignition switch: ON
Accelerator pedal: Fully released ON
Accelerator pedal: Slightly depressed OFF
AIR COND SIG
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Air conditioner switch: OFF OFF
Air conditioner switch: ON
(Compressor operates.)
ON
P/N POSI SW G Ignition switch: ON
Shift lever: P or N (A/T model)
Neutral (M/T model)
ON
Shift lever: Except above OFF
PW/ST SIGNAL
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Steering wheel is in neutral position.
(Forward direction)
OFF
Steering wheel is turned. ON
LOAD SIGNAL G Ignition switch: ON
Rear window defogger switch is ON
and/or lighting switch is in 2nd.
ON
Rear window defogger switch is OFF
and lighting switch is OFF.
OFF
IGNITION SW G Ignition switch: ON OFF ON ON OFF ON
HEATER FAN SW
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Heater fan is operating. ON
Heater fan is not operating OFF
BRAKE SW G Ignition switch: ON
Brake pedal: Fully released OFF
Brake pedal: Slightly depressed ON
INJ PULSE-B1
INJ PULSE-B2
*
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 2.0 - 3.5 msec
2,000 rpm 1.5 - 3.5 msec
IGN TIMING
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle
M/T: 85 BTDC
A/T: 105 BTDC
2,000 rpm 25 - 45 BTDC
CAL/LD VALUE
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 10% - 35%
2,500 rpm 10% - 35%
MASS AIRFLOW
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 1.0 - 4.0 gm/s
2,500 rpm 5.0 - 10.0 gm/s
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-135
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
PURG VOL C/V
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 0%
2,000 rpm 15 - 30%
INT/V TIM (B1)
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 5 - 5CA
2,000 rpm Approx. 0 - 30CA
INT/V SOL (B1)
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 0% - 2%
2,000 rpm Approx. 0% - 60%
AIR COND RLY
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Air conditioner switch: OFF OFF
Air conditioner switch: ON
(Compressor operates)
ON
FUEL PUMP RLY
G For 1 seconds after turning ignition switch ON
G Engine running or cranking
ON
G Except above conditions OFF
THRTL RELAY G Ignition switch: ON ON
COOLING FAN
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
Engine coolant temperature is 99C
(210F) or less
OFF
Engine coolant temperature is 100C
(212F) or more
ON
HO2S1 HTR (B1)
HO2S1 HTR (B2)
*
G Engine: After warming up
G Engine speed: Below 3,600 rpm (M/T models)
Below 3,200 rpm (A/T models)
ON
G Engine speed: Above 3,600 rpm (M/T models)
Above 3,200 rpm (A/T models)
OFF
HO2S2 HTR (B1)
HO2S2 HTR (B2)
*
G Engine speed: Below 3,600 rpm [After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of
70 km/h (43 MPH) or more]
ON
G Engine speed: Above 3,600 rpm OFF
TRVL AFTER MIL G Ignition switch: ON
Vehicle has traveled after MI has
turned ON.
0 - 65,280 km
(0 - 40,565 mile)
O2SEN HTR DTY
G Engine coolant temperature when engine started: More than 80 (176F)
G Engine speed: Below 3,600 rpm (M/T models)
Below 3,200 rpm (A/T models)
Approx. 50%
AC PRESS SEN
G Ignition switch: ON (Engine stopped) Approx. 0V
G Engine: Idle
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
1.0 - 4.0V
VEH SPEED SE
G Turn drive wheels and compare speedometer indication with the CON-
SULT-II value.
Almost the same speed as the
CONSULT-II value
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
EC-136
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
*: These items are displayed with QG18DE engine models
Major Sensor Reference Graph in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EMA
The following are the major sensor reference graphs in DATA MONITOR mode.
CLSD THL POS, ACCEL SEN 1, THRTL SEN 1
Below is the data for CLSD THL POS, ACCEL SEN 1 and THRTL SEN 1 when depressing the accelera-
tor pedal with the ignition switch ON and with selector lever in D position (A/T models) or with shift lever in
1st position (M/T models).
The signal of ACCEL SEN 1 and THRTL SEN 1 should rise gradually without any intermittent drop or rise
after CLSD THL POS is changed from ON to OFF.
ENG SPEED, MAS A/F SE-B1, THRTL SEN 1, HO2S2 (B1), HO2S1 (B1), INJ PULSE-B1
Below is the data for ENG SPEED, MAS A/F SE-B1, THRTL SEN 1, HO2S2 (B1), HO2S1 (B1) and
INJ PULSE-B1 when revving engine quickly up to 4,800 rpm under no load after warming up engine suffi-
ciently.
CAN COMM
G Ignition switch: ON
OK
CAN CIRC 1 OK
CAN CIRC 2 OK or UNKWN
CAN CIRC 3 UNKWN
CAN CIRC 4 OK
CAN CIRC 5 UNKWN
CAN CIRC 6 OK
CAN CIRC 7 UNKWN
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
PBIB0198E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-137
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Each value is for reference, the exact value may vary.
SEF241Y
EC-138
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
PBIB0668E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE
EC-139
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE PFP:00031
Description EBS00EMB
The specification (SP) value indicates the tolerance of the value that is displayed in DATA MONITOR (SPEC)
mode of CONSULT-II during normal operation of the Engine Control System. When the value in DATA MONI-
TOR (SPEC) mode is within the SP value, the Engine Control System is confirmed OK. When the value in
DATA MONITOR (SPEC) mode is NOT within the SP value, the Engine Control System may have one or
more malfunctions.
The SP value is used to detect malfunctions that may affect the Engine Control System, but will not light the
MIL.
The SP value will be displayed for the following three items:
G B/FUEL SCHDL (The fuel injection pulse width programmed into ECM prior to any learned on board cor-
rection)
G A/F ALPHA-B1/B2 (The mean value of air-fuel ratio feedback correction factor per cycle)
G MAS A/F SE-B1 (The signal voltage of the mass air flow sensor)
Testing Condition EBS00EMC
G Vehicle driven distance: More than 5,000 km (3,017 miles)
G Barometric pressure: 98.3 - 104.3 kPa (1.003 - 1.064 kg/cm
2
, 14.25 - 15.12 psi)
G Atmospheric temperature: 20 - 30C (68 - 86F)
G Engine coolant temperature: 75 - 95C (167 - 203F)
G Transmission: Warmed-up
*1
G Electrical load: Not applied
*2
G Engine speed: Idle
*1: For A/T models with CONSULT-II, after the engine is warmed up to normal operating temperature, drive
vehicle until FLUID TEMP SE (A/T fluid temperature sensor signal) indicates more than 60C (140F).
For A/T models without CONSUT-II and M/T models, after the engine is warmed up to normal operating tem-
perature, drive vehicle for 5 minutes.
*2: Rear window defogger switch, air conditioner switch, lighting switch are OFF. Steering wheel is straight
ahead.
Inspection Procedure EBS00EMD
NOTE:
Perform DATA MONITOR (SPEC) mode in maximum scale display.
1. Perform EC-92, "Basic Inspection" .
2. Confirm that the testing conditions indicated above are met.
3. Select B/FUEL SCHDL, A/F ALPHA-B1/B2 and MAS A/F
SE-B1 in DATA MONITOR (SPEC) mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Make sure that monitor items are within the SP value.
5. If NG, go to EC-140, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF601Z
EC-140
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EME
SEF613ZD
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE
EC-141
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
SEF768Z
EC-142
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE
SEF615ZA
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
EC-143
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT PFP:00006
Description EBS00EMF
Intermittent incidents (I/I) may occur. In many cases, the problem resolves itself (the part or circuit function
returns to normal without intervention). It is important to realize that the symptoms described in the customer's
complaint often do not recur on (1st trip) DTC visits. Realize also that the most frequent cause of I/I occur-
rences is poor electrical connections. Because of this, the conditions under which the incident occurred may
not be clear. Therefore, circuit checks made as part of the standard diagnostic procedure may not indicate the
specific problem area.
Common I/I Report Situations
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EMG
1. INSPECTION START
Erase (1st trip) DTCs. Refer to EC-73, "HOW TO ERASE EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMA-
TION" .
>> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK GROUND TERMINALS
Check ground terminals for corroding or loose connection.
Refer to GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident" , Incident Simulation Tests.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
3. SEARCH FOR ELECTRICAL INCIDENT
Perform GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident" , Incident Simulation Tests.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> Repair or replace.
STEP in Work Flow Situation
II The CONSULT-II is used. The SELF-DIAG RESULTS screen shows time data other than 0 or [1t].
III The symptom described by the customer does not recur.
IV (1st trip) DTC does not appear during the DTC Confirmation Procedure.
VI The Diagnostic Procedure for PXXXX does not indicate the problem area.
EC-144
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM PFP:24110
Wiring Diagram EBS00EMH
MBWA0044E
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
EC-145
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EMI
1. INSPECTION START
Start engine.
Is engine running?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 8.
No >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-I
1. Turn ignition switch OFF and then ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 109 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
1 B ECM ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Engine ground
109 B/R Ignition switch
[Ignition switch OFF] 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
111 W/G
ECM relay
(Self shut-off)
[Engine is running]
[Ignition switch OFF]
G For 3 seconds after turning ignition switch OFF
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch OFF]
G 3 seconds passed after turning ignition switch
OFF
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
115
116
B
B
ECM ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Engine ground
119
120
W
W
Power supply for
ECM
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0015E
EC-146
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Fuse block (J/B) connector M1
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between ECM and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK ECM GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT-I
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals 1, 115, 116 and engine ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-II
1. Disconnect ECM relay.
2. Check voltage between ECM relay terminals 1 and 6 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0155E
Voltage: Battery voltage
SEF420X
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
EC-147
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E70, F13 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E63, F31 (RHD models)
G 10A fuse
G 20A fuse
G Harness for open or short between ECM relay and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 111 and ECM relay terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> Go to EC-520, "IGNITION SIGNAL" .
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-III
1. Stop engine and wait at least 10 seconds.
2. Turn ignition switch ON and then OFF.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminals 119, 120 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG (Battery voltage does not exist.)>>GO TO 9.
NG (Battery voltage exists for more than a few seconds.)>>GO TO 11.
Continuity should exist.
Voltage: After turning ignition switch OFF, battery
voltage will exist for a few seconds, then
drop approximately 0V.
MBIB0016E
EC-148
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
9. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-IV
1. Disconnect ECM relay.
2. Check voltage between ECM relay terminal 3 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> GO TO 10.
10. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between ECM relay and E70, F13 (LHD models)
G Harness for open or short between ECM relay and E63, F31 (RHD models)
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
11. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-V
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals 119, 120 and ECM relay terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
12. CHECK ECM RELAY
Refer to EC-149, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> Replace ECM relay.
MBIB0155E
Voltage: Battery voltage
SEF860T
Continuity should exist.
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
EC-149
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
13. CHECK ECM GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT-II
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals 1, 115, 116 and engine ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
14. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00G9A
ECM RELAY
1. Apply 12V direct current between ECM relay terminals 1 and 2.
2. Check continuity between relay terminals 3 and 5, 6 and 7.
3. If NG, replace ECM relay.
Continuity should exist.
Condition Continuity
12V direct current supply between ter-
minals 1 and 2
Yes
OFF No
PBIB0077E
EC-150
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE
DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE PFP:23710
Description EBS00G8M
CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real time application. It is an on-vehicle mul-
tiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent error detection ability. Many elec-
tronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links with other
control units during operation (not independent). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2
communication lines (CAN H line, CAN L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission with less wiring.
Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00G8N
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00G8O
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 3 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-152, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
U1000
1000
CAN communication line
G ECM can not communicate to other control
unit.
G ECM can not communicate for more than the
specified time.
G Harness or connectors
(CAN communication line is open or
shorted).
U1001
1001
DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE
EC-151
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00G8P
MBWA0038E
EC-152
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00G8Q
1. INSPECTION START
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Print out the CONSULT-II screen.
A/T models
M/T models
>> Go to LAN-8, "CAN COMMUNICATION" .
MBIB0180E
MBIB0179E
DTC P0011 IVT CONTROL
EC-153
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0011 IVT CONTROL PFP:23796
Description EBS00GW1
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
*: This signal is sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
This mechanism hydraulically controls cam phases continuously with the fixed operating angle of the intake
valve.
The ECM receives signals such as crankshaft position, camshaft position, engine speed, and engine coolant
temperature. Then, the ECM sends ON/OFF pulse duty signals to the intake valve timing control solenoid
valve depending on driving status. This makes it possible to control the shut/open timing of the intake valve to
increase engine torque in low/mid speed range and output in high-speed range.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GW2
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Engine speed
Intake valve
timing control
Intake valve timing control
solenoid valve
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Vehicle speed signal
*
Vehicle speed
MBIB0121E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
INT/V TIM (B1)
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 5 - 5CA
When revving engine up to 2,000 rpm
quickly
Approx. 0 - 30CA
INT/V SOL (B1)
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 0% - 2%
When revving engine up to 2,000 rpm
quickly
Approx. 0% - 60%
EC-154
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0011 IVT CONTROL
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GW4
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GW5
CAUTION:
Always drive at a safe speed.
NOTE:
G If DTC P0011 is displayed with DTC P1111, first perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P1111. See
EC-395, "DTC P1111 IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE" .
G If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and
wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is between 10V and 16V at
idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Maintain the following conditions for at least 20 consecutive sec-
onds.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-154, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GW6
1. CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (POS)
Refer to EC-353, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Replace crankshaft position sensor (POS).
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name Detecting condition Possible cause
P0011
0011
Intake valve timing con-
trol performance
There is a gap between angle of target and
phase-control angle degree.
G Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
G Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
G Accumulation of debris to the signal pick-up
portion of the camshaft
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
Intake valve timing control The signal is not energized to the solenoid valve and the valve control does not function
ENG SPEED 1,700 - 3,175 rpm (A constant rotation is maintained.)
COOLANT TEMPS 70 - 105C (176 - 194F)
Selector lever 1st or 2nd position
Driving location uphill
Driving vehicle uphill
(Increased engine load will help maintain the driving
conditions required for this test.)
SEF174Y
DTC P0011 IVT CONTROL
EC-155
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (PHASE)
Refer to EC-359, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Replace camshaft position sensor (PHASE).
3. CHECK CAMSHAFT (INTAKE)
Check the following.
G Accumulation of debris to the signal plate of camshaft rear end
G Chipping signal plate of camshaft rear end
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Remove debris and clean the signal plate of camshaft
rear end or replace camshaft.
4. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
For wiring diagram refer to EC-350, "Wiring Diagram" for CKP sensor (POS) and EC-356, "Wiring Diagram"
for CMP sensor (PHASE).
>> INSPECTION END
PBIB0565E
EC-156
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0031, P0032 HO2S1 HEATER (QG16DE)
DTC P0031, P0032 HO2S1 HEATER (QG16DE) PFP:22690
Description EBS00FO4
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM performs ON/OFF duty control of the heated oxygen sensor 1 heater corresponding to the engine
speed and engine coolant temperature. The duty percent varies with engine coolant temperature when engine
is started.
OPERATION
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FO5
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FO6
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FO7
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is between 10.5V and 16V at
idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Engine speed
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater control
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Engine speed rpm Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
Above 3,600 OFF
Below 3,600 ON
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 HTR (B1)
G Engine: After warming up
G Engine speed: Below 3,600 rpm
ON
G Engine speed: Above 3,600 rpm OFF
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0031
0031
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater control circuit low
The current amperage in the heated oxygen sensor
1 heater circuit is out of the normal range.
(An excessively low voltage signal is sent to ECM
through the heated oxygen sensor 1 heater.)
G Harness or connectors
(The heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heater oxygen sensor 1 heater
P0032
0032
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater control circuit high
The current amperage in the heated oxygen sensor
1 heater circuit is out of the normal range.
(An excessively high voltage signal is sent to ECM
through the heated oxygen sensor 1 heater.)
G Harness or connectors
(The heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
circuit is shorted.)
G Heater oxygen sensor 1 heater
DTC P0031, P0032 HO2S1 HEATER (QG16DE)
EC-157
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select DATA MONITOR mode
with CONSULT-II.
4. Start engine and run it for at least 6 seconds at idle speed.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-159, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Start engine and run it for at least 6 seconds at idle speed.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
5. Start engine and run it for at least 6 seconds at idle speed.
6. Select MODE 3 with GST.
7. If DTC is detected, go to EC-159, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
G When using GST, DTC Confirmation Procedure should be performed twice as much as when
using CONSULT-II because GST cannot display MODE 7 (1st trip DTC) concerning this diagnosis.
Therefore, using CONSULT-II is recommended.
SEF058Y
EC-158
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0031, P0032 HO2S1 HEATER (QG16DE)
Wiring Diagram EBS00FO8
MBWA0049E
DTC P0031, P0032 HO2S1 HEATER (QG16DE)
EC-159
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FO9
1. CHECK HO2S1 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between HO2S1 terminal 4 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINA
L NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
24 G
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition.
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm.
Approximately 7.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped.
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
PBIB0519E
MBIB0091E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0541E
EC-160
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0031, P0032 HO2S1 HEATER (QG16DE)
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Fuse block (J/B) connector E105
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between heated oxygen sensor 1 and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK HO2S1 OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 24 and HO2S1 terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 HEATER
Refer to EC-161, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0031, P0032 HO2S1 HEATER (QG16DE)
EC-161
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Component Inspection EBS00FOA
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 HEATER
1. Check resistance between HO2S1 terminals as follows.
2. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard sur-
face such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system
threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread Cleaner tool J-43897-
18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FOB
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-23, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER" .
Terminal No. Resistance
1 and 4 8 - 10 at 20C (68F)
2 and 1, 3, 4

(Continuity should not exist)
3 and 1, 2, 4
PBIB0542E
EC-162
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052 HO2S1 HEATER (QG18DE)
DTC P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052 HO2S1 HEATER (QG18DE) PFP:22690
Description EBS00FOC
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM performs ON/OFF duty control of the heated oxygen sensor 1 heater corresponding to the engine
speed and engine coolant temperature. The duty percent varies with engine coolant temperature when engine
is started.
OPERATION
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FOD
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FOE
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FOF
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is between 10.5V and 16V at
idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Engine speed
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater control
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Engine speed rpm Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
Above 3,200 (A/T models)
Above 3,600 (M/T models)
OFF
Below 3,200 (A/T models)
Below 3,600 (M/T models)
ON
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 HTR (B1)
HO2S1 HTR (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
G Engine speed: Below 3,200 rpm (A/T models)
Below 3,600 rpm (M/T models)
ON
G Engine speed: Above 3,200 rpm (A/T models)
Above 3,600 rpm (M/T models)
OFF
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0031
0031
(Bank 1)
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater control circuit low
The current amperage in the heated oxygen sensor
1 heater circuit is out of the normal range.
(An excessively low voltage signal is sent to ECM
through the heated oxygen sensor 1 heater.)
G Harness or connectors
(The heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heater oxygen sensor 1 heater
P0051
0051
(Bank 2)
P0032
0032
(Bank 1)
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater control circuit
high
The current amperage in the heated oxygen sensor
1 heater circuit is out of the normal range.
(An excessively high voltage signal is sent to ECM
through the heated oxygen sensor 1 heater.)
G Harness or connectors
(The heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
circuit is shorted.)
G Heater oxygen sensor 1 heater
P0052
0052
(Bank 2)
DTC P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052 HO2S1 HEATER (QG18DE)
EC-163
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select DATA MONITOR mode
with CONSULT-II.
4. Start engine and run it for at least 6 seconds at idle speed.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-167, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Start engine and run it for at least 6 seconds at idle speed.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
5. Start engine and run it for at least 6 seconds at idle speed.
6. Select MODE 3 with GST.
7. If DTC is detected, go to EC-167, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
G When using GST, DTC Confirmation Procedure should be performed twice as much as when
using CONSULT-II because GST cannot display MODE 7 (1st trip DTC) concerning this diagnosis.
Therefore, using CONSULT-II is recommended.
SEF058Y
EC-164
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052 HO2S1 HEATER (QG18DE)
Wiring Diagram EBS00FOG
BANK 1
MBWA0053E
DTC P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052 HO2S1 HEATER (QG18DE)
EC-165
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
24 G
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater (bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition.
G Engine speed is below 3,200 rpm (A/T models).
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm (M/T models).
Approximately 7.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped.
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,200 rpm (A/T models).
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm (M/T models).
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
PBIB0519E
EC-166
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052 HO2S1 HEATER (QG18DE)
BANK 2
MBWA0055E
DTC P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052 HO2S1 HEATER (QG18DE)
EC-167
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FOH
1. CHECK HO2S1 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between HO2S1 terminal 4 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
25 R/B
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater (bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition.
G Engine speed is below 3,200 rpm (A/T models).
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm (M/T models).
Approximately 7.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped.
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,200 rpm (A/T models).
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm (M/T models).
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
PBIB0519E
MBIB0092E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0541E
EC-168
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052 HO2S1 HEATER (QG18DE)
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Fuse block (J/B) connector E105
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between heated oxygen sensor 1 and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK HO2S1 OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal and HO2S1 terminal as follows.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 HEATER
Refer to EC-169, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 1.
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P0031, P0032 24 1 1
P0051, P0052 25 1 2
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0031, P0032, P0051, P0052 HO2S1 HEATER (QG18DE)
EC-169
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Component Inspection EBS00FOI
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 HEATER
1. Check resistance between HO2S1 terminals as follows.
2. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard sur-
face such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system
threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread Cleaner tool J-43897-
18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FOJ
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-23, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER" .
Terminal No. Resistance
1 and 4 8 - 10 at 20C (68F)
2 and 1, 3, 4

(Continuity should not exist)
3 and 1, 2, 4
PBIB0542E
EC-170
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0037, P0038 HO2S2 HEATER (QG16DE)
DTC P0037, P0038 HO2S2 HEATER (QG16DE) PFP:226A0
Description EBS00FOK
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM performs ON/OFF control of the heated oxygen sensor 2 heater corresponding to the engine speed.
OPERATION
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FOL
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FOM
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FON
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is between 10.5V and 16V at
idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine.
3. Drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater control
Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Engine speed rpm Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
Above 3,600 OFF
Below 3,600 ON
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S2 HTR (B1)
G Engine speed: Below 3,600 rpm [After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of
70 km/h (43 MPH) or more]
ON
G Engine speed: Above 3,600 rpm OFF
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0037
0037
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater control circuit low
The current amperage in the heated oxygen sensor
2 heater circuit is out of the normal range.
(An excessively low voltage signal is sent to ECM
through the heated oxygen sensor 2 heater.)
G Harness or connectors
(The heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heater oxygen sensor 2 heater
P0038
0038
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater control circuit high
The current amperage in the heated oxygen sensor
2 heater circuit is out of the normal range.
(An excessively high voltage signal is sent to ECM
through the heated oxygen sensor 2 heater.)
G Harness or connectors
(The heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
circuit is shorted.)
G Heater oxygen sensor 2 heater
DTC P0037, P0038 HO2S2 HEATER (QG16DE)
EC-171
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. Stop vehicle and let engine idle for at least 6 seconds.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-173, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITH GST
1. Start engine.
2. Drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
3. Stop vehicle and let engine idle for at least 6 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
5. Start engine.
6. Drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
7. Stop vehicle and let engine idle for at least 6 seconds.
8. Select MODE 3 with GST.
9. If DTC is detected, go to EC-173, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
G When using GST, DTC Confirmation Procedure should be performed twice as much as when
using CONSULT-II because GST cannot display MODE 7 (1st trip DTC) concerning this diagnosis.
Therefore, using CONSULT-II is recommended.
SEF058Y
EC-172
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0037, P0038 HO2S2 HEATER (QG16DE)
Wiring Diagram EBS00FOO
MBWA0051E
DTC P0037, P0038 HO2S2 HEATER (QG16DE)
EC-173
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FOP
1. CHECK HO2S2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between HO2S2 terminal 4 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Fuse block (J/B) connector E105
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between heated oxygen sensor 2 and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
2 R/B
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm.
G After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of 70 km/h
(43 MPH) or more.
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
MBIB0093E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0541E
EC-174
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0037, P0038 HO2S2 HEATER (QG16DE)
3. CHECK HO2S2 OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 2 and HO2S2 terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2 HEATER
Refer to EC-174, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FOQ
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2 HEATER
1. Check resistance between HO2S2 terminals as follows.
2. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard sur-
face such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system
threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread Cleaner tool J-43897-
18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FOR
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EM-23, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER" .
Continuity should exist.
Terminal No. Resistance
1 and 4 2.3 - 4.3 at 25C (77F)
2 and 1, 3, 4

(Continuity should not exist)
3 and 1, 2, 4
PBIB0542E
DTC P0037, P0038, P0057, P0058 HO2S2 HEATER (QG18DE)
EC-175
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0037, P0038, P0057, P0058 HO2S2 HEATER (QG18DE) PFP:226A0
Description EBS00FOS
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM performs ON/OFF control of the heated oxygen sensor 2 heater corresponding to the engine speed.
OPERATION
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FOT
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FOU
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FOV
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is between 10.5V and 16V at
idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine.
3. Drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater control
Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Engine speed rpm Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
Above 3,600 OFF
Below 3,600 ON
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S2 HTR (B1)
HO2S2 HTR (B2)
G Engine speed: Below 3,600 rpm [After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of
70 km/h (43 MPH) or more]
ON
G Engine speed: Above 3,600 rpm OFF
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0037
0037
(Bank 1)
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater control circuit low
The current amperage in the heated oxygen sensor
2 heater circuit is out of the normal range.
(An excessively low voltage signal is sent to ECM
through the heated oxygen sensor 2 heater.)
G Harness or connectors
(The heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heater oxygen sensor 2 heater
P0057
0057
(Bank 2)
P0038
0038
(Bank 1)
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater control circuit high
The current amperage in the heated oxygen sensor
2 heater circuit is out of the normal range.
(An excessively high voltage signal is sent to ECM
through the heated oxygen sensor 2 heater.)
G Harness or connectors
(The heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
circuit is shorted.)
G Heater oxygen sensor 2 heater
P0058
0058
(Bank 2)
EC-176
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0037, P0038, P0057, P0058 HO2S2 HEATER (QG18DE)
4. Stop vehicle and let engine idle for at least 6 seconds.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-180, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITH GST
1. Start engine.
2. Drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
3. Stop vehicle and let engine idle for at least 6 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
5. Start engine.
6. Drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
7. Stop vehicle and let engine idle for at least 6 seconds.
8. Select MODE 3 with GST.
9. If DTC is detected, go to EC-180, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
G When using GST, DTC Confirmation Procedure should be performed twice as much as when
using CONSULT-II because GST cannot display MODE 7 (1st trip DTC) concerning this diagnosis.
Therefore, using CONSULT-II is recommended.
SEF058Y
DTC P0037, P0038, P0057, P0058 HO2S2 HEATER (QG18DE)
EC-177
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00FOW
BANK 1
MBWA0057E
EC-178
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0037, P0038, P0057, P0058 HO2S2 HEATER (QG18DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
2 L
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater (bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm.
G After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of 70 km/h
(43 MPH) or more.
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
DTC P0037, P0038, P0057, P0058 HO2S2 HEATER (QG18DE)
EC-179
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
BANK 2
MBWA0059E
EC-180
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0037, P0038, P0057, P0058 HO2S2 HEATER (QG18DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FOX
1. CHECK HO2S2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between HO2S2 terminal 4 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Fuse block (J/B) connector E105
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between heated oxygen sensor 2 and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
7 W/R
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater (bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm.
G After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of 70 km/h
(43 MPH) or more.
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
MBIB0094E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0541E
DTC P0037, P0038, P0057, P0058 HO2S2 HEATER (QG18DE)
EC-181
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK HO2S2 OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal and HO2S2 terminal as follows.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2 HEATER
Refer to EC-181, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 2.
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FOY
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2 HEATER
1. Check resistance between HO2S2 terminals as follows.
2. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard sur-
face such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system
threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread Cleaner tool J-43897-
18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P0037, P0038 2 1 1
P0057, P0058 7 1 2
Continuity should exist.
Terminal No. Resistance
1 and 4 2.3 - 4.3 at 25C (77F)
2 and 1, 3, 4

(Continuity should not exist)
3 and 1, 2, 4
PBIB0542E
EC-182
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0037, P0038, P0057, P0058 HO2S2 HEATER (QG18DE)
Removal and Installation EBS00FOZ
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EM-23, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER" .
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
EC-183
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR PFP:22680
Component Description EBS00EMO
The mass air flow sensor is placed in the stream of intake air. It mea-
sures the intake flow rate by measuring a part of the entire intake
flow. It consists of a hot film that is supplied with electric current from
the ECM. The temperature of the hot film is controlled by the ECM a
certain amount. The heat generated by the hot film is reduced as the
intake air flows around it. The more air, the greater the heat loss.
Therefore, the ECM must supply more electric current to maintain
the temperature of the hot film as air flow increases. The ECM
detects the air flow by means of this current change.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EMP
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EMQ
These self-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EMR
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
SEC266C
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
MAS A/F SE-B1
G Engine: After warming up
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Shift lever: N
G No-load
Idle Approx. 1.0 - 1.7V
2,500 rpm Approx. 1.5 - 2.1V
CAL/LD VALUE
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 10% - 35%
2,500 rpm 10% - 35%
MASS AIRFLOW
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 1.0 - 4.0 gm/s
2,500 rpm 5.0 - 10.0 gm/s
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0102
0102
Mass air flow sensor circuit
low input
An excessively low voltage from the sensor
is sent to ECM when engine is running.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Intake air leaks
G Mass air flow sensor
P0103
0103
Mass air flow sensor circuit
high input
An excessively high voltage from the sensor
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Mass air flow sensor
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
Mass air flow sensor circuit Engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm due to the fuel cut.
EC-184
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
PROCEDURE FOR DTC P0102
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and wait 5 seconds at most.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-186, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
With GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
PROCEDURE FOR DTC P0103
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Wait at least 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-186, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If DTC is not detected, go to next step.
5. Start engine and wait at least 5 seconds.
6. If DTC is detected, go to EC-186, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
With GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
SEF058Y
SEF058Y
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
EC-185
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00EMS
MBWA0045E
EC-186
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EMT
1. INSPECTION START
Which malfunction (P0102 or P0103) is duplicated?
P0102 or P0103
P0102 >> GO TO 2.
P0103 >> GO TO 3.
2. CHECK INTAKE SYSTEM
Check the following for connection.
G Air duct
G Vacuum hoses
G Intake air passage between air duct to intake manifold
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Reconnect the parts.
3. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 4.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
45 R
Sensor power supply
(Mass air flow sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
50 Y Mass air flow sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.0 - 1.7V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,500 rpm.
1.5 - 2.1V
67 B
Sensor ground
(Mass air flow sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0095E
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
EC-187
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. CHECK MAF SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect MAF sensor harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between MAF sensor terminals 2, 4 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between mass air flow sensor and ECM
G Harness for open or short between mass air flow sensor and ECM relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK MAF SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between MAF sensor terminal 3 and ECM terminal 67.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK MAF SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between MAF sensor terminal 1 and ECM terminal 50.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0096E
Terminal Voltage
2 Approximately 5V
4 Battery voltage
PBIB0076E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
EC-188
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
8. CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EC-188, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace mass air flow sensor.
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EMU
MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
1. Reconnect harness connectors disconnected.
2. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminal 50 (Mass air flow sensor
signal) and ground.
*: Check for liner voltage rise in response to engine being increased to about
4,000 rpm.
4. If the voltage is out of specification, proceed the following.
a. Turn ignition switch OFF.
b. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector and reconnect it again.
c. Perform steps 2 and 3 again.
5. If NG, remove mass air flow sensor from air duct. Check hot film for damage or dust.
6. If NG, clean or replace mass air flow sensor.
Removal and Installation EBS00EMV
MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EM-17, "AIR CLEANER AND AIR DUCT" .
Condition Voltage V
Ignition switch ON (Engine stopped.) Approx. 1.0
Idle (Engine is warmed-up to normal operating
temperature.)
1.0 - 1.7
2,500 rpm (Engine is warmed-up to normal
operating temperature.)
1.5 - 2.1
Idle to about 4,000 rpm* 1.0 - 1.7 to Approx. 4.0
MBIB0017E
DTC P0112, P0113 IAT SENSOR
EC-189
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0112, P0113 IAT SENSOR PFP:22630
Component Description EBS00EMW
The intake air temperature sensor is built into mass air flow sensor.
The sensor detects intake air temperature and transmits a signal to
the ECM.
The temperature sensing unit uses a thermistor which is sensitive to
the change in temperature. Electrical resistance of the thermistor
decreases in response to the temperature rise.
<Reference data>
*: These data are reference values and are measured between ECM terminal 34
(Intake air temperature sensor) and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output
voltage. Doing so may result in damage to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM termi-
nals, such as the ground.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EMX
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EMY
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Wait at least 5 seconds.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-192, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
SEC266C
Intake air
temperature C (F)
Voltage* V Resistance k
10 (14) 4.43 7.9 - 9.3
25 (77) 3.32 1.9 - 2.1
80 (176) 1.23 0.31 - 0.37
SEF012P
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0112
0112
Intake air temperature
sensor circuit low input
An excessively low voltage from the sensor is
sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Intake air temperature sensor
P0113
0113
Intake air temperature
sensor circuit high input
An excessively high voltage from the sensor is
sent to ECM.
SEF058Y
EC-190
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0112, P0113 IAT SENSOR
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
DTC P0112, P0113 IAT SENSOR
EC-191
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00EMZ
MBWA0046E
EC-192
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0112, P0113 IAT SENSOR
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EN0
1. CHECK INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect mass air flow sensor (intake air temperature sensor
is built-into) harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between MAF sensor terminal 5 and ground.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
2. CHECK INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between MAF sensor terminal 3 and ECM terminal 67.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Refer to EC-193, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Replace mass air flow sensor (with intake air temperature sensor).
4. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
MBIB0096E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0066E
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0112, P0113 IAT SENSOR
EC-193
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Component Inspection EBS00EN1
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Check resistance between mass air flow sensor terminals 3 and
5 under the following conditions.
2. If NG, replace mass air flow sensor (with intake air temperature
sensor).
Removal and Installation EBS00EN2
MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EM-17, "AIR CLEANER AND AIR DUCT" .
Intake air temperature C (F) Resistance k
25 (77) 1.9 - 2.1
SEC266C
SEF012P
EC-194
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR PFP:22630
Component Description EBS00EN3
The engine coolant temperature sensor is used to detect the engine
coolant temperature. The sensor modifies a voltage signal from the
ECM. The modified signal returns to the ECM as the engine coolant
temperature input. The sensor uses a thermistor which is sensitive to
the change in temperature. The electrical resistance of the ther-
mistor decreases as temperature increases.
<Reference data>
*: These data are reference values and are measured between ECM terminal 72
(Engine coolant temperature sensor) and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EN4
These self-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When this malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
SEF594K
Engine coolant
temperature C (F)
Voltage* V Resistance k
10 (14) 4.4 7.0 - 11.4
20 (68) 3.5 2.1 - 2.9
50 (122) 2.2 0.68 - 1.00
90 (194) 0.9 0.236 - 0.260
SEF012P
DTC No. Trouble Diagnosis Name DTC Detecting Condition Possible Cause
P0117
0117
Engine coolant temperature
sensor circuit low input
An excessively low voltage from the sensor is
sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Engine coolant temperature sensor
P0118
0118
Engine coolant temperature
sensor circuit high input
An excessively high voltage from the sensor is
sent to ECM.
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
Engine coolant temper-
ature sensor circuit
Engine coolant temperature will be determined by ECM based on the time after turning ignition switch ON
or START. CONSULT-II displays the engine coolant temperature decided by ECM.
Condition
Engine coolant temperature decided
(CONSULT-II display)
Just as ignition switch is turned ON or Start 40C (104F)
More than approx. 4 minutes after ignition ON or
Start
80C (176F)
Except as shown above
40 - 80C (104 - 176F)
(Depends on the time)
When the fail-safe system for engine coolant temperature sensor is activated, the cooling fan operates while
engine is running.
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR
EC-195
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EN5
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Wait at least 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-197, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
SEF058Y
EC-196
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00EN6
MBWA0047E
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR
EC-197
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EN7
1. CHECK ECT SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor harness
connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between ECT sensor terminal 1 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
2. CHECK ECT SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between ECT sensor terminal 2 and engine ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between engine coolant temperature sensor and ECM
G Harness for open or short between engine coolant temperature sensor and TCM
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Refer to EC-198, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace engine coolant temperature sensor.
MBIB0097E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0080E
Continuity should exist.
EC-198
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EN8
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Check resistance between engine coolant temperature sensor
terminals 1 and 2 as shown in the figure.
<Reference data>
*: These data are reference values and are measured between ECM terminal
72 (Engine coolant temperature sensor) and ground.
2. If NG, replace engine coolant temperature sensor.
Removal and Installation EBS00EN9
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Refer to CO-20, "THERMOSTAT AND THERMOSTAT HOUSING" .
PBIB0081E
Engine coolant
temperature C (F)
Voltage* V Resistance k
10 (14) 4.4 7.0 - 11.4
20 (68) 3.5 2.1 - 2.9
50 (122) 2.2 0.68 - 1.00
90 (194) 0.9 0.236 - 0.260
SEF012P
DTC P0132 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-199
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0132 HO2S1 (QG16DE) PFP:22690
Component Description EBS00FP0
The heated oxygen sensor 1 is placed into the exhaust manifold. It
detects the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas compared to the
outside air. The heated oxygen sensor 1 has a closed-end tube
made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from
approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner conditions. The
heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM adjusts
the injection pulse duration to achieve the ideal air-fuel ratio. The
ideal air-fuel ratio occurs near the radical change from 1V to 0V.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FP1
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FP2
To judge the malfunction, the diagnosis checks that the heated oxy-
gen sensor 1 output is not inordinately high.
SEF463R
SEF288D
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 (B1) G Engine: After warming up Maintaining engine speed at 2,000 rpm 0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up Maintaining engine speed at 2,000 rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times during
10 seconds.
SEF301UA
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0132
0132
Heated oxygen sensor 1
circuit high voltage
An excessively high voltage from the sensor
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
EC-200
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0132 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FP3
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
5. Restart engine and let it idle for 2 minutes.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-202, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Restart engine and let it idle for 2 minutes.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
5. Restart engine and let it idle for 2 minutes.
6. Select MODE 3 with GST.
7. If DTC is detected, go to EC-202, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
G When using GST, DTC Confirmation Procedure should be performed twice as much as when
using CONSULT-II because GST cannot display MODE 7 (1st trip DTC) concerning this diagnosis.
Therefore, using CONSULT-II is recommended.
SEF174Y
DTC P0132 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-201
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00FP4
MBWA0048E
EC-202
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0132 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FP5
1. RETIGHTEN HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten heated oxygen sensor 1.
>> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK HO2S1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S1
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
35 W Heated oxygen sensor 1
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
Tightening torque: 40 - 60 Nm (4.1 - 6.2 kg-m, 30 - 44 ft-lb)
MBIB0098E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0091E
DTC P0132 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-203
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK HO2S1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 and HO2S1 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 or HO2S1 terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK HO2S1 CONNECTOR FOR WATER
Check heated oxygen sensor 1 connectors for water.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-203, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FP6
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG and adjust TRIGGER POINT to 100% in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-
II.
3. Select HO2S1 (B1) and HO2S1 MNTR (B1).
4. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load during the follow-
ing steps.
5. Touch RECORD on CONSULT-II screen.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
Water should not exist.
SEF646Y
EC-204
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0132 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
6. Check the following.
G HO2S1 MNTR (B1) in DATA MONITOR mode changes
from RICH to LEAN to RICH 5 times in 10 seconds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes below 0.3V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
G The voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new
one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FP7
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-23, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER" .
SEF217YA
SEF648Y
MBIB0018E
DTC P0132, P0152 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-205
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0132, P0152 HO2S1 (QG18DE) PFP:22690
Component Description EBS00FP8
The heated oxygen sensor 1 is placed into the exhaust manifold. It
detects the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas compared to the
outside air. The heated oxygen sensor 1 has a closed-end tube
made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from
approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner conditions. The
heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM adjusts
the injection pulse duration to achieve the ideal air-fuel ratio. The
ideal air-fuel ratio occurs near the radical change from 1V to 0V.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FP9
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FPA
To judge the malfunction, the diagnosis checks that the heated oxy-
gen sensor 1 output is not inordinately high.
SEF463R
SEF288D
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 (B1)
HO2S1 (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1)
HO2S1 MNTR (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times dur-
ing 10 seconds.
SEF301UA
EC-206
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0132, P0152 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FPB
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
5. Restart engine and let it idle for 2 minutes.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-210, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Restart engine and let it idle for 2 minutes.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
5. Restart engine and let it idle for 2 minutes.
6. Select MODE 3 with GST.
7. If DTC is detected, go to EC-210, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
G When using GST, DTC Confirmation Procedure should be performed twice as much as when
using CONSULT-II because GST cannot display MODE 7 (1st trip DTC) concerning this diagnosis.
Therefore, using CONSULT-II is recommended.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0132
0132
(Bank 1)
Heated oxygen sensor 1
circuit high voltage
An excessively high voltage from the sensor
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted).
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
P0152
0152
(Bank 2)
SEF174Y
DTC P0132, P0152 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-207
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00FPC
BANK 1
MBWA0052E
EC-208
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0132, P0152 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
35 W
Heated oxygen sensor 1
(bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
DTC P0132, P0152 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-209
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
BANK 2
MBWA0054E
EC-210
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0132, P0152 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FPD
1. RETIGHTEN HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten corresponding heated oxygen sensor 1.
>> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK HO2S1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S1
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
36 W
Heated oxygen sensor 1
(bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
Tightening torque: 40 - 60 Nm (4.1 - 6.2 kg-m, 30 - 44 ft-lb)
MBIB0099E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0092E
DTC P0132, P0152 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-211
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK HO2S1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal and HO2S1 terminal as follows.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between the following terminals and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK HO2S1 CONNECTOR FOR WATER
Check heated oxygen sensor 1 connectors for water.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-211, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 1.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FPE
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG and adjust TRIGGER POINT to 100% in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-
II.
3. Select HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) and HO2S1 MNTR (B1)/(B2).
4. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load during the following steps.
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P0132 35 2 1
P0152 36 2 2
Continuity should exist.
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P0132 35 2 1
P0152 36 2 2
Continuity should not exist.
Water should not exist.
EC-212
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0132, P0152 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
5. Touch RECORD on CONSULT-II screen.
6. Check the following.
G HO2S1 MNTR (B1)/(B2) in DATA MONITOR mode
changes from RICH to LEAN to RICH 5 times in 10 sec-
onds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage goes below 0.3V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] or 36 [HO2S1 (B2) signal] and
engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
G The voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
SEF646Y
SEF647Y
SEF648Y
MBIB0019E
DTC P0132, P0152 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-213
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FPF
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-23, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER" .
EC-214
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0133 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
DTC P0133 HO2S1 (QG16DE) PFP:22690
Component Description EBS00FPG
The heated oxygen sensor 1 is placed into the exhaust manifold. It
detects the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas compared to the
outside air. The heated oxygen sensor 1 has a closed-end tube
made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from
approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner conditions. The
heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM adjusts
the injection pulse duration to achieve the ideal air-fuel ratio. The
ideal air-fuel ratio occurs near the radical change from 1V to 0V.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FPH
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FPI
To judge the malfunction of heated oxygen sensor 1, this diagnosis
measures response time of heated oxygen sensor 1 signal. The time
is compensated by engine operating (speed and load), fuel feedback
control constant, and heated oxygen sensor 1 temperature index.
Judgment is based on whether the compensated time (heated oxy-
gen sensor 1 cycling time index) is inordinately long or not.
SEF463R
SEF288D
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times dur-
ing 10 seconds.
SEF010V
DTC P0133 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-215
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FPJ
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
G Always perform at a temperature above 10C (14F).
G Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Stop engine and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select HO2S1 (B1) P0133 of HO2S1 in DTC WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch START.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 3 minutes.
NOTE:
Never raise engine speed above 3,600 rpm after this step. If
the engine speed limit is exceeded, return to step 5.
6. When the following conditions are met, TESTING will be dis-
played on the CONSULT-II screen. Maintain the conditions con-
tinuously until TESTING changes to COMPLETED. (It will
take approximately 20 to 50 seconds.)
If TESTING is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from
step 2.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0133
0133
Heated oxygen sensor 1
circuit slow response
The response of the voltage signal from the
sensor takes more than the specified time.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
G Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
G Fuel pressure
G Injectors
G Intake air leaks
G Exhaust gas leaks
G PCV valve
G Mass air flow sensor
SEF338Z
ENG SPEED More than 2,100 rpm
Vehicle speed More than 80 km/h (50 MPH)
B/FUEL SCHDL 3.2 - 6.7 msec
Selector lever Suitable position
SEF339Z
EC-216
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0133 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
7. Make sure that OK is displayed after touching SELF-DIAG
RESULTS. If NG is displayed, refer to EC-218, "Diagnostic
Procedure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00FPK
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V more
than 5 times within 10 seconds.
4. If NG, go to EC-218, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF658Y
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
0 - 0.3V
MBIB0018E
DTC P0133 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-217
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00FPL
MBWA0048E
EC-218
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0133 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FPM
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
2. RETIGHTEN HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Loosen and retighten heated oxygen sensor 1.
>> GO TO 3.
3. CHECK FOR EXHAUST AIR LEAK
1. Start engine and run it at idle.
2. Listen for an exhaust air leak before three way catalyst (Mani-
fold).
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair or replace.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
35 W Heated oxygen sensor 1
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0095E
Tightening torque: 40 - 60 Nm (4.1 - 6.2 kg-m, 30 - 44 ft-lb)
MBIB0098E
SEF099P
DTC P0133 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-219
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. CHECK FOR INTAKE AIR LEAK
Listen for an intake air leak after the mass air flow sensor.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair or replace.
5. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 or P0172 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure that DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-73, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure that DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 or P0172 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0171 or DTC P0172 (Refer to EC-285 or EC-299 ).
No >> GO TO 6.
SEF215Z
MBIB0096E
EC-220
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0133 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
6. CHECK HO2S1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S1
terminal 3. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK HO2S1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 and HO2S1 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 or HO2S1 terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 HEATER
Refer to EC-161, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 1.
9. CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EC-188, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> Replace mass air flow sensor.
10. CHECK PCV VALVE
Refer to EC-557, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> Replace PCV valve.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0091E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
DTC P0133 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-221
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
11. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-221, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
12. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FPN
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG and adjust TRIGGER POINT to 100% in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-
II.
3. Select HO2S1 (B1) and HO2S1 MNTR (B1).
4. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load during the follow-
ing steps.
5. Touch RECORD on CONSULT-II screen.
6. Check the following.
G HO2S1 MNTR (B1) in DATA MONITOR mode changes
from RICH to LEAN to RICH 5 times in 10 seconds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes below 0.3V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
SEF646Y
SEF217YA
SEF648Y
EC-222
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0133 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
G The voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new
one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FPO
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-23, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER" .
MBIB0018E
DTC P0133, P0153, HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-223
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0133, P0153, HO2S1 (QG18DE) PFP:22690
Component Description EBS00FPP
The heated oxygen sensor 1 is placed into the exhaust manifold. It
detects the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas compared to the
outside air. The heated oxygen sensor 1 has a closed-end tube
made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from
approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner conditions. The
heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM adjusts
the injection pulse duration to achieve the ideal air-fuel ratio. The
ideal air-fuel ratio occurs near the radical change from 1V to 0V.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FPQ
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FPR
To judge the malfunction of heated oxygen sensor 1, this diagnosis
measures response time of heated oxygen sensor 1 signal. The time
is compensated by engine operating (speed and load), fuel feedback
control constant, and heated oxygen sensor 1 temperature index.
Judgment is based on whether the compensated time (heated oxy-
gen sensor 1 cycling time index) is inordinately long or not.
SEF463R
SEF288D
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 (B1)
HO2S1 (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1)
HO2S1 MNTR (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times dur-
ing 10 seconds.
SEF010V
EC-224
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0133, P0153, HO2S1 (QG18DE)
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FPS
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
G Always perform at a temperature above 10C (14F).
G Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Stop engine and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select HO2S1 (B1) P0133 or HO2S1 (B2) P0153 of HO2S1 in DTC
WORK SUPPORT mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch START.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 3 minutes.
NOTE:
Never raise engine speed above 3,600 rpm (M/T models) or
3,200 rpm (A/T models) after this step. If the engine speed
limit is exceeded, return to step 5.
6. When the following conditions are met, TESTING will be dis-
played on the CONSULT-II screen. Maintain the conditions con-
tinuously until TESTING changes to COMPLETED. (It will
take approximately 20 to 50 seconds.)
If TESTING is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from step 2.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0133
0133
(Bank 1)
Heated oxygen sensor 1
circuit slow response
The response of the voltage signal from the
sensor takes more than the specified time.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
G Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
G Fuel pressure
G Injectors
G Intake air leaks
G Exhaust gas leaks
G PCV valve
G Mass air flow sensor
P0153
0153
(Bank 2)
SEF338Z
ENG SPEED More than 1,900 rpm (A/T models)
More than 2,100 rpm (M/T models)
Vehicle speed More than 80 km/h (50 MPH)
B/FUEL SCHDL 3.7 - 7.8 msec (A/T models)
3.2 - 6.7 msec (M/T models)
Selector lever Suitable position
SEF339Z
DTC P0133, P0153, HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-225
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
7. Make sure that OK is displayed after touching SELF-DIAG
RESULTS. If NG is displayed, refer to EC-229, "Diagnostic
Procedure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00FPT
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1(B1) signal] or 36 [HO2S1(B2) signal] and engine
ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V more
than 5 times within 10 seconds.
4. If NG, go to EC-229, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF658Y
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
0 - 0.3V
MBIB0019E
EC-226
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0133, P0153, HO2S1 (QG18DE)
Wiring Diagram EBS00FPU
BANK 1
MBWA0052E
DTC P0133, P0153, HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-227
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
35 W
Heated oxygen sensor 1
(bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
EC-228
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0133, P0153, HO2S1 (QG18DE)
BANK 2
MBWA0054E
DTC P0133, P0153, HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-229
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FPV
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
2. RETIGHTEN HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Loosen and retighten heated oxygen sensor 1.
>> GO TO 3.
3. CHECK FOR EXHAUST AIR LEAK
1. Start engine and run it at idle.
2. Listen for an exhaust air leak before three way catalyst (Mani-
fold).
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair or replace.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
36 W
Heated oxygen sensor 1
(bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0095E
Tightening torque: 40 - 60 Nm (4.1 - 6.2 kg-m, 30 - 44 ft-lb)
MBIB0099E
SEF099P
EC-230
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0133, P0153, HO2S1 (QG18DE)
4. CHECK FOR INTAKE AIR LEAK
Listen for an intake air leak after the mass air flow sensor.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair or replace.
5. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171, P0172, P0174 or P0175 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure that DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-73, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure that DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171, P0172, P0174 or P0175 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0171, P0174 or DTC P0172, P0175 (Refer to EC-291 or EC-
305 ).
No >> GO TO 6.
SEF215Z
MBIB0096E
DTC P0133, P0153, HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-231
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK HO2S1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S1
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK HO2S1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal and HO2S1 terminal as follows.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between the following terminals and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 HEATER
Refer to EC-169, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 1.
9. CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EC-188, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> Replace mass air flow sensor.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0092E
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P0133 35 2 1
P0153 36 2 2
Continuity should exist.
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P0133 35 2 1
P0153 36 2 2
Continuity should not exist.
EC-232
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0133, P0153, HO2S1 (QG18DE)
10. CHECK PCV VALVE
Refer to EC-557, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> Replace PCV valve.
11. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-232, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 1.
12. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FPW
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG and adjust TRIGGER POINT to 100% in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-
II.
3. Select HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) and HO2S1 MNTR (B1)/(B2).
4. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load during the following steps.
5. Touch RECORD on CONSULT-II screen.
6. Check the following.
G HO2S1 MNTR (B1)/(B2) in DATA MONITOR mode
changes from RICH to LEAN to RICH 5 times in 10 sec-
onds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage goes below 0.3V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
SEF646Y
SEF647Y
DTC P0133, P0153, HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-233
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] or 36 [HO2S1 (B2) signal] and
engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
G The voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new
one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FPX
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-23, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER" .
SEF648Y
MBIB0019E
EC-234
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0134 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
DTC P0134 HO2S1 (QG16DE) PFP:22690
Component Description EBS00FPY
The heated oxygen sensor 1 is placed into the exhaust manifold. It
detects the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas compared to the
outside air. The heated oxygen sensor 1 has a closed-end tube
made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from
approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner conditions. The
heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM adjusts
the injection pulse duration to achieve the ideal air-fuel ratio. The
ideal air-fuel ratio occurs near the radical change from 1V to 0V.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FPZ
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FQ0
Under the condition in which the heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is
not input, the ECM circuits will read a continuous approximately
0.3V. Therefore, for this diagnosis, the time that output voltage is
within 200 to 400 mV range is monitored, and the diagnosis checks
that this time is not inordinately long.
SEF463R
SEF288D
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times dur-
ing 10 seconds.
SEF237U
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0134
0134
Heated oxygen sensor 1
circuit no activity detected
The voltage from the sensor is constantly
approx. 0.3V.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
DTC P0134 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-235
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FQ1
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select HO2S1 (B1) P0134 of HO2S1 in DTC WORK SUPPORT mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Touch START.
4. Let it idle for at least 3 minutes.
NOTE:
Never raise engine speed above 3,600 rpm after this step. If
the engine speed limit is exceeded, return to step 4.
5. When the following conditions are met, TESTING will be dis-
played on the CONSULT-II screen. Maintain the conditions con-
tinuously until TESTING changes to COMPLETED. (It will
take approximately 10 to 60 seconds.)
If TESTING is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from
step 2.
6. Make sure that OK is displayed after touching SELF-DIAG
RESULTS. If NG is displayed, refer to EC-238, "Diagnostic
Procedure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00FQ2
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
PBIB0544E
ENG SPEED 1,700 - 3,800 rpm
Vehicle speed More than 64 km/h (40 MPH)
B/FUEL SCHDL 2.9 - 7.3 msec
Selector lever Suitable position
PBIB0545E
SEC750C
EC-236
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0134 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
The voltage does not remain in the range of 0.2 - 0.4V.
4. If NG, go to EC-238, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
MBIB0018E
DTC P0134 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-237
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00FQ3
MBWA0048E
EC-238
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0134 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FQ4
1. INSPECTION START
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK HO2S1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S1
terminal 3. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
35 W Heated oxygen sensor 1
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0095E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0091E
DTC P0134 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-239
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK HO2S1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 and HO2S1 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 or HO2S1 terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-239, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FQ5
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG and adjust TRIGGER POINT to 100% in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-
II.
3. Select HO2S1 (B1) and HO2S1 MNTR (B1).
4. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load during the follow-
ing steps.
5. Touch RECORD on CONSULT-II screen.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
SEF646Y
EC-240
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0134 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
6. Check the following.
G HO2S1 MNTR (B1) in DATA MONITOR mode changes
from RICH to LEAN to RICH 5 times in 10 seconds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes below 0.3V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
G The voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new
one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FQ6
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-23, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER" .
SEF217YA
SEF648Y
MBIB0018E
DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-241
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1 (QG18DE) PFP:22690
Component Description EBS00FQ7
The heated oxygen sensor 1 is placed into the exhaust manifold. It
detects the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas compared to the
outside air. The heated oxygen sensor 1 has a closed-end tube
made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from
approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner conditions. The
heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM adjusts
the injection pulse duration to achieve the ideal air-fuel ratio. The
ideal air-fuel ratio occurs near the radical change from 1V to 0V.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FQ8
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FQ9
Under the condition in which the heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is
not input, the ECM circuits will read a continuous approximately
0.3V. Therefore, for this diagnosis, the time that output voltage is
within 200 to 400 mV range is monitored, and the diagnosis checks
that this time is not inordinately long.
SEF463R
SEF288D
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 (B1)
HO2S1 (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1)
HO2S1 MNTR (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times dur-
ing 10 seconds.
SEF237U
EC-242
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FQA
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select HO2S1 (B1) P0134 or HO2S1 (B2) P0154 of HO2S1 in DTC WORK SUPPORT mode with
CONSULT-II.
3. Touch START.
4. Let it idle for at least 3 minutes.
NOTE:
Never raise engine speed above 3,600 rpm (M/T models) or
3,200 rpm (A/T models) after this step. If the engine speed
limit is exceeded, return to step 4.
5. When the following conditions are met, TESTING will be dis-
played on the CONSULT-II screen. Maintain the conditions con-
tinuously until TESTING changes to COMPLETED. (It will
take approximately 10 to 60 seconds.)
If TESTING is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from step 2.
6. Make sure that OK is displayed after touching SELF-DIAG
RESULTS. If NG is displayed, refer to EC-247, "Diagnostic
Procedure" .
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0134
0134
(Bank 1)
Heated oxygen sensor 1
circuit no activity detected
The voltage from the sensor is constantly
approx. 0.3V.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
P0154
0154
(Bank 2)
PBIB0544E
ENG SPEED 1,500 - 3,400 rpm (A/T models)
1,700 - 3,800 rpm (M/T models)
Vehicle speed More than 64 km/h (40 MPH)
B/FUEL SCHDL 3.3 - 8.7 msec (A/T models)
2.9 - 7.3 msec (M/T models)
Selector lever Suitable position
PBIB0545E
SEC750C
DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-243
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Overall Function Check EBS00FQB
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] or 36 [HO2S1 (B2) signal] and
engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
The voltage does not remain in the range of 0.2 - 0.4V.
4. If NG, go to EC-247, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
MBIB0019E
EC-244
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
Wiring Diagram EBS00FQC
BANK 1
MBWA0052E
DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-245
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
35 W
Heated oxygen sensor 1
(bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
EC-246
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
BANK 2
MBWA0054E
DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-247
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FQD
1. INSPECTION START
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK HO2S1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S1
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
36 W
Heated oxygen sensor 1
(bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0095E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0092E
EC-248
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
3. CHECK HO2S1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal and HO2S1 terminal as follows.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between the following terminals and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-248, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 1.
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FQE
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG and adjust TRIGGER POINT to 100% in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-
II.
3. Select HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) and HO2S1 MNTR (B1)/(B2).
4. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load during the following steps.
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P0134 35 2 1
P0154 36 2 2
Continuity should exist.
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P0134 35 2 1
P0154 36 2 2
Continuity should not exist.
DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-249
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. Touch RECORD on CONSULT-II screen.
6. Check the following.
G HO2S1 MNTR (B1)/(B2) in DATA MONITOR mode
changes from RICH to LEAN to RICH 5 times in 10 sec-
onds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage goes below 0.3V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] or 36 [HO2S1 (B2) signal] and
engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
G The voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
SEF646Y
SEF647Y
SEF648Y
MBIB0019E
EC-250
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FQF
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-23, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER" .
DTC P0138 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
EC-251
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0138 HO2S2 (QG16DE) PFP:226A0
Component Description EBS00FQG
The heated oxygen sensor 2, after three way catalyst, monitors the
oxygen level in the exhaust gas.
Even if switching characteristics of the heated oxygen sensor 1 are
shifted, the air fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal
from the heated oxygen sensor 2.
This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates volt-
age from approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner condi-
tions.
Under normal conditions the heated oxygen sensor 2 is not used for
engine control operation.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FQH
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FQJ
The heated oxygen sensor 2 has a much longer switching time
between rich and lean than the heated oxygen sensor 1. The oxygen
storage capacity before the three way catalyst causes the longer
switching time. To judge the malfunctions of heated oxygen sensor
2, ECM monitors whether the voltage is unusually high during the
various driving condition such as fuel-cut.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FQK
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
3. Stop vehicle with engine running.
SEF327R
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S2 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S2 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
LEAN RICH
SEF305UA
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0138
0138
Heated oxygen sensor 2
circuit high voltage
An excessively high voltage from the sensor
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 2
EC-252
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0138 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
4. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-254, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
Overall Function Check EBS00FQL
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 2 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 (HO2S2 signal) and engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be below 1.4V during this procedure.
5. If NG, go to EC-254, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF189Y
MBIB0020E
DTC P0138 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
EC-253
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00FQM
MBWA0050E
EC-254
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0138 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FQN
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
16 W Heated oxygen sensor 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0095E
DTC P0138 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
EC-255
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure that DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-73, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure that DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0172. Refer to EC-299 .
No >> GO TO 3.
3. CHECK HO2S2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S2
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
SEF215Z
MBIB0096E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0093E
EC-256
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0138 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
4. CHECK HO2S2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 16 and HO2S2 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 16 or HO2S2 terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EC-256, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FQO
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Select FUEL INJECTION in ACTIVE TEST mode, and select
HO2S2 (B1) as the monitor item with CONSULT-II.
4. Check HO2S2 (B1) at idle speed when adjusting FUEL INJECTION to 25%.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
SEF662Y
PBIB0551E
DTC P0138 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
EC-257
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
HO2S2 (B1) should be above 0.68V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is +25%.
HO2S2 (B1) should be below 0.50V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is 25%.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 (HO2S2 signal) and engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.68V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage is above 0.68V at step 4, step 5 is not neces-
sary.
5. Keep vehicle idling for 10 minutes, then check voltage. Or check
the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in 3rd gear
position.
The voltage should be below 0.50V at least once during this
procedure.
6. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FQP
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EX-3, "EXHAUST SYSTEM" .
MBIB0020E
EC-258
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0138, P0158 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
DTC P0138, P0158 HO2S2 (QG18DE) PFP:226A0
Component Description EBS00FQQ
The heated oxygen sensor 2, after three way catalyst, monitors the
oxygen level in the exhaust gas on each bank.
Even if switching characteristics of the heated oxygen sensor 1 are
shifted, the air fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal
from the heated oxygen sensor 2.
This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates volt-
age from approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner condi-
tions.
Under normal conditions the heated oxygen sensor 2 is not used for
engine control operation.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FQR
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FQT
The heated oxygen sensor 2 has a much longer switching time
between rich and lean than the heated oxygen sensor 1. The oxygen
storage capacity before the three way catalyst causes the longer
switching time. To judge the malfunctions of heated oxygen sensor
2, ECM monitors whether the voltage is unusually high during the
various driving condition such as fuel-cut.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FQU
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
3. Stop vehicle with engine running.
SEF327R
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S2 (B1)
HO2S2 (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S2 MNTR (B1)
HO2S2 MNTR (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
LEAN RICH
SEF305UA
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0138
0138
(Bank 1)
Heated oxygen sensor 2
circuit high voltage
An excessively high voltage from the sensor
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 2
P0158
0158
(Bank 2)
DTC P0138, P0158 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-259
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-263, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
Overall Function Check EBS00FQV
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 2 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 17 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be below 1.4V during this procedure.
5. If NG, go to EC-263, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF189Y
MBIB0021E
EC-260
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0138, P0158 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
Wiring Diagram EBS00FQW
BANK 1
MBWA0056E
DTC P0138, P0158 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-261
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
16 Y
Heated oxygen sensor 2
(bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
EC-262
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0138, P0158 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
BANK 2
MBWA0058E
DTC P0138, P0158 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-263
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FQX
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
17 L
Heated oxygen sensor 2
(bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0095E
EC-264
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0138, P0158 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
2. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 or P0175 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure that DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-73, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure that DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 or P0175 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0172, P0175. Refer to EC-305 .
No >> GO TO 3.
3. CHECK HO2S2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S2
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
SEF215Z
MBIB0096E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0094E
DTC P0138, P0158 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-265
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. CHECK HO2S2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal and HO2S2 terminal as follows.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between the following terminals and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EC-265, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FQY
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Select FUEL INJECTION in ACTIVE TEST mode, and select
HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) as the monitor item with CONSULT-II.
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P0138 16 2 1
P0158 17 2 2
Continuity should exist.
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P0138 16 2 1
P0158 17 2 2
Continuity should not exist.
SEF662Y
EC-266
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0138, P0158 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
4. Check HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) at idle speed when adjusting FUEL INJECTION to 25%.
HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) should be above 0.68V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is +25%.
HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) should be below 0.50V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is 25%.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 17 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.68V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage is above 0.68V at step 4, step 5 is not neces-
sary.
5. Keep vehicle idling for 10 minutes, then check voltage. Or check
the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D posi-
tion with OD OFF (A/T), 3rd gear position (M/T).
The voltage should be below 0.50V at least once during this
procedure.
6. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FQZ
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EX-3, "EXHAUST SYSTEM" .
PBIB0551E
MBIB0021E
DTC P0139 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
EC-267
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0139 HO2S2 (QG16DE) PFP:226A0
Component Description EBS00FR0
The heated oxygen sensor 2, after three way catalyst, monitors the
oxygen level in the exhaust gas.
Even if switching characteristics of the heated oxygen sensor 1 are
shifted, the air fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal
from the heated oxygen sensor 2.
This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates volt-
age from approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner condi-
tions.
Under normal conditions the heated oxygen sensor 2 is not used for
engine control operation.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FR1
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FR3
The heated oxygen sensor 2 has a much longer switching time
between rich and lean than the heated oxygen sensor 1. The oxygen
storage capacity before the three way catalyst causes the longer
switching time. To judge the malfunctions of heated oxygen sensor
2, ECM monitors whether the switching response of the sensor's
voltage is faster than specified during the various driving condition
such as fuel-cut.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FR4
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
G COMPLETED will appear on CONSULT-II screen when all tests COND1, COND2 and
COND3 are completed.
G If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and
wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Never stop engine during this procedure. If the engine is stopped, retry this procedure from step 2 in
Procedure for COND1.
SEF327R
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S2 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S2 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
LEAN RICH
SEF302U
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0139
0139
Heated oxygen sensor 2
circuit slow response
It takes more time for the sensor to respond
between rich and lean than the specified time.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 2
G Fuel pressure
G Injectors
G Intake air leaks
EC-268
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0139 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
WITH CONSULT-II
Procedure for COND1
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select HO2S2 (B1) P0139 of HO2S2 in DTC WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch START.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 30 seconds.
6. Rev engine up to 2,000 rpm 2 or 3 times quickly under no load.
If COMPLETED appears on CONSULT-II screen, go to step 2 in Procedure for COND3.
If COMPLETED does not appear on CONSULT-II screen, go to the following step.
7. Drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
8. When the following conditions are met, TESTING will be displayed at COND1 on the CONSULT-II
screen. Maintain the conditions continuously until TESTING changes to COMPLETED. (It will take
approximately 60 seconds.)
NOTE:
G If TESTING is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from step 2 in Procedure for COND1.
G If COMPLETED already appears at COND2 on CONSULT-II screen before Procedure for
COND2 is conducted, it is unnecessary to conduct step 1 in Procedure for COND2.
Procedure for COND2
1. While driving, release accelerator pedal completely from the
above condition [step 8] until INCOMPLETE at COND2 on
CONSULT-II screen has turned to COMPLETED. (It will take
approximately 4 seconds.)
NOTE:
If COMPLETED already appears at COND3 on CONSULT-II
screen before Procedure for COND3 is conducted, it is unnec-
essary to conduct step 1 in Procedure for COND3.
ENG SPEED More than 1,000 rpm
B/FUEL SCHDL More than 1.0 msec
COOLANT TEMP/S 70 - 105 C
Selector level Suitable position
PBIB0552E
PBIB0553E
DTC P0139 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
EC-269
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Procedure for COND3
1. Stop vehicle and let it idle until INCOMPLETE of COND3 on
CONSULT-II screen has turned to COMPLETED. (It will take a
maximum of approximately 6 minutes.)
2. Make sure that OK is displayed after touching SELF-DIAG
RESULTS.
If NG is displayed, refer to EC-271, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00FR5
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 2 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 (HO2S2 signal) and engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should change at more than 0.06V for 1 second
during this procedure.
If the voltage can be confirmed in step 4, step 5 is not nec-
essary.
5. Keep vehicle at idling for 10 minutes, then check the voltage. Or
check the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in 3rd
gear position.
The voltage should change at more than 0.06V for 1 second
during this procedure.
6. If NG, go to EC-271, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF668Y
MBIB0020E
EC-270
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0139 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
Wiring Diagram EBS00FR6
MBWA0050E
DTC P0139 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
EC-271
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FR7
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
16 W Heated oxygen sensor 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0095E
EC-272
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0139 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
2. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 or P0172 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure that DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-73, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure that DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 or P0172 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0171 or P0172. Refer to EC-285 or EC-299 .
No >> GO TO 3.
3. CHECK HO2S2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S2
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
SEF215Z
MBIB0096E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0093E
DTC P0139 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
EC-273
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. CHECK HO2S2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 16 and HO2S2 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 16 or HO2S2 terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EC-273, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FR8
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Select FUEL INJECTION in ACTIVE TEST mode, and select
HO2S2 (B1) as the monitor item with CONSULT-II.
4. Check HO2S2 (B1) at idle speed when adjusting FUEL INJECTION to 25%.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
SEF662Y
PBIB0551E
EC-274
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0139 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
HO2S2 (B1) should be above 0.68V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is +25%.
HO2S2 (B1) should be below 0.50V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is 25%.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 (HO2S2 signal) and engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.68V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage is above 0.68V at step 4, step 5 is not neces-
sary.
5. Keep vehicle idling for 10 minutes, then check voltage. Or check
the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in 3rd gear
position.
The voltage should be below 0.50V at least once during this
procedure.
6. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FR9
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EX-3, "EXHAUST SYSTEM" .
MBIB0020E
DTC P0139, P0159 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-275
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0139, P0159 HO2S2 (QG18DE) PFP:226A0
Component Description EBS00FRA
The heated oxygen sensor 2, after three way catalyst, monitors the
oxygen level in the exhaust gas on each bank.
Even if switching characteristics of the heated oxygen sensor 1 are
shifted, the air fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal
from the heated oxygen sensor 2.
This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates volt-
age from approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner condi-
tions.
Under normal conditions the heated oxygen sensor 2 is not used for
engine control operation.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FRB
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FRD
The heated oxygen sensor 2 has a much longer switching time
between rich and lean than the heated oxygen sensor 1. The oxygen
storage capacity before the three way catalyst causes the longer
switching time. To judge the malfunctions of heated oxygen sensor
2, ECM monitors whether the switching response of the sensor's
voltage is faster than specified during the various driving condition
such as fuel-cut.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FRE
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
G COMPLETED will appear on CONSULT-II screen when all tests COND1, COND2 and
COND3 are completed.
G If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and
wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
SEF327R
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S2 (B1)
HO2S2 (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S2 MNTR (B1)
HO2S2 MNTR (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
LEAN RICH
SEF302U
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0139
0139
(Bank 1)
Heated oxygen sensor 2
circuit slow response
It takes more time for the sensor to respond
between rich and lean than the specified time.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 2
G Fuel pressure
G Injectors
G Intake air leaks
P0159
0159
(Bank 2)
EC-276
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0139, P0159 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
Never stop engine during this procedure. If the engine is stopped, retry this procedure from step 2 in
Procedure for COND1.
WITH CONSULT-II
Procedure for COND1
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select HO2S2 (B1) P0139 or HO2S2 (B2) P0159 of HO2S2 in DTC
WORK SUPPORT mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch START.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 30 seconds.
6. Rev engine up to 2,000 rpm 2 or 3 times quickly under no load.
If COMPLETED appears on CONSULT-II screen, go to step 2 in Procedure for COND3.
If COMPLETED does not appear on CONSULT-II screen, go to the following step.
7. Drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
8. When the following conditions are met, TESTING will be displayed at COND1 on the CONSULT-II
screen. Maintain the conditions continuously until TESTING changes to COMPLETED. (It will take
approximately 60 seconds.)
NOTE:
G If TESTING is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from step 2 in Procedure for COND1.
G If COMPLETED already appears at COND2 on CONSULT-II screen before Procedure for
COND2 is conducted, it is unnecessary to conduct step 1 in Procedure for COND2.
Procedure for COND2
1. While driving, release accelerator pedal completely with OD
OFF (A/T models only) from the above condition [step 8] until
INCOMPLETE at COND2 on CONSULT-II screen has turned
to COMPLETED. (It will take approximately 4 seconds.)
NOTE:
If COMPLETED already appears at COND3 on CONSULT-II
screen before Procedure for COND3 is conducted, it is unnec-
essary to conduct step 1 in Procedure for COND3.
ENG SPEED More than 1,000 rpm
B/FUEL SCHDL More than 1.0 msec
COOLANT TEMP/S 70 - 105 C
Selector level Suitable position
PBIB0552E
PBIB0553E
DTC P0139, P0159 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-277
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Procedure for COND3
1. Stop vehicle and let it idle until INCOMPLETE of COND3 on
CONSULT-II screen has turned to COMPLETED. (It will take a
maximum of approximately 6 minutes.)
2. Make sure that OK is displayed after touching SELF-DIAG
RESULTS.
If NG is displayed, refer to EC-281, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00FRF
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 2 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 17 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should change at more than 0.06V for 1 second
during this procedure.
If the voltage can be confirmed in step 4, step 5 is not nec-
essary.
5. Keep vehicle at idling for 10 minutes, then check the voltage. Or
check the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D
position with OD OFF (A/T), 3rd gear position (M/T).
The voltage should change at more than 0.06V for 1 second
during this procedure.
6. If NG, go to EC-281, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF668Y
MBIB0021E
EC-278
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0139, P0159 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
Wiring Diagram EBS00FRG
BANK 1
MBWA0056E
DTC P0139, P0159 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-279
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
16 Y
Heated oxygen sensor 2
(bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
EC-280
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0139, P0159 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
BANK 2
MBWA0058E
DTC P0139, P0159 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-281
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FRH
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
17 L
Heated oxygen sensor 2
(bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0095E
EC-282
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0139, P0159 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
2. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171, P0172, P0174 or P0175 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure that DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer toEC-73, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure that DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171, P0172, P0174 or P0175 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0171, P0174 or P0172, P0175. Refer to EC-291 or EC-305 .
No >> GO TO 3.
3. CHECK HO2S2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S2
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
SEF215Z
MBIB0096E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0094E
DTC P0139, P0159 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-283
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. CHECK HO2S2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal and HO2S2 terminal as follows.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between the following terminals and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EC-283, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FRI
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Select FUEL INJECTION in ACTIVE TEST mode, and select
HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) as the monitor item with CONSULT-II.
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P0139 16 2 1
P0159 17 2 2
Continuity should exist.
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P0139 16 2 1
P0159 17 2 2
Continuity should not exist.
SEF662Y
EC-284
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0139, P0159 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
4. Check HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) at idle speed when adjusting FUEL INJECTION to 25%.
HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) should be above 0.68V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is +25%.
HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) should be below 0.50V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is 25%.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 17 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.68V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage is above 0.68V at step 4, step 5 is not neces-
sary.
5. Keep vehicle idling for 10 minutes, then check voltage. Or check
the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D posi-
tion with OD OFF (A/T), 3rd gear position (M/T).
The voltage should be below 0.50V at least once during this
procedure.
6. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FRJ
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EX-3, "EXHAUST SYSTEM" .
PBIB0551E
MBIB0021E
DTC P0171 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG16DE)
EC-285
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0171 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG16DE) PFP:16600
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00ENA
With the Air/Fuel Mixture Ratio Self-Learning Control, the actual mixture ratio can be brought closely to the
theoretical mixture ratio based on the mixture ratio feedback signal from the heated oxygen sensor 1. The
ECM calculates the necessary compensation to correct the offset between the actual and the theoretical
ratios.
In case the amount of the compensation value is extremely large (The actual mixture ratio is too lean.), the
ECM judges the condition as the fuel injection system malfunction and light up the MI (2 trip detection logic).
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00ENB
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode with CON-
SULT-II.
4. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
5. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
6. Start engine again and let it idle for at least 10 minutes.
The 1st trip DTC P0171 should be detected at this stage, if a
malfunction exists. If so, go to EC-288, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
7. If it is difficult to start engine at step 6, the fuel injection system
has a malfunction, too.
8. Crank engine while depressing accelerator pedal. If engine
starts, go to EC-288, "Diagnostic Procedure" . If engine does not
start, check exhaust and intake air leak visually.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Heated oxygen sensors 1
Density of oxygen in exhaust gas
(Mixture ratio feedback signal)
Fuel injection control Fuel injectors
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0171
0171
Fuel injection system too
lean
G Fuel injection system does not operate properly.
G The amount of mixture ratio compensation is too
large.
(The mixture ratio is too lean.)
G Intake air leaks
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
G Injectors
G Exhaust gas leaks
G Incorrect fuel pressure
G Lack of fuel
G Mass air flow sensor
G Incorrect PCV hose connection
SEF215Z
EC-286
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0171 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG16DE)
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector. Then
restart and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Select MODE 3 with GST. Make sure DTC P0102 is detected.
6. Select MODE 4 with GST and erase the DTC P0102.
7. Start engine again and let it idle for at least 10 minutes.
8. Select MODE 7 with GST. The 1st trip DTC P0171 should be
detected at this stage, if a malfunction exists. If so, go to EC-
288, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
9. If it is difficult to start engine at step 7, the fuel injection system
has a malfunction.
10. Crank engine while depressing accelerator pedal. If engine starts, go to EC-288, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If engine does not start, check exhaust and intake air leak visually.
MBIB0096E
DTC P0171 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG16DE)
EC-287
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00ENC
MBWA0060E
EC-288
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0171 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG16DE)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00END
1. CHECK EXHAUST AIR LEAK
1. Start engine and run it at idle.
2. Listen for an exhaust air leak before three way catalyst.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace.
2. CHECK FOR INTAKE AIR LEAK AND PCV HOSE
1. Listen for an intake air leak after the mass air flow sensor.
2. Check PCV hose connection.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
3. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 (HO2S1) harness connec-
tor.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 and HO2S1
terminal 2, ECM terminal 74 and HO2S1 terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals 35, 74 or
HO2S1 terminals 2, 3 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
6. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
1. Release fuel pressure to zero. Refer to EC-58, "FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE" .
2. Install fuel pressure gauge and check fuel pressure. Refer to EC-58, "FUEL PRESSURE CHECK" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Follow the construction of FUEL PRESSURE CHECK.
SEF099P
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
MBIB0091E
At idling: Approximately 350 kPa (3.7 kg/cm
2
, 51 psi)
DTC P0171 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG16DE)
EC-289
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
With CONSULT-II
1. Install all removed parts.
2. Check MASS AIR FLOW in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
With GST
1. Install all removed parts.
2. Check mass air flow sensor signal in MODE 1 with GST.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Check connectors for rusted terminals or loose connections in the mass air flow sensor circuit or
engine grounds. Refer to EC-183, "DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR" .
6. CHECK FUNCTION OF INJECTORS
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Perform POWER BALANCE in ACTIVE TEST mode with
CONSULT-II.
3. Make sure that each circuit produces a momentary engine
speed drop.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Listen to each injector operating sound.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Perform trouble diagnosis for EC-530, "INJECTOR CIRCUIT" .
1.0 - 4.0 gm/sec: at idling
5.0 - 10 gm/sec: at 2,500 rpm
1.0 - 4.0 gm/sec: at idling
5.0 - 10 gm/sec: at 2,500 rpm
PBIB0133E
Clicking noise should be heard.
MEC703B
EC-290
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0171 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG16DE)
7. CHECK INJECTOR
1. Confirm that the engine is cooled down and there are no fire hazards near the vehicle.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect injector harness connectors.
4. Remove injector gallery assembly. Refer to EM-31, "FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE" .
Keep fuel hose and all injectors connected to injector gallery.
The injector harness connectors should remain connected.
5. Disconnect all ignition coil harness connectors.
6. Prepare pans or saucers under each injector.
7. Crank engine for about 3 seconds. Make sure that fuel sprays
out from injectors.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace injectors from which fuel does not spray out.
Always replace O-ring with new ones.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Fuel should be sprayed evenly for each injector.
SEF595Q
DTC P0171, P0174 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG18DE)
EC-291
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0171, P0174 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG18DE) PFP:16600
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00ENE
With the Air/Fuel Mixture Ratio Self-Learning Control, the actual mixture ratio can be brought closely to the
theoretical mixture ratio based on the mixture ratio feedback signal from the heated oxygen sensors 1. The
ECM calculates the necessary compensation to correct the offset between the actual and the theoretical
ratios.
In case the amount of the compensation value is extremely large (The actual mixture ratio is too lean.), the
ECM judges the condition as the fuel injection system malfunction and light up the MI (2 trip detection logic).
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00ENF
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode with CON-
SULT-II.
4. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
5. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
6. Start engine again and let it idle for at least 10 minutes.
The 1st trip DTC P0171 or P0174 should be detected at this
stage, if a malfunction exists. If so, go to EC-295, "Diagnostic
Procedure" .
7. If it is difficult to start engine at step 6, the fuel injection system
has a malfunction, too.
8. Crank engine while depressing accelerator pedal. If engine
starts, go to EC-295, "Diagnostic Procedure" . If engine does not
start, check exhaust and intake air leak visually.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Heated oxygen sensors 1
Density of oxygen in exhaust gas
(Mixture ratio feedback signal)
Fuel injection control Fuel injectors
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0171
0171
(Bank 1)
Fuel injection system too
lean
G Fuel injection system does not operate properly.
G The amount of mixture ratio compensation is too
large.
(The mixture ratio is too lean.)
G Intake air leaks
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
G Injectors
G Exhaust gas leaks
G Incorrect fuel pressure
G Lack of fuel
G Mass air flow sensor
G Incorrect PCV hose connection
P0174
0174
(Bank 2)
SEF215Z
EC-292
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0171, P0174 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG18DE)
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector. Then
restart and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Select MODE 3 with GST. Make sure DTC P0102 is detected.
6. Select MODE 4 with GST and erase the DTC P0102.
7. Start engine again and let it idle for at least 10 minutes.
8. Select MODE 7 with GST. The 1st trip DTC P0171 or P0174
should be detected at this stage, if a malfunction exists. If so, go
to EC-295, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
9. If it is difficult to start engine at step 7, the fuel injection system
has a malfunction.
10. Crank engine while depressing accelerator pedal. If engine starts, go to EC-295, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If engine does not start, check exhaust and intake air leak visually.
MBIB0096E
DTC P0171, P0174 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG18DE)
EC-293
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00ENG
BANK 1
MBWA0061E
EC-294
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0171, P0174 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG18DE)
BANK 2
MBWA0062E
DTC P0171, P0174 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG18DE)
EC-295
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00ENH
1. CHECK EXHAUST AIR LEAK
1. Start engine and run it at idle.
2. Listen for an exhaust air leak before three way catalyst.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace.
2. CHECK FOR INTAKE AIR LEAK
1. Listen for an intake air leak after the mass air flow sensor.
2. Check PCV hose connection.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
SEF099P
EC-296
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0171, P0174 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG18DE)
3. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect corresponding heated oxygen sensor 1 (HO2S1)
harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal and HO2S1
terminal as follows.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Check harness continuity between the following terminals and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
6. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
1. Release fuel pressure to zero. Refer to EC-58, "FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE" .
2. Install fuel pressure gauge and check fuel pressure. Refer to EC-58, "FUEL PRESSURE CHECK" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Fuel pump and circuit (Refer to EC-536, "FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT" .)
G Fuel pressure regulator (Refer to EC-58, "FUEL PRESSURE CHECK" .)
G Fuel lines (Refer to MA-23, "Checking Fuel Lines" .)
G Fuel filter for clogging
>> Repair or replace.
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P0171
35 2
1
74 3
P0174
36 2
2
74 3
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0092E
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P0171 35, 74 2, 3 1
P0174 36, 74 2, 3 2
Continuity should not exist.
At idling: 350 kPa (3.7 kg/cm
2
, 51 psi)
DTC P0171, P0174 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG18DE)
EC-297
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
With CONSULT-II
1. Install all removed parts.
2. Check MASS AIR FLOW in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
With GST
1. Install all removed parts.
2. Check mass air flow sensor signal in MODE 1 with GST.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Check connectors for rusted terminals or loose connections in the mass air flow sensor circuit or
engine grounds. Refer to EC-183, "DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR" .
7. CHECK FUNCTION OF INJECTORS
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Perform POWER BALANCE in ACTIVE TEST mode with
CONSULT-II.
3. Make sure that each circuit produces a momentary engine
speed drop.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Listen to each injector operating sound.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Perform trouble diagnosis for EC-530, "INJECTOR CIRCUIT" .
1.0 - 4.0 gm/sec: at idling
5.0 - 10.0 gm/sec: at 2,500 rpm
1.0 - 4.0 gm/sec: at idling
5.0 - 10.0 gm/sec: at 2,500 rpm
PBIB0133E
Clicking noise should be heard.
MEC703B
EC-298
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0171, P0174 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG18DE)
8. CHECK INJECTOR
1. Confirm that the engine is cooled down and there are no fire hazards near the vehicle.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect injector harness connectors on bank 2 (for DTC P0171), bank 1 (for DTC P0174).
4. Remove injector gallery assembly. Refer to EM-31, "FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE" .
Keep fuel hose and all injectors connected to injector gallery.
The injector harness connectors on bank 1 (for DTC P0171), bank 2 (for DTC P0174) should remain con-
nected.
5. Disconnect all ignition coil harness connectors.
6. Prepare pans or saucers under each injector.
7. Crank engine for about 3 seconds. Make sure that fuel sprays
out from injectors.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace injectors from which fuel does not spray out.
Always replace O-ring with new ones.
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Fuel should be sprayed evenly for each injector.
SEF595Q
DTC P0172 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG16DE)
EC-299
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0172 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG16DE) PFP:16600
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FRK
With the Air/Fuel Mixture Ratio Self-Learning Control, the actual mixture ratio can be brought closely to the
theoretical mixture ratio based on the mixture ratio feedback signal from the heated oxygen sensors 1. The
ECM calculates the necessary compensation to correct the offset between the actual and the theoretical
ratios.
In case the amount of the compensation value is extremely large (The actual mixture ratio is too rich.), the
ECM judges the condition as the fuel injection system malfunction and light up the MI (2 trip detection logic).
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FRL
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode with CON-
SULT-II.
4. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
5. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
6. Start engine again and let it idle for at least 10 minutes.
The 1st trip DTC P0172 should be detected at this stage, if a
malfunction exists. If so, go to EC-302, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
7. If it is difficult to start engine at step 6, the fuel injection system
has a malfunction, too.
8. Crank engine while depressing accelerator pedal.
If engine starts, go to EC-302, "Diagnostic Procedure" . If engine
does not start, remove ignition plugs and check for fouling, etc.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Heated oxygen sensors 1
Density of oxygen in exhaust gas
(Mixture ratio feedback signal)
Fuel injection control Fuel injectors
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0172
0172
Fuel injection system too
rich
G Fuel injection system does not operate properly.
G The amount of mixture ratio compensation is too
large.
(The mixture ratio is too rich.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
G Injectors
G Exhaust gas leaks
G Incorrect fuel pressure
G Mass air flow sensor
SEF215Z
EC-300
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0172 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG16DE)
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector. Then
restart and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Select MODE 3 with GST. Make sure DTC P0102 is detected.
6. Select MODE 4 with GST and erase the DTC P0102.
7. Start engine again and let it idle for at least 10 minutes.
8. Select MODE 7 with GST. The 1st trip DTC P0172 should be
detected at this stage, if a malfunction exists. If so, go to EC-
302, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
9. If it is difficult to start engine at step 7, the fuel injection system
has a malfunction.
10. Crank engine while depressing accelerator pedal.
If engine starts, go to EC-302, "Diagnostic Procedure" . If engine does not start, check exhaust and intake
air leak visually.
MBIB0096E
DTC P0172 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG16DE)
EC-301
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00FRM
MBWA0060E
EC-302
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0172 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG16DE)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FRN
1. CHECK EXHAUST AIR LEAK
1. Start engine and run it at idle.
2. Listen for an exhaust air leak before three way catalyst.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace.
2. CHECK FOR INTAKE AIR LEAK
Listen for an intake air leak after the mass air flow sensor.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
3. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 (HO2S1) harness connec-
tor.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 and HO2S1
terminal 2, ECM terminal 74 and HO2S1 terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals 35, 74 or
HO2S1 terminals 2, 3 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
6. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
1. Release fuel pressure to zero. Refer to EC-58, "FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE" .
2. Install fuel pressure gauge and check fuel pressure. Refer to EC-58, "FUEL PRESSURE CHECK" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Follow the construction of FUEL PRESSURE CHECK.
SEF099P
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
MBIB0091E
At idling: 350 kPa (3.7 kg/cm2, 51 psi)
DTC P0172 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG16DE)
EC-303
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
With CONSULT-II
1. Install all removed parts.
2. Check MASS AIR FLOW in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
With GST
1. Install all removed parts.
2. Check mass air flow sensor signal in MODE 1 with GST.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Check connectors for rusted terminals or loose connections in the mass air flow sensor circuit or
engine grounds. Refer to EC-183, "DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR" .
6. CHECK FUNCTION OF INJECTORS
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Perform POWER BALANCE in ACTIVE TEST mode with
CONSULT-II.
3. Make sure that each circuit produces a momentary engine
speed drop.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Listen to each injector operating sound.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Perform trouble diagnosis for EC-530, "INJECTOR CIRCUIT" .
1.0 - 4.0 gm/sec: at idling
5.0 - 10 gm/sec: at 2,500 rpm
1.0 - 4.0 gm/sec: at idling
5.0 - 10 gm/sec: at 2,500 rpm
PBIB0133E
Clicking noise should be heard.
MEC703B
EC-304
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0172 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG16DE)
7. CHECK INJECTOR
1. Remove injector assembly. Refer to EM-31, "FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE" .
Keep fuel hose and all injectors connected to injector gallery.
2. Confirm that the engine is cooled down and there are no fire hazards near the vehicle.
3. Disconnect injector harness connectors.
The injector harness connectors should remain connected.
4. Disconnect all ignition coil harness connectors.
5. Prepare pans or saucers under each injectors.
6. Crank engine for about 3 seconds.
Make sure fuel does not drip from injector.
OK or NG
OK (Does not drip.)>>GO TO 8.
NG (Drips.)>>Replace the injectors from which fuel is dripping. Always replace O-ring with new one.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
DTC P0172, P0175 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG18DE)
EC-305
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0172, P0175 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG18DE) PFP:16600
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FRO
With the Air/Fuel Mixture Ratio Self-Learning Control, the actual mixture ratio can be brought closely to the
theoretical mixture ratio based on the mixture ratio feedback signal from the heated oxygen sensors 1. The
ECM calculates the necessary compensation to correct the offset between the actual and the theoretical
ratios.
In case the amount of the compensation value is extremely large (The actual mixture ratio is too rich.), the
ECM judges the condition as the fuel injection system malfunction and light up the MI (2 trip detection logic).
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FRP
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode with CON-
SULT-II.
4. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
5. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
6. Start engine again and let it idle for at least 10 minutes.
The 1st trip DTC P0172, P0175 should be detected at this stage,
if a malfunction exists. If so, go to EC-309, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
7. If it is difficult to start engine at step 6, the fuel injection system
has a malfunction, too.
8. Crank engine while depressing accelerator pedal.
If engine starts, go to EC-309, "Diagnostic Procedure" . If engine
does not start, remove ignition plugs and check for fouling, etc.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Heated oxygen sensors 1
Density of oxygen in exhaust gas
(Mixture ratio feedback signal)
Fuel injection control Fuel injectors
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0172
0172
(Bank 1)
Fuel injection system too
rich
G Fuel injection system does not operate properly.
G The amount of mixture ratio compensation is too
large.
(The mixture ratio is too rich.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
G Injectors
G Exhaust gas leaks
G Incorrect fuel pressure
G Mass air flow sensor
P0175
0175
(Bank 2)
SEF215Z
EC-306
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0172, P0175 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG18DE)
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector. Then
restart and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Select MODE 3 with GST. Make sure DTC P0102 is detected.
6. Select MODE 4 with GST and erase the DTC P0102.
7. Start engine again and let it idle for at least 10 minutes.
8. Select MODE 7 with GST. The 1st trip DTC P0172 or P0175
should be detected at this stage, if a malfunction exists. If so, go
to EC-309, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
9. If it is difficult to start engine at step 7, the fuel injection system
has a malfunction.
10. Crank engine while depressing accelerator pedal.
If engine starts, go to EC-309, "Diagnostic Procedure" . If engine does not start, check exhaust and intake
air leak visually.
MBIB0096E
DTC P0172, P0175 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG18DE)
EC-307
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00FRQ
BANK 1
MBWA0061E
EC-308
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0172, P0175 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG18DE)
BANK 2
MBWA0062E
DTC P0172, P0175 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG18DE)
EC-309
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FRR
1. CHECK EXHAUST AIR LEAK
1. Start engine and run it at idle.
2. Listen for an exhaust air leak before three way catalyst.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace.
2. CHECK FOR INTAKE AIR LEAK
Listen for an intake air leak after the mass air flow sensor.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
3. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect corresponding heated oxygen sensor 1 (HO2S1)
harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal and HO2S1
terminal as follows.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Check harness continuity between the following terminals and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
6. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
SEF099P
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P0172
35 2
1
74 3
P0175
36 2
2
74 3
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0092E
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P0172 35, 74 2, 3 1
P0175 36, 74 2, 3 2
Continuity should not exist.
EC-310
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0172, P0175 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG18DE)
4. CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
1. Release fuel pressure to zero. Refer to EC-58, "FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE" .
2. Install fuel pressure gauge and check fuel pressure. Refer to EC-58, "FUEL PRESSURE CHECK" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Fuel pump and circuit (Refer to EC-536, "FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT" .)
G Fuel pressure regulator (Refer to EC-58, "FUEL PRESSURE CHECK" .)
>> Repair or replace.
6. CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
With CONSULT-II
1. Install all removed parts.
2. Check MASS AIR FLOW in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
With GST
1. Install all removed parts.
2. Check mass air flow sensor signal in MODE 1 with GST.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Check connectors for rusted terminals or loose connections in the mass air flow sensor circuit or
engine grounds. Refer to EC-183, "DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR" .
At idling: 350 kPa (3.7 kg/cm
2
, 51 psi)
2.0 - 6.0 gm/sec: at idling
7.0 - 20.0 gm/sec: at 2,500 rpm
2.0 - 6.0 gm/sec: at idling
7.0 - 20.0 gm/sec: at 2,500 rpm
DTC P0172, P0175 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION (QG18DE)
EC-311
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
7. CHECK FUNCTION OF INJECTORS
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Perform POWER BALANCE in ACTIVE TEST mode with
CONSULT-II.
3. Make sure that each circuit produces a momentary engine
speed drop.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Listen to each injector operating sound.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Perform trouble diagnosis for EC-530, "INJECTOR CIRCUIT" .
8. CHECK INJECTOR
1. Remove injector assembly. Refer to EM-31, "FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE" .
Keep fuel hose and all injectors connected to injector gallery.
2. Confirm that the engine is cooled down and there are no fire hazards near the vehicle.
3. Disconnect injector harness connectors bank 2 (for DTC P0172), bank 1 (for P0175).
The injector harness connectors on bank 1 (for P0172), bank 2 (for P0175) should remain connected.
4. Disconnect all ignition coil harness connectors.
5. Prepare pans or saucers under each injectors.
6. Crank engine for about 3 seconds.
Make sure fuel does not drip from injector.
OK or NG
OK (Does not drip.)>>GO TO 9.
NG (Drips.)>>Replace the injectors from which fuel is dripping. Always replace O-ring with new one.
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
PBIB0133E
Clicking noise should be heard.
MEC703B
EC-312
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00ENI
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor,
throttle position sensor, etc. The throttle position sensor responds to
the throttle valve movement.
The throttle position sensor has the two sensors. These sensors are
a kind of potentiometers which transform the throttle valve position
into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM. In addi-
tion, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of the
throttle valve and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM
judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these sig-
nals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the
throttle valve opening angle properly in response to driving condi-
tion.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00ENJ
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00ENK
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00ENL
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 8V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0145E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
THRTL SEN1
THRTL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released More than 0.36V
G Shift lever:
D (A/T model)
1st (M/T model)
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0221
0221
Throttle position sensor
circuit range/performance
problem
Rationally incorrect voltage is sent to ECM
compared with the signals from TP sensor 1
and TP sensor 2.
G Harness or connector
(The TP sensor 1 and 2 circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 1 and 2)
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
EC-313
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-315, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
SEF058Y
EC-314
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00ENM
MBWA0138E
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
EC-315
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00ENN
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
47 G
Sensor power supply
(Throttle position sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
49 W Throttle position sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
More than 0.36V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
Less than 4.75V
66 B
Sensor ground
(Throttle position sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
68 R Throttle position sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
Less than 4.75V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 0.36V
MBIB0095E
EC-316
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
2. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between electric throttle control actuator terminal
1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 66 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 49 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 4, ECM
terminal 68 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
Refer to EC-317, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
MBIB0100E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0082E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
EC-317
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00ENO
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Set selector lever to D position (A/T models) or 1st position (M/T models).
5. Check voltage between ECM terminals 49 (TP sensor 1 signal),
68 (TP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the following
conditions.
6. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to the next
step.
7. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
8. Perform EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00ENP
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-19, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
49
(Throttle position sensor 1)
Fully released More than 0.36V
Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
68
(Throttle position sensor 2)
Fully released Less than 4.75V
Fully depressed More than 0.36V
MBIB0022E
EC-318
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00ENQ
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor,
throttle position sensor, etc. The throttle position sensor responds to
the throttle valve movement.
The throttle position sensor has the two sensors. These sensors are
a kind of potentiometers which transform the throttle valve position
into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM. In addi-
tion, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of the
throttle valve and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM
judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these sig-
nals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the
throttle valve opening angle properly in response to driving condi-
tion.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00ENR
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00ENS
These self-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00ENT
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 8V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0145E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
THRTL SEN1
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released More than 0.36V
G Shift lever:
D (A/T model)
1st (M/T model)
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0222
0222
Throttle position sensor 1
circuit low input
An excessively low voltage from the TP sensor 1
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The TP sensor 1 circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 1)
P0223
0223
Throttle position sensor 1
circuit high input
An excessively high voltage from the TP sensor
1 is sent to ECM.
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
EC-319
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-321, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
SEF058Y
EC-320
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00ENU
MBWA0136E
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
EC-321
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00ENV
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
47 G
Sensor power supply
(Throttle position sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
49 W Throttle position sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
More than 0.36V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
Less than 4.75V
66 B
Sensor ground
(Throttle position sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
68 R Throttle position sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
Less than 4.75V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 0.36V
MBIB0095E
EC-322
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
2. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 1 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between electric throttle control actuator terminal
1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 66 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 49 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 4.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
Refer to EC-323, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
MBIB0100E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0082E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
EC-323
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00ENW
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Set selector lever to D position (A/T models) or 1st position (M/T models).
5. Check voltage between ECM terminals 49 (TP sensor 1 signal),
68 (TP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the following
conditions.
6. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to the next
step.
7. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
8. Perform EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00ENX
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-19, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
49
(Throttle position sensor 1)
Fully released More than 0.36V
Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
68
(Throttle position sensor 2)
Fully released Less than 4.75V
Fully depressed More than 0.36V
MBIB0022E
EC-324
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR PFP:18002
Component Description EBS00ENY
The accelerator pedal position sensor is installed on the upper end
of the accelerator pedal assembly. The sensor detects the accelera-
tor position and sends a signal to the ECM.
Accelerator pedal position sensor has two sensors. These sensors
are a kind of potentiometers which transform the accelerator pedal
position into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM.
In addition, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of
the accelerator pedal and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The
ECM judges the current opening angle of the accelerator pedal from
these signals and controls the throttle control motor based on these
signals.
Idle position of the accelerator pedal is determined by the ECM
receiving the signal from the accelerator pedal position sensor. The ECM uses this signal for the engine oper-
ation such as fuel cut.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00ENZ
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EO0
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EO1
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 8V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0146E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
ACCEL SEN1
ACCEL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed More than 3.9V
CLSD THL POS G Ignition switch: ON
Accelerator pedal: Fully released ON
Accelerator pedal: Slightly depressed OFF
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0226
0226
Accelerator pedal position sensor
circuit range/performance problem
Rationally incorrect voltage is sent to ECM
compared with the signals from APP sensor
1 and APP sensor 2.
G Harness or connector
(The APP sensor 1 and 2 circuit is
open or shorted.)
G Accelerator pedal position sensor 1
and 2
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
EC-325
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-327, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
SEF058Y
EC-326
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00EO2
MBWA0142E
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
EC-327
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EO3
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
82 B
Sensor ground
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
83 B
Sensor ground
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 0V
90 R
Sensor power supply
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
91 G
Sensor power supply
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
98 LG
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.175 - 0.335V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 1.95V
106 L
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.35 - 0.67V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.9V
MBIB0095E
EC-328
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
2. CHECK APP SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor harness
connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between APP sensor terminals 1, 2 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK APP SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 82 and APP sensor terminal 4, ECM terminal 83 and
APP sensor terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0152E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0782E
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
EC-329
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK APP SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 106 and APP sensor terminal 3, ECM terminal 98 and
APP sensor terminal 6.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK APP SENSOR
Refer to EC-329, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 9.
9. REPLACE APP SENSOR
1. Replace the accelerator pedal position sensor.
2. Perform EC-55, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
10. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EO4
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
Continuity should exist.
EC-330
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
3. Check voltage between ECM terminals 106 (APP sensor 1 sig-
nal), 98 (APP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the fol-
lowing conditions.
4. If NG, replace accelerator pedal assembly and go to the next
step.
5. Perform EC-55, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
6. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
7. Perform EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00EO5
ACCELERATOR PEDAL
Refer to ACC-2, "ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM" .
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
106
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Fully depressed More than 3.9V
98
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
Fully released 0.175 - 0.335V
Fully depressed More than 1.95V
MBIB0023E
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
EC-331
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR PFP:18002
Component Description EBS00EO6
The accelerator pedal position sensor is installed on the upper end
of the accelerator pedal assembly. The sensor detects the accelera-
tor position and sends a signal to the ECM.
Accelerator pedal position sensor has two sensors. These sensors
are a kind of potentiometers which transform the accelerator pedal
position into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM.
In addition, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of
the accelerator pedal and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The
ECM judges the current opening angle of the accelerator pedal from
these signals and controls the throttle control motor based on these
signals.
Idle position of the accelerator pedal is determined by the ECM
receiving the signal from the accelerator pedal position sensor. The ECM uses this signal for the engine oper-
ation such as fuel cut.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EO7
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EO8
These self-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EO9
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0146E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
ACCEL SEN1
G Ignition switch: ON
(engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed More than 3.9V
CLSD THL POS G Ignition switch: ON
Accelerator pedal: Fully released ON
Accelerator pedal: Slightly depressed OFF
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0227
0227
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1 circuit low input
An excessively low voltage from the APP sensor 1
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The APP sensor 1 circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Accelerator pedal position sensor
(Accelerator pedal position sensor 1)
P0228
0228
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1 circuit high input
An excessively high voltage from the APP sensor 1
is sent to ECM.
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
EC-332
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-334, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
SEF058Y
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
EC-333
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00EOA
MBWA0140E
EC-334
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EOB
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
82 B
Sensor ground
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
83 B
Sensor ground
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 0V
90 R
Sensor power supply
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
91 G
Sensor power supply
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
98 LG
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.175 - 0.335V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 1.95V
106 L
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.35 - 0.67V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.9V
MBIB0095E
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
EC-335
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK APP SENSOR 1 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor harness
connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between APP sensor terminal 2 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK APP SENSOR 1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 82 and APP sensor terminal 4.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0152E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0811E
Continuity should exist.
EC-336
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
6. CHECK APP SENSOR 1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 106 and APP sensor terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK APP SENSOR
Refer to EC-336, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 9.
9. REPLACE APP SENSOR
1. Replace the accelerator pedal position sensor.
2. Perform EC-55, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
10. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EOC
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminals 106 (APP sensor 1 sig-
nal), 98 (APP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the fol-
lowing conditions.
Continuity should exist.
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
106
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Fully depressed More than 3.9V
98
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
Fully released 0.175 - 0.335V
Fully depressed More than 1.95V
MBIB0023E
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
EC-337
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. If NG, replace accelerator pedal assembly and go to the next step.
5. Perform EC-55, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
6. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
7. Perform EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00EOD
ACCELERATOR PEDAL
Refer to ACC-2, "ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM" .
EC-338
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0300 - P0304 MULTIPLE CYLINDER MISFIRE, NO. 1 - 4 CYLINDER MIS-
FIRE
DTC P0300 - P0304 MULTIPLE CYLINDER MISFIRE, NO. 1 - 4 CYLINDER MIS-
FIRE PFP:00000
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EOE
When a misfire occurs, engine speed will fluctuate. If the engine speed fluctuates enough to cause the crank-
shaft position (CKP) sensor (POS) signal to vary, ECM can determine that a misfire is occurring.
The misfire detection logic consists of the following two conditions.
1. One Trip Detection Logic (Three Way Catalyst Damage)
On the first trip that a misfire condition occurs that can damage the three way catalyst (TWC) due to over-
heating, the MI will blink.
When a misfire condition occurs, the ECM monitors the CKP sensor (POS) signal every 200 engine revo-
lutions for a change.
When the misfire condition decreases to a level that will not damage the TWC, the MI will turn off.
If another misfire condition occurs that can damage the TWC on a second trip, the MI will blink.
When the misfire condition decreases to a level that will not damage the TWC, the MI will remain on.
If another misfire condition occurs that can damage the TWC, the MI will begin to blink again.
2. Two Trip Detection Logic (Exhaust quality deterioration)
For misfire conditions that will not damage the TWC (but will affect vehicle emissions), the MI will only light
when the misfire is detected on a second trip. During this condition, the ECM monitors the CKP sensor
signal every 1,000 engine revolutions.
A misfire malfunction can be detected on any one cylinder or on multiple cylinders.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EOF
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON, and select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function
Crankshaft position sensor (POS) Engine speed On board diagnosis of misfire
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0300
0300
Multiple cylinder misfire
detected
Multiple cylinder misfire.
G Improper spark plug
G Insufficient compression
G Incorrect fuel pressure
G The injector circuit is open or shorted
G Fuel injectors
G Intake air leak
G The ignition signal circuit is open or
shorted
G Lack of fuel
G Drive plate or flywheel
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
G Incorrect PCV hose connection
P0301
0301
No.1 cylinder misfire
detected
No. 1 cylinder misfires.
P0302
0302
No. 2 cylinder misfire
detected
No. 2 cylinder misfires.
P0303
0303
No. 3 cylinder misfire
detected
No. 3 cylinder misfires.
P0304
0304
No. 4 cylinder misfire
detected
No. 4 cylinder misfires.
DTC P0300 - P0304 MULTIPLE CYLINDER MISFIRE, NO. 1 - 4 CYLINDER MIS-
FIRE
EC-339
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. Start engine again and drive at 1,500 to 3,000 rpm for at least 3
minutes.
Hold the accelerator pedal as steady as possible.
NOTE:
Refer to the freeze frame data for the test driving condi-
tions.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-339, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EOG
1. CHECK FOR INTAKE AIR LEAK AND PCV HOSE
1. Start engine and run it at idle speed.
2. Listen for the sound of the intake air leak.
3. Check PCV hose connection.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace.
2. CHECK FOR EXHAUST SYSTEM CLOGGING
Stop engine and visually check exhaust tube, three way catalyst and muffler for dents.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
PBIB0164E
EC-340
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0300 - P0304 MULTIPLE CYLINDER MISFIRE, NO. 1 - 4 CYLINDER MIS-
FIRE
3. PERFORM POWER BALANCE TEST
With CONSULT-II
1. Perform POWER BALANCE in ACTIVE TEST mode.
2. Is there any cylinder which does not produce a momentary
engine speed drop?
Without CONSULT-II
When disconnecting each injector harness connector one at a time,
is there any cylinder which does not produce a momentary engine
speed drop?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 4.
No >> GO TO 7.
4. CHECK INJECTOR
Does each injector make an operating sound at idle?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 5.
No >> Check injector(s) and circuit(s). Refer to EC-530,
"INJECTOR CIRCUIT" .
5. CHECK IGNITION SPARK
1. Disconnect ignition coil assembly from rocker cover.
2. Connect a known good spark plug to the ignition coil assembly.
3. Place end of spark plug against a suitable ground and crank engine.
4. Check for spark.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Check ignition coil, power transistor and their circuits.
Refer to EC-520, "IGNITION SIGNAL" .
PBIB0133E
MBIB0101E
MEC703B
SEF575Q
DTC P0300 - P0304 MULTIPLE CYLINDER MISFIRE, NO. 1 - 4 CYLINDER MIS-
FIRE
EC-341
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK SPARK PLUGS
Remove the spark plugs and check for fouling, etc.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Repair or replace spark plug(s) with standard type
one(s). For spark plug type, refer to MA-26, "Checking
and Changing Spark Plugs" .
7. CHECK COMPRESSION PRESSURE
Check compression pressure. Refer to EM-57, "CHECKING COMPRESSION PRESSURE" .
QG16DE engine
QG18DE engine
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Check pistons, piston rings, valves, valve seats and cylinder head gaskets.
8. CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
1. Install all removed parts.
2. Release fuel pressure to zero. Refer to EC-58, "FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE" .
3. Install fuel pressure gauge and check fuel pressure. Refer to EC-58, "FUEL PRESSURE CHECK" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Follow the construction of FUEL PRESSURE CHECK.
SEF156I
Standard:
1,353 kPa (13.53 bar, 13.8 kg/cm
2
, 196 psi)/350 rpm
Minimum:
1,157 kPa (11.57 bar, 11.8 kg/cm
2
, 168 psi)/350 rpm
Difference between each
cylinder:
98 kPa (0.98 bar, 1.0 kg/cm
2
, 14 psi)/350 rpm
Standard:
1,324 kPa (13.24 bar, 13.5 kg/cm
2
, 192 psi)/350 rpm
Minimum:
1,128 kPa (11.28 bar, 11.5 kg/cm
2
, 164 psi)/350 rpm
Difference between each
cylinder:
98 kPa (0.98 bar, 1.0 kg/cm
2
, 14 psi)/350 rpm
At idle: Approx. 350 kPa (3.7 kg/cm
2
, 51 psi)
EC-342
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0300 - P0304 MULTIPLE CYLINDER MISFIRE, NO. 1 - 4 CYLINDER MIS-
FIRE
9. CHECK IGNITION TIMING
Check the following items. Refer to EC-92, "Basic Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> Follow the Basic Inspection.
10. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-203, "Component Inspection" (QG16DE engine models), EC-211, "Component Inspection"
(QG18DE engine models).
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> GO TO 11.
11. CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
With CONSULT-II
Check mass air flow sensor signal in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
With GST
Check mass air flow sensor signal in MODE 1 with GST.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Check connectors for rusted terminals or loose connections in the mass air flow sensor circuit or
engine grounds. Refer to EC-183, "DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR" .
12. CHECK SYMPTOM MATRIX CHART
Check items on the rough idle symptom in EC-97, "Symptom Matrix Chart" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> Repair or replace.
13. ERASE THE 1ST TRIP DTC
Some tests may cause a 1st trip DTC to be set.
Erase the 1st trip DTC from the ECM memory after performing the tests. Refer to EC-73, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
>> GO TO 14.
Items Specifications
Target idle speed
A/T 800 50 rpm (in P or N position)
M/T 700 50 rpm
Ignition timing
A/T 10 5 BTDC (in P or N position)
M/T 8 5 BTDC
1.0 - 4.0 gm/sec: at idling
5.0 - 10.0 gm/sec: at 2,500 rpm
1.0 - 4.0 gm/sec: at idling
5.0 - 10.0 gm/sec: at 2,500 rpm
DTC P0300 - P0304 MULTIPLE CYLINDER MISFIRE, NO. 1 - 4 CYLINDER MIS-
FIRE
EC-343
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
14. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
EC-344
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0327, P0328 KS
DTC P0327, P0328 KS PFP:22060
Component Description EBS00EOH
The knock sensor is attached to the cylinder block. It senses engine
knocking using a piezoelectric element. A knocking vibration from
the cylinder block is sensed as vibrational pressure. This pressure is
converted into a voltage signal and sent to the ECM.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EOI
The MI will not light for knock sensor malfunction.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EOJ
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine and run it for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-346, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
MBIB0102E
DTC No. Trouble Diagnosis Name DTC Detected Condition Possible Cause
P0327
0327
Knock sensor circuit low
input
An excessively low voltage from the sensor is
sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Knock sensor
P0328
0328
Knock sensor circuit high
input
An excessively high voltage from the sensor is
sent to ECM.
SEF058Y
DTC P0327, P0328 KS
EC-345
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00EOK
MBWA0063E
EC-346
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0327, P0328 KS
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EOL
1. CHECK KNOCK SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT-I
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check resistance between ECM terminal 15 and engine ground. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
NOTE:
It is necessary to use an ohmmeter which can measure more than 10 M.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK KNOCK SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT-II
1. Disconnect knock sensor harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 15 and knock
sensor terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK KNOCK SENSOR
Refer to EC-347, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace knock sensor.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
15 W Knock sensor
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 2.5V
54
Sensor ground
(Knock sensor shield circuit)
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
Resistance: Approximately 530 - 590k [at 20C (68F)]
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0102E
DTC P0327, P0328 KS
EC-347
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 5.
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EOM
KNOCK SENSOR
Check resistance between knock sensor terminal 1 and ground.
NOTE:
It is necessary to use an ohmmeter which can measure more
than 10 M.
CAUTION:
Do not use any knock sensors that have been dropped or phys-
ically damaged. Use only new ones.
Removal and Installation EBS00EON
KNOCK SENSOR
Refer to EM-70, "CYLINDER BLOCK" .
MBIB0095E
Resistance: Approximately 530 - 590k [at 20C (68F)]
SEF227W
EC-348
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS) PFP:23731
Component Description EBS00EOO
The crankshaft position sensor (POS) is located on the cylinder
block rear housing facing the gear teeth (cogs) of the signal plate at
the end of the crankshaft. It detects the fluctuation of the engine rev-
olution.
The sensor consists of a permanent magnet and Hall IC.
When the engine is running, the high and low parts of the teeth
cause the gap with the sensor change.
The changing gap causes the magnetic field near the sensor to
change.
Due to the changing magnetic field, the voltage from the sensor
changes.
The ECM receives the voltage signal and detects the fluctuation of
the engine revolution.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EOP
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EOQ
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EOR
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10.5V with igni-
tion switch ON.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select DATA MONITOR mode
with CONSULT-II.
2. Crank engine for at least 2 seconds and run it for at least 5 sec-
onds at idle speed.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-351, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
PBIB0562E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
ENG SPEED
G Tachometer: Connect
G Run engine and compare tachometer indication with the CONSULT-II
value.
Almost the same speed as the
CONSULT-II value.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0335
0335
Crankshaft position
sensor (POS) circuit
G The crankshaft position sensor (POS) signal is not
detected by the ECM during the first few seconds of
engine cranking.
G The proper pulse signal from the crankshaft position
sensor (POS) is not sent to ECM while the engine is
running.
G The crankshaft position sensor (POS) signal is not in
the normal pattern during engine running.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
G Signal plate
SEF058Y
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
EC-349
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
EC-350
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
Wiring Diagram EBS00EOS
MBWA0064E
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
EC-351
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EOT
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
13 W
Crankshaft position
sensor (POS)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 3V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
Approximately 3V
30 B
Crankshaft position
sensor (POS) ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
PBIB0527E
PBIB0528E
MBIB0095E
EC-352
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
2. CHECK CKP SENSOR (POS) POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect crankshaft position (CKP) sensor (POS) harness
connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between CKP sensor (POS) terminal 3 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between crankshaft position sensor (POS) and ECM
G Harness for open or short between crankshaft position sensor (POS) and ECM relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK CKP SENSOR (POS) GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 30 and CKP sensor (POS) terminal 1
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for and short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0103E
Voltage: Battery voltage
SEF509Y
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
EC-353
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. CHECK CKP SENSOR (POS) INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 13 and CKP sensor (POS) terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (POS)
Refer to EC-353, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace crankshaft position sensor (POS).
7. CHECK GEAR TOOTH
Visually check for chipping signal plate gear tooth.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace the signal plate.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EOU
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (POS)
1. Loosen the fixing bolt of the sensor.
2. Disconnect crankshaft position sensor (POS) harness connector.
3. Remove the sensor.
4. Visually check the sensor for chipping.
Continuity should exist.
PBIB0563E
EC-354
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
5. Check resistance as shown in the figure.
6. If NG, replace crankshaft position sensor (POS).
Removal and Installation EBS00EOV
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (POS)
Refer to EM-70, "CYLINDER BLOCK" .
Terminal No. (Polarity) Resistance [at 25C (77F)]
3 (+) - 1 (-)
Except 0 or 3 (+) - 2 (-)
2 (+) - 1 (-)
MBIB0024E
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
EC-355
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE) PFP:23731
Component Description EBS00EOW
The camshaft position sensor (PHASE) senses the retraction with
intake valve camshaft to identify a particular cylinder. The camshaft
position sensor (PHASE) senses the piston position.
When the crankshaft position sensor (POS) system becomes inoper-
ative, the camshaft position sensor (PHASE) provides various con-
trols of engine parts instead, utilizing timing of cylinder identification
signals.
The sensor consists of a permanent magnet and Hall IC.
When engine is running, the high and low parts of the teeth cause
the gap with the sensor to change.
The changing gap causes the magnetic field near the sensor to
change.
Due to the changing magnetic field, the voltage from the sensor changes.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EOX
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EOY
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10.5V with igni-
tion switch ON.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Crank engine for at least 2 seconds and run it for at least 5 sec-
onds at idle speed.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-357, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
If 1st trip DTC is not detected, go to next step.
5. Maintain engine speed at more than 800 rpm for at least 5 sec-
onds.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-357, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
PBIB0562E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0340
0340
Camshaft position sensor
(PHASE) circuit
G The cylinder No. signal is not sent to ECM
for the first few seconds during engine
cranking.
G The cylinder No. signal is not set to ECM
during engine running.
G The cylinder No. signal is not in the normal
pattern during engine running.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
G Camshaft (Intake)
G Starter motor (Refer to SC-22 .)
G Starting system circuit (Refer to SC-22 .)
G Dead (Weak) battery
SEF013Y
EC-356
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
Wiring Diagram EBS00EOZ
MBWA0065E
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
EC-357
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EP0
1. CHECK STARTING SYSTEM
Turn ignition switch to START position.
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> Check starting system. (Refer to SC-22, "STARTING SYSTEM" .)
2. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 3.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
14 R
Camshaft position
sensor (PHASE)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.0 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
1.0 - 4.0V
29 B
Camshaft position
sensor (PHASE)
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
PBIB0525E
PBIB0526E
Does the engine turn over?
Does the starter motor operate?
MBIB0095E
EC-358
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
3. CHECK CMP SENSOR (PHASE) POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect camshaft position (CMP) sensor (PHASE) harness
connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between CMP sensor (PHASE) terminal 3 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between camshaft position sensor (PHASE) and ECM
G Harness for open or short between camshaft position sensor (PHASE) and ECM relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK CMP SENSOR (PHASE) GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 29 and CMP sensor (PHASE) terminal 1.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK CMP SENSOR (PHASE) INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 14 and CMP sensor (PHASE) terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground or short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0104E
Voltage: Battery voltage
SEF509Y
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
EC-359
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
7. CHECK CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (PHASE)
Refer to EC-359, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace camshaft position sensor (PHASE).
8. CHECK CAMSHAFT (INTAKE)
Check the following.
G Accumulation of debris to the signal plate of camshaft rear end
G Chipping signal plate of camshaft rear end
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Remove debris and clean the signal plate of camshaft
rear end or replace camshaft.
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EP1
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (PHASE)
1. Loosen the fixing bolt of the sensor.
2. Disconnect camshaft position sensor (PHASE) harness connector.
3. Remove the sensor.
4. Visually check the sensor for chipping.
5. Check resistance as shown in the figure.
PBIB0565E
PBIB0563E
Terminal No. (Polarity) Resistance [at 25C (77F)]
3 (+) - 1 (-)
Except 0 or 3 (+) - 2 (-)
2 (+) - 1 (-)
MBIB0024E
EC-360
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
Removal and Installation EBS00EP2
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (PHASE)
Refer to EM-36, "CAMSHAFT" .
DTC P0420 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION (QG16DE)
EC-361
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0420 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION (QG16DE) PFP:20905
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FRS
The ECM monitors the switching frequency ratio of heated oxygen
sensors 1 and 2.
A three way catalyst (Manifold) with high oxygen storage capacity
will indicate a low switching frequency of heated oxygen sensor 2.
As oxygen storage capacity decreases, the heated oxygen sensor 2
switching frequency will increase.
When the frequency ratio of heated oxygen sensors 1 and 2
approaches a specified limit value, the three way catalyst (Manifold)
malfunction is diagnosed.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FRT
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
TESTING CONDITION:
G Open engine hood before conducting the following procedure.
G Do not hold engine speed for more than the specified minutes below.
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DTC & SRT CONFIRMATION then SRT WORK SUP-
PORT mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine.
4. Rev engine up to 2,500 to 3,500 rpm and hold it for 3 consecu-
tive minutes then release the accelerator pedal completely.
If INCMP of CATALYST changed to COMPLT, go to step 7
5. Wait 5 seconds at idle.
PBIB0067E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0420
0420
Catalyst system efficiency
below threshold
G Three way catalyst (Manifold) does not operate
properly.
G Three way catalyst (Manifold) does not have
enough oxygen storage capacity.
G Three way catalyst (Manifold)
G Exhaust tube
G Intake air leaks
G Fuel injectors
G Fuel injector leaks
G Spark plug
G Improper ignition timing
PBIB0566E
EC-362
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0420 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION (QG16DE)
6. Rev engine up to 2,000 to 3,000 rpm and maintain it until
INCMP of CATALYST changes to CMPLT (It will take
approximately 5 minutes).
If not CMPLT, stop engine and cool it down to less than 70C
(158F) and then retest from step 1.
7. Select SELF-DIAG RESULTS mode with CONSULT-II.
8. Confirm that the 1st trip DTC is not detected.
If the 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-363, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00FRU
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the three way catalyst (Manifold). During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeters probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 sig-
nal) and engine ground, and ECM terminal 16 (HO2S2 signal)
and engine ground.
4. Keep engine speed at 2,000 rpm constant under no load.
5. Make sure that the voltage switching frequency (high & low)
between ECM terminal 16 and engine ground is very less than
that of ECM terminal 35 and engine ground.
Switching frequency ratio = A/B
A: Heated oxygen sensor 2 voltage switching frequency
B: Heated oxygen sensor 1 voltage switching frequency
This ratio should be less than 0.75.
If the ratio is greater than above, it means three way catalyst
does not operate properly. Go to EC-363, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
NOTE:
If the voltage at terminal 35 does not switch periodically more than 5
times within 10 seconds at step 5, perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0133 first. (See EC-214 .)
PBIB0567E
SEF535Z
MBIB0018E
MBIB0124E
DTC P0420 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION (QG16DE)
EC-363
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FRV
1. CHECK EXHAUST SYSTEM
Visually check exhaust tubes and muffler for dent.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace.
2. CHECK EXHAUST AIR LEAK
1. Start engine and run it at idle.
2. Listen for an exhaust air leak before the three way catalyst
(Manifold).
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
3. CHECK INTAKE AIR LEAK
Listen for an intake air leak after the mass air flow sensor.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair or replace.
4. CHECK IGNITION TIMING
Check the following items. Refer to EC-92, "Basic Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Follow the Basic Inspection.
5. CHECK INJECTORS
1. Refer to Wiring Diagram for Injectors, EC-531 .
2. Stop engine and then turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminals 22, 23, 41, 42 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Perform EC-532, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF099P
Items Specifications
Ignition timing 8 5 BTDC
Target idle speed 700 50 rpm
Battery voltage should exist.
MBIB0030E
EC-364
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0420 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION (QG16DE)
6. CHECK IGNITION SPARK
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ignition coil assembly from rocker cover.
3. Connect a known good spark plug to the ignition coil assembly.
4. Place end of spark plug against a suitable ground and crank engine.
5. Check for spark.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Check ignition coil with power transistor and their circuit.
Refer to EC-520, "IGNITION SIGNAL" .
7. CHECK INJECTOR
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Remove injector assembly.
Refer to EM-31, "FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE" .
Keep fuel hose and all injectors connected to injector gallery.
3. Disconnect all ignition coil harness connectors.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
Make sure fuel does not drip from injector.
OK or NG
OK (Does not drip.)>>GO TO 8.
NG (Drips.)>>Replace the injector(s) from which fuel is dripping.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
Trouble is fixed.>>INSPECTION END
Trouble is not fixed.>>Replace three way catalyst (Manifold).
SEF575Q
DTC P0420, P0430 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION (QG18DE)
EC-365
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0420, P0430 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION (QG18DE) PFP:20905
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FRW
The ECM monitors the switching frequency ratio of heated oxygen
sensors 1 and 2.
A three way catalyst (Manifold) with high oxygen storage capacity
will indicate a low switching frequency of heated oxygen sensor 2.
As oxygen storage capacity decreases, the heated oxygen sensor 2
switching frequency will increase.
When the frequency ratio of heated oxygen sensors 1 and 2
approaches a specified limit value, the three way catalyst (Manifold)
malfunction is diagnosed.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FRX
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
TESTING CONDITION:
G Open engine hood before conducting the following procedure.
G Do not hold engine speed for more than the specified minutes below.
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DTC & SRT CONFIRMATION then SRT WORK SUP-
PORT mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine.
4. Rev engine up to 2,500 to 3,500 rpm and hold it for 3 consecu-
tive minutes then release the accelerator pedal completely.
If INCMP of CATALYST changed to COMPLT, go to step 7
5. Wait 5 seconds at idle.
PBIB0067E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0420
0420
(Bank 1)
Catalyst system efficiency
below threshold
G Three way catalyst (Manifold) does not operate
properly.
G Three way catalyst (Manifold) does not have
enough oxygen storage capacity.
G Three way catalyst (Manifold)
G Exhaust tube
G Intake air leaks
G Fuel injectors
G Fuel injector leaks
G Spark plug
G Improper ignition timing
P0430
0430
(Bank 2)
PBIB0566E
EC-366
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0420, P0430 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION (QG18DE)
6. Rev engine up to 2,000 to 3,000 rpm and maintain it until
INCMP of CATALYST changes to CMPLT (It will take
approximately 5 minutes).
If not CMPLT, stop engine and cool it down to less than 70C
(158F) and then retest from step 1.
7. Select SELF-DIAG RESULTS mode with CONSULT-II.
8. Confirm that the 1st trip DTC is not detected.
If the 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-367, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00FRY
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the three way catalyst (Manifold). During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeters probes between ECM terminals 35 [HO2S1 (B 1)
signal], 36 [HO2S1 (B 2) signal] and engine ground, and ECM
terminals 16 [HO2S2 (B 1) signal], 17 [HO2S2 (B 2) signal] and
engine ground.
4. Keep engine speed at 2,000 rpm constant under no load.
5. Make sure that the voltage switching frequency (high & low)
between ECM terminals 16 and engine ground, or 17 and
engine ground is very less than that of ECM terminals 35 and
engine ground, or 36 and engine ground.
Switching frequency ratio = A/B
A: Heated oxygen sensor 2 voltage switching frequency
B: Heated oxygen sensor 1 voltage switching frequency
This ratio should be less than 0.75.
If the ratio is greater than above, it means three way catalyst
does not operate properly. Go to EC-367, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
PBIB0567E
SEF535Z
MBIB0019E
MBIB0125E
DTC P0420, P0430 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION (QG18DE)
EC-367
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
NOTE:
If the voltage at terminal 35 or 36 does not switch periodically more than 5 times within 10 seconds at step 5,
perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0133, P0153 first. (See EC-223 .)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FRZ
1. CHECK EXHAUST SYSTEM
Visually check exhaust tubes and muffler for dent.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace.
2. CHECK EXHAUST AIR LEAK
1. Start engine and run it at idle.
2. Listen for an exhaust air leak before the three way catalyst
(Manifold).
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
3. CHECK INTAKE AIR LEAK
Listen for an intake air leak after the mass air flow sensor.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair or replace.
4. CHECK IGNITION TIMING
Check the following items. Refer to EC-92, "Basic Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Follow the EC-92, "Basic Inspection" .
SEF099P
Items Specifications
Ignition timing
M/T: 8 5 BTDC
A/T: 10 5 BTDC (in P or N position)
Target idle speed
M/T: 700 50 rpm
A/T: 800 50 rpm (in P or N position)
EC-368
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0420, P0430 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION (QG18DE)
5. CHECK INJECTORS
1. Stop engine and then turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminals 22, 23, 41, 42 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
3. Refer to Wiring Diagram for Injectors, EC-531 .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Perform EC-532, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
6. CHECK IGNITION SPARK
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ignition coil assembly from rocker cover.
3. Connect a known good spark plug to the ignition coil assembly.
4. Place end of spark plug against a suitable ground and crank engine.
5. Check for spark.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Check ignition coil with power transistor and their circuit.
Refer to EC-520, "IGNITION SIGNAL" .
7. CHECK INJECTOR
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Remove injector assembly.
Refer to EM-31, "FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE" .
Keep fuel hose and all injectors connected to injector gallery.
3. Disconnect all ignition coil harness connectors.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
Make sure fuel does not drip from injector.
OK or NG
OK (Does not drip.)>>GO TO 8.
NG (Drips.)>>Replace the injector(s) from which fuel is dripping.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
Trouble is fixed.>>INSPECTION END
Trouble is not fixed.>>Replace three way catalyst (Manifold).
Battery voltage should exist.
MBIB0030E
SEF575Q
DTC P0444, P0445 EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE
EC-369
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0444, P0445 EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE PFP:14920
Description EBS00GW7
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
*: This signal is sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
*2: The ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
This system controls flow rate of fuel vapor from the EVAP canister. The opening of the vapor by-pass pas-
sage in the EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve changes to control the flow rate. The EVAP
canister purge volume control solenoid valve repeats ON/OFF operation according to the signal sent from the
ECM. The opening of the valve varies for optimum engine control. The optimum value stored in the ECM is
determined by considering various engine conditions. When the engine is operating, the flow rate of fuel vapor
from the EVAP canister is regulated as the air flow changes.
COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
The EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve uses a ON/
OFF duty to control the flow rate of fuel vapor from the EVAP canis-
ter. The EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve is
moved by ON/OFF pulses from the ECM. The longer the ON pulse,
the greater the amount of fuel vapor that will flow through the valve.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GW8
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
*2
EVAP canister
purge flow control
EVAP canister purge
volume control solenoid
valve
Mass air flow sensor Amount of intake air
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Battery
Battery voltage
*2
Throttle position sensor Throttle position
Accelerator pedal position sensor Closed throttle position
Heated oxygen sensors 1
Density of oxygen in exhaust gas
(Mixture ratio feedback signal)
Vehicle speed signal
*1
Vehicle speed
SEF337U
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
PURG VOL C/V
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 0%
2,000 rpm 15 - 30%
EC-370
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0444, P0445 EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GWA
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GWB
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for at least 13 seconds.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-372, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0444
0444
EVAP canister purge volume
control solenoid valve circuit
open
An excessively low voltage signal is sent
to ECM through the valve
G Harness or connectors
(The solenoid valve circuit is open or
shorted.)
G EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve
P0445
0445
EVAP canister purge volume
control solenoid valve circuit
shorted
An excessively high voltage signal is sent
to ECM through the valve
G Harness or connectors
(The solenoid valve circuit is shorted.)
G EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve
SEF058Y
DTC P0444, P0445 EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE
EC-371
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GWC
MBWA0066E
EC-372
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0444, P0445 EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GWD
1. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE POWER SUPPLY CIR-
CUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve
harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve terminal 1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
19 GY/L
EVAP canister purge
volume control solenoid
valve
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is about 2,000 rpm (More than
100 seconds after starting engine)
Approximately 10V
PBIB0050E
PBIB0520E
MBIB0113E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0148E
DTC P0444, P0445 EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE
EC-373
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve and ECM
G Harness for open or short between EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve and ECM relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OUTPUT SIGNAL CIR-
CUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 19 and EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid
valve terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK (With CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 4.
OK (Without CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OPERATION
With CONSULT-II
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Start engine.
3. Perform PURG VOL CONT/V in ACTIVE TEST mode with
CONSULT-II. Check that engine speed varies according to the
valve opening.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Refer to EC-374, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Continuity should exist.
PBIB0569E
EC-374
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0444, P0445 EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE
Component Inspection EBS00GWE
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
With CONSULT-II
Check air passage continuity of EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve under the following conditions.
Without CONSULT-II
Check air passage continuity of EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve under the following conditions.
Removal and Installation EBS00GWF
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Refer to EM-19, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
Condition
(PURG VOL CONT/V value)
Air passage continuity
between A and B
100.0% Yes
0.0% No
PBIB0149E
Condition
Air passage continuity
between A and B
12V direct current supply between
terminals 1 and 2
Yes
No supply No
PBIB0150E
DTC P0500 VSS
EC-375
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0500 VSS PFP:32702
Description EBS00EP3
NOTE:
If DTC P0500 is displayed with DTC U1000 or U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-150, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
The vehicle speed signal is sent to the combination meter from ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
through CAN communication line. The combination meter then sends a signal to the ECM through CAN com-
munication line.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EP4
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EP5
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Steps 1 and 2 may be conducted with the drive wheels lifted in the shop or by driving the vehicle. If a
road test is expected to be easier, it is unnecessary to lift the vehicle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Read VHCL SPEED SE in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II. The vehicle speed on CONSULT-
II should exceed 10 km/h (6 MPH) when rotating wheels with suitable gear position.
If NG, go to EC-376, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If OK, go to following step.
3. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Warm engine up to normal operating temperature.
5. Maintain the following conditions for at least 60 consecutive sec-
onds.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-376, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
Overall Function Check EBS00EP6
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the vehicle speed signal circuit. During this check, a 1st trip
DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Lift up drive wheels.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0500
0500
Vehicle speed sensor
The almost 0 km/h (0 MPH) signal from
vehicle speed sensor is sent to ECM
even when vehicle is being driven.
G Harness or connectors
(The CAN communication line is open or
shorted.)
G ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
G Combination meter
G Vehicle speed signal
ENG SPEED 2,000 - 6,000 rpm (A/T models)
2,300 - 6,000 rpm (M/T models)
COOLAN TEMP/S More than 70C (158F)
B/FUEL SCHDL More than 5.0 msec (A/T models)
More than 4.3 msec (M/T models)
Selector lever Suitable position
PW/ST SIGNAL OFF
SEF196Y
EC-376
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0500 VSS
2. Start engine.
3. Read vehicle speed signal in MODE 1 with GST.
The vehicle speed signal on GST should be able to exceed 10 km/h (6 MPH) when rotating wheels with
suitable gear position.
4. If NG, go to EC-376, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EP7
1. CHECK DTC
Check DTC with ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit), Refer to BRC-17, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace.
2. CHECK COMBINATION METER
Check combination meter function.
Refer to DI-5, "COMBINATION METERS (LHD MODELS)" or DI-34, "COMBINATION METERS (RHD MOD-
ELS)" .
>> INSPECTION END
DTC P0550 PSP SENSOR
EC-377
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0550 PSP SENSOR PFP:49763
Component Description EBS00FS0
Power steering pressure (PSP) sensor is installed to the power
steering high-pressure tube and detects a power steering load. This
sensor is a potentiometer which transforms the power steering load
into output voltage, and emits the voltage signal to the ECM. The
ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator and adjusts the
throttle valve opening angle to increase the engine speed and
adjusts the idle speed for the increased load.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FS1
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FS2
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FS3
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for at least 5 seconds.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-379, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
MBIB0105E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
PW/ST SIGNAL
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Steering wheel is in neutral position.
(Forward direction)
OFF
Steering wheel is turned. ON
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0550
0550
Power steering pressure
sensor circuit
An excessively low or high voltage from the
sensor is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Power steering pressure sensor
EC-378
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0550 PSP SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00FS4
MBWA0089E
DTC P0550 PSP SENSOR
EC-379
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FS5
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
12 L
Power steering pressure
sensor
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is being turned.
0.5 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is not being turned.
0.4 - 0.8V
57 B
Sensor ground
(Power steering pressure
sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
65 G
Sensor power supply
(Power steering pressure
sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
MBIB0095E
EC-380
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0550 PSP SENSOR
2. CHECK PSP SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect PSP sensor harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between PSP sensor terminal 3 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK PSP SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 57 and PSP sensor terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK PSP SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 12 and PSP sensor terminal 2.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK PSP SENSOR
Refer to EC-381, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace PSP sensor.
MBIB0105E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
SEF509Y
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0550 PSP SENSOR
EC-381
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FS6
POWER STEERING PRESSURE SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Start engine and let it idle.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminal 12 and ground under the
following conditions.
Condition Voltage
Steering wheel is being turned fully. Approximately 3.6V
Steering wheel is not being turned. Approximately 0.6V
MBIB0025E
EC-382
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0605 ECM
DTC P0605 ECM PFP:23710
Component Description EBS00EP8
The ECM consists of a microcomputer and connectors for signal
input and output and for power supply. The ECM controls the engine.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EP9
FAIL-SAFE MODE
ECM enters fail-safe mode when malfunction A is detected.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EPA
Perform PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A first. If the DTC cannot be confirmed, perform PRO-
CEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION B. If there is no problem on PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION B,
perform PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. If DTC is detected, go to EC-384, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
With GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
SEF093X
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0605
0605
Engine control module
A) ECM calculation function is malfunctioning.
G ECM B) ECM EEP-ROM system is malfunctioning.
C) ECM self shut-off function is malfunctioning.
Detected items Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
Malfunction A
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5
degrees) by the return spring.
SEF058Y
DTC P0605 ECM
EC-383
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION B
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then
turn ON.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-384, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
With GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then
turn ON.
4. Repeat step 3 procedure, 32 times.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-384, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
With GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
SEF058Y
SEF058Y
EC-384
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0605 ECM
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EPB
1. INSPECTION START
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select SELF DIAG RESULTS mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Touch ERASE.
4. Perform DTC Confirmation Procedure.
See EC-382 .
5. Is the 1st trip DTC P0605 displayed again?
With GST
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select MODE 4 with GST.
3. Touch ERASE.
4. Perform DTC Confirmation Procedure.
See EC-382 .
5. Is the 1st trip DTC P0605 displayed again?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> INSPECTION END
2. REPLACE ECM
1. Replace ECM.
2. Perform initialization of NATS system and registration of all NATS ignition key IDs. Refer to EC-75, "NATS
(Nissan Anti-theft System)" .
3. Perform EC-55, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
5. Perform EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY
EC-385
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY PFP:23710
Component Description EBS00EPC
Battery voltage is supplied to the ECM even when the ignition switch
is turned OFF for the ECM memory function of the DTC memory, the
air fuel ratio feedback compensation value memory, the idle air vol-
ume learning value memory, etc.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EPD
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EPE
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then
turn ON.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 four times.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-387, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
SEF093X
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1065
1065
ECM power supply circuit
ECM back up RAM system does not function
properly.
G Harness or connectors
[ECM power supply (back-up) circuit is
open or shorted.]
G ECM
SEF058Y
EC-386
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY
Wiring Diagram EBS00EPF
MBWA0094E
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY
EC-387
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EPG
1. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminal 121 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E70, F13 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E63, F31 (RHD models)
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between ECM and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
121 W/L
Power supply for ECM
(Buck-up)
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0026E
EC-388
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY
4. PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select SELF DIAG RESULTS mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Touch ERASE.
4. Perform DTC Confirmation Procedure.
See EC-385 .
5. Is the 1st trip DTC P1065 displayed again?
With GST
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select MODE 4 with GST.
3. Touch ERASE.
4. Perform DTC Confirmation Procedure.
See EC-385 .
5. Is the 1st trip DTC P1065 displayed again?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 5.
No >> INSPECTION END
5. REPLACE ECM
1. Replace ECM.
2. Perform initialization of NATS system and registration of all NATS ignition key IDs. Refer to EC-75, "NATS
(Nissan Anti-theft System)" .
3. Perform EC-55, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
5. Perform EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
DTC P1102 MAF SENSOR
EC-389
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1102 MAF SENSOR PFP:22680
Component Description EBS00FS7
The mass air flow sensor is placed in the stream of intake air. It mea-
sures the intake flow rate by measuring a part of the entire intake
flow. It consists of a hot film that is supplied with electric current from
the ECM. The temperature of the hot film is controlled by the ECM a
certain amount. The heat generated by the hot film is reduced as the
intake air flows around it. The more air, the greater the heat loss.
Therefore, the ECM must supply more electric current to maintain
the temperature of the hot film as air flow increases. The ECM
detects the air flow by means of this current change.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FS8
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FS9
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FSA
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
SEC266C
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
MAS A/F SE-B1
G Engine: After warming up
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Shift lever: N
G No-load
Idle Approx. 1.0 - 1.7V
2,500 rpm Approx. 1.5 - 2.1V
CAL/LD VALUE
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 10% - 35%
2,500 rpm 10% - 35%
MASS AIRFLOW
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 1.0 - 4.0 gm/s
2,500 rpm 5.0 - 10.0 gm/s
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1102
1102
Mass air flow sensor circuit
range/performance problem
A voltage from the sensor is constantly
approx.1.0V when engine is running.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Mass air flow sensor
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
Mass air flow sensor circuit Engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm due to the fuel cut.
EC-390
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1102 MAF SENSOR
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and wait 5 seconds at most.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-392, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
SEF058Y
DTC P1102 MAF SENSOR
EC-391
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00FSB
MBWA0045E
EC-392
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1102 MAF SENSOR
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FSC
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
45 R
Sensor power supply
(Mass air flow sensor
sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
50 Y Mass air flow sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.0 - 1.7V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,500 rpm.
1.5 - 2.1V
67 B
Sensor ground
(Mass air flow sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0095E
DTC P1102 MAF SENSOR
EC-393
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK MAF SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect MAF sensor harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between MAF sensor terminals 2, 4 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between mass air flow sensor and ECM
G Harness for open or short between mass air flow sensor and ECM relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK MAF SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 67 and MAF sensor terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK MAF SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 50 and MAF sensor terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0096E
Terminal Voltage
2 Approximately 5V
4 Battery voltage
PBIB0076E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
EC-394
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1102 MAF SENSOR
6. CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EC-394, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace mass air flow sensor.
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FSD
MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
1. Reconnect harness connectors disconnected.
2. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminal 50 (Mass air flow sensor
signal) and ground.
*: Check for liner voltage rise in response to engine being increased to about
4,000 rpm.
4. If the voltage is out of specification, proceed the following.
a. Turn ignition switch OFF.
b. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector and reconnect it again.
c. Perform steps 2 and 3 again.
5. If NG, remove mass air flow sensor from air duct. Check hot film for damage or dust.
6. If NG, clean or replace mass air flow sensor.
Removal and Installation EBS00FSE
MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EM-17, "AIR CLEANER AND AIR DUCT" .
Condition Voltage V
Ignition switch ON (Engine stopped.) Approx. 1.0
Idle (Engine is warmed-up to normal operating
temperature.)
1.0 - 1.7
2,500 rpm (Engine is warmed-up to normal
operating temperature.)
1.5 - 2.1
Idle to about 4,000 rpm* 1.0 - 1.7 to Approx. 4.0
MBIB0017E
DTC P1111 IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
EC-395
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1111 IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE PFP:23796
Description EBS00GNV
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
*: This signal is sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
This mechanism hydraulically controls cam phases continuously with the fixed operating angle of the intake
valve.
The ECM receives signals such as crankshaft position, camshaft position, engine speed, and engine coolant
temperature. Then, the ECM sends ON/OFF pulse duty signals to the intake valve timing control solenoid
valve depending on driving status. This makes it possible to control the shut/open timing of the intake valve to
increase engine torque in low/mid speed range and output in high-speed range.
COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
Intake valve timing control solenoid valve is activated by ON/OFF
pulse duty (ratio) signals from the ECM.
The intake valve timing control solenoid valve changes the oil
amount and direction of flow through intake valve timing control unit
or stops oil flow.
The longer pulse width advances valve angle.
The shorter pulse width retards valve angle.
When ON and OFF pulse widths become equal, the solenoid valve
stops oil pressure flow to fix the intake valve angle at the control
position.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EPI
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Engine speed
Intake valve
timing control
Intake valve timing control
solenoid valve
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Vehicle speed signal
*
Vehicle speed
MBIB0121E
PBIB0195E
EC-396
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1111 IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EPJ
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EPK
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF
and wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-398, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITH GST
Following the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
INT/V SOL (B1)
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 0% - 2%
2,000 rpm Approx. 0% - 60%
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1111
1111
Intake valve timing control
solenoid valve circuit
An improper voltage is sent to the ECM
through intake valve timing control solenoid
valve.
G Harness or connectors
(Solenoid valve circuit is open or shorted.)
G Intake valve timing control solenoid valve
SEF058Y
DTC P1111 IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
EC-397
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00EPL
MBWA0067E
EC-398
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1111 IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EPM
1. CHECK IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect intake valve timing control solenoid valve harness
connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between intake valve timing control solenoid
valve terminal 1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTION PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between intake valve timing control solenoid valve and ECM relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
62 Y/R
Intake valve timing
control solenoid valve
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
Approximately 9V
PBIB0532E
MBIB0106E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0285E
DTC P1111 IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
EC-399
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 62 and intake valve timing control solenoid valve termi-
nal 2. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Refer to EC-399, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace intake valve timing control solenoid valve.
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EPN
INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
1. Disconnect intake valve timing control solenoid valve harness connector.
2. Check resistance between intake valve timing control solenoid
valve terminals 1 and 2 under the following conditions.
Removal and Installation EBS00EPO
INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Refer to EM-49, "TIMING CHAIN" .
Continuity should exist.
Terminals Resistance
1 and 2 Approximately 8 at 20C (68F)
1 or 2 and ground

(Continuity should not exist)
MBIB0027E
EC-400
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1121 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
DTC P1121 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00EPP
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor, throttle position sensor, etc.
The throttle control motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve.
The throttle position sensor detects the throttle valve position, and the opening and closing speed of the throt-
tle valve and feeds the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM judges the current opening angle of the throttle
valve from these signals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the throttle valve opening
angle properly in response to driving condition.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EPQ
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction A or B is detected in the two consecutive trips, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and MI
lights up.
When the malfunction C is detected even in the 1st trip, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EPR
NOTE:
G Perform PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A AND B first. If the 1st trip DTC cannot be con-
firmed, perform PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C.
G If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and
wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A AND B
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition witch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Shift selector lever to D position (A/T), 1st position (M/T) and
wait at least 2 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then
turn ON.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-401, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
With GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1121
1121
Electric throttle control
actuator
A)
Electric throttle control actuator does not function
properly due to the return spring malfunction.
G Electric throttle control actuator
B)
Throttle valve opening angle in fail-safe mode is
not in specified range.
C)
ECM detect the throttle valve is stuck open.
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection
logic.
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
Malfunction A
The ECM controls the electric throttle actuator by regulating the throttle opening around the idle position.
The engine speed will not rise more than 2,000 rpm.
Malfunction B ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator by regulating the throttle opening to 20 degrees or less.
Malfunction C
While the vehicle is driving, it slows down gradually by fuel cut. After the vehicle stops, the engine stalls.
The engine can restart in N or P position, and engine speed will not exceed 1,000 rpm or more.
SEF058Y
DTC P1121 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
EC-401
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Shift selector lever to D position (A/T), 1st position (M/T) and
wait at least 2 seconds.
4. Shift selector lever to N or P position.
5. Start engine and let it idle for 3 seconds.
6. If DTC is detected, go to EC-401, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
With GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EPS
1. CHECK ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR VISUALLY
1. Remove the intake air duct.
2. Check if a foreign matter is caught between the throttle valve
and the housing.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Remove the foreign matter and clean the electric throttle
control actuator inside.
2. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
Remove and Installation EBS00HBX
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-19, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
SEF058Y
MBIB0107E
EC-402
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION PFP:16119
Description EBS00EPT
NOTE:
If DTC P1122 is displayed with DTC P1121 or 1126, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P1121 or
P1126. Refer to EC-400 or EC-409 .
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor, throttle position sensor, etc.
The throttle control motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve.
The current opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the throttle position sensor and it provides feed-
back to the ECM to control the throttle control motor to make the throttle valve opening angle properly in
response to driving condition.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GB5
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GB6
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-404, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1122
1122
Electric throttle control
performance problem
Electric throttle control function does
not operate properly.
G Harness or connectors
(Throttle control motor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Harness or connectors
(Throttle control motor relay circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
G Throttle control motor relay
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return
spring.
SEF058Y
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
EC-403
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GB7
MBWA0143E
EC-404
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GB8
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
3 R
Throttle control motor
power supply
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
4 BR
Throttle control motor
(Close)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is releasing
0 - 14V
5 Y
Throttle control motor
(Open)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is depressing
0 - 14V
104 OR Throttle control motor relay
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch ON] 0 - 1.0V
PBIB0534E
PBIB0533E
MBIB0095E
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
EC-405
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY SIGNAL CIRCUIT
Check voltage between ECM terminal 3 and ground under the fol-
lowing conditions with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect throttle control motor relay.
3. Check voltage between throttle control motor relay terminals 2, 5
and ground.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G 15A fuse
G Harness for open or short between throttle control motor relay and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
Ignition switch Voltage
OFF Approximately 0V
ON
Battery voltage
(11 - 14V)
MBIB0028E
MBIB0140E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0575E
EC-406
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
5. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 3 and throttle control motor relay terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
6. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E70, F13 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E63, F31 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between ECM and throttle control motor relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Check continuity between ECM terminal 104 and throttle control motor relay terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> GO TO 8.
8. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness for open or short between ECM and throttle control motor relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
9. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
Refer to EC-408, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> Replace throttle control motor relay.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
EC-407
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
10. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN OR SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between the following terminals.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
11. CHECK ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR VISUALLY
1. Remove the intake air duct.
2. Check if foreign matter is caught between the throttle valve and
the housing.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Remove the foreign matter and clean the electric throttle
control actuator inside.
12. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
Refer to EC-408, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> GO TO 14.
13. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14.
NG >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
14. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
Electric throttle control
actuator terminal
ECM terminal Continuity
3
4 Should exist
5 Should not exist
6
4 Should not exist
5 Should exist
MBIB0100E
MBIB0107E
EC-408
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
Component Inspection EBS00EPY
THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
1. Apply 12V direct current between relay terminals 1 and 2.
2. Check continuity between relay terminals 3 and 5.
3. If NG, replace throttle control motor relay.
THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Check resistance between terminals 3 and 6.
3. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to next
step.
4. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
5. Perform EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00EPZ
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-19, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
Conditions Continuity
12V direct current supply
between terminals 1 and 2
Yes
No current supply No
PBIB0098E
Resistance: Approximately 1 - 15 [at 25 C (77F)]
PBIB0095E
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
EC-409
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00EQ0
Power supply for the Throttle Control motor is provided to the ECM via throttle control motor relay. The throttle
control motor relay is ON/OFF controlled by the ECM. When the ignition switch is turned ON, the ECM sends
an ON signal to throttle control motor relay and battery voltage is provided to the ECM. When the ignition
switch is turned OFF, the ECM sends an OFF signal to throttle control motor relay and battery voltage is not
provided to the ECM.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EQ1
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EQ2
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the DTC P1124 is detected in the two consecutive trips, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights
up.
When the DTC P1126 is detected even in the 1st trip, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EQ3
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
PROCEDURE FOR DTC P1124
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-412, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
THRTL RELAY G Ignition switch: ON ON
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1124
1124
Throttle control motor
relay circuit short
ECM detect the throttle control motor relay
is stuck ON.
G Harness or connectors
(Throttle control motor relay circuit is shorted.)
G Throttle control motor relay
P1126
1126
Throttle control motor
relay circuit open
ECM detects a voltage of power source for
throttle control motor is excessively low.
This self-diagnosis has the one trip
detection logic.
G Harness or connectors
(Throttle control motor relay circuit is open.)
G Throttle control motor relay
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return
spring.
SEF058Y
EC-410
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
With GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
PROCEDURE FOR DTC P1126
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-412, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
With GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
SEF058Y
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
EC-411
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00EQ4
MBWA0144E
EC-412
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EQ5
1. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect throttle control motor relay.
3. Check voltage between throttle control motor relay terminals 2, 5
and ground.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G 15A fuse
G Harness for open or short between throttle control motor relay and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
3 R
Throttle control motor
power supply
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
104 OR Throttle control motor relay
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch ON] 0 - 1.0V
MBIB0140E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0575E
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
EC-413
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 3 and throttle control motor relay terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E70, F13 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E63, F31 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between ECM and throttle control motor relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Check continuity between ECM terminal 104 and throttle control motor relay terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
6. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness for open or short between ECM and throttle control motor relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
Refer to EC-413, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace throttle control motor relay.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GBA
THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
1. Apply 12V direct current between relay terminals 1 and 2.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
EC-414
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
2. Check continuity between relay terminals 3 and 5.
3. If NG, replace throttle control motor relay.
Conditions Continuity
12V direct current supply
between terminals 1 and 2
Yes
No current supply No
PBIB0098E
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
EC-415
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00EQ6
The throttle control motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve.
The current opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the throttle position sensor and it provides feed-
back to the ECM to control the throttle control motor to make the throttle valve opening angle properly in
response to driving condition.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EQ7
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EQ8
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-417, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1128
1128
Throttle control motor
circuit short
ECM detects short both circuits between ECM
and throttle control motor.
G Harness or connectors
(Throttle control motor circuit is shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
(Throttle control motor)
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return
spring.
SEF058Y
EC-416
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00EQ9
MBWA0145E
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
EC-417
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EQA
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
4 BR
Throttle control motor
(Close)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is releasing
0 - 14V
5 Y
Throttle control motor
(Open)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is depressing
0 - 14V
PBIB0534E
PBIB0533E
MBIB0095E
EC-418
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
2. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN OR SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between the following terminals.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
Refer to EC-418, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 5.
4. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EQB
THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Check resistance between terminals 3 and 6.
3. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to next
step.
4. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
5. Perform EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Electric throttle control
actuator terminal
ECM terminal Continuity
3
4 Should exist
5 Should not exist
6
4 Should not exist
5 Should exist
MBIB0100E
Resistance: Approximately 1 - 15 [at 25 C (77F)]
PBIB0095E
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
EC-419
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Remove and Installation EBS00EQC
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-19, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
EC-420
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1143 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
DTC P1143 HO2S1 (QG16DE) PFP:22690
Component Description EBS00FSF
The heated oxygen sensor 1 is placed into the exhaust manifold. It
detects the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas compared to the
outside air. The heated oxygen sensor 1 has a closed-end tube
made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from
approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner conditions. The
heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM adjusts
the injection pulse duration to achieve the ideal air-fuel ratio. The
ideal air-fuel ratio occurs near the radical change from 1V to 0V.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FSG
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FSH
To judge the malfunction, the output from the heated oxygen sensor
1 is monitored to determine whether the rich output is sufficiently
high and whether the lean output is sufficiently low. When both the
outputs are shifting to the lean side, the malfunction will be detected.
SEF463R
SEF288D
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times dur-
ing 10 seconds.
SEF300U
DTC P1143 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-421
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FSI
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
G Always perform at a temperature above 10C (14F).
G Before performing following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Stop engine and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select HO2S1 (B1) P1143 of HO2S1 in DTC WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch START.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 3 minutes.
NOTE:
Never raise engine speed above 3,600 rpm after this step. If
the engine speed limit is exceeded, return to step 5.
6. When the following conditions are met, TESTING will be dis-
played on the CONSULT-II screen. Maintain the conditions con-
tinuously until TESTING changes to COMPLETED. (It will
take approximately 50 seconds or more.)
If TESTING is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from
step 2.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1143
1143
Heated oxygen sensor 1
lean shift monitoring
The maximum and minimum voltage from the
sensor are not reached to the specified voltages.
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
G Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
G Fuel pressure
G Injectors
G Intake air leaks
PBIB0546E
ENG SPEED 1,300 - 3,000 rpm
Vehicle speed 50 - 100 km/h (30 - 62 MPH)
B/FUEL SCHDL 2.4 - 5.5 msec
Selector lever Suitable position
PBIB0547E
EC-422
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1143 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
7. Make sure that OK is displayed after touching SELF-DIAG
RESULTS. If NG is displayed, refer to EC-422, "Diagnostic
Procedure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00FSJ
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
3. Check one of the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm
constant under no load.
The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
The minimum voltage is over 0.1V at least one time.
4. If NG, go to EC-422, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FSK
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
SEC769C
MBIB0018E
MBIB0095E
DTC P1143 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-423
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. RETIGHTEN HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Loosen and retighten heated oxygen sensor 1.
>> GO TO 3.
3. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure that DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-73, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure that DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0171. Refer to EC-285 .
No >> GO TO 4.
4. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 HEATER
Refer to EC-161, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
Tightening torque: 40 - 60 Nm (4.1 - 6.2 kg-m, 30 - 44 ft-lb)
MBIB0098E
SEF215Z
MBIB0096E
EC-424
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1143 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-424, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
For circuit, refer to EC-201, "Wiring Diagram" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FSL
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG and adjust TRIGGER POINT to 100% in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-
II.
3. Select HO2S1 (B1) and HO2S1 MNTR (B1).
4. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load during the follow-
ing steps.
5. Touch RECORD on CONSULT-II screen.
6. Check the following.
G HO2S1 MNTR (B1) in DATA MONITOR mode changes
from RICH to LEAN to RICH 5 times in 10 seconds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes below 0.3V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
SEF646Y
SEF217YA
SEF648Y
DTC P1143 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-425
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
G The voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new
one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FSM
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-23, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER" .
MBIB0018E
EC-426
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1143, P1163 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
DTC P1143, P1163 HO2S1 (QG18DE) PFP:22690
Component Description EBS00FSN
The heated oxygen sensor 1 is placed into the exhaust manifold. It
detects the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas compared to the
outside air. The heated oxygen sensor 1 has a closed-end tube
made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from
approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner conditions. The
heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM adjusts
the injection pulse duration to achieve the ideal air-fuel ratio. The
ideal air-fuel ratio occurs near the radical change from 1V to 0V.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FSO
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FSP
To judge the malfunction, the output from the heated oxygen sensor
1 is monitored to determine whether the rich output is sufficiently
high and whether the lean output is sufficiently low. When both the
outputs are shifting to the lean side, the malfunction will be detected.
SEF463R
SEF288D
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 (B1)
HO2S1 (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1)
HO2S1 MNTR (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times dur-
ing 10 seconds.
SEF300U
DTC P1143, P1163 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-427
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FSQ
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
G Always perform at a temperature above 10C (14F).
G Before performing following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Stop engine and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select HO2S1 (B1) P1143 of HO2S1 or HO2S1 (B2) P1163 of HO2S1
in DTC WORK SUPPORT mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch START.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 3 minutes.
NOTE:
Never raise engine speed above 3,600 rpm (M/T models) or
3,200 rpm (A/T models) after this step. If the engine speed
limit is exceeded, return to step 5.
6. When the following conditions are met, TESTING will be dis-
played on the CONSULT-II screen. Maintain the conditions con-
tinuously until TESTING changes to COMPLETED. (It will
take approximately 50 seconds or more.)
If TESTING is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from step 2.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1143
1143
(Bank 1)
Heated oxygen sensor 1
lean shift monitoring
The maximum and minimum voltage from the
sensor are not reached to the specified voltages.
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
G Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
G Fuel pressure
G Injectors
G Intake air leaks
P1163
1163
(Bank 2)
PBIB0546E
ENG SPEED 1,200 - 2,600 rpm (A/T models)
1,300 - 3,000 rpm (M/T models)
Vehicle speed 50 - 100 km/h (30 - 62 MPH)
B/FUEL SCHDL 3.0 - 6.5 msec (A/T models)
2.4 - 5.5 msec (M/T models)
Selector lever Suitable position
PBIB0547E
EC-428
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1143, P1163 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
7. Make sure that OK is displayed after touching SELF-DIAG
RESULTS. If NG is displayed, refer to EC-428, "Diagnostic
Procedure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00FSR
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] or 36 [HO2S1 (B2) signal] and
engine ground.
3. Check one of the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm
constant under no load.
The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
The minimum voltage is over 0.1V at least one time.
4. If NG, go to EC-428, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FSS
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
SEC769C
MBIB0019E
MBIB0095E
DTC P1143, P1163 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-429
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. RETIGHTEN HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Loosen and retighten corresponding heated oxygen sensor 1.
>> GO TO 3.
3. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 or P0174 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure that DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-73, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure that DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 or P0174 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0171, P0174. Refer to EC-291 .
No >> GO TO 4.
4. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 HEATER
Refer to EC-169, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 1.
Tightening torque: 40 - 60 Nm (4.1 - 6.2 kg-m, 30 - 44 ft-lb)
MBIB0099E
SEF215Z
MBIB0096E
EC-430
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1143, P1163 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-430, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 1.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
For circuit, refer to EC-207, "Wiring Diagram" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FST
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG and adjust TRIGGER POINT to 100% in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-
II.
3. Select HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) and HO2S1 MNTR (B1)/(B2).
4. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load during the following steps.
5. Touch RECORD on CONSULT-II screen.
6. Check the following.
G HO2S1 MNTR (B1)/(B2) in DATA MONITOR mode
changes from RICH to LEAN to RICH 5 times in 10 sec-
onds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage goes below 0.3V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
SEF646Y
SEF647Y
SEF648Y
DTC P1143, P1163 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-431
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] or 36 [HO2S1 (B2) signal] and
engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
G The voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new
one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FSU
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-23, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER" .
MBIB0019E
EC-432
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1144 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
DTC P1144 HO2S1 (QG16DE) PFP:22690
Component Description EBS00FSV
The heated oxygen sensor 1 is placed into the exhaust manifold. It
detects the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas compared to the
outside air. The heated oxygen sensor 1 has a closed-end tube
made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from
approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner conditions. The
heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM adjusts
the injection pulse duration to achieve the ideal air-fuel ratio. The
ideal air-fuel ratio occurs near the radical change from 1V to 0V.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FSW
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FSX
To judge the malfunction, the output from the heated oxygen sensor
1 is monitored to determine whether the rich output is sufficiently
high. The lean output is sufficiently low. When both the outputs are
shifting to the rich side, the malfunction will be detected.
SEF463R
SEF288D
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times dur-
ing 10 seconds.
SEF299UA
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1144
1144
Heated oxygen sensor 1
rich shift monitoring
The maximum and minimum voltages from the
sensor are beyond the specified voltages.
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
G Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
G Fuel pressure
G Injectors
DTC P1144 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-433
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FSY
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
G Always perform at a temperature above 10C (14F).
G Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Stop engine and wait at least 5 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select HO2S1 (B1) P1144 of HO2S1 in DTC WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch START.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 3 minutes.
NOTE:
Never raise engine speed above 3,600 rpm after this step. If
the engine speed limit is exceeded, return to step 5.
6. When the following conditions are met, TESTING will be dis-
played on the CONSULT-II screen. Maintain the conditions con-
tinuously until TESTING changes to COMPLETED. (It will
take approximately 50 seconds or more.)
If TESTING is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from
step 2.
7. Make sure that OK is displayed after touching SELF-DIAG
RESULTS. If NG is displayed, refer to EC-434, "Diagnostic
Procedure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00FSZ
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
PBIB0548E
ENG SPEED 1,300 - 3,000 rpm
Vehicle speed 50 - 100 km/h (30 - 62 MPH)
B/FUEL SCHDL 2.4 - 5.5 msec
Selector lever Suitable position
PBIB0549E
SEC772C
EC-434
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1144 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
3. Check one of the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm
constant under no load.
The maximum voltage is below 0.8V at least one time.
The minimum voltage is below 0.32V at least one time.
4. If NG, go to EC-434, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FT0
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
2. RETIGHTEN HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Loosen and retighten heated oxygen sensor 1.
>> GO TO 3.
MBIB0018E
MBIB0095E
Tightening torque: 40 - 60 Nm (4.1 - 6.2 kg-m, 30 - 44 ft-lb)
MBIB0098E
DTC P1144 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-435
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure that DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-73, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure that DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0172. Refer to EC-299 .
No >> GO TO 4.
4. CHECK HO2S1 CONNECTOR FOR WATER
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
3. Check connectors for water.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
SEF215Z
MBIB0096E
Water should not exist.
MBIB0091E
EC-436
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1144 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 HEATER
Refer to EC-161, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
6. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-436, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
For circuit, refer to EC-201, "Wiring Diagram" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FT1
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG and adjust TRIGGER POINT to 100% in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-
II.
3. Select HO2S1 (B1) and HO2S1 MNTR (B1).
4. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load during the follow-
ing steps.
5. Touch RECORD on CONSULT-II screen.
6. Check the following.
G HO2S1 MNTR (B1) in DATA MONITOR mode changes
from RICH to LEAN to RICH 5 times in 10 seconds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes below 0.3V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
SEF646Y
SEF217YA
DTC P1144 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-437
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
G The voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new
one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FT2
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-23, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER" .
SEF648Y
MBIB0018E
EC-438
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1144, P1164 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
DTC P1144, P1164 HO2S1 (QG18DE) PFP:22690
Component Description EBS00FT3
The heated oxygen sensor 1 is placed into the exhaust manifold. It
detects the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas compared to the
outside air. The heated oxygen sensor 1 has a closed-end tube
made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from
approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner conditions. The
heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM adjusts
the injection pulse duration to achieve the ideal air-fuel ratio. The
ideal air-fuel ratio occurs near the radical change from 1V to 0V.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FT4
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FT5
To judge the malfunction, the output from the heated oxygen sensor
1 is monitored to determine whether the rich output is sufficiently
high. The lean output is sufficiently low. When both the outputs are
shifting to the rich side, the malfunction will be detected.
SEF463R
SEF288D
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 (B1)
HO2S1 (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1)
HO2S1 MNTR (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times dur-
ing 10 seconds.
SEF299UA
DTC P1144, P1164 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-439
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FT6
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
G Always perform at a temperature above 10C (14F).
G Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Stop engine and wait at least 5 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select HO2S1 (B1) P1144 or HO2S1 (B2) P1164 of HO2S1 in DTC
WORK SUPPORT mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch START.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 3 minutes.
NOTE:
Never raise engine speed above 3,600 rpm (M/T models) or
3,200 rpm (A/T models) after this step. If the engine speed
limit is exceeded, return to step 5.
6. When the following conditions are met, TESTING will be dis-
played on the CONSULT-II screen. Maintain the conditions con-
tinuously until TESTING changes to COMPLETED. (It will
take approximately 50 seconds or more.)
If TESTING is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from step 2.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1144
1144
(Bank 1)
Heated oxygen sensor 1
rich shift monitoring
The maximum and minimum voltages from the
sensor are beyond the specified voltages.
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
G Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
G Fuel pressure
G Injectors
P1164
1164
(Bank 2)
PBIB0548E
ENG SPEED 1,200 - 2,600 rpm (A/T models)
1,300 - 3,000 rpm (M/T models)
Vehicle speed 50 - 100 km/h (30 - 62 MPH)
B/FUEL SCHDL 3.0 - 6.5 msec (A/T models)
2.4 - 5.5 msec (M/T models)
Selector lever Suitable position
PBIB0549E
EC-440
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1144, P1164 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
7. Make sure that OK is displayed after touching SELF-DIAG
RESULTS. If NG is displayed, refer to EC-440, "Diagnostic
Procedure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00FT7
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] or 36 [HO2S1 (B2) signal] and
engine ground.
3. Check one of the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm
constant under no load.
The maximum voltage is below 0.8V at least one time.
The minimum voltage is below 0.32V at least one time.
4. If NG, go to EC-440, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FT8
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
SEC772C
MBIB0019E
MBIB0095E
DTC P1144, P1164 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-441
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. RETIGHTEN HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Loosen and retighten heated oxygen sensor 1.
>> GO TO 3.
3. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 or P0175 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure that DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-73, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure that DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 or P0175 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0172, P0175. Refer to EC-305 .
No >> GO TO 4.
Tightening torque: 40 - 60 Nm (4.1 - 6.2 kg-m, 30 - 44 ft-lb)
MBIB0099E
SEF215Z
MBIB0096E
EC-442
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1144, P1164 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
4. CHECK HO2S1 CONNECTOR FOR WATER
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
3. Check connectors for water.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 HEATER
Refer to EC-169, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 1.
6. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-442, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 1.
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
For circuit, refer to EC-207, "Wiring Diagram" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FT9
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG and adjust TRIGGER POINT to 100% in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-
II.
3. Select HO2S1 (B1) and HO2S1 MNTR (B1).
4. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load during the following steps.
5. Touch RECORD on CONSULT-II screen.
Water should not exist.
MBIB0092E
SEF646Y
DTC P1144, P1164 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-443
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. Check the following.
G HO2S1 MNTR (B1)/(B2) in DATA MONITOR mode
changes from RICH to LEAN to RICH 5 times in 10 sec-
onds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage goes below 0.3V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] or 36 [HO2S1 (B2) signal] and
engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
G The voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new
one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FTA
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-23, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER" .
SEF647Y
SEF648Y
MBIB0019E
EC-444
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1146 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
DTC P1146 HO2S2 (QG16DE) PFP:226A0
Component Description EBS00FTB
The heated oxygen sensor 2, after three way catalyst, monitors the
oxygen level in the exhaust gas.
Even if switching characteristics of the heated oxygen sensor 1 are
shifted, the air fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal
from the heated oxygen sensor 2.
This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates volt-
age from approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner condi-
tions.
Under normal conditions the heated oxygen sensor 2 is not used for
engine control operation.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FTC
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FTE
The heated oxygen sensor 2 has a much longer switching time
between rich and lean than the heated oxygen sensor 1. The oxygen
storage capacity before the three way catalyst causes the longer
switching time. To judge the malfunctions of heated oxygen sensor
2, ECM monitors whether the minimum voltage of sensor is suffi-
ciently low during the various driving condition such as fuel-cut.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FTF
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
G COMPLETED will appear on CONSULT-II screen when all tests COND1, COND2 and
COND3 are completed.
G If DTC confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and
wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Never stop engine during this procedure. If the engine is stopped, retry procedure from step 2 in Pro-
cedure for COND1
SEF327R
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S2 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S2 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
LEAN RICH
SEF258VA
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1146
1146
Heated oxygen sensor 2
minimum voltage monitoring
The minimum voltage from the sensor is not
reached to the specified voltage.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 2
G Fuel pressure
G Injectors
DTC P1146 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
EC-445
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
WITH CONSULT-II
Procedure for COND1
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select HO2S2 (B1) P1146 of HO2S2 in DTC WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch START.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 30 seconds.
6. Rev engine up to 2,000 rpm 2 or 3 times quickly under no load.
If COMPLETED appears on CONSULT-II screen, go to step 2 in Procedure for COND3.
If COMPLETED does not appear on CONSULT-II screen, go to the following step.
7. Drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
8. When the following conditions are met, TESTING will be displayed at COND1 on the CONSULT-II
screen. Maintain the conditions continuously until TESTING changes to COMPLETED. (It will take
approximately 60 seconds.)
NOTE:
G If TESTING is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from step 2 in Procedure for COND1.
G If COMPLETED already appears at COND2 on CONSULT-II screen before Procedure for
COND2 is conducted, it is unnecessary to conduct step 1 in Procedure for COND2.
Procedure for COND2
1. While driving, release accelerator pedal completed from the
above condition [step 8] until INCOMPLETE at COND2 on
CONSULT-II screen has turned to COMPLETED (It will take
approximately 4 seconds.)
NOTE:
If COMPLETE already appears at COND3 on CONSULT-
II screen before Procedure for COND3 is conducted, it is
unnecessary to conduct step 1 in Procedure for COND3.
ENG SPEED More than 1,000 rpm
B/FUEL SCHDL More than 1.0 msec
COOLANT TEMP/S 70 - 105C
Selector lever Suitable position
PBIB0555E
PBIB0556E
EC-446
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1146 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
Procedure for COND3
1. Stop vehicle and let it idle until INCOMPLETE of COND3 on
CONSULT-II screen has turned to COMPLETED. (It will take a
maximum of approximately 6 minutes.)
2. Make sure that OK is displayed after touching SELF-DIAG
RESULTS.
If NG is displayed, refer to EC-448, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00FTG
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 2 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 (HO2S2 signal) and engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be below 0.56V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage can be confirmed in step 4, step 5 is not nec-
essary.
5. Keep vehicle at idling for 10 minutes, then check the voltage. Or
check the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in 3rd
gear position.
The voltage should be below 0.56V at least once during this
procedure.
6. If NG, go to EC-448, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEC775C
MBIB0020E
DTC P1146 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
EC-447
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00FTH
MBWA0050E
EC-448
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1146 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FTI
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
16 W Heated oxygen sensor 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0095E
DTC P1146 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
EC-449
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure that DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-73, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure that DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0172. Refer to EC-299 .
No >> GO TO 3.
3. CHECK HO2S2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S2
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
SEF215Z
MBIB0096E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0093E
EC-450
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1146 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
4. CHECK HO2S2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 16 and HO2S2 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 16 or HO2S2 terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EC-450, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FTJ
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Select FUEL INJECTION in ACTIVE TEST mode, and select
HO2S2 (B1) as the monitor item with CONSULT-II.
4. Check HO2S2 (B1) at idle speed when adjusting FUEL INJECTION to 25%.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
SEF662Y
PBIB0551E
DTC P1146 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
EC-451
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
HO2S2 (B1) should be above 0.68V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is +25%.
HO2S2 (B1) should be below 0.56V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is 25%.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 (HO2S2 signal) and engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.68V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage is above 0.68V at step 4, step 5 is not neces-
sary.
5. Keep vehicle at idling for 10 minutes, then check voltage. Or
check the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in 3rd
gear position.
The voltage should be below 0.56V at least once during this
procedure.
6. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FTK
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EX-3, "EXHAUST SYSTEM" .
MBIB0020E
EC-452
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1146, P1166 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
DTC P1146, P1166 HO2S2 (QG18DE) PFP:226A0
Component Description EBS00FTL
The heated oxygen sensor 2, after three way catalyst, monitors the
oxygen level in the exhaust gas on each bank.
Even if switching characteristics of the heated oxygen sensor 1 are
shifted, the air fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal
from the heated oxygen sensor 2.
This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates volt-
age from approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner condi-
tions.
Under normal conditions the heated oxygen sensor 2 is not used for
engine control operation.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FTM
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FTO
The heated oxygen sensor 2 has a much longer switching time
between rich and lean than the heated oxygen sensor 1. The oxygen
storage capacity before the three way catalyst causes the longer
switching time. To judge the malfunctions of heated oxygen sensor
2, ECM monitors whether the minimum voltage of sensor is suffi-
ciently low during the various driving condition such as fuel-cut.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FTP
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
G COMPLETED will appear on CONSULT-II screen when all tests COND1, COND2 and
COND3 are completed.
G If DTC confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and
wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Never stop engine during this procedure. If the engine is stopped, retry procedure from step 2 in Pro-
cedure for COND1
SEF327R
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S2 (B1)
HO2S2 (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S2 MNTR (B1)
HO2S2 MNTR (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
LEAN RICH
SEF258VA
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1146
1146
(Bank 1)
Heated oxygen sensor 2
minimum voltage monitoring
The minimum voltage from the sensor is
not reached to the specified voltage.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 2
G Fuel pressure
G Injectors
P1166
1166
(Bank 2)
DTC P1146, P1166 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-453
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
WITH CONSULT-II
Procedure for COND1
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select HO2S2 (B1) P1146 or HO2S2 (B2) P1166 of HO2S2 in DTC
WORK SUPPORT mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch START.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 30 seconds.
6. Rev engine up to 2,000 rpm 2 or 3 times quickly under no load.
If COMPLETED appears on CONSULT-II screen, go to step 2 in Procedure for COND3.
If COMPLETED does not appear on CONSULT-II screen, go to the following step.
7. Drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
8. When the following conditions are met, TESTING will be displayed at COND1 on the CONSULT-II
screen. Maintain the conditions continuously until TESTING changes to COMPLETED. (It will take
approximately 60 seconds.)
NOTE:
G If TESTING is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from step 2 in Procedure for COND1.
G If COMPLETED already appears at COND2 on CONSULT-II screen before Procedure for
COND2 is conducted, it is unnecessary to conduct step 1 in Procedure for COND2.
Procedure for COND2
1. While driving, release accelerator pedal completed with OD
OFF (A/T models only) from the above condition [step 8] until
INCOMPLETE at COND2 on CONSULT-II screen has turned
to COMPLETED (It will take approximately 4 seconds.)
NOTE:
If COMPLETE already appears at COND3 on CONSULT-
II screen before Procedure for COND3 is conducted, it is
unnecessary to conduct step 1 in Procedure for COND3.
ENG SPEED More than 1,000 rpm
B/FUEL SCHDL More than 1.0 msec
COOLANT TEMP/S 70 - 105C
Selector lever Suitable position
PBIB0555E
PBIB0556E
EC-454
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1146, P1166 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
Procedure for COND3
1. Stop vehicle and let it idle until INCOMPLETE of COND3 on
CONSULT-II screen has turned to COMPLETED. (It will take a
maximum of approximately 6 minutes.)
2. Make sure that OK is displayed after touching SELF-DIAG
RESULTS.
If NG is displayed, refer to EC-458, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00FTQ
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 2 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 17 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be below 0.56V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage can be confirmed in step 4, step 5 is not nec-
essary.
5. Keep vehicle at idling for 10 minutes, then check the voltage. Or
check the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D
position with OD OFF (A/T), 3rd gear position (M/T).
The voltage should be below 0.56V at least once during this
procedure.
6. If NG, go to EC-458, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEC775C
MBIB0021E
DTC P1146, P1166 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-455
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00FTR
BANK 1
MBWA0056E
EC-456
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1146, P1166 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
16 Y
Heated oxygen sensor 2
(bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
DTC P1146, P1166 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-457
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
BANK 2
MBWA0058E
EC-458
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1146, P1166 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FTS
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
17 L
Heated oxygen sensor 2
(bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0095E
DTC P1146, P1166 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-459
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 or P0175 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure that DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-73, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure that DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 or P0175 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0172, P0175. Refer to EC-305 .
No >> GO TO 3.
3. CHECK HO2S2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S2
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
SEF215Z
MBIB0096E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0094E
EC-460
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1146, P1166 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
4. CHECK HO2S2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal and HO2S2 terminal as follows.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between the following terminals and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EC-460, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FTT
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Select FUEL INJECTION in ACTIVE TEST mode, and select
HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) as the monitor item with CONSULT-II.
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P1146 16 2 1
P1166 17 2 2
Continuity should exist.
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P1146 16 2 1
P1166 17 2 2
Continuity should not exist.
SEF662Y
DTC P1146, P1166 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-461
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. Check HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) at idle speed when adjusting FUEL INJECTION to 25%.
HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) should be above 0.68V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is +25%.
HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) should be below 0.56V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is 25%.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 17 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.68V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage is above 0.68V at step 4, step 5 is not neces-
sary.
5. Keep vehicle at idling for 10 minutes, then check voltage. Or
check the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D
position with OD OFF (A/T), 3rd gear position (M/T).
The voltage should be below 0.56V at least once during this
procedure.
6. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FTU
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EX-3, "EXHAUST SYSTEM" .
PBIB0551E
MBIB0021E
EC-462
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1147 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
DTC P1147 HO2S2 (QG16DE) PFP:226A0
Component Description EBS00FTV
The heated oxygen sensor 2, after three way catalyst, monitors the
oxygen level in the exhaust gas.
Even if switching characteristics of the heated oxygen sensor 1 are
shifted, the air fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal
from the heated oxygen sensor 2.
This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates volt-
age from approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner condi-
tions.
Under normal conditions the heated oxygen sensor 2 is not used for
engine control operation.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FTW
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FTY
The heated oxygen sensor 2 has a much longer switching time
between rich and lean than the heated oxygen sensor 1. The oxygen
storage capacity before the three way catalyst causes the longer
switching time. To judge the malfunctions of heated oxygen sensor
2, ECM monitors whether the maximum voltage of the sensor is suf-
ficiently high during the various driving condition such as fuel-cut.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FTZ
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
G COMPLETED will appear on CONSULT-II screen when all tests COND1, COND2 and
COND3 are completed.
G If DTC confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and
wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Never stop engine during this procedure. If the engine is stopped, retry procedure from step 2 in Pro-
cedure for COND1
SEF327R
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S2 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S2 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
LEAN RICH
SEF259VA
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1147
1147
Heated oxygen sensor 2
maximum voltage monitoring
The maximum voltage from the sensor is
not reached to the specified voltage.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 2
G Fuel pressure
G Injectors
G Intake air leaks
DTC P1147 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
EC-463
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
WITH CONSULT-II
Procedure for COND1
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select HO2S2 (B1) P1147 of HO2S2 in DTC WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch START.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 30 seconds.
6. Rev engine up to 2,000 rpm 2 or 3 times quickly under no load.
If COMPLETED appears on CONSULT-II screen, go to step 2 in Procedure for COND3.
If COMPLETED does not appear on CONSULT-II screen, go to the following step.
7. Drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
8. When the following conditions are met, TESTING will be displayed at COND1 on the CONSULT-II
screen. Maintain the conditions continuously until TESTING changes to COMPLETED. (It will take
approximately 60 seconds.)
NOTE:
G If TESTING is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from step 2 in Procedure for COND1.
G If COMPLETED already appears at COND2 on CONSULT-II screen before Procedure for
COND2 is conducted, it is unnecessary to conduct step 1 in Procedure for COND2.
Procedure for COND2
1. While driving, release accelerator pedal completed from the
above condition [step 8] until INCOMPLETE at COND2 on
CONSULT-II screen has turned to COMPLETED (It will take
approximately 4 seconds.)
NOTE:
If COMPLETE already appears at COND3 on CONSULT-
II screen before Procedure for COND3 is conducted, it is
unnecessary to conduct step 1 in Procedure for COND3.
ENG SPEED More than 1,000 rpm
B/FUEL SCHDL More than 1.0 msec
COOLANT TEMP/S 70 - 105C
Selector lever Suitable position
PBIB0557E
PBIB0558E
EC-464
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1147 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
Procedure for COND3
1. Stop vehicle and let it idle until INCOMPLETE of COND3 on
CONSULT-II screen has turned to COMPLETED. (It will take a
maximum of approximately 6 minutes.)
2. Make sure that OK is displayed after touching SELF-DIAG
RESULTS.
If NG is displayed, refer to EC-466, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00FU0
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 2 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 (HO2S2 signal) and engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.68V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage can be confirmed in step 4, step 5 is not nec-
essary.
5. Keep vehicle idling for 10 minutes, then check the voltage. Or
check the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in 3rd
gear position.
The voltage should be above 0.68V at least once during this
procedure.
6. If NG, go to EC-466, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEC778C
MBIB0020E
DTC P1147 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
EC-465
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00FU1
MBWA0050E
EC-466
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1147 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FU2
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
16 W Heated oxygen sensor 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0095E
DTC P1147 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
EC-467
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure that DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-73, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure that DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0171. Refer to EC-285 .
No >> GO TO 3.
3. CHECK HO2S2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S2
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
SEF215Z
MBIB0096E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0093E
EC-468
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1147 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
4. CHECK HO2S2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 16 and HO2S2 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 16 or HO2S2 terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EC-468, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FU3
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Select FUEL INJECTION in ACTIVE TEST mode, and select
HO2S2 (B1) as the monitor item with CONSULT-II.
4. Check HO2S2 (B1) at idle speed when adjusting FUEL INJECTION to 25%.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
SEF662Y
PBIB0551E
DTC P1147 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
EC-469
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
HO2S2 (B1) should be above 0.68V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is +25%.
HO2S2 (B1) should be below 0.56V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is 25%.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 (HO2S2 signal) and engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.68V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage is above 0.68V at step 4, step 5 is not neces-
sary.
5. Keep vehicle idling for 10 minutes, then check voltage. Or check
the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in 3rd gear
position.
The voltage should be below 0.56V at least once during this
procedure.
6. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FU4
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EX-3, "EXHAUST SYSTEM" .
MBIB0020E
EC-470
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1147, P1167 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
DTC P1147, P1167 HO2S2 (QG18DE) PFP:226A0
Component Description EBS00FU5
The heated oxygen sensor 2, after three way catalyst, monitors the
oxygen level in the exhaust gas on each bank.
Even if switching characteristics of the heated oxygen sensor 1 are
shifted, the air fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal
from the heated oxygen sensor 2.
This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates volt-
age from approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner condi-
tions.
Under normal conditions the heated oxygen sensor 2 is not used for
engine control operation.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FU6
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FU8
The heated oxygen sensor 2 has a much longer switching time
between rich and lean than the heated oxygen sensor 1. The oxygen
storage capacity before the three way catalyst causes the longer
switching time. To judge the malfunctions of heated oxygen sensor
2, ECM monitors whether the maximum voltage of the sensor is suf-
ficiently high during the various driving condition such as fuel-cut.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00FU9
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
G COMPLETED will appear on CONSULT-II screen when all tests COND1, COND2 and
COND3 are completed.
G If DTC confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and
wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
SEF327R
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S2 (B1)
HO2S2 (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S2 MNTR (B1)
HO2S2 MNTR (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
LEAN RICH
SEF259VA
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1147
1147
(Bank 1)
Heated oxygen sensor 2
maximum voltage monitoring
The maximum voltage from the sensor is
not reached to the specified voltage.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 2
G Fuel pressure
G Injectors
G Intake air leaks
P1167
1167
(Bank 2)
DTC P1147, P1167 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-471
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Never stop engine during this procedure. If the engine is stopped, retry procedure from step 2 in Pro-
cedure for COND1
WITH CONSULT-II
Procedure for COND1
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select HO2S2 (B1) P1147 or HO2S2 (B2) P1167 of HO2S2 in DTC
WORK SUPPORT mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch START.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 30 seconds.
6. Rev engine up to 2,000 rpm 2 or 3 times quickly under no load.
If COMPLETED appears on CONSULT-II screen, go to step 2 in Procedure for COND3.
If COMPLETED does not appear on CONSULT-II screen, go to the following step.
7. Drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
8. When the following conditions are met, TESTING will be displayed at COND1 on the CONSULT-II
screen. Maintain the conditions continuously until TESTING changes to COMPLETED. (It will take
approximately 60 seconds.)
NOTE:
G If TESTING is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from step 2 in Procedure for COND1.
G If COMPLETED already appears at COND2 on CONSULT-II screen before Procedure for
COND2 is conducted, it is unnecessary to conduct step 1 in Procedure for COND2.
Procedure for COND2
1. While driving, release accelerator pedal completed with OD
OFF (A/T models only) from the above condition [step 8] until
INCOMPLETE at COND2 on CONSULT-II screen has turned
to COMPLETED (It will take approximately 4 seconds.)
NOTE:
If COMPLETE already appears at COND3 on CONSULT-
II screen before Procedure for COND3 is conducted, it is
unnecessary to conduct step 1 in Procedure for COND3.
ENG SPEED More than 1,000 rpm
B/FUEL SCHDL More than 1.0 msec
COOLANT TEMP/S 70 - 105C
Selector lever Suitable position
PBIB0557E
PBIB0558E
EC-472
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1147, P1167 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
Procedure for COND3
1. Stop vehicle and let it idle until INCOMPLETE of COND3 on
CONSULT-II screen has turned to COMPLETED. (It will take a
maximum of approximately 6 minutes.)
2. Make sure that OK is displayed after touching SELF-DIAG
RESULTS.
If NG is displayed, refer to EC-476, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00FUA
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 2 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 17 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.68V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage can be confirmed in step 4, step 5 is not nec-
essary.
5. Keep vehicle idling for 10 minutes, then check the voltage. Or
check the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D
position with OD OFF (A/T), 3rd gear position (M/T).
The voltage should be above 0.68V at least once during this
procedure.
6. If NG, go to EC-476, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEC778C
MBIB0021E
DTC P1147, P1167 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-473
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00FUB
BANK 1
MBWA0056E
EC-474
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1147, P1167 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
16 Y
Heated oxygen sensor 2
(bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
DTC P1147, P1167 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-475
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
BANK 2
MBWA0058E
EC-476
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1147, P1167 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FUC
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
17 L
Heated oxygen sensor 2
(bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0095E
DTC P1147, P1167 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-477
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 or P0174 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure that DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-73, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure that DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 or P0174 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0171, P0174. Refer to EC-291 .
No >> GO TO 3.
3. CHECK HO2S2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S2
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
SEF215Z
MBIB0096E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0094E
EC-478
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1147, P1167 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
4. CHECK HO2S2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal and HO2S2 terminal as follows.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between the following terminals and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EC-478, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FUD
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Select FUEL INJECTION in ACTIVE TEST mode, and select
HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) as the monitor item with CONSULT-II.
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P1147 16 2 1
P1167 17 2 2
Continuity should exist.
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P1147 16 2 1
P1167 17 2 2
Continuity should not exist.
SEF662Y
DTC P1147, P1167 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-479
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. Check HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) at idle speed when adjusting FUEL INJECTION to 25%.
HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) should be above 0.68V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is +25%.
HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) should be below 0.56V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is 25%.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 17 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.68V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage is above 0.68V at step 4, step 5 is not neces-
sary.
5. Keep vehicle idling for 10 minutes, then check voltage. Or check
the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D posi-
tion with OD OFF (A/T), 3rd gear position (M/T).
The voltage should be below 0.56V at least once during this
procedure.
6. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FUE
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EX-3, "EXHAUST SYSTEM" .
PBIB0551E
MBIB0021E
EC-480
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE PFP:00000
System Description EBS00EQD
NOTE:
If DTC P1217 is displayed with DTC U1000, U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-150, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
COOLING FAN CONTROL
*1: The ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
*2: These signals are sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
The ECM controls the cooling fan corresponding to the vehicle speed, engine coolant temperature, refrigerant
pressure, and air conditioner ON signal. The control system has 2-step control [ON/OFF].
The ECM sends a cooling fan control signal to the smart entrance control unit through CAN communication
line, and the smart entrance control unit controls cooling fan relays.
OPERATION
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EQE
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
*1
Cooling fan
control
Cooling fan relay(s)
Battery
Battery voltage
*1
Vehicle speed signal
Vehicle speed
*2
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Air conditioner switch Air conditioner ON signal
*2
Refrigerant pressure sensor Refrigerant pressure
MBIB0036E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
AIR COND SIG
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Air conditioner switch: OFF OFF
Air conditioner switch: ON
(Compressor operates.)
ON
COOLING FAN
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
Engine coolant temperature is 99C
(210F) or less
OFF
Engine coolant temperature is 100C
(212F) or more
ON
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-481
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EQF
If the cooling fan or another component in the cooling system malfunctions, engine coolant temperature will
rise. When the engine coolant temperature reaches an abnormally high temperature condition, a malfunction
is indicated.
CAUTION:
When a malfunction is indicated, be sure to replace the coolant. Refer to CO-8, "Changing Engine
Coolant" . Also, replace the engine oil. Refer to LU-7, "Changing Engine Oil" .
1. Fill radiator with coolant up to specified level with a filling speed of 2 liters per minute. Be sure to
use coolant with the proper mixture ratio. Refer to MA-18, "Engine Coolant Mixture Ratio" .
2. After refilling coolant, run engine to ensure that no water-flow noise is emitted.
Overall Function Check EBS00EQG
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the cooling fan. During this check, a DTC might not be con-
firmed.
WARNING:
Never remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could be caused by high pres-
sure fluid escaping from the radiator.
Wrap a thick cloth around cap. Carefully remove the cap by turning it a quarter turn to allow built-up
pressure to escape. Then turn the cap all the way off.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Check the coolant level in the reservoir tank and radiator.
Allow engine to cool before checking coolant level.
If the coolant level in the reservoir tank and/or radiator is below
the proper range, skip the following steps and go to EC-484,
"Diagnostic Procedure" .
2. Confirm whether customer filled the coolant or not. If customer
filled the coolant, skip the following steps and go to EC-484,
"Diagnostic Procedure" .
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1217
1217
Engine over tempera-
ture (Overheat)
G Cooling fan does not operate properly (Over-
heat).
G Cooling fan system does not operate prop-
erly (Overheat).
G Engine coolant was not added to the system
using the proper filling method.
G Harness or connectors
(The cooling fan circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Harness or connectors
(The CAN communication line is open or
shorted.)
G Cooling fan
G Radiator hose
G Radiator
G Radiator cap
G Water pump
G Thermostat
For more information, refer to EC-488,
"Main 12 Causes of Overheating" .
SEF621W
EC-482
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
4. Perform COOLING FAN in ACTIVE TEST mode with CON-
SULT-II.
5. If the results are NG, go to EC-484, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
1. Check the coolant level in the reservoir tank and radiator.
Allow engine to cool before checking coolant level.
If the coolant level in the reservoir tank and/or radiator is below
the proper range, skip the following steps and go to EC-484,
"Diagnostic Procedure" .
2. Confirm whether customer filled the coolant or not. If customer
filled the coolant, skip the following steps and go to EC-484,
"Diagnostic Procedure" .
3. Start engine.
Be careful not to overheat engine.
4. Turn air conditioner switch ON.
5. Turn blower fan switch ON.
6. Make sure that cooling fans operate.
If NG, go to EC-484, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
MBIB0037E
SEF621W
SEC163BA
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-483
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00EQH
MBWA0068E
EC-484
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EQI
1. INSPECTION START
Do you have CONSULT-II?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> GO TO 3.
2. CHECK COOLING FAN OPERATION
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle.
2. Select COOLING FAN in ACTIVE TEST mode with CON-
SULT-II and touch ON on the CONSULT-II screen.
3. Make sure that cooling fans-1 and -2 operate.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Check cooling fan control circuit. (Go to EC-486, "PRO-
CEDURE A" .)
3. CHECK COOLING FAN OPERATION
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle.
2. Turn air conditioner switch ON.
3. Turn blower fan switch ON.
4. Make sure that cooling fans-1 and -2 operate.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Check cooling fan control circuit. (Go to EC-486, "PRO-
CEDURE A" .)
MBIB0037E
SEC163BA
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-485
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. CHECK COOLING SYSTEM FOR LEAK
Apply pressure to the cooling system with a tester, and check if the
pressure drops.
CAUTION:
Higher than the specified pressure may cause radiator damage.
Pressure should not drop.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Check the following for leak
G Hose
G Radiator
G Water pump
Refer to CO-18, "WATER PUMP" .
5. CHECK RADIATOR CAP
Apply pressure to cap with a tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace radiator cap.
6. CHECK THERMOSTAT
1. Check valve seating condition at normal room temperatures.
It should seat tightly.
2. Check valve opening temperature and valve lift.
3. Check if valve is closed at 5C (9F) below valve opening tem-
perature.
For details, refer to CO-20, "THERMOSTAT AND THERMOSTAT
HOUSING" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace thermostat
7. CHECK ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Refer to EC-198, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace engine coolant temperature sensor.
Testing pressure: 157 kPa (1.6 kg/cm
2
, 23 psi)
SLC754A
Radiator cap relief pressure: 59 - 98 kPa
(0.6 - 1.0 kg/cm
2
, 9 - 14 psi)
SLC755A
Valve opening temperature: 82C (180F) [standard]
Valve lift: More than 8 mm/95C
(0.31 in/203F)
SLC343
EC-486
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
8. CHECK MAIN 12 CAUSES
If the cause cannot be isolated, go to EC-488, "Main 12 Causes of Overheating" .
>> INSPECTION END
PROCEDURE A
1. CHECK COOLING FAN POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect cooling fan relay-1.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between cooling fan relay-1 terminals 1, 3, 6 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Fuse block (J/B) connector E106
G 10A fuse
G 30A fusible links
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-1 and fuse
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-1 and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0108E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0951E
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-487
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTORS CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect cooling fan motor-1 harness connector and cooling
fan motor-2 harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between cooling fan relay-1 terminal 5
and cooling fan motor-1 terminal 1, cooling fan motor-1 terminal
2 and body ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
5. Check harness continuity between cooling fan relay-1 terminal 7
and cooling fan motor-2 terminal 1, cooling fan motor-2 terminal
2 and body ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
6. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK COOLING FAN OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect smart entrance control unit.
2. Check harness continuity between smart entrance control unit
terminal 33 and cooling fan relay-1 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E123, M17 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E110, M94 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between smart entrance control unit and cooling fan relay-1
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK COOLING FAN RELAY-1
Refer to EC-489, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace cooling fan relay.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0109E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0173E
EC-488
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
7. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTORS
Refer to EC-489, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace cooling fan motors.
8. CHECK SMART ENTRANCE CONTROL UNIT
Refer to EC-489, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace smart entrance control unit.
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Perform EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Main 12 Causes of Overheating EBS00EQJ
Engine Step Inspection item Equipment Standard Reference page
OFF 1 G Blocked radiator
G Blocked condenser
G Blocked radiator grille
G Blocked bumper
G Visual No blocking
2 G Coolant mixture G Coolant tester 50 - 50% coolant mixture See MA-18, "Engine
Coolant Mixture Ratio" .
3 G Coolant level G Visual Coolant up to MAX level
in reservoir tank and radi-
ator filler neck
See MA-20, "Changing
Engine Coolant" .
4 G Radiator cap G Pressure tester 59 - 98 kPa
(0.6 - 1.0 kg/cm
2
, 9 - 14
psi) (Limit)
See MA-22, "CHECKING
RADIATOR CAP" .
ON*
2
5 G Coolant leaks G Visual No leaks See MA-23, "CHECKING
COOLINGSYSTEMFOR
LEAKS" .
ON*
2 6 G Thermostat G Touch the upper and
lower radiator hoses
Both hoses should be hot See CO-20, "THERMO-
STAT AND THERMO-
STAT HOUSING" , and
CO-11, "RADIATOR" .
ON*
1
7 G Cooling fan G CONSULT-II Operating See trouble diagnosis for
DTC P1217 (EC-480 ).
OFF 8 G Combustion gas leak G Color checker chemical
tester 4 Gas analyzer
Negative
ON*
3 9 G Coolant temperature
gauge
G Visual Gauge less than 3/4
when driving

G Coolant overflow to
reservoir tank
G Visual No overflowduring driving
and idling
See MA-20, "Changing
Engine Coolant" .
OFF*
4
10 G Coolant return from
reservoir tank to radia-
tor
G Visual Should be initial level in
reservoir tank
See CO-8, "LEVEL
CHECK" .
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-489
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
*1: Turn the ignition switch ON.
*2: Engine running at 3,000 rpm for 10 minutes.
*3: Drive at 90 km/h (55 MPH) for 30 minutes and then let idle for 10 minutes.
*4: After 60 minutes of cool down time.
For more information, refer to CO-5, "OVERHEATING CAUSE ANALYSIS" .
Component Inspection EBS00EQK
COOLING FAN RELAY-1
1. Apply 12V direct current between relay terminals 1 and 2.
2. Check continuity between relay terminals 3 and 5, 6 and 7.
3. If NG, replace cooling fan relay.
COOLING FAN MOTORS-1 AND -2
1. Disconnect cooling fan motor harness connectors.
2. Supply cooling fan motor terminals with battery voltage and
check operation.
Cooling fan motor should operate.
3. If NG, replace cooling fan motor.
OFF 11 G Cylinder head G Straight gauge feeler
gauge
0.1 mm (0.004 in) Maxi-
mum distortion (warping)
See EM-57, "CYLINDER
HEAD" .
12 G Cylinder block and pis-
tons
G Visual No scuffing on cylinder
walls or piston
See EM-57, "CYLINDER
HEAD" .
Engine Step Inspection item Equipment Standard Reference page
Condition Continuity
12V direct current supply
between terminals 1 and 2
Yes
OFF No
PBIB0077E
Terminals
(+) ()
Cooling fan motor 1 2
MBIB0109E
EC-490
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00EQL
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor,
throttle position sensor, etc. The throttle position sensor responds to
the throttle valve movement.
The throttle position sensor has the two sensors. These sensors are
a kind of potentiometers which transform the throttle valve position
into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM. In addi-
tion, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of the
throttle valve and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM
judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these sig-
nals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the
throttle valve opening angle properly in response to driving condi-
tion.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EQM
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EQN
These self-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EQO
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 8V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0145E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
THRTL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released More than 0.36V
G Shift lever:
D (A/T model)
1st (M/T model)
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1223
1223
Throttle position sensor 2
circuit low input
An excessively low voltage from the TP sensor 2
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The TP sensor 2 circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 2)
P1224
1224
Throttle position sensor 2
circuit high input
An excessively high voltage from the TP sensor 2
is sent to ECM.
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
EC-491
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-493, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
SEF058Y
EC-492
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00EQP
MBWA0137E
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
EC-493
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EQQ
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
47 G
Sensor power supply
(Throttle position sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
49 W Throttle position sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
More than 0.36V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
Less than 4.75V
66 B
Sensor ground
(Throttle position sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
68 R Throttle position sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
Less than 4.75V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 0.36V
MBIB0095E
EC-494
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
2. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between electric throttle control actuator terminal
1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 66 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 68 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
Refer to EC-495, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
MBIB0100E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0082E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
EC-495
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EQR
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Set selector lever to D position (A/T models) or 1st position (M/T models).
5. Check voltage between ECM terminals 49 (TP sensor 1 signal),
68 (TP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the following
conditions.
6. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to the next
step.
7. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
8. Perform EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00EQS
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-19, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
49
(Throttle position sensor 1)
Fully released More than 0.36V
Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
68
(Throttle position sensor 2)
Fully released Less than 4.75V
Fully depressed More than 0.36V
MBIB0022E
EC-496
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1225 TP SENSOR
DTC P1225 TP SENSOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00EQT
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor,
throttle position sensor, etc. The throttle position sensor responds to
the throttle valve movement.
The throttle position sensor has the two sensors. These sensors are
a kind of potentiometers which transform the throttle valve position
into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM. In addi-
tion, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of the
throttle valve and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM
judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these sig-
nals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the
throttle valve opening angle properly in response to driving condi-
tion.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EQU
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EQV
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-497, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITH GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
PBIB0145E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1225
1225
Closed throttle position
learning performance
problem
Closed throttle position learning value is excessively
low.
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 1 and 2)
SEF058Y
DTC P1225 TP SENSOR
EC-497
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EQW
1. CHECK ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR VISUALLY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Remove the intake air duct.
3. Check if foreign matter is caught between the throttle valve and
the housing.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Remove the foreign matter and clean the electric throttle
control actuator inside.
2. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
Remove and Installation EBS00EQX
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-19, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
MBIB0107E
EC-498
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1226 TP SENSOR
DTC P1226 TP SENSOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00EQY
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor,
throttle position sensor, etc. The throttle position sensor responds to
the throttle valve movement.
The throttle position sensor has the two sensors. These sensors are
a kind of potentiometers which transform the throttle valve position
into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM. In addi-
tion, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of the
throttle valve and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM
judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these sig-
nals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the
throttle valve opening angle properly in response to driving condi-
tion.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EQZ
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00ER0
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4, 32 times.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-499, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITH GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
PBIB0145E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1226
1226
Closed throttle position
learning performance
problem
Closed throttle position learning is not performed
successfully, repeatedly.
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 1 and 2)
SEF058Y
DTC P1226 TP SENSOR
EC-499
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00ER1
1. CHECK ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR VISUALLY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Remove the intake air duct.
3. Check if foreign matter is caught between the throttle valve and
the housing.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Remove the foreign matter and clean the electric throttle
control actuator inside.
2. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
Remove and Installation EBS00ER2
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-19, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
MBIB0107E
EC-500
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR PFP:18002
Component Description EBS00ER3
The accelerator pedal position sensor is installed on the upper end
of the accelerator pedal assembly. The sensor detects the accelera-
tor position and sends a signal to the ECM.
Accelerator pedal position sensor has two sensors. These sensors
are a kind of potentiometers which transform the accelerator pedal
position into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM.
In addition, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of
the accelerator pedal and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The
ECM judges the current opening angle of the accelerator pedal from
these signals and controls the throttle control motor based on these
signals.
Idle position of the accelerator pedal is determined by the ECM
receiving the signal from the accelerator pedal position sensor. The ECM uses this signal for the engine oper-
ation such as fuel cut.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00ER4
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00ER5
These self-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00ER6
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 8V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0146E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
ACCEL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released 0.41 - 0.71V
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed More than 4.2V
CLSD THL POS G Ignition switch: ON
Accelerator pedal: Fully released ON
Accelerator pedal: Slightly depressed OFF
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1227
1227
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2 circuit low input
An excessively low voltage from the APP sensor 2
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The APP sensor 2 circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Accelerator pedal position sensor
(Accelerator pedal position sensor 2)
P1228
1228
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2 circuit high input
An excessively high voltage from the APP sensor 2
is sent to ECM.
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
EC-501
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-503, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
SEF058Y
EC-502
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00ER7
MBWA0141E
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
EC-503
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00ER8
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
82 B
Sensor ground
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
83 B
Sensor ground
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 0V
90 R
Sensor power supply
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
91 G
Sensor power supply
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
98 LG
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.175 - 0.335V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 1.95V
106 L
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.35 - 0.67V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.9V
MBIB0095E
EC-504
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
2. CHECK APP SENSOR 2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor harness
connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between APP sensor terminal 1 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK APP SENSOR 2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 83 and APP sensor terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0152E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0812E
Continuity should exist.
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
EC-505
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK APP SENSOR 2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 98 and APP sensor terminal 6.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK APP SENSOR
Refer to EC-505, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 9.
9. REPLACE APP SENSOR
1. Replace the accelerator pedal position sensor.
2. Perform EC-55, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
10. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00ER9
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminals 106 (APP sensor 1 sig-
nal), 98 (APP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the fol-
lowing conditions.
Continuity should exist.
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
106
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Fully depressed More than 3.9V
98
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
Fully released 0.175 - 0.335V
Fully depressed More than 1.95V
MBIB0023E
EC-506
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
4. If NG, replace accelerator pedal assembly and go to the next step.
5. Perform EC-55, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
6. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
7. Perform EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00ERA
ACCELERATOR PEDAL
Refer to ACC-2, "ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM" .
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY
EC-507
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY PFP:16119
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00ERB
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00ERC
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 8V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-509, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1229
1229
Sensor power supply circuit
short
ECM detects a voltage of power source
for sensor is excessively low or high.
G Harness or connectors
(The TP sensor 1 and 2 circuit is shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 1 and 2)
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return
spring.
SEF058Y
EC-508
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY
Wiring Diagram EBS00ERD
MBWA0139E
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY
EC-509
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00ERE
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between electric throttle control actuator terminal
1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
47 G
Sensor power supply
(Throttle position sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
MBIB0095E
MBIB0100E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0082E
EC-510
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY
3. CHECK SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUITS FOR SHORT
Check the following.
G Harness for short to power and short to ground between ECM terminal 47 and electric throttle control
actuator terminal 1.
G ECM pin terminal.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
Refer to EC-317, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-55, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-55, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
DTC P1706 PNP SWITCH
EC-511
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1706 PNP SWITCH PFP:32006
Component Description EBS00ERF
When the shift lever position is P (A/T models only) or N, park/neutral position (PNP) switch is ON.
ECM detects the position because the continuity of the line (the ON signal) exists.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00ERG
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00ERH
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00ERI
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select P/N POSI SW in DATA MONITOR mode with CON-
SULT-II. Then check the P/N POSI SW signal under the follow-
ing conditions.
If NG, go to EC-514, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If OK, go to following step.
3. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
5. Maintain the following conditions for at least 60 consecutive sec-
onds.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-514, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
P/N POSI SW G Ignition switch: ON
Shift lever:
P or N (A/T model)
Neutral (M/T model)
ON
Shift lever: Except above OFF
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1706
1706
Park/neutral position switch
The signal of the park/neutral position (PNP)
switch is not changed in the process of
engine starting and driving.
G Harness or connectors
(PNP switch circuit is open or shorted.)
G Park/neutral position (PNP) switch
Position (Selector lever) Known-good signal
N and P position ON
Except the above position OFF
ENG SPEED 1,200 - 6,000 rpm (A/T models)
1,300 - 6,000 rpm (M/T models)
COOLAN TEMP/S More than 70C (158F)
B/FUEL SCHDL More than 3.0 msec (A/T models)
More than 2.7 msec (M/T models)
VHCL SPEED SE More than 46 km/h (30 MPH)
Selector lever Suitable position
SEF212Y
SEF213Y
EC-512
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1706 PNP SWITCH
Overall Function Check EBS00ERJ
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the park/neutral position (PNP) switch circuit. During this
check, a 1st trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 102 (PNP switch signal)
and body ground under the following conditions.
3. If NG, go to EC-514, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Condition (Gear position) Voltage V (Known-good data)
P (A/T models only) and N position Approximately 0
Except the above position
A/T models: Battery voltage
M/T models: Approximately 5
MBIB0029E
DTC P1706 PNP SWITCH
EC-513
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00ERK
MBWA0069E
EC-514
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1706 PNP SWITCH
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00ERL
1. CHECK PNP SWITCH GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect PNP switch harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between PNP switch terminal 2 and
body ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or con-
nectors.
2. CHECK PNP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 102 and PNP switch terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK PNP SWITCH
Refer to AT-110, "DTC P0705 PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION (PNP) SWITCH" (A/T models) or MT-14, "POSI-
TION SWITCH" , MT-62, "POSITION SWITCH" (M/T models).
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Replace PNP switch.
4. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
102
P (A/T)
G/OR (M/T)
PNP switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is P or N (A/T models),
Neutral (M/T models).
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Except the above gear position
A/T models
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
M/T models
Approximately 5V
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0110E
Continuity should exist.
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH
EC-515
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH PFP:25320
Description EBS00ERM
Brake switch signal is applied to the ECM through the stop lamp switch when the brake pedal is depressed.
This signal is used mainly to decrease the engine speed when the vehicle is driving.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00ERN
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00ERO
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00ERP
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Fully depress the brake pedal for at least 5 seconds.
3. Erase the DTC with CONSULT-II.
4. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-517, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
BRAKE SW G Ignition switch: ON
Brake pedal: Fully released OFF
Brake pedal: Slightly depressed ON
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1805
1805
Brake switch
A brake switch signal is not sent to ECM for
an extremely long time while the vehicle is
driving.
G Harness or connectors
(Stop lamp switch circuit is open or shorted.)
G Stop lamp switch
SEF058Y
EC-516
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH
Wiring Diagram EBS00ERQ
MBWA0091E
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH
EC-517
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00ERR
1. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check the stop lamp when depressing and releasing the brake pedal.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect stop lamp switch harness connector.
2. Check voltage between stop lamp switch terminal 1 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
101 R/G Stop lamp switch
[Engine is running]
G Brake pedal fully released
Approximately 0V
[Engine is running]
G Brake pedal depressed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
Brake pedal Stop lamp
Fully released Not illuminated
Depressed Illuminated
MBIB0152E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0117E
EC-518
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G 15A fuse
G Fuse block (J/B) connector M2
G Harness for open and short between stop lamp switch and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Disconnect stop lamp switch harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 101 and stop
lamp switch terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and stop lamp switch
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH
Refer to EC-519, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace stop lamp switch.
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0152E
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH
EC-519
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Component Inspection EBS00ERS
STOP LAMP SWITCH
1. Disconnect stop lamp switch harness connector.
2. Check continuity between stop lamp switch terminals 1 and 2
under the following conditions.
If NG, adjust brake pedal installation, refer to BR-6, "BRAKE
PEDAL" , and perform step 2 again.
MBIB0152E
Conditions Continuity
Brake pedal fully released Should not exist.
Brake pedal depressed Should exist.
PBIB0118E
EC-520
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
IGNITION SIGNAL
IGNITION SIGNAL PFP:22448
Component Description EBS00ERT
IGNITION COIL & POWER TRANSISTOR
The ignition signal from the ECM is sent to and amplified by the
power transistor. The power transistor turns on and off the ignition
coil primary circuit. This on-off operation induces the proper high
voltage in the coil secondary circuit.
MBIB0111E
IGNITION SIGNAL
EC-521
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00ERU
MBWA0087E
EC-522
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
IGNITION SIGNAL
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
111 W/G
ECM relay
(Self shut-off)
[Engine is running]
[Ignition switch OFF]
G For a few seconds after turning ignition
switch OFF
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch OFF]
G More than a few seconds passed after turn-
ing ignition switch OFF
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
119
120
W
W
Power supply for ECM [Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
IGNITION SIGNAL
EC-523
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
MBWA0088E
EC-524
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
IGNITION SIGNAL
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00ERV
1. CHECK ENGINE START
Turn ignition switch OFF, and restart engine.
Is engine running?
Yes or No
Yes (With CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 2.
Yes (Without CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 3.
No >> GO TO 4.
2. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
With CONSULT-II
1. Perform POWER BALANCE in ACTIVE TEST mode with CONSULT-II.
2. Make sure that each circuit produces a momentary engine
speed drop.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 10.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
60
61
79
80
L/R
BR
GY/R
PU
Ignition signal No. 3
Ignition signal No. 1
Ignition signal No. 4
Ignition signal No. 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0 - 0.1V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - 0.2V
PBIB0521E
PBIB0522E
PBIB0133E
IGNITION SIGNAL
EC-525
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
Without CONSULT-II
1. Let engine idle.
2. Read the voltage signal between ECM terminals 60, 61, 79, 80
and ground with an oscilloscope.
3. Verify that the oscilloscope screen shows the signal wave as
shown below.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 10.
4. CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-I
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminals 119, 120 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Go to EC-144, "POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM"
.
5. CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-II
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect condenser harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between condenser terminal 1 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 6.
MBIB0033E
PBIB0521E
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0034E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0624E
EC-526
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
IGNITION SIGNAL
6. CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-III
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM relay.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM relay terminal 7 and
condenser terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-IV
Check voltage between ECM relay terminal 6 and ground with CON-
SULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> GO TO 8.
8. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E70, F13 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E63, F31 (RHD models)
G 20A fuse
G Harness for open or short between ECM relay and battery
>> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
9. CHECK ECM RELAY
Refer to EC-528, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> Replace ECM relay.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0155E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0625E
IGNITION SIGNAL
EC-527
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
10. CHECK CONDENSER GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect condenser harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between condenser terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connector.
11. CHECK CONDENSER
Refer to EC-528, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Replace condenser.
12. CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-V
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
3. Disconnect ignition coil harness connector.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
5. Check voltage between ignition coil terminal 1 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14.
NG >> GO TO 13.
13. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between ignition coil and ECM relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0111E
Voltage: Battery voltage
SEF107S
EC-528
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
IGNITION SIGNAL
14. CHECK IGNITION COIL GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between ignition coil terminal 2 and engine ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 15.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
15. CHECK IGNITION COIL OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals 60, 61, 79, 80 and ignition coil terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 16.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
16. CHECK IGNITION COIL WITH POWER TRANSISTOR
Refer to EC-528, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> Replace ignition coil with power transistor.
17. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00ERW
ECM RELAY
1. Apply 12V direct current between ECM relay terminals 1 and 2.
2. Check continuity between relay terminals 3 and 5, 6 and 7.
3. If NG, replace ECM relay.
CONDENSER
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect condenser harness connector.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
Condition Continuity
12V direct current supply
between terminals 1 and 2
Yes
OFF No
PBIB0077E
IGNITION SIGNAL
EC-529
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. Check resistance between condenser terminals 1 and 2.
IGNITION COIL WITH POWER TRANSISTOR
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ignition coil harness connector.
3. Check resistance between ignition coil terminals as follows.
Removal and Installation EBS00ERX
IGNITION COIL WITH POWER TRANSISTOR
Refer to EM-29, "IGNITION COIL" .
Resistance: Above 1 M at 25C (77F)
MBIB0031E
Terminal No. Resistance [at 25C (77F)]
3 and 1 Except 0 or
3 and 2
Except 0
1 and 2
MBIB0032E
EC-530
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
INJECTOR CIRCUIT PFP:16600
Component Description EBS00ES5
The fuel injector is a small, precise solenoid valve. When the ECM
supplies a ground to the injector circuit, the coil in the injector is
energized. The energized coil pulls the needle valve back and allows
fuel to flow through the injector into the intake manifold. The amount
of fuel injected depends upon the injection pulse duration. Pulse
duration is the length of time the injector remains open. The ECM
controls the injection pulse duration based on engine fuel needs.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00ES6
Specification data are reference values.
*: This item is displayed with QG18DE engine models.
SEF375Z
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
B/FUEL SCHDL
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 1.5 - 3.0 msec
2,000 rpm 1.2 - 3.0 msec
INJ PULSE-B1
INJ PULSE-B2
*
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 2.0 - 3.5 msec
2,000 rpm 1.5 - 3.5 msec
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
EC-531
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00ES7
MBWA0086E
EC-532
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00ES8
1. INSPECTION START
Turn ignition switch to START.
Is any cylinder ignited?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> GO TO 3.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
22
23
41
42
G/B
R/B
L/B
Y/B
Injector No. 3
Injector No. 1
Injector No. 4
Injector No. 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
PBIB0529E
PBIB0530E
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
EC-533
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Perform POWER BALANCE in ACTIVE TEST mode with
CONSULT-II.
3. Make sure that each circuit produces a momentary engine
speed drop.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Listen to each injector operating sound.
Clicking noise should be heard.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 3.
PBIB0133E
MEC703B
EC-534
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
3. CHECK INJECTOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect injector harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between injector terminal 1 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Fuse block (J/B) connector M1
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between injector and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK INJECTOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between injector terminal 2 and ECM terminals 22, 23, 41, 42.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK INJECTOR
Refer to EC-535, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace injector.
MBIB0101E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0582E
Continuity should exist.
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
EC-535
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00ES9
INJECTOR
1. Disconnect injector harness connector.
2. Check resistance between terminals as shown in the figure.
Removal and Installation EBS00ESA
INJECTOR
Refer to EM-31, "FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE" .
Resistance: 13.5 - 17.5 [at 20C (68F)]
PBIB0181E
EC-536
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT PFP:17042
Description EBS00ESE
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
*: The ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
The ECM activates the fuel pump for several seconds after the ignition switch is turned on to improve engine
startability. If the ECM receives a engine speed signal from the crankshaft position sensor (POS) and cam-
shaft position sensor (PHASE), it knows that the engine is rotating, and causes the pump to operate. If the
engine speed signal is not received when the ignition switch is ON, the engine stalls. The ECM stops pump
operation and prevents battery discharging, thereby improving safety. The ECM does not directly drive the fuel
pump. It controls the ON/OFF fuel pump relay, which in turn controls the fuel pump.
COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
A turbine type design fuel pump is used in the fuel tank.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00ESF
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
*
Fuel pump control Fuel pump relay
Battery
Battery voltage
*
Condition Fuel pump operation
Ignition switch is turned to ON. Operates for 1 second.
Engine running and cranking Operates.
When engine is stopped Stops in 1.5 seconds.
Except as shown above Stops.
MBIB0046E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
FUEL PUMP RLY
G For 1 seconds after turning ignition switch ON
G Engine running or cranking
ON
G Except above conditions OFF
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
EC-537
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00ESG
MBWA0031E
EC-538
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00ESH
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Pinch fuel feed hose with two fingers.
Fuel pressure pulsation should be felt on the fuel hose for 1
second after ignition switch is turned ON.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK FUEL PUMP RELAY POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect fuel pump relay.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between fuel pump relay terminals 1, 5 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
113 B/P Fuel pump relay
[Ignition switch ON]
G For 1 seconds after turning ignition switch ON
[Engine is running]
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G More than 1 seconds after turning ignition switch
ON.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
MBIB0114E
MBIB0154E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0657E
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
EC-539
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Fuse block (J/B) connector B1
G 10A fuse
G 15A fuse
G Harness for open or short between fuel pump relay and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK FUEL PUMP POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump harness con-
nector.
3. Check harness continuity between fuel pump relay terminal 3
and fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump terminal 5, fuel level
sensor unit and fuel pump terminal 3 and body ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors B37, D83
G Harness for open or short between fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump and fuel pump relay
G Harness for open or short between fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump and body ground
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK FUEL PUMP RELAY OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 113 and fuel pump relay terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0115E
Continuity should exist.
EC-540
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness connectors B5, M23 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors B42, M95 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between ECM and fuel pump relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK FUEL PUMP RELAY
Refer to EC-540, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace fuel pump relay.
9. CHECK FUEL PUMP
Refer to EC-540, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> Replace fuel pump.
10. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00ESI
FUEL PUMP RELAY
Check continuity between terminals 3 and 5 under the following con-
ditions.
FUEL PUMP
1. Disconnect fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump harness connector.
2. Check resistance between fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump
terminals 3 and 5.
Conditions Continuity
12V direct current supply
between terminals 1 and 2
Yes
No current supply No
PBIB0098E
Resistance: Approximately 1.0 [at 25C (77F)]
PBIB0658E
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
EC-541
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Removal and Installation EBS00ESJ
FUEL PUMP
Refer to DI-32, "FUEL LEVEL SENSOR UNIT CHECK" .
EC-542
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR PFP:92136
Component Description EBS00ESQ
The refrigerant pressure sensor is installed at the liquid tank of the
air conditioner system. The sensor uses an electrostatic volume
pressure transducer to convert refrigerant pressure to voltage. The
voltage signal is sent to ECM, and ECM controls cooling fan system.
MBIB0116E
SEF099X
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
EC-543
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00ESR
MBWA0090E
EC-544
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00ESS
1. CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR OVERALL FUNCTION
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn A/C switch and blower switch ON.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminal 69 and ground with CON-
SULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
46 R
Sensor power supply
(Refrigerant pressure sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
57 B
Sensor ground
(Refrigerant pressure sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
69
W (LHD)
B (RHD)
Refrigerant pressure sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Both A/C switch and blower switch are ON.
(Compressor operates.)
1.0 - 4.0V
Voltage: 1.0 - 4.0V
MBIB0035E
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
EC-545
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn A/C switch and blower switch OFF.
2. Stop engine.
3. Disconnect refrigerant pressure sensor harness connector.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
5. Check voltage between refrigerant pressure sensor terminal 3
and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness for open or short between ECM and refrigerant pressure sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 57 and refrigerant pressure sensor terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness for open or short between ECM and refrigerant pressure sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0116E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
SEF479Y
Continuity should exist.
EC-546
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
6. CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 69 and refrigerant pressure sensor terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness for open or short between ECM and refrigerant pressure sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
OK or NG
OK >> Replace refrigerant pressure sensor.
NG >> Repair or replace.
Removal and Installation EBS00EST
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
Refer to ATC-127, "REFRIGERANT LINES" .
Continuity should exist.
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL
EC-547
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL PFP:25350
Description EBS00ESU
The electrical load signals except headlamp switch signal are transferred through the CAN communication
line.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H63
Specification data are reference values.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
LOAD SIGNAL G Ignition switch: ON
Rear window defogger switch is ON and/or lighting
switch is 2nd.
ON
Rear window defogger switch is OFF and lighting
switch is OFF.
OFF
EC-548
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL
Wiring Diagram EBS00H64
MBWA0147E
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL
EC-549
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H65
1. CHECK LOAD SIGNAL CIRCUIT OVERALL FUNCTION-I
With CONSULT-II
With GST
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Connect CONSULT-II or GST and select DATA MONITOR mode.
3. Select LOAD SIGNAL and check indication under the following
conditions.
OK or NG
OK (With CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 2.
OK (Without CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 4.
2. CHECK LOAD SIGNAL CIRCUIT OVERALL FUNCTION-II
With CONSULT-II
Check LOAD SIGNAL indication under the following conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 5.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
84 R/Y
Electrical load signal
(Headlamp signal)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Lighting switch is 2ND position
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Lighting switch is OFF
Approximately 0V
Condition Indication
Rear window defogger switch ON ON
Rear window defogger switch OFF OFF
PBIB0103E
Condition Indication
Lighting switch ON at 2nd position ON
Lighting switch OFF OFF
PBIB0103E
EC-550
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL
3. CHECK LOAD SIGNAL CIRCUIT OVERALL FUNCTION-II
Without CONSULT-II
Check voltage between ECM terminal 84 and ground under the fol-
lowing conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 5.
4. CHECK REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
Refer to GW-40, "REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER" .
>> INSPECTION END
5. CHECK HEADLAMP FUNCTION
1. Turn lighting switch ON at 2nd position.
2. Check that headlamps are illuminated.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Refer to LT-5, "HEADLAMP -CONVENTIONAL TYPE-" , LT-10, "HEADLAMP - XENON TYPE -" ,
LT-18, "HEADLAMP (WITH DAYTIME) - CONVENTIONAL TYPE -" or LT-25, "HEADLAMP
(WITH DAYTIME) - XENON TYPE -" .
Condition Voltage
Lighting switch ON at 2nd position Battery voltage
Lighting switch OFF Approximately 0V
MBIB0158E
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL
EC-551
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK HEADLAMP INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
CONVENTIONAL TYPE HEADLAMP WITHOUT DAYTIME LIGHT SYSTEM
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Disconnect lighting switch harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 84 and lighting switch terminal 10.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
CONVENTIONAL TYPE HEADLAMP WITH DAYTIME LIGHT SYSTEM
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Disconnect daytime light relay.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 84 and daytime light relay terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
XENON TYPE HEADLAMP
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Disconnect headlamp LH relay.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 84 and headlamp LH relay terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G harness for open and short between ECM and lighting switch
G harness for open and short between ECM and daytime light relay
G harness for open and short between ECM and headlamp LH relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-143, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
EC-552
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
MI & DATA LINK CONNECTORS
MI & DATA LINK CONNECTORS PFP:24814
Wiring DiagramLHD Models EBS00ESW
MBWA0151E
MI & DATA LINK CONNECTORS
EC-553
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring DiagramRHD Models EBS00H9S
MBWA0152E
EC-554
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM PFP:14950
Description EBS00ESX
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The evaporative emission system is used to reduce hydrocarbons emitted into the atmosphere from the fuel
system. This reduction of hydrocarbons is accomplished by activated charcoals in the EVAP canister.
The fuel vapor in the sealed fuel tank is led into the EVAP canister which contains activated carbon and the
vapor is stored there when the engine is not operating or when refueling to the fuel tank.
The vapor in the EVAP canister is purged by the air through the purge line to the intake manifold when the
engine is operating. EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve is controlled by ECM. When the
engine operates, the flow rate of vapor controlled by EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve is
proportionally regulated as the air flow increases.
EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve also shuts off the vapor purge line during decelerating and
idling.
PBIB0491E
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM
EC-555
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION LINE DRAWING
MBIB0014E
EC-556
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM
Component Inspection EBS00ESY
EVAP CANISTER
Check EVAP canister as follows:
1. Block port B . Orally blow air through port A .
Check that air flows freely through port C .
2. Block port A . Orally blow air through port B .
Check that air flows freely through port C .
FUEL CHECK VALVE
1. Blow air through connector on fuel tank side.
A considerable resistance should be felt and a portion of air flow
should be directed toward the EVAP canister side.
2. Blow air through connector on EVAP canister side.
Air flow should be smoothly directed toward fuel tank side.
3. If fuel check valve is suspected of not properly functioning in
steps 1 and 2 above, replace it.
FUEL TANK VACUUM RELIEF VALVE (BUILT INTO FUEL FILLER CAP)
1. Wipe clean valve housing.
2. Check valve opening pressure and vacuum.
3. If out of specification, replace fuel filler cap as an assembly.
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Refer to EC-374, "Component Inspection" .
PBIB0663E
SEF552Y
SEF989X
Pressure: 15.3 - 20.0 kPa (0.153 - 0.200 bar,
0.156 - 0.204 kg/cm
2
, 2.22 - 2.90 psi)
Vacuum: 6.0 to 3.3 kPa (0.060 to 0.033 bar,
0.061 to 0.034 kg/cm
2
, 0.87 to 0.48 psi)
SEF943S
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION
EC-557
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION PFP:11810
Description EBS00ESZ
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
This system returns blow-by gas to the intake manifold.
The positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) valve is provided to conduct crankcase blow-by gas to the intake
manifold. During partial throttle operation of the engine, the intake manifold sucks the blow-by gas through the
PCV valve. Normally, the capacity of the valve is sufficient to handle any blow-by and a small amount of venti-
lating air. The ventilating air is then drawn from the air inlet tubes into the crankcase. In this process the air
passes through the hose connecting air inlet tubes to rocker cover. Under full-throttle condition, the manifold
vacuum is insufficient to draw the blow-by flow through the valve. The flow goes through the hose connection
in the reverse direction.
On vehicles with an excessively high blow-by, the valve does not
meet the requirement. This is because some of the flow will go
through the hose connection to the air inlet tubes under all condi-
tions.
Component Inspection EBS00ET0
PCV (POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION) VALVE
With engine running at idle, remove PCV valve from rocker cover. A
properly working valve makes a hissing noise as air passes through
it. A strong vacuum should be felt immediately when a finger is
placed over valve inlet.
PBIB0492E
SEF559A
SEC137A
EC-558
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION
PCV VALVE VENTILATION HOSE
1. Check hoses and hose connections for leaks.
2. Disconnect all hoses and clean with compressed air. If any hose
cannot be freed of obstructions, replace.
S-ET277
SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
EC-559
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS) PFP:00030
Fuel Pressure EBS00ET1
Idle Speed and Ignition Timing EBS00ET2
*1: Under the following conditions:
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Electric load: OFF (Lights, heater fan & rear window defogger)
G Steering wheel: Kept in straight-ahead position
Calculated Load Value EBS00ET3
Mass Air Flow Sensor EBS00ET4
*: Engine is warmed up to normal operating temperature and running under no-load.
Intake Air Temperature Sensor EBS00ET5
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor EBS00ET6
Heated Oxygen Sensor 1 Heater EBS00ET7
Heated Oxygen sensor 2 Heater EBS00ET8
Crankshaft Position Sensor (POS) EBS00ET9
Refer to EC-353, "Component Inspection" .
Camshaft Position Sensor (PHASE) EBS00ETA
Refer to EC-359, "Component Inspection" .
Fuel pressure at idle
Approximately 350 kPa (3.7kg/cm
2
, 51psi)
Target idle speed
No-load*1 (in P or N position)
A/T: 80050 rpm
M/T: 70050 rpm
Air conditioner: ON In P or N position 825 rpm or more
Ignition timing
In P or N position A/T: 105 BTDC
M/T: 85 BTDC
Calculated load value % (Using CONSULT-II or GST)
At idle 10 - 35
At 2,500 rpm 10 - 35
Supply voltage Battery voltage (11 - 14V)
Output voltage at idle 1.0 - 1.7*V
Mass air flow (Using CONSULT-II or GST)
1.0 - 4.0 gm/sec at idle*
5.0 - 10.0 gm/sec at 2,500 rpm*
Temperature C (F) Resistance k
25 (77) 1.9 - 2.1
80 (176) 0.31 - 0.37
Temperature C (F) Resistance k
20 (68) 2.1 - 2.9
50 (122) 0.68 - 1.00
90 (194) 0.236 - 0.260
Resistance [at 20C (68F)] 8 - 10
Resistance [at 25C (77F)] 2.3 - 4.3
EC-560
[QG (WITH EURO-OBD)]
SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
Throttle Control Motor EBS00ETB
Injector EBS00ETC
Fuel Pump EBS00ETD
Resistance [at 25C (77F)] Approximately 1 - 15
Resistance [at 20C (68F)] 13.5 - 17.5
Resistance [at 25C (77F)] Approximately 1.0
INDEX FOR DTC
EC-561
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
INDEX FOR DTC PFP:00024
Alphabetical Index EBS00ETE
Check if the vehicle is a model with Euro-OBD (E-OBD) system or not by the Type approval number on the
identification plate. Refer to GI-46, "IDENTIFICATION PLATE" .
NOTE:
If DTC U1000 or U1001 is displayed with other DTC, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-663, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
QG16DE ENGINE MODELS
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC
*1
Reference page
CONSULT-II
*2
ECM
*3
APP SEN 1/CIRC
*5
P0227 0227 EC-742
APP SEN 1/CIRC
*5
P0228 0228 EC-742
APP SEN 2/CIRC
*5
P1227 1227 EC-821
APP SEN 2/CIRC
*5
P1228 1228 EC-821
APP SENSOR
*5
P0226 0226 EC-735
BRAKE SW/CIRCUIT P1805 1805 EC-832
CAN COMM CIRCUIT
*6
U1001 1001 EC-663
CKP SEN/CIRCUIT P0335 0335 EC-753
CMP SEN/CIRC-B1 P0340 0340 EC-760
CTP LEARNING P1225 1225 EC-817
CTP LEARNING P1226 1226 EC-819
ECM P0605 0605 EC-767
ECM BACK UP/CIRC P1065 1065 EC-770
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT
*5
P0117 0117 EC-672
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT
*5
P0118 0118 EC-672
ENG OVER TEMP P1217 1217 EC-801
ETC ACTR
*5
P1121 1121 EC-780
ETC FUNCTION/CIRC
*5
P1122 1122 EC-783
ETC MOT
*5
P1128 1128 EC-796
ETC MOT PWR
*5
P1124 1124 EC-790
ETC MOT PWR
*5
P1126 1126 EC-790
HO2S1 (B1) P0132 0132 EC-677
HO2S1 (B1) P0134 0134 EC-692
HO2S2 (B1) P0138 0138 EC-707
KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 P0327 0327 EC-749
KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 P0328 0328 EC-749
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT
*5
P0102 0102 EC-666
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT
*5
P0103 0103 EC-666
MAF SENSOR
*5
P1102 1102 EC-774
NATS MALFUNCTION P1610 - P1615 1610 - 1615 EC-595
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.
No DTC Flashing
*4
EC-596
EC-562
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
INDEX FOR DTC
*1: 1st trip DTC No. is the same as DTC No.
*2: These numbers are prescribed by ISO 15031-5.
*3: In Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results), these numbers are controlled by NISSAN.
*4: When engine is running.
*5: When the fail-safe operation occurs, the MI illuminates.
*6: The trouble shooting for this DTC needs CONSULT-II.
QG18DE ENGINE MODELS
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.
P0000 0000
SENSOR POWER/CIRC
*5
P1229 1229 EC-828
TP SEN 1/CIRC
*5
P0222 0222 EC-729
TP SEN 1/CIRC
*5
P0223 0223 EC-729
TP SEN 2/CIRC
*5
P1223 1223 EC-811
TP SEN 2/CIRC
*5
P1224 1224 EC-811
TP SENSOR
*5
P0221 0221 EC-723
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC
*1
Reference page
CONSULT-II
*2
ECM
*3
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC
*1
Reference page
CONSULT-II
*2
ECM
*3
APP SEN 1/CIRC
*5
P0227 0227 EC-742
APP SEN 1/CIRC
*5
P0228 0228 EC-742
APP SEN 2/CIRC
*5
P1227 1227 EC-821
APP SEN 2/CIRC
*5
P1228 1228 EC-821
APP SENSOR
*5
P0226 0226 EC-735
BRAKE SW/CIRCUIT P1805 1805 EC-832
CAN COMM CIRCUIT
*5
U1000 1000 EC-663
CAN COMM CIRCUIT
*6
U1001 1001 EC-663
CKP SEN/CIRCUIT P0335 0335 EC-753
CMP SEN/CIRC-B1 P0340 0340 EC-760
CTP LEARNING P1225 1225 EC-817
CTP LEARNING P1226 1226 EC-819
ECM P0605 0605 EC-767
ECM BACK UP/CIRC P1065 1065 EC-770
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT
*5
P0117 0117 EC-672
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT
*5
P0118 0118 EC-672
ENG OVER TEMP P1217 1217 EC-801
ETC ACTR
*5
P1121 1121 EC-780
ETC FUNCTION/CIRC
*5
P1122 1122 EC-783
ETC MOT
*5
P1128 1128 EC-796
ETC MOT PWR
*5
P1124 1124 EC-790
ETC MOT PWR
*5
P1126 1126 EC-790
HO2S1 (B1) P0132 0132 EC-683
INDEX FOR DTC
EC-563
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
*1: 1st trip DTC No. is the same as DTC No.
*2: These numbers are prescribed by ISO 15031-5.
*3: In Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results), these numbers are controlled by NISSAN.
*4: When engine is running.
*5: When the fail-safe operation occurs, the MI illuminates.
*6: The trouble shooting for this DTC needs CONSULT-II.
NOTE:
Regarding P12 models with QG18DE engine, B1 indicates bank 1, B2 indicates bank 2.
DTC No. Index EBS00ETF
Check if the vehicle is a model with Euro-OBD (E-OBD) system or not by the Type approval number on the
identification plate. Refer to GI-46, "IDENTIFICATION PLATE" .
NOTE:
If DTC U1000 or U1001 is displayed with other DTC, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-663, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
QG16DE ENGINE MODELS
HO2S1 (B1) P0134 0134 EC-698
HO2S1 (B2) P0152 0152 EC-683
HO2S1 (B2) P0154 0154 EC-698
HO2S2 (B1) P0138 0138 EC-714
HO2S2 (B2) P0158 0158 EC-714
KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 P0327 0327 EC-749
KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 P0328 0328 EC-749
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT
*5
P0102 0102 EC-666
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT
*5
P0103 0103 EC-666
MAF SENSOR
*5
P1102 1102 EC-774
NATS MALFUNCTION P1610 - P1615 1610 - 1615 EC-595
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.
No DTC Flashing
*4
EC-596
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.
P0000 0000
SENSOR POWER/CIRC
*5
P1229 1229 EC-828
TP SEN 1/CIRC
*5
P0222 0222 EC-729
TP SEN 1/CIRC
*5
P0223 0223 EC-729
TP SEN 2/CIRC
*5
P1223 1223 EC-811
TP SEN 2/CIRC
*5
P1224 1224 EC-811
TP SENSOR
*5
P0221 0221 EC-723
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC
*1
Reference page
CONSULT-II
*2
ECM
*3
DTC
*1
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
Reference page
CONSULT-II
*2
ECM
*3
No DTC Flashing
*4
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.
EC-596
U1001
1001
*6
CAN COMM CIRCUIT EC-663
EC-564
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
INDEX FOR DTC
*1: 1st trip DTC No. is the same as DTC No.
*2: These numbers are prescribed by ISO 15031-5.
*3: In Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results), these numbers are controlled by NISSAN.
P0000 0000
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.

P0102 0102 MAF SEN/CIRCUIT


*5
EC-666
P0103 0103 MAF SEN/CIRCUIT
*5
EC-666
P0117 0117 ECT SEN/CIRCUIT
*5
EC-672
P0118 0118 ECT SEN/CIRCUIT
*5
EC-672
P0132 0132 HO2S1 (B1) EC-677
P0134 0134 HO2S1 (B1) EC-692
P0138 0138 HO2S2 (B1) EC-707
P0221 0221
TP SENSOR
*5
EC-723
P0222 0222
TP SEN 1/CIRC
*5
EC-729
P0223 0223
TP SEN 1/CIRC
*5
EC-729
P0226 0226 APP SENSOR
*5
EC-735
P0227 0227 APP SEN 1/CIRC
*5
EC-742
P0228 0228 APP SEN 1/CIRC
*5
EC-742
P0327 0327 KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 EC-749
P0328 0328 KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 EC-749
P0335 0335 CKP SEN/CIRCUIT EC-753
P0340 0340 CMP SEN/CIRC-B1 EC-760
P0605 0605 ECM EC-767
P1065 1065 ECM BACK UP/CIRC EC-770
P1102 1102 MAF SENSOR
*5
EC-774
P1121 1121
ETC ACTR
*5
EC-780
P1122 1122
ETC FUNCTION/CIRC
*5
EC-783
P1124 1124
ETC MOT PWR
*5
EC-790
P1126 1126
ETC MOT PWR
*5
EC-790
P1128 1128
ETC MOT
*5
EC-796
P1217 1217 ENG OVER TEMP EC-801
P1223 1223 TP SEN 2/CIRC
*5
EC-811
P1224 1224 TP SEN 2/CIRC
*5
EC-790
P1225 1225 CTP LEARNING EC-817
P1226 1226 CTP LEARNING EC-819
P1227 1227
APP SEN 2/CIRC
*5
EC-821
P1228 1228
APP SEN 2/CIRC
*5
EC-821
P1229 1229
SENSOR POWER/CIRC
*5
EC-828
P1610 - P1615 1610 - 1615 NATS MALFUNCTION EC-595
P1805 1805 BRAKE SW/CIRCUIT EC-832
DTC
*1
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
Reference page
CONSULT-II
*2
ECM
*3
INDEX FOR DTC
EC-565
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
*4: When engine is running.
*5: When the fail-safe operation occurs, the MI illuminates.
*6: The troubleshooting for this DTC needs CONSULT-II.
QG18DE ENGINE MODELS
DTC
*1
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
Reference page
CONSULT-II
*2
ECM
*3
No DTC
Flashing
*4
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.
EC-596
U1000 1000
*6
CAN COMM CIRCUIT EC-663
U1001 1001
*6
CAN COMM CIRCUIT EC-663
P0000 0000
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.

P0102 0102
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT
*5
EC-666
P0103 0103
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT
*5
EC-666
P0117 0117
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT
*5
EC-672
P0118 0118
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT
*5
EC-672
P0132 0132 HO2S1 (B1) EC-683
P0134 0134 HO2S1 (B1) EC-698
P0138 0138 HO2S2 (B1) EC-714
P0152 0152 HO2S1 (B2) EC-683
P0154 0154 HO2S1 (B2) EC-698
P0158 0158 HO2S2 (B2) EC-714
P0221 0221 TP SENSOR* EC-723
P0222 0222 TP SEN 1/CIRC
*5
EC-729
P0223 0223 TP SEN 1/CIRC
*5
EC-729
P0226 0226
APP SENSOR
*5
EC-735
P0227 0227
APP SEN 1/CIRC
*5
EC-742
P0228 0228
APP SEN 1/CIRC
*5
EC-742
P0327 0327 KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 EC-749
P0328 0328 KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 EC-749
P0335 0335 CKP SEN/CIRCUIT EC-753
P0340 0340 CMP SEN/CIRC-B1 EC-760
P0605 0605 ECM EC-767
P1065 1065 ECM BACK UP/CIRC EC-770
P1102 1102
MAF SENSOR
*5
EC-774
P1121 1121
ETC ACTR
*5
EC-780
P1122 1122
ETC FUNCTION/CIRC
*5
EC-783
P1124 1124 ETC MOT PWR EC-811
P1126 1126 ETC MOT PWR
*5
EC-790
P1128 1128
ETC MOT
*5
EC-796
P1217 1217 ENG OVER TEMP EC-801
P1223 1223
TP SEN 2/CIRC
*5
EC-811
EC-566
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
INDEX FOR DTC
*1: 1st trip DTC No. is the same as DTC No.
*2: These numbers are prescribed by ISO 15031-5.
*3: In Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results), these numbers are controlled by NISSAN.
*4: When engine is running.
*5: When the fail-safe operation occurs, the MI illuminates.
*6: The troubleshooting for this DTC needs CONSULT-II.
NOTE:
Regarding P12 models with QG18DE engine, B1 indicates bank 1, B2 indicates bank 2.
P1224 1224
TP SEN 2/CIRC
*5
EC-811
P1225 1225 CTP LEARNING EC-817
P1226 1226 CTP LEARNING EC-819
P1227 1227
APP SEN 2/CIRC
*5
EC-821
P1228 1228
APP SEN 2/CIRC
*5
EC-821
P1229 1229 SENSOR POWER/CIRC
*5
EC-828
P1610 - P1615 1610 - 1615 NATS MALFUNCTION EC-595
P1805 1805 BRAKE SW/CIRCUIT EC-832
DTC
*1
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
Reference page
CONSULT-II
*2
ECM
*3
PRECAUTIONS
EC-567
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
PRECAUTIONS PFP:00001
Precautions for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) AIR BAG and SEAT
BELT PRE-TENSIONER EBS00ETG
The Supplemental Restraint System such as "AIR BAG" and "SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER", used along
with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SRS and SB section of
this Service Manual.
WARNING:
G To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death
in the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be per-
formed by an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
G Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to per-
sonal injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air
Bag Module, see the SRS section.
G Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harness connec-
tors.
On Board Diagnostic (OBD) System of Engine EBS00ETH
The ECM has an on board diagnostic system. It will light up the malfunction indicator (MI) to warn the driver of
a malfunction causing emission deterioration.
CAUTION:
G Be sure to turn the ignition switch OFF and disconnect the battery ground cable before any repair
or inspection work. The open/short circuit of related switches, sensors, solenoid valves, etc. will
cause the MI to light up.
G Be sure to connect and lock the connectors securely after work. A loose (unlocked) connector will
cause the MI to light up due to the open circuit. (Be sure the connector is free from water, grease,
dirt, bent terminals, etc.)
G Certain systems and components, especially those related to OBD, may use a new style slide-
locking type harness connector. For description and how to disconnect, refer to PG-86, "HAR-
NESS CONNECTOR" .
G Be sure to route and secure the harnesses properly after work. The interference of the harness
with a bracket, etc. may cause the MI to light up due to the short circuit.
G Be sure to connect rubber tubes properly after work. A misconnected or disconnected rubber tube
may cause the MI to light up due to the malfunction of the fuel injection system, etc.
G Be sure to erase the unnecessary malfunction information (repairs completed) from the ECM
before returning the vehicle to the customer.
Precaution EBS00ETI
G Always use a 12 volt battery as power source.
G Do not attempt to disconnect battery cables while engine is
running.
G Before connecting or disconnecting the ECM harness con-
nector, turn ignition switch OFF and disconnect battery
ground cable. Failure to do so may damage the ECM
because battery voltage is applied to ECM even if ignition
switch is turned off.
G Before removing parts, turn ignition switch OFF and then
disconnect battery ground cable.
SEF289H
EC-568
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
PRECAUTIONS
G Do not disassemble ECM.
G If battery cable is disconnected, the memory will return to
the initial ECM values.
The ECM will now start to self-control at its initial values.
Engine operation can vary slightly when the cable is dis-
connected. However, this is not an indication of a problem.
Do not replace parts because of a slight variation.
G When connecting ECM harness connector, fasten it
securely with a lever as far as it will go as shown at right.
G When connecting or disconnecting pin connectors into or
from ECM, take care not to damage pin terminals (bend or
break).
Make sure that there are not any bends or breaks on ECM
pin terminal, when connecting pin connectors.
G Securely connect ECM harness connectors.
A poor connection can cause an extremely high (surge)
voltage to develop in coil and condenser, thus resulting in
damage to ICs.
G Keep engine control system harness at least 10 cm (4 in)
away from adjacent harness, to prevent engine control sys-
tem malfunctions due to receiving external noise, degraded
operation of ICs, etc.
G Keep engine control system parts and harness dry.
G Before replacing ECM, perform ECM Terminals and Refer-
ence Value inspection and make sure ECM functions prop-
erly. Refer to EC-622, "ECM Terminals and Reference Value"
.
G Handle mass air flow sensor carefully to avoid damage.
G Do not disassemble mass air flow sensor.
G Do not clean mass air flow sensor with any type of deter-
gent.
G Do not disassemble electric throttle control actuator.
G Even a slight leak in the air intake system can cause seri-
ous problems.
G Do not shock or jar the camshaft position sensor (PHASE), crankshaft position sensor (POS).
SEF707Y
MBIB0145E
PBIB0090E
MEF040D
PRECAUTIONS
EC-569
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
G After performing each TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS, perform
DTC Confirmation Procedure or Overall Function
Check.
The DTC should not be displayed in the DTC Confirmation
Procedure if the repair is completed. The Overall Func-
tion Check should be a good result if the repair is com-
pleted.
G When measuring ECM signals with a circuit tester, connect
a break-out box (SST) and Y-cable adapter (SST) between
the ECM and ECM harness connector.
G When measuring ECM signals with a circuit tester, never
allow the two tester probes to contact.
Accidental contact of probes will cause a short circuit and
damage the ECM power transistor.
G Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/
output voltage. Doing so may result in damage to the ECM's
transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as
the ground.
G Do not operate fuel pump when there is no fuel in lines.
G Tighten fuel hose clamps to the specified torque.
SAT652J
SEF348N
MBIB0046E
EC-570
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
PRECAUTIONS
G Do not depress accelerator pedal when starting.
G Immediately after starting, do not rev up engine unneces-
sarily.
G Do not rev up engine just prior to shutdown.
G When installing C.B. ham radio or a mobile phone, be sure
to observe the following as it may adversely affect elec-
tronic control systems depending on installation location.
Keep the antenna as far as possible from the electronic
control units.
Keep the antenna feeder line more than 20 cm (8 in) away
from the harness of electronic controls.
Do not let them run parallel for a long distance.
Adjust the antenna and feeder line so that the standing-
wave radio can be kept smaller.
Be sure to ground the radio to vehicle body.
G Regarding P12 models with QG18DE engine, B1 indicates
bank 1 (cylinders number 1 and 4), B2 indicates bank 2
(cylinders number 2 and 3).
Wiring Diagrams and Trouble Diagnosis EBS00ETJ
When you read wiring diagrams, refer to the following:
G GI-14, "How to Read Wiring Diagrams"
G PG-3, "POWER SUPPLY ROUTING" for power distribution circuit
When you perform trouble diagnosis, refer to the following:
G GI-11, "HOW TO FOLLOW TEST GROUPS IN TROUBLE DIAGNOSES"
G GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident"
SEF709Y
SEF708Y
SEF440Y
PREPARATION
EC-571
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
PREPARATION PFP:00002
Special Service Tools EBS00ETK
Commercial Service Tools EBS00ETL
Tool number
Tool name
Description
KV10117100
Heated oxygen
sensor wrench
Loosening or tightening heated oxygen sensors
with 22 mm (0.87 in) hexagon nut
KV10114400
Heated oxygen
sensor wrench
Loosening or tightening heated oxygen sensors
a: 22 mm (0.87 in)
KV109E0010
Break-out box
Measuring ECM signals with a circuit tester
KV109E0080
Y-cable adapter
Measuring ECM signals with a circuit tester
S-NT379
S-NT636
S-NT825
S-NT826
Tool name Description
Quick connector
release
Removing fuel tube quick connectors in engine
room
(Available in SEC. 164 of PARTS CATALOG:
Part No. 16441 6N210)
Fuel filler cap adapter Checking fuel tank vacuum relief valve opening
pressure
PBIC0198E
S-NT653
EC-572
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
PREPARATION
Socket wrench Removing and installing engine coolant
temperature sensor
Oxygen sensor
thread cleaner
ie: (J-43897-18)
(J-43897-12)
Reconditioning the exhaust system threads
before installing a new oxygen sensor. Use with
anti-seize lubricant shown below.
a: 18 mm diameter with pitch 1.5 mm for
Zirconia Oxygen Sensor
b: 12 mm diameter with pitch 1.25 mm for
Titania Oxygen Sensor
Anti-seize lubricant
ie: (Permatex
TM
133AR or equivalent
meeting MIL
specification MIL-A-
907)
Lubricating oxygen sensor thread cleaning tool
when reconditioning exhaust system threads.
Tool name Description
S-NT705
AEM488
S-NT779
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-573
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM PFP:23710
System Diagram - QG16DE Engine Models EBS00ETM
MBIB0011E
EC-574
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
System Diagram - QG18DE Engine Models EBS00GBB
MBIB0012E
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-575
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Vacuum Hose Drawing EBS00ETN
Refer to EC-573, "System Diagram - QG16DE Engine Models" or EC-574, "System Diagram - QG18DE
Engine Models" for Vacuum Control System.
MBIB0013E
EC-576
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
System Chart EBS00ETO
*1: This sensor is not used to control the engine system under normal conditions.
*2: The signals are sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
*3: The output signals are sent from the ECM through CAN communication line.
Multiport Fuel Injection (MFI) System EBS00ETP
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
*1: Under normal conditions, this sensor is not for engine control operation.
*2: This signal is sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
*3: The ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
Input (Sensor) ECM Function Output (Actuator)
G Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
G Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
G Mass air flow sensor
G Engine coolant temperature sensor
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
G Throttle position sensor
G Accelerator pedal position sensor
G Park/neutral position (PNP) switch
G Intake air temperature sensor
G Power steering pressure sensor
G Ignition switch
G Stop lamp switch
G Battery voltage
G Knock sensor
G Refrigerant pressure sensor
G Heated oxygen sensor 2
*1
G TCM (Transmission control module)
*2
G Air conditioner switch
*2
G Vehicle speed signal
*2
G Electrical load signal
*2
Fuel injection & mixture ratio control Fuel injectors
Electronic ignition system Power transistor
Fuel pump control Fuel pump relay
On board diagnostic system
MI (On the instrument panel)
*3
Intake valve timing control
Intake valve timing control solenoid
valve
Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater control Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater control Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
EVAP canister purge flow control
EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve
Air conditioning cut control
Air conditioner relay
*3
Cooling fan control
Cooling fan relays
*3
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
*3
and piston position
Fuel injection & mix-
ture ratio control
Fuel injectors
Mass air flow sensor Amount of intake air
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Heated oxygen sensor 1 Density of oxygen in exhaust gas
Throttle position sensor Throttle position
Accelerator pedal position sensor Accelerator pedal position
Park/neutral position (PNP) switch Gear position
Knock sensor Engine knocking condition
Battery
Battery voltage
*3
Power steering pressure sensor Power steering operation
Heated oxygen sensor 2
*1
Density of oxygen in exhaust gas
Vehicle speed signal
*2
Vehicle speed
Air conditioner switch
*2
Air conditioner operation
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-577
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The amount of fuel injected from the fuel injector is determined by the ECM. The ECM controls the length of
time the valve remains open (injection pulse duration). The amount of fuel injected is a program value in the
ECM memory. The program value is preset by engine operating conditions. These conditions are determined
by input signals (for engine speed and intake air) from the crankshaft position sensor (POS), camshaft position
sensor (PHASE) and the mass air flow sensor.
VARIOUS FUEL INJECTION INCREASE/DECREASE COMPENSATION
In addition, the amount of fuel injected is compensated to improve engine performance under various operat-
ing conditions as listed below.
<Fuel increase>
G During warm-up
G When starting the engine
G During acceleration
G Hot-engine operation
G When selector lever is changed from N to D (A/T models)
G High-load, high-speed operation
<Fuel decrease>
G During deceleration
G During high engine speed operation
MIXTURE RATIO FEEDBACK CONTROL (CLOSED LOOP CONTROL)
The mixture ratio feedback system provides the best air-fuel mixture ratio for driveability and emission control.
The three way catalyst (manifold) can then better reduce CO, HC and NOx emissions. This system uses
heated oxygen sensor 1 in the exhaust manifold to monitor if the engine operation is rich or lean. The ECM
adjusts the injection pulse width according to the sensor voltage signal. For more information about heated
oxygen sensor 1, refer to EC-692, "DTC P0134 HO2S1 (QG16DE)" or EC-698, "DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1
(QG18DE)" . This maintains the mixture ratio within the range of stoichiometric (ideal air-fuel mixture).
This stage is referred to as the closed loop control condition.
Heated oxygen sensor 2 is located downstream of the three way catalyst (manifold). Even if the switching
characteristics of heated oxygen sensor 1 shift, the air-fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric by the signal
from heated oxygen sensor 2.
Open Loop Control
The open loop system condition refers to when the ECM detects any of the following conditions. Feedback
control stops in order to maintain stabilized fuel combustion.
G Deceleration and acceleration
G High-load, high-speed operation
G Malfunction of heated oxygen sensor 1 or its circuit
G Insufficient activation of heated oxygen sensor 1 at low engine coolant temperature
G High engine coolant temperature
G During warm-up
G After shifting from N to D (A/T models)
G When starting the engine
PBIB0121E
EC-578
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
MIXTURE RATIO SELF-LEARNING CONTROL
The mixture ratio feedback control system monitors the mixture ratio signal transmitted from heated oxygen
sensor 1. This feedback signal is then sent to the ECM. The ECM controls the basic mixture ratio as close to
the theoretical mixture ratio as possible. However, the basic mixture ratio is not necessarily controlled as orig-
inally designed. Both manufacturing differences (i.e., mass air flow sensor hot film) and characteristic changes
during operation (i.e., injector clogging) directly affect mixture ratio.
Accordingly, the difference between the basic and theoretical mixture ratios is monitored in this system. This is
then computed in terms of injection pulse duration to automatically compensate for the difference between
the two ratios.
Fuel trim refers to the feedback compensation value compared against the basic injection duration. Fuel trim
includes short term fuel trim and long term fuel trim.
Short term fuel trim is the short-term fuel compensation used to maintain the mixture ratio at its theoretical
value. The signal from heated oxygen sensor 1 indicates whether the mixture ratio is RICH or LEAN compared
to the theoretical value. The signal then triggers a reduction in fuel volume if the mixture ratio is rich, and an
increase in fuel volume if it is lean.
Long term fuel trim is overall fuel compensation carried out long-term to compensate for continual deviation
of the short term fuel trim from the central value. Such deviation will occur due to individual engine differences,
wear over time and changes in the usage environment.
FUEL INJECTION TIMING
Two types of systems are used.
Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection System
Fuel is injected into each cylinder during each engine cycle according to the firing order. This system is used
when the engine is running.
Simultaneous Multiport Fuel Injection System
Fuel is injected simultaneously into all four cylinders twice each engine cycle. In other words, pulse signals of
the same width are simultaneously transmitted from the ECM.
The four injectors will then receive the signals two times for each engine cycle.
This system is used when the engine is being started and/or if the fail-safe system (CPU) is operating.
FUEL SHUT-OFF
Fuel to each cylinder is cut off during deceleration or operation of the engine at excessively high speeds.
SEF337W
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-579
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Electronic Ignition (EI) System EBS00ETQ
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
*1: This signal is sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
*2: The ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ignition timing is controlled by the ECM to maintain the best air-
fuel ratio for every running condition of the engine. The ignition tim-
ing data is stored in the ECM. This data forms the map shown.
The ECM receives information such as the injection pulse width and
camshaft position sensor signal. Computing this information, ignition
signals are transmitted to the power transistor.
e.g., N: 1,800 rpm, Tp: 1.50 msec
A BTDC
During the following conditions, the ignition timing is revised by the
ECM according to the other data stored in the ECM.
G At starting
G During warm-up
G At idle
G At low battery voltage
G During acceleration
The knock sensor retard system is designed only for emergencies. The basic ignition timing is programmed
within the anti-knocking zone, if recommended fuel is used under dry conditions. The retard system does not
operate under normal driving conditions. If engine knocking occurs, the knock sensor monitors the condition.
The signal is transmitted to the ECM. The ECM retards the ignition timing to eliminate the knocking condition.
Air Conditioning Cut Control EBS00ETR
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
*1: These signals are sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
*2: The ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
*2
and piston position
Ignition timing control Power transistor
Mass air flow sensor Amount of intake air
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Throttle position sensor Throttle position
Accelerator pedal position sensor Accelerator pedal position
Knock sensor Engine knocking
Park/neutral position (PNP) switch Gear position
Battery
Battery voltage
*2
Vehicle speed signal
*1
Vehicle speed
SEF742M
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Air conditioner switch
*1
Air conditioner ON signal
Air conditioner
cut control
Air conditioner relay
Throttle position sensor Throttle valve opening angle
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
*2
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Battery
Battery voltage
*2
Refrigerant pressure sensor Refrigerant pressure
Power steering pressure sensor Power steering operation
Vehicle speed signal
*1
Vehicle speed
EC-580
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
This system improves engine operation when the air conditioner is used.
Under the following conditions, the air conditioner is turned off.
G When the accelerator pedal is fully depressed.
G When cranking the engine.
G At high engine speeds.
G When the engine coolant temperature becomes excessively high.
G When operating power steering during low engine speed or low vehicle speed.
G When engine speed is excessively low.
G When refrigerant pressure is excessively low or high.
Fuel Cut Control (at No Load and High Engine Speed) EBS00ETS
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
*1: This signal is sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
If the engine speed is above 3,950 rpm with no load (for example, in neutral and engine speed over 3,950
rpm) fuel will be cut off after some time. The exact time when the fuel is cut off varies based on engine speed.
Fuel cut will operate until the engine speed reaches 1,500 rpm, then fuel cut is cancelled.
NOTE:
This function is different from deceleration control listed under Multiport Fuel Injection (MFI) System, EC-576
.
CAN communication EBS00ETT
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real time application. It is an on-vehicle mul-
tiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent error detection ability. Many elec-
tronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links with other
control units during operation (not independent). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2
communication lines (CAN H line, CAN L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission with less wiring.
Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.
LHD MODELS WITH TYRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM
A/T Models
System diagram
Input/output signal chart
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Park/neutral position (PNP) switch Neutral position
Fuel cut control Fuel injectors
Throttle position sensor Throttle position
Accelerator pedal position sensor Accelerator pedal position
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
Vehicle speed signal
*1
Vehicle speed
SKIA1523E
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-581
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
T: Transmit R: Receive
M/T Models
System diagram
Input/output signal chart
T: Transmit R: Receive
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actua-
tor and
electric unit
(control
unit)
Smart
entrance
control unit
Tyre pres-
sure moni-
toring
control unit
Combina-
tion meter
Engine speed signal T R R
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
Signals ECM
ABS actuator
and electric
unit (control
unit)
Smart
entrance con-
trol unit
Tyre pres-
sure monitor-
ing control
unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R
Rear window defogger signal
R
*1
T
Heater fan switch signal
R
*1
T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
SKIA1525E
EC-582
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
*1: Except YD22DDTi engine model
*2: YD22DDTi engine model only
LHD MODELS WITHOUT TYRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM
A/T Models
System diagram
Input/output signal chart
T: Transmit R: Receive
MI signal T R
Glow lamp signal
*2
T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
Signals ECM
ABS actuator
and electric
unit (control
unit)
Smart
entrance con-
trol unit
Tyre pres-
sure monitor-
ing control
unit
Combination
meter
SKIA1530E
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actuator
andelectric unit
(control unit)
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R R
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-583
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
M/T Models
System diagram
Input/output signal chart
T: Transmit R: Receive
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actuator
and electric unit
(control unit)
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
SKIA1532E
Signals ECM
ABS actuator and
electric unit (con-
trol unit)
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R
Rear window defogger signal
R
*1
T
Heater fan switch signal
R
*1
T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Glow lamp signal
*2
T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
EC-584
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
*1: Except YD22DDTi engine model
*2:YD22DDTi engine model only
RHD MODELS WITH TYRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM
A/T Models
System diagram
Input/output signal chart
T: Transmit R: Receive
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Signals ECM
ABS actuator and
electric unit (con-
trol unit)
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actu-
ator and
electric
unit (con-
trol unit)
Tyre pres-
sure moni-
toring
control unit
Smart
entrance
control unit
Combina-
tion meter
Engine speed signal T R R
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
SKIA1537E
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-585
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
M/T Models
System diagram
Input/output signal chart
T: Transmit R: Receive
*1: Except YD22DDTi engine model
*2: YD22DDTi engine model only
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actu-
ator and
electric
unit (con-
trol unit)
Tyre pres-
sure moni-
toring
control unit
Smart
entrance
control unit
Combina-
tion meter
Signals ECM
ABS actua-
tor and elec-
tric unit
(control unit)
Tyre pres-
sure monitor-
ing control
unit
Smart
entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R
Rear window defogger signal R
*1
T
Heater fan switch signal R
*1
T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Glow lamp signal
*2
T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
SKIA1539E
EC-586
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
RHD MODELS WITHOUT TYRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM
A/T Models
System diagram
Input/output signal chart
T: Transmit R: Receive
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actuator
and electric
unit (control
unit)
Smart
entrance con-
trol unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R R
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
SKIA1544E
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-587
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
M/T Models
System diagram
Input/output signal chart
T: Transmit R: Receive
*1: Except YD22DDTi engine model
*2: YD22DDTi engine model only
SKIA1546E
Signals ECM
ABS actuator and
electric unit (con-
trol unit)
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R
Rear window defogger signal
R
*1
T
Heater fan switch signal
R
*1
T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Glow lamp signal
*2
T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
EC-588
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE PFP:00018
Idle Speed and Ignition Timing Check EBS00ETU
IDLE SPEED
With CONSULT-II
Check idle speed in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
IGNITION TIMING
Any of following two methods may be used.
Method A
1. Slide the harness protector of ignition coil No. to clear the wires.
2. Attach timing light to the wires as shown.
3. Check ignition timing.
Method B
1. Remove No. 1 ignition coil.
2. Connect No. 1 ignition coil and No. 1 spark plug with suitable
high-tension wire as shown, and attach timing light clamp to this
wire.
SEF058Y
MBIB0047E
MBIB0048E
MBIB0049E
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
EC-589
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. Check ignition timing.
Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning EBS00ETW
DESCRIPTION
Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning is an operation to learn the fully released position of the accel-
erator pedal by monitoring the accelerator pedal position sensor output signal. It must be performed each time
harness connector of accelerator pedal position sensor or ECM is disconnected.
OPERATION PROCEDURE
1. Make sure that accelerator pedal is fully released.
2. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF wait at least 10 seconds.
Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning EBS00ETX
DESCRIPTION
Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning is an operation to learn the fully closed position of the throttle valve
by monitoring the throttle position sensor output signal. It must be performed each time harness connector of
electric throttle control actuator or ECM is disconnected.
OPERATION PROCEDURE
1. Make sure that accelerator pedal is fully released.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF wait at least 10 seconds.
Make sure that throttle valve moves during above 10 seconds by confirming the operating sound.
Idle Air Volume Learning EBS00ETY
DESCRIPTION
Idle Air Volume Learning is an operation to learn the idle air volume that keeps each engine within the spe-
cific range. It must be performed under any of the following conditions:
G Each time electric throttle control actuator or ECM is replaced.
G Idle speed or ignition timing is out of specification.
PREPARATION
Before performing Idle Air Volume Learning, make sure that all of the following conditions are satisfied.
Learning will be cancelled if any of the following conditions are missed for even a moment.
G Battery voltage: More than 12.9V (At idle)
G Engine coolant temperature: 70 - 95C (158 - 203F)
G PNP switch: ON
G Electric load switch: OFF
(Air conditioner, headlamp, rear window defogger)
On vehicles equipped with daytime light systems, set lighting switch to the 1st position to light
only small lamps.
G Steering wheel: Neutral (Straight-ahead position)
G Vehicle speed: Stopped
SEF166Y
EC-590
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
G Transmission: Warmed-up
For A/T models with CONSULT-II, drive vehicle until FLUID TEMP SE in DATA MONITOR mode of A/
T system indicates less than 0.9V.
For A/T models without CONSULT-II and M/T models, drive vehicle for 10 minutes.
OPERATION PROCEDURE
With CONSULT-II
1. Perform EC-589, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
2. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
4. Check that all items listed under the topic PRE-CONDITIONING (previously mentioned) are in good
order.
5. Select IDLE AIR VOL LEARN in WORK SUPPORT mode.
6. Touch START and wait 20 seconds.
7. Make sure that CMPLT is displayed on CONSULT-II screen. If
INCMP is displayed, Idle Air Volume Learning will not be car-
ried out successfully. In this case, find the cause of the problem
by referring to the Diagnostic Procedure below.
8. Rev up the engine two or three times and make sure that idle
speed and ignition timing are within the specifications.
Without CONSULT-II
NOTE:
G It is better to count the time accurately with a clock.
G It is impossible to switch the diagnostic mode when an accelerator pedal position sensor circuit
has a malfunction.
1. Perform EC-589, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
2. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
SEF217Z
SEF454Y
ITEM SPECIFICATION
Idle speed M/T: 70050 rpm
A/T: 80050 rpm (in P or N position)
Ignition timing M/T: 85 BTDC
A/T: 10 BTDC (in P or N position)
SEF455Y
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
EC-591
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
4. Check that all items listed under the topic PRE-CONDITIONING (previously mentioned) are in good
order.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
6. Confirm that accelerator pedal is fully released, turn ignition switch ON and wait 3 seconds.
7. Repeat the following procedure quickly five times within 5 seconds.
a. Fully depress the accelerator pedal.
b. Fully release the accelerator pedal.
8. Wait 7 seconds, fully depress the accelerator pedal and keep it for approx. 20 seconds until the MI stops
blinking and turned ON.
9. Fully release the accelerator pedal within 3 seconds after the MI turned ON.
10. Start engine and let it idle.
11. Wait 20 seconds.
12. Rev up the engine two or three times and make sure that idle speed and ignition timing are within the
specifications.
13. If idle speed and ignition timing are not within the specification, the result will be incomplete. In this case,
find the cause of the problem by referring to the Diagnostic Procedure below.
DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
If idle air volume learning cannot be performed successfully, proceed as follows:
1. Check that throttle valve is fully closed.
2. Check PCV valve operation.
3. Check that downstream of throttle valve is free from air leakage.
4. When the above three items check out OK, engine component parts and their installation condi-
tion are questionable. Check and eliminate the cause of the problem.
It is useful to perform EC-652, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE" .
5. If any of the following conditions occur after the engine has started, eliminate the cause of the
problem and perform Idle air volume learning all over again:
Engine stalls.
Erroneous idle.
Fuel Pressure Check EBS00ETZ
FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE
Before disconnecting fuel line, release fuel pressure from fuel line to eliminate danger.
NOTE:
Prepare pans or saucers under the disconnected fuel line because the fuel may spill out. The fuel pres-
sure cannot be completely released because P12 models do not have fuel return system.
ITEM SPECIFICATION
Idle speed M/T: 70050 rpm
A/T: 80050 rpm (in P or N position)
Ignition timing M/T: 85 BTDC
A/T: 105 BTDC (in P or N position)
PBIB0665E
EC-592
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Perform FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE in WORK SUPPORT
mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine.
4. After engine stalls, crank it two or three times to release all fuel
pressure.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Remove fuel pump fuse located in fuse box.
2. Start engine.
3. After engine stalls, crank it two or three times to release all fuel
pressure.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF.
5. Reinstall fuel pump fuse after servicing fuel system.
FUEL PRESSURE CHECK
NOTE:
G When reconnecting fuel line, always use new clamps.
G Make sure that clamp screw does not contact adjacent parts.
G Use a torque driver to tighten clamps.
G Use Pressure Gauge to check fuel pressure.
G Do not perform fuel pressure check with system operating. Fuel pressure gauge may indicate
false readings.
1. Release fuel pressure to zero. Refer to EC-591, "FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE" .
2. Install the fuel pressure gauge with the fuel pressure check
adapter as shown in the figure.
3. Turn ignition switch ON, and check for fuel leakage.
4. Start engine and check for fuel leakage.
5. Read the indication of fuel pressure gauge.
6. If result is unsatisfactory, go to next step.
7. Check the following.
G Fuel hoses and fuel tubes for clogging
G Fuel filter for clogging
G Fuel pump
G Fuel pressure regulator for clogging
If OK, replace fuel pressure regulator.
If NG, repair or replace.
SEF214Y
MBIB0141E
At idling:
Approximately 350 kPa (3.7 kg/cm
2
, 51 psi)
MBIB0050E
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-593
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM PFP:00028
Introduction EBS00EU0
The ECM has an on board diagnostic system, which detects malfunctions related to engine sensors or actua-
tors. The ECM also records various emission-related diagnostic information including:
The above information can be checked using procedures listed in the table below.
: Applicable : Not applicable
*1: When DTC and 1st trip DTC simultaneously appear on the display, they cannot be clearly distinguished from each other.
The malfunction indicator (MI) on the instrument panel lights up when the same malfunction is detected in two
consecutive trips (Two trip detection logic), or when the ECM enters fail-safe mode. (Refer to EC-605 .)
Two Trip Detection Logic EBS00EU1
When a malfunction is detected for the first time, 1st trip DTC and 1st trip Freeze Frame data are stored in the
ECM memory. The MI will not light up at this stage. <1st trip>
If the same malfunction is detected again during the next drive, the DTC and Freeze Frame data are stored in
the ECM memory, and the MI lights up. The MI lights up at the same time when the DTC is stored. <2nd trip>
The trip in the Two Trip Detection Logic means a driving mode in which self-diagnosis is performed during
vehicle operation. When the ECM enters fail-safe mode (Refer to EC-605 .), the DTC is stored in the ECM
memory even in the 1st trip.
Emission-related Diagnostic Information EBS00EU2
DTC AND 1ST TRIP DTC
The 1st trip DTC (whose number is the same as the DTC number) is displayed for the latest self-diagnostic
result obtained. If the ECM memory was cleared previously, and the 1st trip DTC did not reoccur, the 1st trip
DTC will not be displayed.
If a malfunction is detected during the 1st trip, the 1st trip DTC is stored in the ECM memory. The MI will not
light up (two trip detection logic). If the same malfunction is not detected in the 2nd trip (meeting the required
driving pattern), the 1st trip DTC is cleared from the ECM memory. If the same malfunction is detected in the
2nd trip, both the 1st trip DTC and DTC are stored in the ECM memory and the MI lights up. In other words,
the DTC is stored in the ECM memory and the MI lights up when the same malfunction occurs in two consec-
utive trips. If a 1st trip DTC is stored and a non-diagnostic operation is performed between the 1st and 2nd
trips, only the 1st trip DTC will continue to be stored. For fail-safe items, the DTC is stored in the ECM memory
even in the 1st trip.
Procedures for clearing the DTC and the 1st trip DTC from the ECM memory are described in EC-594, "HOW
TO ERASE EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
When a 1st trip DTC is detected, check, print out or write down and erase (1st trip) DTC and Freeze Frame
data as specified in Work Flow procedure Step II, refer to EC-601 . Then perform DTC Confirmation Proce-
dure or Overall Function Check to try to duplicate the problem. If the malfunction is duplicated, the item
requires repair.
How to Read DTC and 1st Trip DTC
DTC and 1st trip DTC can be read by the following methods.
With CONSULT-II
CONSULT-II displays the DTC in SELF-DIAG RESULTS mode. Examples: P0117, P0340, P1065, etc.
(CONSULT-II also displays the malfunctioning component or system.)
Without CONSULT-II
Emission-related diagnostic information
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC)
Freeze Frame data
1st Trip Diagnostic Trouble Code (1st Trip DTC)
1st Trip Freeze Frame data
DTC 1st trip DTC Freeze Frame data
1st trip Freeze Frame
data
CONSULT-II
ECM
*
1

EC-594
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
The number of blinks of the MI in the Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-Diagnostic Results) indicates the DTC.
Example: 0117, 0340 1065 etc.
G 1st trip DTC No. is the same as DTC No.
G Output of a DTC indicates a malfunction. However, the Diagnostic Test Mode II does not indicate
whether the malfunction is still occurring or has occurred in the past and has returned to normal.
CONSULT-II can identify malfunction status as shown below. Therefore, using CONSULT-II (if avail-
able) is recommended.
A sample of CONSULT-II display for DTC and 1st trip DTC is shown below. DTC or 1st trip DTC of a malfunc-
tion is displayed in SELF-DIAGNOSTIC RESULTS mode of CONSULT-II. Time data indicates how many times
the vehicle was driven after the last detection of a DTC.
If the DTC is being detected currently, the time data will be 0.
If a 1st trip DTC is stored in the ECM, the time data will be [1t].
FREEZE FRAME DATA AND 1ST TRIP FREEZE FRAME DATA
The ECM records the driving conditions such as fuel system status, calculated load value, engine coolant tem-
perature, short term fuel trim, long term fuel trim, engine speed, vehicle speed, base fuel schedule and intake
air temperature at the moment a malfunction is detected.
Data which are stored in the ECM memory, along with the 1st trip DTC, are called 1st trip freeze frame data.
The data, stored together with the DTC data, are called freeze frame data and displayed on CONSULT-II. For
details, see EC-639 .
Only one set of freeze frame data (either 1st trip freeze frame data or freeze frame data) can be stored in the
ECM. 1st trip freeze frame data is stored in the ECM memory along with the 1st trip DTC. There is no priority
for 1st trip freeze frame data and it is updated each time a different 1st trip DTC is detected. However, once
freeze frame data (2nd trip detection/MI on) is stored in the ECM memory, 1st trip freeze frame data is no
longer stored. Remember, only one set of freeze frame data can be stored in the ECM.
Both 1st trip freeze frame data and freeze frame data (along with the DTCs) are cleared when the ECM mem-
ory is erased. Procedures for clearing the ECM memory are described in EC-594, "HOW TO ERASE EMIS-
SION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
HOW TO ERASE EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION
How to Erase DTC ( With CONSULT-II)
The emission related diagnostic information in the ECM can be erased by selecting ERASE in the SELF-
DIAG RESULTS mode with CONSULT-II.
1. If the ignition switch stays ON after repair work, be sure to turn ignition switch OFF once. Wait at least
10 seconds and then turn it ON (engine stopped) again.
2. Touch ENGINE.
3. Touch SELF-DIAG RESULTS.
PBIB0911E
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-595
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. Touch ERASE. (The DTC in the ECM will be erased.)
How to Erase DTC ( Without CONSULT-II)
1. If the ignition switch stays ON after repair work, be sure to turn ignition switch OFF once.
2. Wait at least 10 seconds and then turn it ON (engine stopped) again.
3. Change the diagnostic test mode from Mode II to Mode I by depressing the accelerator pedal. Refer to
EC-597, "HOW TO SWITCH DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE" .
G If the battery is disconnected, the emission-related diagnostic information will be lost after
approx. 24 hours.
G The following data are cleared when the ECM memory is erased.
1. Diagnostic trouble codes
2. 1st trip diagnostic trouble codes
3. Freeze frame data
4. 1st trip freeze frame data
5. Others
Actual work procedures are explained using a DTC as an example. Be careful so that not only the DTC, but all
of the data listed above, are cleared from the ECM memory during work procedures.
NATS (Nissan Anti-theft System) EBS00EU3
G If the security indicator lights up with the ignition switch in
the ON position or NATS MALFUNCTION is displayed
on SELF-DIAG RESULTS screen, perform self-diagnostic
results mode with CONSULT-II using NATS program card.
Refer to BL-156, "NATS (NISSAN ANTI-THEFT SYSTEM)" .
G Confirm no self-diagnostic results of NATS is displayed
before touching ERASE in SELF-DIAG RESULTS mode
with CONSULT-II.
G When replacing ECM, initialization of NATS system and reg-
istration of all NATS ignition key IDs must be carried out
with CONSULT-II using NATS program card.
Therefore, be sure to receive all keys from vehicle owner.
Regarding the procedures of NATS initialization and NATS ignition key ID registration, refer to
CONSULT-II operation manual, NATS.
PBIB0671E
SEF515Y
EC-596
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
Malfunction Indicator (MI) EBS00EU4
DESCRIPTION
The MI is located on the instrument panel.
1. The MI will light up when the ignition switch is turned ON without
the engine running. This is a bulb check.
G If the MI does not light up, refer to DI-95, "WARNING LAMPS" ,
or see EC-950, "MI & DATA LINK CONNECTORS" .
2. When the engine is started, the MI should go off.
If the MI remains on, the on board diagnostic system has
detected an engine system malfunction.
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEM FUNCTION
The on board diagnostic system has the following four functions.
MI Flashing without DTC
If the ECM is in Diagnostic Test Mode II, MI may flash when engine is running. In this case, check ECM diag-
nostic test mode. Refer to EC-597, "HOW TO SWITCH DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE" .
How to switch the diagnostic test (function) modes, and details of the above functions are described later EC-
597, "HOW TO SWITCH DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE" .
The following emission-related diagnostic information is cleared when the ECM memory is erased.
1. Diagnostic trouble codes
2. 1st trip diagnostic trouble codes
3. Freeze frame data
SAT652J
Diagnostic Test
Mode
KEY and ENG.
Status
Function Explanation of Function
Mode I Ignition switch in
ON position
Engine stopped
BULB CHECK This function checks the MI bulb for damage (blown, open
circuit, etc.).
If the MI does not come on, check MI circuit.
Engine running MALFUNCTION
WARNING
This is a usual driving condition. When a malfunction is
detected twice in two consecutive driving cycles (two trip
detection logic), the MI will light up to inform the driver that
a malfunction has been detected.
The following malfunctions will light up the MI in the 1st
trip.
G Fail-safe mode
Mode II Ignition switch in
ON position
Engine stopped
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC
RESULTS
This function allows DTCs and 1st trip DTCs to be read.
Engine running HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
MONITOR
This function allows the fuel mixture condition (lean or
rich), monitored by heated oxygen sensor 1, to be read.
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-597
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. 1st trip freeze frame data
5. Others
HOW TO SWITCH DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE
NOTE:
G It is better to count the time accurately with a clock.
G It is impossible to switch the diagnostic mode when an accelerator pedal position sensor circuit
has a malfunction.
G Always ECM returns to Diagnostic Test Mode I after ignition switch is turned OFF.
How to Set Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)
1. Confirm that accelerator pedal is fully released, turn ignition switch ON and wait 3 seconds.
2. Repeat the following procedure quickly five times within 5 seconds.
a. Fully depress the accelerator pedal.
b. Fully release the accelerator pedal.
3. Wait 7 seconds, fully depress the accelerator pedal and keep it for approx. 10 seconds until the MI starts
blinking.
4. Fully release the accelerator pedal.
ECM has entered to Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results).
How to Set Diagnostic Test Mode II (Heated Oxygen Sensor 1 Monitor)
1. Set the ECM in Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results). Refer to EC-597, "How to Set Diagnostic
Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)" .
2. Start Engine.
ECM has entered to Diagnostic Test Mode II (Heated oxygen sensor 1 monitor).
ECM will start heated oxygen sensor 1 monitoring from the bank 1 sensor for QG18DE engine models.
How to Switch Monitored Sensor From Bank 1 to Bank 2 or Vice Versa
1. Fully depress the accelerator pedal quickly and then release it immediately.
2. Make sure that monitoring sensor has changed by MI blinking as follows.
How to Erase Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)
1. Set ECM in Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results). Refer to EC-597, "How to Set Diagnostic
Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)" .
2. Fully depress the accelerator pedal and keep it for more than 10 seconds.
The emission-related diagnostic information has been erased from the backup memory in the ECM.
PBIB0092E
PBIB0093E
EC-598
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
3. Fully release the accelerator pedal, and confirm the DTC 0000 is displayed.
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE I BULB CHECK
In this mode, the MI on the instrument panel should stay ON. If it remains OFF, check the bulb. Refer to DI-95,
"WARNING LAMPS" or see EC-950, "MI & DATA LINK CONNECTORS" .
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE I MALFUNCTION WARNING
G These DTC numbers are clarified in Diagnostic Test Mode II (SELF-DIAGNOSTIC RESULTS)
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE II SELF-DIAGNOSTIC RESULTS
In this mode, the DTC and 1st trip DTC are indicated by the number of blinks of the MI as shown below.
The DTC and 1st trip DTC are displayed at the same time. If the MI does not illuminate in diagnostic test mode
I (Malfunction warning), all displayed items are 1st trip DTCs. If only one code is displayed when the MI illumi-
nates in diagnostic test mode II (SELF-DIAGNOSTIC RESULTS), it is a DTC; if two or more codes are dis-
played, they may be either DTCs or 1st trip DTCs. DTC No. is same as that of 1st trip DTC. These unidentified
codes can be identified by using the CONSULT-II. A DTC will be used as an example for how to read a code.
A particular trouble code can be identified by the number of four-digit numeral flashes. The zero is indicated
by the number of ten flashes. The length of time the 1,000th-digit numeral flashes on and off is 1.2 seconds
consisting of an ON (0.6-second) - OFF (0.6-second) cycle.
The 100th-digit numeral and lower digit numerals consist of a 0.3-second ON and 0.3-second OFF cycle.
A change from one digit numeral to another occurs at an interval of 1.0-second OFF. In other words, the later
numeral appears on the display 1.3 seconds after the former numeral has disappeared.
A change from one trouble code to another occurs at an interval of 1.8-second OFF.
In this way, all the detected malfunctions are classified by their DTC numbers. The DTC 0000 refers to no
malfunction. (See EC-561, "INDEX FOR DTC" )
How to Erase Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)
The DTC can be erased from the back up memory in the ECM by depressing accelerator pedal. Refer to EC-
597, "HOW TO SWITCH DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE" .
G If the battery is disconnected, the DTC will be lost from the backup memory after approx 24 hours.
G Be careful not to erase the stored memory before starting trouble diagnoses.
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE II HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 MONITOR
In this mode, the MI displays the condition of the fuel mixture (lean or rich) which is monitored by the heated
oxygen sensor 1.
MI Condition
ON When the malfunction is detected.
OFF No malfunction.
SEF952W
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-599
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
*: Maintains conditions just before switching to open loop.
To check the heated oxygen sensor 1 function, start engine in the Diagnostic Test Mode II and warm it up until
engine coolant temperature indicator points to the middle of the gauge.
Next run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no-load conditions. Then make sure that the MI
comes ON more than 5 times within 10 seconds with engine running at 2,000 rpm under no-load.
MI Fuel mixture condition in the exhaust gas Air fuel ratio feedback control condition
ON Lean
Closed loop system
OFF Rich
*Remains ON or OFF Any condition Open loop system
EC-600
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS PFP:00004
Trouble Diagnosis Introduction EBS00EU5
INTRODUCTION
The engine has an ECM to control major systems such as fuel con-
trol, ignition control, idle air control system, etc. The ECM accepts
input signals from sensors and instantly drives actuators. It is essen-
tial that both input and output signals are proper and stable. At the
same time, it is important that there are no problems such as vac-
uum leaks, fouled spark plugs, or other problems with the engine.
It is much more difficult to diagnose a problem that occurs intermit-
tently rather than continuously. Most intermittent problems are
caused by poor electric connections or improper wiring. In this case,
careful checking of suspected circuits may help prevent the replace-
ment of good parts.
A visual check only may not find the cause of the problems. A road
test with CONSULT-II or a circuit tester connected should be per-
formed. Follow the Work Flow on EC-601 .
Before undertaking actual checks, take a few minutes to talk with a
customer who approaches with a driveability complaint. The cus-
tomer can supply good information about such problems, especially
intermittent ones. Find out what symptoms are present and under
what conditions they occur. A Diagnostic Worksheet like the exam-
ple on EC-604 should be used.
Start your diagnosis by looking for conventional problems first. This
will help troubleshoot driveability problems on an electronically con-
trolled engine vehicle.
MEF036D
SEF233G
SEF234G
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-601
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
WORK FLOW
Flow Chart
*1 If time data of SELF-DIAG
RESULTS is other than 0 or [1t],
perform EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAG-
NOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCI-
DENT" .
*2 If time data of SELF-DIAG
RESULTS is other than 0 or [1t],
perform EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAG-
NOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCI-
DENT" .
*3 If the on board diagnostic system can-
not be performed, check main power
supply and ground circuit. Refer to
EC-657, "POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
FOR ECM" .
*4 If the incident cannot be verified, per-
form EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNO-
SISFOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT"
.
*5 EC-652, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS -
SPECIFICATION VALUE"
MBIB0178E
EC-602
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Description for Work Flow
STEP DESCRIPTION
STEP I
Get detailed information about the conditions and the environment when the incident/symptom occurred using the
DIAGNOSTIC WORK SHEET, EC-604 .
STEP II
Before confirming the concern, check and write down (print out using CONSULT-II) the (1st trip) DTC and the (1st
trip) freeze frame data, then erase the DTC and the data. (Refer to EC-594, "HOW TO ERASE EMISSION-RELATED
DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .) The (1st trip) DTC and the (1st trip) freeze frame data can be used when duplicat-
ing the incident at STEP III & IV.
If the incident cannot be verified, perform EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
Study the relationship between the cause, specified by (1st trip) DTC, and the symptom described by the customer.
(The Symptom Matrix Chart will be useful. See EC-612 .)
Also check related service bulletins for information.
STEP III
Try to confirm the symptom and under what conditions the incident occurs.
The DIAGNOSTIC WORK SHEET and the freeze frame data are useful to verify the incident. Connect CONSULT-II
to the vehicle in DATA MONITOR (AUTO TRIG) mode and check real time diagnosis results.
If the incident cannot be verified, perform EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
If the malfunction code is detected, skip STEP IV and perform STEP V.
STEP IV
Try to detect the (1st trip) DTC by driving in (or performing) the DTC Confirmation Procedure. Check and read the
(1st trip) DTC and (1st trip) freeze frame data by using CONSULT-II or GST.
During the (1st trip) DTC verification, be sure to connect CONSULT-II to the vehicle in DATA MONITOR (AUTO TRIG)
mode and check real time diagnosis results.
If the incident cannot be verified, perform EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
In case the DTC Confirmation Procedure is not available, perform the Overall Function Check instead. The (1st
trip) DTC cannot be displayed by this check, however, this simplified check is an effective alternative.
The NG result of the Overall Function Check is the same as the (1st trip) DTC detection.
STEP V
Take the appropriate action based on the results of STEP I through IV.
If the malfunction code is indicated, proceed to TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR DTC PXXXX.
If the normal code is indicated, proceed to the BASIC INSPECTION. (Refer to EC-607 .) If COSULT-II is available,
perform DATA MONITOR (SPEC) mode with CONSULT-II and proceed to the TOROUBLE DIAGNOSIS SPECI-
FICATION VALUE. (Refer to EC-652 .) (If malfunction is detected, proceed to PERAIR/REPLACE.) Then perform
inspections according to the Symptom Matrix Chart. (Refer to EC-612 .)
STEP VI
Identify where to begin diagnosis based on the relationship study between symptom and possible causes. Inspect the
system for mechanical binding, loose connectors or wiring damage using (tracing) Harness Layouts.
Gently shake the related connectors, components or wiring harness with CONSULT-II set in DATA MONITOR
(AUTO TRIG) mode.
Check the voltage of the related ECM terminals or monitor the output data from the related sensors with CONSULT-II.
Refer to EC-622 , EC-646 .
The Diagnostic Procedure in EC section contains a description based on open circuit inspection. A short circuit
inspection is also required for the circuit check in the Diagnostic Procedure. For details, refer to Circuit Inspection in
GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident" .
Repair or replace the malfunction parts.
If malfunctioning part cannot be detected, perform EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCI-
DENT" .
STEP VII
Once you have repaired the circuit or replaced a component, you need to run the engine in the same conditions and
circumstances which resulted in the customer's initial complaint.
Perform the DTC Confirmation Procedure and confirm the normal code [DTC No. P0000] is detected. If the incident
is still detected in the final check, perform STEP VI by using a method different from the previous one.
Before returning the vehicle to the customer, be sure to erase the unnecessary (already fixed) (1st trip) DTC in ECM
and TCM (Transmission control module). (Refer to EC-594, "HOW TO ERASE EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC
INFORMATION" .)
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-603
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DIAGNOSTIC WORKSHEET
Description
There are many operating conditions that lead to the malfunction of
engine components. A good grasp of such conditions can make trou-
bleshooting faster and more accurate.
In general, each customer feels differently about a problem. It is
important to fully understand the symptoms or conditions for a cus-
tomer complaint.
Utilize a diagnostic worksheet like the one on the next page in order
to organize all the information for troubleshooting.
Some conditions may cause the MI to come on steady or blink and
DTC to be detected. Examples:
G Vehicle ran out of fuel, which caused the engine to misfire.
G Fuel filler cap was left off or incorrectly screwed on, allowing fuel
to evaporate into the atmosphere.
SEF907L
EC-604
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Worksheet Sample
DTC Inspection Priority Chart EBS00EU6
If some DTCs are displayed at the same time, perform inspections one by one based on the following priority
chart.
NOTE:
If DTC U1000 and/or U1001 is displayed with other DTC, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC
U1000 and U1001. Refer to EC-663, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
MTBL0017
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-605
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
QG16DE ENGINE
QG18DE ENGINE
Fail-safe Chart EBS00EU7
When the DTC listed below is detected, the ECM enters the fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
Priority Detected items (DTC)
1 G U1001 CAN communication line
G P0102 P0103 P1102 Mass air flow sensor
G P0117 P0118 Engine coolant temperature sensor
G P0221 P0222 P0223 P1223 P1224 P1225 P1226 P1229 Throttle position sensor
G P0226 P0227 P0228 P1227 P1228 Accelerator pedal position sensor
G P0327 P0328 Knock sensor
G P0335 Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
G P0340 Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
G P0605 ECM
G P1610-P1615 NATS
2 G P0132 P0134 Heated oxygen sensor 1
G P0138 Heated oxygen sensor 2
G P1065 ECM power supply
G P1122 Electric throttle control function
G P1124 P1126 P1128 Electric throttle control actuator
G P1805 Brake switch
3 G P1121 Electric throttle control actuator
G P1217 Engine over temperature (OVERHEAT)
Priority Detected items (DTC)
1 G U1000 U1001 CAN communication line
G P0102 P0103 P1102 Mass air flow sensor
G P0117 P0118 Engine coolant temperature sensor
G P0221 P0222 P0223 P1223 P1224 P1225 P1226 P1229 Throttle position sensor
G P0226 P0227 P0228 P1227 P1228 Accelerator pedal position sensor
G P0327 P0328 Knock sensor
G P0335 Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
G P0340 Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
G P0605 ECM
G P1610-P1615 NATS
2 G P0132 P0134 P0152 P0154 Heated oxygen sensor 1
G P0138 P0158 Heated oxygen sensor 2
G P1065 ECM power supply
G P1122 Electric throttle control function
G P1124 P1126 P1128 Electric throttle control actuator
G P1805 Brake switch
3 G P1121 Electric throttle control actuator
G P1217 Engine over temperature (OVERHEAT)
EC-606
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
DTC No. Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
P0102
P0103
P1102
Mass air flow sensor circuit Engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm due to the fuel cut.
P0117
P0118
Engine coolant tempera-
ture sensor circuit
Engine coolant temperature will be determined by ECM based on the time after turning
ignition switch ON or START.
CONSULT-II displays the engine coolant temperature decided by ECM.
Condition
Engine coolant temperature decided (CONSULT-
II display)
Just as ignition switch is turned
ON or Start
40C (104F)
More than approx. 4 minutes after
ignition ON or Start
80C (176F)
Except as shown above
40 - 80C (104 - 176F)
(Depends on the time)
When the fail-safe system for engine coolant temperature sensor is activated, the cool-
ing fan operates while engine is running.
P0221
P0222
P0223
P1223
P1224
Throttle position sensor The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening
in order for the idle position to be within +10 degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the nor-
mal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
P0226
P0227
P0228
P1227
P1228
Accelerator pedal position
sensor
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening
in order for the idle position to be within +10 degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the nor-
mal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
P1121 Electric throttle control actu-
ator
(ECM detect the throttle
valve is stuck open.)
While the vehicle is driving, it slows down gradually by fuel cut. After the vehicle stops,
the engine stalls.
The engine can restart in N or P position, and engine speed will not exceed 1,000
rpm or more.
P1122 Electric throttle control func-
tion
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.
P1124
P1126
Throttle control motor relay ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.
P1128 Throttle control motor
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.
P1229 Sensor power supply ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-607
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Basic Inspection EBS00EU8
1. INSPECTION START
1. Check service records for any recent repairs that may indicate a related problem, or a current need for
scheduled maintenance.
2. Open engine hood and check the following:
Harness connectors for improper connections
Wiring harness for improper connections, pinches and cut
Vacuum hoses for splits, kinks and improper connections
Hoses and ducts for leaks
Air cleaner clogging
Gasket
3. Confirm that electrical or mechanical loads are not applied.
Headlamp switch is OFF.
Air conditioner switch is OFF.
Rear window defogger switch is OFF.
Steering wheel is in the straight-ahead position, etc.
4. Start engine and warm it up until engine coolant temperature
indicator points the middle of gauge.
Ensure engine stays below 1,000 rpm.
5. Run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no-
load.
6. Make sure that no DTC is displayed with CONSULT-II or ECM.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. REPAIR OR REPLACE
Repair or replace components as necessary according to corresponding Diagnostic Procedure.
>> GO TO 3.
SEF983U
SEF976U
SEF977U
EC-608
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
3. CHECK TARGET IDLE SPEED
With CONSULT-II
1. Run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no-load.
2. Rev engine (2,000 to 3,000 rpm) two or three times under no-
load, then run engine at idle speed for about 1 minute.
3. Read idle speed in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no-load.
2. Rev engine (2,000 to 3,000 rpm) two or three times under no-load, then run engine at idle speed for about
1 minute.
3. Check idle speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. PERFORM ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION LEARNING
1. Stop engine.
2. Perform EC-589, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
>> GO TO 5.
5. PERFORM THROTTLE VALVE CLOSED POSITION LEARNING
Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
>> GO TO 6.
SEF978U
M/T: 700 50 rpm
A/T: 800 50 rpm (in P or N position)
SEF058Y
M/T: 700 50 rpm
A/T: 800 50 rpm (in P or N position)
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-609
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. PERFORM IDLE AIR VOLUME LEARNING
Refer to EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
CMPLT or INCMP
CMPLT>> GO TO 7.
INCMP >> 1. Follow the construction of Idle Air Volume Learning.
2. GO TO 4.
7. CHECK TARGET IDLE SPEED AGAIN
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Read idle speed in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Check idle speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 8.
8. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Check camshaft position sensor (PHASE) and circuit. Refer to EC-760 .
G Check crankshaft position sensor (POS) and circuit. Refer to EC-753 .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> 1. Repair or replace.
2. GO TO 4.
9. CHECK ECM FUNCTION
1. Substitute another known-good ECM to check ECM function. (ECM may be the cause of a problem, but
this is the rarely the case.)
2. Perform initialization of NATS system and registration of NATS ignition key IDs. Refer to EC-595, "NATS
(Nissan Anti-theft System)" .
>> GO TO 4.
Which is the result CMPLT or INCMP?
M/T: 700 50 rpm
A/T: 800 50 rpm (in P or N position)
M/T: 700 50 rpm
A/T: 800 50 rpm (in P or N position)
EC-610
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
10. CHECK IGNITION TIMING
1. Run engine at idle.
2. Check ignition timing with a timing light.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 11.
11. PERFORM ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION LEARNING
1. Stop engine.
2. Perform EC-589, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
>> GO TO 12.
12. PERFORM THROTTLE VALVE CLOSED POSITION LEARNING
Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
>> GO TO 13.
13. PERFORM IDLE AIR VOLUME LEARNING
Refer to EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
CMPLT or INCMP
CMPLT>> GO TO 14.
INCMP >> 1. Follow the construction of Idle Air Volume Learning.
2. GO TO 4.
14. CHECK TARGET IDLE SPEED AGAIN
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Read idle speed in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Check idle speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 15.
NG >> GO TO 17.
M/T: 8 5 BTDC
A/T: 10 5 BTDC (in P or N position)
Which is the result CMPLT or INCMP?
M/T: 700 50 rpm
A/T: 800 50 rpm (in P or N position)
M/T: 700 50 rpm
A/T: 800 50 rpm (in P or N position)
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-611
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
15. CHECK IGNITION TIMING AGAIN
1. Run engine at idle.
2. Check ignition timing with a timing light.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 16.
16. CHECK TIMING CHAIN INSTALLATION
Check timing chain installation. Refer to EM-49, "TIMING CHAIN" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> 1. Repair the timing chain installation.
2. GO TO 4.
17. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Check camshaft position sensor (PHASE) and circuit. Refer to EC-760 .
G Check crankshaft position sensor (POS) and circuit. Refer to EC-753 .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 18.
NG >> 1. Repair or replace.
2. GO TO 4.
18. CHECK ECM FUNCTION
1. Substitute another known-good ECM to check ECM function. (ECM may be the cause of a problem, but
this is the rarely the case.)
2. Perform initialization of NATS system and registration of NATS ignition key IDs. Refer to EC-595, "NATS
(Nissan Anti-theft System)" .
>> GO TO 4.
M/T: 8 5 BTDC
A/T: 10 5 BTDC (in P or N position)
EC-612
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Symptom Matrix Chart EBS00EU9
SYSTEM BASIC ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
SYMPTOM
Reference
page
H
A
R
D
/
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
/
R
E
S
T
A
R
T
(
E
X
C
P
.
H
A
)
E
N
G
I
N
E
S
T
A
L
L
H
E
S
I
T
A
T
I
O
N
/
S
U
R
G
I
N
G
/
F
L
A
T
S
P
O
T
S
P
A
R
K
K
N
O
C
K
/
D
E
T
O
N
A
T
I
O
N
L
A
C
K
O
F
P
O
W
E
R
/
P
O
O
R
A
C
C
E
L
E
R
A
T
I
O
N
H
I
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
L
O
W
I
D
L
E
R
O
U
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
H
U
N
T
I
N
G
I
D
L
I
N
G
V
I
B
R
A
T
I
O
N
S
L
O
W
/
N
O
R
E
T
U
R
N
T
O
I
D
L
E
O
V
E
R
H
E
A
T
S
/
W
A
T
E
R
T
E
M
P
E
R
A
T
U
R
E
H
I
G
H
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
F
U
E
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
O
I
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
B
A
T
T
E
R
Y
D
E
A
D
(
U
N
D
E
R
C
H
A
R
G
E
)
Warranty symptom code AA AB AC AD AE AF AG AH AJ AK AL AM HA
Fuel Fuel pump circuit 1 1 2 3 2 2 2 3 2 EC-934
Fuel pressure regulator system 3 3 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 EC-591
Injector circuit 1 1 2 3 2 2 2 2 EC-928
Evaporative emission system 3 3 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 EC-952
Air Positive crankcase ventilation sys-
tem
3 3 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 1 EC-955
Incorrect idle speed adjustment 3 3 1 1 1 1 1 EC-607
Electric throttle control actuator 1 1 2 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 2
EC-780,
EC-783 ,
EC-790 ,
EC-796
Ignition Incorrect ignition timing adjustment 3 3 1 1 1 1 1 1 EC-607
Ignition circuit 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 EC-895
Main power supply and ground circuit 2 2 3 3 3 3 3 2 3 EC-657
Mass air flow sensor circuit 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2
EC-666,
EC-774
Engine coolant temperature sensor circuit 1 1 2 2 2 3 2 2 3 1 2 EC-672
Throttle position sensor circuit 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
EC-723,
EC-729 ,
EC-811 ,
EC-817 ,
EC-819 ,
EC-828
Accelerator pedal position sensor circuit 3 2 1 2 2
EC-735,
EC-742 ,
EC-821
Heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit 1 2 3 2 2 2 2
EC-677,
EC-683 ,
EC-692 ,
EC-698 ,
EC-865 ,
EC-872
Knock sensor circuit 2 2 3 EC-749
Crankshaft position sensor (POS) circuit 2 2 EC-753
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE) circuit 2 2 EC-760
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-613
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
1 - 6: The numbers refer to the order of inspection.
(continued on next page)
Vehicle speed signal circuit 2 3 3 3 EC-912
Power steering pressure sensor circuit 2 3 3 3 3 EC-913
ECM 2 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3
EC-767,
EC-770
Intake valve timing control solenoid valve cir-
cuit
3 3 2 1 3 2 2 3 3 EC-918
PNP switch circuit 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 EC-924
Refrigerant pressure sensor circuit 2 3 3 3 3 4 EC-940
Electrical load signal circuit 3 3 3 3 EC-945
Air conditioner circuit 2 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 ATC-30
SYMPTOM
Reference
page
H
A
R
D
/
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
/
R
E
S
T
A
R
T
(
E
X
C
P
.
H
A
)
E
N
G
I
N
E
S
T
A
L
L
H
E
S
I
T
A
T
I
O
N
/
S
U
R
G
I
N
G
/
F
L
A
T
S
P
O
T
S
P
A
R
K
K
N
O
C
K
/
D
E
T
O
N
A
T
I
O
N
L
A
C
K
O
F
P
O
W
E
R
/
P
O
O
R
A
C
C
E
L
E
R
A
T
I
O
N
H
I
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
L
O
W
I
D
L
E
R
O
U
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
H
U
N
T
I
N
G
I
D
L
I
N
G
V
I
B
R
A
T
I
O
N
S
L
O
W
/
N
O
R
E
T
U
R
N
T
O
I
D
L
E
O
V
E
R
H
E
A
T
S
/
W
A
T
E
R
T
E
M
P
E
R
A
T
U
R
E
H
I
G
H
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
F
U
E
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
O
I
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
B
A
T
T
E
R
Y
D
E
A
D
(
U
N
D
E
R
C
H
A
R
G
E
)
Warranty symptom code AA AB AC AD AE AF AG AH AJ AK AL AM HA
EC-614
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
SYSTEM ENGINE MECHANICAL & OTHER
SYMPTOM
Reference
page
H
A
R
D
/
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
/
R
E
S
T
A
R
T
(
E
X
C
P
.
H
A
)
E
N
G
I
N
E
S
T
A
L
L
H
E
S
I
T
A
T
I
O
N
/
S
U
R
G
I
N
G
/
F
L
A
T
S
P
O
T
S
P
A
R
K
K
N
O
C
K
/
D
E
T
O
N
A
T
I
O
N
L
A
C
K
O
F
P
O
W
E
R
/
P
O
O
R
A
C
C
E
L
E
R
A
T
I
O
N
H
I
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
L
O
W
I
D
L
E
R
O
U
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
H
U
N
T
I
N
G
I
D
L
I
N
G
V
I
B
R
A
T
I
O
N
S
L
O
W
/
N
O
R
E
T
U
R
N
T
O
I
D
L
E
O
V
E
R
H
E
A
T
S
/
W
A
T
E
R
T
E
M
P
E
R
A
T
U
R
E
H
I
G
H
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
F
U
E
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
O
I
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
B
A
T
T
E
R
Y
D
E
A
D
(
U
N
D
E
R
C
H
A
R
G
E
)
Warranty symptom code AA AB AC AD AE AF AG AH AJ AK AL AM HA
Fuel Fuel tank
5
5
FL-13
Fuel piping 5 5 5 5 5 5
FL-3, MA-
23
Vapor lock
Valve deposit
5 5 5 5 5 5 5

Poor fuel (Heavy weight gaso-


line, Low octane)

Air Air duct
5 5 5 5 5 5
EM-17
Air cleaner EM-17
Air leakage from air duct
(Mass air flow sensor electric
throttle control actuator)
5 5 5 5
EM-17
Electric throttle control actuator EM-19
Air leakage from intake manifold/
Collector/Gasket
EM-19
Cranking Battery
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
SC-3
Alternator circuit SC-12
Starter circuit 3 SC-22
Signal plate/Flywheel/Drive plate 6 EM-70
PNP switch
4
MT-14, MT-
62 or AT-
115
Engine Cylinder head
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 EM-57
Cylinder head gasket 4 3
Cylinder block
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6
4
EM-70
Piston
Piston ring
Connecting rod
Bearing
Crankshaft
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-615
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
1 - 6: The numbers refer to the order of inspection.
Valve
mecha-
nism
Timing chain
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
EM-49
Camshaft EM-36
Intake valve timing control EM-49
Intake valve
3 EM-57
Exhaust valve
Exhaust Exhaust manifold/Tube/Muffler/
Gasket
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
EM-23, EX-
3
Three way catalyst
Lubrica-
tion
Oil pan/Oil strainer/Oil pump/Oil
filter/Oil gallery
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 2
EM-27, LU-
8 , LU-9 ,
LU-5
Oil level (Low)/Filthy oil LU-6
Cooling Radiator/Hose/Radiator filler cap
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 2 5
CO-11
Thermostat 5 CO-20
Water pump CO-18
Water gallery CO-7
Cooling fan 5 CO-11
Coolant level (low)/Contaminated
coolant
CO-8
NATS (Nissan Anti-Theft System) 1 1
EC-595 or
BL-156
SYMPTOM
Reference
page
H
A
R
D
/
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
/
R
E
S
T
A
R
T
(
E
X
C
P
.
H
A
)
E
N
G
I
N
E
S
T
A
L
L
H
E
S
I
T
A
T
I
O
N
/
S
U
R
G
I
N
G
/
F
L
A
T
S
P
O
T
S
P
A
R
K
K
N
O
C
K
/
D
E
T
O
N
A
T
I
O
N
L
A
C
K
O
F
P
O
W
E
R
/
P
O
O
R
A
C
C
E
L
E
R
A
T
I
O
N
H
I
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
L
O
W
I
D
L
E
R
O
U
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
H
U
N
T
I
N
G
I
D
L
I
N
G
V
I
B
R
A
T
I
O
N
S
L
O
W
/
N
O
R
E
T
U
R
N
T
O
I
D
L
E
O
V
E
R
H
E
A
T
S
/
W
A
T
E
R
T
E
M
P
E
R
A
T
U
R
E
H
I
G
H
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
F
U
E
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
O
I
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
B
A
T
T
E
R
Y
D
E
A
D
(
U
N
D
E
R
C
H
A
R
G
E
)
Warranty symptom code AA AB AC AD AE AF AG AH AJ AK AL AM HA
EC-616
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Engine Control Component Parts Location EBS00EUA
MBIB0117E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-617
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
MBIB0118E
EC-618
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
MBIB0119E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-619
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
MBIB0120E
EC-620
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Circuit Diagram EBS00EUB
MBWA0042E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-621
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
MBWA0043E
EC-622
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
ECM Harness Connector Terminal Layout EBS00EUC
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00EUD
PREPARATION
1. ECM is located behind the glove box. For this inspection,
remove glove box.
2. Remove ECM harness protector.
3. When disconnecting ECM harness connector, loosen it with
levers as far as they will go as shown at right.
4. Connect a break-out box (SST) and Y-cable adapter (SST)
between the ECM and ECM harness connector.
G Use extreme care not to touch 2 pins at one time.
G Data is for comparison and may not be exact.
ECM INSPECTION TABLE
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
QG16DE Engine Models
MBIB0045E
MBIB0155E
MBIB0145E
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
1 B ECM ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Engine ground
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-623
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2 R/B
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm.
G After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of 70
km/h (43 MPH) or more
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
3 R
Throttle control motor power
supply
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
4 BR
Throttle control motor
(Close)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is 1st
G Accelerator pedal is releasing
0 - 14V
5 Y
Throttle control motor
(Open)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is 1st
G Accelerator pedal is depressing
0 - 14V
12 L
Power steering pressure
sensor
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is being turned
0.5 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is not being turned
0.4 - 0.8V
13 R
Crankshaft position sensor
(POS)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 3.0V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
Approximately 3.0V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0534E
PBIB0533E
PBIB0527E
PBIB0528E
EC-624
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
14 R
Camshaft position sensor
(PHASE)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.0 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
1.0 - 4.0V
15 W Knock sensor
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 2.5V
16 W Heated oxygen sensor 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
19 GY/L
EVAP canister purge
volume control solenoid
valve
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is about 2,000 rpm (More
than 100 seconds after starting engine)
Approximately 10V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0525E
PBIB0526E
PBIB0050E
PBIB0520E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-625
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
22
23
41
42
G/B
R/B
L/B
Y/B
Injector No. 3
Injector No. 1
Injector No. 4
Injector No. 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
24 G
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm.
Approximately 7.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped.
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
29 B
Camshaft position sensor
(PHASE) ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
30 B
Camshaft position sensor
(POS) ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
34 BR
Intake air temperature
sensor
[Engine is running]
Approximately 0 - 4.8V
Output voltage varies with
intake air temperature.
35 W Heated oxygen sensor 1
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
45 R
Sensor power supply
(Mass air flow sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
46 R
Sensor power supply
(Refrigerant pressure
sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
47 G
Sensor power supply
(Throttle position sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0529E
PBIB0530E
PBIB0519E
EC-626
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
49 W Throttle position sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is 1st
G Accelerator pedal fully released
More than 0.36V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is 1st
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
Less than 4.75V
50 Y Mass air flow sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.0 - 1.7V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,500 rpm.
1.5 - 2.1V
54 -
Sensor ground
(Knock sensor shield circuit)
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
57 B
Sensor ground
(Power steering pressure
sensor/Refrigerant pressure
sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
60
61
79
80
L/R
BR
GY/R
PU
Ignition signal No. 3
Ignition signal No. 1
Ignition signal No. 4
Ignition signal No. 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0 - 0.1V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - 0.2V
62 Y/R
Intake valve timing control
solenoid valve
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed 2,500 rpm
7 - 10V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0521E
PBIB0522E
MBIB0052E
PBIB0532E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-627
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
65 G
Sensor power supply
(Power steering pressure
sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
66 B
Sensor ground
(Throttle position sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
67 B
Sensor ground
(Mass air flow sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
68 R Throttle position sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is 1st
G Accelerator pedal fully released
Less than 4.75V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is 1st
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 0.36V
69 R/L Refrigerant pressure sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Both A/C switch and blower switch are
ON
(Compressor operates.)
1.0 - 4.0V
72 BR/W
Engine coolant temperature
sensor
[Engine is running]
Approximately 0 - 4.8V
Output voltage varies with
engine coolant temperature.
73 B
Sensor ground
(Engine coolant temperature
sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
74 B
Sensor ground
(Heated oxygen sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
82 B
Sensor ground
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
83 B
Sensor ground
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
85 LG DATA link connector
[Ignition switch ON]
G CONSULT-II or GST is disconnected.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
86 R CAN communication line [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 2.3V
90 R
Sensor power supply
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
91 G
Sensor power supply
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
94 L CAN communication line [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 2.8V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
EC-628
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
98 LG
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is 1st
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.175 - 0.335V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is 1st
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 1.95V
101 R/G Stop lamp switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Brake pedal fully released
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Brake pedal fully depressed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
102 G/OR PNP switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Gear position is neutral
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Except the above gear position
Approximately 5V
104 OR Throttle control motor relay
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch ON] 0 - 1.0V
106 L
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is 1st
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.35 - 0.67V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is 1st
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.9V
109 B/R Ignition switch
[Ignition switch OFF] 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
111 W/G ECM relay (Self shut-off)
[Engine is running]
[Ignition switch OFF]
G For 5 seconds after turning ignition switch
OFF
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch OFF]
G 5 seconds passed after turning ignition
switch OFF
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
113 B/P Fuel pump relay
[Ignition switch ON]
G For 1 second after turning ignition switch
ON
[Engine is running]
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G More than 1 second after turning ignition
switch ON.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
115
116
B
B
ECM ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Engine ground
119
120
W
W
Power supply for ECM [Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
121 W/L
Power supply for ECM
(Buck-up)
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-629
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
QG18DE Engine Models
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
1 B ECM ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Engine ground
2 L
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater (bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm.
G After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of 70
km/h (43 MPH) or more
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
3 R
Throttle control motor power
supply
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
4 BR
Throttle control motor
(Close)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is releasing
0 - 14V
5 Y
Throttle control motor
(Open)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is depressing
0 - 14V
7 W/R
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater (bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm
G After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of 70
km/h (43 MPH) or more
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14)
12 L
Power steering pressure
sensor
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is being turned
Approximately 3.6V
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is not being turned
Approximately 0.6V
PBIB0534E
PBIB0533E
EC-630
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
13 R
Crankshaft position sensor
(POS)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 3.0V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
Approximately 3.0V
14 R
Camshaft position sensor
(PHASE)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.0 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
1.0 - 4.0V
15 W Knock sensor
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 2.5V
16 Y
Heated oxygen sensor 2
(bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
17 L
Heated oxygen sensor 2
(bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0527E
PBIB0528E
PBIB0525E
PBIB0526E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-631
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
19 GY/L
EVAP canister purge
volume control solenoid
valve
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is about 2,000 rpm (More
than 100 seconds after starting engine)
Approximately 10V
22
23
41
42
G/B
R/B
L/B
Y/B
Injector No. 3
Injector No. 1
Injector No. 4
Injector No. 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
24 G
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater (bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm (M/T
model)
G Engine speed is below 3,200 rpm (A/T
model)
Approximately 7.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,200 rpm (M/T
model)
G Engine speed is above 3,200 rpm (A/T
model)
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0050E
PBIB0520E
PBIB0529E
PBIB0530E
PBIB0519E
EC-632
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
25 R/B
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater (bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm (M/T
model)
G Engine speed is below 3,200 rpm (A/T
model)
Approximately 7.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm (M/T
model)
G Engine speed is above 3,200 rpm (A/T
model)
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
29 B
Camshaft position sensor
(PHASE) ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
30 B
Camshaft position sensor
(POS) ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
34 BR
Intake air temperature
sensor
[Engine is running]
Approximately 0 - 4.8V
Output voltage varies with
intake air temperature.
35 W
Heated oxygen sensor 1
(bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
36 W
Heated oxygen sensor 1
(bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
45 R
Sensor power supply
(Mass air flow sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
46 R
Sensor power supply
(Refrigerant pressure
sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
47 G
Sensor power supply
(Throttle position sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
49 W Throttle position sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
More than 0.36V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
Less than 4.75V
50 Y Mass air flow sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.0 - 1.7V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,500 rpm
1.5 - 2.1V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0519E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-633
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC 54 -
Sensor ground
(Knock sensor shield circuit)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
57 B
Sensor ground
(Power steering pressure
sensor/Refrigerant pressure
sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
60
61
79
80
L/R
BR
GY/R
PU
Ignition signal No. 3
Ignition signal No. 1
Ignition signal No. 4
Ignition signal No. 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0 - 0.1V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
0 - 0.2V
62 Y/R
Intake valve timing control
solenoid valve
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,500 rpm
7 - 10V
65 G
Sensor power supply
(Power steering pressure
sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
66 B
Sensor ground
(Throttle position sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
67 B
Sensor ground
(Mass air flow sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0521E
PBIB0522E
MBIB0052E
PBIB0532E
EC-634
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
68 R Throttle position sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
Less than 4.75V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 0.36V
69 R/L Refrigerant pressure sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Both A/C switch and blower switch are
ON
(Compressor operates.)
1.0 - 4.0V
72 BR/W
Engine coolant temperature
sensor
[Engine is running]
Approximately 0 - 4.8V
Output voltage varies with
engine coolant temperature.
73 B
Sensor ground
(Engine coolant temperature
sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
74 B
Sensor ground
(Heated oxygen sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
82 B
Sensor ground
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
83 B
Sensor ground
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
85 LG DATA link connector
[Ignition switch ON]
G CONSULT-II or GST is disconnected.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
86 R CAN communication line [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 2.3V
90 R
Sensor power supply
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
91 G
Sensor power supply
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
92
Accelerator pedal position
sensor signal output
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.35 - 0.67V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.9V
94 L CAN communication line [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 2.8V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-635
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
98 LG
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.175 - 0.335V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 1.95V
101 R/G Stop lamp switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Brake pedal fully released
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Brake pedal fully depressed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
102
P
(A/T)
G/OR
(M/T)
PNP switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Gear position is P or N
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Except the above gear position
A/T models
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
M/T models
Approximately 5V
103 Tachometer signal output
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
10 - 11V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
10 - 11V
104 OR Throttle control motor relay
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch ON] 0 - 1.0V
106 L
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
More than 0.36V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
Less than 4.75V
109 B/R Ignition switch
[Ignition switch OFF] 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
MBIB0053E
MBIB0054E
EC-636
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
CONSULT-II Function EBS00EUE
FUNCTION
*1: The following emission-related diagnostic information is cleared when the ECM memory is erased.
1. Diagnostic trouble codes
2. 1st trip diagnostic trouble codes
3. Freeze frame data
4. 1st trip freeze frame data
5. Others
111 W/G ECM relay (Self shut-off)
[Engine is running]
[Ignition switch OFF]
G For 5 seconds after turning ignition switch
OFF
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch OFF]
G 5 seconds passed after turning ignition
switch OFF
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
113 B/P Fuel pump relay
[Ignition switch ON]
G For 1 second after turning ignition switch
ON
[Engine is running]
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G More than 1 second after turning ignition
switch ON.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
115
116
B
B
ECM ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Engine ground
119
120
W
W
Power supply for ECM [Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
121 W/L
Power supply for ECM
(Buck-up)
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
Diagnostic test mode Function
Work support
This mode enables a technician to adjust some devices faster and more accurately by following the
indications on the CONSULT-II unit.
Self-diagnostic results
Self-diagnostic results such as 1st trip DTC, DTCs and 1st trip freeze frame data or freeze frame data
can be read and erased quickly.
*1
Data monitor Input/Output data in the ECM can be read.
Data monitor (SPEC)
Input/Output of the specification for Basic fuel schedule, AFM, A/F feedback control value and the
other data monitor items can be read.
Active test
Diagnostic Test Mode in which CONSULT-II drives some actuators apart from the ECMs and also
shifts some parameters in a specified range.
Function test This mode is used to inform customers when their vehicle condition requires periodic maintenance.
ECM part number ECM part number can be read.
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-637
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
ENGINE CONTROL COMPONENT PARTS/CONTROL SYSTEMS APPLICATION
X: Applicable
*1: This item includes 1st trip DTCs.
*2: This mode includes 1st trip freeze frame data or freeze frame data. The items appear on CONSULT-II screen in freeze frame data
mode only if a 1st trip DTC or DTC is detected. For details, refer to EC-639 .
CONSULT-II INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
Item
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE
WORK
SUPPORT
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC
RESULTS
DATA
MONI-
TOR
DATA
MONI-
TOR
(SPEC)
ACTIVE
TEST
DTC
*1
FREEZE
FRAME
DATA
*2
E
N
G
I
N
E
C
O
N
T
R
O
L
C
O
M
P
O
N
E
N
T
P
A
R
T
S
I
N
P
U
T
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Mass air flow sensor
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Heated oxygen sensor 1
Heated oxygen sensor 2
Vehicle speed signal
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Throttle position sensor
Intake air temperature sensor
Knock sensor
Refrigerant pressure sensor
Closed throttle position switch (accelerator
pedal position sensor signal)

Air conditioner switch
Park/neutral position (PNP) switch
Stop lamp switch
Power steering pressure sensor
Battery voltage
Electrical load signal
E
N
G
I
N
E
C
O
N
T
R
O
L
C
O
M
P
O
N
E
N
T
P
A
R
T
S
O
U
T
P
U
T
Injectors
Power transistor (Ignition timing)
Throttle control motor relay
Throttle control motor
EVAP canister purge volume control sole-
noid valve

Air conditioner relay
Fuel pump relay
Cooling fan relay
Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
Intake valve timing control solenoid valve
Calculated load value
EC-638
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
2. Connect CONSULT-II to data link connector, which is located
under the drivers side dash panel.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Touch START.
5. Touch ENGINE.
6. Perform each diagnostic test mode according to each service
procedure.
For further information, see the CONSULT-II Operation Manual.
WORK SUPPORT MODE
Work Item
MBIB0156E
PBR455D
SEF995X
SEF824Y
WORK ITEM CONDITION USAGE
FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE G FUEL PUMP WILL STOP BY TOUCHING START DUR-
ING IDLING.
CRANK A FEW TIMES AFTER ENGINE STALLS.
When releasing fuel pressure
from fuel line
IDLE AIR VOL LEARN G THE IDLE AIR VOLUME THAT KEEPS THE ENGINE
WITHIN THE SPECIFIED RANGE IS MEMORIZED IN
ECM.
When learning the idle air volume
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-639
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
*: This function is not necessary in the usual service procedure.
SELF-DIAG RESULTS MODE
Self Diagnostic Item
Regarding items of DTC and 1st trip DTC, refer to EC-561, "INDEX FOR DTC" .)
Freeze Frame Data and 1st Trip Freeze Frame Data
*1: The items are the same as those of 1st trip freeze frame data.
SELF-LEARNING CONT G THE COEFFICIENT OF SELF-LEARNING CONTROL
MIXTURE RATIO RETURNS TO THE ORIGINAL COEF-
FICIENT.
When clearing the coefficient of
self-learning control value
TARGET IDLE RPM ADJ
*
G IDLE CONDITION When setting target idle speed
TARGET IGN TIM ADJ
*
G IDLE CONDITION When adjusting target ignition tim-
ing
After adjustment, confirm target
ignition timing with a timing light.
WORK ITEM CONDITION USAGE
Freeze frame data
item
*1
Description
DIAG TROUBLE
CODE
[PXXXX]
G The engine control component part/control system has a trouble code, it is displayed as PXXXX. (Refer
to EC-561, "INDEX FOR DTC" .)
FUEL SYS-B1
G Fuel injection system status at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
G One mode in the following is displayed.
MODE 2: Open loop due to detected system malfunction
MODE 3: Open loop due to driving conditions (power enrichment, deceleration enrichment)
MODE 4: Closed loop - using oxygen sensor(s) as feedback for fuel control
MODE 5: Open loop - has not yet satisfied condition to go to closed loop
CAL/LD VALUE [%] G The calculated load value at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
COOLANT TEMP [C]
or [F]
G The engine coolant temperature at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
L-FUEL TRIM-B1 [%]
G Long-term fuel trim at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
G The long-term fuel trim indicates much more gradual feedback compensation to the base fuel schedule
than short-term fuel trim.
S-FUEL TRIM-B1 [%]
G Short-term fuel trim at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
G The short-term fuel trim indicates dynamic or instantaneous feedback compensation to the base fuel
schedule.
ENGINE SPEED
[rpm]
G The engine speed at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
VHCL SPEED [km/h]
or [mph]
G The vehicle speed at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
B/FUEL SCHDL
[msec]
G The base fuel schedule at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
INT/A TEMP SE [C]
or [F]
G The intake air temperature at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
EC-640
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
DATA MONITOR MODE
Monitored Item
: Applicable
Monitored item
[Unit]
ECM
INPUT
SIG-
NALS
MAIN
SIG-
NALS
CAN
DIAG
SUP-
PORT
MNTR
Description Remarks
ENG SPEED [rpm]
G Indicates the engine speed computed
from the signals of the crankshaft posi-
tion sensor (POS) and camshaft posi-
tion sensor (PHASE).
G Accuracy becomes poor if engine
speed drops below the idle rpm.
G If the signal is interrupted while the
engine is running, an abnormal
value may be indicated.
MAS A/F SE-B1 [V]
G The signal voltage of the mass air flow
sensor is displayed.
G When the engine is stopped, a
certain value is indicated.
B/FUEL SCHDL
[msec]

G Base fuel schedule indicates the fuel
injection pulse width programmed into
ECM, prior to any learned on board cor-
rection.
A/F ALPHA-B1 [%]
G The mean value of the air-fuel ratio
feedback correction factor per cycle is
indicated.
G When the engine is stopped, a
certain value is indicated.
G This data also includes the data
for the air-fuel ratio learning con-
trol.
A/F ALPHA-B2
[%]
*1

COOLAN TEMP/S
[C] or [F]

G The engine coolant temperature (deter-
mined by the signal voltage of the
engine coolant temperature sensor) is
displayed.
G When the engine coolant tempera-
ture sensor is open or short-cir-
cuited, ECMenters fail-safe mode.
The engine coolant temperature
determined by the ECM is dis-
played.
HO2S1 (B1) [V]
G The signal voltage of the heated oxygen
sensor 1 is displayed.
HO2S1 (B2) [V]
*1

HO2S2 (B1) [V]


G The signal voltage of the heated oxygen
sensor 2 is displayed.
HO2S2 (B2) [V]
*1

HO2S1 MNTR (B1)


[RICH/LEAN]

G Display of heated oxygen sensor 1 sig-
nal during air-fuel ratio feedback control:
RICH ... means the mixture became
rich, and control is being affected
toward a leaner mixture.
LEAN ... means the mixture became
lean, and control is being affected
toward a rich mixture.
G After turning ON the ignition
switch, RICH is displayed until
air-fuel mixture ratio feedback
control begins.
G When the air-fuel ratio feedback is
clamped, the value just before the
clamping is displayed continu-
ously.
HO2S1 MNTR (B2)
[RICH/LEAN]
*1

HO2S2 MNTR (B1)
[RICH/LEAN]

G Display of heated oxygen sensor 2 sig-
nal:
RICH ... means the amount of oxygen
after three way catalyst is relatively
small.
LEAN ... means the amount of oxygen
after three way catalyst is relatively
large.
G When the engine is stopped, a
certain value is indicated. HO2S2 MNTR (B2)
[RICH/LEAN]
*1

VHCL SPEED SE
[km/h] or [mph]

G The vehicle speed computed from the
vehicle speed signal is displayed.
BATTERY VOLT
[V]

G The power supply voltage of ECM is dis-
played.
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-641
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
ACCEL SEN 1 [V]
G The accelerator pedal position sensor
signal voltage is displayed.
ACCEL SEN 2 [V]
THRTL SEN 1 [V]
G The throttle position sensor signal volt-
age is displayed.
THRTL SEN 2 [V]
INT/A TEMP SE
[C] or [F]

G The intake air temperature (determined
by the signal voltage of the intake air
temperature sensor) is indicated.
START SIGNAL
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition of the
starter signal computed from the signals
of the crankshaft position sensor (POS),
camshaft position sensor (PHASE) and
battery voltage.
G After starting the engine, [OFF] is
displayed regardless of the starter
signal.
CLSD THL POS
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates idle position [ON/OFF] com-
puted by ECM according to the acceler-
ator pedal position sensor signal.
AIR COND SIG
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition of the air
conditioner switch as determined by the
air conditioner signal.
P/N POSI SW
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from the
park/neutral position (PNP) switch sig-
nal.
PW/ST SIGNAL
[ON/OFF]

G [ON/OFF] condition of the power steer-
ing oil pressure switch as determined by
the power steering oil pressure signal is
indicated.
LOAD SIGNAL
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from the
electrical load signal.
ON ... Rear window defogger switch is
ON and/or lighting switch is in 2nd posi-
tion.
OFF ... Both rear window defogger
switch and lighting switch are OFF.
IGNITION SW
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from igni-
tion switch.
HEATER FAN SW
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from the
heater fan switch signal.
BRAKE SW
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from the
stop lamp switch signal.
INJ PULSE-B1
[msec]

G Indicates the actual fuel injection pulse
width compensated by ECM according
to the input signals.
G When the engine is stopped, a
certain computed value is indi-
cated.
INJ PULSE-B2
[msec]
*1
IGN TIMING
[BTDC]

G Indicates the ignition timing computed
by ECM according to the input signals.
G When the engine is stopped, a
certain value is indicated.
CAL/LD VALUE [%]
G Calculated load value indicates the
value of the current airflow divided by
peak airflow.
MASS AIRFLOW
[gm/s]
G Indicates the mass airflow computed by
ECM according to the signal voltage of
the mass air flow sensor.
Monitored item
[Unit]
ECM
INPUT
SIG-
NALS
MAIN
SIG-
NALS
CAN
DIAG
SUP-
PORT
MNTR
Description Remarks
EC-642
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
PURG VOL C/V
[%]
G Indicates the EVAP canister purge vol-
ume control solenoid valve control value
computed by the ECM according to the
input signals.
G The opening becomes larger as the
value increases.
INT/V TIM (B1)
[CA]
G Indicates [CA] of intake camshaft
advanced angle.
INT/V SOL (B1) [%]
G The control condition of the intake valve
timing control solenoid valve (deter-
mined by ECM according to the input
signals) is indicated.
ON ... intake valve timing control is oper-
ating.
OFF ... Intake valve timing control is not
operating.
AIR COND RLY
[ON/OFF]

G The air conditioner relay control condi-
tion (determined by ECM according to
the input signals) is indicated.
FUEL PUMP RLY
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates the fuel pump relay control
condition determined by ECM according
to the input signals.
THRTL RELAY
[ON/OFF]

*2
G Indicates the throttle control motor relay
control condition determined by the
ECM according to the input signals.
COOLING FAN
[ON/OFF]
G Indicates the condition of the cooling fan
(determined by ECM according to the
input signals).
ON ... Operation
OFF ... Stop
HO2S1 HTR (B1)
[ON/OFF]
G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition of heated
oxygen sensor 1 heater determined by
ECM according to the input signals.
HO2S1 HTR (B2)
[ON/OFF]
*1
HO2S2 HTR (B1)
[ON/OFF]
G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition of heated
oxygen sensor 2 heater determined by
ECM according to the input signals.
HO2S2 HTR (B2)
[ON/OFF]
*1
VEHICLE SPEED
[km/h] or [mph]

G The vehicle speed computed from the
vehicle speed signal sent from TCM is
displayed.
IDL A/V LEARN
[YET/CMPLT/
INCMP]
G Display the condition of idle air volume
learning
YET ... Idle air volume learning has not
been performed yet.
CMPLT ... Idle air volume learning has
already been performed successfully.
INCMP ... Idle air volume learning has
not been performed successfully.
TRVL AFTER MIL
[km] or [mile]
G Distance traveled while MI is activated.
Monitored item
[Unit]
ECM
INPUT
SIG-
NALS
MAIN
SIG-
NALS
CAN
DIAG
SUP-
PORT
MNTR
Description Remarks
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-643
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
*1: For QG18 engine models.
*2: For QG16 engine models.
NOTE:
G Any monitored item that does not match the vehicle being diagnosed is deleted from the display automatically.
DATA MONITOR (SPEC) MODE
Monitored Item
O2SEN HTR DTY
[%]
G Indicates the heated oxygen sensor 1
heater control value computed by the
ECM according to the input signals.
AC PRESS SEN
[V]

*2
G The signal voltage from the refrigerant
pressure sensor is displayed.
Voltage [V]
G Voltage, frequency, duty cycle or pulse
width measured by the probe.
G Only # is displayed if item is
unable to be measured.
G Figures with #s are temporary
ones. They are the same figures
as an actual piece of data which
was just previously measured.
Frequency
[msec], [Hz] or [%]
DUTY-HI
DUTY-LOW
PLS WIDTH-HI
PLS WIDTH-LOW
CAN COMM
[OK/NG]

G Indicates the communication condition
of CAN communication line.
G These items are not displayed in
SELECTION FROM MENU
mode.
CAN CIRC 1
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 2
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 3
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 4
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 5
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 6
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 7
[OK/UNKWN]

Monitored item
[Unit]
ECM
INPUT
SIG-
NALS
MAIN
SIG-
NALS
CAN
DIAG
SUP-
PORT
MNTR
Description Remarks
Monitored item [Unit]
ECM
input
signals
Main
signals
Description Remarks
ENG SPEED [rpm]
G Indicates the engine speed computed
from the signal of the crankshaft position
sensor (POS).
MAS A/F SE-B1 [V]
G The signal voltage of the mass air flow
sensor specification is displayed.
G When engine is running specification
range is indicated.
B/FUEL SCHDL
[msec]

G Base fuel schedule indicates the fuel
injection pulse width programmed into
ECM, prior to any learned on board cor-
rection.
G When engine is running specification
range is indicated.
EC-644
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
*1: For QG18 engine models
NOTE:
G Any monitored item that does not match the vehicle being diagnosed is deleted from the display automatically.
ACTIVE TEST MODE
Test Item
A/F ALPHA-B1 [%]
G The mean value of the air-fuel ratio feed-
back correction factor per cycle is indi-
cated.
G When engine is running specification
range is indicated.
G This data also includes the data for the
air-fuel ratio learning control.
A/F ALPHA-B2 [%]
*1

Monitored item [Unit]


ECM
input
signals
Main
signals
Description Remarks
TEST ITEM CONDITION JUDGEMENT CHECK ITEM (REMEDY)
FUEL INJEC-
TION
G Engine: Return to the original
trouble condition
G Change the amount of fuel injec-
tion using CONSULT-II.
If trouble symptom disappears, see
CHECK ITEM.
G Harness and connectors
G Fuel injectors
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
IGNITION TIM-
ING
G Engine: Return to the original
trouble condition
G Timing light: Set
G Retard the ignition timing using
CONSULT-II.
If trouble symptom disappears, see
CHECK ITEM.
G Perform Idle Air Volume Learn-
ing.
POWER BAL-
ANCE
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine.
G A/C switch OFF
G Shift lever N
G Cut off each injector signal one at
a time using CONSULT-II.
Engine runs rough or dies.
G Harness and connectors
G Compression
G Fuel injectors
G Power transistor
G Spark plugs
G Ignition coils
COOLING FAN
G Ignition switch: ON
G Turn the cooling fan ON and
OFF with CONSULT-II.
Cooling fan moves and stops.
G Harness and connectors
G Cooling fan relay
G Cooling fan motor
ENG COOLANT
TEMP
G Engine: Return to the original
trouble condition
G Change the engine coolant tem-
perature using CONSULT-II.
If trouble symptom disappears, see
CHECK ITEM.
G Harness and connectors
G Engine coolant temperature sen-
sor
G Fuel injectors
FUEL PUMP
RELAY
G Ignition switch: ON (Engine
stopped)
G Turn the fuel pump relay ON
and OFF using CONSULT-II
and listen to operating sound.
Fuel pump relay makes the operat-
ing sound.
G Harness and connectors
G Fuel pump relay
PURG VOL
CONT/V
G Engine: After warming up, run
engine at 1,500 rpm.
G Change the EVAP canister purge
volume control solenoid valve
opening percent using CON-
SULT-II.
Engine speed changes according to
the opening percent.
G Harness and connectors
G Solenoid valve
V/T ASSIGN
ANGLE
G Engine: Return to the original
trouble condition
G Change intake valve timing using
CONSULT-II.
If trouble symptom disappears, see
CHECK ITEM.
G Harness and connectors
G Intake valve timing control sole-
noid valve
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-645
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
REAL TIME DIAGNOSIS IN DATA MONITOR MODE (RECORDING VEHICLE DATA)
Description
CONSULT-II has two kinds of triggers and they can be selected by touching SETTING in DATA MONITOR
mode.
1. AUTO TRIG (Automatic trigger):
G The malfunction will be identified on the CONSULT-II screen
in real time.
In other words, DTC/1st trip DTC and malfunction item will be
displayed if the malfunction is detected by ECM.
At the moment a malfunction is detected by ECM, MONI-
TOR in DATA MONITOR screen is changed to Recording
Data ... xx% as shown at right, and the data after the mal-
function detection is recorded. Then when the percentage
reached 100%, REAL-TIME DIAG screen is displayed. If
STOP is touched on the screen during Recording Data ...
xx%, REAL-TIME DIAG screen is also displayed.
The recording time after the malfunction detection and the
recording speed can be changed by TRIGGER POINT and
Recording Speed. Refer to CONSULT-II OPERATION MAN-
UAL.
2. MANU TRIG (Manual trigger):
G DTC/1st trip DTC and malfunction item will not be displayed
automatically on CONSULT-II screen even though a malfunc-
tion is detected by ECM.
DATA MONITOR can be performed continuously even though
a malfunction is detected.
Operation
1. AUTO TRIG
G While trying to detect the DTC/1st trip DTC by performing the DTC Confirmation Procedure, be sure
to select to DATA MONITOR (AUTO TRIG) mode. You can confirm the malfunction at the moment it is
detected.
G While narrowing down the possible causes, CONSULT-II should be set in DATA MONITOR (AUTO
TRIG) mode, especially in case the incident is intermittent.
When you are inspecting the circuit by gently shaking (or twisting) the suspicious connectors, compo-
nents and harness in the DTC Confirmation Procedure, the moment a malfunction is found the DTC/
1st trip DTC will be displayed. (Refer to Incident Simulation Tests in GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient
Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident" .)
2. MANU TRIG
G If the malfunction is displayed as soon as DATA MONITOR is selected, reset CONSULT-II to MANU
TRIG. By selecting MANU TRIG you can monitor and store the data. The data can be utilized for fur-
ther diagnosis, such as a comparison with the value for the normal operating condition.
SEF705Y
SEF707X
EC-646
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EUG
Remarks:
G Specification data are reference values.
G Specification data are output/input values which are detected or supplied by the ECM at the connector.
* Specification data may not be directly related to their components signals/values/operations.
i.e. Adjust ignition timing with a timing light before monitoring IGN TIMING, because the monitor may show the specification data in
spite of the ignition timing not being adjusted to the specification data. This IGN TIMING monitors the data calculated by the ECM
according to the signals input from the camshaft position sensor and other ignition timing related sensors.
PBIB0197E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
ENG SPEED
G Tachometer: Connect
G Run engine and compare tachometer indication with the CONSULT-II
value.
Almost the same speed as the
CONSULT-II value.
MAS A/F SE-B1
G Engine: After warming up
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Shift lever: N
G No-load
Idle Approx. 1.0 - 1.7V
2,500 rpm Approx. 1.5 - 2.1V
B/FUEL SCHDL
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 1.5 - 3.0 msec
2,000 rpm 1.2 - 3.0 msec
A/F ALPHA-B1
A/F ALPHA-B2
*
G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
75% - 125%
COOLAN TEMP/S G Engine: After warming up More than 70C (158F)
HO2S1 (B1)
HO2S1 (B2)
*
G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S2 (B1)
HO2S2 (B2)
*
G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-647
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
HO2S1 MNTR (B1)
HO2S1 MNTR (B2)
*
G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times dur-
ing 10 seconds.
HO2S2 MNTR (B1)
HO2S2 MNTR (B2)
*
G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
LEAN RICH
VEH SPEED SE
G Turn drive wheels and compare speedometer indication with the CON-
SULT-II value.
Almost the same speed as the
CONSULT-II value
BATTERY VOLT G Ignition switch: ON (Engine stopped) 11 - 14V
ACCEL SEN1
ACCEL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed More than 3.9V
THRTL SEN1
THRTL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released More than 0.36V
G Shift lever:
D (A/T model)
1st (M/T model)
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
START SIGNAL G Ignition switch: ON START ON OFF ON OFF
CLSD THL POS G Ignition switch: ON
Accelerator pedal: Fully released ON
Accelerator pedal: Slightly depressed OFF
AIR COND SIG
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Air conditioner switch: OFF OFF
Air conditioner switch: ON
(Compressor operates.)
ON
P/N POSI SW G Ignition switch: ON
Shift lever: P or N (A/T model)
Neutral (M/T model)
ON
Shift lever: Except above OFF
PW/ST SIGNAL
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Steering wheel is in neutral position.
(Forward direction)
OFF
Steering wheel is turned. ON
LOAD SIGNAL G Ignition switch: ON
Rear window defogger switch is ON
and/or lighting switch is in 2nd.
ON
Rear window defogger switch is OFF
and lighting switch is OFF.
OFF
IGNITION SW G Ignition switch: ON OFF ON ON OFF ON
HEATER FAN SW
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Heater fan is operating. ON
Heater fan is not operating OFF
BRAKE SW G Ignition switch: ON
Brake pedal: Fully released OFF
Brake pedal: Slightly depressed ON
INJ PULSE-B1
INJ PULSE-B2
*
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 2.0 - 3.5 msec
2,000 rpm 1.5 - 3.5 msec
IGN TIMING
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle
M/T: 85 BTDC
A/T: 105 BTDC
2,000 rpm 25 - 45 BTDC
CAL/LD VALUE
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 10% - 35%
2,500 rpm 10% - 35%
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
EC-648
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
MASS AIRFLOW
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 1.0 - 4.0 gm/s
2,500 rpm 5.0 - 10.0 gm/s
PURG VOL C/V
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 0%
2,000 rpm 15 - 30%
INT/V TIM (B1)
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 5 - 5CA
2,000 rpm Approx. 0 - 30CA
INT/V SOL (B1)
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 0% - 2%
2,000 rpm Approx. 0% - 60%
AIR COND RLY
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Air conditioner switch: OFF OFF
Air conditioner switch: ON
(Compressor operates)
ON
FUEL PUMP RLY
G For 1 seconds after turning ignition switch ON
G Engine running or cranking
ON
G Except above conditions OFF
THRTL RELAY G Ignition switch: ON ON
COOLING FAN
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
Engine coolant temperature is 99C
(210F) or less
OFF
Engine coolant temperature is 100C
(212F) or more
ON
HO2S1 HTR (B1)
HO2S1 HTR (B2)
*
G Engine: After warming up
G Engine speed: Below 3,600 rpm (M/T models)
Below 3,200 rpm (A/T models)
ON
G Engine speed: Above 3,600 rpm (M/T models)
Above 3,200 rpm (A/T models)
OFF
HO2S2 HTR (B1)
HO2S2 HTR (B2)
*
G Engine speed: Below 3,600 rpm [After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of
70 km/h (43 MPH) or more]
ON
G Engine speed: Above 3,600 rpm OFF
TRVL AFTER MIL G Ignition switch: ON
Vehicle has traveled after MI has
turned ON.
0 - 65,280 km
(0 - 40,565 mile)
O2SEN HTR DTY
G Engine coolant temperature when engine started: More than 80 (176F)
G Engine speed: Below 3,600 rpm (M/T models)
Below 3,200 rpm (A/T models)
Approx. 50%
AC PRESS SEN
G Ignition switch: ON (Engine stopped) Approx. 0V
G Engine: Idle
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
1.0 - 4.0V
VEH SPEED SE
G Turn drive wheels and compare speedometer indication with the CON-
SULT-II value.
Almost the same speed as the
CONSULT-II value
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-649
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
*: These items are displayed with QG18DE engine models
Major Sensor Reference Graph in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EUH
The following are the major sensor reference graphs in DATA MONITOR mode.
CLSD THL POS, ACCEL SEN 1, THRTL SEN 1
Below is the data for CLSD THL POS, ACCEL SEN 1 and THRTL SEN 1 when depressing the accelera-
tor pedal with the ignition switch ON and with selector lever in D position (A/T models) or with shift lever in
1st position (M/T models).
The signal of ACCEL SEN 1 and THRTL SEN 1 should rise gradually without any intermittent drop or rise
after CLSD THL POS is changed from ON to OFF.
ENG SPEED, MAS A/F SE-B1, THRTL SEN 1, HO2S2 (B1), HO2S1 (B1), INJ PULSE-B1
Below is the data for ENG SPEED, MAS A/F SE-B1, THRTL SEN 1, HO2S2 (B1), HO2S1 (B1) and
INJ PULSE-B1 when revving engine quickly up to 4,800 rpm under no load after warming up engine suffi-
ciently.
CAN COMM
G Ignition switch: ON
OK
CAN CIRC 1 OK
CAN CIRC 2 OK or UNKWN
CAN CIRC 3 UNKWN
CAN CIRC 4 OK
CAN CIRC 5 UNKWN
CAN CIRC 6 OK
CAN CIRC 7 UNKWN
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
PBIB0198E
EC-650
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Each value is for reference, the exact value may vary.
SEF241Y
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-651
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
PBIB0668E
EC-652
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE PFP:00031
Description EBS00EUI
The specification (SP) value indicates the tolerance of the value that is displayed in DATA MONITOR (SPEC)
mode of CONSULT-II during normal operation of the Engine Control System. When the value in DATA MONI-
TOR (SPEC) mode is within the SP value, the Engine Control System is confirmed OK. When the value in
DATA MONITOR (SPEC) mode is NOT within the SP value, the Engine Control System may have one or
more malfunctions.
The SP value is used to detect malfunctions that may affect the Engine Control System, but will not light the
MI.
The SP value will be displayed for the following three items:
G B/FUEL SCHDL (The fuel injection pulse width programmed into ECM prior to any learned on board cor-
rection)
G A/F ALPHA-B1/B2 (The mean value of air-fuel ratio feedback correction factor per cycle)
G MAS A/F SE-B1 (The signal voltage of the mass air flow sensor)
Testing Condition EBS00EUJ
G Vehicle driven distance: More than 5,000 km (3,017 miles)
G Barometric pressure: 98.3 - 104.3 kPa (1.003 - 1.064 kg/cm
2
, 14.25 - 15.12 psi)
G Atmospheric temperature: 20 - 30C (68 - 86F)
G Engine coolant temperature: 75 - 95C (167 - 203F)
G Transmission: Warmed-up*1
G Electrical load: Not applied*2
G Engine speed: Idle
*1: For A/T models with CONSULT-II, after the engine is warmed up to normal operating temperature, drive
vehicle until FLUID TEMP SE (A/T fluid temperature sensor signal) indicates more than 60C (140F).
For A/T models without CONSUT-II and M/T models, after the engine is warmed up to normal operating tem-
perature, drive vehicle for 5 minutes.
*2: Rear window defogger switch, air conditioner switch, lighting switch are OFF. Steering wheel is straight
ahead.
Inspection Procedure EBS00EUK
NOTE:
Perform DATA MONITOR (SPEC) mode in maximum scale display.
1. Perform EC-607, "Basic Inspection" .
2. Confirm that the testing conditions indicated above are met.
3. Select B/FUEL SCHDL, A/F ALPHA-B1/B2 and MAS A/F
SE-B1 in DATA MONITOR (SPEC) mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Make sure that monitor items are within the SP value.
5. If NG, go to EC-653, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF601Z
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE
EC-653
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EUL
SEF613ZD
EC-654
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE
SEF768Z
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE
EC-655
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
SEF615ZA
EC-656
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT PFP:00006
Description EBS00EUM
Intermittent incidents (I/I) may occur. In many cases, the problem resolves itself (the part or circuit function
returns to normal without intervention). It is important to realize that the symptoms described in the customer's
complaint often do not recur on (1st trip) DTC visits. Realize also that the most frequent cause of I/I occur-
rences is poor electrical connections. Because of this, the conditions under which the incident occurred may
not be clear. Therefore, circuit checks made as part of the standard diagnostic procedure may not indicate the
specific problem area.
Common I/I Report Situations
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EUN
1. INSPECTION START
Erase (1st trip) DTCs. Refer to EC-594, "HOW TO ERASE EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMA-
TION" .
>> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK GROUND TERMINALS
Check ground terminals for corroding or loose connection.
Refer to GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident" , Incident Simulation Tests.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
3. SEARCH FOR ELECTRICAL INCIDENT
Perform GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident" , Incident Simulation Tests.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> Repair or replace.
STEP in Work Flow Situation
II The CONSULT-II is used. The SELF-DIAG RESULTS screen shows time data other than 0 or [1t].
III The symptom described by the customer does not recur.
IV (1st trip) DTC does not appear during the DTC Confirmation Procedure.
VI The Diagnostic Procedure for PXXXX does not indicate the problem area.
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
EC-657
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM PFP:24110
Wiring Diagram EBS00EUO
MBWA0044E
EC-658
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EUP
1. INSPECTION START
Start engine.
Is engine running?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 8.
No >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-I
1. Turn ignition switch OFF and then ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 109 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
1 B ECM ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Engine ground
109 B/R Ignition switch
[Ignition switch OFF] 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
111 W/G
ECM relay
(Self shut-off)
[Engine is running]
[Ignition switch OFF]
G For a few seconds after turning ignition switch
OFF
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch OFF]
G More than a few seconds passed after turning
ignition switch OFF
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
115
116
B
B
ECM ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Engine ground
119
120
W
W
Power supply for
ECM
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0015E
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
EC-659
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Fuse block (J/B) connector M1
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between ECM and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK ECM GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT-I
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals 1, 115, 116 and engine ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-II
1. Disconnect ECM relay.
2. Check voltage between ECM relay terminals 1 and 6 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0155E
Voltage: Battery voltage
SEF420X
EC-660
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
6. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E70, F13 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E63, F31 (RHD models)
G 10A fuse
G 20A fuse
G Harness for open or short between ECM relay and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 111 and ECM relay terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> Go to EC-895, "IGNITION SIGNAL" .
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-III
1. Stop engine and wait at least 10 seconds.
2. Turn ignition switch ON and then OFF.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminals 119, 120 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG (Battery voltage does not exist.)>>GO TO 9.
NG (Battery voltage exists for more than a few seconds.)>>GO TO 12.
Continuity should exist.
Voltage: After turning ignition switch OFF, battery
voltage will exist for a few seconds, then
drop approximately 0V.
MBIB0016E
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
EC-661
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
9. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-IV
1. Disconnect ECM relay.
2. Check voltage between ECM relay terminal 3 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> GO TO 10.
10. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between ECM relay and F13 (LHD models)
G Harness for open or short between ECM relay and F31 (RHD models)
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
11. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-V
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals 119, 120 and ECM relay terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
12. CHECK ECM RELAY
Refer to EC-662, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> Replace ECM relay.
MBIB0155E
Voltage: Battery voltage
SEF860T
Continuity should exist.
EC-662
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
13. CHECK ECM GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT-II
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals 1, 115, 116 and engine ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
14. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GKC
ECM RELAY
1. Apply 12V direct current between ECM relay terminals 1 and 2.
2. Check continuity between relay terminals 3 and 5, 6 and 7.
3. If NG, replace ECM relay.
Continuity should exist.
Condition Continuity
12V direct current supply
between terminals 1 and
2
Yes
OFF No
PBIB0077E
DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE
EC-663
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE PFP:23710
Description EBS00EUQ
CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real time application. It is an on-vehicle mul-
tiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent error detection ability. Many elec-
tronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links with other
control units during operation (not independent). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2
communication lines (CAN H line, CAN L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission with less wiring.
Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EUR
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EUS
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 3 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-665, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
DTC No.
Trouble diagnosis
name
DTC detecting condition Possible cause
U1000
1000
CAN communication
line
G ECM cannot communicate to other control
unit.
G ECM cannot communicate for more than the
specified time.
G Harness or connectors
(CAN communication line is open or
shorted.)
U1001
1001
EC-664
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE
Wiring Diagram EBS00EUT
MBWA0038E
DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE
EC-665
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EUU
1. INSPECTION START
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Print out the CONSULT-II screen.
A/T models
M/T models
>> Go to LAN-8, "CAN COMMUNICATION" .
MBIB0180E
MBIB0179E
EC-666
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR PFP:22680
Component Description EBS00EUV
The mass air flow sensor is placed in the stream of intake air. It mea-
sures the intake flow rate by measuring a part of the entire intake
flow. It consists of a hot film that is supplied with electric current from
the ECM. The temperature of the hot film is controlled by the ECM a
certain amount. The heat generated by the hot film is reduced as the
intake air flows around it. The more air, the greater the heat loss.
Therefore, the ECM must supply more electric current to maintain
the temperature of the hot film as air flow increases. The ECM
detects the air flow by means of this current change.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EUW
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EUX
These self-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EUY
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
SEC266C
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
MAS A/F SE-B1
G Engine: After warming up
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Shift lever: N
G No-load
Idle Approx. 1.0 - 1.7V
2,500 rpm Approx. 1.5 - 2.1V
CAL/LD VALUE
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 10% - 35%
2,500 rpm 10% - 35%
MASS AIRFLOW
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 1.0 - 4.0 gm/s
2,500 rpm 5.0 - 10.0 gm/s
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0102
0102
Mass air flow sensor circuit
low input
An excessively low voltage from the sensor
is sent to ECM when engine is running.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Intake air leaks
G Mass air flow sensor
P0103
0103
Mass air flow sensor circuit
high input
An excessively high voltage from the sensor
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Mass air flow sensor
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
Mass air flow sensor circuit Engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm due to the fuel cut.
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
EC-667
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
PROCEDURE FOR DTC P0102
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and wait 5 seconds at most.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-669, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and wait 5 seconds at most.
2. Tarn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-669, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
PROCEDURE FOR DTC P0103
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Wait at least 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-669, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If DTC is not detected, go to next step.
5. Start engine and wait at least 5 seconds.
6. If DTC is detected, go to EC-669, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 5 seconds.
2. Tarn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-669, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If DTC is not detected, go to next step.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
6. Start engine and wait at least 5 seconds.
7. Tarn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
8. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
9. If DTC is detected, go to EC-669, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
SEF058Y
EC-668
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00EUZ
MBWA0045E
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
EC-669
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EV0
1. INSPECTION START
Which malfunction (P0102 or P0103) is duplicated?
P0102 or P0103
P0102 >> GO TO 2.
P0103 >> GO TO 3.
2. CHECK INTAKE SYSTEM
Check the following for connection.
G Air duct
G Vacuum hoses
G Intake air passage between air duct to intake manifold
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Reconnect the parts.
3. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 4.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
45 R
Sensor power supply
(Mass air flow sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
50 Y Mass air flow sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.0 - 1.7V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,500 rpm.
1.5 - 2.1V
67 B
Sensor ground
(Mass air flow sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0095E
EC-670
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
4. CHECK MAF SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect MAF sensor harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between MAF sensor terminals 2, 4 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between mass air flow sensor and ECM
G Harness for open or short between mass air flow sensor and ECM relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK MAF SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between MAF sensor terminal 3 and ECM terminal 67.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK MAF SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between MAF sensor terminal 1 and ECM terminal 50.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0096E
Terminal Voltage
2 Approximately 5V
4 Battery voltage
PBIB0076E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
EC-671
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
8. CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EC-671, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace mass air flow sensor.
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EV1
MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
1. Reconnect harness connectors disconnected.
2. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminal 50 (Mass air flow sensor
signal) and ground.
*: Check for liner voltage rise in response to engine being increased to about
4,000 rpm.
4. If the voltage is out of specification, proceed the following.
a. Turn ignition switch OFF.
b. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector and reconnect it again.
c. Perform steps 2 and 3 again.
5. If NG, remove mass air flow sensor from air duct. Check hot film for damage or dust.
6. If NG, clean or replace mass air flow sensor.
Removal and Installation EBS00EV2
MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EM-17, "AIR CLEANER AND AIR DUCT" .
Condition Voltage V
Ignition switch ON (Engine stopped.) Approx. 1.0
Idle (Engine is warmed-up to normal operating
temperature.)
1.0 - 1.7
2,500 rpm (Engine is warmed-up to normal
operating temperature.)
1.5 - 2.1
Idle to about 4,000 rpm* 1.0 - 1.7 to Approx. 4.0
MBIB0017E
EC-672
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR PFP:22630
Component Description EBS00EV3
The engine coolant temperature sensor is used to detect the engine
coolant temperature. The sensor modifies a voltage signal from the
ECM. The modified signal returns to the ECM as the engine coolant
temperature input. The sensor uses a thermistor which is sensitive to
the change in temperature. The electrical resistance of the ther-
mistor decreases as temperature increases.
<Reference data>
*: These data are reference values and are measured between ECM terminal 72
(Engine coolant temperature sensor) and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EV4
These self-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When this malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
SEF594K
Engine coolant
temperature C (F)
Voltage* V Resistance k
10 (14) 4.4 7.0 - 11.4
20 (68) 3.5 2.1 - 2.9
50 (122) 2.2 0.68 - 1.00
90 (194) 0.9 0.236 - 0.260
SEF012P
DTC No. Trouble Diagnosis Name DTC Detecting Condition Possible Cause
P0117
0117
Engine coolant temperature
sensor circuit low input
An excessively low voltage from the sensor is
sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Engine coolant temperature sensor
P0118
0118
Engine coolant temperature
sensor circuit high input
An excessively high voltage from the sensor is
sent to ECM.
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
Engine coolant temper-
ature sensor circuit
Engine coolant temperature will be determined by ECM based on the time after turning ignition switch ON
or START.
CONSULT-II displays the engine coolant temperature decided by ECM.
Condition
Engine coolant temperature decided
(CONSULT-II display)
Just as ignition switch is turned ON or Start 40C (104F)
More than approx. 4 minutes after ignition ON or
Start
80C (176F)
Except as shown above
40 - 80C (104 - 176F)
(Depends on the time)
When the fail-safe system for engine coolant temperature sensor is activated, the cooling fan operates
while engine is running.
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR
EC-673
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EV5
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Wait at least 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-675, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 5 seconds.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-675, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
EC-674
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00EV6
MBWA0047E
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR
EC-675
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EV7
1. CHECK ECT SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor harness
connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between ECT sensor terminal 1 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
2. CHECK ECT SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between ECT sensor terminal 2 and engine ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between engine coolant temperature sensor and ECM
G Harness for open or short between engine coolant temperature sensor and TCM
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Refer to EC-676, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace engine coolant temperature sensor.
MBIB0097E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0080E
Continuity should exist.
EC-676
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EV8
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Check resistance between engine coolant temperature sensor
terminals 1 and 2 as shown in the figure.
<Reference data>
*: These data are reference values and are measured between ECM terminal
72 (Engine coolant temperature sensor) and ground.
2. If NG, replace engine coolant temperature sensor.
Removal and Installation EBS00EV9
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Refer to CO-20, "THERMOSTAT AND THERMOSTAT HOUSING" .
PBIB0081E
Engine coolant
temperature C (F)
Voltage* V Resistance k
10 (14) 4.4 7.0 - 11.4
20 (68) 3.5 2.1 - 2.9
50 (122) 2.2 0.68 - 1.00
90 (194) 0.9 0.236 - 0.260
SEF012P
DTC P0132 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-677
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0132 HO2S1 (QG16DE) PFP:22690
Component Description EBS00H66
The heated oxygen sensor 1 is placed into the exhaust manifold. It
detects the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas compared to the
outside air. The heated oxygen sensor 1 has a closed-end tube
made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from
approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner conditions. The
heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM adjusts
the injection pulse duration to achieve the ideal air-fuel ratio. The
ideal air-fuel ratio occurs near the radical change from 1V to 0V.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H67
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H68
To judge the malfunction, the diagnosis checks that the heated oxy-
gen sensor 1 output is not inordinately high.
SEF463R
SEF288D
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 (B1) G Engine: After warming up Maintaining engine speed at 2,000 rpm 0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up Maintaining engine speed at 2,000 rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times during
10 seconds.
SEF301UA
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0132
0132
Heated oxygen sensor 1
circuit high voltage
An excessively high voltage from the sensor
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
EC-678
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0132 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H69
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
5. Restart engine and let it idle for 2 minutes.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-680, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Restart engine and let it idle for 2 minutes.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
5. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-680, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF174Y
DTC P0132 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-679
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00H6A
MBWA0048E
EC-680
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0132 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H6B
1. RETIGHTEN HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten heated oxygen sensor 1.
>> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK HO2S1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S1
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
35 W Heated oxygen sensor 1
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
Tightening torque: 40 - 60 Nm (4.1 - 6.2 kg-m, 30 - 44 ft-lb)
MBIB0098E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0091E
DTC P0132 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-681
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK HO2S1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 and HO2S1 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 or HO2S1 terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK HO2S1 CONNECTOR FOR WATER
Check heated oxygen sensor 1 connectors for water.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-681, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H6C
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG and adjust TRIGGER POINT to 100% in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-
II.
3. Select HO2S1 (B1) and HO2S1 MNTR (B1).
4. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load during the follow-
ing steps.
5. Touch RECORD on CONSULT-II screen.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
Water should not exist.
SEF646Y
EC-682
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0132 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
6. Check the following.
G HO2S1 MNTR (B1) in DATA MONITOR mode changes
from RICH to LEAN to RICH 5 times in 10 seconds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes below 0.3V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
G The voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new
one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00H6D
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-23, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER" .
SEF217YA
SEF648Y
MBIB0018E
DTC P0132, P0152 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-683
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0132, P0152 HO2S1 (QG18DE) PFP:22690
Component Description EBS00H6E
The heated oxygen sensor 1 is placed into the exhaust manifold. It
detects the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas compared to the
outside air. The heated oxygen sensor 1 has a closed-end tube
made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from
approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner conditions. The
heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM adjusts
the injection pulse duration to achieve the ideal air-fuel ratio. The
ideal air-fuel ratio occurs near the radical change from 1V to 0V.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H6F
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H6G
To judge the malfunction, the diagnosis checks that the heated oxy-
gen sensor 1 output is not inordinately high.
SEF463R
SEF288D
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 (B1)
HO2S1 (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1)
HO2S1 MNTR (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times dur-
ing 10 seconds.
SEF301UA
EC-684
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0132, P0152 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H6H
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
5. Restart engine and let it idle for 2 minutes.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-688, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Restart engine and let it idle for 2 minutes.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
5. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-688, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0132
0132
(Bank 1)
Heated oxygen sensor 1
circuit high voltage
An excessively high voltage from the sensor
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
P0152
0152
(Bank 2)
SEF174Y
DTC P0132, P0152 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-685
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00H6I
BANK 1
MBWA0052E
EC-686
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0132, P0152 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
35 W
Heated oxygen sensor 1
(bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
DTC P0132, P0152 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-687
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
BANK 2
MBWA0054E
EC-688
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0132, P0152 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H6J
1. RETIGHTEN HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten corresponding heated oxygen sensor 1.
>> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK HO2S1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S1
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
36 W
Heated oxygen sensor 1
(bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
Tightening torque: 40 - 60 Nm (4.1 - 6.2 kg-m, 30 - 44 ft-lb)
MBIB0099E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0092E
DTC P0132, P0152 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-689
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK HO2S1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal and HO2S1 terminal as follows.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between the following terminals and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK HO2S1 CONNECTOR FOR WATER
Check heated oxygen sensor 1 connectors for water.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-689, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 1.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H6K
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG and adjust TRIGGER POINT to 100% in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-
II.
3. Select HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) and HO2S1 MNTR (B1)/(B2).
4. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load during the following steps.
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P0132 35 2 1
P0152 36 2 2
Continuity should exist.
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P0132 35 2 1
P0152 36 2 2
Continuity should not exist.
Water should not exist.
EC-690
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0132, P0152 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
5. Touch RECORD on CONSULT-II screen.
6. Check the following.
G HO2S1 MNTR (B1)/(B2) in DATA MONITOR mode
changes from RICH to LEAN to RICH 5 times in 10 sec-
onds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage goes below 0.3V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] or 36 [HO2S1 (B2) signal] and
engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
G The voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
SEF646Y
SEF647Y
SEF648Y
MBIB0019E
DTC P0132, P0152 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-691
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00H6L
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-23, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER" .
EC-692
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0134 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
DTC P0134 HO2S1 (QG16DE) PFP:22690
Component Description EBS00FUF
The heated oxygen sensor 1 is placed into the exhaust manifold. It
detects the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas compared to the
outside air. The heated oxygen sensor 1 has a closed-end tube
made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from
approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner conditions. The
heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM adjusts
the injection pulse duration to achieve the ideal air-fuel ratio. The
ideal air-fuel ratio occurs near the radical change from 1V to 0V.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FUG
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FUH
Under the condition in which the heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is
not input, the ECM circuits will read a continuous approximately
0.3V. Therefore, for this diagnosis, the time that output voltage is
within 200 to 400 mV range is monitored, and the diagnosis checks
that this time is not inordinately long.
SEF463R
SEF288D
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times dur-
ing 10 seconds.
SEF237U
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0134
0134
Heated oxygen sensor 1
circuit no activity detected
The voltage from the sensor is constantly
approx. 0.3V.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
DTC P0134 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-693
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Overall Function Check EBS00FUJ
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG in DATA MONITOR mode with CON-
SULT-II, and select HO2S1 (B1).
3. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load.
4. Make sure that the indications do not remain in the range
between 0.2 to 0.4V.
5. If NG, go to EC-695, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
The voltage does not remain in the range of 0.2 - 0.4V.
4. If NG, go to EC-695, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF646Y
MBIB0018E
EC-694
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0134 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
Wiring Diagram EBS00FUK
MBWA0048E
DTC P0134 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-695
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FUL
1. INSPECTION START
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK HO2S1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S1
terminal 3. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
35 W Heated oxygen sensor 1
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0095E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0091E
EC-696
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0134 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
3. CHECK HO2S1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 and HO2S1 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 or HO2S1 terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-695, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FUM
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG and adjust TRIGGER POINT to 100% in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-
II.
3. Select HO2S1 (B1) and HO2S1 MNTR (B1).
4. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load during the follow-
ing steps.
5. Touch RECORD on CONSULT-II screen.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
SEF646Y
DTC P0134 HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-697
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. Check the following.
G HO2S1 MNTR (B1) in DATA MONITOR mode changes
from RICH to LEAN to RICH 5 times in 10 seconds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes below 0.3V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m
(19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor
Thread Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
G The voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been
dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor;
use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor
Thread Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FUN
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-23, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER" .
SEF217YA
SEF648Y
MBIB0018E
EC-698
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1 (QG18DE) PFP:22690
Component Description EBS00FUO
The heated oxygen sensor 1 is placed into the EXHAUST MANI-
FOLD. It detects the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas compared
to the outside air. The heated oxygen sensor 1 has a closed-end
tube made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from
approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner conditions. The
heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM adjusts
the injection pulse duration to achieve the ideal air-fuel ratio. The
ideal air-fuel ratio occurs near the radical change from 1V to 0V.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FUP
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00FUQ
Under the condition in which the heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is
not input, the ECM circuits will read a continuous approximately
0.3V. Therefore, for this diagnosis, the time that output voltage is
within 200 to 400 mV range is monitored, and the diagnosis checks
that this time is not inordinately long.
SEF463R
SEF288D
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 (B1)
HO2S1 (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1)
HO2S1 MNTR (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times dur-
ing 10 seconds.
SEF237U
DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-699
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Overall Function Check EBS00FUS
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG in DATA MONITOR mode with CON-
SULT-II, and select HO2S1 (B1) and HO2S1 (B2).
3. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load.
4. Make sure that the indications do not remain in the range
between 0.2 to 0.4V.
5. If NG, go to EC-703, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] or 36 [HO2S1 (B2) signal] and
engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
The voltage does not remain in the range of 0.2 - 0.4V.
4. If NG, go to EC-703, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0134
0134
(Bank 1)
Heated oxygen sensor 1
circuit no activity detected
The voltage from the sensor is constantly
approx. 0.3V.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
P0154
0154
(Bank 2)
SEF646Y
MBIB0019E
EC-700
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
Wiring Diagram EBS00FUT
BANK 1
MBWA0052E
DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-701
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
35 W
Heated oxygen sensor 1
(bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
EC-702
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
BANK 2
MBWA0054E
DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-703
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FUU
1. INSPECTION START
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK HO2S1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S1
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
36 W
Heated oxygen sensor 1
(bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0095E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0092E
EC-704
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
3. CHECK HO2S1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal and HO2S1 terminal as follows.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between the following terminals and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-704, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 1.
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FUV
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG and adjust TRIGGER POINT to 100% in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-
II.
3. Select HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) and HO2S1 MNTR (B1)/(B2).
4. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load during the following steps.
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P0134 35 2 1
P0154 36 2 2
Continuity should exist.
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P0134 35 2 1
P0154 36 2 2
Continuity should not exist.
DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-705
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. Touch RECORD on CONSULT-II screen.
6. Check the following.
G HO2S1 MNTR (B1)/(B2) in DATA MONITOR mode
changes from RICH to LEAN to RICH 5 times in 10 sec-
onds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage goes below 0.3V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] or 36 [HO2S1 (B2) signal] and
engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
G The voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
SEF646Y
SEF647Y
SEF648Y
MBIB0019E
EC-706
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0134, P0154 HO2S1 (QG18DE)
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FUW
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-23, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER" .
DTC P0138 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
EC-707
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0138 HO2S2 (QG16DE) PFP:226A0
Component Description EBS00H6M
The heated oxygen sensor 2, after three way catalyst, monitors the
oxygen level in the exhaust gas.
Even if switching characteristics of the heated oxygen sensor 1 are
shifted, the air fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal
from the heated oxygen sensor 2.
This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates volt-
age from approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner condi-
tions.
Under normal conditions the heated oxygen sensor 2 is not used for
engine control operation.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H6N
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H6O
The heated oxygen sensor 2 has a much longer switching time
between rich and lean than the heated oxygen sensor 1. The oxygen
storage capacity before the three way catalyst causes the longer
switching time. To judge the malfunctions of heated oxygen sensor
2, ECM monitors whether the voltage is unusually high during the
various driving condition such as fuel-cut.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H6P
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
3. Stop vehicle with engine running.
SEF327R
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S2 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S2 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
LEAN RICH
SEF305UA
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0138
0138
Heated oxygen sensor 2
circuit high voltage
An excessively high voltage from the sensor
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 2
EC-708
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0138 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
4. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-710, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
Overall Function Check EBS00H6Q
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 2 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 (HO2S2 signal) and engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be below 1.4V during this procedure.
5. If NG, go to EC-710, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF189Y
MBIB0020E
DTC P0138 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
EC-709
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00H6R
MBWA0050E
EC-710
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0138 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H6S
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
16 W Heated oxygen sensor 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0095E
DTC P0138 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
EC-711
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure that DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-73, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure that DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0172. Refer to EC-299 .
No >> GO TO 3.
3. CHECK HO2S2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S2
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
SEF215Z
MBIB0096E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0093E
EC-712
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0138 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
4. CHECK HO2S2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 16 and HO2S2 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 16 or HO2S2 terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EC-712, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H6T
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Select FUEL INJECTION in ACTIVE TEST mode, and select
HO2S2 (B1) as the monitor item with CONSULT-II.
4. Check HO2S2 (B1) at idle speed when adjusting FUEL INJECTION to 25%.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
SEF662Y
PBIB0551E
DTC P0138 HO2S2 (QG16DE)
EC-713
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
HO2S2 (B1) should be above 0.68V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is +25%.
HO2S2 (B1) should be below 0.50V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is 25%.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 (HO2S2 signal) and engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.68V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage is above 0.68V at step 4, step 5 is not neces-
sary.
5. Keep vehicle idling for 10 minutes, then check voltage. Or check
the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in 3rd gear
position.
The voltage should be below 0.50V at least once during this
procedure.
6. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00H6U
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EX-3, "EXHAUST SYSTEM" .
MBIB0020E
EC-714
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0138, P0158 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
DTC P0138, P0158 HO2S2 (QG18DE) PFP:226A0
Component Description EBS00H6V
The heated oxygen sensor 2, after three way catalyst, monitors the
oxygen level in the exhaust gas on each bank.
Even if switching characteristics of the heated oxygen sensor 1 are
shifted, the air fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal
from the heated oxygen sensor 2.
This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates volt-
age from approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner condi-
tions.
Under normal conditions the heated oxygen sensor 2 is not used for
engine control operation.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H6W
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H6X
The heated oxygen sensor 2 has a much longer switching time
between rich and lean than the heated oxygen sensor 1. The oxygen
storage capacity before the three way catalyst causes the longer
switching time. To judge the malfunctions of heated oxygen sensor
2, ECM monitors whether the voltage is unusually high during the
various driving condition such as fuel-cut.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H6Y
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
3. Stop vehicle with engine running.
SEF327R
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S2 (B1)
HO2S2 (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S2 MNTR (B1)
HO2S2 MNTR (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
LEAN RICH
SEF305UA
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0138
0138
(Bank 1)
Heated oxygen sensor 2
circuit high voltage
An excessively high voltage from the sensor
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 2
P0158
0158
(Bank 2)
DTC P0138, P0158 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-715
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-719, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
Overall Function Check EBS00H6Z
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 2 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 17 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be below 1.4V during this procedure.
5. If NG, go to EC-719, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF189Y
MBIB0021E
EC-716
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0138, P0158 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
Wiring Diagram EBS00H70
BANK 1
MBWA0056E
DTC P0138, P0158 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-717
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
16 Y
Heated oxygen sensor 2
(bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
EC-718
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0138, P0158 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
BANK 2
MBWA0058E
DTC P0138, P0158 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-719
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H71
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
17 L
Heated oxygen sensor 2
(bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0095E
EC-720
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0138, P0158 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
2. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 or P0175 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure that DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-73, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure that DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 or P0175 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0172, P0175. Refer to EC-305 .
No >> GO TO 3.
3. CHECK HO2S2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S2
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
SEF215Z
MBIB0096E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0094E
DTC P0138, P0158 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-721
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. CHECK HO2S2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal and HO2S2 terminal as follows.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between the following terminals and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EC-721, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H72
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Select FUEL INJECTION in ACTIVE TEST mode, and select
HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) as the monitor item with CONSULT-II.
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P0138 16 2 1
P0158 17 2 2
Continuity should exist.
DTC
Terminals
Bank
ECM Sensor
P0138 16 2 1
P0158 17 2 2
Continuity should not exist.
SEF662Y
EC-722
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0138, P0158 HO2S2 (QG18DE)
4. Check HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) at idle speed when adjusting FUEL INJECTION to 25%.
HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) should be above 0.68V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is +25%.
HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) should be below 0.50V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is 25%.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 17 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.68V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage is above 0.68V at step 4, step 5 is not neces-
sary.
5. Keep vehicle idling for 10 minutes, then check voltage. Or check
the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D posi-
tion with OD OFF (A/T), 3rd gear position (M/T).
The voltage should be below 0.50V at least once during this
procedure.
6. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00H73
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EX-3, "EXHAUST SYSTEM"
PBIB0551E
MBIB0021E
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
EC-723
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00EVA
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor,
throttle position sensor, etc. The throttle position sensor responds to
the throttle valve movement.
The throttle position sensor has the two sensors. These sensors are
a kind of potentiometers which transform the throttle valve position
into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM. In addi-
tion, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of the
throttle valve and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM
judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these sig-
nals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the
throttle valve opening angle properly in response to driving condi-
tion.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EVB
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EVC
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EVD
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 8V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0145E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
THRTL SEN1
THRTL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released More than 0.36V
G Shift lever:
D (A/T model)
1st (M/T model)
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0221
0221
Throttle position sensor
circuit range/performance
problem
Rationally incorrect voltage is sent to ECM
compared with the signals from TP sensor 1
and TP sensor 2.
G Harness or connector
(The TP sensor 1 and 2 circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 1 and 2)
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
EC-724
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-726, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-726, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
EC-725
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00EVE
MBWA0138E
EC-726
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EVF
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
47 G
Sensor power supply
(Throttle position sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
49 W Throttle position sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
More than 0.36V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
Less than 4.75V
66 B
Sensor ground
(Throttle position sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
68 R Throttle position sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
Less than 4.75V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 0.36V
MBIB0095E
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
EC-727
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between electric throttle control actuator terminal
1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 66 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 49 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 4, ECM
terminal 68 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
Refer to EC-728, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
MBIB0100E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0082E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
EC-728
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
6. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EVG
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Set selector lever to D position (A/T models) or 1st position (M/T models).
5. Check voltage between ECM terminals 49 (TP sensor 1 signal),
68 (TP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the following
conditions.
6. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to the next
step.
7. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
8. Perform EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00EVH
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-19, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
49
(Throttle position sensor 1)
Fully released More than 0.36V
Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
68
(Throttle position sensor 2)
Fully released Less than 4.75V
Fully depressed More than 0.36V
MBIB0022E
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
EC-729
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00EVI
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor,
throttle position sensor, etc. The throttle position sensor responds to
the throttle valve movement.
The throttle position sensor has the two sensors. These sensors are
a kind of potentiometers which transform the throttle valve position
into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM. In addi-
tion, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of the
throttle valve and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM
judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these sig-
nals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the
throttle valve opening angle properly in response to driving condi-
tion.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EVJ
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EVK
These self-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EVL
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 8V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0145E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
THRTL SEN1
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released More than 0.36V
G Shift lever:
D (A/T model)
1st (M/T model)
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0222
0222
Throttle position sensor 1
circuit low input
An excessively low voltage from the TP sensor 1
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The TP sensor 1 circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 1)
P0223
0223
Throttle position sensor 1
circuit high input
An excessively high voltage from the TP sensor 1
is sent to ECM.
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
EC-730
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-732, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-732, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
EC-731
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00EVM
MBWA0136E
EC-732
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EVN
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
47 G
Throttle position sensor
power supply
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
49 W Throttle position sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
More than 0.36V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
Less than 4.75V
66 B
Throttle position sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
68 R Throttle position sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
Less than 4.75V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 0.36V
MBIB0095E
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
EC-733
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 1 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between electric throttle control actuator terminal
1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 66 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 49 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 4.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
Refer to EC-734, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
MBIB0100E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0082E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
EC-734
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
6. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EVO
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Set selector lever to D position (A/T models) or 1st position (M/T models).
5. Check voltage between ECM terminals 49 (TP sensor 1 signal),
68 (TP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the following
conditions.
6. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to the next
step.
7. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
8. Perform EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00EVP
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-19, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
49
(Throttle position sensor 1)
Fully released More than 0.36V
Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
68
(Throttle position sensor 2)
Fully released Less than 4.75V
Fully depressed More than 0.36V
MBIB0022E
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
EC-735
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR PFP:18002
Component Description EBS00EVQ
The accelerator pedal position sensor is installed on the upper end
of the accelerator pedal assembly. The sensor detects the accelera-
tor position and sends a signal to the ECM.
Accelerator pedal position sensor has two sensors. These sensors
are a kind of potentiometers which transform the accelerator pedal
position into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM.
In addition, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of
the accelerator pedal and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The
ECM judges the current opening angle of the accelerator pedal from
these signals and controls the throttle control motor based on these
signals.
Idle position of the accelerator pedal is determined by the ECM
receiving the signal from the accelerator pedal position sensor. The ECM uses this signal for the engine oper-
ation such as fuel cut.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EVR
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EVS
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EVT
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 8V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0146E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
ACCEL SEN1
ACCEL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed More than 3.9V
CLSD THL POS G Ignition switch: ON
Accelerator pedal: Fully released ON
Accelerator pedal: Slightly depressed OFF
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0226
0226
Accelerator pedal position sensor
circuit range/performance problem
Rationally incorrect voltage is sent to ECM
compared with the signals from APP sensor
1 and APP sensor 2.
G Harness or connector
(The APP sensor 1 and 2 circuit is
open or shorted.)
G Accelerator pedal position sensor 1
and 2
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
EC-736
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-738, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-738, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
EC-737
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00EVU
MBWA0142E
EC-738
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EVV
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
82 B
Sensor ground
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
83 B
Sensor ground
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 0V
90 R
Sensor power supply
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
91 G
Sensor power supply
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
98 LG
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.175 - 0.335V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 1.95V
106 L
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.35 - 0.67V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.9V
MBIB0095E
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
EC-739
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK APP SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor harness
connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between APP sensor terminals 1, 2 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK APP SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 82 and APP sensor terminal 4, ECM terminal 83 and
APP sensor terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0152E
APP sensor terminal Voltage (V)
1 Approximately 2.5
2 Approximately 5
MBIB0152E
Continuity should exist.
EC-740
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
6. CHECK APP SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 106 and APP sensor terminal 3, ECM terminal 98 and
APP sensor terminal 6.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK APP SENSOR
Refer to EC-740, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 9.
9. REPLACE APP SENSOR
1. Replace the accelerator pedal position sensor.
2. Perform EC-589, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
10. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EVW
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
EC-741
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. Check voltage between ECM terminals 106 (APP sensor 1 sig-
nal), 98 (APP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the fol-
lowing conditions.
4. If NG, replace accelerator pedal assembly and go to the next
step.
5. Perform EC-589, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
6. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
7. Perform EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00EVX
ACCELERATOR PEDAL
Refer to ACC-2, "ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM" .
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
106
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Fully depressed More than 3.9V
98
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
Fully released 0.175 - 0.335V
Fully depressed More than 1.195V
MBIB0023E
EC-742
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR PFP:18002
Component Description EBS00EVY
The accelerator pedal position sensor is installed on the upper end
of the accelerator pedal assembly. The sensor detects the accelera-
tor position and sends a signal to the ECM.
Accelerator pedal position sensor has two sensors. These sensors
are a kind of potentiometers which transform the accelerator pedal
position into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM.
In addition, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of
the accelerator pedal and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The
ECM judges the current opening angle of the accelerator pedal from
these signals and controls the throttle control motor based on these
signals.
Idle position of the accelerator pedal is determined by the ECM
receiving the signal from the accelerator pedal position sensor. The ECM uses this signal for the engine oper-
ation such as fuel cut.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EVZ
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EW0
These self-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EW1
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 8V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0146E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
ACCEL SEN1
G Ignition switch: ON
(engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed More than 3.9V
CLSD THL POS G Ignition switch: ON
Accelerator pedal: Fully released ON
Accelerator pedal: Slightly depressed OFF
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0227
0227
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1 circuit low input
An excessively low voltage from the APP sensor 1
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The APP sensor 1 circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Accelerator pedal position sensor
(Accelerator pedal position sensor 1)
P0228
0228
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1 circuit high input
An excessively high voltage from the APP sensor 1
is sent to ECM.
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
EC-743
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-745, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-745, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
EC-744
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00EW2
MBWA0140E
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
EC-745
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EW3
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
82 B
Sensor ground
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
83 B
Sensor ground
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 0V
90 R
Sensor power supply
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
91 G
Sensor power supply
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
98 LG
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.175 - 0.335V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 1.95V
106 L
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.35 - 0.67V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.9V
MBIB0095E
EC-746
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
2. CHECK APP SENSOR 1 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor harness
connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between APP sensor terminal 2 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK APP SENSOR 1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 82 and APP sensor terminal 4.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0152E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0811E
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
EC-747
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK APP SENSOR 1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 106 and APP sensor terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK APP SENSOR
Refer to EC-747, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 9.
9. REPLACE APP SENSOR
1. Replace the accelerator pedal position sensor.
2. Perform EC-589, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
10. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EW4
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminals 106 (APP sensor 1 sig-
nal), 98 (APP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the fol-
lowing conditions.
Continuity should exist.
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
106
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Fully depressed More than 3.9V
98
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
Fully released 0.175 - 0.335V
Fully depressed More than 1.195V
MBIB0023E
EC-748
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
4. If NG, replace accelerator pedal assembly and go to the next step.
5. Perform EC-589, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
6. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
7. Perform EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00EW5
ACCELERATOR PEDAL
Refer to ACC-2, "ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM" .
DTC P0327, P0328 KS
EC-749
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0327, P0328 KS PFP:22060
Component Description EBS00EW6
The knock sensor is attached to the cylinder block. It senses engine
knocking using a piezoelectric element. A knocking vibration from
the cylinder block is sensed as vibrational pressure. This pressure is
converted into a voltage signal and sent to the ECM.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EW7
The MI will not light for knock sensor malfunction.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EW8
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine and run it for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-751, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and run it for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-751, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
MBIB0102E
DTC No. Trouble Diagnosis Name DTC Detected Condition Possible Cause
P0327
0327
Knock sensor circuit low
input
An excessively low voltage from the sensor is
sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Knock sensor
P0328
0328
Knock sensor circuit high
input
An excessively high voltage from the sensor is
sent to ECM.
SEF058Y
EC-750
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0327, P0328 KS
Wiring Diagram EBS00EW9
MBWA0063E
DTC P0327, P0328 KS
EC-751
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EWA
1. CHECK KNOCK SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT-I
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check resistance between ECM terminal 15 and engine ground. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
NOTE:
It is necessary to use an ohmmeter which can measure more than 10 M.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK KNOCK SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT-II
1. Disconnect knock sensor harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 15 and knock
sensor terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK KNOCK SENSOR
Refer to EC-752, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace knock sensor.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
15 W Knock sensor
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 2.5V
54
Knock sensor shield circuit
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
Resistance: Approximately 530 - 590k [at 20C (68F)]
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0102E
EC-752
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0327, P0328 KS
4. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 5.
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EWB
KNOCK SENSOR
Check resistance between knock sensor terminal 1 and ground.
NOTE:
It is necessary to use an ohmmeter which can measure more
than 10 M.
CAUTION:
Do not use any knock sensors that have been dropped or phys-
ically damaged. Use only new ones.
Removal and Installation EBS00EWC
KNOCK SENSOR
Refer to EM-70, "CYLINDER BLOCK" .
MBIB0095E
Resistance: Approximately 530 - 590k [at 20C (68F)]
SEF227W
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
EC-753
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS) PFP:23731
Component Description EBS00EWD
The crankshaft position sensor (POS) is located on the cylinder
block rear housing facing the gear teeth (cogs) of the signal plate at
the end of the crankshaft. It detects the fluctuation of the engine rev-
olution.
The sensor consists of a permanent magnet and Hall IC.
When the engine is running, the high and low parts of the teeth
cause the gap with the sensor change.
The changing gap causes the magnetic field near the sensor to
change.
Due to the changing magnetic field, the voltage from the sensor
changes.
The ECM receives the voltage signal and detects the fluctuation of
the engine revolution.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EWE
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EWF
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EWG
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10.5V with igni-
tion switch ON.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select DATA MONITOR mode
with CONSULT-II.
2. Crank engine for at least 2 seconds and run it for at least 5 sec-
onds at idle speed.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-756, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
PBIB0562E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
ENG SPEED
G Tachometer: Connect
G Run engine and compare tachometer indication with the CONSULT-II
value.
Almost the same speed as the
CONSULT-II value.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0335
0335
Crankshaft position
sensor (POS) circuit
G The crankshaft position sensor (POS) signal is not
detected by the ECM during the first few seconds of
engine cranking.
G The proper pulse signal from the crankshaft position
sensor (POS) is not sent to ECM while the engine is
running.
G The crankshaft position sensor (POS) signal is not in
the normal pattern during engine running.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
G Signal plate
SEF058Y
EC-754
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Crank engine for at least 2 seconds and run it for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-756, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
EC-755
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00EWH
MBWA0064E
EC-756
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EWI
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
13 W
Crankshaft position
sensor (POS)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 3V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
Approximately 3V
30 B
Crankshaft position
sensor (POS) ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
PBIB0527E
PBIB0528E
MBIB0095E
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
EC-757
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK CKP SENSOR (POS) POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect crankshaft position (CKP) sensor (POS) harness
connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between CKP sensor (POS) terminal 3 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between crankshaft position sensor (POS) and ECM
G Harness for open or short between crankshaft position sensor (POS) and ECM relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK CKP SENSOR (POS) GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 30 and CKP sensor (POS) terminal 1
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for and short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0103E
Voltage: Battery voltage
SEF509Y
Continuity should exist.
EC-758
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
5. CHECK CKP SENSOR (POS) INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 13 and CKP sensor (POS) terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (POS)
Refer to EC-758, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace crankshaft position sensor (POS).
7. CHECK GEAR TOOTH
Visually check for chipping signal plate gear tooth.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace the signal plate.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EWJ
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (POS)
1. Loosen the fixing bolt of the sensor.
2. Disconnect crankshaft position sensor (POS) harness connector.
3. Remove the sensor.
4. Visually check the sensor for chipping.
Continuity should exist.
PBIB0563E
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
EC-759
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. Check resistance as shown in the figure.
6. If NG, replace crankshaft position sensor (POS).
Removal and Installation EBS00EWK
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (POS)
Refer to EM-70, "CYLINDER BLOCK" .
Terminal No. (Polarity) Resistance [at 25C (77F)]
3 (+) - 1 (-)
Except 0 or 3 (+) - 2 (-)
2 (+) - 1 (-)
MBIB0024E
EC-760
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE) PFP:23731
Component Description EBS00EWL
The camshaft position sensor (PHASE) senses the retraction with
intake valve camshaft to identify a particular cylinder. The camshaft
position sensor (PHASE) senses the piston position.
When the crankshaft position sensor (POS) system becomes inoper-
ative, the camshaft position sensor (PHASE) provides various con-
trols of engine parts instead, utilizing timing of cylinder identification
signals.
The sensor consists of a permanent magnet and Hall IC.
When engine is running, the high and low parts of the teeth cause
the gap with the sensor to change.
The changing gap causes the magnetic field near the sensor to
change.
Due to the changing magnetic field, the voltage from the sensor changes.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EWM
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EWN
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10.5V with igni-
tion switch ON.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Crank engine for at least 2 seconds and run it for at least 5 sec-
onds at idle speed.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-763, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
If 1st trip DTC is not detected, go to next step.
5. Maintain engine speed at more than 800 rpm for at least 5 sec-
onds.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-763, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Crank engine for at least 2 seconds and run it for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-763, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If 1st trip DTC is not detected, go to next step.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
PBIB0562E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0340
0340
Camshaft position sensor
(PHASE) circuit
G The cylinder No. signal is not sent to ECM
for the first few seconds during engine
cranking.
G The cylinder No. signal is not set to ECM
during engine running.
G The cylinder No. signal is not in the normal
pattern during engine running.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
G Camshaft (Intake)
G Starter motor (Refer to SC-22 .)
G Starting system circuit (Refer to SC-22 .)
G Dead (Weak) battery
SEF013Y
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
EC-761
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. Start engine and maintain engine speed at more than 800 rpm for at least 5 seconds.
7. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
8. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
9. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-763, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
EC-762
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
Wiring Diagram EBS00EWO
MBWA0065E
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
EC-763
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EWP
1. CHECK STARTING SYSTEM
Turn ignition switch to START position.
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> Check starting system. (Refer to SC-22, "STARTING SYSTEM" .)
2. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 3.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
14 R
Camshaft position
sensor (PHASE)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.0 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
1.0 - 4.0V
29 B
Camshaft position
sensor (PHASE)
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
PBIB0525E
PBIB0526E
Does the engine turn over?
Does the starter motor operate?
MBIB0095E
EC-764
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
3. CHECK CMP SENSOR (PHASE) POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect camshaft position (CMP) sensor (PHASE) harness
connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between CMP sensor (PHASE) terminal 3 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between camshaft position sensor (PHASE) and ECM
G Harness for open or short between camshaft position sensor (PHASE) and ECM relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK CMP SENSOR (PHASE) GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 29 and CMP sensor (PHASE) terminal 1.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK CMP SENSOR (PHASE) INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 14 and CMP sensor (PHASE) terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground or short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0104E
Voltage: Battery voltage
SEF509Y
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
EC-765
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
7. CHECK CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (PHASE)
Refer to EC-765, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace camshaft position sensor (PHASE).
8. CHECK CAMSHAFT (INTAKE)
Check the following.
G Accumulation of debris to the signal plate of camshaft rear end
G Chipping signal plate of camshaft rear end
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Remove debris and clean the signal plate of camshaft
rear end or replace camshaft.
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EWQ
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (PHASE)
1. Loosen the fixing bolt of the sensor.
2. Disconnect camshaft position sensor (PHASE) harness connector.
3. Remove the sensor.
4. Visually check the sensor for chipping.
5. Check resistance as shown in the figure.
PBIB0565E
PBIB0563E
Terminal No. (Polarity) Resistance [at 25C (77F)]
3 (+) - 1 (-)
Except 0 or 3 (+) - 2 (-)
2 (+) - 1 (-)
MBIB0024E
EC-766
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
Removal and Installation EBS00EWR
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (PHASE)
Refer to EM-36, "CAMSHAFT" .
DTC P0605 ECM
EC-767
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0605 ECM PFP:23710
Component Description EBS00EWX
The ECM consists of a microcomputer and connectors for signal
input and output and for power supply. The ECM controls the engine.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EWY
FAIL-SAFE MODE
ECM enters fail-safe mode when malfunction A is detected.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EWZ
Perform PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A first. If the 1st trip DTC cannot be confirmed, perform
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION B. If there is no problem on PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION
B, perform PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-769, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-769, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF093X
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0605
0605
Engine control module
A) ECM calculation function is malfunctioning.
G ECM B) ECM EEP-ROM system is malfunctioning.
C) ECM self shut-off function is malfunctioning.
Detected items Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
Malfunction A
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5
degrees) by the return spring.
SEF058Y
EC-768
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0605 ECM
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION B
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then
turn ON.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-769, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-769, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then
turn ON.
4. Repeat step 3 procedure, 32 times.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-769, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Repeat step 2 procedure, 32 times.
4. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-769, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
SEF058Y
DTC P0605 ECM
EC-769
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EX0
1. INSPECTION START
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select SELF DIAG RESULTS mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Touch ERASE.
4. Perform DTC Confirmation Procedure.
See EC-767 .
5. Is the 1st trip DTC P0605 displayed again?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Erase the Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) memory. Refer to EC-594, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
3. Perform DTC Confirmation Procedure.
See EC-767 .
4. Is the 1st trip DTC P0605 displayed again?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> INSPECTION END
2. REPLACE ECM
1. Replace ECM.
2. Perform initialization of NATS system and registration of all NATS ignition key IDs. Refer to EC-595,
"NATS (Nissan Anti-theft System)" .
3. Perform EC-589, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
5. Perform EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
EC-770
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY PFP:23710
Component Description EBS00EX1
Battery voltage is supplied to the ECM even when the ignition switch
is turned OFF for the ECM memory function of the DTC memory, the
air fuel ratio feedback compensation value memory, the idle air vol-
ume learning value memory, etc.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EX2
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EX3
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then
turn ON.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 four times.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-772, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 four times.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
6. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
7. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-772, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF093X
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1065
1065
ECM power supply circuit
ECM back up RAM system does not function
properly.
G Harness or connectors
[ECM power supply (back-up) circuit is
open or shorted.]
G ECM
SEF058Y
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY
EC-771
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00EX4
MBWA0094E
EC-772
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EX5
1. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminal 121 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E70, F13 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E63, F31 (RHD models)
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between ECM and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
121 W/L
Power supply for ECM
(Buck-up)
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0026E
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY
EC-773
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select SELF DIAG RESULTS mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Touch ERASE.
4. Perform DTC Confirmation Procedure.
See EC-770 .
5. Is the 1st trip DTC P1065 displayed again?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Erase the Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) memory. Refer to EC-594, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
3. Perform DTC Confirmation Procedure.
See EC-770 .
4. Is the 1st trip DTC P1065 displayed again?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 5.
No >> INSPECTION END
5. REPLACE ECM
1. Replace ECM.
2. Perform initialization of NATS system and registration of all NATS ignition key IDs. Refer to EC-595,
"NATS (Nissan Anti-theft System)" .
3. Perform EC-589, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
5. Perform EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
EC-774
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1102 MAF SENSOR
DTC P1102 MAF SENSOR PFP:22680
Component Description EBS00H74
The mass air flow sensor is placed in the stream of intake air. It mea-
sures the intake flow rate by measuring a part of the entire intake
flow. It consists of a hot film that is supplied with electric current from
the ECM. The temperature of the hot film is controlled by the ECM a
certain amount. The heat generated by the hot film is reduced as the
intake air flows around it. The more air, the greater the heat loss.
Therefore, the ECM must supply more electric current to maintain
the temperature of the hot film as air flow increases. The ECM
detects the air flow by means of this current change.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H75
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H76
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H77
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
SEC266C
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
MAS A/F SE-B1
G Engine: After warming up
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Shift lever: N
G No-load
Idle Approx. 1.0 - 1.7V
2,500 rpm Approx. 1.5 - 2.1V
CAL/LD VALUE
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 10% - 35%
2,500 rpm 10% - 35%
MASS AIRFLOW
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 1.0 - 4.0 gm/s
2,500 rpm 5.0 - 10.0 gm/s
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1102
1102
Mass air flow sensor circuit
range/performance problem
A voltage from the sensor is constantly
approx.1.0V when engine is running.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Mass air flow sensor
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
Mass air flow sensor circuit Engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm due to the fuel cut.
DTC P1102 MAF SENSOR
EC-775
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and wait 5 seconds at most.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-777, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and wait 5 seconds at most.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-777, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
EC-776
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1102 MAF SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00H78
MBWA0045E
DTC P1102 MAF SENSOR
EC-777
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H79
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
45 R
Sensor power supply
(Mass air flow sensor
sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
50 Y Mass air flow sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.0 - 1.7V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,500 rpm.
1.5 - 2.1V
67 B
Sensor ground
(Mass air flow sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0095E
EC-778
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1102 MAF SENSOR
2. CHECK MAF SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect MAF sensor harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between MAF sensor terminals 2, 4 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between mass air flow sensor and ECM
G Harness for open or short between mass air flow sensor and ECM relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK MAF SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 67 and MAF sensor terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK MAF SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 50 and MAF sensor terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0096E
Terminal Voltage
2 Approximately 5V
4 Battery voltage
PBIB0076E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
DTC P1102 MAF SENSOR
EC-779
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EC-779, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace mass air flow sensor.
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H7A
MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
1. Reconnect harness connectors disconnected.
2. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminal 50 (Mass air flow sensor
signal) and ground.
*: Check for liner voltage rise in response to engine being increased to about
4,000 rpm.
4. If the voltage is out of specification, proceed the following.
a. Turn ignition switch OFF.
b. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector and reconnect it again.
c. Perform steps 2 and 3 again.
5. If NG, remove mass air flow sensor from air duct. Check hot film for damage or dust.
6. If NG, clean or replace mass air flow sensor.
Removal and Installation EBS00H7B
MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EM-17, "AIR CLEANER AND AIR DUCT" .
Condition Voltage V
Ignition switch ON (Engine stopped.) Approx. 1.0
Idle (Engine is warmed-up to normal operating
temperature.)
1.0 - 1.7
2,500 rpm (Engine is warmed-up to normal
operating temperature.)
1.5 - 2.1
Idle to about 4,000 rpm* 1.0 - 1.7 to Approx. 4.0
MBIB0017E
EC-780
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1121 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
DTC P1121 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00EX6
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor, throttle position sensor, etc.
The throttle control motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve.
The throttle position sensor detects the throttle valve position, and the opening and closing speed of the throt-
tle valve and feeds the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM judges the current opening angle of the throttle
valve from these signals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the throttle valve opening
angle properly in response to driving condition.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EX7
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction A or B is detected in the two consecutive trips, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and MI
lights up.
When the malfunction C is detected even in the 1st trip, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EX8
NOTE:
G Perform PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A AND B first. If the 1st trip DTC cannot be con-
firmed, perform PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C.
If there is no problem on PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A AND B, perform PROCEDURE
FOR MALFUNCTION C.
G If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and
wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A AND B
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition witch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Shift selector lever to D position (A/T), 1st position (M/T) and
wait at least 2 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then
turn ON.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-781, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1121
1121
Electric throttle control
actuator
A)
Electric throttle control actuator does not function
properly due to the return spring malfunction.
G Electric throttle control actuator
B)
Throttle valve opening angle in fail-safe mode is
not in specified range.
C)
ECM detect the throttle valve is stuck open.
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection
logic.
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
Malfunction A
The ECM controls the electric throttle actuator by regulating the throttle opening around the idle position.
The engine speed will not rise more than 2,000 rpm.
Malfunction B ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator by regulating the throttle opening to 20 degrees or less.
Malfunction C
While the vehicle is driving, it slows down gradually by fuel cut. After the vehicle stops, the engine stalls.
The engine can restart in N or P position, and engine speed will not exceed 1,000 rpm or more.
SEF058Y
DTC P1121 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
EC-781
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Shift selector lever to D position (A/T), 1st position (M/T) and wait at least 2 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
4. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-781, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Shift selector lever to D position (A/T), 1st position (M/T) and
wait at least 2 seconds.
4. Shift selector lever to N or P position.
5. Start engine and let it idle for 3 seconds.
6. If DTC is detected, go to EC-781, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Shift selector lever to D position (A/T), 1st position (M/T) and wait at least 2 seconds.
3. Shift selector lever to N or P position.
4. Start engine and let it idle for the 3 seconds.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
6. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
7. If DTC is detected, go to EC-781, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EX9
1. CHECK ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR VISUALLY
1. Remove the intake air duct.
2. Check if a foreign matter is caught between the throttle valve
and the housing.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Remove the foreign matter and clean the electric throttle
control actuator inside.
2. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
SEF058Y
MBIB0107E
EC-782
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1121 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Remove and Installation EBS00HBZ
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-19, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
EC-783
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION PFP:16119
Description EBS00EXA
NOTE:
If DTC P1122 is displayed with DTC P1121 or 1126, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P1121 or
P1126. Refer to EC-780 or EC-790 .
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor, throttle position sensor, etc.
The throttle control motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve.
The current opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the throttle position sensor and it provides feed-
back to the ECM to control the throttle control motor to make the throttle valve opening angle properly in
response to driving condition.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EXB
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EXC
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-785, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
2. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
4. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
5. If DTC is detected, go to EC-785, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1122
1122
Electric throttle control
performance problem
Electric throttle control function does
not operate properly.
G Harness or connectors
(Throttle control motor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Harness or connectors
(Throttle control motor relay circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
G Throttle control motor relay
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return
spring.
SEF058Y
EC-784
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
Wiring Diagram EBS00EXD
MBWA0143E
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
EC-785
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EXE
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
3 R
Throttle control motor
power supply
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
4 BR
Throttle control motor
(Close)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is releasing
0 - 14V
5 Y
Throttle control motor
(Open)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is depressing
0 - 14V
104 OR Throttle control motor relay
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch ON] 0 - 1.0V
PBIB0534E
PBIB0533E
MBIB0095E
EC-786
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
2. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY SIGNAL CIRCUIT
Check voltage between ECM terminal 3 and ground under the fol-
lowing conditions with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect throttle control motor relay.
3. Check voltage between throttle control motor relay terminals 2, 5
and ground.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G 15A fuse
G Harness for open or short between throttle control motor relay and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
Ignition switch Voltage
OFF Approximately 0V
ON
Battery voltage
(11 - 14V)
MBIB0028E
MBIB0140E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0575E
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
EC-787
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 3 and throttle control motor relay terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
6. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E70, F13 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E63, F31 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between ECM and throttle control motor relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Check continuity between ECM terminal 104 and throttle control motor relay terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> GO TO 8.
8. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness for open or short between ECM and throttle control motor relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
9. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
Refer to EC-789, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> Replace throttle control motor relay.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
EC-788
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
10. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN OR SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between the following terminals.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
11. CHECK ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR VISUALLY
1. Remove the intake air duct.
2. Check if foreign matter is caught between the throttle valve and
the housing.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Remove the foreign matter and clean the electric throttle
control actuator inside.
12. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
Refer to EC-789, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> GO TO 14.
13. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14.
NG >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
14. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
Electric throttle control
actuator terminal
ECM terminal Continuity
3
4 Should exist
5 Should not exist
6
4 Should not exist
5 Should exist
MBIB0100E
MBIB0107E
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
EC-789
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Component Inspection EBS00EXF
THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
1. Apply 12V direct current between relay terminals 1 and 2.
2. Check continuity between relay terminals 3 and 5.
3. If NG, replace throttle control motor relay.
THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Check resistance between terminals 3 and 6.
3. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to next
step.
4. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
5. Perform EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00EXG
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-19, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
Conditions Continuity
12V direct current supply between terminals
1 and 2
Yes
No current supply No
PBIB0098E
Resistance: Approximately 1 - 15 [at 25 C (77F)]
PBIB0095E
EC-790
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00EXH
Power supply for the Throttle Control motor is provided to the ECM via throttle control motor relay. The throttle
control motor relay is ON/OFF controlled by the ECM. When the ignition switch is turned ON, the ECM sends
an ON signal to throttle control motor relay and battery voltage is provided to the ECM. When the ignition
switch is turned OFF, the ECM sends an OFF signal to throttle control motor relay and battery voltage is not
provided to the ECM.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EXI
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EXJ
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the DTC P1124 is detected in the two consecutive trips, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights
up.
When the DTC P1126 is detected even in the 1st trip, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EXK
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
PROCEDURE FOR DTC P1124
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-793, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
THRTL RELAY G Ignition switch: ON ON
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1124
1124
Throttle control motor
relay circuit short
ECM detect the throttle control motor relay
is stuck ON.
G Harness or connectors
(Throttle control motor relay circuit is shorted.)
G Throttle control motor relay
P1126
1126
Throttle control motor
relay circuit open
ECM detects a voltage of power source for
throttle control motor is excessively low.
This self-diagnosis has the one trip
detection logic.
G Harness or connectors
(Throttle control motor relay circuit is open.)
G Throttle control motor relay
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return
spring.
SEF058Y
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
EC-791
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-793, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
PROCEDURE FOR DTC P1126
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-793, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 second.
2. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
4. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
5. If DTC is detected, go to EC-793, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
EC-792
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
Wiring Diagram EBS00EXL
MBWA0144E
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
EC-793
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EXM
1. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect throttle control motor relay.
3. Check voltage between throttle control motor relay terminals 2, 5
and ground.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G 15A fuse
G Harness for open or short between throttle control motor relay and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
104 OR Throttle control motor relay
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch ON] 0 - 1.0V
3 R
Throttle control motor
power supply
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
MBIB0140E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0575E
EC-794
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
3. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 3 and throttle control motor relay terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E70, F13 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E63, F31 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between ECM and throttle control motor relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Check continuity between ECM terminal 104 and throttle control motor relay terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
6. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness for open or short between ECM and throttle control motor relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
Refer to EC-794, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace throttle control motor relay.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GKD
THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
1. Apply 12V direct current between relay terminals 1 and 2.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
EC-795
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Check continuity between relay terminals 3 and 5.
3. If NG, replace throttle control motor relay.
Conditions Continuity
12V direct current supply
between terminals 1 and 2
Yes
No current supply No
PBIB0098E
EC-796
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00EXN
The throttle control motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve.
The current opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the throttle position sensor and it provides feed-
back to the ECM to control the throttle control motor to make the throttle valve opening angle properly in
response to driving condition.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EXO
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EXP
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-798, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 second.
2. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
4. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
5. If DTC is detected, go to EC-798, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1128
1128
Throttle control motor
circuit short
ECM detects short both circuits between ECM
and throttle control motor.
G Harness or connectors
(Throttle control motor circuit is shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
(Throttle control motor)
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return
spring.
SEF058Y
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
EC-797
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00EXQ
MBWA0145E
EC-798
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EXR
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
4 BR
Throttle control motor
(Close)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is releasing
0 - 14V
5 Y
Throttle control motor
(Open)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is depressing
0 - 14V
PBIB0534E
PBIB0533E
MBIB0095E
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
EC-799
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN OR SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between the following terminals.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness connectors.
3. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
Refer to EC-799, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 5.
4. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EXS
THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Check resistance between terminals 3 and 6.
3. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to next
step.
4. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
5. Perform EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Electric throttle control
actuator terminal
ECM terminal Continuity
3
4 Should exist
5 Should not exist
6
4 Should not exist
5 Should exist
MBIB0100E
Resistance: Approximately 1 - 15 [at 25 C (77F)]
PBIB0095E
EC-800
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
Remove and Installation EBS00EXT
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-19, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-801
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE PFP:00000
System Description EBS00EXU
NOTE:
If DTC P1217 is displayed with DTC U1000, U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-663, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
COOLING FAN CONTROL
*1: The ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
*2: These signals are sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
The ECM controls the cooling fan corresponding to the vehicle speed, engine coolant temperature, refrigerant
pressure, and air conditioner ON signal. The control system has 2-step control [ON/OFF].
The ECM sends a cooling fan control signal to the smart entrance control unit through CAN communication
line, and the smart entrance control unit controls cooling fan relay.
OPERATION
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EXV
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
*1
Cooling fan
control
Cooling fan relay
Battery
Battery voltage
*1
Vehicle speed signal
Vehicle speed
*2
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Air conditioner switch Air conditioner ON signal
*2
Refrigerant pressure sensor Refrigerant pressure
MBIB0036E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
AIR COND SIG
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Air conditioner switch: OFF OFF
Air conditioner switch: ON
(Compressor operates.)
ON
COOLING FAN
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
Engine coolant temperature is 99C
(210F) or less
OFF
Engine coolant temperature is 100C
(212F) or more
ON
EC-802
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EXW
If the cooling fan or another component in the cooling system malfunctions, engine coolant temperature will
rise. When the engine coolant temperature reaches an abnormally high temperature condition, a malfunction
is indicated.
CAUTION:
When a malfunction is indicated, be sure to replace the coolant. Refer to CO-8, "Changing Engine
Coolant" . Also, replace the engine oil. Refer to LU-7, "Changing Engine Oil" .
1. Fill radiator with coolant up to specified level with a filling speed of 2 liters per minute. Be sure to
use coolant with the proper mixture ratio. Refer to MA-18, "Engine Coolant Mixture Ratio" .
2. After refilling coolant, run engine to ensure that no water-flow noise is emitted.
Overall Function Check EBS00EXX
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the cooling fan. During this check, a DTC might not be con-
firmed.
WARNING:
Never remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could be caused by high pres-
sure fluid escaping from the radiator.
Wrap a thick cloth around cap. Carefully remove the cap by turning it a quarter turn to allow built-up
pressure to escape. Then turn the cap all the way off.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Check the coolant level in the reservoir tank and radiator.
Allow engine to cool before checking coolant level.
If the coolant level in the reservoir tank and/or radiator is below
the proper range, skip the following steps and go to EC-805,
"Diagnostic Procedure" .
2. Confirm whether customer filled the coolant or not. If customer
filled the coolant, skip the following steps and go to EC-805,
"Diagnostic Procedure" .
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1217
1217
Engine over temperature
(Overheat)
G Cooling fan does not operate properly
(Overheat).
G Cooling fan system does not operate properly
(Overheat).
G Engine coolant was not added to the system
using the proper filling method.
G Harness or connectors
(The cooling fan circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Harness or connectors
(The CAN communication line is
open or shorted.)
G Cooling fan
G Radiator hose
G Radiator
G Radiator cap
G Water pump
G Thermostat
For more information, refer to EC-809,
"Main 12 Causes of Overheating" .
SEF621W
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-803
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. Perform COOLING FAN in ACTIVE TEST mode with CON-
SULT-II.
5. If the results are NG, go to EC-805, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Check the coolant level in the reservoir tank and radiator.
Allow engine to cool before checking coolant level.
If the coolant level in the reservoir tank and/or radiator is below
the proper range, skip the following steps and go to EC-805,
"Diagnostic Procedure" .
2. Confirm whether customer filled the coolant or not. If customer
filled the coolant, skip the following steps and go to EC-805,
"Diagnostic Procedure" .
3. Start engine and let it idle.
Be careful not to overheat engine.
4. Turn air conditioner switch ON.
5. Turn blower fan switch ON.
6. Make sure that cooling fans operate.
If NG, go to EC-805, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
MBIB0037E
SEF621W
SEC163BA
EC-804
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
Wiring Diagram EBS00EXY
MBWA0068E
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-805
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EXZ
1. INSPECTION START
Do you have CONSULT-II?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> GO TO 3.
2. CHECK COOLING FAN OPERATION
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle.
2. Select COOLING FAN in ACTIVE TEST mode with CON-
SULT-II and touch ON on the CONSULT-II screen.
3. Make sure that cooling fans-1 and -2 operate.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Check cooling fan control circuit. (Go to EC-807, "PRO-
CEDURE A" .)
3. CHECK COOLING FAN OPERATION
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle.
2. Turn air conditioner switch ON.
3. Turn blower fan switch ON.
4. Make sure that cooling fans-1 and -2 operate.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Check cooling fan control circuit. (Go to EC-807, "PRO-
CEDURE A" .)
MBIB0037E
SEC163BA
EC-806
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
4. CHECK COOLING SYSTEM FOR LEAK
Apply pressure to the cooling system with a tester, and check if the
pressure drops.
CAUTION:
Higher than the specified pressure may cause radiator damage.
Pressure should not drop.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Check the following for leak
G Hose
G Radiator
G Water pump
Refer to CO-18, "WATER PUMP" .
5. CHECK RADIATOR CAP
Apply pressure to cap with a tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace radiator cap.
6. CHECK THERMOSTAT
1. Check valve seating condition at normal room temperatures.
It should seat tightly.
2. Check valve opening temperature and valve lift.
3. Check if valve is closed at 5C (9F) below valve opening tem-
perature.
For details, refer to CO-20, "THERMOSTAT AND THERMOSTAT
HOUSING" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace thermostat
7. CHECK ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Refer to EC-676, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace engine coolant temperature sensor.
Testing pressure: 157 kPa (1.6 kg/cm
2
, 23 psi)
SLC754A
Radiator cap relief pressure: 59 - 98 kPa
(0.6 - 1.0 kg/cm
2
, 9 - 14 psi)
SLC755A
Valve opening temperature: 82C (180F) [standard]
Valve lift: More than 8 mm/95C
(0.31 in/203F)
SLC343
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-807
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
8. CHECK MAIN 12 CAUSES
If the cause cannot be isolated, go to EC-809, "Main 12 Causes of Overheating" .
>> INSPECTION END
PROCEDURE A
1. CHECK COOLING FAN POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect cooling fan relay-1.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between cooling fan relay-1 terminals 1, 3, 6 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Fuse block (J/B) connector E106
G 10A fuse
G 30A fusible links
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-1 and fuse
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-1 and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0108E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0951E
EC-808
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
3. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTORS CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect cooling fan motor-1 harness connector and cooling
fan motor-2 harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between cooling fan relay-1 terminal 5
and cooling fan motor-1 terminal 1, cooling fan motor-1 terminal
2 and body ground.
Refer to wiring diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
5. Check harness continuity between cooling fan relay-1 terminal 7
and cooling fan motor-2 terminal 1, cooling fan motor-2 terminal
2 and body ground.
Refer to wiring diagram.
6. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK COOLING FAN OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect smart entrance control unit.
2. Check harness continuity between smart entrance control unit
terminal 33 and cooling fan relay-1 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E123, M17 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E110, M94 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between smart entrance control unit and cooling fan relay-1
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK COOLING FAN RELAY-1
Refer to EC-810, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace cooling fan relay.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0109E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0173E
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-809
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
7. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTORS
Refer to EC-810, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace cooling fan motors.
8. CHECK SMART ENTRANCE CONTROL UNIT
Refer to BCS-3, "SMART ENTRANCE CONTROL SYSTEM" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace cooling fan motors.
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Perform EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Main 12 Causes of Overheating EBS00EY0
Engine Step Inspection item Equipment Standard Reference page
OFF 1 G Blocked radiator
G Blocked condenser
G Blocked radiator grille
G Blocked bumper
G Visual No blocking
2 G Coolant mixture G Coolant tester 50 - 50% coolant mixture See MA-18, "Engine
Coolant Mixture Ratio" .
3 G Coolant level G Visual Coolant up to MAX level
in reservoir tank and radi-
ator filler neck
See MA-20, "Changing
Engine Coolant" .
4 G Radiator cap G Pressure tester 59 - 98 kPa
(0.6 - 1.0 kg/cm
2
, 9 - 14
psi) (Limit)
See MA-22, "CHECKING
RADIATOR CAP" .
ON*
2
5 G Coolant leaks G Visual No leaks See MA-23, "CHECKING
COOLINGSYSTEMFOR
LEAKS" .
ON*
2 6 G Thermostat G Touch the upper and
lower radiator hoses
Both hoses should be hot See CO-20, "THERMO-
STAT AND THERMO-
STAT HOUSING" , and
CO-11, "RADIATOR" .
ON*
1
7 G Cooling fan G CONSULT-II Operating See trouble diagnosis for
DTC P1217 (EC-801 ).
OFF 8 G Combustion gas leak G Color checker chemical
tester 4 Gas analyzer
Negative
ON*
3 9 G Coolant temperature
gauge
G Visual Gauge less than 3/4
when driving

G Coolant overflow to
reservoir tank
G Visual No overflowduring driving
and idling
See MA-20, "Changing
Engine Coolant" .
OFF*
4
10 G Coolant return from
reservoir tank to radia-
tor
G Visual Should be initial level in
reservoir tank
See CO-8, "LEVEL
CHECK" .
EC-810
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
*1: Turn the ignition switch ON.
*2: Engine running at 3,000 rpm for 10 minutes.
*3: Drive at 90 km/h (55 MPH) for 30 minutes and then let idle for 10 minutes.
*4: After 60 minutes of cool down time.
For more information, refer to CO-5, "OVERHEATING CAUSE ANALYSIS" .
Component Inspection EBS00EY1
COOLING FAN RELAY-1
1. Apply 12V direct current between relay terminals 1 and 2.
2. Check continuity between relay terminals 3 and 5, 6 and 7.
3. If NG, replace cooling fan relay.
COOLING FAN MOTORS-1 AND -2
1. Disconnect cooling fan motor harness connectors.
2. Supply cooling fan motor terminals with battery voltage and
check operation.
Cooling fan motor should operate.
If NG, replace cooling fan motor.
OFF 11 G Cylinder head G Straight gauge feeler
gauge
0.1 mm (0.004 in) Maxi-
mum distortion (warping)
See EM-57, "CYLINDER
HEAD" .
12 G Cylinder block and pis-
tons
G Visual No scuffing on cylinder
walls or piston
See EM-57, "CYLINDER
HEAD" .
Engine Step Inspection item Equipment Standard Reference page
Condition Continuity
12V direct current supply between terminals
1 and 2
Yes
OFF No
PBIB0077E
Terminals
(+) ()
Cooling fan motor 1 2
MBIB0109E
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
EC-811
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00EY2
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor,
throttle position sensor, etc. The throttle position sensor responds to
the throttle valve movement.
The throttle position sensor has the two sensors. These sensors are
a kind of potentiometers which transform the throttle valve position
into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM. In addi-
tion, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of the
throttle valve and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM
judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these sig-
nals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the
throttle valve opening angle properly in response to driving condi-
tion.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EY3
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EY4
These self-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EY5
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0145E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
THRTL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released More than 0.36V
G Shift lever:
D (A/T model)
1st (M/T model)
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1223
1223
Throttle position sensor 2
circuit low input
An excessively low voltage from the TP sensor 2
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The TP sensor 2 circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 2)
P1224
1224
Throttle position sensor 2
circuit high input
An excessively high voltage from the TP sensor 2
is sent to ECM.
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
EC-812
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-814, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-816, "Component Inspection" .
SEF058Y
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
EC-813
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00EY6
MBWA0137E
EC-814
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EY7
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
47 G
Throttle position sensor
power supply
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
49 W Throttle position sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
More than 0.36V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
Less than 4.75V
66 B
Throttle position sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
68 R Throttle position sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
Less than 4.75V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (A/T model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 0.36V
MBIB0095E
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
EC-815
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between electric throttle control actuator terminal
1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 66 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 68 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
Refer to EC-816, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
MBIB0100E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0082E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
EC-816
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
6. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EY8
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Set selector lever to D position (A/T models) or 1st position (M/T models).
5. Check voltage between ECM terminals 49 (TP sensor 1 signal),
68 (TP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the following
conditions.
6. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to the next
step.
7. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
8. Perform EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00EY9
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-19, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
49
(Throttle position sensor 1)
Fully released More than 0.36V
Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
68
(Throttle position sensor 2)
Fully released Less than 4.75V
Fully depressed More than 0.36V
MBIB0022E
DTC P1225 TP SENSOR
EC-817
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1225 TP SENSOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00EYA
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor,
throttle position sensor, etc. The throttle position sensor responds to
the throttle valve movement.
The throttle position sensor has the two sensors. These sensors are
a kind of potentiometers which transform the throttle valve position
into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM. In addi-
tion, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of the
throttle valve and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM
judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these sig-
nals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the
throttle valve opening angle properly in response to driving condi-
tion.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EYB
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EYC
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-818, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-818, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
PBIB0145E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1225
1225
Closed throttle position
learning performance
problem
Closed throttle position learning value is excessively
low.
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 1 and 2)
SEF058Y
EC-818
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1225 TP SENSOR
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EYD
1. CHECK ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR VISUALLY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Remove the intake air duct.
3. Check if foreign matter is caught between the throttle valve and
the housing.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Remove the foreign matter and clean the electric throttle
control actuator inside.
2. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
Remove and Installation EBS00EYE
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-19, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
MBIB0107E
DTC P1226 TP SENSOR
EC-819
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1226 TP SENSOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00EYF
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor,
throttle position sensor, etc. The throttle position sensor responds to
the throttle valve movement.
The throttle position sensor has the two sensors. These sensors are
a kind of potentiometers which transform the throttle valve position
into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM. In addi-
tion, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of the
throttle valve and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM
judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these sig-
nals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the
throttle valve opening angle properly in response to driving condi-
tion.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EYG
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EYH
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4, 32 times.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-820, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Repeat step 2, 32 times.
4. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-820, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
PBIB0145E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1226
1226
Closed throttle position
learning performance
problem
Closed throttle position learning is not performed
successfully, repeatedly.
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 1 and 2)
SEF058Y
EC-820
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1226 TP SENSOR
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EYI
1. CHECK ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR VISUALLY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Remove the intake air duct.
3. Check if foreign matter is caught between the throttle valve and
the housing.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Remove the foreign matter and clean the electric throttle
control actuator inside.
2. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
Remove and Installation EBS00EYJ
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-19, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
MBIB0107E
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
EC-821
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR PFP:18002
Component Description EBS00EYK
The accelerator pedal position sensor is installed on the upper end
of the accelerator pedal assembly. The sensor detects the accelera-
tor position and sends a signal to the ECM.
Accelerator pedal position sensor has two sensors. These sensors
are a kind of potentiometers which transform the accelerator pedal
position into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM.
In addition, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of
the accelerator pedal and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The
ECM judges the current opening angle of the accelerator pedal from
these signals and controls the throttle control motor based on these
signals.
Idle position of the accelerator pedal is determined by the ECM
receiving the signal from the accelerator pedal position sensor. The ECM uses this signal for the engine oper-
ation such as fuel cut.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EYL
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EYM
These self-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EYN
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0146E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
ACCEL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed More than 3.9V
CLSD THL POS G Ignition switch: ON
Accelerator pedal: Fully released ON
Accelerator pedal: Slightly depressed OFF
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1227
1227
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2 circuit low input
An excessively low voltage from the APP sensor 2
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The APP sensor 2 circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Accelerator pedal position sensor
(Accelerator pedal position sensor 2)
P1228
1228
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2 circuit high input
An excessively high voltage from the APP sensor 2
is sent to ECM.
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
EC-822
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-824, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-824, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
EC-823
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00EYO
MBWA0141E
EC-824
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EYP
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
82 B
Sensor ground
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
83 B
Sensor ground
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 0V
90 R
Sensor power supply
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
91 G
Sensor power supply
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
98 LG
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.175 - 0.335V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 1.95V
106 L
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.35 - 0.67V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.9V
MBIB0095E
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
EC-825
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK APP SENSOR 2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor harness
connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between APP sensor terminal 1 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK APP SENSOR 2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 83 and APP sensor terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0152E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0812E
Continuity should exist.
EC-826
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
6. CHECK APP SENSOR 2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 98 and APP sensor terminal 6.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK APP SENSOR
Refer to EC-826, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 9.
9. REPLACE APP SENSOR
1. Replace the accelerator pedal position sensor.
2. Perform EC-589, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
10. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EYQ
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminals 106 (APP sensor 1 sig-
nal), 98 (APP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the fol-
lowing conditions.
Continuity should exist.
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
106
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Fully depressed More than 3.9V
98
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
Fully released 0.175 - 0.335V
Fully depressed More than 1.195V
MBIB0023E
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
EC-827
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. If NG, replace accelerator pedal assembly and go to the next step.
5. Perform EC-589, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
6. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
7. Perform EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00EYR
ACCELERATOR PEDAL
Refer to ACC-2, "ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM" .
EC-828
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY PFP:16119
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EYS
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EYT
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-830, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle for 1 seconds.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-830, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1229
1229
Sensor power supply circuit
short
ECM detects a voltage of power source
for sensor is excessively low or high.
G Harness or connectors
(The TP sensor 1 and 2 circuit is shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 1 and 2)
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return
spring.
SEF058Y
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY
EC-829
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00EYU
MBWA0139E
EC-830
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EYV
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between electric throttle control actuator terminal
1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
47 G
Throttle position sensor
power supply
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
MBIB0095E
MBIB0100E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0082E
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY
EC-831
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUITS FOR SHORT
Check the following.
G Harness for short to power and short to ground between ECM terminal 47 and electric throttle control
actuator terminal 1.
G ECM pin terminal.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
Refer to EC-728, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-589, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-589, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
EC-832
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH PFP:25320
Description EBS00EYW
Brake switch signal is applied to the ECM through the stop lamp switch when the brake pedal is depressed.
This signal is used mainly to decrease the engine speed when the vehicle is driving.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EYX
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00EYY
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00EYZ
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Fully depress the brake pedal for at least 5 seconds.
3. Erase the DTC with CONSULT-II.
4. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-834, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Fully depress the brake pedal at least 5 seconds.
3. Erase the Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) memory. Refer to EC-594 .
4. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
5. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-834, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
BRAKE SW G Ignition switch: ON
Brake pedal: Fully released OFF
Brake pedal: Slightly depressed ON
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1805
1805
Brake switch
A brake switch signal is not sent to ECM for an
extremely long time while the vehicle is driving.
G Harness or connectors
(Stop lamp switch circuit is open or shorted.)
G Stop lamp switch
SEF058Y
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH
EC-833
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00EZ0
MBWA0091E
EC-834
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EZ1
1. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check the stop lamp when depressing and releasing the brake pedal.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect stop lamp switch harness connector.
2. Check voltage between stop lamp switch terminal 1 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
101 R/G Stop lamp switch
[Engine is running]
G Brake pedal fully released
Approximately 0V
[Engine is running]
G Brake pedal depressed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
Brake pedal Stop lamp
Fully released Not illuminated
Depressed Illuminated
MBIB0152E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0117E
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH
EC-835
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G 15A fuse
G Fuse block (J/B) connector M2
G Harness for open and short between stop lamp switch and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Disconnect stop lamp switch harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 101 and stop
lamp switch terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and stop lamp switch
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH
Refer to EC-836, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace stop lamp switch.
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0152E
EC-836
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH
Component Inspection EBS00EZ2
STOP LAMP SWITCH
1. Disconnect stop lamp switch harness connector.
2. Check continuity between stop lamp switch terminals 1 and 2
under the following conditions.
If NG, adjust brake pedal installation, refer to BR-6, "BRAKE
PEDAL" , and perform step 2 again.
MBIB0152E
Conditions Continuity
Brake pedal fully released Should not exist.
Brake pedal depressed Should exist.
PBIB0118E
HO2S1 HEATER (QG16DE)
EC-837
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
HO2S1 HEATER (QG16DE) PFP:22690
Description EBS00FV4
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM performs ON/OFF duty control of the heated oxygen sensor 1 heater corresponding to the engine
speed and engine coolant temperature. The duty percent varies with engine coolant temperature when engine
is started.
OPERATION
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FV5
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Engine speed
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater control
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Engine speed rpm Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
Above 3,600 OFF
Below 3,600 ON
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 HTR (B1)
G Engine: After warming up
G Engine speed: Below 3,600 rpm
ON
G Engine speed: Above 3,600 rpm OFF
EC-838
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S1 HEATER (QG16DE)
Wiring Diagram EBS00FV7
MBWA0071E
HO2S1 HEATER (QG16DE)
EC-839
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FV8
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION CHECK
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Set the tester probe between ECM terminal 24 (HO2S1 heater signal) and ground.
5. Start engine and let it idle.
6. Check the voltage under the following conditions.
Verify that the oscilloscope screen shows the signal wave as
shown below.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END.
NG >> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINA
L NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
24 G
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition.
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm.
Approximately 7.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped.
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
PBIB0519E
Conditions Voltage
At idle
Approximately 7.0V
Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
MBIB0038E
PBIB0519E
EC-840
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S1 HEATER (QG16DE)
2. CHECK HO2S1 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between HO2S1 terminal 4 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Fuse block (J/B) connector E105
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between heated oxygen sensor 1 and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK HO2S1 OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 24 and HO2S1 terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 HEATER
Refer to EC-841, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
MBIB0091E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0541E
Continuity should exist.
HO2S1 HEATER (QG16DE)
EC-841
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FV9
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 HEATER
1. Check resistance between HO2S1 terminals as follows.
2. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard sur-
face such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system
threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread Cleaner tool J-43897-
18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FVA
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-23, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER" .
Terminal No. Resistance
1 and 4 8 - 10 at 20C (68F)
2 and 3, 4

(Continuity should not exist)
3 and 1, 2, 4
PBIB0542E
EC-842
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S1 HEATER (QG18DE)
HO2S1 HEATER (QG18DE) PFP:22690
Description EBS00FVB
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM performs ON/OFF duty control of the heated oxygen sensor 1 heater corresponding to the engine
speed and engine coolant temperature. The duty percent varies with engine coolant temperature when engine
is started.
OPERATION
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FVC
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Engine speed
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater control
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Engine speed rpm Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
Above 3,200 (A/T models)
Above 3,600 (M/T models)
OFF
Below 3,200 (A/T models)
Below 3,600 (M/T models)
ON
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 HTR (B1)
HO2S1 HTR (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
G Engine speed: Below 3,200 rpm (A/T models)
Below 3,600 rpm (M/T models)
ON
G Engine speed: Above 3,200 rpm (A/T models)
Above 3,600 rpm (M/T models)
OFF
HO2S1 HEATER (QG18DE)
EC-843
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00FVE
BANK 1
MBWA0076E
EC-844
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S1 HEATER (QG18DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
24 G
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater (bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition.
G Engine speed is below 3,200 rpm (A/T models).
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm (M/T models).
Approximately 7.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped.
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,200 rpm (A/T models).
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm (M/T models).
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
PBIB0519E
HO2S1 HEATER (QG18DE)
EC-845
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
BANK 2
MBWA0078E
EC-846
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S1 HEATER (QG18DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FVF
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION CHECK
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Set the tester probe between ECM terminal 24 [HO2S1 (B1) heater signal] or 25 [HO2S1 (B2) heater sig-
nal] and ground.
5. Start engine and let it idle.
6. Check the voltage under the following conditions.
Verify that the oscilloscope screen shows the signal wave as
shown below.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END.
NG >> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
25 R/B
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater (bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition.
G Engine speed is below 3,200 rpm (A/T models).
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm (M/T models).
Approximately 7.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped.
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,200 rpm (A/T models).
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm (M/T models).
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
PBIB0519E
Conditions Voltage
At idle
Approximately 7.0V
Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
MBIB0039E
PBIB0519E
HO2S1 HEATER (QG18DE)
EC-847
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK HO2S1 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between HO2S1 terminal 4 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Fuse block (J/B) connector E105
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between heated oxygen sensor 1 and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK HO2S1 OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals 24, 25 and HO2S1 terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 HEATER
Refer to EC-848, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
MBIB0091E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0541E
Continuity should exist.
EC-848
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S1 HEATER (QG18DE)
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FVG
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 HEATER
1. Check resistance between HO2S1 terminals as follows.
2. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard sur-
face such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system
threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread Cleaner tool J-43897-
18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FVH
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-23, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER" .
Terminal No. Resistance
1 and 4 8 - 10 at 20C (68F)
2 and 3, 4

(Continuity should not exist)
3 and 1, 2, 4
PBIB0542E
HO2S2 HEATER (QG16DE)
EC-849
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
HO2S2 HEATER (QG16DE) PFP:226A0
Description EBS00FVI
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM performs ON/OFF control of the heated oxygen sensor 2 heater corresponding to the engine speed.
OPERATION
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FVJ
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater control
Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Engine speed rpm Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
Above 3,600 OFF
Below 3,600 ON
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S2 HTR (B1)
G Engine speed: Below 3,600 rpm [After driving for 2 minutes at a speed
of 70 km/h (43 MPH) or more]
ON
G Engine speed: Above 3,600 rpm OFF
EC-850
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S2 HEATER (QG16DE)
Wiring Diagram EBS00FVL
MBWA0073E
HO2S2 HEATER (QG16DE)
EC-851
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FVM
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION CHECK
1. Start engine and drive the vehicle at over 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle and keep the engine running.
3. Set the voltmeter probe between ECM terminal 2 (HO2S2 heater signal) and ground.
4. Check the voltage under the following conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END.
NG >> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
2 R/B
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm.
G After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of 70 km/h
(43 MPH) or more.
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
Conditions Voltage
At idle 0 - 1V
Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm Battery voltage
PBIB0673E
EC-852
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S2 HEATER (QG16DE)
2. CHECK HO2S2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between HO2S2 terminal 4 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Fuse block (J/B) connector E105
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between heated oxygen sensor 2 and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK HO2S2 OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 2 and HO2S2 terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2 HEATER
Refer to EC-853, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
MBIB0093E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0541E
Continuity should exist.
HO2S2 HEATER (QG16DE)
EC-853
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FVN
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2 HEATER
1. Check resistance between HO2S2 terminals as follows.
2. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard sur-
face such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system
threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread Cleaner tool J-43897-
18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FVO
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EX-3, "EXHAUST SYSTEM" .
Terminal No. Resistance
1 and 4 2.3 - 4.3 at 25C (77F)
2 and 1, 3, 4

(Continuity should not exist)
3 and 1, 2, 4
PBIB0542E
EC-854
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S2 HEATER (QG18DE)
HO2S2 HEATER (QG18DE) PFP:226A0
Description EBS00FVP
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM performs ON/OFF control of the heated oxygen sensor 2 heaters corresponding to the engine
speed.
OPERATION
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FVQ
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater control
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heaters
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Engine speed rpm Heated oxygen sensor 2 heaters
Above 3,600 OFF
Below 3,600 ON
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S2 HTR (B1)
HO2S2 HTR (B2)
G Ignition switch: ON (Engine stopped)
G Engine is running above 3,600 rpm.
OFF
G Engine is running below 3,600 rpm after driving for 2 minutes at a
speed of 70 km/h (43 MPH) or more.
ON
HO2S2 HEATER (QG18DE)
EC-855
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00FVR
BANK 1
MBWA0080E
EC-856
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S2 HEATER (QG18DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
2 L
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater (bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm.
G After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of 70 km/h
(43 MPH) or more.
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
HO2S2 HEATER (QG18DE)
EC-857
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
BANK 2
MBWA0082E
EC-858
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S2 HEATER (QG18DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and body ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FVS
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
1. Start engine and drive the vehicle at 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle and keep the engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 2 [HO2S2(B1) heater signal] or 7 [HO2S2(B2) heater signal]
and ground.
4. Check the voltage under the following conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
7 W/R
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater (bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm.
G After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of 70 km/h
(43 MPH) or more.
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
Conditions voltage
At idle 0 - 1V
Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm. Battery voltage
MBIB0040E
HO2S2 HEATER (QG18DE)
EC-859
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK HO2S2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between HO2S2 terminal 4 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Fuse block (J/B) connector E105
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between heated oxygen sensor 2 and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK HO2S2 OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 2 and HO2S2 (B1) terminal 1, ECM terminal 7 and
HO2S2 (B2) terminal 1. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2 HEATER
Refer to EC-860, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 2.
MBIB0094E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0541E
Continuity should exist.
EC-860
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S2 HEATER (QG18DE)
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FVT
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2 HEATER
1. Check resistance between HO2S2 terminals as follows.
2. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard sur-
face such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system
threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread Cleaner tool J-43897-
18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FVU
HATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EX-3, "EXHAUST SYSTEM" .
Terminal No. Resistance
2 and 3 2.3 - 4.3 at 25C (77F)
1 and 2, 3, 4

(Continuity should not exist)
4 and 1, 2, 3
SEF249Y
IAT SENSOR
EC-861
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
IAT SENSOR PFP:22630
Component Description EBS00EZ3
The intake air temperature sensor is built into mass air flow sensor.
The sensor detects intake air temperature and transmits a signal to
the ECM.
The temperature sensing unit uses a thermistor which is sensitive to
the change in temperature. Electrical resistance of the thermistor
decreases in response to the temperature rise.
<Reference data>
*: These data are reference values and are measured between ECM terminal 34
(Intake air temperature sensor) and body ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output
voltage. Doing so may result in damage to the ECM's transistor.
Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
SEC266C
Intake air
temperature C (F)
Voltage* V Resistance k
25 (77) 3.32 1.9 - 2.1
80 (176) 1.23 0.31 - 0.37
SEF012P
EC-862
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
IAT SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00EZ4
MBWA0070E
IAT SENSOR
EC-863
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EZ5
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 34 and ground with CON-
SULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect mass air flow sensor (intake air temperature sensor
is built-into) harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between MAF sensor terminal 5 and ground.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 67 and mass air flow sensor terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
Voltage: 0.04 - 4.84V
MBIB0041E
MBIB0096E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0066E
Continuity should exist.
EC-864
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
IAT SENSOR
4. CHECK INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Refer to EC-864, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace mass air flow sensor (with intake air temperature sensor).
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EZ6
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Check resistance between intake air temperature sensor termi-
nals 3 and 5 under the following conditions.
2. If NG, replace mass air flow sensor (with intake air temperature
sensor).
Removal and Installation EBS00EZ7
MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EM-17, "AIR CLEANER AND AIR DUCT" .
Intake air temperature C (F) Resistance k
25 (77) 1.9 - 2.1
SEC266C
SEF012P
HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-865
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
HO2S1 (QG16DE) PFP:22690
Component Description EBS00FVV
The heated oxygen sensor 1 is placed into the exhaust manifold. It
detects the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas compared to the
outside air. The heated oxygen sensor 1 has a closed-end tube
made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from
approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner conditions. The
heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM adjusts
the injection pulse duration to achieve the ideal air-fuel ratio. The
ideal air-fuel ratio occurs near the radical change from 1V to 0V.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FVW
Specification data are reference values.
SEF463R
SEF288D
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 (B1) G Engine: After warming up Maintaining engine speed at 2,000 rpm 0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up Maintaining engine speed at 2,000 rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times dur-
ing 10 seconds.
EC-866
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S1 (QG16DE)
Wiring Diagram EBS00FVY
MBWA0071E
HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-867
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FVZ
1. INSPECTION START
Do you have CONSULT-II?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> GO TO 3.
2. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select HO2S1 MNTR (B1) in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Keep the engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load, and make
sure that the monitors fluctuate between LEAN and RICH more
than five times in 10 seconds.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 4.
3. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
3. Keep the engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load, and make
sure that the voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to
1.0V more than five times in 10 seconds.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 4.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
35 W Heated oxygen sensor 1
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
1 time: RICH LEAN RICH
2 times: RICH LEAN RICH LEAN RICH
SEF646Y
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
MBIB0018E
EC-868
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S1 (QG16DE)
4. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 5.
5. RETIGHTEN HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Loosen and retighten heated oxygen sensor 1.
>> GO TO 6.
6. CHECK FOR EXHAUST AIR LEAK
1. Start engine and run it at idle.
2. Listen for an exhaust air leak before three way catalyst (Mani-
fold).
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Repair or replace.
7. CHECK FOR INTAKE AIR LEAK
Listen for an intake air leak after the mass air flow sensor.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair or replace.
MBIB0095E
Tightening torque: 40 - 60 Nm (4.1 - 6.2 kg-m, 30 - 44 ft-lb)
MBIB0098E
SEF099P
HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-869
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
8. CHECK HO2S1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect HO2S1 harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S1
terminal 3. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
9. CHECK HO2S1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 and HO2S1 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 or HO2S1 terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
10. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 HEATER
Refer to EC-841, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 1.
11. CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EC-671, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Replace mass air flow sensor.
12. CHECK PCV VALVE
Refer to EC-955, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> Replace PCV valve.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0091E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
EC-870
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S1 (QG16DE)
13. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-870, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14.
NG >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 1.
14. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FW0
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG and adjust TRIGGER POINT to 100% in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-
II.
3. Select HO2S1 (B1) and HO2S1 MNTR (B1).
4. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load during the follow-
ing steps.
5. Touch RECORD on CONSULT-II screen.
6. Check the following.
G HO2S1 MNTR (B1) in DATA MONITOR mode changes
from RICH to LEAN to RICH 5 times in 10 seconds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes below 0.3V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
SEF646Y
SEF217YA
SEF648Y
HO2S1 (QG16DE)
EC-871
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
G The voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new
one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FW1
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-23, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER" .
MBIB0018E
EC-872
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S1 (QG18DE)
HO2S1 (QG18DE) PFP:22690
Component Description EBS00FW2
The heated oxygen sensor 1 is placed into the exhaust manifold. It
detects the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas compared to the
outside air. The heated oxygen sensor 1 has a closed-end tube
made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from
approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner conditions. The
heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM adjusts
the injection pulse duration to achieve the ideal air-fuel ratio. The
ideal air-fuel ratio occurs near the radical change from 1V to 0V.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FW3
Specification data are reference values.
SEF463R
SEF288D
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 (B1)
HO2S1 (B2)
G Engine: After warming up Maintaining engine speed at 2,000 rpm
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1)
HO2S1 MNTR (B2)
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times during
10 seconds.
HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-873
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00FW4
BANK 1
MBWA0076E
EC-874
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S1 (QG18DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
35 W
Heated oxygen sensor 1
(bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-875
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
BANK 2
MBWA0078E
EC-876
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S1 (QG18DE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FW5
1. INSPECTION START
Do you have CONSULT-II?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> GO TO 3.
2. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select HO2S1 MNTR (B1) andHO2S1 MNTR (B2) in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Keep the engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load, and make
sure that the monitors fluctuate between LEAN and RICH more
than five times in 10 seconds.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 4.
3. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1(B1) signal] or 36 [HO2S1(B2) signal] and engine
ground.
3. Keep the engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load, and make
sure that the voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to
1.0V more than five times in 10 seconds.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 4.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
36 W
Heated oxygen sensor 1
(bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
1 time: RICH LEAN RICH
2 times: RICH LEAN RICH LEAN RICH
SEF646Y
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
MBIB0019E
HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-877
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 5.
5. RETIGHTEN HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Loosen and retighten heated oxygen sensor 1.
>> GO TO 6.
6. CHECK FOR EXHAUST AIR LEAK
1. Start engine and run it at idle.
2. Listen for an exhaust air leak before three way catalyst (Mani-
fold).
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Repair or replace.
7. CHECK FOR INTAKE AIR LEAK
Listen for an intake air leak after the mass air flow sensor.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair or replace.
MBIB0095E
Tightening torque: 40 - 60 Nm (4.1 - 6.2 kg-m, 30 - 44 ft-lb)
MBIB0099E
SEF099P
EC-878
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S1 (QG18DE)
8. CHECK HO2S1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect HO2S1 harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S1
terminal 3. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
9. CHECK HO2S1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 and HO2S1 (B1) terminal 2, ECM terminal 36 and
HO2S1 (B2) terminal 2. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals 35, 36 or HO2S1 terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
10. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 HEATER
Refer to EC-848, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 1.
11. CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EC-671, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Replace mass air flow sensor.
12. CHECK PCV VALVE
Refer to EC-955, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> Replace PCV valve.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0092E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
HO2S1 (QG18DE)
EC-879
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
13. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-879, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14.
NG >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 1.
14. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FW6
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG and adjust TRIGGER POINT to 100% in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-
II.
3. Select HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) and HO2S1 MNTR (B1)/(B2).
4. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load during the following steps.
5. Touch RECORD on CONSULT-II screen.
6. Check the following.
G HO2S1 MNTR (B1)/(B2) in DATA MONITOR mode
changes from RICH to LEAN to RICH 5 times in 10 sec-
onds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage goes below 0.3V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1)/(B2) voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
SEF646Y
SEF647Y
SEF648Y
EC-880
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S1 (QG18DE)
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] or 36 [HO2S1 (B2) signal] and
engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
G The voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new
one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FW7
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-23, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND CATALYTIC CONVERTER" .
MBIB0019E
HO2S2 (QG16DE)
EC-881
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
HO2S2 (QG16DE) PFP:226A0
Component Description EBS00FW8
The heated oxygen sensor 2, after three way catalyst, monitors the
oxygen level in the exhaust gas.
Even if switching characteristics of the heated oxygen sensor 1 are
shifted, the air fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal
from the heated oxygen sensor 2.
This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates volt-
age from approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner condi-
tions.
Under normal conditions the heated oxygen sensor 2 is not used for
engine control operation.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FW9
Specification data are reference values.
SEF327R
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S2 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S2 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
LEAN RICH
EC-882
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S2 (QG16DE)
Wiring Diagram EBS00FWB
MBWA0073E
HO2S2 (QG16DE)
EC-883
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FWC
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION-I
1. Start engine and drive the vehicle at over 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle and keep the engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 (HO2S2 signal) and ground.
4. Check the voltage while revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times. (Depress and release the accelerator pedal as
quickly as possible.)
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION-II
Keep engine at idle for 10 minutes, then check the voltage between
ECM terminal 16 and ground, or check voltage when coasting 80
km/h (50 MPH) in 3rd gear.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 3.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
16 W Heated oxygen sensor 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
The voltage does not remain in the range of 0.2 -0.4V
MBIB0020E
The voltage does not remain in the range of 0.2 -0.4V
MBIB0020E
EC-884
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S2 (QG16DE)
3. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 4.
4. CHECK HO2S2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S2
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HO2S2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 16 and HO2S2 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 16 or HO2S2 terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground or short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EC-885, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
MBIB0095E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0093E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
HO2S2 (QG16DE)
EC-885
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00FWD
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Select FUEL INJECTION in ACTIVE TEST mode, and select
HO2S2 (B1) as the monitor item with CONSULT-II.
4. Check HO2S2 (B1) at idle speed when adjusting FUEL INJECTION to 25%.
HO2S2 (B1) should be above 0.68V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is +25%.
HO2S2 (B1) should be below 0.50V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is 25%.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 (HO2S2 signal) and engine ground.
SEF662Y
PBIB0551E
EC-886
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S2 (QG16DE)
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.68V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage is above 0.68V at step 4, step 5 is not neces-
sary.
5. Keep vehicle at idling for 10 minutes, then check voltage. Or
check the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in 3rd
gear position.
The voltage should be below 0.50V at least once during this
procedure.
6. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FWE
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EX-3, "EXHAUST SYSTEM" .
MBIB0020E
HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-887
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
HO2S2 (QG18DE) PFP:226A0
Component Description EBS00FWF
The heated oxygen sensor 2, after three way catalyst, monitors the
oxygen level in the exhaust gas on each bank.
Even if switching characteristics of the heated oxygen sensor 1 are
shifted, the air fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal
from the heated oxygen sensor 2.
This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates volt-
age from approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner condi-
tions.
Under normal conditions the heated oxygen sensor 2 is not used for
engine control operation.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00FWG
Specification data are reference values.
SEF327R
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S2 (B1)
HO2S2 (B2)
G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle up to
2,000 rpm
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S2 MNTR (B1)
HO2S2 MNTR (B2)
LEAN RICH
EC-888
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S2 (QG18DE)
Wiring Diagram EBS00FWH
BANK 1
MBWA0080E
HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-889
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and body ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
16 Y
Heated oxygen sensor 2
(bank 1)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
EC-890
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S2 (QG18DE)
BANK 2
MBWA0082E
HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-891
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and body ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00FWI
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION - I
1. Start engine and drive the vehicle at 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle and keep the engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 17 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
ground.
4. Check the voltage while revving engine up to 4,000 rpm under
no load at least 10 times.
(Depress and release the accelerator pedal as quickly as possi-
ble.)
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION - II
Keep engine at idle for 10 minutes, then check the voltage between
ECM terminal 16 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 17 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
ground, or check the voltage when coasting at 80 km/h (50 MPH) in
D position with OD OFF (A/T), 3rd gear position (M/T).
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 3.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
17 L
Heated oxygen sensor 2
(bank 2)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
74 B
Heated oxygen sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
The voltage does not remain in the range of 0.2 - 0.4V
MBIB0021E
The voltage does not remain in the range of 0.2 - 0.4V
MBIB0021E
EC-892
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S2 (QG18DE)
3. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Stop vehicle and turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 4.
4. CHECK HO2S2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S2
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HO2S2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 16 and HO2S2 (B1) terminal 2, ECM terminal 17 and
HO2S2 (B2) terminal 2. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals 16, 17 or HO2S2 terminal 1 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground or short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EC-893, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 2.
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
MBIB0095E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0094E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
HO2S2 (QG18DE)
EC-893
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Component Inspection EBS00FWJ
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Select FUEL INJECTION in ACTIVE TEST mode, and select
HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) as the monitor item with CONSULT-II.
4. Check HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) at idle speed when adjusting FUEL INJECTION to 25%.
HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) should be above 0.68V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is +25%.
HO2S2 (B1)/(B2) should be below 0.50V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is 25%.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] or 17 [HO2S2 (B2) signal] and
engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.68V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage is above 0.68V at step 4, step 5 is not neces-
sary.
5. Keep vehicle at idling for 10 minutes, then check voltage. Or
check the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D
position with OD OFF (A/T), 3rd gear position (M/T).
The voltage should be below 0.50V at least once during this
procedure.
6. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
SEF662Y
PBIB0551E
MBIB0021E
EC-894
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S2 (QG18DE)
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00FWK
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EX-3, "EXHAUST SYSTEM" .
IGNITION SIGNAL
EC-895
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
IGNITION SIGNAL PFP:22448
Component Description EBS00EZ8
IGNITION COIL & POWER TRANSISTOR
The ignition signal from the ECM is sent to and amplified by the
power transistor. The power transistor turns on and off the ignition
coil primary circuit. This on-off operation induces the proper high
voltage in the coil secondary circuit.
MBIB0111E
EC-896
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
IGNITION SIGNAL
Wiring Diagram EBS00EZ9
MBWA0087E
IGNITION SIGNAL
EC-897
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
111 W/G
ECM relay
(Self shut-off)
[Engine is running]
[Ignition switch OFF]
G For a few seconds after turning ignition
switch OFF
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch OFF]
G More than a few seconds passed after turn-
ing ignition switch OFF
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
119
120
W
W
Power supply for ECM [Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
EC-898
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
IGNITION SIGNAL
MBWA0088E
IGNITION SIGNAL
EC-899
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EZA
1. CHECK ENGINE START
Turn ignition switch OFF, and restart engine.
Is engine running?
Yes or No
Yes (With CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 2.
Yes (Without CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 3.
No >> GO TO 4.
2. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
With CONSULT-II
1. Perform POWER BALANCE in ACTIVE TEST mode with CONSULT-II.
2. Make sure that each circuit produces a momentary engine
speed drop.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 10.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
60
61
79
80
L/R
BR
GY/R
PU
Ignition signal No. 3
Ignition signal No. 1
Ignition signal No. 4
Ignition signal No. 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0 - 0.1V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - 0.2V
PBIB0521E
PBIB0522E
PBIB0133E
EC-900
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
IGNITION SIGNAL
3. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
Without CONSULT-II
1. Let engine idle.
2. Read the voltage signal between ECM terminals 60, 61, 79, 80
and ground with an oscilloscope.
3. Verify that the oscilloscope screen shows the signal wave as
shown below.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 10.
4. CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-I
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminals 119, 120 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Go to EC-657, "POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM"
.
5. CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-II
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect condenser harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between condenser terminal 1 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 6.
MBIB0033E
PBIB0521E
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0034E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0624E
IGNITION SIGNAL
EC-901
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-III
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM relay.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM relay terminal 7 and
condenser terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-IV
Check voltage between ECM relay terminal 6 and ground with CON-
SULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> GO TO 8.
8. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E70, F13 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E63, F31 (RHD models)
G 20A fuse
G Harness for open or short between ECM relay and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
9. CHECK ECM RELAY
Refer to EC-903, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> Replace ECM relay.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0155E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0625E
EC-902
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
IGNITION SIGNAL
10. CHECK CONDENSER GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect condenser harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between condenser terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connector.
11. CHECK CONDENSER
Refer to EC-903, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Replace condenser.
12. CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-V
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
3. Disconnect ignition coil harness connector.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
5. Check voltage between ignition coil terminal 1 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14.
NG >> GO TO 13.
13. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between ignition coil and ECM relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0111E
Voltage: Battery voltage
SEF107S
IGNITION SIGNAL
EC-903
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
14. CHECK IGNITION COIL GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between ignition coil terminal 2 and engine ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 15.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
15. CHECK IGNITION COIL OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals 60, 61, 79, 80 and ignition coil terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 16.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
16. CHECK IGNITION COIL WITH POWER TRANSISTOR
Refer to EC-903, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> Replace ignition coil with power transistor.
17. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EZB
ECM RELAY
1. Apply 12V direct current between ECM relay terminals 1 and 2.
2. Check continuity between relay terminals 3 and 5, 6 and 7.
3. If NG, replace ECM relay.
CONDENSER
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect condenser harness connector.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
Condition Continuity
12V direct current supply
between terminals 1 and 2
Yes
OFF No
PBIB0077E
EC-904
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
IGNITION SIGNAL
3. Check resistance between condenser terminals 1 and 2.
IGNITION COIL WITH POWER TRANSISTOR
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ignition coil harness connector.
3. Check resistance between ignition coil terminals as follows.
Removal and Installation EBS00EZC
IGNITION COIL WITH POWER TRANSISTOR
Refer to EM-29, "IGNITION COIL" .
Resistance: Above 1 M at 25C (77F)
MBIB0031E
Terminal No. Resistance [at 25C (77F)]
3 and 1 Except 0 or
3 and 2
Except 0
1 and 2
MBIB0032E
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
EC-905
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE PFP:14920
Description EBS00EZD
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
*: This signal is sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
*2: The ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
This system controls flow rate of fuel vapor from the EVAP canister. The opening of the vapor by-pass pas-
sage in the EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve changes to control the flow rate. The EVAP
canister purge volume control solenoid valve repeats ON/OFF operation according to the signal sent from the
ECM. The opening of the valve varies for optimum engine control. The optimum value stored in the ECM is
determined by considering various engine conditions. When the engine is operating, the flow rate of fuel vapor
from the EVAP canister is regulated as the air flow changes.
COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
The EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve uses a ON/
OFF duty to control the flow rate of fuel vapor from the EVAP canis-
ter. The EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve is
moved by ON/OFF pulses from the ECM. The longer the ON pulse,
the greater the amount of fuel vapor that will flow through the valve.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EZE
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
*2
EVAP canister
purge flow control
EVAP canister purge
volume control solenoid
valve
Mass air flow sensor Amount of intake air
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Battery
Battery voltage
*2
Throttle position sensor Throttle position
Accelerator pedal position sensor Closed throttle position
Heated oxygen sensors 1
Density of oxygen in exhaust gas
(Mixture ratio feedback signal)
Vehicle speed signal
*1
Vehicle speed
SEF337U
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
PURG VOL C/V
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 0%
2,000 rpm 15 - 30%
EC-906
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Wiring Diagram EBS00EZG
MBWA0083E
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
EC-907
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and body ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
19 GY/L
EVAP canister purge
volume control solenoid
valve
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is about 2,000 rpm
Approximately 10V
PBIB0520E
EC-908
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EZH
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect the EVAP purge hose connected to the EVAP canister.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Select PURG VOL CONT/V in ACTIVE TEST mode with CONSULT-II.
5. Start engine and let it idle.
6. Change the valve opening percentage with touching Qu or
Qd on CONSULT-II screen, and check for vacuum existence at
the EVAP purge hose under the following conditions.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect the EVAP purge hose connected to the EVAP canister.
3. Start engine and let it idle for at least 80 seconds.
4. Check for vacuum existence at the EVAP purge hose under the
following conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> GO TO 3.
2. CHECK EVAP CANISTER
Refer to EC-954, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> Replace EVAP canister.
PBIB0569E
Conditions Vacuum
At idle Should not exist.
Engine speed is about 2,000 rpm. Should exist.
MBIB0112E
Conditions Vacuum
At idle Should not exist.
Engine speed is about 2,000 rpm. Should exist.
MBIB0112E
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
EC-909
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK EVAP PURGE LINE
Check EVAP purge line (pipe, rubber tube, fuel tank and EVAP canister) for cracks or improper connection.
Refer to EC-953, "EVAPORATIVE EMISSION LINE DRAWING" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair or reconnect the hose.
4. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE POWER SUPPLY CIR-
CUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve
harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve terminal 1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve and ECM
G Harness for open or short between EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve and ECM relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0113E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0148E
EC-910
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
6. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OUTPUT SIGNAL CIR-
CUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 19 and EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid
valve terminal 2. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK (With CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 7.
OK (Without CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground and short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OPERATION
With CONSULT-II
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Start engine.
3. Perform PURG VOL CONT/V in ACTIVE TEST mode with
CONSULT-II. Check that engine speed varies according to the
valve opening.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> GO TO 8.
8. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Refer to EC-911, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve.
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Continuity should exist.
PBIB0569E
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
EC-911
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Component Inspection EBS00EZI
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
With CONSULT-II
Check air passage continuity of EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve under the following conditions.
Without CONSULT-II
Check air passage continuity of EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve under the following conditions.
Removal and Installation EBS00EZJ
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Refer to EM-19, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
Condition
(PURG VOL CONT/V value)
Air passage continuity
between A and B
100.0% Yes
0.0% No
PBIB0149E
Condition
Air passage continuity
between A and B
12V direct current supply between
terminals 1 and 2
Yes
No supply No
PBIB0150E
EC-912
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
VSS
VSS PFP:32702
Description EBS00H9O
NOTE:
If DTC U1000 or U1001 is displayed, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000, U1001. Refer to
EC-663, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
The vehicle speed signal is sent to the combination meter from ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
through CAN communication line. The combination meter then sends a signal to the ECM through CAN com-
munication line.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H9Q
1. CHECK VEHICLE SPEED SIGNAL OVERALL FUNCTION
With CONSULT-II
1. Lift up the vehicle.
2. Start engine.
3. Select VHCL SPEED SE in DATA MONITOR mode with
CONSULT-II.
4. Make sure that VHCL SPEED SE indication exceeds 10 km/h
(6 MPH) when rotating wheels with suitable gear position.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Lift up the vehicle.
2. Start engine.
3. Read vehicle speed with combination meter.
Make sure that vehicle speed indication exceeds 10 km/h (6 MPH) when rotating wheels with suitable
gear position.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK DTC
Check DTC with ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit), Refer to BRC-17, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace.
3. CHECK COMBINATION METER
Check combination meter function.
Refer to DI-5, "COMBINATION METERS (LHD MODELS)" or DI-34, "COMBINATION METERS (RHD MOD-
ELS)" .
>> INSPECTION END
SEF196Y
POWER STEERING PRESSURE SENSOR
EC-913
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
POWER STEERING PRESSURE SENSOR PFP:49763
Component Description EBS00H7C
Power steering pressure (PSP) sensor is installed to the power
steering high-pressure tube and detects a power steering load. This
sensor is a potentiometer which transforms the power steering load
into output voltage, and emits the voltage signal to the ECM. The
ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator and adjusts the
throttle valve opening angle to increase the engine speed and
adjusts the idle speed for the increased load.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H7D
Specification data are reference values.
MBIB0105E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
PW/ST SIGNAL
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Steering wheel is in neutral position.
(Forward direction)
OFF
Steering wheel is turned. ON
EC-914
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
POWER STEERING PRESSURE SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00H7G
MBWA0089E
POWER STEERING PRESSURE SENSOR
EC-915
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H7H
1. INSPECTION START
Do you have CONSULT-II?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> GO TO 3.
2. CHECK POWER STEERING PRESSURE SENSOR OVERALL FUNCTION
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Check PW/ST SIGNAL in DATA MONITOR mode with CON-
SULT-II under the following conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 4.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
12 L
Power steering pressure
sensor
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is being turned.
0.5 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is not being turned.
0.4 - 0.8V
57 B
Sensor ground
(Power steering pressure
sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
65 G
Sensor power supply
(Power steering pressure
sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
Steering in neutral position OFF
Steering is turned ON
PBIB0646E
EC-916
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
POWER STEERING PRESSURE SENSOR
3. CHECK POWER STEERING PRESSURE SENSOR OVERALL FUNCTION
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 12 and ground under the
following conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 5.
5. CHECK PSP SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect PSP sensor harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between PSP sensor terminal 3 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
Condition Voltage
Steering wheel is being turned. 0.5 - 4.0V
Steering wheel is not being turned. 0.4 - 0.8V
MBIB0126E
MBIB0095E
MBIB0105E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
SEF509Y
POWER STEERING PRESSURE SENSOR
EC-917
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK PSP SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 57 and PSP sensor terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK PSP SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 12 and PSP sensor terminal 2.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK PSP SENSOR
Refer to EC-917, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace PSP sensor.
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H7I
POWER STEERING PRESSURE SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Start engine and let it idle.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminal 12 and ground under the
following conditions.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
Condition Voltage
Steering wheel is being turned fully. 0.5 - 4.0V
Steering wheel is not being turned. 0.4 - 0.8V
MBIB0025E
EC-918
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE PFP:23796
Description EBS00EZK
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
*: This signal is sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
This mechanism hydraulically controls cam phases continuously with the fixed operating angle of the intake
valve.
The ECM receives signals such as crankshaft position, camshaft position, engine speed, and engine coolant
temperature. Then, the ECM sends ON/OFF pulse duty signals to the intake valve timing control solenoid
valve depending on driving status. This makes it possible to control the shut/open timing of the intake valve to
increase engine torque in low/mid speed range and output in high-speed range.
COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
Intake valve timing control solenoid valve is activated by ON/OFF
pulse duty (ratio) signals from the ECM.
The intake valve timing control solenoid valve changes the oil
amount and direction of flow through intake valve timing control unit
or stops oil flow.
The longer pulse width advances valve angle.
The shorter pulse width retards valve angle.
When ON and OFF pulse widths become equal, the solenoid valve
stops oil pressure flow to fix the intake valve angle at the control
position.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EZL
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Engine speed
Intake valve
timing control
Intake valve timing control
solenoid valve
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Vehicle speed signal
*
Vehicle speed
MBIB0121E
PBIB0195E
IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
EC-919
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
INT/V TIM (B1)
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 5 - 5CA
When revving engine up to 2,000 rpm
quickly
Approx. 0 - 30CA
INT/V SOL (B1)
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 0% - 2%
When revving engine up to 2,000 rpm
quickly
Approx. 0% - 60%
EC-920
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Wiring Diagram EBS00EZN
MBWA0084E
IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
EC-921
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EZO
1. CHECK IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OVERALL FUNCTION CHECK
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Set the tester probe between ECM terminals 62 (IVT control solenoid valve signal) and ground.
5. Start engine and let it idle.
6. Check the voltage under the following conditions.
Verify that the oscilloscope screen shows the signal wave as
shown below.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
62 Y/R
Intake valve timing
control solenoid valve
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G When revving engine up to 2,000 rpm quickly
Approximately 9V
PBIB0532E
Conditions Voltage
At idle
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
When revving engine up
to 2,000 rpm quickly
Approximately 9V
MBIB0042E
PBIB0532E
EC-922
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
2. CHECK IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE POWER SUPPLY CIRCIUT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect intake valve timing control solenoid valve harness
connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between intake valve timing control solenoid
valve terminal 1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTION PART
Check harness for open or short between intake valve timing control solenoid valve and ECM relay.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 62 and intake valve timing control solenoid valve termi-
nal 2. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Refer to EC-923, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace intake valve timing control solenoid valve.
MBIB0106E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0285E
Continuity should exist.
IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
EC-923
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (POS)
Refer to EC-758, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace crankshaft position sensor (POS).
7. CHECK CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (PHASE)
Refer to EC-765, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace camshaft position sensor (PHASE).
8. CHECK CAMSHAFT (INTAKE)
Check the following.
G Accumulation of debris to the signal plate of camshaft rear end
G Chipping signal plate of camshaft rear end
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Remove debris and clean the signal plate of camshaft
rear end or replace camshaft.
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00EZP
INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
1. Disconnect intake valve timing control solenoid valve harness connector.
2. Check resistance between intake valve timing control solenoid
valve terminals 1 and 2.
Removal and Installation EBS00EZQ
INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Refer to EM-49, "TIMING CHAIN" .
PBIB0565E
Terminals Resistance
1 and 2 Approximately 8 at 20C (68F)
1 or 2 and ground

(Continuity should not exist)
PBIB0574E
EC-924
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
PNP SWITCH
PNP SWITCH PFP:32006
Component Description EBS00EZR
When the gear position is P (A/T models only) or N, park/neutral position (PNP) switch is ON.
ECM detects the position because the continuity of the line (the ON signal) exists.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EZS
Specification data are reference values.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
P/N POSI SW G Ignition switch: ON
Shift lever:
P or N (A/T model)
Neutral (M/T model)
ON
Shift lever: Except above OFF
PNP SWITCH
EC-925
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00EZU
MBWA0085E
EC-926
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
PNP SWITCH
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EZV
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select P/N POSI SW in DATA MONITOR mode with CON-
SULT-II.
3. Check the P/N POSI SW signal under the following conditions.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 102 and ground under the
following conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
102
P (A/T)
G/OR (M/T)
PNP switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is P or N (A/T models),
Neutral (M/T models).
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Except the above gear position
A/T models
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
M/T models
Approximately 5V
Selector lever position P/N POSI SW signal
P and N position ON
Except the above position OFF
PBIB0102E
Selector lever position Voltage
P and N position Approximately 0V
Except the above position
A/T models: Battery voltage
M/T models: Approximately 5V
MBIB0043E
PNP SWITCH
EC-927
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK PNP SWITCH GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect PNP switch harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between PNP switch terminal 2 and
body ground. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or con-
nectors.
3. CHECK PNP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 102 and PNP switch terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK PNP SWITCH
Refer to AT-404, "ON-VEHICLE SERVICE" (A/T models) or MT-14, "POSITION SWITCH" , MT-62, "POSI-
TION SWITCH" (M/T models).
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace PNP switch.
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0110E
Continuity should exist.
EC-928
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
INJECTOR CIRCUIT PFP:16600
Component Description EBS00EZW
The fuel injector is a small, precise solenoid valve. When the ECM
supplies a ground to the injector circuit, the coil in the injector is
energized. The energized coil pulls the needle valve back and allows
fuel to flow through the injector into the intake manifold. The amount
of fuel injected depends upon the injection pulse duration. Pulse
duration is the length of time the injector remains open. The ECM
controls the injection pulse duration based on engine fuel needs.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00EZX
Specification data are reference values.
*: This item is displayed with QG18DE engine models.
SEF375Z
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
B/FUEL SCHDL
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 1.5 - 3.0 msec
2,000 rpm 1.2 - 3.0 msec
INJ PULSE-B1
INJ PULSE-B2
*
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 2.0 - 3.5 msec
2,000 rpm 1.5 - 3.5 msec
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
EC-929
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00EZY
MBWA0086E
EC-930
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00EZZ
1. INSPECTION START
Turn ignition switch to START.
Is any cylinder ignited?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> GO TO 3.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
22
23
41
42
G/B
R/B
L/B
Y/B
Injector No. 3
Injector No. 1
Injector No. 4
Injector No. 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
PBIB0529E
PBIB0530E
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
EC-931
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Perform POWER BALANCE in ACTIVE TEST mode with
CONSULT-II.
3. Make sure that each circuit produces a momentary engine
speed drop.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Listen to each injector operating sound.
Clicking noise should be heard.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 3.
PBIB0133E
MEC703B
EC-932
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
3. CHECK INJECTOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect injector harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between injector terminal 1 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Fuse block (J/B) connector M1
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between injector and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK INJECTOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between injector terminal 2 and ECM terminals 22, 23, 41, 42.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK INJECTOR
Refer to EC-933, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace injector.
MBIB0101E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0582E
Continuity should exist.
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
EC-933
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00F00
INJECTOR
1. Disconnect injector harness connector.
2. Check resistance between terminals as shown in the figure.
Removal and Installation EBS00F01
INJECTOR
Refer to EM-31, "FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE" .
Resistance: 13.5 - 17.5 [at 20C (68F)]
PBIB0181E
EC-934
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT PFP:17042
Description EBS00F05
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
*: The ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
The ECM activates the fuel pump for several seconds after the ignition switch is turned on to improve engine
startability. If the ECM receives a engine speed signal from the crankshaft position sensor (POS) and cam-
shaft position sensor (PHASE), it knows that the engine is rotating, and causes the pump to operate. If the
engine speed signal is not received when the ignition switch is ON, the engine stalls. The ECM stops pump
operation and prevents battery discharging, thereby improving safety. The ECM does not directly drive the fuel
pump. It controls the ON/OFF fuel pump relay, which in turn controls the fuel pump.
COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
A turbine type design fuel pump is used in the fuel tank.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00F06
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
*
Fuel pump control Fuel pump relay
Battery
Battery voltage
*
Condition Fuel pump operation
Ignition switch is turned to ON. Operates for 1 second.
Engine running and cranking Operates.
When engine is stopped Stops in 1.5 seconds.
Except as shown above Stops.
MBIB0046E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
FUEL PUMP RLY
G For 1 seconds after turning ignition switch ON
G Engine running or cranking
ON
G Except above conditions OFF
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
EC-935
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00F07
MBWA0031E
EC-936
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00F08
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Pinch fuel feed hose with two fingers.
Fuel pressure pulsation should be felt on the fuel hose for 1
second after ignition switch is turned ON.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK FUEL PUMP RELAY POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect fuel pump relay.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between fuel pump relay terminals 1, 5 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
113 B/P Fuel pump relay
[Ignition switch ON]
G For 1 seconds after turning ignition switch ON
[Engine is running]
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G More than 1 seconds after turning ignition switch
ON.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
MBIB0114E
MBIB0154E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0657E
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
EC-937
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Fuse block (J/B) connector B1
G 10A fuse
G 15A fuse
G Harness for open or short between fuel pump relay and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK FUEL PUMP POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump harness con-
nector.
3. Check harness continuity between fuel pump relay terminal 3
and fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump terminal 5, fuel level
sensor unit and fuel pump terminal 3 and body ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors B37, D83
G Harness for open or short between fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump and fuel pump relay
G Harness for open or short between fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump and body ground
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK FUEL PUMP RELAY OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 113 and fuel pump relay terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0115E
Continuity should exist.
EC-938
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness connectors B5, M23 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors B42, M95 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between ECM and fuel pump relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK FUEL PUMP RELAY
Refer to EC-938, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace fuel pump relay.
9. CHECK FUEL PUMP
Refer to EC-938, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> Replace fuel pump.
10. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00F09
FUEL PUMP RELAY
Check continuity between terminals 3 and 5 under the following con-
ditions.
FUEL PUMP
1. Disconnect fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump harness con-
nector.
Conditions Continuity
12V direct current supply
between terminals 1 and 2
Yes
No current supply No
PBIB0098E
MBIB0115E
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
EC-939
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Check resistance between fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump
terminals 3 and 5.
Removal and Installation EBS00F0A
FUEL PUMP
Refer to FL-6, "FUEL LEVEL SENSOR UNIT, FUEL FILTER AND FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY (EXCEPT
YD22DDTi)" .
Resistance: Approximately 1.0 [at 25C (77F)]
PBIB0658E
EC-940
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR PFP:92136
Component Description EBS00F0H
The refrigerant pressure sensor is installed at the liquid tank of the
air conditioner system. The sensor uses an electrostatic volume
pressure transducer to convert refrigerant pressure to voltage. The
voltage signal is sent to ECM, and ECM controls cooling fan system.
MBIB0116E
SEF099X
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
EC-941
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00F0I
MBWA0090E
EC-942
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00F0J
1. CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR OVERALL FUNCTION
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn A/C switch and blower switch ON.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminal 69 and ground with CON-
SULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
46 R
Sensor power supply
(Refrigerant pressure sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
57 B
Sensor ground
(Refrigerant pressure sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
69
W (LHD)
B (RHD)
Refrigerant pressure sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Both A/C switch and blower switch are ON.
(Compressor operates.)
1.0 - 4.0V
Voltage: 1.0 - 4.0V
MBIB0035E
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
EC-943
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn A/C switch and blower switch OFF.
2. Stop engine.
3. Disconnect refrigerant pressure sensor harness connector.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
5. Check voltage between refrigerant pressure sensor terminal 3
and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness for open or short between ECM and refrigerant pressure sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 57 and refrigerant pressure sensor terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness for open or short between ECM and refrigerant pressure sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0116E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
SEF479Y
Continuity should exist.
EC-944
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
6. CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 69 and refrigerant pressure sensor terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness for open or short between ECM and refrigerant pressure sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
OK or NG
OK >> Replace refrigerant pressure sensor.
NG >> Repair or replace.
Removal and Installation EBS00F0K
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
Refer to ATC-127, "REFRIGERANT LINES" .
Continuity should exist.
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL
EC-945
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL PFP:25350
Description EBS00H8J
The electrical load signals except headlamp switch signal are transferred through the CAN communication
line.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H8K
Specification data are reference values.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
LOAD SIGNAL G Ignition switch: ON
Rear window defogger switch is ON and/or
lighting switch is 2nd.
ON
Rear window defogger switch is OFF and light-
ing switch is OFF.
OFF
EC-946
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL
Wiring Diagram EBS00H8L
MBWA0147E
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL
EC-947
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H8M
1. CHECK LOAD SIGNAL CIRCUIT OVERALL FUNCTION-I
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Connect CONSULT-II and select DATA MONITOR mode.
3. Select LOAD SIGNAL and check indication under the following
conditions.
OK or NG
OK (With CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 2.
OK (Without CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 4.
2. CHECK LOAD SIGNAL CIRCUIT OVERALL FUNCTION-II
With CONSULT-II
Check LOAD SIGNAL indication under the following conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 5.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
84 R/Y
Electrical load signal
(Headlamp signal)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Lighting switch is 2ND position
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Lighting switch is OFF
Approximately 0V
Condition Indication
Rear window defogger switch ON ON
Rear window defogger switch OFF OFF
PBIB0103E
Condition Indication
Lighting switch ON at 2nd position ON
Lighting switch OFF OFF
PBIB0103E
EC-948
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL
3. CHECK LOAD SIGNAL CIRCUIT OVERALL FUNCTION-II
Without CONSULT-II
Check voltage between ECM terminal 84 and ground under the fol-
lowing conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 5.
4. CHECK REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
Refer to GW-40, "REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER" .
>> INSPECTION END
5. CHECK HEADLAMP FUNCTION
1. Turn lighting switch ON at 2nd position.
2. Check that headlamps are illuminated.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Refer to LT-5, "HEADLAMP -CONVENTIONAL TYPE-" , LT-10, "HEADLAMP - XENON TYPE -" ,
LT-18, "HEADLAMP (WITH DAYTIME) - CONVENTIONAL TYPE -" or LT-25, "HEADLAMP
(WITH DAYTIME) - XENON TYPE -" .
Condition Voltage
Lighting switch ON at 2nd position Battery voltage
Lighting switch OFF Approximately 0V
MBIB0158E
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL
EC-949
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK HEADLAMP INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
CONVENTIONAL TYPE HEADLAMP WITHOUT DAYTIME LIGHT SYSTEM
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Disconnect lighting switch harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 84 and lighting switch terminal 10.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
CONVENTIONAL TYPE HEADLAMP WITH DAYTIME LIGHT SYSTEM
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Disconnect daytime light relay.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 84 and daytime light relay terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
XENON TYPE HEADLAMP
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Disconnect headlamp LH relay.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 84 and headlamp LH relay terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G harness for open and short between ECM and lighting switch
G harness for open and short between ECM and daytime light relay
G harness for open and short between ECM and headlamp LH relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-656, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
EC-950
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
MI & DATA LINK CONNECTORS
MI & DATA LINK CONNECTORS PFP:24814
Wiring DiagramLHD Models EBS00F0N
MBWA0151E
MI & DATA LINK CONNECTORS
EC-951
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring DiagramRHD Models EBS00H9T
MBWA0152E
EC-952
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM PFP:14950
Description EBS00F0O
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The evaporative emission system is used to reduce hydrocarbons emitted into the atmosphere from the fuel
system. This reduction of hydrocarbons is accomplished by activated charcoals in the EVAP canister.
The fuel vapor in the sealed fuel tank is led into the EVAP canister which contains activated carbon and the
vapor is stored there when the engine is not operating or when refueling to the fuel tank.
The vapor in the EVAP canister is purged by the air through the purge line to the intake manifold when the
engine is operating. EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve is controlled by ECM. When the
engine operates, the flow rate of vapor controlled by EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve is
proportionally regulated as the air flow increases.
EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve also shuts off the vapor purge line during decelerating and
idling.
PBIB0491E
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM
EC-953
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION LINE DRAWING
MBIB0014E
EC-954
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM
Component Inspection EBS00F0P
EVAP CANISTER
Check EVAP canister as follows:
1. Block port B . Orally blow air through port A .
Check that air flows freely through port C .
2. Block port A . Orally blow air through port B .
Check that air flows freely through port C .
FUEL CHECK VALVE
1. Blow air through connector on fuel tank side.
A considerable resistance should be felt and a portion of air flow
should be directed toward the EVAP canister side.
2. Blow air through connector on EVAP canister side.
Air flow should be smoothly directed toward fuel tank side.
3. If fuel check valve is suspected of not properly functioning in
steps 1 and 2 above, replace it.
FUEL TANK VACUUM RELIEF VALVE (BUILT INTO FUEL FILLER CAP)
1. Wipe clean valve housing.
2. Check valve opening pressure and vacuum.
3. If out of specification, replace fuel filler cap as an assembly.
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Refer to EC-911, "Component Inspection" .
PBIB0663E
SEF552Y
SEF989X
Pressure: 15.3 - 20.0 kPa (0.153 - 0.200 bar,
0.156 - 0.204 kg/cm
2
, 2.22 - 2.90 psi)
Vacuum: 6.0 to 3.3 kPa (0.060 to 0.033 bar,
0.061 to 0.034 kg/cm
2
, 0.87 to 0.48 psi)
SEF943S
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION
EC-955
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION PFP:11810
Description EBS00F0Q
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
This system returns blow-by gas to the intake manifold.
The positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) valve is provided to conduct crankcase blow-by gas to the intake
manifold. During partial throttle operation of the engine, the intake manifold sucks the blow-by gas through the
PCV valve. Normally, the capacity of the valve is sufficient to handle any blow-by and a small amount of venti-
lating air. The ventilating air is then drawn from the air inlet tubes into the crankcase. In this process the air
passes through the hose connecting air inlet tubes to rocker cover. Under full-throttle condition, the manifold
vacuum is insufficient to draw the blow-by flow through the valve. The flow goes through the hose connection
in the reverse direction.
On vehicles with an excessively high blow-by, the valve does not
meet the requirement. This is because some of the flow will go
through the hose connection to the air inlet tubes under all condi-
tions.
Component Inspection EBS00F0R
PCV (POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION) VALVE
With engine running at idle, remove PCV valve from rocker cover. A
properly working valve makes a hissing noise as air passes through
it. A strong vacuum should be felt immediately when a finger is
placed over valve inlet.
PBIB0492E
SEF559A
SEC137A
EC-956
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION
PCV VALVE VENTILATION HOSE
1. Check hoses and hose connections for leaks.
2. Disconnect all hoses and clean with compressed air. If any hose
cannot be freed of obstructions, replace.
S-ET277
SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
EC-957
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS) PFP:00030
Fuel Pressure EBS00F0S
Idle Speed and Ignition Timing EBS00F0T
*1: Under the following conditions:
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Electric load: OFF (Lights, heater fan & rear window defogger)
G Steering wheel: Kept in straight-ahead position
Calculated Load Value EBS00F0U
Mass Air Flow Sensor EBS00F0V
*: Engine is warmed up to normal operating temperature and running under no-load.
Intake Air Temperature Sensor EBS00F0W
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor EBS00F0X
Heated Oxygen Sensor 1 Heater EBS00F0Y
Heated Oxygen sensor 2 Heater EBS00F0Z
Crankshaft Position Sensor (POS) EBS00F10
Refer to EC-758, "Component Inspection" .
Camshaft Position Sensor (PHASE) EBS00F11
Refer to EC-765, "Component Inspection" .
Fuel pressure at idle
Approximately 350 kPa (3.7kg/cm
2
, 51psi)
Target idle speed
No-load*1 (in P or N position)
A/T: 80050 rpm
M/T: 70050 rpm
Air conditioner: ON In P or N position 825 rpm or more
Ignition timing
In P or N position A/T: 105 BTDC
M/T: 85 BTDC
Calculated load value % (Using CONSULT-II)
At idle 10 - 35
At 2,500 rpm 10 - 35
Supply voltage Battery voltage (11 - 14V)
Output voltage at idle 1.0 - 1.7*V
Mass air flow (Using CONSULT-II)
1.0 - 4.0 gm/sec at idle*
5.0 - 10.0 gm/sec at 2,500 rpm*
Temperature C (F) Resistance k
25 (77) 1.9 - 2.1
80 (176) 0.31 - 0.37
Temperature C (F) Resistance k
20 (68) 2.1 - 2.9
50 (122) 0.68 - 1.00
90 (194) 0.236 - 0.260
Resistance [at 20C (68F)] 8 - 10
Resistance [at 25C (77F)] 2.3 - 4.3
EC-958
[QG (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
Throttle Control Motor EBS00F12
Injector EBS00F13
Fuel Pump EBS00F14
Resistance [at 25C (77F)] Approximately 1 - 15
Resistance [at 20C (68F)] 13.5 - 17.5
Resistance [at 25C (77F)] Approximately 1.0
INDEX FOR DTC
EC-959
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
INDEX FOR DTC PFP:00024
Alphabetical Index EBS00F15
Check if the vehicle is a model with Euro-OBD (E-OBD) system or not by the Type approval number on the
identification plate. Refer to GI-46, "IDENTIFICATION PLATE" .
NOTE:
If DTC U1000 or U1001 is displayed with other DTC, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-1083, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC*
1
Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM*
3
ACC COMMAND VALUE*
7
P1568 1568 EC-1340
APP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
P0227 0227 EC-1188
APP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
P0228 0228 EC-1188
APP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
P1227 1227 EC-1322
APP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
P1228 1228 EC-1322
APP SENSOR*
5
P0226 0226 EC-1181
ASCD BRAKE SW*
7
P1572 1572 EC-1341
ASCD SW*
7
P1564 1564 EC-1333
ASCD VHL SPD SEN*
7
P1574 1574 EC-1351
BRAKE SW/CIRCUIT P1805 1805 EC-1360
CAN COMM CIRCUIT U1000
1000*
6
EC-1083
CAN COMM CIRCUIT U1001
1001*
6
EC-1083
CKP SEN/CIRCUIT P0335 0335 EC-1205
CMP SEN/CIRC-B1 P0340 0340 EC-1212
CTP LEARNING P1225 1225 EC-1318
CTP LEARNING P1226 1226 EC-1320
CYL 1 MISFIRE P0301 0301 EC-1195
CYL 2 MISFIRE P0302 0302 EC-1195
CYL 3 MISFIRE P0303 0303 EC-1195
CYL 4 MISFIRE P0304 0304 EC-1195
ECM P0605 0605 EC-1235
ECM BACK UP/CIRC P1065 1065 EC-1238
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
P0117 0117 EC-1111
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
P0118 0118 EC-1111
ENG OVER TEMP P1217 1217 EC-1295
ETC ACTR*
5
P1121 1121 EC-1246
ETC FUNCTION/CIRC*
5
P1122 1122 EC-1248
ETC MOT*
5
P1128 1128 EC-1261
ETC MOT PWR*
5
P1124 1124 EC-1255
ETC MOT PWR*
5
P1126 1126 EC-1255
FUEL SYS-LEAN-B1 P0171 0171 EC-1157
FUEL SYS-RICH-B1 P0172 0172 EC-1163
HO2S1 (B1) P0132 0132 EC-1119
EC-960
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
INDEX FOR DTC
HO2S1 (B1) P0133 0133 EC-1125
HO2S1 (B1) P0134 0134 EC-1135
HO2S1 (B1) P1143 1143 EC-1266
HO2S1 (B1) P1144 1144 EC-1272
HO2S1 HTR (B1) P0031 0031 EC-1090
HO2S1 HTR (B1) P0032 0032 EC-1090
HO2S2 (B1) P0138 0138 EC-1142
HO2S2 (B1) P0139 0139 EC-1149
HO2S2 (B1) P1146 1146 EC-1278
HO2S2 (B1) P1147 1147 EC-1286
HO2S2 HTR (B1) P0037 0037 EC-1095
HO2S2 HTR (B1) P0038 0038 EC-1095
IAT SEN/CIRCUIT P0112 0112 EC-1106
IAT SEN/CIRCUIT P0113 0113 EC-1106
IAT SENSOR P0127 0127 EC-1116
IN PULY SPEED P1715 1715
IN PY SPD SEN/CIRC P0715 0715 CVT-78
INT/V TIM CONT-B1 P0011 0011 EC-1087
INT/V TIM V/CIR-B1 P1111 1111 EC-1242
KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 P0327 0327 EC-1201
KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 P0328 0328 EC-1201
L/PRESS SOL/CIRC P0745 0745 CVT-94
LINE PRESS SEN P1791 1791 CVT-113
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
P0102 0102 EC-1100
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
P0103 0103 EC-1100
MULTI CYL MISFIRE P0300 0300 EC-1195
NATS MALFUNCTION P1610 - P1615 1610 - 1615 EC-1016
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.
No DTC
Flashing*
4
EC-1448
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.
P0000 0000
OUT PULY SPEED P1720 1720 EC-1358
P-N POS SW/CIRCUIT P1706 1706 EC-1353
PURG VOLUME CONT/V P0444 0444 EC-1222
PURG VOLUME CONT/V P0445 0445 EC-1222
PW ST P SEN/CIRC P0550 0550 EC-1230
SENSOR POWER/CIRC*
5
P1229 1229 EC-1329
STEP MOTR CIRC P1777 1777 CVT-108
STEP MOTR FNC P1778 1778 CVT-111
TCC SOLENOID/CIRC P0740 0740 CVT-89
TCS/CIRC*
8
P1212 1212 EC-1294
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC*
1
Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM*
3
INDEX FOR DTC
EC-961
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
*1: 1st trip DTC No. is the same as DTC No.
*2: These numbers are prescribed by ISO 15031-5.
*3: In Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results), these numbers are controlled by NISSAN.
*4: When engine is running.
*5: When the fail-safe operation occurs, the MI illuminates.
*6: The troubleshooting for these DTCs needs CONSULT-II.
*7: For models with ICC system.
*8: For models with ESP/TCS/ABS system.
DTC No. Index EBS00F16
NOTE:
If DTC U1000 or U1001 is displayed with other DTC, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-1083, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
TP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
P0222 0222 EC-1175
TP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
P0223 0223 EC-1175
TP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
P1223 1223 EC-1312
TP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
P1224 1224 EC-1312
TP SENSOR*
5
P0221 0221 EC-1169
TW CATALYST SYS-B1 P0420 0420 EC-1218
VEH SPEED SEN/CIRC P0500 0500 EC-1228
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC*
1
Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM*
3
DTC*
1
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM*
3
No DTC Flashing*
4
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.
EC-1448
U1000
1000*
6
CAN COMM CIRCUIT EC-1083
U1001
1001*
6
CAN COMM CIRCUIT EC-1083
P0000 0000
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.

P0011 0011 INT/V TIM CONT-B1 EC-1087


P0031 0031 HO2S1 HTR (B1) EC-1090
P0032 0032 HO2S1 HTR (B1) EC-1090
P0037 0037 HO2S2 HTR (B1) EC-1095
P0038 0038 HO2S2 HTR (B1) EC-1095
P0102 0102 MAF SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
EC-1100
P0103 0103 MAF SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
EC-1100
P0112 0112 IAT SEN/CIRCUIT EC-1106
P0113 0113 IAT SEN/CIRCUIT EC-1106
P0117 0117
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
EC-1111
P0118 0118
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
EC-1111
P0127 0127 IAT SENSOR EC-1116
P0132 0132 HO2S1 (B1) EC-1119
P0133 0133 HO2S1 (B1) EC-1125
EC-962
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
INDEX FOR DTC
P0134 0134 HO2S1 (B1) EC-1135
P0138 0138 HO2S2 (B1) EC-1142
P0139 0139 HO2S2 (B1) EC-1149
P0171 0171 FUEL SYS-LEAN-B1 EC-1157
P0172 0172 FUEL SYS-RICH-B1 EC-1163
P0221 0221
TP SENSOR*
5
EC-1169
P0222 0222
TP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
EC-1175
P0223 0223
TP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
EC-1175
P0226 0226
APP SENSOR*
5
EC-1181
P0227 0227
APP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
EC-1188
P0228 0228 APP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
EC-1188
P0300 0300 MULTI CYL MISFIRE EC-1195
P0301 0301 CYL 1 MISFIRE EC-1195
P0302 0302 CYL 2 MISFIRE EC-1195
P0303 0303 CYL 3 MISFIRE EC-1195
P0304 0304 CYL 4 MISFIRE EC-1195
P0327 0327 KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 EC-1201
P0328 0328 KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 EC-1201
P0335 0335 CKP SEN/CIRCUIT EC-1205
P0340 0340 CMP SEN/CIRC-B1 EC-1212
P0420 0420 TW CATALYST SYS-B1 EC-1218
P0444 0444 PURG VOLUME CONT/V EC-1222
P0445 0445 PURG VOLUME CONT/V EC-1222
P0500 0500 VEH SPEED SEN/CIRC EC-1228
P0550 0550 PW ST P SEN/CIRC EC-1230
P0605 0605 ECM EC-1235
P0715 0715 IN PY SPD SEN/CIRC CVT-78
P0740 0740 TCC SOLENOID/CIRC CVT-89
P0745 0745 L/PRESS SOL/CIRC CVT-94
P1065 1065 ECM BACK UP/CIRC EC-1238
P1111 1111 INT/V TIM V/CIR-B1 EC-1242
P1121 1121 ETC ACTR*
5
EC-1246
P1122 1122 ETC FUNCTION/CIRC*
5
EC-1248
P1124 1124 ETC MOT PWR*
5
EC-1255
P1126 1126
ETC MOT PWR*
5
EC-1255
P1128 1128
ETC MOT*
5
EC-1261
P1143 1143 HO2S1 (B1) EC-1266
P1144 1144 HO2S1 (B1) EC-1272
P1146 1146 HO2S2 (B1) EC-1278
P1147 1147 HO2S2 (B1) EC-1286
DTC*
1
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM*
3
INDEX FOR DTC
EC-963
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
*1: 1st trip DTC No. is the same as DTC No.
*2: These numbers are prescribed by ISO 15031-5.
*3: In Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results), these numbers are controlled by NISSAN.
*4: When engine is running.
*5: When the fail-safe operation occurs, the MI illuminates.
*6: The troubleshooting for these DTCs needs CONSULT-II.
*7: For models with ICC system.
*8: For models with ESP/TCS/ABS system.
P1212 1212 TCS/CIRC*
8
EC-1294
P1217 1217 ENG OVER TEMP EC-1295
P1223 1223
TP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
EC-1312
P1224 1224
TP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
EC-1312
P1225 1225 CTP LEARNING EC-1318
P1226 1226 CTP LEARNING EC-1320
P1227 1227
APP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
EC-1322
P1228 1228
APP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
EC-1322
P1229 1229 SENSOR POWER/CIRC*
5
EC-1329
P1564 1564 ASCD SW*
7
EC-1333
P1568 1568 ACC COMMAND VALUE*
7
EC-1340
P1572 1572 ASCD BRAKE SW*
7
EC-1341
P1574 1574
ASCD VHL SPD SEN*
7
EC-1351
P1610 - P1615 1610 - 1615 NATS MALFUNCTION EC-1016
P1706 1706 P-N POS SW/CIRCUIT EC-1353
P1715 1715 IN PULY SPEED
P1720 1720 OUT PULY SPEED EC-1358
P1777 1777 STEP MOTR CIRC CVT-108
P1778 1778 STEP MOTR FNC CVT-111
P1791 1791 LINE PRESS SEN CVT-113
P1805 1805 BRAKE SW/CIRCUIT EC-1360
DTC*
1
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM*
3
EC-964
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
PRECAUTIONS
PRECAUTIONS PFP:00001
Precautions for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) AIR BAG and SEAT
BELT PRE-TENSIONER EBS00F17
The Supplemental Restraint System such as "AIR BAG" and "SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER", used along
with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SRS and SB section of
this Service Manual.
WARNING:
G To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death
in the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be per-
formed by an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
G Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to per-
sonal injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air
Bag Module, see the SRS section.
G Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harness connec-
tors.
On Board Diagnostic (OBD) System of Engine and CVT EBS00F18
The ECM has an on board diagnostic system. It will light up the malfunction indicator (MI) to warn the driver of
a malfunction causing emission deterioration.
CAUTION:
G Be sure to turn the ignition switch OFF and disconnect the battery ground cable before any repair
or inspection work. The open/short circuit of related switches, sensors, solenoid valves, etc. will
cause the MI to light up.
G Be sure to connect and lock the connectors securely after work. A loose (unlocked) connector will
cause the MI to light up due to the open circuit. (Be sure the connector is free from water, grease,
dirt, bent terminals, etc.)
G Certain systems and components, especially those related to OBD, may use a new style slide-
locking type harness connector. For description and how to disconnect, refer to PG-86, "HAR-
NESS CONNECTOR" .
G Be sure to route and secure the harnesses properly after work. The interference of the harness
with a bracket, etc. may cause the MI to light up due to the short circuit.
G Be sure to connect rubber tubes properly after work. A misconnected or disconnected rubber tube
may cause the MI to light up due to the malfunction of the fuel injection system, etc.
G Be sure to erase the unnecessary malfunction information (repairs completed) from the ECM and
TCM (Transmission control module) before returning the vehicle to the customer.
Precaution EBS00F19
G Always use a 12 volt battery as power source.
G Do not attempt to disconnect battery cables while engine is
running.
G Before connecting or disconnecting the ECM harness con-
nector, turn ignition switch OFF and disconnect battery
ground cable. Failure to do so may damage the ECM
because battery voltage is applied to ECM even if ignition
switch is turned off.
G Before removing parts, turn ignition switch OFF and then
disconnect battery ground cable.
SEF289H
PRECAUTIONS
EC-965
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
G Do not disassemble ECM.
G If battery cable is disconnected, the memory will return to
the initial ECM values.
The ECM will now start to self-control at its initial values.
Engine operation can vary slightly when the cable is dis-
connected. However, this is not an indication of a problem.
Do not replace parts because of a slight variation.
G When connecting ECM harness connector, fasten it
securely with levers as far as they will go as shown at right.
G When connecting or disconnecting pin connectors into or
from ECM, take care not to damage pin terminals (bend or
break).
Make sure that there are not any bends or breaks on ECM
pin terminal, when connecting pin connectors.
G Securely connect ECM harness connectors.
A poor connection can cause an extremely high (surge)
voltage to develop in coil and condenser, thus resulting in
damage to ICs.
G Keep engine control system harness at least 10 cm (4 in)
away from adjacent harness, to prevent engine control sys-
tem malfunctions due to receiving external noise, degraded
operation of ICs, etc.
G Keep engine control system parts and harness dry.
G Before replacing ECM, perform ECM Terminals and Refer-
ence Value inspection and make sure ECM functions prop-
erly. Refer to EC-1047 .
G Handle mass air flow sensor carefully to avoid damage.
G Do not disassemble mass air flow sensor.
G Do not clean mass air flow sensor with any type of deter-
gent.
G Do not disassemble electric throttle control actuator.
G Even a slight leak in the air intake system can cause seri-
ous problems.
G Do not shock or jar the camshaft position sensor (PHASE),
crankshaft position sensor (POS).
SEF707Y
MBIB0145E
PBIB0090E
MEF040D
EC-966
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
PRECAUTIONS
G After performing each TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS, perform
DTC Confirmation Procedure or Overall Function
Check.
The DTC should not be displayed in the DTC Confirmation
Procedure if the repair is completed. The Overall Func-
tion Check should be a good result if the repair is com-
pleted.
G When measuring ECM signals with a circuit tester, connect
a break-out box (SST) and Y-cable adapter (SST) between
the ECM and ECM harness connector.
G When measuring ECM signals with a circuit tester, never
allow the two tester probes to contact.
Accidental contact of probes will cause a short circuit and
damage the ECM power transistor.
G Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/
output voltage. Doing so may result in damage to the ECM's
transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as
the ground.
G Do not operate fuel pump when there is no fuel in lines.
G Tighten fuel hose clamps to the specified torque.
SAT652J
SEF348N
MBIB0046E
PRECAUTIONS
EC-967
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
G Do not depress accelerator pedal when starting.
G Immediately after starting, do not rev up engine unneces-
sarily.
G Do not rev up engine just prior to shutdown.
G When installing C.B. ham radio or a mobile phone, be sure
to observe the following as it may adversely affect elec-
tronic control systems depending on installation location.
Keep the antenna as far as possible from the electronic
control units.
Keep the antenna feeder line more than 20 cm (8 in) away
from the harness of electronic controls.
Do not let them run parallel for a long distance.
Adjust the antenna and feeder line so that the standing-
wave radio can be kept smaller.
Be sure to ground the radio to vehicle body.
Wiring Diagrams and Trouble Diagnosis EBS00F1A
When you read wiring diagrams, refer to the following:
G GI-14, "How to Read Wiring Diagrams"
G PG-3, "POWER SUPPLY ROUTING" for power distribution circuit
When you perform trouble diagnosis, refer to the following:
G GI-11, "HOW TO FOLLOW TEST GROUPS IN TROUBLE DIAGNOSES"
G GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident"
SEF709Y
SEF708Y
EC-968
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
PREPARATION
PREPARATION PFP:00002
Special Service Tools EBS00F1B
Commercial Service Tools EBS00F1C
Tool number
Tool name
Description
KV10117100
Heated oxygen
sensor wrench
Loosening or tightening heated oxygen sensors
with 22 mm (0.87 in) hexagon nut
KV10114400
Heated oxygen
sensor wrench
Loosening or tightening heated oxygen sensors
a: 22 mm (0.87 in)
KV109E0010
Break-out box
Measuring ECM signals with a circuit tester
KV109E0080
Y-cable adapter
Measuring ECM signals with a circuit tester
S-NT379
S-NT636
NT825
NT826
Tool name Description
Quick connector
release
Removing fuel tube quick connectors in engine
room
(Available in SEC. 164 of PARTS CATALOG:
Part No. 16441 6N210)
Fuel filler cap adapter Checking fuel tank vacuum relief valve opening
pressure
PBIC0198E
S-NT653
PREPARATION
EC-969
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Socket wrench Removing and installing engine coolant
temperature sensor
Oxygen sensor
thread cleaner
ie: (J-43897-18)
(J-43897-12)
Reconditioning the exhaust system threads
before installing a new oxygen sensor. Use with
anti-seize lubricant shown below.
a: 18 mm diameter with pitch 1.5 mm for
Zirconia Oxygen Sensor
b: 12 mm diameter with pitch 1.25 mm for
Titania Oxygen Sensor
Anti-seize lubricant
i.e.: (Permatex
TM
133AR or equivalent
meeting MIL
specification MIL-A-
907)
Lubricating oxygen sensor thread cleaning tool
when reconditioning exhaust system threads.
Tool name Description
S-NT705
AEM488
S-NT779
EC-970
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM PFP:23710
System Diagram EBS00F1D
MBIB0051E
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-971
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Vacuum Hose Drawing EBS00F1E
Refer to for Vacuum Control System.
PBIB0489E
EC-972
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
System Chart EBS00F1F
*1: This sensor is not used to control the engine system under normal conditions.
*2: These input signals are sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
*3: These output signals are sent from the ECM through CAN communication line.
Multiport Fuel Injection (MFI) System EBS00F1G
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
*1: Under normal conditions, this sensor is not for engine control operation.
*2: These signals are sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
Input (Sensor) ECM Function Output (Actuator)
G Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
G Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
G Mass air flow sensor
G Engine coolant temperature sensor
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
G Throttle position sensor
G Accelerator pedal position sensor
G Park/neutral position (PNP) switch
G Intake air temperature sensor
G Power steering pressure sensor
G Ignition switch
G Battery voltage
G Knock sensor
G Refrigerant pressure sensor
G Stop lamp switch
G ICC steering switch
G Heated oxygen sensor 2 *
1
G TCM (Transmission control module) *
2
G ESP/TCS/ABS control unit *
2
G ICC unit *
2
G Air conditioner switch *
2
G Vehicle speed signal *
2
G Electrical load signal *
2
Fuel injection & mixture ratio control Fuel injectors
Electronic ignition system Power transistor
Fuel pump control Fuel pump relay
ICC vehicle speed control Electric throttle control actuator
On board diagnostic system MI (On the instrument panel) *
3
Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater control Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater control Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
EVAP canister purge flow control
EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve
Air conditioning cut control Air conditioner relay *
3
Cooling fan control
Cooling fan relays *
3
Sensor Input Signal to ECM
ECM
function
Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed *
3
and piston position
Fuel injec-
tion & mix-
ture ratio
control
Fuel injectors
Mass air flow sensor Amount of intake air
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Heated oxygen sensor 1 Density of oxygen in exhaust gas
Throttle position sensor Throttle position
Accelerator pedal position sensor Accelerator pedal position
Park/neutral position (PNP) switch Gear position
Knock sensor Engine knocking condition
Battery
Battery voltage *
3
Power steering pressure sensor Power steering operation
Heated oxygen sensor 2 *
1
Density of oxygen in exhaust gas
Vehicle speed signal *
2
Vehicle speed
Air conditioner switch *
2
Air conditioner operation
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-973
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
*3: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The amount of fuel injected from the fuel injector is determined by the ECM. The ECM controls the length of
time the valve remains open (injection pulse duration). The amount of fuel injected is a program value in the
ECM memory. The program value is preset by engine operating conditions. These conditions are determined
by input signals (for engine speed and intake air) from both the crankshaft position sensor and the mass air
flow sensor.
VARIOUS FUEL INJECTION INCREASE/DECREASE COMPENSATION
In addition, the amount of fuel injected is compensated to improve engine performance under various operat-
ing conditions as listed below.
<Fuel increase>
G During warm-up
G When starting the engine
G During acceleration
G Hot-engine operation
G When selector lever is changed from N to D (CVT models)
G High-load, high-speed operation
<Fuel decrease>
G During deceleration
G During high engine speed operation
MIXTURE RATIO FEEDBACK CONTROL (CLOSED LOOP CONTROL)
The mixture ratio feedback system provides the best air-fuel mixture ratio for driveability and emission control.
The three way catalyst (manifold) can then better reduce CO, HC and NOx emissions. This system uses
heated oxygen sensor 1 in the exhaust manifold to monitor if the engine operation is rich or lean. The ECM
adjusts the injection pulse width according to the sensor voltage signal. For more information about heated
oxygen sensor 1, refer to EC-1119 . This maintains the mixture ratio within the range of stoichiometric (ideal
air-fuel mixture).
This stage is referred to as the closed loop control condition.
Heated oxygen sensor 2 is located downstream of the three way catalyst (manifold). Even if the switching
characteristics of heated oxygen sensor 1 shift, the air-fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric by the signal
from heated oxygen sensor 2.
Open Loop Control
The open loop system condition refers to when the ECM detects any of the following conditions. Feedback
control stops in order to maintain stabilized fuel combustion.
G Deceleration and acceleration
G High-load, high-speed operation
G Malfunction of heated oxygen sensor 1 or its circuit
G Insufficient activation of heated oxygen sensor 1 at low engine coolant temperature
G High engine coolant temperature
G During warm-up
G After shifting from N to D (CVT models)
PBIB0121E
EC-974
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
G When starting the engine
MIXTURE RATIO SELF-LEARNING CONTROL
The mixture ratio feedback control system monitors the mixture ratio signal transmitted from heated oxygen
sensor 1. This feedback signal is then sent to the ECM. The ECM controls the basic mixture ratio as close to
the theoretical mixture ratio as possible. However, the basic mixture ratio is not necessarily controlled as orig-
inally designed. Both manufacturing differences (i.e., mass air flow sensor hot film) and characteristic changes
during operation (i.e., injector clogging) directly affect mixture ratio.
Accordingly, the difference between the basic and theoretical mixture ratios is monitored in this system. This is
then computed in terms of injection pulse duration to automatically compensate for the difference between
the two ratios.
Fuel trim refers to the feedback compensation value compared against the basic injection duration. Fuel trim
includes short term fuel trim and long term fuel trim.
Short term fuel trim is the short-term fuel compensation used to maintain the mixture ratio at its theoretical
value. The signal from heated oxygen sensor 1 indicates whether the mixture ratio is RICH or LEAN compared
to the theoretical value. The signal then triggers a reduction in fuel volume if the mixture ratio is rich, and an
increase in fuel volume if it is lean.
Long term fuel trim is overall fuel compensation carried out long-term to compensate for continual deviation
of the short term fuel trim from the central value. Such deviation will occur due to individual engine differences,
wear over time and changes in the usage environment.
FUEL INJECTION TIMING
Two types of systems are used.
Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection System
Fuel is injected into each cylinder during each engine cycle according to the firing order. This system is used
when the engine is running.
Simultaneous Multiport Fuel Injection System
Fuel is injected simultaneously into all four cylinders twice each engine cycle. In other words, pulse signals of
the same width are simultaneously transmitted from the ECM.
The four injectors will then receive the signals two times for each engine cycle.
This system is used when the engine is being started and/or if the fail-safe system (CPU) is operating.
FUEL SHUT-OFF
Fuel to each cylinder is cut off during deceleration or operation of the engine at excessively high speeds.
SEF337W
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-975
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Electronic Ignition (EI) System EBS00F1H
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
*1: This signal is sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
*2: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ignition timing is controlled by the ECM to maintain the best air-
fuel ratio for every running condition of the engine. The ignition tim-
ing data is stored in the ECM. This data forms the map shown.
The ECM receives information such as the injection pulse width and
camshaft position sensor signal. Computing this information, ignition
signals are transmitted to the power transistor.
e.g., N: 1,800 rpm, Tp: 1.50 msec
A BTDC
During the following conditions, the ignition timing is revised by the
ECM according to the other data stored in the ECM.
G At starting
G During warm-up
G At idle
G At low battery voltage
G During acceleration
The knock sensor retard system is designed only for emergencies. The basic ignition timing is programmed
within the anti-knocking zone, if recommended fuel is used under dry conditions. The retard system does not
operate under normal driving conditions. If engine knocking occurs, the knock sensor monitors the condition.
The signal is transmitted to the ECM. The ECM retards the ignition timing to eliminate the knocking condition.
Air Conditioning Cut Control EBS00F1I
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
*1: These signals are sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
*2: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM
ECM func-
tion
Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed *
2
and piston position
Ignition
timing con-
trol
Power transistor
Mass air flow sensor Amount of intake air
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Throttle position sensor Throttle position
Accelerator pedal position sensor Accelerator pedal position
Knock sensor Engine knocking
Park/neutral position (PNP) switch Gear position
Battery Battery voltage *
2
Vehicle speed signal *
1
Vehicle speed
SEF742M
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Air conditioner switch *
1
Air conditioner ON signal
Air conditioner
cut control
Air conditioner relay
Throttle position sensor Throttle valve opening angle
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed *
2
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Refrigerant pressure sensor Refrigerant pressure
Power steering pressure sensor Power steering operation
Vehicle speed signal *
1
Vehicle speed
EC-976
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
This system improves engine operation when the air conditioner is used.
Under the following conditions, the air conditioner is turned off.
G When the accelerator pedal is fully depressed.
G When cranking the engine.
G At high engine speeds.
G When the engine coolant temperature becomes excessively high.
G When operating power steering during low engine speed or low vehicle speed.
G When engine speed is excessively low.
G When refrigerant pressure is excessively low or high.
Fuel Cut Control (at No Load and High Engine Speed) EBS00F1J
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
*1: This signal is sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
If the engine speed is above 1,800 rpm with no load (for example, in neutral and engine speed over 1,800
rpm) fuel will be cut off after some time. The exact time when the fuel is cut off varies based on engine speed.
Fuel cut will operate until the engine speed reaches 1,500 rpm, then fuel cut is cancelled.
NOTE:
This function is different from deceleration control listed under Multiport Fuel Injection (MFI) System, EC-972
.
CAN communication EBS00F1K
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real time application. It is an on-vehicle mul-
tiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent error detection ability. Many elec-
tronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links with other
control units during operation (not independent). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2
communication lines (CAN H line, CAN L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission with less wiring.
Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM
ECM func-
tion
Actuator
Park/neutral position (PNP) switch Neutral position
Fuel cut
control
Fuel injectors
Throttle position sensor Throttle position
Accelerator pedal position sensor Accelerator pedal position
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
Vehicle speed signal*
1
Vehicle speed
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-977
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
CAN COMMUNICATION UNIT FOR LHD MODELS WITH TYRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYS-
TEM
CVT Models with ESP and ICC
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
SKIA1519E
Signals ECM TCM
ESP/
TCS /
ABS
control
unit
Steer-
ing
angle
sensor
Smart
entranc
e con-
trol unit
Tyre
pres-
sure
moni-
toring
control
unit
ICC
unit
ICC
sensor
Combi-
nation
meter
Engine speed signal T R R R R
Accelerator pedal position signal T R R R
Closed throttle position signal T R
ICC steering switch signal T R
Shift pattern signal T R
Parking brake switch signal T R
ICC system display signal T R
ICC sensor signal R T
ESP operation signal R T R
TCS operation signal R T R
ABS operation signal R R T R
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Steering wheel angle sensor signal R T
Wheel speed sensor signal T R
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
Primary pulley revolution signal R T R
Secondary pulley revolution signal R T R
ICC operation signal R T
Brake switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R R
Fuel consumption signal T R
EC-978
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
CVT Models with ESP without ICC
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
Signals ECM TCM
ESP/
TCS /
ABS
control
unit
Steer-
ing
angle
sensor
Smart
entranc
e con-
trol unit
Tyre
pres-
sure
moni-
toring
control
unit
ICC
unit
ICC
sensor
Combi-
nation
meter
Signals ECM TCM
ESP/ TCS
/ ABS con-
trol unit
Steering
angle sen-
sor
Smart
entrance
control
unit
Tyre pres-
sure moni-
toring
control
unit
Combina-
tion meter
Engine speed signal T R R R
Accelerator pedal position signal T R R
ESP operation signal R T
TCS operation signal R T
ABS operation signal R R T
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Steering wheel angle sensor signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
Primary pulley revolution signal R T
Secondary pulley revolution signal R T
SKIA1520E
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-979
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
CVT Models without ESP and ICC
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
Signals ECM TCM
ESP/ TCS
/ ABS con-
trol unit
Steering
angle sen-
sor
Smart
entrance
control
unit
Tyre pres-
sure moni-
toring
control
unit
Combina-
tion meter
SKIA1521E
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actua-
tor and elec-
tric unit
(control unit)
Smart
entrance
control unit
Tyre pres-
sure moni-
toring
control unit
Combina-
tion meter
Engine speed signal T R R
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
Primary pulley revolution signal R T
Secondary pulley revolution signal R T
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
EC-980
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
M/T Models with ESP
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actua-
tor and elec-
tric unit
(control unit)
Smart
entrance
control unit
Tyre pres-
sure moni-
toring
control unit
Combina-
tion meter
SKIA1524E
Signals ECM
ESP/ TCS /
ABS control
unit
Steering
angle sen-
sor
Smart
entrance
control unit
Tyre pres-
sure moni-
toring
control unit
Combina-
tion meter
Engine speed signal T R R
Accelerator pedal position signal T R
ESP operation signal R T
TCS operation signal R T
ABS operation signal R T
Steering wheel angle sensor signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-981
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
M/T Models without ESP
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
Signals ECM
ESP/ TCS /
ABS control
unit
Steering
angle sen-
sor
Smart
entrance
control unit
Tyre pres-
sure moni-
toring
control unit
Combina-
tion meter
Signals ECM
ABS actuator
and electric
unit (control
unit)
Smart
entrance con-
trol unit
Tyre pres-
sure monitor-
ing control
unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
SKIA1525E
EC-982
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
CAN COMMUNICATION UNIT FOR LHD MODELS WITHOUT TYRE PRESSURE MONITORING
SYSTEM
CVT Models with ESP and ICC
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
Signals ECM
ABS actuator
and electric
unit (control
unit)
Smart
entrance con-
trol unit
Tyre pres-
sure monitor-
ing control
unit
Combination
meter
SKIA1526E
Signals ECM TCM
ESP/
TCS /
ABS con-
trol unit
Steering
angle
sensor
Smart
entrance
control
unit
ICC unit
ICC sen-
sor
Combina-
tion
meter
Engine speed signal T R R R R
Accelerator pedal position signal T R R R
Closed throttle position signal T R
ICC steering switch signal T R
Shift pattern signal T R
Parking brake switch signal T R
ICC system display signal T R
ICC sensor signal R T
ESP operation signal R T R
TCS operation signal R T R
ABS operation signal R R T R
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Steering wheel angle sensor signal R T
Wheel speed sensor signal T R
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
Primary pulley revolution signal R T R
Secondary pulley revolution signal R T R
ICC operation signal R T
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-983
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
CVT Models with ESP without ICC
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
Brake switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Signals ECM TCM
ESP/
TCS /
ABS con-
trol unit
Steering
angle
sensor
Smart
entrance
control
unit
ICC unit
ICC sen-
sor
Combina-
tion
meter
SKIA1527E
Signals ECM TCM
ESP/ TCS /
ABS control
unit
Steering
angle sensor
Smart
entrance
control unit
Combina-
tion meter
Engine speed signal T R R R
Accelerator pedal position signal T R R
ESP operation signal R T
TCS operation signal R T
ABS operation signal R R T
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Steering wheel angle sensor signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
Primary pulley revolution signal R T
EC-984
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
CVT Models without ESP and ICC
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
Secondary pulley revolution signal R T
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Signals ECM TCM
ESP/ TCS /
ABS control
unit
Steering
angle sensor
Smart
entrance
control unit
Combina-
tion meter
SKIA1528E
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actuator
and electric
unit (control
unit)
Smart
entrance con-
trol unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R R
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
Primary pulley revolution signal R T
Secondary pulley revolution signal R T
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-985
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
M/T Models with ESP
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actuator
and electric
unit (control
unit)
Smart
entrance con-
trol unit
Combination
meter
SKIA1531E
Signals ECM
ESP/ TCS /
ABS control
unit
Steering angle
sensor
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R R
Accelerator pedal position signal T R
ESP operation signal R T
TCS operation signal R T
ABS operation signal R T
Steering wheel angle sensor signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
EC-986
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
M/T Models without ESP
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Signals ECM
ESP/ TCS /
ABS control
unit
Steering angle
sensor
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
SKIA1532E
Signals ECM
ABS actuator and
electric unit (con-
trol unit)
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-987
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
CAN COMMUNICATION UNIT FOR RHD MODELS WITH TYRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYS-
TEM
CVT Models with ESP and ICC
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
Signals ECM TCM
ICC
sensor
ESP/
TCS /
ABS
control
unit
Tyre
pres-
sure
monitor-
ing con-
trol unit
Steer-
ing
angle
sensor
ICC unit
Smart
entranc
e con-
trol unit
Combi-
nation
meter
Engine speed signal T R R R R
Accelerator pedal position signal T R R R
Closed throttle position signal T R
ICC steering switch signal T R
Shift pattern signal T R
Parking brake switch signal T R
ICC system display signal T
ICC sensor signal T R
ESP operation signal R T R
TCS operation signal R T R
ABS operation signal R R T R
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Steering wheel angle sensor signal R T
Wheel speed sensor signal T R
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
Primary pulley revolution signal R T R
Secondary pulley revolution signal R T R
ICC operation signal R T
Brake switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
SKIA1533E
EC-988
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
CVT Models with ESP without ICC
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
Signals ECM TCM
ICC
sensor
ESP/
TCS /
ABS
control
unit
Tyre
pres-
sure
monitor-
ing con-
trol unit
Steer-
ing
angle
sensor
ICC unit
Smart
entranc
e con-
trol unit
Combi-
nation
meter
SKIA1534E
Signals ECM TCM
ESP/
TCS /
ABS con-
trol unit
Tyre
pressure
monitor-
ing con-
trol unit
Steering
angle
sensor
Smart
entrance
control
unit
Combi-
nation
meter
Engine speed signal T R R R
Accelerator pedal position signal T R R
ESP operation signal R T
TCS operation signal R T
ABS operation signal R R T
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Steering wheel angle sensor signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
Primary pulley revolution signal R T
Secondary pulley revolution signal R T
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-989
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
CVT Models without ESP and ICC
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
Engine coolant temperature T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
Signals ECM TCM
ESP/
TCS /
ABS con-
trol unit
Tyre
pressure
monitor-
ing con-
trol unit
Steering
angle
sensor
Smart
entrance
control
unit
Combi-
nation
meter
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actua-
tor and
electricunit
(control
unit)
Tyre pres-
sure moni-
toring
control unit
Smart
entrance
control unit
Combina-
tion meter
Engine speed signal T R R
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
Primary pulley revolution signal R T
Secondary pulley revolution signal R T
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
SKIA1535E
EC-990
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
M/T Models with ESP
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actua-
tor and
electricunit
(control
unit)
Tyre pres-
sure moni-
toring
control unit
Smart
entrance
control unit
Combina-
tion meter
Signals ECM
ESP/ TCS
/ ABS con-
trol unit
Tyre pres-
sure moni-
toring
control unit
Steering
angle sen-
sor
Smart
entrance
control unit
Combina-
tion meter
Engine speed signal T R R
Accelerator pedal position signal T R
ESP operation signal R T
TCS operation signal R T
ABS operation signal R T
Steering wheel angle sensor signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
SKIA1538E
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-991
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
M/T Models without ESP
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
Signals ECM
ESP/ TCS
/ ABS con-
trol unit
Tyre pres-
sure moni-
toring
control unit
Steering
angle sen-
sor
Smart
entrance
control unit
Combina-
tion meter
Signals ECM
ABS actua-
tor and elec-
tric unit
(control unit)
Tyre pres-
sure monitor-
ing control
unit
Smart
entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
SKIA1539E
EC-992
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
CAN COMMUNICATION UNIT FOR RHD MODELS WITHOUT TYRE PRESSURE MONITORING
SYSTEM
CVT Models with ESP and ICC
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
Signals ECM
ABS actua-
tor and elec-
tric unit
(control unit)
Tyre pres-
sure monitor-
ing control
unit
Smart
entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Signals ECM TCM
ICC sen-
sor
ESP/
TCS /
ABS
control
unit
Steering
angle
sensor
ICC unit
Smart
entrance
control
unit
Combi-
nation
meter
Engine speed signal T R R R R
Accelerator pedal position signal T R R R
Closed throttle position signal T R
ICC steering switch signal T R
Shift pattern signal T R
Parking brake switch signal T R
ICC system display signal T R
ICC sensor signal T R
ESP operation signal R T R
TCS operation signal R T R
ABS operation signal R R T R
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Steering wheel angle sensor signal R T
Wheel speed sensor signal T R
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
Primary pulley revolution signal R T R
Secondary pulley revolution signal R T R
ICC operation signal R T
SKIA1540E
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-993
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
CVT Models with ESP without ICC
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
Brake switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Signals ECM TCM
ICC sen-
sor
ESP/
TCS /
ABS
control
unit
Steering
angle
sensor
ICC unit
Smart
entrance
control
unit
Combi-
nation
meter
Signals ECM TCM
ESP/ TCS
/ ABS
control
unit
Steering
angle sen-
sor
Smart
entrance
control
unit
Combina-
tion meter
Engine speed signal T R R R
Accelerator pedal position signal T R R
ESP operation signal R T
TCS operation signal R T
ABS operation signal R R T
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Steering wheel angle sensor signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
SKIA1541E
EC-994
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
CVT Models without ESP and ICC
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
Primary pulley revolution signal R T
Secondary pulley revolution signal R T
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Signals ECM TCM
ESP/ TCS
/ ABS
control
unit
Steering
angle sen-
sor
Smart
entrance
control
unit
Combina-
tion meter
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actuator
and electric unit
(control unit)
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R R
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
Primary pulley revolution signal R T
Secondary pulley revolution signal R T
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
SKIA1542E
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-995
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
M/T Models with ESP
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actuator
and electric unit
(control unit)
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
SKIA1545E
Signals ECM
ESP/ TCS /
ABS control
unit
Steering
angle sensor
Smart
entrance
control unit
Combina-
tion meter
Engine speed signal T R R
Accelerator pedal position signal T R
ESP operation signal R T
TCS operation signal R T
ABS operation signal R T
Steering wheel angle sensor signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
EC-996
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
M/T Models without ESP
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Signals ECM
ESP/ TCS /
ABS control
unit
Steering
angle sensor
Smart
entrance
control unit
Combina-
tion meter
SKIA1546E
Signals ECM
ABS actuator and
electric unit (con-
trol unit)
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
EC-997
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE PFP:00018
Idle Speed and Ignition Timing Check EBS00F1L
IDLE SPEED
With CONSULT-II
Check idle speed in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
With GST
Check idle speed in "MODE 1" with GST.
IGNITION TIMING
Any of following two methods may be used.
Method A
1. Slide the harness protector of ignition coil No.1 to clear the
wires.
2. Attach timing light to the wires as shown in the figure.
3. Check ignition timing.
Method B
1. Remove No. 1 ignition coil.
SEF058Y
MBIB0065E
MBIB0132E
EC-998
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
2. Connect No. 1 ignition coil and No. 1 spark plug with suitable
high-tension wire as shown, and attach timing light clamp to this
wire.
3. Check ignition timing.
Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning EBS00F1N
DESCRIPTION
Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning is an operation to learn the fully released position of the accel-
erator pedal by monitoring the accelerator pedal position sensor output signal. It must be performed each time
harness connector of accelerator pedal position sensor or ECM is disconnected.
OPERATION PROCEDURE
1. Make sure that accelerator pedal is fully released.
2. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF wait at least 10 seconds.
Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning EBS00F1O
DESCRIPTION
Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning is an operation to learn the fully closed position of the throttle valve
by monitoring the throttle position sensor output signal. It must be performed each time harness connector of
electric throttle control actuator or ECM is disconnected.
OPERATION PROCEDURE
1. Make sure that accelerator pedal is fully released.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
MBIB0066E
SEF166Y
MBIB0067E
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
EC-999
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
Make sure that throttle valve moves during above 10 seconds by confirming the operating sound.
Idle Air Volume Learning EBS00F1P
DESCRIPTION
Idle Air Volume Learning is an operation to learn the idle air volume that keeps each engine within the spe-
cific range. It must be performed under any of the following conditions:
G Each time electric throttle control actuator or ECM is replaced.
G Idle speed or ignition timing is out of specification.
PREPARATION
Before performing Idle Air Volume Learning, make sure that all of the following conditions are satisfied.
Learning will be cancelled if any of the following conditions are missed for even a moment.
G Battery voltage: More than 12.9V (At idle)
G Engine coolant temperature: 70 - 95C (158 - 203F)
G PNP switch: ON
G Electric load switch: OFF
(Air conditioner, headlamp, rear window defogger)
On vehicles equipped with daytime light systems, set lighting switch to the 1st position to light
only small lamps.
G Steering wheel: Neutral (Straight-ahead position)
G Vehicle speed: Stopped
G Transmission: Warmed-up
For CVT models with CONSULT-II, drive vehicle until FLUID TEMP SE in DATA MONITOR mode of
CVT system indicates less than 0.9V.
For CVT models without CONSULT-II and M/T models, drive vehicle for 10 minutes.
OPERATION PROCEDURE
With CONSULT-II
1. Perform EC-998, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
2. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
4. Check that all items listed under the topic PRE-CONDITIONING (previously mentioned) are in good
order.
5. Select IDLE AIR VOL LEARN in WORK SUPPORT mode.
SEF217Z
EC-1000
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
6. Touch START and wait 20 seconds.
7. Make sure that CMPLT is displayed on CONSULT-II screen. If
INCMP is displayed, Idle Air Volume Learning will not be car-
ried out successfully. In this case, find the cause of the problem
by referring to the Diagnostic Procedure below.
8. Rev up the engine two or three times and make sure that idle
speed and ignition timing are within the specifications.
Without CONSULT-II
NOTE:
G It is better to count the time accurately with a clock.
G It is impossible to switch the diagnostic mode when an accelerator pedal position sensor circuit
has a malfunction.
1. Perform EC-998, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
2. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
4. Check that all items listed under the topic PRE-CONDITIONING (previously mentioned) are in good
order.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
6. Confirm that accelerator pedal is fully released, turn ignition switch ON and wait 3 seconds.
7. Repeat the following procedure quickly five times within 5 seconds.
a. Fully depress the accelerator pedal.
b. Fully release the accelerator pedal.
8. Wait 7 seconds, fully depress the accelerator pedal and keep it for approx. 20 seconds until the MI stops
blinking and turned ON.
9. Fully release the accelerator pedal within 3 seconds after the MI goes off.
10. Start engine and let it idle.
SEF454Y
ITEM SPECIFICATION
Idle speed M/T: 60050 rpm
CVT: 65050 rpm (in P or N position)
Ignition timing M/T: 145 BTDC
CVT: 155 BTDC (in P or N position)
SEF455Y
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
EC-1001
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
11. Wait 20 seconds.
12. Rev up the engine two or three times and make sure that idle speed and ignition timing are within the
specifications.
13. If idle speed and ignition timing are not within the specification, the result will be incomplete. In this case,
find the cause of the problem by referring to the Diagnostic Procedure below.
DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
If idle air volume learning cannot be performed successfully, proceed as follows:
1. Check that throttle valve is fully closed.
2. Check PCV valve operation.
3. Check that downstream of throttle valve is free from air leakage.
4. When the above three items check out OK, engine component parts and their installation condi-
tion are questionable. Check and eliminate the cause of the problem.
It is useful to perform EC-1072, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE" .
5. If any of the following conditions occur after the engine has started, eliminate the cause of the
problem and perform Idle air volume learning all over again:
G Engine stalls.
G Erroneous idle.
Fuel Pressure Check EBS00F1Q
FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE
Before disconnecting fuel line, release fuel pressure from fuel line to eliminate danger.
NOTE:
Prepare pans or saucers under the disconnected fuel line because the fuel may spill out. The fuel pres-
sure cannot be completely released because QR engine models do not have fuel return system.
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Perform FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE in WORK SUPPORT
mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine.
4. After engine stalls, crank it two or three times to release all fuel
pressure.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF.
ITEM SPECIFICATION
Idle speed M/T: 60050 rpm
CVT: 65050 rpm (in P or N position)
Ignition timing M/T: 145 BTDC
CVT: 155 BTDC (in P or N position)
PBIB0665E
SEF214Y
EC-1002
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
Without CONSULT-II
1. Remove fuel pump fuse located in fuse box.
2. Start engine.
3. After engine stalls, crank it two or three times to release all fuel
pressure.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF.
5. Reinstall fuel pump fuse after servicing fuel system.
FUEL PRESSURE CHECK
CAUTION:
G The fuel hose connection method used when taking fuel pressure check must not be used for
other purposes.
G Be careful not to scratch or put debris around connection area when servicing, so that the quick
connector maintains sealability with O-rings inside.
G When installing fuel hose quick connetor, refer to EM-116, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
1. Release fuel pressure to zero. Refer to EC-1001, "FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE" .
2. Prepare fuel hose and fuel hose clamp for fuel pressure check, and connect fuel pressure gauge.
G Use suitable fuel hose for fuel pressure check (genuine NISSAN fuel hose without quick connector).
G To avoid unnecessary force or tension to hose, use moderately long fuel hose for fuel pressure check.
G Do not use the fuel hose for checking fuel pressure with damage or cracks on it.
G Use Pressure Gauge to check fuel pressure.
3. Remove fuel hose. Refer to EM-116, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
G Do not twist or kink fuel hose because it is plastic hose.
G Do not remove fuel hose from quick connector.
G Keep the original fuel hose to be free from intrusion of dust or foreign substances with a suitable cover.
4. Install the fuel pressure gauge as shown in the figure.
G Wipe off oil or dirt from hose insertion part using cloth moist-
ened with gasoline.
G Apply proper amount of gasoline between top of the fuel tube
and No.1 spool.
G Insert fuel hose for fuel pressure check until it touches the
No.1 spool on fuel tube.
G Use NISSAN genuine hose clamp (part number: 16439
N4710 or 16439 40U00).
G When reconnecting fuel line, always use new clamps.
G When reconnecting fuel hose, check the original fuel hose for
damage and abnormality.
G Use a torque driver to tighten clamps.
G Install hose clamp to the position within 1 - 2 mm (0.04 - 0.08
in).
G Make sure that clamp screw does not contact adjacent parts.
5. After connecting fuel hose for fuel pressure check, pull the hose
with a force of approximately 98 N (10 kg, 22 lb) to confirm fuel
tube does not come off.
6. Turn ignition switch "ON", and check for fuel leakage.
MBIB0141E
Tightening torque:
1 - 1.5 Nm (0.1 - 0.15 kg-m, 9 - 13 in-lb)
PBIB0669E
MBIB0068E
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
EC-1003
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
7. Start engine and check for fuel leakage.
8. Read the indication of fuel pressure gauge.
G Do not perform fuel pressure check with system operating. Fuel pressure gauge may indicate false
readings.
G During fuel pressure check, confirm for fuel leakage from fuel connection every 3 minutes.
9. If result is unsatisfactory, go to next step.
10. Check the following.
G Fuel hoses and fuel tubes for clogging
G Fuel filter for clogging
G Fuel pump
G Fuel pressure regulator for clogging
If OK, replace fuel pressure regulator.
If NG, repair or replace.
At idling: Approximately 350 kPa (3.5 bar, 3.7 kg/cm
2
, 51 psi)
EC-1004
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM PFP:00028
Introduction EBS00F1R
The ECM has an on board diagnostic system, which detects malfunctions related to engine sensors or actua-
tors. The ECM also records various emission-related diagnostic information including:
The above information can be checked using procedures listed in the table below.
: Applicable : Not applicable
*1: 1st trip DTCs for self-diagnoses concerning SRT items cannot be shown on the GST display.
*2: When DTC and 1st trip DTC simultaneously appear on the display, they cannot be clearly distinguished from each other.
The malfunction indicator (MI) on the instrument panel lights up when the same malfunction is detected in two
consecutive trips (Two trip detection logic), or when the ECM enters fail-safe mode. (Refer to EC-1030 .)
Two Trip Detection Logic EBS00F1S
When a malfunction is detected for the first time, 1st trip DTC and 1st trip Freeze Frame data are stored in the
ECM memory. The MI will not light up at this stage. <1st trip>
If the same malfunction is detected again during the next drive, the DTC and Freeze Frame data are stored in
the ECM memory, and the MI lights up. The MI lights up at the same time when the DTC is stored. <2nd trip>
The trip in the Two Trip Detection Logic means a driving mode in which self-diagnosis is performed during
vehicle operation. Specific on board diagnostic items will cause the ECM to light up or blink the MI, and store
DTC and Freeze Frame data, even in the 1st trip, as shown below.
: Applicable : Not applicable
*1: Except ECM
Emission-related diagnostic information ISO Standard
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Mode 3 of ISO 15031-5
Freeze Frame data Mode 2 of ISO 15031-5
System Readiness Test (SRT) code Mode 1 of ISO 15031-5
1st Trip Diagnostic Trouble Code (1st Trip DTC) Mode 7 of ISO 15031-5
1st Trip Freeze Frame data
Test values and Test limits Mode 6 of ISO 15031-5
Calibration ID Mode 9 of ISO 15031-5
DTC 1st trip DTC
Freeze Frame
data
1st trip Freeze
Frame data
SRT code Test value
CONSULT-II
GST
*
1

ECM
*
2

Items
MI DTC 1st trip DTC
1st trip 2nd trip
1st trip
displaying
2nd trip
displaying
1st trip
displaying
2nd trip
display-
ing
Blinking
Lighting
up
Blinking
Lighting
up
Misfire (Possible three way cata-
lyst damage) DTC: P0300 -
P0304 is being detected

Misfire (Possible three way cata-
lyst damage) DTC: P0300 -
P0304 is being detected

Fail-safe items (Refer to EC-1030
.)
*
1
*
1

Except above
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-1005
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Emission-related Diagnostic Information EBS00F1T
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION ITEMS
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC*
1
SRT code
Test Valve/
Test Limit
(GST only)
1st trip DTC Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM*
3
CAN COMM CIRCUIT U1000
1000*
6
EC-1083
CAN COMM CIRCUIT U1001
1001*
6
EC-1083
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.
P0000 0000
INT/V TIM CONT-B1 P0011 0011 EC-1087
HO2S1 HTR (B1) P0031 0031
*
5
EC-1090
HO2S1 HTR (B1) P0032 0032
*
5
EC-1090
HO2S2 HTR (B1) P0037 0037
*
5
EC-1095
HO2S2 HTR (B1) P0038 0038
*
5
EC-1095
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT*
4
P0102 0102 EC-1100
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT*
4
P0103 0103 EC-1100
IAT SEN/CIRCUIT P0112 0112 EC-1106
IAT SEN/CIRCUIT P0113 0113 EC-1106
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT*
4
P0117 0117 EC-1111
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT*
4
P0118 0118 EC-1111
IAT SENSOR P0127 0127 EC-1116
HO2S1 (B1) P0132 0132
*
5
EC-1119
HO2S1 (B1) P0133 0133
*
5
EC-1125
HO2S1 (B1) P0134 0134
*
5
EC-1135
HO2S2 (B1) P0138 0138 *
5
EC-1142
HO2S2 (B1) P0139 0139 *
5
EC-1149
FUEL SYS-LEAN-B1 P0171 0171 EC-1157
FUEL SYS-RICH-B1 P0172 0172 EC-1163
TP SENSOR*
4
P0221 0221 EC-1169
TP SEN 1/CIRC*
4
P0222 0222 EC-1175
TP SEN 1/CIRC*
4
P0223 0223 EC-1175
APP SENSOR*
4
P0226 0226 EC-1181
APP SEN 1/CIRC*
4
P0227 0227 EC-1188
APP SEN 1/CIRC*
4
P0228 0228 EC-1188
MULTI CYL MISFIRE P0300 0300 EC-1195
CYL 1 MISFIRE P0301 0301 EC-1195
CYL 2 MISFIRE P0302 0302 EC-1195
CYL 3 MISFIRE P0303 0303 EC-1195
CYL 4 MISFIRE P0304 0304 EC-1195
KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 P0327 0327 EC-1201
KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 P0328 0328 EC-1201
CKP SEN/CIRCUIT P0335 0335 EC-1205
EC-1006
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
CMP SEN/CIRC-B1 P0340 0340 EC-1212
TW CATALYST SYS-B1 P0420 0420
*
5
EC-1218
PURG VOLUME CONT/V P0444 0444 EC-1222
PURG VOLUME CONT/V P0445 0445 EC-1222
VEH SPEED SEN/CIRC P0500 0500 EC-1228
PW ST P SEN/CIRC P0550 0550 EC-1230
ECM P0605 0605 EC-1235
IN PY SPD SEN/CIRC P0715 0715 CVT-78
TCC SOLENOID/CIRC P0740 0740 CVT-89
L/PRESS SOL/CIRC P0745 0745 CVT-94
ECM BACK UP/CIRC P1065 1065 EC-1238
INT/V TIM V/CIR-B1 P1111 1111 EC-1242
ETC ACTR*
4
P1121 1121 EC-1246
ETC FUNCTION/CIRC*
4
P1122 1122 EC-1248
ETC MOT PWR*
4
P1124 1124 EC-1255
ETC MOT PWR*
4
P1126 1126 EC-1255
ETC MOT*
4
P1128 1128 EC-1261
HO2S1 (B1) P1143 1143 *
5
EC-1266
HO2S1 (B1) P1144 1144 *
5
EC-1272
HO2S2 (B1) P1146 1146 *
5
EC-1278
HO2S2 (B1) P1147 1147
*
5
EC-1286
TCS/CIRC*
8
P1212 1212 EC-1294
ENG OVER TEMP P1217 1217 EC-1295
TP SEN 2/CIRC*
4
P1223 1223 EC-1312
TP SEN 2/CIRC*
4
P1224 1224 EC-1312
CTP LEARNING P1225 1225 EC-1318
CTP LEARNING P1226 1226 EC-1320
APP SEN 2/CIRC*
4
P1227 1227 EC-1322
APP SEN 2/CIRC*
4
P1228 1228 EC-1322
SENSOR POWER/CIRC*
4
P1229 1229 EC-1329
ASCD SW*
7
P1564 1564 EC-1333
ACC COMMAND VALUE*
7
P1568 1568 EC-1340
ASCD BRAKE SW*
7
P1572 1572 EC-1341
ASCD VHL SPD SEN*
7
P1574 1574 EC-1351
NATS MALFUNCTION
P1610 -
P1615
1610 - 1615 EC-1016
P-N POS SW/CIRCUIT P1706 1706 EC-1353
IN PULY SPEED P1715 1715
OUT PULY SPEED P1720 1720 EC-1358
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC*
1
SRT code
Test Valve/
Test Limit
(GST only)
1st trip DTC Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM*
3
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-1007
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
*1: 1st trip DTC No. is the same as DTC No.
*2: These numbers are prescribed by ISO 15031-5.
*3: In Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results), these numbers are controlled by NISSAN.
*4: When the fail-safe operation occurs, the MI illuminates.
*5: These are not displayed with GST.
*6: The troubleshooting for these DTCs needs CONSULT-II.
*7: For models with ICC system.
*8: For models with ESP system.
DTC AND 1ST TRIP DTC
The 1st trip DTC (whose number is the same as the DTC number) is displayed for the latest self-diagnostic
result obtained. If the ECM memory was cleared previously, and the 1st trip DTC did not reoccur, the 1st trip
DTC will not be displayed.
If a malfunction is detected during the 1st trip, the 1st trip DTC is stored in the ECM memory. The MI will not
light up (two trip detection logic). If the same malfunction is not detected in the 2nd trip (meeting the required
driving pattern), the 1st trip DTC is cleared from the ECM memory. If the same malfunction is detected in the
2nd trip, both the 1st trip DTC and DTC are stored in the ECM memory and the MI lights up. In other words,
the DTC is stored in the ECM memory and the MI lights up when the same malfunction occurs in two consec-
utive trips. If a 1st trip DTC is stored and a non-diagnostic operation is performed between the 1st and 2nd
trips, only the 1st trip DTC will continue to be stored. For malfunctions that blink or light up the MI during the
1st trip, the DTC and 1st trip DTC are stored in the ECM memory.
Procedures for clearing the DTC and the 1st trip DTC from the ECM memory are described in EC-1015, "HOW
TO ERASE EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
For malfunctions in which 1st trip DTCs are displayed, refer to EC-1005 . These items are required by legal
regulations to continuously monitor the system/component. In addition, the items monitored non-continuously
are also displayed on CONSULT-II.
1st trip DTC is specified in Mode 7 of ISO 15031-5. 1st trip DTC detection occurs without lighting up the MI
and therefore does not warn the driver of a problem. However, 1st trip DTC detection will not prevent the vehi-
cle from being tested, for example during Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) tests.
When a 1st trip DTC is detected, check, print out or write down and erase (1st trip) DTC and Freeze Frame
data as specified in Work Flow procedure Step II, refer to EC-1026 . Then perform DTC Confirmation Proce-
dure or Overall Function Check to try to duplicate the problem. If the malfunction is duplicated, the item
requires repair.
How to Read DTC and 1st Trip DTC
DTC and 1st trip DTC can be read by the following methods.
With CONSULT-II
With GST
CONSULT-II or GST (Generic Scan Tool) Examples: P0340, P0740, P0745, etc.
These DTCs are prescribed by ISO 15031-5.
(CONSULT-II also displays the malfunctioning component or system.)
No Tools
The number of blinks of the MI in the Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-Diagnostic Results) indicates the DTC.
Example: 0102, 0340 etc.
These DTCs are controlled by NISSAN.
G 1st trip DTC No. is the same as DTC No.
G Output of a DTC indicates a malfunction. However, GST or the Diagnostic Test Mode II do not indi-
cate whether the malfunction is still occurring or has occurred in the past and has returned to nor-
mal. CONSULT-II can identify malfunction status as shown below. Therefore, using CONSULT-II (if
available) is recommended.
STEP MOTR CIRC P1777 1777 CVT-108
STEP MOTR FNC P1778 1778 CVT-111
LINE PRESS SEN P1791 1791 CVT-113
BRAKE SW/CIRCUIT P1805 1805 EC-1360
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC*
1
SRT code
Test Valve/
Test Limit
(GST only)
1st trip DTC Reference page
CONSULT-II
GST*
2
ECM*
3
EC-1008
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
A sample of CONSULT-II display for DTC and 1st trip DTC is shown below. DTC or 1st trip DTC of a malfunc-
tion is displayed in SELF-DIAGNOSTIC RESULTS mode of CONSULT-II. Time data indicates how many times
the vehicle was driven after the last detection of a DTC.
If the DTC is being detected currently, the time data will be 0.
If a 1st trip DTC is stored in the ECM, the time data will be [1t].
FREEZE FRAME DATA AND 1ST TRIP FREEZE FRAME DATA
The ECM records the driving conditions such as fuel system status, calculated load value, engine coolant tem-
perature, short term fuel trim, long term fuel trim, engine speed, vehicle speed, base fuel schedule and intake
air temperature at the moment a malfunction is detected.
Data which are stored in the ECM memory, along with the 1st trip DTC, are called 1st trip freeze frame data.
The data, stored together with the DTC data, are called freeze frame data and displayed on CONSULT-II or
GST. The 1st trip freeze frame data can only be displayed on the CONSULT-II screen, not on the GST. For
details, see EC-1058 .
Only one set of freeze frame data (either 1st trip freeze frame data or freeze frame data) can be stored in the
ECM. 1st trip freeze frame data is stored in the ECM memory along with the 1st trip DTC. There is no priority
for 1st trip freeze frame data and it is updated each time a different 1st trip DTC is detected. However, once
freeze frame data (2nd trip detection/MI on) is stored in the ECM memory, 1st trip freeze frame data is no
longer stored. Remember, only one set of freeze frame data can be stored in the ECM. The ECM has the fol-
lowing priorities to update the data.
For example, the EGR malfunction (Priority: 2) was detected and the freeze frame data was stored in the 2nd
trip. After that when the misfire (Priority: 1) is detected in another trip, the freeze frame data will be updated
from the EGR malfunction to the misfire. The 1st trip freeze frame data is updated each time a different mal-
function is detected. There is no priority for 1st trip freeze frame data. However, once freeze frame data is
stored in the ECM memory, 1st trip freeze data is no longer stored (because only one freeze frame data or 1st
trip freeze frame data can be stored in the ECM). If freeze frame data is stored in the ECM memory and freeze
frame data with the same priority occurs later, the first (original) freeze frame data remains unchanged in the
ECM memory.
Both 1st trip freeze frame data and freeze frame data (along with the DTCs) are cleared when the ECM mem-
ory is erased. Procedures for clearing the ECM memory are described in EC-1015, "HOW TO ERASE EMIS-
SION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
SYSTEM READINESS TEST (SRT) CODE
System Readiness Test (SRT) code is specified in Mode 1 of ISO 15031-5.
As part of an enhanced emissions test for Inspection & Maintenance (I/M), certain states require the status of
SRT be used to indicate whether the ECM has completed self-diagnosis of major emission systems and com-
ponents. Completion must be verified in order for the emissions inspection to proceed.
If a vehicle is rejected for a State emissions inspection due to one or more SRT items indicating INCMP, use
the information in this Service Manual to set the SRT to CMPLT.
In most cases the ECM will automatically complete its self-diagnosis cycle during normal usage, and the SRT
status will indicate CMPLT for each application system. Once set as CMPLT, the SRT status remains
CMPLT until the self-diagnosis memory is erased.
PBIB0911E
Priority Items
1
Freeze frame data Misfire DTC: P0300 - P0304
Fuel Injection System Function DTC: P0171, P0172
2 Except the above items (Includes CVT related items)
3 1st trip freeze frame data
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-1009
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Occasionally, certain portions of the self-diagnostic test may not be completed as a result of the customer's
normal driving pattern; the SRT will indicate INCMP for these items.
NOTE:
The SRT will also indicate INCMP if the self-diagnosis memory is erased for any reason or if the ECM mem-
ory power supply is interrupted for several hours.
If, during the state emissions inspection, the SRT indicates CMPLT for all test items, the inspector will con-
tinue with the emissions test. However, if the SRT indicates INCMP for one or more of the SRT items the
vehicle is returned to the customer untested.
NOTE:
If MI is ON during the state emissions inspection, the vehicle is also returned to the customer untested even
though the SRT indicates CMPLT for all test items. Therefore, it is important to check SRT (CMPLT) and
DTC (No DTCs) before the inspection.
SRT Item
The table below shows required self-diagnostic items to set the SRT to CMPLT.
*: If completion of several SRTs is required, perform driving patterns (DTC confirmation procedure), one by one based on the priority for
models with CONSULT-II.
SRT Set Timing
SRT is set as CMPLT after self-diagnosis has been performed one or more times. Completion of SRT is
done regardless of whether the result is OK or NG. The set timing is different between OK and NG results and
is shown in the table below.
SRT item
(CONSULT-II
indication)
Performance
Priority*
Required self-diagnostic items to set the SRT to CMPLT Corresponding DTC No.
CATALYST 2 Three way catalyst function P0420
HO2S 1 Heated oxygen sensor 1 P0132
Heated oxygen sensor 1 P0133
Heated oxygen sensor 1 P0134
Heated oxygen sensor 1 P1143
Heated oxygen sensor 1 P1144
Heated oxygen sensor 2 P0138
Heated oxygen sensor 2 P0139
Heated oxygen sensor 2 P1146
Heated oxygen sensor 2 P1147
HO2S HTR 1 Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater P0031, P0032
Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater P0037, P0038
Self-diagnosis result
Example
Diagnosis
Ignition cycle
ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON
All OK Case 1 P0400 OK (1) (1) OK (2) (2)
P0402 OK (1) (1) (1) OK (2)
P1402 OK (1) OK (2) (2) (2)
SRT of EGR CMPLT CMPLT CMPLT CMPLT
Case 2 P0400 OK (1) (1) (1) (1)
P0402 (0) (0) OK (1) (1)
P1402 OK (1) OK (2) (2) (2)
SRT of EGR INCMP INCMP CMPLT CMPLT
EC-1010
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
OK: Self-diagnosis is carried out and the result is OK.
NG: Self-diagnosis is carried out and the result is NG.
: Self-diagnosis is not carried out.
When all SRT related self-diagnoses showed OK results in a single cycle (Ignition OFF-ON-OFF), the SRT will
indicate CMPLT. Case 1 above
When all SRT related self-diagnoses showed OK results through several different cycles, the SRT will indicate
CMPLT at the time the respective self-diagnoses have at least one OK result. Case 2 above
If one or more SRT related self-diagnoses showed NG results in 2 consecutive cycles, the SRT will also indi-
cate CMPLT. Case 3 above
The table above shows that the minimum number of cycles for setting SRT as INCMP is one (1) for each
self-diagnosis (Case 1 & 2) or two (2) for one of self-diagnoses (Case 3). However, in preparation for the state
emissions inspection, it is unnecessary for each self-diagnosis to be executed twice (Case 3) for the following
reasons:
G The SRT will indicate CMPLT at the time the respective self-diagnoses have one (1) OK result.
G The emissions inspection requires CMPLT of the SRT only with OK self-diagnosis results.
G When, during SRT driving pattern, 1st trip DTC (NG) is detected prior to CMPLT of SRT, the self-diagno-
sis memory must be erased from ECM after repair.
G If the 1st trip DTC is erased, all the SRT will indicate INCMP.
NOTE:
SRT can be set as CMPLT together with the DTC(s). Therefore, DTC check must always be carried out
prior to the state emission inspection even though the SRT indicates CMPLT.
SRT Service Procedure
If a vehicle has failed the state emissions inspection due to one or more SRT items indicating INCMP, review
the flowchart diagnostic sequence on the next page.
NG exists Case 3 P0400 OK OK
P0402
P1402 NG NG
NG
(Consecutive
NG)
(1st trip)
DTC
1st trip DTC 1st trip DTC
DTC
(= MI ON)
SRT of EGR INCMP INCMP INCMP CMPLT
Self-diagnosis result
Example
Diagnosis
Ignition cycle
ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-1011
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
How to Display SRT Code
WITH CONSULT-II
Selecting SRT STATUS in DTC CONFIRMATION mode with
CONSULT-II.
For items whose SRT codes are set, a CMPLT is displayed on the
CONSULT-II screen; for items whose SRT codes are not set,
INCMP is displayed.
A sample of CONSULT-II display for SRT code is shown at right.
INCMP means the self-diagnosis is incomplete and SRT is not set.
CMPLT means the self-diagnosis is complete and SRT is set.
WITH GST
Selecting Mode 1 with GST (Generic Scan Tool)
*1 EC-1007 *2 EC-1011 *3 EC-1009
SEF573XB
PBIB0666E
EC-1012
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
How to Set SRT Code
To set all SRT codes, self-diagnosis for the items indicated above must be performed one or more times. Each
diagnosis may require a long period of actual driving under various conditions.
WITH CONSULT-II
Perform corresponding DTC Confirmation Procedure one by one based on Performance Priority in the table
on EC-1009 .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
The most efficient driving pattern in which SRT codes can be properly set is explained on the next page. The
driving pattern should be performed one or more times to set all SRT codes.
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-1013
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Driving Pattern
MBIB0044E
EC-1014
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
G The time required for each diagnosis varies with road surface conditions, weather, altitude, individual driv-
ing habits, etc.
Zone A refers to the range where the time, required for the diagnosis under normal conditions*, is the
shortest.
Zone B refers to the range where the diagnosis can still be performed if the diagnosis is not completed
within zone A.
*: Normal conditions refer to the following:
G Sea level
G Flat road
G Ambient air temperature: 20 - 30C (68 - 86F)
G Diagnosis is performed as quickly as possible under normal conditions.
Under different conditions [For example: ambient air temperature other than 20 - 30C (68 - 86F)], diag-
nosis may also be performed.
Pattern 1:
G The engine is started at the engine coolant temperature of 10 to 35C (14 to 95F)
(where the voltage between the ECM terminal 72 and ground is 3.0 - 4.3V).
G The engine must be operated at idle speed until the engine coolant temperature is greater than
70C (158F) (where the voltage between the ECM terminal 72 and ground is lower than 1.4V).
Pattern 2:
G When steady-state driving is performed again even after it is interrupted, each diagnosis can be con-
ducted. In this case, the time required for diagnosis may be extended.
*1: Depress the accelerator pedal until vehicle speed is 90 km/h (56 MPH), then release the accelerator pedal
and keep it released for more than 10 seconds. Depress the accelerator pedal until vehicle speed is 90 km/h
(56 MPH) again.
*2: Checking the vehicle speed with GST is advised.
TEST VALUE AND TEST LIMIT (GST ONLY NOT APPLICABLE TO CONSULT-II)
The following is the information specified in Mode 6 of ISO 15031-5.
The test value is a parameter used to determine whether a system/circuit diagnostic test is OK or NG while
being monitored by the ECM during self-diagnosis. The test limit is a reference value which is specified as the
maximum or minimum value and is compared with the test value being monitored.
Items for which these data (test value and test limit) are displayed are the same as SRT code items.
These data (test value and test limit) are specified by Test ID (TID) and Component ID (CID) and can be dis-
played on the GST screen.
: Applicable : Not applicable
SRT item Self-diagnostic test item
Test value (GST display)
Test limit Application
TID CID
CATALYST Three way catalyst function 01H 01H Max.
HO2S
Heated oxygen sensor 1
09H 04H Max.
0AH 84H Min.
0BH 04H Max.
0CH 04H Max.
0DH 04H Max.
Heated oxygen sensor 2
19H 86H Min.
1AH 86H Min.
1BH 06H Max.
1CH 06H Max.
HO2S HTR
Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
29H 08H Max.
2AH 88H Min.
Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
2DH 0AH Max.
2EH 8AH Min.
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-1015
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
HOW TO ERASE EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION
How to Erase DTC ( With CONSULT-II)
The emission related diagnostic information in the ECM can be erased by selecting ERASE in the SELF-
DIAG RESULTS mode with CONSULT-II.
If DTCs are displayed for both ECM and TCM (Transmission control module), they need to be erased individu-
ally from the ECM and TCM (Transmission control module).
NOTE:
If the DTC is not for CVT related items (see EC-959 ), skip steps 2 through 4.
1. If the ignition switch stays ON after repair work, be sure to turn ignition switch OFF once. Wait at least
10 seconds and then turn it ON (engine stopped) again.
2. Turn CONSULT-II ON and touch CVT.
3. Touch SELF-DIAG RESULTS.
4. Touch ERASE. [The DTC in the TCM (Transmission control module) will be erased.] Then touch BACK
twice.
5. Touch ENGINE.
6. Touch SELF-DIAG RESULTS.
7. Touch ERASE. (The DTC in the ECM will be erased.)
How to Erase DTC ( With GST)
The emission related diagnostic information in the ECM can be erased by selecting Mode 4 with GST.
NOTE:
If the DTC is not for CVT related items (see EC-959 ), skip step 2.
1. If the ignition switch stays ON after repair work, be sure to turn ignition switch OFF once. Wait at least
10 seconds and then turn it ON (engine stopped) again.
SEF905Z
EC-1016
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
2. Perform SELF-DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE (Without CONSULT-II) in CVT section titled TROUBLE
DIAGNOSIS, Self-diagnosis. (The engine warm-up step can be skipped when performing the diagnosis
only to erase the DTC.)
3. Select Mode 4 with GST (Generic Scan Tool).
How to Erase DTC ( No Tools)
1. If the ignition switch stays ON after repair work, be sure to turn ignition switch OFF once.
2. Wait at least 10 seconds and then turn it ON (engine stopped) again.
3. Change the diagnostic test mode from Mode II to Mode I by depressing the accelerator pedal. Refer to
EC-1017, "HOW TO SWITCH DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE" .
G If the battery is disconnected, the emission-related diagnostic information will be lost after
approx. 24 hours.
G The following data are cleared when the ECM memory is erased.
Diagnostic trouble codes
1st trip diagnostic trouble codes
Freeze frame data
1st trip freeze frame data
System readiness test (SRT) codes
Test values
Others
Actual work procedures are explained using a DTC as an example. Be careful so that not only the DTC, but all
of the data listed above, are cleared from the ECM memory during work procedures.
NATS (Nissan Anti-theft System) EBS00F1U
G If the security indicator lights up with the ignition switch in
the ON position or NATS MALFUNCTION is displayed
on SELF-DIAG RESULTS screen, perform self-diagnostic
results mode with CONSULT-II using NATS program card.
Refer to BL-156, "NATS (NISSAN ANTI-THEFT SYSTEM)" .
G Confirm no self-diagnostic results of NATS is displayed
before touching ERASE in SELF-DIAG RESULTS mode
with CONSULT-II.
G When replacing ECM, initialization of NATS system and reg-
istration of all NATS ignition key IDs must be carried out
with CONSULT-II using NATS program card.
Therefore, be sure to receive all keys from vehicle owner.
Regarding the procedures of NATS initialization and NATS ignition key ID registration, refer to
CONSULT-II operation manual, NATS.
Malfunction Indicator (MI) EBS00F1V
DESCRIPTION
The MI is located on the instrument panel.
1. The MI will light up when the ignition switch is turned ON without
the engine running. This is a bulb check.
G If the MI does not light up, refer to DI-95, "WARNING LAMPS"
or see EC-1406 .
2. When the engine is started, the MI should go off.
If the MI remains on, the on board diagnostic system has
detected an engine system malfunction.
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEM FUNCTION
The on board diagnostic system has the following four functions.
SEF515Y
SAT652J
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-1017
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
MI Flashing without DTC
If the ECM is in Diagnostic Test Mode II, MI may flash when engine is running. In this case, check ECM diag-
nostic test mode. EC-1017, "HOW TO SWITCH DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE" .
How to switch the diagnostic test (function) modes, and details of the above functions are described later, EC-
1017 .
The following emission-related diagnostic information is cleared when the ECM memory is erased.
G Diagnostic trouble codes
G 1st trip diagnostic trouble codes
G Freeze frame data
G 1st trip freeze frame data
G System readiness test (SRT) codes
G Test values
G Others
HOW TO SWITCH DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE
NOTE:
G It is better to count the time accurately with a clock.
G It is impossible to switch the diagnostic mode when an accelerator pedal position sensor circuit
has a malfunction.
G Always ECM returns to Diagnostic Test Mode I after ignition switch is turned OFF.
How to Set Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)
1. Confirm that accelerator pedal is fully released, turn ignition switch ON and wait 3 seconds.
Diagnostic Test
Mode
KEY and ENG.
Status
Function Explanation of Function
Mode I Ignition switch in
ON position
Engine stopped
BULB CHECK This function checks the MI bulb for damage (blown, open
circuit, etc.).
If the MI does not come on, check MI circuit.
Engine running MALFUNCTION
WARNING
This is a usual driving condition. When a malfunction is
detected twice in two consecutive driving cycles (two trip
detection logic), the MI will light up to inform the driver that
a malfunction has been detected.
The following malfunctions will light up or blink the MI in
the 1st trip.
G Misfire (Possible three way catalyst damage)
G Fail-safe mode
Mode II Ignition switch in
ON position
Engine stopped
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC
RESULTS
This function allows DTCs and 1st trip DTCs to be read.
Engine running HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
MONITOR
This function allows the fuel mixture condition (lean or
rich), monitored by heated oxygen sensor 1, to be read.
EC-1018
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
2. Repeat the following procedure quickly five times within 5 seconds.
a. Fully depress the accelerator pedal.
b. Fully release the accelerator pedal.
3. Wait 7 seconds, fully depress the accelerator pedal and keep it for approx. 10 seconds until the MI starts
blinking.
4. Fully release the accelerator pedal.
ECM has entered to Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results).
How to Set Diagnostic Test Mode II (Heated Oxygen Sensor 1 Monitor)
1. Set the ECM in Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results). Refer to EC-1017, "How to Set Diagnos-
tic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)" .
2. Start Engine.
ECM has entered to Diagnostic Test Mode II (Heated oxygen sensor 1 monitor).
How to Erase Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)
1. Set ECM in Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results). Refer to EC-1017, "How to Set Diagnostic
Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)" .
2. Fully depress the accelerator pedal and keep it for more than 10 seconds.
The emission-related diagnostic information has been erased from the backup memory in the ECM.
3. Fully release the accelerator pedal, and confirm the DTC 0000 is displayed.
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE I BULB CHECK
In this mode, the MI on the instrument panel should stay ON. If it remains OFF, check the bulb. Refer to DI-95,
"WARNING LAMPS" or see EC-1406 .
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE I MALFUNCTION WARNING
G These DTC numbers are clarified in Diagnostic Test Mode II (SELF-DIAGNOSTIC RESULTS)
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE II SELF-DIAGNOSTIC RESULTS
In this mode, the DTC and 1st trip DTC are indicated by the number of blinks of the MI as shown below.
The DTC and 1st trip DTC are displayed at the same time. If the MI does not illuminate in diagnostic test mode
I (Malfunction warning), all displayed items are 1st trip DTCs. If only one code is displayed when the MI illumi-
nates in diagnostic test mode II (SELF-DIAGNOSTIC RESULTS), it is a DTC; if two or more codes are dis-
played, they may be either DTCs or 1st trip DTCs. DTC No. is same as that of 1st trip DTC. These unidentified
PBIB0092E
MI Condition
ON When the malfunction is detected.
OFF No malfunction.
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-1019
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
codes can be identified by using the CONSULT-II or GST. A DTC will be used as an example for how to read a
code.
A particular trouble code can be identified by the number of four-digit numeral flashes. The zero is indicated
by the number of ten flashes. The length of time the 1,000th-digit numeral flashes on and off is 1.2 seconds
consisting of an ON (0.6-second) - OFF (0.6-second) cycle.
The 100th-digit numeral and lower digit numerals consist of a 0.3-second ON and 0.3-second OFF cycle.
A change from one digit numeral to another occurs at an interval of 1.0-second OFF. In other words, the later
numeral appears on the display 1.3 seconds after the former numeral has disappeared.
A change from one trouble code to another occurs at an interval of 1.8-second OFF.
In this way, all the detected malfunctions are classified by their DTC numbers. The DTC 0000 refers to no
malfunction. (See EC-959, "INDEX FOR DTC" )
How to Erase Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)
The DTC can be erased from the back up memory in the ECM by depressing accelerator pedal. Refer to EC-
1017, "HOW TO SWITCH DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE" .
G If the battery is disconnected, the DTC will be lost from the backup memory after approx 24 hours.
G Be careful not to erase the stored memory before starting trouble diagnoses.
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE II HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 MONITOR
In this mode, the MI displays the condition of the fuel mixture (lean or rich) which is monitored by the heated
oxygen sensor 1.
*: Maintains conditions just before switching to open loop.
To check the heated oxygen sensor 1 function, start engine in the Diagnostic Test Mode II and warm it up until
engine coolant temperature indicator points to the middle of the gauge.
Next run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no-load conditions. Then make sure that the MI
comes ON more than 5 times within 10 seconds with engine running at 2,000 rpm under no-load.
OBD System Operation Chart EBS00F1W
RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN MI, 1ST TRIP DTC, DTC, AND DETECTABLE ITEMS
G When a malfunction is detected for the first time, the 1st trip DTC and the 1st trip freeze frame data are
stored in the ECM memory.
SEF952W
MI Fuel mixture condition in the exhaust gas Air fuel ratio feedback control condition
ON Lean
Closed loop system
OFF Rich
*Remains ON or OFF Any condition Open loop system
EC-1020
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
G When the same malfunction is detected in two consecutive trips, the DTC and the freeze frame data are
stored in the ECM memory, and the MI will come on. For details, refer to EC-1004, "Two Trip Detection
Logic" .
G The MI will go off after the vehicle is driven 3 times with no malfunction. The drive is counted only when
the recorded driving pattern is met (as stored in the ECM). If another malfunction occurs while counting,
the counter will reset.
G The DTC and the freeze frame data will be stored until the vehicle is driven 40 times (driving pattern A)
without the same malfunction recurring (except for Misfire and Fuel Injection System). For Misfire and
Fuel Injection System, the DTC and freeze frame data will be stored until the vehicle is driven 80 times
(driving pattern C) without the same malfunction recurring. The TIME in SELF-DIAGNOSTIC
RESULTS mode of CONSULT-II will count the number of times the vehicle is driven.
G The 1st trip DTC is not displayed when the self-diagnosis results in OK for the 2nd trip.
SUMMARY CHART
For details about patterns B and C under Fuel Injection System and Misfire, see EC-1022 .
For details about patterns A and B under Other, see EC-1024 .
*1: Clear timing is at the moment OK is detected.
*2: Clear timing is when the same malfunction is detected in the 2nd trip.
Items Fuel Injection System Misfire Other
MI (goes off) 3 (pattern B) 3 (pattern B) 3 (pattern B)
DTC, Freeze Frame Data (no
display)
80 (pattern C) 80 (pattern C) 40 (pattern A)
1st Trip DTC (clear)
1 (pattern C), *
1
1 (pattern C), *
1
1 (pattern B)
1st Trip Freeze Frame Data
(clear)
*
1
, *
2
*
1
, *
2
1 (pattern B)
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-1021
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN MI, DTC, 1ST TRIP DTC AND DRIVING PATTERNS FOR "MISFIRE"
<EXHAUST QUALITY DETERIORATION>, "FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM"
*1: When the same malfunction is
detected in two consecutive trips, MI
will light up.
*2: MI will go off after vehicle is driven 3
times (pattern B) without any malfunc-
tions.
*3: When the same malfunction is
detected in two consecutive trips, the
DTC and the freeze frame data will be
stored in ECM.
SEF392SA
EC-1022
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EXPLANATION FOR DRIVING PATTERNS FOR "MISFIRE <EXHAUST QUALITY DETERIORA-
TION>", "FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM"
<Driving Pattern B>
Driving pattern B means the vehicle operation as follows:
All components and systems should be monitored at least once by the OBD system.
G The B counter will be cleared when the malfunction is detected once regardless of the driving pattern.
G The B counter will be counted up when driving pattern B is satisfied without any malfunction.
G The MI will go off when the B counter reaches 3. (*2 in OBD SYSTEM OPERATION CHART)
<Driving Pattern C>
Driving pattern C means the vehicle operation as follows:
1. The following conditions should be satisfied at the same time:
Engine speed: (Engine speed in the freeze frame data) 375 rpm
Calculated load value: (Calculated load value in the freeze frame data) x (10.1) [%]
Engine coolant temperature (T) condition:
G When the freeze frame data shows lower than 70C (158F), T should be lower than 70C (158F).
G When the freeze frame data shows higher than or equal to 70C (158F), T should be higher than or
equal to 70C (158F).
Example:
If the stored freeze frame data is as follows:
Engine speed: 850 rpm, Calculated load value: 30%, Engine coolant temperature: 80C (176F)
To be satisfied with driving pattern C, the vehicle should run under the following conditions:
Engine speed: 475 - 1,225 rpm, Calculated load value: 27 - 33%, Engine coolant temperature: more than 70C
(158F)
G The C counter will be cleared when the malfunction is detected regardless of (1).
G The C counter will be counted up when (1) is satisfied without the same malfunction.
G The DTC will not be displayed after C counter reaches 80.
G The 1st trip DTC will be cleared when C counter is counted once without the same malfunction after DTC
is stored in ECM.
*4: The DTC and the freeze frame data
will not be displayed any longer after
vehicle is driven 80 times (pattern C)
without the same malfunction. (The
DTC and the freeze frame data still
remain in ECM.)
*5: When a malfunction is detected for
the first time, the 1st trip DTC and the
1st trip freeze frame data will be
stored in ECM.
*6: The 1st trip DTC and the 1st trip
freeze frame data will be cleared at
the moment OK is detected.
*7: When the same malfunction is
detected in the 2nd trip, the 1st trip
freeze frame data will be cleared.
*8: 1st trip DTC will be cleared when
vehicle is driven once (pattern C)
without the same malfunction after
DTC is stored in ECM.
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-1023
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN MI, DTC, 1ST TRIP DTC AND DRIVING PATTERNS EXCEPT FOR
"MISFIRE <EXHAUST QUALITY DETERIORATION>", "FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM"
*1: When the same malfunction is
detected in two consecutive trips, MI
will light up.
*2: MI will go off after vehicle is driven 3
times (pattern B) without any malfunc-
tions.
*3: When the same malfunction is
detected in two consecutive trips, the
DTC and the freeze frame data will be
stored in ECM.
*4: The DTC and the freeze frame data
will not be displayed any longer after
vehicle is driven 40 times (pattern A)
without the same malfunction.
(The DTC and the freeze frame data
still remain in ECM.)
*5: When a malfunction is detected for
the first time, the 1st trip DTC and the
1st trip freeze frame data will be
stored in ECM.
*6: 1st trip DTC will be cleared after vehi-
cle is driven once (pattern B) without
the same malfunction.
*7: When the same malfunction is
detected in the 2nd trip, the 1st trip
freeze frame data will be cleared.
SEF393SA
EC-1024
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EXPLANATION FOR DRIVING PATTERNS EXCEPT FOR "MISFIRE <EXHAUST QUALITY
DETERIORATION>", "FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM"
<Driving Pattern A>
G The A counter will be cleared when the malfunction is detected regardless of (1) - (4).
G The A counter will be counted up when (1) - (4) are satisfied without the same malfunction.
G The DTC will not be displayed after the A counter reaches 40.
<Driving Pattern B>
Driving pattern B means the vehicle operation as follows:
All components and systems should be monitored at least once by the OBD system.
G The B counter will be cleared when the malfunction is detected once regardless of the driving pattern.
G The B counter will be counted up when driving pattern B is satisfied without any malfunctions.
G The MI will go off when the B counter reaches 3 (*2 in OBD SYSTEM OPERATION CHART).
AEC574
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1025
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS PFP:00004
Trouble Diagnosis Introduction EBS00F1X
INTRODUCTION
The engine has an ECM to control major systems such as fuel con-
trol, ignition control, idle air control system, etc. The ECM accepts
input signals from sensors and instantly drives actuators. It is essen-
tial that both input and output signals are proper and stable. At the
same time, it is important that there are no problems such as vac-
uum leaks, fouled spark plugs, or other problems with the engine.
It is much more difficult to diagnose a problem that occurs intermit-
tently rather than continuously. Most intermittent problems are
caused by poor electric connections or improper wiring. In this case,
careful checking of suspected circuits may help prevent the replace-
ment of good parts.
A visual check only may not find the cause of the problems. A road
test with CONSULT-II (or GST) or a circuit tester connected should
be performed. Follow the Work Flow on EC-1026 .
Before undertaking actual checks, take a few minutes to talk with a
customer who approaches with a driveability complaint. The cus-
tomer can supply good information about such problems, especially
intermittent ones. Find out what symptoms are present and under
what conditions they occur. A Diagnostic Worksheet like the exam-
ple on EC-1029 should be used.
Start your diagnosis by looking for conventional problems first. This
will help troubleshoot driveability problems on an electronically con-
trolled engine vehicle.
MEF036D
SEF233G
SEF234G
EC-1026
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
WORK FLOW
Flow Chart
*1 If time data of SELF-DIAG
RESULTS is other than 0 or [1t],
perform EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAG-
NOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCI-
DENT" .
*2 If the incident cannot be verified, per-
form EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNO-
SISFOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT"
.
*3 If the on board diagnostic system can-
not be performed, check main power
supply and ground circuit. Refer to
EC-1077, "POWER SUPPLY CIR-
CUIT FOR ECM" .
*4 If malfunctioning part cannot be
detected, perform EC-1076, "TROU-
BLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMIT-
TENT INCIDENT" .
*5 EC-1013 *6 EC-1072
MBIB0159E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1027
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Description for Work Flow
STEP DESCRIPTION
STEP I
Get detailed information about the conditions and the environment when the incident/symptom occurred using the
DIAGNOSTIC WORK SHEET, EC-1028 .
STEP II
Before confirming the concern, check and write down (print out using CONSULT-II or GST) the (1st trip) DTC and the
(1st trip) freeze frame data, then erase the DTC and the data. (Refer to EC-1015 .) The (1st trip) DTC and the (1st
trip) freeze frame data can be used when duplicating the incident at STEP III & IV.
If the incident cannot be verified, perform EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
Study the relationship between the cause, specified by (1st trip) DTC, and the symptom described by the customer.
(The Symptom Matrix Chart will be useful. See EC-1037 .)
Also check related service bulletins for information.
STEP III
Try to confirm the symptom and under what conditions the incident occurs.
The DIAGNOSTIC WORK SHEET and the freeze frame data are useful to verify the incident. Connect CONSULT-II
to the vehicle in DATA MONITOR (AUTO TRIG) mode and check real time diagnosis results.
If the incident cannot be verified, perform EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
If the malfunction code is detected, skip STEP IV and perform STEP V.
STEP IV
Try to detect the (1st trip) DTC by driving in (or performing) the DTC Confirmation Procedure. Check and read the
(1st trip) DTC and (1st trip) freeze frame data by using CONSULT-II or GST.
During the (1st trip) DTC verification, be sure to connect CONSULT-II to the vehicle in DATA MONITOR (AUTO TRIG)
mode and check real time diagnosis results.
If the incident cannot be verified, perform EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
In case the DTC Confirmation Procedure is not available, perform the Overall Function Check instead. The (1st
trip) DTC cannot be displayed by this check, however, this simplified check is an effective alternative.
The NG result of the Overall Function Check is the same as the (1st trip) DTC detection.
STEP V
Take the appropriate action based on the results of STEP I through IV.
If the malfunction code is indicated, proceed to TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR DTC PXXXX.
If the normal code is indicated, proceed to the BASIC INSPECTION. (Refer to EC-1032 .) If COSULT-II is available,
perform DATA MONITOR (SPEC) mode with CONSULT-II and proceed to the TOROUBLE DIAGNOSIS SPECI-
FICATION VALUE. (Refer to EC-1072 .) (If malfunction is detected, proceed to PERAIR/REPLACE.) Then perform
inspections according to the Symptom Matrix Chart. (Refer to EC-1037 .)
STEP VI
Identify where to begin diagnosis based on the relationship study between symptom and possible causes. Inspect the
system for mechanical binding, loose connectors or wiring damage using (tracing) Harness Layouts.
Gently shake the related connectors, components or wiring harness with CONSULT-II set in DATA MONITOR
(AUTO TRIG) mode.
Check the voltage of the related ECM terminals or monitor the output data from the related sensors with CONSULT-II.
Refer to EC-1047 , EC-1067 .
The Diagnostic Procedure in EC section contains a description based on open circuit inspection. A short circuit
inspection is also required for the circuit check in the Diagnostic Procedure. For details, refer to Circuit Inspection in
GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident" .
Repair or replace the malfunction parts.
If malfunctioning part cannot be detected, perform EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCI-
DENT" .
STEP VII
Once you have repaired the circuit or replaced a component, you need to run the engine in the same conditions and
circumstances which resulted in the customer's initial complaint.
Perform the DTC Confirmation Procedure and confirm the normal code [DTC No. P0000] is detected. If the incident
is still detected in the final check, perform STEP VI by using a method different from the previous one.
Before returning the vehicle to the customer, be sure to erase the unnecessary (already fixed) (1st trip) DTC in ECM
and TCM (Transmission control module). (Refer to EC-1015, "HOW TO ERASE EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC
INFORMATION" and CVT-21, "HOW TO ERASE DTC" .)
EC-1028
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
DIAGNOSTIC WORKSHEET
Description
There are many operating conditions that lead to the malfunction of
engine components. A good grasp of such conditions can make trou-
bleshooting faster and more accurate.
In general, each customer feels differently about a problem. It is
important to fully understand the symptoms or conditions for a cus-
tomer complaint.
Utilize a diagnostic worksheet like the one on the next page in order
to organize all the information for troubleshooting.
Some conditions may cause the MIL to come on steady or blink and
DTC to be detected. Examples:
G Vehicle ran out of fuel, which caused the engine to misfire.
G Fuel filler cap was left off or incorrectly screwed on, allowing fuel
to evaporate into the atmosphere.
SEF907L
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1029
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Worksheet Sample
DTC Inspection Priority Chart EBS00F1Y
If some DTCs are displayed at the same time, perform inspections one by one based on the following priority
chart.
NOTE:
If DTC U1000 and/or U1001 is displayed with other DTC, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC
U1000 and U1001. Refer to EC-1083 .
MTBL0017
EC-1030
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Fail-safe Chart EBS00F1Z
When the DTC listed bellow is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
Priority Detected items (DTC)
1 G U1000 U1001 CAN communication line
G P0102 P0103 Mass air flow sensor
G P0112 P0113 P0127Intake air temperature sensor
G P0117 P0118 Engine coolant temperature sensor
G P0221 P0222 P0223 P1223 P1224 P1225 P1226 Throttle position sensor
G P0226 P0227 P0228 P1227 P1228 Accelerator pedal position sensor
G P0327 P0328 Knock sensor
G P0335 Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
G P0340 Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
G P0500 Vehicle speed sensor
G P0605 ECM
G P1229 Sensor power supply
G P1610-P1615 NATS
G P1706 Park/Neutral position (PNP) switch
2 G P0031 P0032 Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
G P0037 P0038 Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
G P0132 P0133 P0134 P1143 P1144 Heated oxygen sensor 1
G P0138 P0139 P1146 P1147 Heated oxygen sensor 2
G P0444 P0445 EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve
G P0550 Power steering pressure sensor
G P0715 P0740 P0745 P1715 P1777 P1791 CVT related sensors and solenoid valves
G P1065 ECM power supply
G P1111 Intake valve timing control solenoid valve
G P1122 Electric throttle control function
G P1124 P1126 Throttle control motor relay
G P1128 Throttle control mother
G P1212 ESP/TCS/ABS communication line
G P1720 Vehicle speed sensor
G P1805 Brake switch
3 G P0011 Intake valve timing control
G P0171 P0172 Fuel injection system function
G P0300 - P0304 Misfire
G P0420 Three way catalyst function
G P1121 Electric throttle control actuator
G P1217 Engine over temperature (OVERHEAT)
G P1564 ICC steering switch
G P1568 ICC command value
G P1572 ICC brake switch
G P1574 ICC vehicle speed sensor
G P1778 CVT step motor
DTC No. Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
P0102
P0103
Mass air flow sensor circuit Engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm due to the fuel cut.
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1031
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
P0117
P0118
Engine coolant tempera-
ture sensor circuit
Engine coolant temperature will be determined by ECM based on the time after turning
ignition switch ON or START.
CONSULT-II displays the engine coolant temperature decided by ECM.
Condition
Engine coolant temperature decided (CONSULT-
II display)
Just as ignition switch is turned
ON or Start
40C (104F)
More than approx. 4 minutes after
ignition ON or Start
80C (176F)
Except as shown above
40 - 80C (104 - 176F)
(Depends on the time)
When the fail-safe system for engine coolant temperature sensor is activated, the cool-
ing fan operates while engine is running.
P0221
P0222
P0223
P1223
P1224
Throttle position sensor The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening
in order for the idle position to be within +10 degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the nor-
mal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
P0226
P0227
P0228
P1227
P1228
Accelerator pedal position
sensor
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening
in order for the idle position to be within +10 degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the nor-
mal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
P1121 Electric throttle control actu-
ator
(ECM detect the throttle
valve is stuck open.)
While the vehicle is driving, it slows down gradually by fuel cut. After the vehicle stops,
the engine stalls.
The engine can restart in N or P position, and engine speed will not exceed 1,000
rpm or more.
P1122 Electric throttle control func-
tion
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.
P1124
P1126
Throttle control motor relay ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.
P1128 Throttle control motor ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.
P1229 Sensor power supply ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.
DTC No. Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
EC-1032
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Basic Inspection EBS00F20
1. INSPECTION START
1. Check service records for any recent repairs that may indicate a related problem, or a current need for
scheduled maintenance.
2. Open engine hood and check the following:
Harness connectors for improper connections
Wiring harness for improper connections, pinches and cut
Vacuum hoses for splits, kinks and improper connections
Hoses and ducts for leaks
Air cleaner clogging
Gasket
3. Confirm that electrical or mechanical loads are not applied.
Headlamp switch is OFF.
Air conditioner switch is OFF.
Rear window defogger switch is OFF.
Steering wheel is in the straight-ahead position, etc.
4. Start engine and warm it up until engine coolant temperature
indicator points the middle of gauge.
Ensure engine stays below 1,000 rpm.
5. Run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no-
load.
6. Make sure that no DTC is displayed with CONSULT-II or GST.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. REPAIR OR REPLACE
Repair or replace components as necessary according to corresponding Diagnostic Procedure.
>> GO TO 3
SEF983U
SEF976U
SEF977U
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1033
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK TARGET IDLE SPEED
With CONSULT-II
1. Run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no-load.
2. Rev engine (2,000 to 3,000 rpm) two or three times under no-
load, then run engine at idle speed for about 1 minute.
3. Read idle speed in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no-load.
2. Rev engine (2,000 to 3,000 rpm) two or three times under no-load, then run engine at idle speed for about
1 minute.
3. Check idle speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. PERFORM ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION LEARNING
1. Stop engine.
2. Perform EC-998, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
>> GO TO 5.
5. PERFORM THROTTLE VALVE CLOSED POSITION LEARNING
Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
>> GO TO 6.
SEF978U
M/T: 600 50 rpm
CVT: 650 50 rpm (in P or N position)
SEF058Y
M/T: 600 50 rpm
CVT: 650 50 rpm (in P or N position)
EC-1034
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
6. PERFORM IDLE AIR VOLUME LEARNING
Refer to EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
CMPLT or INCMP
CMPLT>> GO TO 7.
INCMP >> 1. Follow the construction of Idle Air Volume Learning.
2. GO TO 4.
7. CHECK TARGET IDLE SPEED AGAIN
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Read idle speed in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Check idle speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 8.
8. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the Following.
G Check camshaft position sensor (PHASE) and circuit. Refer to EC-1212 .
G Check crankshaft position sensor (POS) and circuit. Refer to EC-1205 .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> 1. Repair or replace.
2. GO TO 4.
9. CHECK ECM FUNCTION
1. Substitute another known-good ECM to check ECM function. (ECM may be the cause of a problem, but
this is the rarely the case.)
2. Perform initialization of NATS system and registration of NATS ignition key IDs. Refer to EC-1016, "NATS
(Nissan Anti-theft System)" .
>> GO TO 4.
Which is the result CMPLT or INCMP?
M/T: 600 50 rpm
CVT: 650 50 rpm (in P or N position)
M/T: 600 50 rpm
CVT: 650 50 rpm (in P or N position)
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1035
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
10. CHECK IGNITION TIMING
1. Run engine at idle.
2. Check ignition timing with a timing light.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 11.
11. PERFORM ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION LEARNING
1. Stop engine.
2. Perform EC-998, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
>> GO TO 12.
12. PERFORM THROTTLE VALVE CLOSED POSITION LEARNING
Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
>> GO TO 13.
13. PERFORM IDLE AIR VOLUME LEARNING
Refer to EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
CMPLT or INCMP
CMPLT>> GO TO 14.
INCMP >> 1. Follow the construction of Idle Air Volume Learning.
2. GO TO 4.
14. CHECK TARGET IDLE SPEED AGAIN
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Read idle speed in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Check idle speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 15.
NG >> GO TO 17.
M/T: 14 5 BTDC
CVT: 15 5 BTDC (in P or N position)
Which is the result CMPLT or INCMP?
M/T: 600 50 rpm
CVT: 650 50 rpm (in P or N position)
M/T: 600 50 rpm
CVT: 650 50 rpm (in P or N position)
EC-1036
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
15. CHECK IGNITION TIMING AGAIN
1. Run engine at idle.
2. Check ignition timing with a timing light.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 16.
16. CHECK TIMING CHAIN INSTALLATION
Check timing chain installation. Refer to EM-143, "TIMING CHAIN" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> 1. Repair the timing chain installation.
2. GO TO 4.
17. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Check camshaft position sensor (PHASE) and circuit. Refer to EC-1212 .
G Check crankshaft position sensor (POS) and circuit. Refer to EC-1205 .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 18.
NG >> 1. Repair or replace.
2. GO TO 4.
18. CHECK ECM FUNCTION
1. Substitute another known-good ECM to check ECM function. (ECM may be the cause of a problem, but
this is the rarely the case.)
2. Perform initialization of NATS system and registration of NATS ignition key IDs. Refer to EC-1016, "NATS
(Nissan Anti-theft System)" .
>> GO TO 4.
M/T: 14 5 BTDC
CVT: 15 5 BTDC (in P or N position)
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1037
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Symptom Matrix Chart EBS00F21
SYSTEM BASIC ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
SYMPTOM
Reference
page
H
A
R
D
/
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
/
R
E
S
T
A
R
T
(
E
X
C
P
.
H
A
)
E
N
G
I
N
E
S
T
A
L
L
H
E
S
I
T
A
T
I
O
N
/
S
U
R
G
I
N
G
/
F
L
A
T
S
P
O
T
S
P
A
R
K
K
N
O
C
K
/
D
E
T
O
N
A
T
I
O
N
L
A
C
K
O
F
P
O
W
E
R
/
P
O
O
R
A
C
C
E
L
E
R
A
T
I
O
N
H
I
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
L
O
W
I
D
L
E
R
O
U
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
H
U
N
T
I
N
G
I
D
L
I
N
G
V
I
B
R
A
T
I
O
N
S
L
O
W
/
N
O
R
E
T
U
R
N
T
O
I
D
L
E
O
V
E
R
H
E
A
T
S
/
W
A
T
E
R
T
E
M
P
E
R
A
T
U
R
E
H
I
G
H
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
F
U
E
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
O
I
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
B
A
T
T
E
R
Y
D
E
A
D
(
U
N
D
E
R
C
H
A
R
G
E
)
Warranty symptom code AA AB AC AD AE AF AG AH AJ AK AL AM HA
Fuel Fuel pump circuit 1 1 2 3 2 2 2 3 2 EC-1381
Fuel pressure regulator system 3 3 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 EC-1001
Injector circuit 1 1 2 3 2 2 2 2 EC-1375
Evaporative emission system 3 3 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 EC-1408
Air Positive crankcase ventilation sys-
tem
3 3 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 1 EC-1411
Incorrect idle speed adjustment 3 3 1 1 1 1 1 EC-1032
Electric throttle control actuator 1 1 2 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 2
EC-1246,
EC-1248 ,
EC-1255 ,
EC-1261
Ignition Incorrect ignition timing adjustment 3 3 1 1 1 1 1 1 EC-1032
Ignition circuit 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 EC-1365
Main power supply and ground circuit 2 2 3 3 3 3 3 2 3 EC-1077
Mass air flow sensor circuit 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 EC-1100
Engine coolant temperature sensor circuit 1 1 2 2 2 3 2 2 3 1 2 EC-1111
Throttle position sensor circuit 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
EC-1169,
EC-1175 ,
EC-1312 ,
EC-1318 ,
EC-1320 ,
EC-1329
Accelerator pedal position sensor circuit 3 2 1 2 2
EC-1181,
EC-1188 ,
EC-1322
Heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit 1 2 3 2 2 2 2
EC-1119,
EC-1125 ,
EC-1135 ,
EC-1266 ,
EC-1272
Knock sensor circuit 2 2 3 EC-1201
Crankshaft position sensor (POS) circuit 2 2 EC-1205
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE) circuit 2 2 EC-1212
Vehicle speed signal circuit 2 3 3 3 EC-1228
EC-1038
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
1 - 6: The numbers refer to the order of inspection.
(continued on next page)
SYSTEM ENGINE MECHANICAL & OTHER
Power steering pressure sensor circuit 2 3 3 3 3 EC-1230
ECM 2 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3
EC-1235,
EC-1238
Intake valve timing control solenoid valve cir-
cuit
3 3 2 1 3 2 2 3 3 EC-1242
PNP switch circuit 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 EC-1353
Refrigerant pressure sensor circuit 2 3 3 3 3 4 EC-1387
Electrical load signal circuit 3 3 3 3 EC-1392
Air conditioner circuit 2 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 ATC-30
SYMPTOM
Reference
page
H
A
R
D
/
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
/
R
E
S
T
A
R
T
(
E
X
C
P
.
H
A
)
E
N
G
I
N
E
S
T
A
L
L
H
E
S
I
T
A
T
I
O
N
/
S
U
R
G
I
N
G
/
F
L
A
T
S
P
O
T
S
P
A
R
K
K
N
O
C
K
/
D
E
T
O
N
A
T
I
O
N
L
A
C
K
O
F
P
O
W
E
R
/
P
O
O
R
A
C
C
E
L
E
R
A
T
I
O
N
H
I
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
L
O
W
I
D
L
E
R
O
U
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
H
U
N
T
I
N
G
I
D
L
I
N
G
V
I
B
R
A
T
I
O
N
S
L
O
W
/
N
O
R
E
T
U
R
N
T
O
I
D
L
E
O
V
E
R
H
E
A
T
S
/
W
A
T
E
R
T
E
M
P
E
R
A
T
U
R
E
H
I
G
H
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
F
U
E
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
O
I
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
B
A
T
T
E
R
Y
D
E
A
D
(
U
N
D
E
R
C
H
A
R
G
E
)
Warranty symptom code AA AB AC AD AE AF AG AH AJ AK AL AM HA
SYMPTOM
Reference
page
H
A
R
D
/
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
/
R
E
S
T
A
R
T
(
E
X
C
P
.
H
A
)
E
N
G
I
N
E
S
T
A
L
L
H
E
S
I
T
A
T
I
O
N
/
S
U
R
G
I
N
G
/
F
L
A
T
S
P
O
T
S
P
A
R
K
K
N
O
C
K
/
D
E
T
O
N
A
T
I
O
N
L
A
C
K
O
F
P
O
W
E
R
/
P
O
O
R
A
C
C
E
L
E
R
A
T
I
O
N
H
I
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
L
O
W
I
D
L
E
R
O
U
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
H
U
N
T
I
N
G
I
D
L
I
N
G
V
I
B
R
A
T
I
O
N
S
L
O
W
/
N
O
R
E
T
U
R
N
T
O
I
D
L
E
O
V
E
R
H
E
A
T
S
/
W
A
T
E
R
T
E
M
P
E
R
A
T
U
R
E
H
I
G
H
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
F
U
E
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
O
I
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
B
A
T
T
E
R
Y
D
E
A
D
(
U
N
D
E
R
C
H
A
R
G
E
)
Warranty symptom code AA AB AC AD AE AF AG AH AJ AK AL AM HA
Fuel Fuel tank
5
5
FL-13
Fuel piping 5 5 5 5 5 5
MA-23,
EM-128
Vapor lock
Valve deposit
5 5 5 5 5 5 5

Poor fuel (Heavy weight gaso-


line, Low octane)

TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1039
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Air Air duct
5 5 5 5 5 5
EM-114
Air cleaner EM-114
Air leakage from air duct
(Mass air flow sensor electric
throttle control actuator)
5 5 5 5
EM-114
Electric throttle control actuator EM-116
Air leakage from intake manifold/
Collector/Gasket
EM-116
Cranking Battery
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
SC-3
Alternator circuit SC-12
Starter circuit 3 SC-22
Signal plate/Flywheel/Drive plate 6 EM-165
PNP switch
4
MT-126 or
CVT-67
Engine Cylinder head
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 EM-152
Cylinder head gasket 4 3
Cylinder block
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6
4
EM-165
Piston
Piston ring
Connecting rod
Bearing
Crankshaft
Valve
mecha-
nism
Timing chain
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
EM-143
Camshaft EM-133
Intake valve timing control EM-143
Intake valve
3 EM-152
Exhaust valve
Exhaust Exhaust manifold/Tube/Muffler/
Gasket
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
EM-121,
EX-3
Three way catalyst
SYMPTOM
Reference
page
H
A
R
D
/
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
/
R
E
S
T
A
R
T
(
E
X
C
P
.
H
A
)
E
N
G
I
N
E
S
T
A
L
L
H
E
S
I
T
A
T
I
O
N
/
S
U
R
G
I
N
G
/
F
L
A
T
S
P
O
T
S
P
A
R
K
K
N
O
C
K
/
D
E
T
O
N
A
T
I
O
N
L
A
C
K
O
F
P
O
W
E
R
/
P
O
O
R
A
C
C
E
L
E
R
A
T
I
O
N
H
I
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
L
O
W
I
D
L
E
R
O
U
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
H
U
N
T
I
N
G
I
D
L
I
N
G
V
I
B
R
A
T
I
O
N
S
L
O
W
/
N
O
R
E
T
U
R
N
T
O
I
D
L
E
O
V
E
R
H
E
A
T
S
/
W
A
T
E
R
T
E
M
P
E
R
A
T
U
R
E
H
I
G
H
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
F
U
E
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
O
I
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
B
A
T
T
E
R
Y
D
E
A
D
(
U
N
D
E
R
C
H
A
R
G
E
)
Warranty symptom code AA AB AC AD AE AF AG AH AJ AK AL AM HA
EC-1040
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
1 - 6: The numbers refer to the order of inspection.
Lubrica-
tion
Oil pan/Oil strainer/Oil pump/Oil
filter/Oil gallery
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 2
EM-123,
LU-18 , LU-
19 , LU-14
Oil level (Low)/Filthy oil LU-16
Cooling Radiator/Hose/Radiator filler cap
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 2 5
CO-31
Thermostat 5 CO-40
Water pump CO-38
Water gallery CO-27
Cooling fan 5 CO-31
Coolant level (low)/Contaminated
coolant
CO-29
NATS (Nissan Anti-theft System) 1 1
EC-1016 or
BL-156
SYMPTOM
Reference
page
H
A
R
D
/
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
/
R
E
S
T
A
R
T
(
E
X
C
P
.
H
A
)
E
N
G
I
N
E
S
T
A
L
L
H
E
S
I
T
A
T
I
O
N
/
S
U
R
G
I
N
G
/
F
L
A
T
S
P
O
T
S
P
A
R
K
K
N
O
C
K
/
D
E
T
O
N
A
T
I
O
N
L
A
C
K
O
F
P
O
W
E
R
/
P
O
O
R
A
C
C
E
L
E
R
A
T
I
O
N
H
I
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
L
O
W
I
D
L
E
R
O
U
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
H
U
N
T
I
N
G
I
D
L
I
N
G
V
I
B
R
A
T
I
O
N
S
L
O
W
/
N
O
R
E
T
U
R
N
T
O
I
D
L
E
O
V
E
R
H
E
A
T
S
/
W
A
T
E
R
T
E
M
P
E
R
A
T
U
R
E
H
I
G
H
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
F
U
E
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
O
I
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
B
A
T
T
E
R
Y
D
E
A
D
(
U
N
D
E
R
C
H
A
R
G
E
)
Warranty symptom code AA AB AC AD AE AF AG AH AJ AK AL AM HA
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1041
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Engine Control Component Parts Location EBS00F22
MBIB0070E
EC-1042
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
MBIB0147E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1043
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
MBIB0148E
EC-1044
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
MBIB0149E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1045
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Circuit Diagram EBS00F23
MBWA0001E
EC-1046
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
MBWA0002E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1047
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
ECM Harness Connector Terminal Layout EBS00F24
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00F25
PREPARATION
1. ECM is located behind the glove box. For this inspection,
remove glove box.
2. Remove ECM harness protector.
3. When disconnecting ECM harness connector, loosen it with
levers as far as they will go as shown at right.
4. Connect a break-out box (SST) and Y-cable adapter (SST)
between the ECM and ECM harness connector.
G Use extreme care not to touch 2 pins at one time.
G Data is for comparison and may not be exact.
ECM INSPECTION TABLE
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
MBIB0045E
MBIB0155E
MBIB0145E
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
1 B ECM ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Engine ground
EC-1048
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
2 R/W
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is below 3,800 rpm.
G After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of 70
km/h (43 MPH) or more
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,800 rpm
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
3 R
Throttle control motor
relay power supply
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
4 BR
Throttle control motor
(Close)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is releasing
0 - 14V
5 Y
Throttle control motor
(Open)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is depressing
0 - 14V
12 Y
Power steering pres-
sure sensor
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is being turned
0.5 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is not being turned
0.4 - 0.8V
13 L
Crankshaft position
sensor (POS)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 3.0V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
Approximately 3.0V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0534E
PBIB0533E
PBIB0527E
PBIB0528E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1049
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
14 L
Camshaft position sen-
sor (PHASE)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.0 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
1.0 - 4.0V
15 W Knock sensor
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 2.5V
16 W/Y Heated oxygen sensor 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
19 P
EVAP canister purge
volume control solenoid
valve
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is about 2,000 rpm (More than
100 seconds after starting engine)
Approximately 10V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0525E
PBIB0526E
PBIB0050E
PBIB0520E
EC-1050
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
22
23
41
42
G/B
SB
L
R/W
Injector No. 3
Injector No. 1
Injector No. 4
Injector No. 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
24 P/L
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm.
Approximately 7.0V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
34 G
Intake air temperature
sensor
[Engine is running]
Approximately 0 - 4.8V
Output voltage varies with
intake air temperature.
35 PU Heated oxygen sensor 1
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
45 R Sensor's power supply [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
46 R
Sensor's power supply
(Refrigerant pressure
sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
47 G Sensor's power supply [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
49 W
Throttle position
sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
More than 0.36V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
Less than 4.75V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0529E
PBIB0530E
PBIB0519E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1051
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
50 B Mass air flow sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.1 - 1.5V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,500 rpm.
1.6 - 2.0V
54 W
Sensors' ground
(Mass air flow sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
55 B Sensors' ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
60
61
79
80
L/Y
Y/R
GY/L
PU/G
Ignition signal No. 3
Ignition signal No. 1
Ignition signal No. 4
Ignition signal No. 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0 - 0.1V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - 0.2V
62 Y
Intake valve timing
control solenoid valve
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G When revving engine up to 2,000 rpm
quickly
Approximately 4V - BATTERY
VOLTAGE (11 - 14V)
65 R
Sensor's power supply
(Power steering pres-
sure sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
66 B Sensors' ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0521E
PBIB0522E
MBIB0052E
PBIB0532E
EC-1052
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
68 R
Throttle position
sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
Less than 4.75V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 0.36V
69 L
Refrigerant pressure
sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Both A/C switch and blower switch are ON
(Compressor operates.)
1.0 - 4.0V
72 L/OR
Engine coolant tempera-
ture sensor
[Engine is running]
Approximately 0 - 4.8V
Output voltage varies with
engine coolant temperature.
74 B Sensors' ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
82*
2
B
Sensor's ground
(ICC steering switch)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
84 R/Y
Electrical load signal
(Headlamp signal)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Lighting switch is 2ND position
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Lighting switch is OFF
Approximately 0V
85 LG DATA link connector
[Ignition switch ON]
G CONSULT-II or GST is disconnected.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
86 R CAN communication line [Ignition switch ON] 1.0 - 2.5V
92*
1
GY
Accelerator pedal posi-
tion sensor signal output
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
Approximately 0.5V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
Approximately 4.2V
94 L CAN communication line [Ignition switch ON] 2.5 - 4.0V
98 LG
Accelerator pedal
position sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.175 - 0.335V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 1.95V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1053
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
99*
2
PU ICC steering switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G ICC steering switch is OFF.
Approximately 4.3V
[Ignition switch ON]
G ON/OFF switch is ON.
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G CANCEL switch is ON.
Approximately 1.3V
[Ignition switch ON]
G DISTANCE switch is ON.
Approximately 2.2V
[Ignition switch ON]
G SET/COAST switch is ON.
Approximately 3V
[Ignition switch ON]
G RESUME/ACCEL switch is ON.
Approximately 3.7V
101 R/G Stop lamp switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Brake pedal fully released
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Brake pedal fully depressed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
102
P (CVT)
L (M/T)
PNP switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Gear position is P or N
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Except the above gear position
CVT models
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
M/T models
Approximately 5V
103*
1
L/OR
Tachometer signal
output
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
10 - 11V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
10 - 11V
104 OR
Throttle control motor
relay
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch ON] 0 - 1.0V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
MBIB0053E
MBIB0054E
EC-1054
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
*1: CVT models
*2: Models with ICC system
CONSULT-II Function EBS00F26
FUNCTION
106 L
Accelerator pedal posi-
tion sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.35 - 0.67V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.9V
108*
2
R ICC brake switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Brake pedal is depressed
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Brake pedal is fully released
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
109 B/R Ignition switch
[Ignition switch OFF] 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
111 W/G
ECM relay
(Self shut-off)
[Engine is running]
[Ignition switch OFF]
G For 5 seconds after turning ignition switch
OFF
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch OFF]
G 5 seconds passed after turning ignition
switch OFF
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
113 B/P Fuel pump relay
[Ignition switch ON]
G For 1 seconds after turning ignition switch
ON
[Engine is running]
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G More than 1 seconds after turning ignition
switch ON.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
115
116
B
B
ECM ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Engine ground
119
120
W/R
W/R
Power supply for ECM [Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
121 W/L
Power supply for ECM
(Buck-up)
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
Diagnostic test mode Function
Work support
This mode enables a technician to adjust some devices faster and more accurately by following the
indications on the CONSULT-II unit.
Self-diagnostic results
Self-diagnostic results such as 1st trip DTC, DTCs and 1st trip freeze frame data or freeze frame data
can be read and erased quickly.*
Data monitor Input/Output data in the ECM can be read.
Data monitor (SPEC)
Input/Output of the specification for Basic fuel schedule, AFM, A/F feedback control value and the
other data monitor items can be read.
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1055
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
*: The following emission-related diagnostic information is cleared when the ECM memory is erased.
G Diagnostic trouble codes
G 1st trip diagnostic trouble codes
G Freeze frame data
G 1st trip freeze frame data
G System readiness test (SRT) codes
G Test values
G Others
ENGINE CONTROL COMPONENT PARTS/CONTROL SYSTEMS APPLICATION
Active test
Diagnostic Test Mode in which CONSULT-II drives some actuators apart from the ECMs and also
shifts some parameters in a specified range.
Function test This mode is used to inform customers when their vehicle condition requires periodic maintenance.
DTC & SRT confirmation The status of system monitoring tests and the self-diagnosis status/result can be confirmed.
ECM part number ECM part number can be read.
Diagnostic test mode Function
Item
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE
WORK
SUP-
PORT
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC
RESULTS
DATA
MONI-
TOR
DATA
MONI-
TOR
(SPEC)
ACTIVE
TEST
DTC & SRT
CONFIRMATION
DTC*1
FREEZE
FRAME
DATA*2
SRT
STATUS
DTC
WORK
SUP-
PORT
E
N
G
I
N
E
C
O
N
T
R
O
L
C
O
M
P
O
N
E
N
T
P
A
R
T
S
I
N
P
U
T
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Mass air flow sensor
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Heated oxygen sensor 1
Heated oxygen sensor 2
Vehicle speed signal
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Throttle position sensor
Intake air temperature sensor
Knock sensor
Refrigerant pressure sensor
Closed throttle position switch
(accelerator pedal position sensor
signal)

Air conditioner switch
Park/neutral position (PNP) switch
Stop lamp switch
Power steering pressure sensor
Battery voltage
Electrical load signal
ICC steering switch
ICC brake switch
EC-1056
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
X: Applicable
*1: This item includes 1st trip DTCs.
*2: This mode includes 1st trip freeze frame data or freeze frame data. The items appear on CONSULT-II screen in freeze frame data
mode only if a 1st trip DTC or DTC is detected. For details, refer to EC-1008 .
CONSULT-II INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Connect CONSULT-II to data link connector, which is located
under drivers side dash panel.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Touch START.
E
N
G
I
N
E
C
O
N
T
R
O
L
C
O
M
P
O
N
E
N
T
P
A
R
T
S
O
U
T
P
U
T
Injectors
Power transistor (Ignition timing)
Throttle control motor relay
Throttle control motor
EVAP canister purge volume con-
trol solenoid valve

Air conditioner relay
Fuel pump relay
Cooling fan relay
Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
Intake valve timing control solenoid
valve

Calculated load value
Item
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE
WORK
SUP-
PORT
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC
RESULTS
DATA
MONI-
TOR
DATA
MONI-
TOR
(SPEC)
ACTIVE
TEST
DTC & SRT
CONFIRMATION
DTC*1
FREEZE
FRAME
DATA*2
SRT
STATUS
DTC
WORK
SUP-
PORT
MBIB0156E
PBR455D
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1057
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. Touch ENGINE.
6. Perform each diagnostic test mode according to each service
procedure.
For further information, see the CONSULT-II Operation Manual.
WORK SUPPORT MODE
Work Item
*: This function is not necessary in the usual service procedure.
SELF-DIAG RESULTS MODE
Self Diagnostic Item
Regarding items of DTC and 1st trip DTC, refer to EC-959, "INDEX FOR DTC" .)
SEF995X
SEF824Y
WORK ITEM CONDITION USAGE
FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE G FUEL PUMP WILL STOP BY TOUCHING START DUR-
ING IDLING.
CRANK A FEW TIMES AFTER ENGINE STALLS.
When releasing fuel pressure
from fuel line
IDLE AIR VOL LEARN G THE IDLE AIR VOLUME THAT KEEPS THE ENGINE
WITHIN THE SPECIFIED RANGE IS MEMORIZED IN
ECM.
When learning the idle air volume
SELF-LEARNING CONT G THE COEFFICIENT OF SELF-LEARNING CONTROL
MIXTURE RATIO RETURNS TO THE ORIGINAL COEF-
FICIENT.
When clearing the coefficient of
self-learning control value
TARGET IDLE RPM ADJ* G IDLE CONDITION When setting target idle speed
TARGET IGN TIM ADJ* G IDLE CONDITION When adjusting target ignition tim-
ing
After adjustment, confirm target
ignition timing with a timing light.
EC-1058
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Freeze Frame Data and 1st Trip Freeze Frame Data
*: The items are the same as those of 1st trip freeze frame data.
DATA MONITOR MODE
Monitored Item
: Applicable
Freeze frame data
item*
Description
DIAG TROUBLE
CODE
[PXXXX]
G The engine control component part/control system has a trouble code, it is displayed as PXXXX. (Refer
to EC-959, "INDEX FOR DTC" .)
FUEL SYS-B1
G Fuel injection system status at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
G One mode in the following is displayed.
MODE 2: Open loop due to detected system malfunction
MODE 3: Open loop due to driving conditions (power enrichment, deceleration enrichment)
MODE 4: Closed loop - using oxygen sensor(s) as feedback for fuel control
MODE 5: Open loop - has not yet satisfied condition to go to closed loop
CAL/LD VALUE [%] G The calculated load value at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
COOLANT TEMP [C]
or [F]
G The engine coolant temperature at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
L-FUEL TRIM-B1 [%]
G Long-term fuel trim at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
G The long-term fuel trim indicates much more gradual feedback compensation to the base fuel schedule
than short-term fuel trim.
S-FUEL TRIM-B1 [%]
G Short-term fuel trim at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
G The short-term fuel trim indicates dynamic or instantaneous feedback compensation to the base fuel
schedule.
ENGINE SPEED
[rpm]
G The engine speed at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
VHCL SPEED [km/h]
or [mph]
G The vehicle speed at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
B/FUEL SCHDL
[msec]
G The base fuel schedule at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
INT/A TEMP SE [C]
or [F]
G The intake air temperature at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
Monitored item
[Unit]
ECM
INPUT
SIG-
NALS
MAIN
SIG-
NALS
CAN
DIAG
SUP-
PORT
MNTR
Description Remarks
ENG SPEED [rpm]
G Indicates the engine speed computed
from the signals of the crankshaft posi-
tion sensor (POS) and camshaft posi-
tion sensor (PHASE).
G Accuracy becomes poor if engine
speed drops below the idle rpm.
G If the signal is interrupted while the
engine is running, an abnormal
value may be indicated.
MAS A/F SE-B1 [V]
G The signal voltage of the mass air flow
sensor is displayed.
G When the engine is stopped, a
certain value is indicated.
B/FUEL SCHDL
[msec]

G Base fuel schedule indicates the fuel
injection pulse width programmed into
ECM, prior to any learned on board cor-
rection.
A/F ALPHA-B1 [%]
G The mean value of the air-fuel ratio
feedback correction factor per cycle is
indicated.
G When the engine is stopped, a
certain value is indicated.
G This data also includes the data
for the air-fuel ratio learning con-
trol.
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1059
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
COOLAN TEMP/S
[C] or [F]

G The engine coolant temperature (deter-
mined by the signal voltage of the
engine coolant temperature sensor) is
displayed.
G When the engine coolant tempera-
ture sensor is open or short-cir-
cuited, ECM enters fail-safe mode.
The engine coolant temperature
determined by the ECM is dis-
played.
HO2S1 (B1) [V]
G The signal voltage of the heated oxygen
sensor 1 is displayed.
HO2S2 (B1) [V]
G The signal voltage of the heated oxygen
sensor 2 is displayed.
HO2S1 MNTR(B1)
[RICH/LEAN]

G Display of heated oxygen sensor 1 sig-
nal during air-fuel ratio feedback control:
RICH ... means the mixture became
rich, and control is being affected
toward a leaner mixture.
LEAN ... means the mixture became
lean, and control is being affected
toward a rich mixture.
G After turning ON the ignition
switch, RICH is displayed until
air-fuel mixture ratio feedback
control begins.
G When the air-fuel ratio feedback is
clamped, the value just before the
clamping is displayed continu-
ously.
HO2S2 MNTR(B1)
[RICH/LEAN]

G Display of heated oxygen sensor 2 sig-
nal:
RICH ... means the amount of oxygen
after three way catalyst is relatively
small.
LEAN ... means the amount of oxygen
after three way catalyst is relatively
large.
G When the engine is stopped, a
certain value is indicated.
VHCL SPEED SE
[km/h] or [mph]

G The vehicle speed computed from the
vehicle speed signal is displayed.
BATTERY VOLT
[V]

G The power supply voltage of ECM is dis-
played.
ACCEL SEN 1 [V]
G The accelerator pedal position sensor
signal voltage is displayed.
ACCEL SEN 2 [V]
THRTL SEN 1 [V]
G The throttle position sensor signal volt-
age is displayed.
THRTL SEN 2 [V]
INT/A TEMP SE
[C] or [F]

G The intake air temperature (determined
by the signal voltage of the intake air
temperature sensor) is indicated.
START SIGNAL
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates start signal status [ON/OFF]
computed by the ECM according to the
signals of engine speed and battery volt-
age.
G After starting the engine, [OFF] is
displayed regardless of the starter
signal.
CLSD THL POS
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates idle position [ON/OFF] com-
puted by the ECM according to the
accelerator pedal position sensor signal.
AIR COND SIG
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition of the air
conditioner switch as determined by the
air conditioner signal.
P/N POSI SW
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from the
park/neutral position (PNP) switch sig-
nal.
Monitored item
[Unit]
ECM
INPUT
SIG-
NALS
MAIN
SIG-
NALS
CAN
DIAG
SUP-
PORT
MNTR
Description Remarks
EC-1060
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
PW/ST SIGNAL
[ON/OFF]

G [ON/OFF] condition of the power steer-
ing oil pressure switch as determined by
the power steering oil pressure signal is
indicated.
LOAD SIGNAL
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from the
electrical load signal.
ON ... Rear window defogger switch is
ON and/or lighting switch is in 2nd posi-
tion.
OFF ... Both rear window defogger
switch and lighting switch are OFF.
IGNITION SW
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from igni-
tion switch.
HEATER FAN SW
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from the
heater fan switch signal.
BRAKE SW
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from the
stop lamp switch signal.
INJ PULSE-B1
[msec]

G Indicates the actual fuel injection pulse
width compensated by ECM according
to the input signals.
G When the engine is stopped, a
certain computed value is indi-
cated.
IGN TIMING
[BTDC]

G Indicates the ignition timing computed
by ECM according to the input signals.
G When the engine is stopped, a
certain value is indicated.
CAL/LD VALUE [%]
G Calculated load value indicates the
value of the current airflow divided by
peak airflow.
MASS AIRFLOW
[gm/s]
G Indicates the mass airflow computed by
ECM according to the signal voltage of
the mass air flow sensor.
PURG VOL C/V
[%]
G Indicates the EVAP canister purge vol-
ume control solenoid valve control value
computed by the ECM according to the
input signals.
G The opening becomes larger as the
value increases.
INT/V TIM (B1)
[CA]
G Indicates [CA] of intake camshaft
advanced angle.
INT/V SOL (B1) [%]
G The control condition of the intake valve
timing control solenoid valve (deter-
mined by ECM according to the input
signals) is indicated.
ON ... intake valve timing control is oper-
ating.
OFF ... Intake valve timing control is not
operating.
AIR COND RLY
[ON/OFF]

G The air conditioner relay control condi-
tion (determined by ECM according to
the input signals) is indicated.
FUEL PUMP RLY
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates the fuel pump relay control
condition determined by ECM according
to the input signals.
Monitored item
[Unit]
ECM
INPUT
SIG-
NALS
MAIN
SIG-
NALS
CAN
DIAG
SUP-
PORT
MNTR
Description Remarks
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1061
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
THRTL RELAY
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates the throttle control motor relay
control condition determined by the
ECM according to the input signals.
COOLING FAN
[HI/LOW/OFF]
G Indicates the condition of the cooling fan
(determined by ECM according to the
input signals).
HI ... High speed operation
LOW ... Low speed operation
OFF ... Stop
HO2S1 HTR (B1)
[ON/OFF]
G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition of heated
oxygen sensor 1 heater determined by
ECM according to the input signals.
HO2S2 HTR (B1)
[ON/OFF]
G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition of heated
oxygen sensor 2 heater determined by
ECM according to the input signals.
I/P PULLY SPD
[rpm]

G Indicates the engine speed computed
from the primary speed sensor signal.
VEHICLE SPEED
[km/h] or [mph]

G Indicates the vehicle speed computed
from the secondary speed sensor sig-
nal.
IDL A/V LEARN
[YET/CMPLT/
INCMP]
G Display the condition of idle air volume
learning
YET ... Idle air volume learning has not
been performed yet.
CMPLT ... Idle air volume learning has
already been performed successfully.
INCMP ... Idle air volume learning has
not been performed successfully.
TRVL AFTER MIL
[km] or [mile]
G Distance traveled while MI is activated.
AC PRESS SEN
[V]
G The signal voltage from the refrigerant
pressure sensor is displayed.
VHCL SPEED SE
[km/h] or [mph]
G The vehicle speed computed from the
vehicle speed signal sent from TCM is
displayed.
SET VHCL SPD
[km/h] or [mph]
G The preset vehicle speed is displayed.
MAIN SW
[ON/OFF]
G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from ON/
OFF switch signal.
CANCEL SW
[ON/OFF]
G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from CAN-
CEL switch signal.
RESUME/ACC SW
[ON/OFF]
G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from
ACCEL/RES switch signal.
SET SW
[ON/OFF]
G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from
COAST/SET switch signal.
BRAKE SW1
[ON/OFF]
G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from ICC
brake switch signal.
BRAKE SW2
[ON/OFF]
G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition of stop
lamp switch signal.
DIST SW
[ON/OFF]
G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from DIS-
TANCE switch signal.
Monitored item
[Unit]
ECM
INPUT
SIG-
NALS
MAIN
SIG-
NALS
CAN
DIAG
SUP-
PORT
MNTR
Description Remarks
EC-1062
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
NOTE:
G Any monitored item that does not match the vehicle being diagnosed is deleted from the display automatically.
DATA MONITOR (SPEC) MODE
Monitored Item
NOTE:
G Any monitored item that does not match the vehicle being diagnosed is deleted from the display automatically.
CRUISE LAMP
[ON/OFF]
G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition of
CRUISE lamp determined by the ECM
according to the input signals.
Voltage [V]
G Voltage, frequency, duty cycle or pulse
width measured by the probe.
G Only # is displayed if item is
unable to be measured.
G Figures with #s are temporary
ones. They are the same figures
as an actual piece of data which
was just previously measured.
Frequency
[msec], [Hz] or [%]
DUTY-HI
DUTY-LOW
PLS WIDTH-HI
PLS WIDTH-LOW
CAN COMM
[OK/NG]

G Indicates the communication condition
of CAN communication line.
G These items are not displayed in
SELECTION FROM MENU
mode.
CAN CIRC 1
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 2
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 3
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 4
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 5
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 6
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 7
[OK/UNKWN]

Monitored item
[Unit]
ECM
INPUT
SIG-
NALS
MAIN
SIG-
NALS
CAN
DIAG
SUP-
PORT
MNTR
Description Remarks
Monitored item [Unit]
ECM
input
signals
Main
signals
Description Remarks
ENG SPEED [rpm]
G Indicates the engine speed computed
from the signal of the crankshaft position
sensor (POS).
MAS A/F SE-B1 [V]
G The signal voltage of the mass air flow
sensor specification is displayed.
G When engine is running specification
range is indicated.
B/FUEL SCHDL
[msec]
G Base fuel schedule indicates the fuel
injection pulse width programmed into
ECM, prior to any learned on board cor-
rection.
G When engine is running specification
range is indicated.
A/F ALPHA-B1 [%]
G The mean value of the air-fuel ratio feed-
back correction factor per cycle is indi-
cated.
G When engine is running specification
range is indicated.
G This data also includes the data for the
air-fuel ratio learning control.
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1063
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
ACTIVE TEST MODE
Test Item
DTC & SRT CONFIRMATION MODE
SRT STATUS Mode
For details, refer to EC-1008, "SYSTEM READINESS TEST (SRT) CODE" .
SRT Work Support Mode
This mode enables a technician to drive a vehicle to set the SRT while monitoring the SRT status.
TEST ITEM CONDITION JUDGEMENT CHECK ITEM (REMEDY)
FUEL INJEC-
TION
G Engine: Return to the original
trouble condition
G Change the amount of fuel injec-
tion using CONSULT-II.
If trouble symptom disappears, see
CHECK ITEM.
G Harness and connectors
G Fuel injectors
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
IGNITION TIM-
ING
G Engine: Return to the original
trouble condition
G Timing light: Set
G Retard the ignition timing using
CONSULT-II.
If trouble symptom disappears, see
CHECK ITEM.
G Perform Idle Air Volume Learn-
ing.
POWER BAL-
ANCE
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine.
G A/C switch OFF
G Shift lever N
G Cut off each injector signal one at
a time using CONSULT-II.
Engine runs rough or dies.
G Harness and connectors
G Compression
G Fuel injectors
G Power transistor
G Spark plugs
G Ignition coils
COOLING FAN
G Ignition switch: ON
G Turn the cooling fan ON and
OFF with CONSULT-II.
Cooling fan moves and stops.
G Harness and connectors
G Cooling fan relay
G Cooling fan motor
ENG COOLANT
TEMP
G Engine: Return to the original
trouble condition
G Change the engine coolant tem-
perature using CONSULT-II.
If trouble symptom disappears, see
CHECK ITEM.
G Harness and connectors
G Engine coolant temperature sen-
sor
G Fuel injectors
FUEL PUMP
RELAY
G Ignition switch: ON (Engine
stopped)
G Turn the fuel pump relay ON
and OFF using CONSULT-II
and listen to operating sound.
Fuel pump relay makes the operat-
ing sound.
G Harness and connectors
G Fuel pump relay
PURG VOL
CONT/V
G Engine: After warming up, run
engine at 1,500 rpm.
G Change the EVAP canister purge
volume control solenoid valve
opening percent using CON-
SULT-II.
Engine speed changes according to
the opening percent.
G Harness and connectors
G Solenoid valve
V/T ASSIGN
ANGLE
G Engine: Return to the original
trouble condition
G Change intake valve timing using
CONSULT-II.
If trouble symptom disappears, see
CHECK ITEM.
G Harness and connectors
G Intake valve timing control sole-
noid valve
EC-1064
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
DTC Work Support Mode
REAL TIME DIAGNOSIS IN DATA MONITOR MODE (RECORDING VEHICLE DATA)
Description
CONSULT-II has two kinds of triggers and they can be selected by touching SETTING in DATA MONITOR
mode.
1. AUTO TRIG (Automatic trigger):
G The malfunction will be identified on the CONSULT-II screen
in real time.
In other words, DTC/1st trip DTC and malfunction item will be
displayed if the malfunction is detected by ECM.
At the moment a malfunction is detected by ECM, MONI-
TOR in DATA MONITOR screen is changed to Recording
Data ... xx% as shown at right, and the data after the mal-
function detection is recorded. Then when the percentage
reached 100%, REAL-TIME DIAG screen is displayed. If
STOP is touched on the screen during Recording Data ...
xx%, REAL-TIME DIAG screen is also displayed.
The recording time after the malfunction detection and the
recording speed can be changed by TRIGGER POINT and
Recording Speed. Refer to CONSULT-II OPERATION MAN-
UAL.
2. MANU TRIG (Manual trigger):
G DTC/1st trip DTC and malfunction item will not be displayed
automatically on CONSULT-II screen even though a malfunc-
tion is detected by ECM.
DATA MONITOR can be performed continuously even though
a malfunction is detected.
Operation
1. AUTO TRIG
G While trying to detect the DTC/1st trip DTC by performing the DTC Confirmation Procedure, be sure
to select to DATA MONITOR (AUTO TRIG) mode. You can confirm the malfunction at the moment it is
detected.
G While narrowing down the possible causes, CONSULT-II should be set in DATA MONITOR (AUTO
TRIG) mode, especially in case the incident is intermittent.
When you are inspecting the circuit by gently shaking (or twisting) the suspicious connectors, compo-
nents and harness in the DTC Confirmation Procedure, the moment a malfunction is found the DTC/
1st trip DTC will be displayed. (Refer to Incident Simulation Tests in GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient
Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident" .)
2. MANU TRIG
G If the malfunction is displayed as soon as DATA MONITOR is selected, reset CONSULT-II to MANU
TRIG. By selecting MANU TRIG you can monitor and store the data. The data can be utilized for fur-
ther diagnosis, such as a comparison with the value for the normal operating condition.
Test mode Test item Condition Reference page
HO2S1
HO2S1 (B1) P0133
Refer to corresponding
trouble diagnosis for
DTC.
EC-1125
HO2S1 (B1) P0134 EC-1135
HO2S1 (B1) P1143 EC-1266
HO2S1 (B1) P1144 EC-1272
H02S2
HO2S2 (B1) P0139 EC-1149
HO2S2 (B1) P1146 EC-1278
HO2S2 (B1) P1147 EC-1286
SEF705Y
SEF707X
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1065
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Generic Scan Tool (GST) Function EBS00F27
DESCRIPTION
Generic Scan Tool (OBDII scan tool) complying with SAE J1978 has
8 different functions explained below.
ISO9141 is used as the protocol.
The name GST or Generic Scan Tool is used in this service man-
ual.
FUNCTION
PBIB0197E
SEF139P
Diagnostic test mode Function
MODE 1 READINESS TESTS
This mode gains access to current emission-related data values, including analog inputs
and outputs, digital inputs and outputs, and system status information.
MODE 2 (FREEZE DATA)
This mode gains access to emission-related data value which were stored by ECM during
the freeze frame. For details, refer to EC-1008, "FREEZE FRAME DATA AND 1ST TRIP
FREEZE FRAME DATA" .
MODE 3 DTCs
This mode gains access to emission-related power train trouble codes which were stored
by ECM.
EC-1066
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
GST INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Connect GST to data link connector, which is located under
drivers side dash panel near the fuse box cover.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Enter the program according to instruction on the screen or in
the operation manual.
(*: Regarding GST screens in this section, sample screens are
shown.)
5. Perform each diagnostic mode according to each service proce-
dure.
For further information, see the GST Operation Manual of the
tool maker.
MODE 4 CLEAR DIAG INFO
This mode can clear all emission-related diagnostic information. This includes:
G Clear number of diagnostic trouble codes (MODE 1)
G Clear diagnostic trouble codes (MODE 3)
G Clear trouble code for freeze frame data (MODE 1)
G Clear freeze frame data (MODE 2)
G Reset status of system monitoring test (MODE 1)
G Clear on board monitoring test results (MODE 6 and 7)
MODE 6 (ON BOARD TESTS)
This mode accesses the results of on board diagnostic monitoring tests of specific com-
ponents/systems that are not continuously monitored.
MODE 7 (ON BOARD TESTS)
This mode enables the off board test drive to obtain test results for emission-related pow-
ertrain components/systems that are continuously monitored during normal driving condi-
tions.
MODE 8 This mode is not applicable on this vehicle.
MODE 9 (CALIBRATION ID)
This mode enables the off-board test device to request specific vehicle information such
as Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) and Calibration IDs.
Diagnostic test mode Function
MBIB0156E
SEF398S
SEF416S
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1067
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00F28
Remarks:
G Specification data are reference values.
G Specification data are output/input values which are detected or supplied by the ECM at the connector.
* Specification data may not be directly related to their components signals/values/operations.
i.e. Adjust ignition timing with a timing light before monitoring IGN TIMING, because the monitor may show the specification data in
spite of the ignition timing not being adjusted to the specification data. This IGN TIMING monitors the data calculated by the ECM
according to the signals input from the camshaft position sensor and other ignition timing related sensors.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
ENG SPEED
G Tachometer: Connect
G Run engine and compare tachometer indication with the CONSULT-II
value.
Almost the same speed as the
CONSULT-II value.
MAS A/F SE-B1
G Engine: After warming up
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Shift lever: N
G No-load
Idle Approx. 1.1 - 1.5V
2,500 rpm Approx. 1.6 - 2.0V
B/FUEL SCHDL
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 2.5 - 3.5 msec
2,000 rpm 2.5 - 3.5 msec
A/F ALPHA-B1 G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
54% - 155%
COOLAN TEMP/S G Engine: After warming up More than 70C (158F)
HO2S1 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S2 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times dur-
ing 10 seconds.
HO2S2 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
LEAN RICH
VEH SPEED SE
G Turn drive wheels and compare speedometer indication with the CON-
SULT-II value.
Almost the same speed as the
CONSULT-II value
BATTERY VOLT G Ignition switch: ON (Engine stopped) 11 - 14V
ACCEL SEN1
ACCEL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed More than 3.9V
THRTL SEN1
THRTL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released More than 0.36V
G Shift lever:
D (CVTCVT model)
1st (M/T model)
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
START SIGNAL G Ignition switch: ON START ON OFF ON OFF
CLSD THL POS G Ignition switch: ON
Accelerator pedal: Fully released ON
Accelerator pedal: Slightly depressed OFF
AIR COND SIG
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Air conditioner switch: OFF OFF
Air conditioner switch: ON
(Compressor operates.)
ON
P/N POSI SW G Ignition switch: ON
Shift lever:
P or N (CVT model)
Neutral (M/T model)
ON
Shift lever: Except above OFF
EC-1068
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
PW/ST SIGNAL
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Steering wheel is in neutral position.
(Forward direction)
OFF
Steering wheel is turned. ON
LOAD SIGNAL G Ignition switch: ON
Rear window defogger switch is ON
and/or lighting switch is in 2nd.
ON
Rear window defogger switch is OFF
and lighting switch is OFF.
OFF
IGNITION SW G Ignition switch: ON OFF ON ON OFF ON
HEATER FAN SW
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Heater fan is operating. ON
Heater fan is not operating OFF
BRAKE SW G Ignition switch: ON
Brake pedal: Fully released OFF
Brake pedal: Slightly depressed ON
INJ PULSE-B1
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 2.0 - 3.0 msec
2,000 rpm 1.9 - 2.9 msec
IGN TIMING
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle
M/T 12 - 16 BTDC
CVT 13 - 17 BTDC
2,000 rpm 25 - 45 BTDC
CAL/LD VALUE
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 10% - 35%
2,500 rpm 10% - 35%
MASS AIRFLOW
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 1.0 - 4.0 gm/s
2,500 rpm 4.0 - 10.0 gm/s
PURG VOL C/V
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 0%
2,000 rpm 20 - 30%
INT/V TIM (B1)
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 5 - 5CA
When revving up to 2,000 rpm quickly Approx. 0 - 20CA
INT/V SOL (B1)
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 0% - 2%
When revving up to 2,000 rpm quickly Approx. 0% - 50%
AIR COND RLY
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Air conditioner switch: OFF OFF
Air conditioner switch: ON
(Compressor operates)
ON
FUEL PUMP RLY
G For 1 seconds after turning ignition switch ON
G Engine running or cranking
ON
G Except above conditions OFF
THRTL RELAY G Ignition switch: ON ON
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1069
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
COOLING FAN
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
Engine coolant temperature is 94C
(201F) or less
OFF
Engine coolant temperature is
between 95C (203F) and 99C
(210F)
LOW
Engine coolant temperature is 100C
(212F) or more
HIGH
HO2S1 HTR (B1)
G Engine: After warming up
G Engine speed: Below 3,600 rpm
ON
G Engine speed: Above 3,600 rpm OFF
HO2S2 HTR (B1)
G Engine speed: Below 3,800 rpm [After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of
70 km/h (43 MPH) or more]
ON
G Engine speed: Above 3,800 rpm OFF
I/P PULLY SPD G Vehicle speed: More than 20 km/h
Almost the same speed as the
CONSULT-II value
VEHICLE SPEED
G Turn drive wheels and compare speedometer indication with the CON-
SULT-II value.
Almost the same speed as the
CONSULT-II value
TRVL AFTER MIL G Ignition switch: ON
Vehicle has traveled after MIL has
turned ON.
0 - 65,535 km
(0 - 40,723 mile)
O2SEN HTR DTY
G Engine coolant temperature when engine started: More than 80C
(176F)
G Engine speed: below 3,600 rpm
Approx. 50 %
AC PRESS SEN
G Ignition switch: ON (Engine stopped) Approx. 0V
G Engine: Idle
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
1.0 - 4.0V
VEH SPEED SE
G Turn drive wheels and compare speedometer indication with the CON-
SULT-II value.
Almost the same speed as the
CONSULT-II value
SET VHCL SPD G Engine: Running ICC: Operating
The preset vehicle speed is dis-
played.
MAIN SW G Ignition switch: ON
ON/OFF switch: Depressed ON
ON/OFF switch: Released OFF
CANCEL SW G Ignition switch: ON
CANCEL switch: Depressed ON
CANCEL switch: Released OFF
RESUME/ACC SW G Ignition switch: ON
ACCEL/RES switch: Depressed ON
ACCEL/RES switch: Released OFF
SET SW G Ignition switch: ON
COAST/SET switch: Depressed ON
COAST/SET switch: Released OFF
BRAKE SW1 G Ignition switch: ON
Brake pedal: Fully released ON
Brake pedal: Slightly depressed OFF
BRAKE SW2 G Ignition switch: ON
Brake pedal: Fully released OFF
Brake pedal: Slightly depressed ON
DIST SW G Ignition switch: ON
DISTANCE switch: Depressed ON
DISTANCE switch: Released OFF
CRUISE LAMP G Ignition switch: ON
CRUISE lamp: Illuminated ON
CRUISE lamp: Not illuminated OFF
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
EC-1070
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Major Sensor Reference Graph in Data Monitor Mode EBS00F29
The following are the major sensor reference graphs in DATA MONITOR mode.
CLSD THL POS, ACCEL SEN 1, THRTL SEN 1
Below is the data for CLSD THL POS, ACCEL SEN 1 and THRTL SEN 1 when depressing the accelera-
tor pedal with the ignition switch ON and with selector lever in D position (CVT models) or with shift lever in
1st position (M/T models).
The signal of ACCEL SEN 1 and THRTL SEN 1 should rise gradually without any intermittent drop or rise
after CLSD THL POS is changed from ON to OFF.
ENG SPEED, MAS A/F SE-B1, THRTL SEN 1, HO2S2 (B1), HO2S1 (B1), INJ PULSE-B1
Below is the data for ENG SPEED, MAS A/F SE-B1, THRTL SEN 1, HO2S2 (B1), HO2S1 (B1) and
INJ PULSE-B1 when revving engine quickly up to 4,800 rpm under no load after warming up engine suffi-
ciently.
Each value is for reference, the exact value may vary.
CAN COMM
G Ignition switch: ON
OK
CAN CIRC 1 OK
CAN CIRC 2 OK or ONKWN
CAN CIRC 3 OK
CAN CIRC 4 OK
CAN CIRC 5 OK or UNKWN
CAN CIRC 6 OK
CAN CIRC 7 UNKWN
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
PBIB0198E
SEF241Y
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1071
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
PBIB0668E
EC-1072
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE PFP:00031
Description EBS00F2A
The specification (SP) value indicates the tolerance of the value that is displayed in DATA MONITOR (SPEC)
mode of CONSULT-II during normal operation of the Engine Control System. When the value in DATA MONI-
TOR (SPEC) mode is within the SP value, the Engine Control System is confirmed OK. When the value in
DATA MONITOR (SPEC) mode is NOT within the SP value, the Engine Control System may have one or
more malfunctions.
The SP value is used to detect malfunctions that may affect the Engine Control System, but will not light the
MIL.
The SP value will be displayed for the following three items:
G B/FUEL SCHDL (The fuel injection pulse width programmed into ECM prior to any learned on board cor-
rection)
G A/F ALPHA-B1 (The mean value of air-fuel ratio feedback correction factor per cycle)
G MAS A/F SE-B1 (The signal voltage of the mass air flow sensor)
Testing Condition EBS00F2B
G Vehicle driven distance: More than 5,000 km (3,017 miles)
G Barometric pressure: 98.3 - 104.3 kPa (0.983 - 1.043 bar, 1.003 - 1.064 kg/cm
2
, 14.25 - 15.12 psi)
G Atmospheric temperature: 20 - 30C (68 - 86F)
G Engine coolant temperature: 75 - 95C (167 - 203F)
G Transmission: Warmed-up*
1
G Electrical load: Not applied*
2
G Engine speed: Idle
*1: For CVT models with CONSULT-II, after the engine is warmed up to normal operating temperature, drive
vehicle until FLUID TEMP SE (CVT fluid temperature sensor signal) indicates more than 60C (140F).
For CVT models without CONSUT-II and M/T models, after the engine is warmed up to normal operating tem-
perature, drive vehicle for 5 minutes.
*2: Rear window defogger switch, air conditioner switch, lighting switch are OFF. Steering wheel is straight
ahead.
Inspection Procedure EBS00F2C
NOTE:
Perform DATA MONITOR (SPEC) mode in maximum scale display.
1. Perform EC-1032, "Basic Inspection" .
2. Confirm that the testing conditions indicated above are met.
3. Select B/FUEL SCHDL, A/F ALPHA-B1 and MAS A/F SE-
B1 in DATA MONITOR (SPEC) mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Make sure that monitor items are within the SP value.
5. If NG, go to EC-1073, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF601Z
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE
EC-1073
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00F2D
SEF613ZD
EC-1074
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE
SEF768Z
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE
EC-1075
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
SEF615ZA
EC-1076
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT PFP:00006
Description EBS00F2E
Intermittent incidents (I/I) may occur. In many cases, the problem resolves itself (the part or circuit function
returns to normal without intervention). It is important to realize that the symptoms described in the customer's
complaint often do not recur on (1st trip) DTC visits. Realize also that the most frequent cause of I/I occur-
rences is poor electrical connections. Because of this, the conditions under which the incident occurred may
not be clear. Therefore, circuit checks made as part of the standard diagnostic procedure may not indicate the
specific problem area.
Common I/I Report Situations
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00F2F
1. INSPECTION START
Erase (1st trip) DTCs. Refer to EC-1015, "HOW TO ERASE EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMA-
TION" .
>> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK GROUND TERMINALS
Check ground terminals for corroding or loose connection.
Refer to GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident" , "Incident Simulation Tests",
Ground Inspection.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
3. SEARCH FOR ELECTRICAL INCIDENT
Perform GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident" , "Incident Simulation Tests".
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> Repair or replace.
STEP in Work Flow Situation
II The CONSULT-II is used. The SELF-DIAG RESULTS screen shows time data other than 0 or [1t].
III The symptom described by the customer does not recur.
IV (1st trip) DTC does not appear during the DTC Confirmation Procedure.
VI The Diagnostic Procedure for PXXXX does not indicate the problem area.
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
EC-1077
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM PFP:24110
Wiring Diagram EBS00F2G
MBWA0003E
EC-1078
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GKE
1. INSPECTION START
Start engine.
Is engine running?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 8.
No >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-I
1. Turn ignition switch OFF and then ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 109 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Fuse block (J/B) connector M1
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between ECM and fuse
>> Repair harness or connectors.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
1
115
116
B
B
B
ECM ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Engine ground
109 B/R Ignition switch
[Ignition switch OFF] 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
111 W/G
ECM relay
(Self shut-off)
[Engine is running]
[Ignition switch OFF]
G For 5 seconds after turning ignition switch OFF
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch OFF]
G 5 seconds passed after turning ignition switch
OFF
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
119
120
W/R
W/R
Power supply for
ECM
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0015E
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
EC-1079
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. CHECK ECM GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT-I
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals 1, 115, 116 and engine ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-II
1. Disconnect ECM relay.
2. Check voltage between ECM relay terminals 1 and 6 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
6. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness connectors E70, F13 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E63, F31 (RHD models)
G 10A fuse
G 20A fuse
G Harness for open or short between ECM relay and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0155E
Voltage: Battery voltage
SEF420X
EC-1080
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
7. CHECK OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 111 and ECM relay terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> Go to EC-1365, "IGNITION SIGNAL" .
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-III
1. Stop engine and wait at least 10 seconds.
2. Turn ignition switch ON and then OFF.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminals 119, 120 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG (Battery voltage does not exist.)>>GO TO 9.
NG (Battery voltage exists for more than a few seconds.)>>GO TO 11.
9. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-IV
1. Disconnect ECM relay.
2. Check voltage between ECM relay terminal 3 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> GO TO 10.
Continuity should exist.
Voltage: After turning ignition switch OFF, battery
voltage will exist for a few seconds, then
drop approximately 0V.
MBIB0016E
MBIB0155E
Voltage: Battery voltage
SEF860T
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
EC-1081
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
10. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness for open or short between ECM relay and 10A fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
11. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-V
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals 119, 120 and ECM relay terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
12. CHECK ECM RELAY
Refer to EC-1082, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> Replace ECM relay.
13. CHECK ECM GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT-II
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals 1, 115, 116 and engine ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
14. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
EC-1082
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
Component Inspection EBS00GKF
ECM RELAY
1. Apply 12V direct current between ECM relay terminals 1 and 2.
2. Check continuity between relay terminals 3 and 5, 6 and 7.
3. If NG, replace ECM relay.
Condition Continuity
12V direct current supply
between terminals 1 and
2
Yes
OFF No
PBIB0077E
DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE
EC-1083
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE PFP:23710
Description EBS00F2I
CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real time application. It is an on-vehicle mul-
tiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent error detection ability. Many elec-
tronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links with other
control units during operation (not independent). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2
communication lines (CAN H line, CAN L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission with less wiring.
Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00F2J
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00F2K
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 3 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1085, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
DTC No.
Trouble diagnosis
name
DTC detecting condition Possible cause
U1000
1000
CAN communication
line
G ECM cannot communicate to other control
unit.
G ECM cannot communicate for more than the
specified time.
G Harness or connectors
(CAN communication line is open or
shorted.)
U1001
1001
EC-1084
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE
Wiring Diagram EBS00F2L
MBWA0038E
DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE
EC-1085
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00F2M
1. INSPECTION START
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Print out the CONSULT-II screen.
CVT Models with ESP and ICC
CVT Models with ESP without ICC
CVT models without ESP and ICC
M/T Models with ESP
MBIB0174E
MBIB0122E
MBIB0180E
MBIB0123E
EC-1086
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE
M/T models without ESP
>> Go to LAN-8, "CAN COMMUNICATION" .
MBIB0179E
DTC P0011 IVT CONTROL
EC-1087
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0011 IVT CONTROL PFP:23796
Description EBS00F2N
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
*: This signal is sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
This mechanism hydraulically controls cam phases continuously with the fixed operating angle of the intake
valve.
The ECM receives signals such as crankshaft position, camshaft position, engine speed, and engine coolant
temperature. Then, the ECM sends ON/OFF pulse duty signals to the intake valve timing control solenoid
valve depending on driving status. This makes it possible to control the shut/open timing of the intake valve to
increase engine torque in low/mid speed range and output in high-speed range.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00F2O
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Engine speed
Intake valve
timing control
Intake valve timing control
solenoid valve
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Vehicle speed signal* Vehicle speed
PBIB0540E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
INT/V TIM (B1)
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 5 - 5CA
When revving up to 2,000 rpm quickly Approx. 0 - 20CA
INT/V SOL (B1)
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 0% - 2%
When revving up to 2,000 rpm quickly Approx. 0% - 50%
EC-1088
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0011 IVT CONTROL
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00F2P
FAIL-SAFE MODE
ECM enters in fail-safe mode when the malfunction is detected.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00F2Q
CAUTION:
Always drive at a safe speed.
NOTE:
G If DTC P0011 is displayed with DTC P1111, first perform trouble diagnosis for "DTC P1111". See
EC-1242 .
G If "DTC Confirmation Procedure" has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch "OFF" and
wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is between 10V and 16V at
idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch "ON".
2. Select "DATA MONITOR" mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Maintain the following conditions for at least 20 consecutive sec-
onds.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1088, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure "WITH CONSULT-II" above.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00F2R
1. CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (POS)
Refer to EC-1210, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Replace crankshaft position sensor (POS).
DTC No.
Trouble diagnosis
name
Detecting condition Possible cause
P0011
0011
Intake valve timing
control performance
There is a gap between angle of target and
phase-control angle degree.
G Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
G Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
G Accumulation of debris to the signal pick-up
portion of the camshaft
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
Intake valve timing control The signal is not energized to the solenoid valve and the valve control does not function
ENG SPEED 2,000 - 3,175 rpm (A constant rotation is maintained.)
COOLANT TEMPS 80 - 90C (176 - 194F)
Selector lever 1st or 2nd position
Driving location uphill
Driving vehicle uphill
(Increased engine load will help maintain the driving
conditions required for this test.)
SEF174Y
DTC P0011 IVT CONTROL
EC-1089
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (PHASE)
Refer to EC-1216, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Replace camshaft position sensor (PHASE).
3. CHECK CAMSHAFT (INTAKE)
Check the following.
G Accumulation of debris to the signal plate of camshaft rear end
G Chipping signal plate of camshaft rear end
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Remove debris and clean the signal plate of camshaft
rear end or replace camshaft.
4. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
For wiring diagram refer to CKP sensor (POS) EC-1207 and CMP sensor (PHASE) EC-1213 .
>> INSPECTION END
PBIB0565E
EC-1090
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0031, P0032 HO2S1 HEATER
DTC P0031, P0032 HO2S1 HEATER PFP:22690
Description EBS00GBD
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM performs ON/OFF duty control of the heated oxygen sensor 1 heater corresponding to the engine
speed and engine coolant temperature. The duty percent varies with engine coolant temperature when engine
is started.
OPERATION
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GBE
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GBF
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GBG
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is between 10.5V and 16V at
idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Engine speed
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater control
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Engine speed rpm Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
Above 3,600 OFF
Below 3,600 ON
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 HTR (B1)
G Engine: After warming up
G Engine speed: Below 3,600 rpm
ON
G Engine speed: Above 3,600 rpm OFF
DTC No.
Trouble diagnosis
name
DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0031
0031
Heated oxygen
sensor 1 heater
control circuit low
The current amperage in the heated oxygen
sensor 1 heater circuit is out of the normal
range.
(An excessively low voltage signal is sent to
ECM through the heated oxygen sensor 1
heater.)
G Harness or connectors
(The heated oxygen sensor 1 heater circuit is
open or shorted.)
G Heater oxygen sensor 1 heater
P0032
0032
Heated oxygen
sensor 1 heater
control circuit high
The current amperage in the heated oxygen
sensor 1 heater circuit is out of the normal
range.
(An excessively high voltage signal is sent to
ECM through the heated oxygen sensor 1
heater.)
G Harness or connectors
(The heated oxygen sensor 1 heater circuit is
shorted.)
G Heater oxygen sensor 1 heater
DTC P0031, P0032 HO2S1 HEATER
EC-1091
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select DATA MONITOR mode
with CONSULT-II.
4. Start engine and run it for at least 6 seconds at idle speed.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1093, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Start engine and run it for at least 6 seconds at idle speed.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
5. Start engine and run it for at least 6 seconds at idle speed.
6. Select MODE 3 with GST.
7. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1093, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
G When using GST, DTC Confirmation Procedure should be performed twice as much as when
using CONSULT-II because GST cannot display MODE 7 (1st trip DTC) concerning this diagnosis.
Therefore, using CONSULT-II is recommended.
SEF058Y
EC-1092
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0031, P0032 HO2S1 HEATER
Wiring Diagram EBS00GBH
MBWA0009E
DTC P0031, P0032 HO2S1 HEATER
EC-1093
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GBI
1. CHECK HO2S1 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between HO2S1 terminal 4 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Fuse block (J/B) connector E106
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between heated oxygen sensor 1 and fuse
>> Repair harness or connectors.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
24 P/L
Heated oxygen sen-
sor 1 heater
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition.
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm.
Approximately 7.0V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
PBIB0519E
MBIB0151E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0541E
EC-1094
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0031, P0032 HO2S1 HEATER
3. CHECK HO2S1 OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 24 and HO2S1 terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 HEATER
Refer to EC-1094, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GBJ
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 HEATER
1. Check resistance between HO2S1 terminals as follows.
2. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard sur-
face such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system
threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread Cleaner tool J-43897-
18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00GBK
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-121, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND THREE WAY CATALYST" .
Continuity should exist.
Terminal No. Resistance
1 and 4 2.3 - 4.3 at 25C (77F)
2 and 1, 3, 4

(Continuity should not exist)
3 and 1, 2, 4
PBIB0542E
DTC P0037, P0038 HO2S2 HEATER
EC-1095
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0037, P0038 HO2S2 HEATER PFP:226A0
Description EBS00GBL
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM performs ON/OFF control of the heated oxygen sensor 2 heater corresponding to the engine speed.
OPERATION
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GBM
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GBN
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GBO
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is between 10.5V and 16V at
idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine.
3. Drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater control
Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Engine speed rpm Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
Above 3,800 OFF
Below 3,800 ON
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S2 HTR (B1)
G Engine speed: Below 3,800 rpm [After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of
70 km/h (43 MPH) or more]
ON
G Engine speed: Above 3,800 rpm OFF
DTC No.
Trouble diagnosis
name
DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0037
0037
Heated oxygen
sensor 2 heater
control circuit low
The current amperage in the heated oxygen sen-
sor 2 heater circuit is out of the normal range.
(An excessively low voltage signal is sent to ECM
through the heated oxygen sensor 2 heater.)
G Harness or connectors
(The heated oxygen sensor 2 heater circuit is
open or shorted.)
G Heater oxygen sensor 2 heater
P0038
0038
Heated oxygen
sensor 2 heater
control circuit high
The current amperage in the heated oxygen sen-
sor 2 heater circuit is out of the normal range.
(An excessively high voltage signal is sent to
ECM through the heated oxygen sensor 2
heater.)
G Harness or connectors
(The heated oxygen sensor 2 heater circuit is
shorted.)
G Heater oxygen sensor 2 heater
EC-1096
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0037, P0038 HO2S2 HEATER
4. Stop vehicle and let engine idle for at least 6 seconds.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1098, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
WITH GST
1. Start engine.
2. Drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
3. Stop vehicle and let engine idle for at least 6 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
5. Start engine.
6. Drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
7. Stop vehicle and let engine idle for at least 6 seconds.
8. Select MODE 3 with GST.
9. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1098, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
G When using GST, DTC Confirmation Procedure should be performed twice as much as when
using CONSULT-II because GST cannot display MODE 7 (1st trip DTC) concerning this diagnosis.
Therefore, using CONSULT-II is recommended.
SEF058Y
DTC P0037, P0038 HO2S2 HEATER
EC-1097
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GBP
MBWA0011E
EC-1098
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0037, P0038 HO2S2 HEATER
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GBQ
1. CHECK HO2S2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between HO2S2 terminal 4 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Fuse block (J/B) connector E106
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between heated oxygen sensor 2 and fuse
>> Repair harness or connectors.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
2 R/W
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is below 3,800 rpm.
G After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of 70 km/h
(43 MPH) or more.
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,800 rpm.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
MBIB0151E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0541E
DTC P0037, P0038 HO2S2 HEATER
EC-1099
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK HO2S2 OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 2 and HO2S2 terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2 HEATER
Refer to EC-1099, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GBR
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2 HEATER
1. Check resistance between HO2S2 terminals as follows.
2. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard sur-
face such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system
threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread Cleaner tool J-43897-
18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00GBS
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EX-3, "EXHAUST SYSTEM" .
Continuity should exist.
Terminal No. Resistance
1 and 4 2.3 - 4.3 at 25C (77F)
2 and 1, 3, 4

(Continuity should not exist)
3 and 1, 2, 4
PBIB0542E
EC-1100
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR PFP:22680
Component Description EBS00GBT
The mass air flow sensor is placed in the stream of intake air. It mea-
sures the intake flow rate by measuring a part of the entire intake
flow. It consists of a hot film that is supplied with electric current from
the ECM. The temperature of the hot film is controlled by the ECM a
certain amount. The heat generated by the hot film is reduced as the
intake air flows around it. The more air, the greater the heat loss.
Therefore, the ECM must supply more electric current to maintain
the temperature of the hot film as air flow increases. The ECM
detects the air flow by means of this current change.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GBU
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GBV
These self-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GBW
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
SEC266C
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
MAS A/F SE-B1
G Engine: After warming up
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Shift lever: N
G No-load
Idle Approx. 1.1 - 1.5V
2,500 rpm Approx. 1.6 - 2.0V
CAL/LD VALUE
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 10% - 35%
2,500 rpm 10% - 35%
MASS AIRFLOW
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 1.0 - 4.0 gm/s
2,500 rpm 4.0 - 10.0 gm/s
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0102
0102
Mass air flow sensor circuit
low input
An excessively low voltage from the sensor
is sent to ECM when engine is running.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Intake air leaks
G Mass air flow sensor
P0103
0103
Mass air flow sensor circuit
high input
An excessively high voltage from the sensor
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Mass air flow sensor
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
Mass air flow sensor circuit Engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm due to the fuel cut.
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
EC-1101
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
PROCEDURE FOR DTC P0102
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and wait 5 seconds at most.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1103, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
With GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
PROCEDURE FOR DTC P0103
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Wait at least 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1103, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If DTC is not detected, go to next step.
5. Start engine and wait at least 5 seconds.
6. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1103, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
With GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
SEF058Y
SEF058Y
EC-1102
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00GBX
MBWA0004E
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
EC-1103
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GBY
1. INSPECTION START
Which malfunction (P0102 or P0103) is duplicated?
P0102 or P0103
P0102 >> GO TO 2.
P0103 >> GO TO 3.
2. CHECK INTAKE SYSTEM
Check the following for connection.
G Air duct
G Vacuum hoses
G Intake air passage between air duct to intake manifold
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Reconnect the parts.
3. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 4.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
45 R Sensor's power supply [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
50 B Mass air flow sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.1 - 1.5V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,500 rpm.
1.6 - 2.0V
54 W
Sensor's ground
(Mass air flow sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0142E
EC-1104
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
4. CHECK MAF SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect MAF sensor harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between MAF sensor terminals 2, 4 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between mass air flow sensor and ECM
G Harness for open or short between mass air flow sensor and ECM relay
>> Repair harness or connectors.
6. CHECK MAF SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between MAF sensor terminal 3 and ECM terminal 54.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK MAF SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between MAF sensor terminal 1 and ECM terminal 50.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0131E
Terminal Voltage
2 Approximately 5V
4 Battery voltage
PBIB0076E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
EC-1105
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
8. CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EC-1105, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace mass air flow sensor.
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GBZ
MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
1. Reconnect harness connectors disconnected.
2. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminal 50 (Mass air flow sensor
signal) and ground.
*: Check for liner voltage rise in response to engine being increased to about
4,000 rpm.
4. If the voltage is out of specification, proceed the following.
a. Turn ignition switch OFF.
b. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector and reconnect it again.
c. Perform steps 2 and 3 again.
5. If NG, remove mass air flow sensor from air duct. Check hot film for damage or dust.
6. If NG, clean or replace mass air flow sensor.
Removal and Installation EBS00GC0
MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EM-114, "AIR CLEANER AND AIR DUCT" .
Condition Voltage V
Ignition switch ON (Engine stopped.) Approx. 1.0
Idle (Engine is warmed-up to normal operating
temperature.)
1.1 - 1.5
2,500 rpm (Engine is warmed-up to normal
operating temperature.)
1.6 - 2.0
Idle to about 4,000 rpm* 1.5 - 2.0 to Approx. 4.0
MBIB0017E
EC-1106
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0112, P0113 IAT SENSOR
DTC P0112, P0113 IAT SENSOR PFP:22630
Component Description EBS00GC1
The intake air temperature sensor is built into mass air flow sensor.
The sensor detects intake air temperature and transmits a signal to
the ECM.
The temperature sensing unit uses a thermistor which is sensitive to
the change in temperature. Electrical resistance of the thermistor
decreases in response to the temperature rise.
<Reference data>
*: These data are reference values and are measured between ECM terminal 34
(Intake air temperature sensor) and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output
voltage. Doing so may result in damage to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM termi-
nals, such as the ground.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GC2
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GC3
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
SEC266C
Intake air
temperature C (F)
Voltage* V Resistance k
10 (14) 4.43 7.9 - 9.3
25 (77) 3.32 1.9 - 2.1
80 (176) 1.23 0.31 - 0.37
SEF012P
DTC No.
Trouble diagnosis
name
DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0112
0112
Intake air tempera-
ture sensor circuit
low input
An excessively low voltage from the sensor is
sent to ECM. G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Intake air temperature sensor P0113
0113
Intake air tempera-
ture sensor circuit
high input
An excessively high voltage from the sensor is
sent to ECM.
DTC P0112, P0113 IAT SENSOR
EC-1107
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Wait at least 5 seconds.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1103, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
SEF058Y
EC-1108
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0112, P0113 IAT SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00GC4
MBWA0005E
DTC P0112, P0113 IAT SENSOR
EC-1109
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GC5
1. CHECK INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect mass air flow sensor (intake air temperature sensor
is built-into) harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between MAF sensor terminal 5 and ground.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair harness or connectors.
2. CHECK INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between MAF sensor terminal 3 and ECM terminal 54.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair harness or connectors.
3. CHECK INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Refer to EC-1105, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Replace mass air flow sensor (with intake air temperature sensor).
4. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
MBIB0131E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0066E
Continuity should exist.
EC-1110
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0112, P0113 IAT SENSOR
Component Inspection EBS00GC6
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Check resistance between mass air flow sensor terminals 3 and
5 under the following conditions.
2. If NG, replace mass air flow sensor (with intake air temperature
sensor).
Removal and Installation EBS00GC7
MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EM-114, "AIR CLEANER AND AIR DUCT" .
Intake air temperature C (F) Resistance k
25 (77) 1.9 - 2.1
SEC266C
SEF012P
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR
EC-1111
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR PFP:22630
Component Description EBS00GC8
The engine coolant temperature sensor is used to detect the engine
coolant temperature. The sensor modifies a voltage signal from the
ECM. The modified signal returns to the ECM as the engine coolant
temperature input. The sensor uses a thermistor which is sensitive to
the change in temperature. The electrical resistance of the ther-
mistor decreases as temperature increases.
<Reference data>
*: These data are reference values and are measured between ECM terminal 72
(Engine coolant temperature sensor) and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GC9
These self-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When this malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
SEF594K
Engine coolant
temperature C (F)
Voltage* V Resistance k
10 (14) 4.4 7.0 - 11.4
20 (68) 3.5 2.1 - 2.9
50 (122) 2.2 0.68 - 1.00
90 (194) 0.9 0.236 - 0.260
SEF012P
DTC No.
Trouble Diagnosis
Name
DTC Detecting Condition Possible Cause
P0117
0117
Engine coolant
temperature sen-
sor circuit low input
An excessively low voltage from the sensor is
sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Engine coolant temperature sensor P0118
0118
Engine coolant
temperature sen-
sor circuit high
input
An excessively high voltage from the sensor is
sent to ECM.
EC-1112
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GCA
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Wait at least 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1114, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
Engine coolant temper-
ature sensor circuit
Engine coolant temperature will be determined by ECM based on the time after turning ignition switch ON
or START. CONSULT-II displays the engine coolant temperature decided by ECM.
Condition
Engine coolant temperature decided
(CONSULT-II display)
Just as ignition switch is turned ON or Start 40C (104F)
More than approx. 4 minutes after ignition ON or
Start
80C (176F)
Except as shown above
40 - 80C (104 - 176F)
(Depends on the time)
When the fail-safe system for engine coolant temperature sensor is activated, the cooling fan operates
while engine is running.
SEF058Y
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR
EC-1113
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GCB
MBWA0006E
EC-1114
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GCC
1. CHECK ECT SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor harness
connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between ECT sensor terminal 1 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
2. CHECK ECT SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between ECT sensor terminal 2 and engine ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between engine coolant temperature sensor and ECM
G Harness for open or short between engine coolant temperature sensor and TCM
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Refer to EC-1115, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace engine coolant temperature sensor.
MBIB0134E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0080E
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR
EC-1115
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GCD
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Check resistance between engine coolant temperature sensor
terminals 1 and 2 as shown in the figure.
<Reference data>
*: These data are reference values and are measured between ECM terminal
72 (Engine coolant temperature sensor) and ground.
2. If NG, replace engine coolant temperature sensor.
Removal and Installation EBS00GCE
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Refer to CO-40, "THERMOSTAT AND WATER CONTROL VALVE" .
PBIB0081E
Engine coolant
temperature C (F)
Voltage* V Resistance k
10 (14) 4.4 7.0 - 11.4
20 (68) 3.5 2.1 - 2.9
50 (122) 2.2 0.68 - 1.00
90 (194) 0.9 0.236 - 0.260
SEF012P
EC-1116
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0127 IAT SENSOR
DTC P0127 IAT SENSOR PFP:22630
Component Description EBS00F3U
The intake air temperature sensor is built into mass air flow sensor.
The sensor detects intake air temperature and transmits a signal to
the ECM.
The temperature sensing unit uses a thermistor which is sensitive to
the change in temperature. Electrical resistance of the thermistor
decreases in response to the temperature rise.
<Reference data>
*: These data are reference values and are measured between ECM terminal 84
(Intake air temperature sensor) and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output
voltage. Doing so may result in damage to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM termi-
nals, such as the ground.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00F3V
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00F3W
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
This test may be conducted with the drive wheels lifted in the shop or by driving the vehicle. If a road
test is expected to be easier, it is unnecessary to lift the vehicle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Wait until engine coolant temperature is less than 90C (194F)
a. Turn ignition switch ON.
SEC266C
Intake air
temperature C (F)
Voltage* V Resistance k
10 (14) 4.43 7.9 - 9.3
25 (77) 3.32 1.9 - 2.1
80 (176) 1.23 0.31 - 0.37
SEF012P
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0127
0127
Intake air temperature
too high
Rationally incorrect voltage from the sensor is
sent to ECM, compared with the voltage signal
from engine coolant temperature sensor.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted)
G Intake air temperature sensor
DTC P0127 IAT SENSOR
EC-1117
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
b. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
c. Check the engine coolant temperature.
d. If the engine coolant temperature is not less than 90C (194F),
turn ignition switch "OFF" and cool down engine.
G Perform the following steps before engine coolant tempera-
ture is above 90C (194F).
2. Turn ignition switch "ON".
3. Select "DATA MONITOR" mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Start engine.
5. Hold vehicle speed at more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 100 con-
secutive seconds.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1117, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00F3X
1. CHECK INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Refer to EC-1117, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Replace mass air flow sensor (with intake air temperature sensor).
2. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
Refer to EC-1108, "Wiring Diagram" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00F3Y
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Check resistance between mass air flow sensor terminals 3 and
5 under the following conditions.
2. If NG, replace mass air flow sensor (with intake air temperature
sensor).
SEF058Y
Intake air temperature C (F) Resistance k
25 (77) 1.9 - 2.1
SEC266C
SEF012P
EC-1118
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0127 IAT SENSOR
Removal and Installation EBS00F3Z
MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EM-114, "AIR CLEANER AND AIR DUCT" .
DTC P0132 HO2S1
EC-1119
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0132 HO2S1 PFP:22690
Component Description EBS00GCF
The heated oxygen sensor 1 is placed into the exhaust manifold. It
detects the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas compared to the
outside air. The heated oxygen sensor 1 has a closed-end tube
made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from
approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner conditions. The
heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM adjusts
the injection pulse duration to achieve the ideal air-fuel ratio. The
ideal air-fuel ratio occurs near the radical change from 1V to 0V.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GCG
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GCH
To judge the malfunction, the diagnosis checks that the heated oxy-
gen sensor 1 output is not inordinately high.
SEF463R
SEF288D
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 (B1) G Engine: After warming up Maintaining engine speed at 2,000 rpm 0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up Maintaining engine speed at 2,000 rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times during
10 seconds.
SEF301UA
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0132
0132
Heated oxygen sensor 1
circuit high voltage
An excessively high voltage from the sensor
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
EC-1120
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0132 HO2S1
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GCI
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
5. Restart engine and let it idle for 2 minutes.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1122, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Restart engine and let it idle for 2 minutes.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
5. Restart engine and let it idle for 2 minutes.
6. Select MODE 3 with GST.
7. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1122, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
G When using GST, DTC Confirmation Procedure should be performed twice as much as when
using CONSULT-II because GST cannot display MODE 7 (1st trip DTC) concerning this diagnosis.
Therefore, using CONSULT-II is recommended.
SEF174Y
DTC P0132 HO2S1
EC-1121
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GCJ
MBWA0008E
EC-1122
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0132 HO2S1
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GCK
1. RETIGHTEN HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Loosen and retighten heated oxygen sensor 1.
>> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK HO2S1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S1
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
35 PU Heated oxygen sensor 1
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
74 B Sensors' ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
Tightening torque: 40 - 50 Nm (4.1 - 5.1 kg-m, 30 - 37 ft-lb)
MBIB0150E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0151E
DTC P0132 HO2S1
EC-1123
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK HO2S1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 and HO2S1 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 or HO2S1 terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK HO2S1 CONNECTOR FOR WATER
Check heated oxygen sensor 1 connectors for water.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-1123, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GCL
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG and adjust TRIGGER POINT to 100% in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-
II.
3. Select HO2S1 (B1) and HO2S1 MNTR (B1).
4. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load during the follow-
ing steps.
5. Touch RECORD on CONSULT-II screen.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
Water should not exist.
SEF646Y
EC-1124
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0132 HO2S1
6. Check the following.
G HO2S1 MNTR (B1) in DATA MONITOR mode changes
from RICH to LEAN to RICH 5 times in 10 seconds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes below 0.3V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] and engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
G The voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new
one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00GCM
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-121, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND THREE WAY CATALYST" .
SEF217YA
SEF648Y
MBIB0018E
DTC P0133 HO2S1
EC-1125
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0133 HO2S1 PFP:22690
Component Description EBS00GCN
The heated oxygen sensor 1 is placed into the exhaust manifold. It
detects the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas compared to the
outside air. The heated oxygen sensor 1 has a closed-end tube
made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from
approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner conditions. The
heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM adjusts
the injection pulse duration to achieve the ideal air-fuel ratio. The
ideal air-fuel ratio occurs near the radical change from 1V to 0V.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GCO
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GCP
To judge the malfunction of heated oxygen sensor 1, this diagnosis
measures response time of heated oxygen sensor 1 signal. The time
is compensated by engine operating (speed and load), fuel feedback
control constant, and heated oxygen sensor 1 temperature index.
Judgment is based on whether the compensated time (heated oxy-
gen sensor 1 cycling time index) is inordinately long or not.
SEF463R
SEF288D
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times dur-
ing 10 seconds.
SEF010V
EC-1126
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0133 HO2S1
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GCQ
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
G Always perform at a temperature above 10C (14F).
G Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Stop engine and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select HO2S1 (B1) P0133 of HO2S1 in DTC WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch START.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 3 minutes.
NOTE:
Never raise engine speed above 3,600 rpm after this step. If
the engine speed limit is exceeded, return to step 5.
6. When the following conditions are met, TESTING will be dis-
played on the CONSULT-II screen. Maintain the conditions con-
tinuously until TESTING changes to COMPLETED. (It will
take approximately 20 to 50 seconds.)
If TESTING is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from
step 2.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0133
0133
Heated oxygen sensor 1
circuit slow response
The response of the voltage signal from the
sensor takes more than the specified time.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
G Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
G Fuel pressure
G Injectors
G Intake air leaks
G Exhaust gas leaks
G PCV valve
G Mass air flow sensor
SEF338Z
ENG SPEED 1,650 - 3,600 rpm
Vehicle speed More than 80 km/h (50 MPH)
B/FUEL SCHDL 4.0 - 14.5 msec
Selector lever Suitable position
SEF339Z
DTC P0133 HO2S1
EC-1127
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
7. Make sure that OK is displayed after touching SELF-DIAG
RESULTS. If NG is displayed, refer to EC-1129, "Diagnostic
Procedure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00GCR
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V more
than 5 times within 10 seconds.
4. If NG, go to EC-1129, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF658Y
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
0 - 0.3V
MBIB0018E
EC-1128
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0133 HO2S1
Wiring Diagram EBS00GCS
MBWA0008E
DTC P0133 HO2S1
EC-1129
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GCT
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
2. RETIGHTEN HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Loosen and retighten heated oxygen sensor 1.
>> GO TO 3.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
35 PU Heated oxygen sensor 1
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
74 B Sensors' ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0142E
Tightening torque: 40 - 50 Nm (4.1 - 5.1 kg-m, 30 - 37 ft-lb)
MBIB0150E
EC-1130
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0133 HO2S1
3. CHECK FOR EXHAUST AIR LEAK
1. Start engine and run it at idle.
2. Listen for an exhaust air leak before three way catalyst (Mani-
fold).
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair or replace.
4. CHECK FOR INTAKE AIR LEAK
Listen for an intake air leak after the mass air flow sensor.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair or replace.
SEF099P
DTC P0133 HO2S1
EC-1131
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 or P0172 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure that DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-1015, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure that DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 or P0172 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0171 or DTC P0172 (Refer to EC-1157 or EC-1163 ).
No >> GO TO 6.
6. CHECK HO2S1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S1
terminal 3. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
SEF215Z
MBIB0131E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0151E
EC-1132
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0133 HO2S1
7. CHECK HO2S1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 and HO2S1 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 or HO2S1 terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 HEATER
Refer to EC-1094, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace malfunctioning heated oxygen sensor 1.
9. CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EC-1105, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> Replace mass air flow sensor.
10. CHECK PCV VALVE
Refer to EC-1411, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> Replace PCV valve.
11. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-1132, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
12. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GCU
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG and adjust TRIGGER POINT to 100% in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-
II.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
DTC P0133 HO2S1
EC-1133
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. Select HO2S1 (B1) and HO2S1 MNTR (B1).
4. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load during the follow-
ing steps.
5. Touch RECORD on CONSULT-II screen.
6. Check the following.
G HO2S1 MNTR (B1) in DATA MONITOR mode changes
from RICH to LEAN to RICH 5 times in 10 seconds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes below 0.3V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
G The voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new
one.
SEF646Y
SEF217YA
SEF648Y
MBIB0018E
EC-1134
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0133 HO2S1
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00GCV
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-121, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND THREE WAY CATALYST" .
DTC P0134 HO2S1
EC-1135
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0134 HO2S1 PFP:22690
Component Description EBS00GCW
The heated oxygen sensor 1 is placed into the exhaust manifold. It
detects the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas compared to the
outside air. The heated oxygen sensor 1 has a closed-end tube
made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from
approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner conditions. The
heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM adjusts
the injection pulse duration to achieve the ideal air-fuel ratio. The
ideal air-fuel ratio occurs near the radical change from 1V to 0V.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GCX
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GCY
Under the condition in which the heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is
not input, the ECM circuits will read a continuous approximately
0.3V. Therefore, for this diagnosis, the time that output voltage is
within 200 to 400 mV range is monitored, and the diagnosis checks
that this time is not inordinately long.
SEF463R
SEF288D
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times dur-
ing 10 seconds.
SEF237U
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0134
0134
Heated oxygen sensor 1
circuit no activity detected
The voltage from the sensor is constantly
approx. 0.3V.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
EC-1136
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0134 HO2S1
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GCZ
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select HO2S1 (B1) P0134 of HO2S1 in DTC WORK SUPPORT mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Touch START.
4. Let it idle for at least 3 minutes.
NOTE:
Never raise engine speed above 3,600 rpm after this step. If
the engine speed limit is exceeded, return to step 4.
5. When the following conditions are met, TESTING will be dis-
played on the CONSULT-II screen. Maintain the conditions con-
tinuously until TESTING changes to COMPLETED. (It will
take approximately 10 to 60 seconds.)
If TESTING is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from
step 2.
6. Make sure that OK is displayed after touching SELF-DIAG
RESULTS. If NG is displayed, refer to EC-1139, "Diagnostic
Procedure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00GD0
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
PBIB0544E
ENG SPEED 1,550 - 3,600 rpm
Vehicle speed More than 64 km/h (40 MPH)
B/FUEL SCHDL 2.9 - 14.5 msec
Selector lever Suitable position
PBIB0545E
SEC750C
DTC P0134 HO2S1
EC-1137
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage does not remain in the range of 0.2 - 0.4V.
4. If NG, go to EC-1139, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
MBIB0018E
EC-1138
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0134 HO2S1
Wiring Diagram EBS00GD1
MBWA0008E
DTC P0134 HO2S1
EC-1139
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GD2
1. INSPECTION START
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK HO2S1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S1
terminal 3. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
35 PU Heated oxygen sensor 1
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
74 B Sensors' ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0142E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0151E
EC-1140
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0134 HO2S1
3. CHECK HO2S1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 and HO2S1 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 or HO2S1 terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-1140, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GD3
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG and adjust TRIGGER POINT to 100% in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-
II.
3. Select HO2S1 (B1) and HO2S1 MNTR (B1).
4. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load during the follow-
ing steps.
5. Touch RECORD on CONSULT-II screen.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
SEF646Y
DTC P0134 HO2S1
EC-1141
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. Check the following.
G HO2S1 MNTR (B1) in DATA MONITOR mode changes
from RICH to LEAN to RICH 5 times in 10 seconds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes below 0.3V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
G The voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new
one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00GD4
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-121, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND THREE WAY CATALYST" .
SEF217YA
SEF648Y
MBIB0018E
EC-1142
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0138 HO2S2
DTC P0138 HO2S2 PFP:226A0
Component Description EBS00GD5
The heated oxygen sensor 2, after three way catalyst (manifold),
monitors the oxygen level in the exhaust gas on each bank.
Even if switching characteristics of the heated oxygen sensor 1 are
shifted, the air fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal
from the heated oxygen sensor 2.
This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates volt-
age from approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner condi-
tions.
Under normal conditions the heated oxygen sensor 2 is not used for
engine control operation.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GD6
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GD7
The heated oxygen sensor 2 has a much longer switching time
between rich and lean than the heated oxygen sensor 1. The oxygen
storage capacity before the three way catalyst causes the longer
switching time. To judge the malfunctions of heated oxygen sensor
2, ECM monitors whether the voltage is unusually high during the
various driving condition such as fuel-cut.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GD8
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
3. Stop vehicle with engine running.
SEF327R
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S2 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S2 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
LEAN RICH
SEF305UA
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0138
0138
Heated oxygen sensor 2
circuit high voltage
An excessively high voltage from the sensor
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 2
DTC P0138 HO2S2
EC-1143
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. Let engine idle for 1 minute.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1145, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00GD9
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 2 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 (HO2S2 signal) and engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be below 1.4V during this procedure.
5. If NG, go to EC-1145, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF189Y
MBIB0020E
EC-1144
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0138 HO2S2
Wiring Diagram EBS00GDA
MBWA0010E
DTC P0138 HO2S2
EC-1145
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GDB
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
16 W/Y Heated oxygen sensor 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
74 B Sensors' ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0142E
EC-1146
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0138 HO2S2
2. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure that DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-1015, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure that DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0172. Refer to EC-1163 .
No >> GO TO 3.
3. CHECK HO2S2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S2
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
SEF215Z
MBIB0131E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0151E
DTC P0138 HO2S2
EC-1147
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. CHECK HO2S2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 16 and HO2S2 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 16 or HO2S2 terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EC-1147, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GDC
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Select FUEL INJECTION in ACTIVE TEST mode, and select
HO2S2 (B1) as the monitor item with CONSULT-II.
4. Check HO2S2 (B1) at idle speed when adjusting FUEL INJECTION to 25%.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
SEF662Y
PBIB0551E
EC-1148
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0138 HO2S2
HO2S2 (B1) should be above 0.68V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is +25%.
HO2S2 (B1) should be below 0.50V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is 25%.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] and engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.68V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage is above 0.68V at step 4, step 5 is not neces-
sary.
5. Keep vehicle idling for 10 minutes, then check voltage. Or check
the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D posi-
tion (CVT), 3rd gear position (M/T).
The voltage should be below 0.50V at least once during this
procedure.
6. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00GDD
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EX-3, "EXHAUST SYSTEM" .
MBIB0020E
DTC P0139 HO2S2
EC-1149
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0139 HO2S2 PFP:226A0
Component Description EBS00GDE
The heated oxygen sensor 2, after three way catalyst (manifold),
monitors the oxygen level in the exhaust gas on each bank.
Even if switching characteristics of the heated oxygen sensor 1 are
shifted, the air fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal
from the heated oxygen sensor 2.
This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates volt-
age from approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner condi-
tions.
Under normal conditions the heated oxygen sensor 2 is not used for
engine control operation.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GDF
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GDG
The heated oxygen sensor 2 has a much longer switching time
between rich and lean than the heated oxygen sensor 1. The oxygen
storage capacity before the three way catalyst causes the longer
switching time. To judge the malfunctions of heated oxygen sensor
2, ECM monitors whether the switching response of the sensor's
voltage is faster than specified during the various driving condition
such as fuel-cut.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GDH
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
G COMPLETED will appear on CONSULT-II screen when all tests COND1, COND2 and
COND3 are completed.
G If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and
wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Never stop engine during this procedure. If the engine is stopped, retry this procedure from step 2 in
Procedure for COND1.
SEF327R
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S2 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S2 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
LEAN RICH
SEF302U
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0139
0139
Heated oxygen sensor 2
circuit slow response
It takes more time for the sensor to respond
between rich and lean than the specified time.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 2
G Fuel pressure
G Injectors
G Intake air leaks
EC-1150
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0139 HO2S2
WITH CONSULT-II
Procedure for COND1
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select HO2S2 (B1) P0139 of HO2S2 in DTC WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch START.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 30 seconds.
6. Rev engine up to 2,000 rpm 2 or 3 times quickly under no load.
If COMPLETED appears on CONSULT-II screen, go to step 2 in Procedure for COND3.
If COMPLETED does not appear on CONSULT-II screen, go to the following step.
7. Drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
8. When the following conditions are met, TESTING will be displayed at COND1 on the CONSULT-II
screen. Maintain the conditions continuously until TESTING changes to COMPLETED. (It will take
approximately 60 seconds.)
NOTE:
G If TESTING is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from step 2 in Procedure for COND1.
G If COMPLETED already appears at COND2 on CONSULT-II screen before Procedure for
COND2 is conducted, it is unnecessary to conduct step 1 in Procedure for COND2.
Procedure for COND2
1. While driving, release accelerator pedal completely from the
above condition [step 8] until INCOMPLETE at COND2 on
CONSULT-II screen has turned to COMPLETED. (It will take
approximately 4 seconds.)
NOTE:
If COMPLETED already appears at COND3 on CONSULT-II
screen before Procedure for COND3 is conducted, it is unnec-
essary to conduct step 1 in Procedure for COND3.
ENG SPEED More than 1,000 rpm
B/FUEL SCHDL More than 1.0 msec
COOLANT TEMP/S 70 - 105 C
Selector level Suitable position
PBIB0552E
PBIB0553E
DTC P0139 HO2S2
EC-1151
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Procedure for COND3
1. Stop vehicle and let it idle until INCOMPLETE of COND3 on
CONSULT-II screen has turned to COMPLETED. (It will take a
maximum of approximately 6 minutes.)
2. Make sure that OK is displayed after touching SELF-DIAG
RESULTS.
If NG is displayed, refer to EC-1153, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00GDI
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 2 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 (HO2S2 signal) and engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should change at more than 0.06V for 1 second
during this procedure.
If the voltage can be confirmed in step 4, step 5 is not nec-
essary.
5. Keep vehicle at idling for 10 minutes, then check the voltage. Or
check the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D
position (CVT), 3rd gear position (M/T).
The voltage should change at more than 0.06V for 1 second
during this procedure.
6. If NG, go to EC-1153, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF668Y
MBIB0020E
EC-1152
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0139 HO2S2
Wiring Diagram EBS00GDJ
MBWA0010E
DTC P0139 HO2S2
EC-1153
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GDK
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
16 W/Y Heated oxygen sensor 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
74 B Sensors' ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0142E
EC-1154
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0139 HO2S2
2. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 or P0172 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure that DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-1015, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure that DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 or P0172 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0171 or P0172. Refer to EC-1157 or EC-1163 .
No >> GO TO 3.
3. CHECK HO2S2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S2
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
SEF215Z
MBIB0131E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0151E
DTC P0139 HO2S2
EC-1155
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. CHECK HO2S2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 16 and HO2S2 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 16 or HO2S2 terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EC-1155, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GDL
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Select FUEL INJECTION in ACTIVE TEST mode, and select
HO2S2 (B1) as the monitor item with CONSULT-II.
4. Check HO2S2 (B1) at idle speed when adjusting FUEL INJECTION to 25%.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
SEF662Y
PBIB0551E
EC-1156
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0139 HO2S2
HO2S2 (B1) should be above 0.68V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is +25%.
HO2S2 (B1) should be below 0.50V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is 25%.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 (HO2S2 signal) and engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.68V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage is above 0.68V at step 4, step 5 is not neces-
sary.
5. Keep vehicle idling for 10 minutes, then check voltage. Or check
the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D posi-
tion (CVT), 3rd gear position (M/T).
The voltage should be below 0.50V at least once during this
procedure.
6. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00GDM
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EX-3, "EXHAUST SYSTEM" .
MBIB0020E
DTC P0171 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION
EC-1157
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0171 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION PFP:16600
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GDN
With the Air/Fuel Mixture Ratio Self-Learning Control, the actual mixture ratio can be brought closely to the
theoretical mixture ratio based on the mixture ratio feedback signal from the heated oxygen sensor 1. The
ECM calculates the necessary compensation to correct the offset between the actual and the theoretical
ratios.
In case the amount of the compensation value is extremely large (The actual mixture ratio is too lean.), the
ECM judges the condition as the fuel injection system malfunction and light up the MI (2 trip detection logic).
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GDO
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode with CON-
SULT-II.
4. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
5. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
6. Start engine again and let it idle for at least 10 minutes.
The 1st trip DTC P0171 should be detected at this stage, if a
malfunction exists. If so, go to EC-1160, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
7. If it is difficult to start engine at step 6, the fuel injection system
has a malfunction, too.
8. Crank engine while depressing accelerator pedal. If engine
starts, go to EC-1160, "Diagnostic Procedure" . If engine does
not start, check exhaust and intake air leak visually.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Heated oxygen sensors 1
Density of oxygen in exhaust gas
(Mixture ratio feedback signal)
Fuel injection control Fuel injectors
DTC No.
Trouble diagnosis
name
DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0171
0171
Fuel injection system
too lean
G Fuel injection system does not operate properly.
G The amount of mixture ratio compensation is too
large.
(The mixture ratio is too lean.)
G Intake air leaks
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
G Injectors
G Exhaust gas leaks
G Incorrect fuel pressure
G Lack of fuel
G Mass air flow sensor
G Incorrect PCV hose connection
SEF215Z
EC-1158
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0171 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector. Then
restart and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Select MODE 3 with GST. Make sure DTC P0102 is detected.
6. Select MODE 4 with GST and erase the DTC P0102.
7. Start engine again and let it idle for at least 10 minutes.
8. Select MODE 7 with GST. The 1st trip DTC P0171 should be
detected at this stage, if a malfunction exists. If so, go to EC-
1160, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
9. If it is difficult to start engine at step 7, the fuel injection system
has a malfunction.
10. Crank engine while depressing accelerator pedal. If engine starts, go to EC-1160, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
If engine does not start, check exhaust and intake air leak visually.
MBIB0131E
DTC P0171 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION
EC-1159
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GDP
MBWA0012E
EC-1160
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0171 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GDQ
1. CHECK EXHAUST AIR LEAK
1. Start engine and run it at idle.
2. Listen for an exhaust air leak before three way catalyst.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace.
2. CHECK FOR INTAKE AIR LEAK AND PCV HOSE
1. Listen for an intake air leak after the mass air flow sensor.
2. Check PCV hose connection.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
3. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 (HO2S1) harness connec-
tor.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 and HO2S1
terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 or HO2S1
terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
6. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
1. Release fuel pressure to zero. Refer to EC-1001, "FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE" .
2. Install fuel pressure gauge and check fuel pressure. Refer to EC-1002, "FUEL PRESSURE CHECK" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Follow the construction of FUEL PRESSURE CHECK.
SEF099P
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
MBIB0151E
At idling: Approximately 350 kPa (3.5 bar, 3.7 kg/cm
2
, 51 psi)
DTC P0171 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION
EC-1161
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
With CONSULT-II
1. Install all removed parts.
2. Check MASS AIR FLOW in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
With GST
1. Install all removed parts.
2. Check mass air flow sensor signal in MODE 1 with GST.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Check connectors for rusted terminals or loose connections in the mass air flow sensor circuit or
engine grounds. Refer to EC-1100, "DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR" .
6. CHECK FUNCTION OF INJECTORS
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Perform POWER BALANCE in ACTIVE TEST mode with
CONSULT-II.
3. Make sure that each circuit produces a momentary engine
speed drop.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Listen to each injector operating sound.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Perform trouble diagnosis for EC-1375, "INJECTOR CIRCUIT" .
1.0 - 4.0 gm/sec: at idling
4.0 - 10 gm/sec: at 2,500 rpm
1.0 - 4.0 gm/sec: at idling
4.0 - 10 gm/sec: at 2,500 rpm
PBIB0133E
Clicking noise should be heard.
MEC703B
EC-1162
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0171 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION
7. CHECK INJECTOR
1. Confirm that the engine is cooled down and there are no fire hazards near the vehicle.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect injector harness connectors.
4. Remove injector gallery assembly. Refer to EM-128, "FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE" .
Keep fuel hose and all injectors connected to injector gallery.
The injector harness connectors should remain connected.
5. Disconnect all ignition coil harness connectors.
6. Prepare pans or saucers under each injector.
7. Crank engine for about 3 seconds. Make sure that fuel sprays
out from injectors.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace injectors from which fuel does not spray out.
Always replace O-ring with new ones.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Fuel should be sprayed evenly for each injector.
SEF595Q
DTC P0172 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION
EC-1163
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0172 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION PFP:16600
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GDR
With the Air/Fuel Mixture Ratio Self-Learning Control, the actual mixture ratio can be brought closely to the
theoretical mixture ratio based on the mixture ratio feedback signal from the heated oxygen sensors 1. The
ECM calculates the necessary compensation to correct the offset between the actual and the theoretical
ratios.
In case the amount of the compensation value is extremely large (The actual mixture ratio is too rich.), the
ECM judges the condition as the fuel injection system malfunction and light up the MI (2 trip detection logic).
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GDS
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode with CON-
SULT-II.
4. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
5. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
6. Start engine again and let it idle for at least 10 minutes.
The 1st trip DTC P0172 should be detected at this stage, if a
malfunction exists. If so, go to EC-1166, "Diagnostic Procedure"
.
7. If it is difficult to start engine at step 6, the fuel injection system
has a malfunction, too.
8. Crank engine while depressing accelerator pedal.
If engine starts, go to EC-1166, "Diagnostic Procedure" . If
engine does not start, remove ignition plugs and check for foul-
ing, etc.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Heated oxygen sensors 1
Density of oxygen in exhaust gas
(Mixture ratio feedback signal)
Fuel injection control Fuel injectors
DTC No.
Trouble diagnosis
name
DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0172
0172
Fuel injection system
too rich
G Fuel injection system does not operate properly.
G The amount of mixture ratio compensation is too
large.
(The mixture ratio is too rich.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
G Injectors
G Exhaust gas leaks
G Incorrect fuel pressure
G Mass air flow sensor
SEF215Z
EC-1164
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0172 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector. Then
restart and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Select MODE 3 with GST. Make sure DTC P0102 is detected.
6. Select MODE 4 with GST and erase the DTC P0102.
7. Start engine again and let it idle for at least 10 minutes.
8. Select MODE 7 with GST. The 1st trip DTC P0172 should be
detected at this stage, if a malfunction exists. If so, go to EC-
1166, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
9. If it is difficult to start engine at step 7, the fuel injection system
has a malfunction.
10. Crank engine while depressing accelerator pedal.
If engine starts, go to EC-1166, "Diagnostic Procedure" . If engine does not start, check exhaust and
intake air leak visually.
MBIB0131E
DTC P0172 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION
EC-1165
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GDT
MBWA0012E
EC-1166
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0172 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GDU
1. CHECK EXHAUST AIR LEAK
1. Start engine and run it at idle.
2. Listen for an exhaust air leak before three way catalyst.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace.
2. CHECK FOR INTAKE AIR LEAK
Listen for an intake air leak after the mass air flow sensor.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
3. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 (HO2S1) harness connec-
tor.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 and HO2S1
terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 or HO2S1
terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
6. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
1. Release fuel pressure to zero. Refer to EC-1001, "FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE" .
2. Install fuel pressure gauge and check fuel pressure. Refer to EC-1002, "FUEL PRESSURE CHECK" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Follow the construction of FUEL PRESSURE CHECK.
SEF099P
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
MBIB0151E
At idling: 350 kPa (3.5 bar, 3.7 kg/cm2, 51 psi)
DTC P0172 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION
EC-1167
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
With CONSULT-II
1. Install all removed parts.
2. Check MASS AIR FLOW in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
With GST
1. Install all removed parts.
2. Check mass air flow sensor signal in MODE 1 with GST.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Check connectors for rusted terminals or loose connections in the mass air flow sensor circuit or
engine grounds. Refer to EC-1100, "DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR" .
6. CHECK FUNCTION OF INJECTORS
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Perform POWER BALANCE in ACTIVE TEST mode with
CONSULT-II.
3. Make sure that each circuit produces a momentary engine
speed drop.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Listen to each injector operating sound.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Perform trouble diagnosis for EC-1375, "INJECTOR CIRCUIT" .
1.0 - 4.0 gm/sec: at idling
4.0 - 10 gm/sec: at 2,500 rpm
1.0 - 4.0 gm/sec: at idling
4.0 - 10 gm/sec: at 2,500 rpm
PBIB0133E
Clicking noise should be heard.
MEC703B
EC-1168
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0172 FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM FUNCTION
7. CHECK INJECTOR
1. Remove injector assembly. Refer to EM-128, "FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE" .
Keep fuel hose and all injectors connected to injector gallery.
2. Confirm that the engine is cooled down and there are no fire hazards near the vehicle.
3. Disconnect injector harness connectors.
The injector harness connectors should remain connected.
4. Disconnect all ignition coil harness connectors.
5. Prepare pans or saucers under each injectors.
6. Crank engine for about 3 seconds.
Make sure fuel does not drip from injector.
OK or NG
OK (Does not drip.)>>GO TO 8.
NG (Drips.)>>Replace the injectors from which fuel is dripping. Always replace O-ring with new one.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
EC-1169
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00GDV
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor,
throttle position sensor, etc. The throttle position sensor responds to
the throttle valve movement.
The throttle position sensor has the two sensors. These sensors are
a kind of potentiometers which transform the throttle valve position
into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM. In addi-
tion, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of the
throttle valve and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM
judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these sig-
nals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the
throttle valve opening angle properly in response to driving condi-
tion.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GDW
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GDX
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GDY
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0145E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
THRTL SEN1
THRTL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released More than 0.36V
G Shift lever:
D (CVT model)
1st (M/T model)
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0221
0221
Throttle position sensor
circuit range/performance
problem
Rationally incorrect voltage is sent to ECM
compared with the signals from TP sensor 1
and TP sensor 2.
G Harness or connector
(The TP sensor 1 and 2 circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 1 and 2)
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
EC-1170
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1172, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
SEF058Y
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
EC-1171
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GDZ
MBWA0127E
EC-1172
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GE0
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
47 G
Throttle position sensor
power supply
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
49 W Throttle position sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
More than 0.36V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
Less than 4.75V
66 B Sensors ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
68 R Throttle position sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
Less than 4.75V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 0.36V
MBIB0142E
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
EC-1173
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between electric throttle control actuator terminal
1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 66 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 49 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 4, ECM
terminal 68 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
Refer to EC-1174, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
MBIB0133E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0082E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
EC-1174
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
6. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GE1
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Set selector lever to D position (CVT models) or 1st position (M/T models).
5. Check voltage between ECM terminals 49 (TP sensor 1 signal),
68 (TP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the following
conditions.
6. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to the next
step.
7. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
8. Perform EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00GE2
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-116, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
49
(Throttle position sensor 1)
Fully released More than 0.36V
Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
68
(Throttle position sensor 2)
Fully released Less than 4.75V
Fully depressed More than 0.36V
MBIB0022E
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
EC-1175
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00GE3
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor,
throttle position sensor, etc. The throttle position sensor responds to
the throttle valve movement.
The throttle position sensor has the two sensors. These sensors are
a kind of potentiometers which transform the throttle valve position
into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM. In addi-
tion, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of the
throttle valve and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM
judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these sig-
nals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the
throttle valve opening angle properly in response to driving condi-
tion.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GE4
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GE5
These self-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GE6
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0145E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
THRTL SEN1
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released More than 0.36V
G Shift lever:
D (CVT model)
1st (M/T model)
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0222
0222
Throttle position sensor 1
circuit low input
An excessively low voltage from the TP sensor 1
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The TP sensor 1 circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 1)
P0223
0223
Throttle position sensor 1
circuit high input
An excessively high voltage from the TP sensor
1 is sent to ECM.
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
EC-1176
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1178, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
SEF058Y
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
EC-1177
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GE7
MBWA0125E
EC-1178
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GE8
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
47 G
Throttle position sensor
power supply
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
49 W Throttle position sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
More than 0.36V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
Less than 4.75V
66 B Sensors ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
68 R Throttle position sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
Less than 4.75V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 0.36V
MBIB0142E
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
EC-1179
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 1 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between electric throttle control actuator terminal
1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 66 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 49 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 4.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
Refer to EC-1180, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
MBIB0133E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0082E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
EC-1180
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
6. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GE9
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Set selector lever to D position (CVT models) or 1st position (M/T models).
5. Check voltage between ECM terminals 49 (TP sensor 1 signal),
68 (TP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the following
conditions.
6. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to the next
step.
7. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
8. Perform EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00GEA
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-116, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
49
(Throttle position sensor 1)
Fully released More than 0.36V
Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
68
(Throttle position sensor 2)
Fully released Less than 4.75V
Fully depressed More than 0.36V
MBIB0022E
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
EC-1181
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR PFP:18002
Component Description EBS00GEB
The accelerator pedal position sensor is installed on the upper end
of the accelerator pedal assembly. The sensor detects the accelera-
tor position and sends a signal to the ECM.
Accelerator pedal position sensor has two sensors. These sensors
are a kind of potentiometers which transform the accelerator pedal
position into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM.
In addition, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of
the accelerator pedal and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The
ECM judges the current opening angle of the accelerator pedal from
these signals and controls the throttle control motor based on these
signals.
Idle position of the accelerator pedal is determined by the ECM
receiving the signal from the accelerator pedal position sensor. The ECM uses this signal for the engine oper-
ation such as fuel cut.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GEC
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GED
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GEE
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0146E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
ACCEL SEN1
ACCEL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed More than 3.9V
CLSD THL POS G Ignition switch: ON
Accelerator pedal: Fully released ON
Accelerator pedal: Slightly depressed OFF
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0226
0226
Accelerator pedal position sensor
circuit range/performance problem
Rationally incorrect voltage is sent to ECM
compared with the signals from APP sensor
1 and APP sensor 2.
G Harness or connector
(The APP sensor 1 and 2 circuit is
open or shorted.)
G Accelerator pedal position sensor 1
and 2
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
EC-1182
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1184, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
SEF058Y
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
EC-1183
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GEF
MBWA0131E
EC-1184
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GEG
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
45 R Sensors power supply [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
47 G Sensors power supply [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
55 B Sensors ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
66 B Sensors ground
[Ignition switch ON]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
98 LG
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is Ist (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.175 - 0.335V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is Ist (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 1.95V
106 L
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is Ist (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.35 - 0.67V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is Ist (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.9V
MBIB0142E
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
EC-1185
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK APP SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor harness
connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between APP sensor terminals 1, 2 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness connectors M79, F108
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK APP SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 55 and APP sensor terminal 4, ECM terminal 66 and
APP sensor terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
MBIB0152E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0782E
Continuity should exist.
EC-1186
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness connectors M79, F108
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
G Harness for open or short between TCM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK APP SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 106 and APP sensor terminal 3, ECM terminal 98 and
APP sensor terminal 6.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness connectors M79, F108
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK APP SENSOR
Refer to EC-1187, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 9.
9. REPLACE APP SENSOR
1. Replace the accelerator pedal position sensor.
2. Perform EC-998, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
10. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
EC-1187
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Component Inspection EBS00GEH
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminals 106 (APP sensor 1 sig-
nal), 98 (APP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the fol-
lowing conditions.
4. If NG, replace accelerator pedal assembly and go to the next
step.
5. Perform EC-998, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
6. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
7. Perform EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00GEI
ACCELERATOR PEDAL
Refer to ACC-2, "ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM" .
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
106
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Fully depressed More than 3.9V
98
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
Fully released 0.175 - 0.335V
Fully depressed More than 1.95V
MBIB0023E
EC-1188
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR PFP:18002
Component Description EBS00GEJ
The accelerator pedal position sensor is installed on the upper end
of the accelerator pedal assembly. The sensor detects the accelera-
tor position and sends a signal to the ECM.
Accelerator pedal position sensor has two sensors. These sensors
are a kind of potentiometers which transform the accelerator pedal
position into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM.
In addition, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of
the accelerator pedal and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The
ECM judges the current opening angle of the accelerator pedal from
these signals and controls the throttle control motor based on these
signals.
Idle position of the accelerator pedal is determined by the ECM
receiving the signal from the accelerator pedal position sensor. The ECM uses this signal for the engine oper-
ation such as fuel cut.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GEK
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GEL
These self-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GEM
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0146E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
ACCEL SEN1
G Ignition switch: ON
(engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed More than 3.9V
CLSD THL POS G Ignition switch: ON
Accelerator pedal: Fully released ON
Accelerator pedal: Slightly depressed OFF
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0227
0227
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1 circuit low input
An excessively low voltage from the APP sensor 1
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The APP sensor 1 circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Accelerator pedal position sensor
(Accelerator pedal position sensor 1)
P0228
0228
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1 circuit high input
An excessively high voltage from the APP sensor 1
is sent to ECM.
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
EC-1189
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1191, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
SEF058Y
EC-1190
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00GEN
MBWA0129E
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
EC-1191
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GEO
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
45 R Sensors power supply [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
47 G Sensors power supply [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
55 B Sensors ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
66 B Sensors ground
[Ignition switch ON]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
98 LG
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is Ist (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.175 - 0.335V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is Ist (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 1.95V
106 L
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is Ist (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.35 - 0.67V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is Ist (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.9V
MBIB0142E
EC-1192
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
2. CHECK APP SENSOR 1 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor harness
connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between APP sensor terminal 2 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M79, F108
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK APP SENSOR 1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 55 and APP sensor terminal 4.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M79, F108
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
G Harness for open or short between TCM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0152E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0811E
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
EC-1193
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK APP SENSOR 1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 106 and APP sensor terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M79, F108
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK APP SENSOR
Refer to EC-1193, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 9.
9. REPLACE APP SENSOR
1. Replace the accelerator pedal position sensor.
2. Perform EC-998, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
10. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GEP
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminals 106 (APP sensor 1 sig-
nal), 98 (APP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the fol-
lowing conditions.
Continuity should exist.
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
106
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Fully depressed More than 3.9V
98
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
Fully released 0.175 - 0.335V
Fully depressed More than 1.95V
MBIB0023E
EC-1194
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
4. If NG, replace accelerator pedal assembly and go to the next step.
5. Perform EC-998, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
6. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
7. Perform EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00GEQ
ACCELERATOR PEDAL
Refer to ACC-2, "ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM" .
DTC P0300 - P0304 MULTIPLE CYLINDER MISFIRE, NO. 1 - 4 CYLINDER MIS-
FIRE
EC-1195
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0300 - P0304 MULTIPLE CYLINDER MISFIRE, NO. 1 - 4 CYLINDER MIS-
FIRE PFP:00000
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GER
When a misfire occurs, engine speed will fluctuate. If the engine speed fluctuates enough to cause the crank-
shaft position (CKP) sensor (POS) signal to vary, ECM can determine that a misfire is occurring.
The misfire detection logic consists of the following two conditions.
1. One Trip Detection Logic (Three Way Catalyst Damage)
On the first trip that a misfire condition occurs that can damage the three way catalyst (TWC) due to over-
heating, the MI will blink.
When a misfire condition occurs, the ECM monitors the CKP sensor (POS) signal every 200 engine revo-
lutions for a change.
When the misfire condition decreases to a level that will not damage the TWC, the MI will turn off.
If another misfire condition occurs that can damage the TWC on a second trip, the MI will blink.
When the misfire condition decreases to a level that will not damage the TWC, the MI will remain on.
If another misfire condition occurs that can damage the TWC, the MI will begin to blink again.
2. Two Trip Detection Logic (Exhaust quality deterioration)
For misfire conditions that will not damage the TWC (but will affect vehicle emissions), the MI will only light
when the misfire is detected on a second trip. During this condition, the ECM monitors the CKP sensor
signal every 1,000 engine revolutions.
A misfire malfunction can be detected on any one cylinder or on multiple cylinders.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GES
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON, and select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function
Crankshaft position sensor (POS) Engine speed On board diagnosis of misfire
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0300
0300
Multiple cylinder misfire
detected
Multiple cylinder misfire.
G Improper spark plug
G Insufficient compression
G Incorrect fuel pressure
G The injector circuit is open or shorted
G Fuel injectors
G Intake air leak
G The ignition signal circuit is open or
shorted
G Lack of fuel
G Drive plate or flywheel
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
G Incorrect PCV hose connection
P0301
0301
No.1 cylinder misfire
detected
No. 1 cylinder misfires.
P0302
0302
No. 2 cylinder misfire
detected
No. 2 cylinder misfires.
P0303
0303
No. 3 cylinder misfire
detected
No. 3 cylinder misfires.
P0304
0304
No. 4 cylinder misfire
detected
No. 4 cylinder misfires.
EC-1196
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0300 - P0304 MULTIPLE CYLINDER MISFIRE, NO. 1 - 4 CYLINDER MIS-
FIRE
4. Start engine again and drive at 1,500 to 3,000 rpm for at least 3
minutes.
Hold the accelerator pedal as steady as possible.
NOTE:
Refer to the freeze frame data for the test driving condi-
tions.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1196, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GET
1. CHECK FOR INTAKE AIR LEAK AND PCV HOSE
1. Start engine and run it at idle speed.
2. Listen for the sound of the intake air leak.
3. Check PCV hose connection.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace.
2. CHECK FOR EXHAUST SYSTEM CLOGGING
Stop engine and visually check exhaust tube, three way catalyst and muffler for dents.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
PBIB0164E
DTC P0300 - P0304 MULTIPLE CYLINDER MISFIRE, NO. 1 - 4 CYLINDER MIS-
FIRE
EC-1197
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. PERFORM POWER BALANCE TEST
With CONSULT-II
1. Perform POWER BALANCE in ACTIVE TEST mode.
2. Is there any cylinder which does not produce a momentary
engine speed drop?
Without CONSULT-II
When disconnecting each injector harness connector one at a time,
is there any cylinder which does not produce a momentary engine
speed drop?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 4.
No >> GO TO 7.
4. CHECK INJECTOR
Does each injector make an operating sound at idle?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 5.
No >> Check injector(s) and circuit(s). Refer to EC-1375,
"INJECTOR CIRCUIT" .
PBIB0133E
MBIB0146E
MEC703B
EC-1198
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0300 - P0304 MULTIPLE CYLINDER MISFIRE, NO. 1 - 4 CYLINDER MIS-
FIRE
5. CHECK IGNITION SPARK
1. Disconnect ignition coil assembly from rocker cover.
2. Connect a known good spark plug to the ignition coil assembly.
3. Place end of spark plug against a suitable ground and crank engine.
4. Check for spark.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Check ignition coil, power transistor and their circuits.
Refer to EC-1365, "IGNITION SIGNAL" .
6. CHECK SPARK PLUGS
Remove the spark plugs and check for fouling, etc.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Repair or replace spark plug(s) with standard type
one(s). For spark plug type, refer to MA-26, "Checking
and Changing Spark Plugs" .
7. CHECK COMPRESSION PRESSURE
Check compression pressure. Refer to EM-152, "CHECKING COMPRESSION PRESSURE" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Check pistons, piston rings, valves, valve seats and cylinder head gaskets.
8. CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
1. Install all removed parts.
2. Release fuel pressure to zero. Refer to EC-1001, "FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE" .
3. Install fuel pressure gauge and check fuel pressure. Refer to EC-1002, "FUEL PRESSURE CHECK" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Follow the construction of FUEL PRESSURE CHECK.
SEF575Q
SEF156I
Standard:
1,190 kPa (11.9 bar, 12.1 kg/cm
2
, 172 psi)/250 rpm
Minimum:
990 kPa (9.9 bar, 10.1 kg/cm
2
, 144 psi)/250 rpm
Difference between each
cylinder:
98 kPa (0.98 bar, 1.0 kg/cm
2
, 14 psi)/250 rpm
At idle: Approx. 350 kPa (3.5 bar, 3.7 kg/cm
2
, 51 psi)
DTC P0300 - P0304 MULTIPLE CYLINDER MISFIRE, NO. 1 - 4 CYLINDER MIS-
FIRE
EC-1199
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
9. CHECK IGNITION TIMING
Check the following items. Refer to EC-1032, "Basic Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> Follow the Basic Inspection.
10. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-1123, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> GO TO 11.
11. CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
With CONSULT-II
Check mass air flow sensor signal in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
With GST
Check mass air flow sensor signal in MODE 1 with GST.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Check connectors for rusted terminals or loose connections in the mass air flow sensor circuit or
engine grounds. Refer to EC-1100, "DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR" .
12. CHECK SYMPTOM MATRIX CHART
Check items on the rough idle symptom in EC-1037, "Symptom Matrix Chart" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> Repair or replace.
13. ERASE THE 1ST TRIP DTC
Some tests may cause a 1st trip DTC to be set.
Erase the 1st trip DTC from the ECM memory after performing the tests. Refer to EC-1015, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
>> GO TO 14.
Items Specifications
Target idle speed
CVT 650 50 rpm (in P or N position)
M/T 600 50 rpm
Ignition timing
CVT 15 5 BTDC (in P or N position)
M/T 14 5 BTDC
1.0 - 4.0 gm/sec: at idling
4.0 - 10.0 gm/sec: at 2,500 rpm
1.0 - 4.0 gm/sec: at idling
4.0 - 10.0 gm/sec: at 2,500 rpm
EC-1200
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0300 - P0304 MULTIPLE CYLINDER MISFIRE, NO. 1 - 4 CYLINDER MIS-
FIRE
14. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
DTC P0327, P0328 KS
EC-1201
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0327, P0328 KS PFP:22060
Component Description EBS00GEU
The knock sensor is attached to the cylinder block. It senses engine
knocking using a piezoelectric element. A knocking vibration from
the cylinder block is sensed as vibrational pressure. This pressure is
converted into a voltage signal and sent to the ECM.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GEV
The MI will not light for knock sensor malfunction.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GEW
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine and run it for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1203, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
MBIB0139E
DTC No. Trouble Diagnosis Name DTC Detected Condition Possible Cause
P0327
0327
Knock sensor circuit low
input
An excessively low voltage from the sensor is
sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Knock sensor
P0328
0328
Knock sensor circuit high
input
An excessively high voltage from the sensor is
sent to ECM.
SEF058Y
EC-1202
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0327, P0328 KS
Wiring Diagram EBS00GEX
MBWA0013E
DTC P0327, P0328 KS
EC-1203
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GEY
1. CHECK KNOCK SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT-I
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check resistance between ECM terminal 15 and engine ground. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
NOTE:
It is necessary to use an ohmmeter which can measure more than 10 M.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK KNOCK SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT-II
1. Disconnect knock sensor harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 15 and knock
sensor terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK KNOCK SENSOR
Refer to EC-1204, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace knock sensor.
4. CHECK KNOCK SENSOR SHIELD CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between knock sensor terminal 2 and engine ground.
2. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
15 W Knock sensor
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 2.5V
Resistance: Approximately 530 - 590k [at 20C (68F)]
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0139E
Continuity should exist
EC-1204
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0327, P0328 KS
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GEZ
KNOCK SENSOR
Check resistance between knock sensor terminal 1 and ground.
NOTE:
It is necessary to use an ohmmeter which can measure more
than 10 M.
CAUTION:
Do not use any knock sensors that have been dropped or phys-
ically damaged. Use only new ones.
Removal and Installation EBS00GF0
KNOCK SENSOR
Refer to EM-165, "CYLINDER BLOCK" .
Resistance: Approximately 530 - 590k [at 20C (68F)]
SEF227W
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
EC-1205
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS) PFP:23731
Component Description EBS00GF1
The crankshaft position sensor (POS) is located on the cylinder
block rear housing facing the gear teeth (cogs) of the signal plate at
the end of the crankshaft. It detects the fluctuation of the engine rev-
olution.
The sensor consists of a permanent magnet and Hall IC.
When the engine is running, the high and low parts of the teeth
cause the gap with the sensor change.
The changing gap causes the magnetic field near the sensor to
change.
Due to the changing magnetic field, the voltage from the sensor
changes.
The ECM receives the voltage signal and detects the fluctuation of
the engine revolution.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GF2
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GF3
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GF4
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10.5V with igni-
tion switch ON.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select DATA MONITOR mode
with CONSULT-II.
2. Crank engine for at least 2 seconds and run it for at least 5 sec-
onds at idle speed.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1208, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
PBIB0562E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
ENG SPEED
G Tachometer: Connect
G Run engine and compare tachometer indication with the CONSULT-II
value.
Almost the same speed as the
CONSULT-II value.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0335
0335
Crankshaft position
sensor (POS) circuit
G The crankshaft position sensor (POS) signal is not
detected by the ECM during the first few seconds of
engine cranking.
G The proper pulse signal from the crankshaft position
sensor (POS) is not sent to ECM while the engine is
running.
G The crankshaft position sensor (POS) signal is not in
the normal pattern during engine running.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
G Signal plate
SEF058Y
EC-1206
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
EC-1207
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GF5
MBWA0014E
EC-1208
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GF6
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
13 L
Crankshaft position
sensor (POS)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 3V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
Approximately 3V
PBIB0527E
PBIB0528E
MBIB0142E
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
EC-1209
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR (POS) POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect crankshaft position (CKP) sensor (POS) harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between CKP sensor (POS) terminal 1 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between crankshaft position sensor (POS) and ECM
G Harness for open or short between crankshaft position sensor (POS) and ECM relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK CKP SENSOR (POS) GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between CKP sensor (POS) terminal 3 and engine ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB0512E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0664E
Continuity should exist.
EC-1210
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
5. CHECK CKP SENSOR (POS) INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 13 and CKP sensor (POS) terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (POS)
Refer to EC-1210, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace crankshaft position sensor (POS).
7. CHECK GEAR TOOTH
Visually check for chipping signal plate gear tooth.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace the signal plate.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GF7
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (POS)
1. Loosen the fixing bolt of the sensor.
2. Disconnect crankshaft position sensor (POS) harness connector.
3. Remove the sensor.
4. Visually check the sensor for chipping.
Continuity should exist.
PBIB0563E
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
EC-1211
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. Check resistance as shown in the figure.
6. If NG, replace crankshaft position sensor (POS).
Removal and Installation EBS00GF8
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (POS)
Refer to EM-165, "CYLINDER BLOCK" .
Terminal No. (Polarity) Resistance [at 25C (77F)]
3 (+) - 1 (-)
Except 0 or 3 (+) - 2 (-)
2 (+) - 1 (-)
MBIB0024E
EC-1212
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE) PFP:23731
Component Description EBS00GF9
The camshaft position sensor (PHASE) senses the retraction with
intake valve camshaft to identify a particular cylinder. The camshaft
position sensor (PHASE) senses the piston position.
When the crankshaft position sensor (POS) system becomes inoper-
ative, the camshaft position sensor (PHASE) provides various con-
trols of engine parts instead, utilizing timing of cylinder identification
signals.
The sensor consists of a permanent magnet and Hall IC.
When engine is running, the high and low parts of the teeth cause
the gap with the sensor to change.
The changing gap causes the magnetic field near the sensor to
change.
Due to the changing magnetic field, the voltage from the sensor changes.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GFA
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GFB
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10.5V with igni-
tion switch ON.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Crank engine for at least 2 seconds and run it for at least 5 sec-
onds at idle speed.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1214, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
If 1st trip DTC is not detected, go to next step.
5. Maintain engine speed at more than 800 rpm for at least 5 sec-
onds.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1214, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
PBIB0562E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0340
0340
Camshaft position sensor
(PHASE) circuit
G The cylinder No. signal is not sent to ECM
for the first few seconds during engine
cranking.
G The cylinder No. signal is not set to ECM
during engine running.
G The cylinder No. signal is not in the normal
pattern during engine running.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
G Camshaft (Intake)
G Starter motor (Refer to SC-22 .)
G Starting system circuit (Refer to SC-22 .)
G Dead (Weak) battery
SEF013Y
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
EC-1213
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GFC
MBWA0015E
EC-1214
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GFD
1. CHECK STARTING SYSTEM
Turn ignition switch to START position.
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> Check starting system. (Refer to SC-22, "STARTING SYSTEM" .)
2. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 3.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
14 L
Camshaft position
sensor (PHASE)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.0 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
1.0 - 4.0V
PBIB0525E
PBIB0526E
Does the engine turn over?
Does the starter motor operate?
MBIB0142E
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
EC-1215
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR (PHASE) POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect camshaft position (CMP) sensor (PHASE) harness
connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between CMP sensor (PHASE) terminal 1 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between camshaft position sensor (PHASE) and ECM
G Harness for open or short between camshaft position sensor (PHASE) and ECM relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK CMP SENSOR (PHASE) GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between CMP sensor (PHASE) terminal 3 and engine ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0134E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0664E
Continuity should exist.
EC-1216
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
6. CHECK CMP SENSOR (PHASE) INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 14 and CMP sensor (PHASE) terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground or short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (PHASE)
Refer to EC-1216, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace camshaft position sensor (PHASE).
8. CHECK CAMSHAFT (INTAKE)
Check the following.
G Accumulation of debris to the signal plate of camshaft rear end
G Chipping signal plate of camshaft rear end
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Remove debris and clean the signal plate of camshaft
rear end or replace camshaft.
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GFE
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (PHASE)
1. Loosen the fixing bolt of the sensor.
2. Disconnect camshaft position sensor (PHASE) harness connector.
3. Remove the sensor.
4. Visually check the sensor for chipping.
Continuity should exist.
PBIB0565E
PBIB0563E
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
EC-1217
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. Check resistance as shown in the figure.
Removal and Installation EBS00GFF
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (PHASE)
Refer to EM-133, "CAMSHAFT" .
Terminal No. (Polarity) Resistance [at 25C (77F)]
3 (+) - 1 (-)
Except 0 or 3 (+) - 2 (-)
2 (+) - 1 (-)
MBIB0024E
EC-1218
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0420 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION
DTC P0420 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION PFP:20905
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GFG
The ECM monitors the switching frequency ratio of heated oxygen
sensors 1 and 2.
A three way catalyst (Manifold) with high oxygen storage capacity
will indicate a low switching frequency of heated oxygen sensor 2.
As oxygen storage capacity decreases, the heated oxygen sensor 2
switching frequency will increase.
When the frequency ratio of heated oxygen sensors 1 and 2
approaches a specified limit value, the three way catalyst (Manifold)
malfunction is diagnosed.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GFH
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
TESTING CONDITION:
G Open engine hood before conducting the following procedure.
G Do not hold engine speed for more than the specified minutes below.
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DTC & SRT CONFIRMATION then SRT WORK SUP-
PORT mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine.
4. Rev engine up to 2,000 to 3,000 rpm and hold it for 3 consecu-
tive minutes then release the accelerator pedal completely.
If INCMP of CATALYST changed to COMPLT, go to step 7
5. Wait 5 seconds at idle.
PBIB0067E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0420
0420
Catalyst system efficiency
below threshold
G Three way catalyst (Manifold) does not operate
properly.
G Three way catalyst (Manifold) does not have
enough oxygen storage capacity.
G Three way catalyst (Manifold)
G Exhaust tube
G Intake air leaks
G Fuel injectors
G Fuel injector leaks
G Spark plug
G Improper ignition timing
PBIB0566E
DTC P0420 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION
EC-1219
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. Rev engine up to 2,000 to 3,000 rpm and maintain it until
INCMP of CATALYST changes to CMPLT (It will take
approximately 5 minutes).
If not CMPLT, stop engine and cool it down to less than 70C
(158F) and then retest from step 1.
7. Select SELF-DIAG RESULTS mode with CONSULT-II.
8. Confirm that the 1st trip DTC is not detected.
If the 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1220, "Diagnostic Pro-
cedure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00GFI
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the three way catalyst (Manifold). During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeters probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 sig-
nal) and engine ground, and ECM terminal 16 (HO2S2 signal)
and engine ground.
4. Keep engine speed at 2,000 rpm constant under no load.
5. Make sure that the voltage switching frequency (high & low)
between ECM terminal 16 and engine ground is very less than
that of ECM terminal 35 and engine ground.
Switching frequency ratio = A/B
A: Heated oxygen sensor 2 voltage switching frequency
B: Heated oxygen sensor 1 voltage switching frequency
This ratio should be less than 0.75.
If the ratio is greater than above, it means three way catalyst
does not operate properly. Go to EC-1220, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
NOTE:
If the voltage at terminal 92 does not switch periodically more than 5
times within 10 seconds at step 5, perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0133 first. (See EC-1129 .)
PBIB0567E
SEF535Z
MBIB0018E
MBIB0124E
EC-1220
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0420 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GFJ
1. CHECK EXHAUST SYSTEM
Visually check exhaust tubes and muffler for dent.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace.
2. CHECK EXHAUST AIR LEAK
1. Start engine and run it at idle.
2. Listen for an exhaust air leak before the three way catalyst
(Manifold).
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
3. CHECK INTAKE AIR LEAK
Listen for an intake air leak after the mass air flow sensor.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair or replace.
4. CHECK IGNITION TIMING
Check the following items. Refer to EC-1032, "Basic Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Follow the Basic Inspection.
SEF099P
Items Specifications
Ignition timing
CVT 15 5 BTDC (in P or N position)
M/T 14 5 BTDC
Target idle speed
CVT 650 50 rpm (in P or N position)
M/T 600 50 rpm
DTC P0420 THREE WAY CATALYST FUNCTION
EC-1221
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. CHECK INJECTORS
1. Refer to Wiring Diagram for Injectors, EC-1376 .
2. Stop engine and then turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminals 22, 23, 41, 42 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Perform EC-1377, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
6. CHECK IGNITION SPARK
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ignition coil assembly from rocker cover.
3. Connect a known good spark plug to the ignition coil assembly.
4. Place end of spark plug against a suitable ground and crank engine.
5. Check for spark.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Check ignition coil with power transistor and their circuit.
Refer to EC-1365, "IGNITION SIGNAL" .
7. CHECK INJECTOR
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Remove injector assembly.
Refer to EM-128, "FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE" .
Keep fuel hose and all injectors connected to injector gallery.
3. Disconnect all ignition coil harness connectors.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
Make sure fuel does not drip from injector.
OK or NG
OK (Does not drip.)>>GO TO 8.
NG (Drips.)>>Replace the injector(s) from which fuel is dripping.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
Trouble is fixed.>>INSPECTION END
Trouble is not fixed.>>Replace three way catalyst (Manifold).
Battery voltage should exist.
MBIB0030E
SEF575Q
EC-1222
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0444, P0445 EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE
DTC P0444, P0445 EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE PFP:14920
Description EBS00GVT
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
*1: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
*2: This signal is sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
This system controls flow rate of fuel vapor from the EVAP canister. The opening of the vapor by-pass pas-
sage in the EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve changes to control the flow rate. The EVAP
canister purge volume control solenoid valve repeats ON/OFF operation according to the signal sent from the
ECM. The opening of the valve varies for optimum engine control. The optimum value stored in the ECM is
determined by considering various engine conditions. When the engine is operating, the flow rate of fuel vapor
from the EVAP canister is regulated as the air flow changes.
COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
The EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve uses a ON/
OFF duty to control the flow rate of fuel vapor from the EVAP canis-
ter. The EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve is
moved by ON/OFF pulses from the ECM. The longer the ON pulse,
the greater the amount of fuel vapor that will flow through the valve.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GVU
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed*
1
EVAP canister
purge flow control
EVAP canister purge volume
control solenoid valve
Mass air flow sensor Amount of intake air
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Battery
Battery voltage*
1
Throttle position sensor Throttle position
Accelerator pedal position sensor Closed throttle position
Heated oxygen sensors 1
Density of oxygen in exhaust gas
(Mixture ratio feedback signal)
Vehicle speed signal*
2
Vehicle speed
SEF337U
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
PURG VOL C/V
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 0%
2,000 rpm 20 - 30%
DTC P0444, P0445 EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE
EC-1223
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GVZ
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GW0
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for at least 13 seconds.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1225, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0444
0444
EVAP canister purge volume
control solenoid valve circuit
open
An excessively low voltage signal is sent
to ECM through the valve
G Harness or connectors
(The solenoid valve circuit is open or
shorted.)
G EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve
P0445
0445
EVAP canister purge volume
control solenoid valve circuit
shorted
An excessively high voltage signal is sent
to ECM through the valve
G Harness or connectors
(The solenoid valve circuit is shorted.)
G EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve
SEF058Y
EC-1224
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0444, P0445 EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE
Wiring Diagram EBS00GVV
MBWA0016E
DTC P0444, P0445 EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE
EC-1225
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GVW
1. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE POWER SUPPLY CIR-
CUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve
harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve terminal 1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
19 P
EVAP canister purge
volume control solenoid
valve
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is about 2,000 rpm
(More than 100 seconds after starting engine)
Approximately 10V
PBIB0050E
PBIB0520E
MBIB0133E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0148E
EC-1226
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0444, P0445 EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness for open or short between EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve and ECM
>> Repair harness or connectors.
3. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OUTPUT SIGNAL CIR-
CUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 19 and EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid
valve terminal 2. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK (With CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 4.
OK (Without CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground and short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OPERATION
With CONSULT-II
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Start engine.
3. Perform PURG VOL CONT/V in ACTIVE TEST mode with
CONSULT-II. Check that engine speed varies according to the
valve opening.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Refer to EC-1227, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Continuity should exist.
PBIB0569E
DTC P0444, P0445 EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID
VALVE
EC-1227
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Component Inspection EBS00GVX
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
With CONSULT-II
Check air passage continuity of EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve under the following conditions.
Without CONSULT-II
Check air passage continuity of EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve under the following conditions.
Removal and Installation EBS00GVY
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Refer to EM-116, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
Condition
(PURG VOL CONT/V value)
Air passage continuity
between A and B
100.0% Yes
0.0% No
PBIB0149E
Condition
Air passage continuity
between A and B
12V direct current supply between termi-
nals 1 and 2
Yes
No supply No
PBIB0150E
EC-1228
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0500 VSS
DTC P0500 VSS PFP:32702
Description EBS00GFK
NOTE:
If DTC P0500 is displayed with DTC U1000 or U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-1083, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
The vehicle speed signal is sent to the combination meter from the ESP/TCS/ABS control unit or ABS actuator
and electric unit (control unit) through CAN communication line. The combination meter then sends a signal to
the ECM through CAN communication line.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GFL
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GFM
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Steps 1 and 2 may be conducted with the drive wheels lifted in the shop or by driving the vehicle. If a
road test is expected to be easier, it is unnecessary to lift the vehicle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Read VHCL SPEED SE in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II. The vehicle speed on CONSULT-
II should exceed 10 km/h (6 MPH) when rotating wheels with suitable gear position.
If NG, go to EC-1229, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If OK, go to following step.
3. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Warm engine up to normal operating temperature.
5. Maintain the following conditions for at least 60 consecutive sec-
onds.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1229, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00GFN
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the vehicle speed signal circuit. During this check, a 1st trip
DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Lift up drive wheels.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0500
0500
Vehicle speed sensor
The almost 0 km/h (0 MPH) signal from
vehicle speed sensor is sent to ECM
even when vehicle is being driven.
G Harness or connectors
(The CAN communication line is open or
shorted.)
G ESP/TCS/ABS control unit
G ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
G Wheel sensor
G Combination meter
ENG SPEED 2,000 - 6,000 rpm
COOLAN TEMP/S More than 70C (158F)
B/FUEL SCHDL 4.9 - 31.8 msec
Selector lever Suitable position
PW/ST SIGNAL OFF
SEF196Y
DTC P0500 VSS
EC-1229
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Start engine.
3. Read vehicle speed signal in MODE 1 with GST.
The vehicle speed signal on GST should be able to exceed 10 km/h (6 MPH) when rotating wheels with
suitable gear position.
4. If NG, go to EC-1229, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GFO
1. CHECK DTC
Refer to BRC-17, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS" (Models without ESP) or BRC-60, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS"
(Models with ESP).
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace.
2. CHECK COMBINATION METER
Check combination meter function.
Refer to DI-5, "COMBINATION METERS (LHD MODELS)" or DI-34, "COMBINATION METERS (RHD MOD-
ELS)" .
>> INSPECTION END
EC-1230
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0550 PSP SENSOR
DTC P0550 PSP SENSOR PFP:49763
Component Description EBS00GFP
Power steering pressure (PSP) sensor is installed to the power
steering high-pressure tube and detects a power steering load. This
sensor is a potentiometer which transforms the power steering load
into output voltage, and emits the voltage signal to the ECM. The
ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator and adjusts the
throttle valve opening angle to increase the engine speed and
adjusts the idle speed for the increased load.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GFQ
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GFR
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GFS
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for at least 5 seconds.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1232, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
MBIB0153E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
PW/ST SIGNAL
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Steering wheel is in neutral position.
(Forward direction)
OFF
Steering wheel is turned. ON
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0550
0550
Power steering pressure
sensor circuit
An excessively low or high voltage from the
sensor is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Power steering pressure sensor
DTC P0550 PSP SENSOR
EC-1231
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GFT
MBWA0032E
EC-1232
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0550 PSP SENSOR
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GFU
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
12 Y
Power steering pressure
sensor
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is being turned.
Approximately 3.6V
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is not being turned.
Approximately 0.6V
55 B Sensors' ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
65 R
Sensor's power supply
(Power steering pres-
sure sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
MBIB0142E
DTC P0550 PSP SENSOR
EC-1233
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK PSP SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect PSP sensor harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between PSP sensor terminal 3 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair harness or connectors.
3. CHECK PSP SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 55 and PSP sensor terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between power steering pressure sensor and ECM
G Harness for open or short between power steering pressure sensor and TCM
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK PSP SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 12 and PSP sensor terminal 2.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0153E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
SEF509Y
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
EC-1234
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0550 PSP SENSOR
6. CHECK PSP SENSOR
Refer to EC-1234, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace PSP sensor.
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GFV
POWER STEERING PRESSURE SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Start engine and let it idle.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminal 12 and ground under the
following conditions.
Condition Voltage
Steering wheel is being turned fully. Approximately 3.6V
Steering wheel is not being turned. Approximately 0.6V
MBIB0025E
DTC P0605 ECM
EC-1235
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0605 ECM PFP:23710
Component Description EBS00GFW
The ECM consists of a microcomputer and connectors for signal
input and output and for power supply. The ECM controls the engine.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GFX
FAIL-SAFE MODE
ECM enters fail-safe mode when malfunction A is detected.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GFY
Perform PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A first. If the DTC cannot be confirmed, perform PRO-
CEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION B. If there is no problem on PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION B,
perform PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1237, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
With GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
SEF093X
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0605
0605
Engine control module
A) ECM calculation function is malfunctioning.
G ECM B) ECM EEP-ROM system is malfunctioning.
C) ECM self shut-off function is malfunctioning.
Detected items Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
Malfunction A
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5
degrees) by the return spring.
SEF058Y
EC-1236
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0605 ECM
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION B
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then
turn ON.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1237, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
With GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then
turn ON.
4. Repeat step 3 procedure, 32 times.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1237, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
With GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
SEF058Y
SEF058Y
DTC P0605 ECM
EC-1237
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GFZ
1. INSPECTION START
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select SELF DIAG RESULTS mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Touch ERASE.
4. Perform DTC Confirmation Procedure.
See EC-1235 .
5. Is the 1st trip DTC P0605 displayed again?
With GST
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select MODE 4 with GST.
3. Touch ERASE.
4. Perform DTC Confirmation Procedure.
See EC-1235 .
5. Is the 1st trip DTC P0605 displayed again?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> INSPECTION END
2. REPLACE ECM
1. Replace ECM.
2. Perform initialization of NATS system and registration of all NATS ignition key IDs. Refer to EC-1016,
"NATS (Nissan Anti-theft System)" .
3. Perform EC-998, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
5. Perform EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
EC-1238
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY PFP:23710
Component Description EBS00GG0
Battery voltage is supplied to the ECM even when the ignition switch
is turned OFF for the ECM memory function of the DTC memory, the
air fuel ratio feedback compensation value memory, the idle air vol-
ume learning value memory, etc.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GG1
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GG2
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then
turn ON.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 four times.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1240, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
SEF093X
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1065
1065
ECM power supply circuit
ECM back up RAM system does not function
properly.
G Harness or connectors
[ECM power supply (back-up) circuit is
open or shorted.]
G ECM
SEF058Y
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY
EC-1239
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GG3
MBWA0040E
EC-1240
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GG4
1. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminal 121 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between ECM and battery
>> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
121 W/L
Power supply for ECM
(Buck-up)
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0026E
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY
EC-1241
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select SELF DIAG RESULTS mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Touch ERASE.
4. Perform DTC Confirmation Procedure.
See EC-1238 .
5. Is the 1st trip DTC P1065 displayed again?
With GST
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select MODE 4 with GST.
3. Touch ERASE.
4. Perform DTC Confirmation Procedure.
See EC-1238 .
5. Is the 1st trip DTC P1065 displayed again?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 5.
No >> INSPECTION END
5. REPLACE ECM
1. Replace ECM.
2. Perform initialization of NATS system and registration of all NATS ignition key IDs. Refer to EC-1016,
"NATS (Nissan Anti-theft System)" .
3. Perform EC-998, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
5. Perform EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
EC-1242
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1111 IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
DTC P1111 IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE PFP:23796
Component Description EBS00GG5
Intake valve timing control solenoid valve is activated by ON/OFF
pulse duty (ratio) signals from the ECM.
The intake valve timing control solenoid valve changes the oil
amount and direction of flow through intake valve timing control unit
or stops oil flow.
The longer pulse width advances valve angle.
The shorter pulse width retards valve angle.
When ON and OFF pulse widths become equal, the solenoid valve
stops oil pressure flow to fix the intake valve angle at the control
position.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GG6
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GG7
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GG8
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF
and wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1244, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
WITH GST
Following the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
PBIB0195E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
INT/V SOL (B1)
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 0% - 2%
When revving engine up to 2,000 rpm
quickly
Approx. 0% - 50%
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1111
1111
Intake valve timing control
solenoid valve circuit
An improper voltage is sent to the ECM
through intake valve timing control solenoid
valve.
G Harness or connectors
(Solenoid valve circuit is open or shorted.)
G Intake valve timing control solenoid valve
SEF058Y
DTC P1111 IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
EC-1243
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GG9
MBWA0017E
EC-1244
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1111 IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GGA
1. CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect intake valve timing control solenoid valve harness
connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between intake valve timing control solenoid
valve terminal 1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
62 Y
Intake valve timing
control solenoid valve
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G When revving engine up to 2,000 rpm quickly
Approximately 4V - BATTERY
VOLTAGE (11 - 14V)
MBIB0052E
PBIB0532E
MBIB0138E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0285E
DTC P1111 IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
EC-1245
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. DETECT MALFUNCTION PART
Check harness for open or short between intake valve timing control solenoid valve and ECM relay.
>> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3. CHECK INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR
OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 62 and intake valve timing control solenoid valve termi-
nal 2. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Refer to EC-1245, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace intake valve timing control solenoid valve.
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GGB
INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
1. Disconnect intake valve timing control solenoid valve harness connector.
2. Check resistance between intake valve timing control solenoid
valve terminals 1 and 2 under the following conditions.
Removal and Installation EBS00GGC
INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Refer to EM-143, "TIMING CHAIN" .
Continuity should exist.
Terminals Resistance
1 and 2 Approximately 8 at 20C (68F)
1 or 2 and ground

(Continuity should not exist)
MBIB0027E
EC-1246
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1121 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
DTC P1121 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00GGD
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor, throttle position sensor, etc.
The throttle control motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve.
The throttle position sensor detects the throttle valve position, and the opening and closing speed of the throt-
tle valve and feeds the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM judges the current opening angle of the throttle
valve from these signals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the throttle valve opening
angle properly in response to driving condition.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GGE
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction A or B is detected in the two consecutive trips, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and MI
lights up.
When the malfunction C is detected even in the 1st trip, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GNX
NOTE:
G Perform PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A AND B first. If the 1st trip DTC cannot be con-
firmed, perform PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C.
G If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and
wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A AND B
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition witch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Shift selector lever to D position (CVT), 1st position (M/T) and
wait at least 2 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then
turn ON.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1247, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
With GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1121
1121
Electric throttle control
actuator
A)
Electric throttle control actuator does not function
properly due to the return spring malfunction.
G Electric throttle control actuator
B)
Throttle valve opening angle in fail-safe mode is
not in specified range.
C)
ECM detect the throttle valve is stuck open.
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection
logic.
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
Malfunction A
The ECM controls the electric throttle actuator by regulating the throttle opening around the idle position.
The engine speed will not rise more than 2,000 rpm.
Malfunction B ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator by regulating the throttle opening to 20 degrees or less.
Malfunction C
While the vehicle is driving, it slows down gradually by fuel cut. After the vehicle stops, the engine stalls.
The engine can restart in N or P position, and engine speed will not exceed 1,000 rpm or more.
SEF058Y
DTC P1121 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
EC-1247
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Shift selector lever to D position (CVT), 1st position (M/T) and
wait at least 2 seconds.
4. Shift selector lever to N or P position.
5. Start engine and let it idle for 3 seconds.
6. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1247, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
With GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GNY
1. CHECK ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR VISUALLY
1. Remove the intake air duct.
2. Check if a foreign matter is caught between the throttle valve
and the housing.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Remove the foreign matter and clean the electric throttle
control actuator inside.
2. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
Removal and Installation EBS00HBW
Refer to EM-116, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
SEF058Y
MBIB0143E
EC-1248
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION PFP:16119
Description EBS00GGH
NOTE:
If DTC P1122 is displayed with DTC P1121 or 1126, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P1121 or
P1126. Refer to EC-1246 or EC-1255 .
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor, throttle position sensor, etc.
The throttle control motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve.
The current opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the throttle position sensor and it provides feed-
back to the ECM to control the throttle control motor to make the throttle valve opening angle properly in
response to driving condition.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GGI
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GGJ
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1250, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1122
1122
Electric throttle control
performance problem
Electric throttle control function does not
operate properly.
G Harness or connectors
(Throttle control motor circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Harness or connectors
(Throttle control motor relay circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
G Throttle control motor relay
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return
spring.
SEF058Y
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
EC-1249
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GGK
MBWA0132E
EC-1250
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GGL
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
3 R
Throttle control motor relay
power supply
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
4 BR
Throttle control motor
(Close)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is releasing
0 - 14V
5 Y
Throttle control motor
(Open)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is depressing
0 - 14V
104 OR Throttle control motor relay
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch ON] 0 - 1.0V
PBIB0534E
PBIB0533E
MBIB0142E
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
EC-1251
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY SIGNAL CIRCUIT
Check voltage between ECM terminal 3 and ground under the fol-
lowing conditions with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect throttle control motor relay.
3. Check voltage between throttle control motor relay terminals 2, 5
and ground.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G 15A fuse
G Harness for open or short between throttle control motor relay and fuse
>> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
Ignition switch Voltage
OFF Approximately 0V
ON
Battery voltage
(11 - 14V)
MBIB0028E
MBIB0140E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0575E
EC-1252
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
5. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 3 and throttle control motor relay terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
6. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E70, F13 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E63, F31 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between ECM and throttle control motor relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Check continuity between ECM terminal 104 and throttle control motor relay terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> GO TO 8.
8. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness for open or short between ECM and throttle control motor relay
>> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
9. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
Refer to EC-1254, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> Replace throttle control motor relay.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
EC-1253
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
10. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN OR SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between the following terminals.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> Repair or replace.
11. CHECK ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR VISUALLY
1. Remove the intake air duct.
2. Check if foreign matter is caught between the throttle valve and
the housing.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Remove the foreign matter and clean the electric throttle
control actuator inside.
12. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
Refer to EC-1254, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> GO TO 14.
13. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14.
NG >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
14. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
Electric throttle control
actuator terminal
ECM terminal Continuity
3
4 Should exist
5 Should not exist
6
4 Should not exist
5 Should exist
MBIB0133E
MBIB0143E
EC-1254
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
Component Inspection EBS00GGM
THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
1. Apply 12V direct current between relay terminals 1 and 2.
2. Check continuity between relay terminals 3 and 5.
3. If NG, replace throttle control motor relay.
THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Check resistance between terminals 3 and 6.
3. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to next
step.
4. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
5. Perform EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00GGN
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-116, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
Conditions Continuity
12V direct current supply between terminals
1 and 2
Yes
No current supply No
PBIB0098E
Resistance: Approximately 1 - 15 [at 25 C (77F)]
PBIB0095E
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
EC-1255
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00GGO
Power supply for the Throttle Control motor is provided to the ECM via throttle control motor relay. The throttle
control motor relay is ON/OFF controlled by the ECM. When the ignition switch is turned ON, the ECM sends
an ON signal to throttle control motor relay and battery voltage is provided to the ECM. When the ignition
switch is turned OFF, the ECM sends an OFF signal to throttle control motor relay and battery voltage is not
provided to the ECM.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GGP
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GGQ
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the DTC P1124 is detected in the two consecutive trips, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and MI lights up.
When the DTC P1126 is detected even in the 1st trip, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GGR
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
PROCEDURE FOR DTC P1124
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1258, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
With GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
THRTL RELAY G Ignition switch: ON ON
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1124
1124
Throttle control motor
relay circuit short
ECM detect the throttle control motor relay
is stuck ON.
G Harness or connectors
(Throttle control motor relay circuit is shorted.)
G Throttle control motor relay
P1126
1126
Throttle control motor
relay circuit open
ECM detects a voltage of power source for
throttle control motor is excessively low.
This self-diagnosis has the one trip
detection logic.
G Harness or connectors
(Throttle control motor relay circuit is open.)
G Throttle control motor relay
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return
spring.
SEF058Y
EC-1256
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
PROCEDURE FOR DTC P1126
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1258, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
With GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
SEF058Y
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
EC-1257
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GGS
MBWA0133E
EC-1258
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GGT
1. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect throttle control motor relay.
3. Check voltage between throttle control motor relay terminals 2, 5
and ground.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G 15A fuse
G Harness for open or short between throttle control motor relay and fuse
>> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
3 R
Throttle control motor relay
power supply
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
104 OR Throttle control motor relay
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch ON] 0 - 1.0V
MBIB0140E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0575E
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
EC-1259
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 3 and throttle control motor relay terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E70, F13 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E63, F31 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between ECM and throttle control motor relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Check continuity between ECM terminal 104 and throttle control motor relay terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
6. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness for open or short between ECM and throttle control motor relay
>> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
7. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
Refer to EC-1259, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace throttle control motor relay.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GGU
THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
1. Apply 12V direct current between relay terminals 1 and 2.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
EC-1260
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
2. Check continuity between relay terminals 3 and 5.
3. If NG, replace throttle control motor relay.
Conditions Continuity
12V direct current supply between terminals
1 and 2
Yes
No current supply No
PBIB0098E
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
EC-1261
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00GGV
The throttle control motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve.
The current opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the throttle position sensor and it provides feed-
back to the ECM to control the throttle control motor to make the throttle valve opening angle properly in
response to driving condition.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GGW
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GGX
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1263, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1128
1128
Throttle control motor
circuit short
ECM detects short both circuits between ECM
and throttle control motor.
G Harness or connectors
(Throttle control motor circuit is shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
(Throttle control motor)
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return
spring.
SEF058Y
EC-1262
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00GGY
MBWA0134E
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
EC-1263
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GGZ
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
4 BR
Throttle control motor
(Close)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is releasing
0 - 14V
5 Y
Throttle control motor
(Open)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is depressing
0 - 14V
PBIB0534E
PBIB0533E
MBIB0142E
EC-1264
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
2. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN OR SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between the following terminals.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
3. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
Refer to EC-1264, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 5.
4. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GH0
THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Check resistance between terminals 3 and 6.
3. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to next
step.
4. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
5. Perform EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Electric throttle control
actuator terminal
ECM terminal Continuity
3
4 Should exist
5 Should not exist
6
4 Should not exist
5 Should exist
MBIB0133E
Resistance: Approximately 1 - 15 [at 25 C (77F)]
PBIB0095E
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
EC-1265
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Remove and Installation EBS00GH1
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-116, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
EC-1266
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1143 HO2S1
DTC P1143 HO2S1 PFP:22690
Component Description EBS00GH2
The heated oxygen sensor 1 is placed into the exhaust manifold. It
detects the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas compared to the
outside air. The heated oxygen sensor 1 has a closed-end tube
made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from
approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner conditions. The
heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM adjusts
the injection pulse duration to achieve the ideal air-fuel ratio. The
ideal air-fuel ratio occurs near the radical change from 1V to 0V.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GH3
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GH4
To judge the malfunction, the output from the heated oxygen sensor
1 is monitored to determine whether the rich output is sufficiently
high and whether the lean output is sufficiently low. When both the
outputs are shifting to the lean side, the malfunction will be detected.
SEF463R
SEF288D
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times dur-
ing 10 seconds.
SEF300U
DTC P1143 HO2S1
EC-1267
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GH5
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
G Always perform at a temperature above 10C (14F).
G Before performing following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Stop engine and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select HO2S1 (B1) P1143 of HO2S1 in DTC WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch START.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 3 minutes.
NOTE:
Never raise engine speed above 3,600 rpm after this step. If
the engine speed limit is exceeded, return to step 5.
6. When the following conditions are met, TESTING will be dis-
played on the CONSULT-II screen. Maintain the conditions con-
tinuously until TESTING changes to COMPLETED. (It will
take approximately 50 seconds or more.)
If TESTING is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from
step 2.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1143
1143
Heated oxygen sensor 1
lean shift monitoring
The maximum and minimum voltage from the
sensor are not reached to the specified voltages.
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
G Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
G Fuel pressure
G Injectors
G Intake air leaks
PBIB0546E
ENG SPEED 1,400 - 3,200 rpm
Vehicle speed Less than 100 km/h (62 MPH)
B/FUEL SCHDL 2.9 - 14.5 msec
Selector lever Suitable position
PBIB0547E
EC-1268
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1143 HO2S1
7. Make sure that OK is displayed after touching SELF-DIAG
RESULTS. If NG is displayed, refer to EC-1268, "Diagnostic
Procedure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00GH6
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
3. Check one of the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm
constant under no load.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is over 0.1V at least one time.
4. If NG, go to EC-1268, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GH7
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
SEC769C
MBIB0018E
MBIB0142E
DTC P1143 HO2S1
EC-1269
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. RETIGHTEN HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Loosen and retighten heated oxygen sensor 1.
>> GO TO 3.
3. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure that DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-1015, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure that DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0171. Refer to EC-1157 .
No >> GO TO 4.
4. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 HEATER
Refer to EC-1094, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
Tightening torque: 40 - 50 Nm (4.1 - 5.1 kg-m, 30 - 37 ft-lb)
MBIB0150E
SEF215Z
MBIB0131E
EC-1270
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1143 HO2S1
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-1270, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
For circuit, refer to EC-1121, "Wiring Diagram" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GH8
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG and adjust TRIGGER POINT to 100% in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-
II.
3. Select HO2S1 (B1) and HO2S1 MNTR (B1).
4. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load during the follow-
ing steps.
5. Touch RECORD on CONSULT-II screen.
6. Check the following.
G HO2S1 MNTR (B1) in DATA MONITOR mode changes
from RICH to LEAN to RICH 5 times in 10 seconds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes below 0.3V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
SEF646Y
SEF217YA
SEF648Y
DTC P1143 HO2S1
EC-1271
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
G The voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new
one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00GH9
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-121, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND THREE WAY CATALYST" .
MBIB0018E
EC-1272
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1144 HO2S1
DTC P1144 HO2S1 PFP:22690
Component Description EBS00GHA
The heated oxygen sensor 1 is placed into the exhaust manifold. It
detects the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas compared to the
outside air. The heated oxygen sensor 1 has a closed-end tube
made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from
approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner conditions. The
heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM adjusts
the injection pulse duration to achieve the ideal air-fuel ratio. The
ideal air-fuel ratio occurs near the radical change from 1V to 0V.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GHB
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GHC
To judge the malfunction, the output from the heated oxygen sensor
1 is monitored to determine whether the rich output is sufficiently
high. The lean output is sufficiently low. When both the outputs are
shifting to the rich side, the malfunction will be detected.
SEF463R
SEF288D
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times dur-
ing 10 seconds.
SEF299U
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1144
1144
Heated oxygen sensor 1
rich shift monitoring
The maximum and minimum voltages from the
sensor are beyond the specified voltages.
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
G Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
G Fuel pressure
G Injectors
DTC P1144 HO2S1
EC-1273
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GHD
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
G Always perform at a temperature above 10C (14F).
G Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 11V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Stop engine and wait at least 5 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select HO2S1 (B1) P1144 of HO2S1 in DTC WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch START.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 3 minutes.
NOTE:
Never raise engine speed above 3,600 rpm after this step. If
the engine speed limit is exceeded, return to step 5.
6. When the following conditions are met, TESTING will be dis-
played on the CONSULT-II screen. Maintain the conditions con-
tinuously until TESTING changes to COMPLETED. (It will
take approximately 50 seconds or more.)
If TESTING is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from
step 2.
7. Make sure that OK is displayed after touching SELF-DIAG
RESULTS. If NG is displayed, refer to EC-1274, "Diagnostic
Procedure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00GHE
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
PBIB0548E
ENG SPEED 1,400 - 3,200 rpm
Vehicle speed Less than 100 km/h (62 MPH)
B/FUEL SCHDL 2.9 - 14.5 msec
Selector lever Suitable position
PBIB0549E
SEC772C
EC-1274
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1144 HO2S1
WITH GST
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
3. Check one of the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm
constant under no load.
G The maximum voltage is below 0.8V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.35V at least one time.
4. If NG, go to EC-1274, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GHF
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
2. RETIGHTEN HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Loosen and retighten heated oxygen sensor 1.
>> GO TO 3.
MBIB0018E
MBIB0142E
Tightening torque: 40 - 50 Nm (4.1 - 5.1 kg-m, 30 - 37 ft-lb)
MBIB0150E
DTC P1144 HO2S1
EC-1275
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure that DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-1015, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure that DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0172. Refer to EC-1163 .
No >> GO TO 4.
4. CHECK HO2S1 CONNECTOR FOR WATER
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
3. Check connectors for water.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
SEF215Z
MBIB0131E
Water should not exist.
MBIB0151E
EC-1276
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1144 HO2S1
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 HEATER
Refer to EC-1094, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
6. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-1276, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
For circuit, refer to EC-1121, "Wiring Diagram" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GHG
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG and adjust TRIGGER POINT to 100% in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-
II.
3. Select HO2S1 (B1) and HO2S1 MNTR (B1).
4. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load during the follow-
ing steps.
5. Touch RECORD on CONSULT-II screen.
6. Check the following.
G HO2S1 MNTR (B1) in DATA MONITOR mode changes
from RICH to LEAN to RICH 5 times in 10 seconds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes below 0.3V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
SEF646Y
SEF217YA
DTC P1144 HO2S1
EC-1277
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
G The voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new
one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00GHH
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-121, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND THREE WAY CATALYST" .
SEF648Y
MBIB0018E
EC-1278
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1146 HO2S2
DTC P1146 HO2S2 PFP:226A0
Component Description EBS00GHI
The heated oxygen sensor 2, after three way catalyst (manifold),
monitors the oxygen level in the exhaust gas on each bank.
Even if switching characteristics of the heated oxygen sensor 1 are
shifted, the air fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal
from the heated oxygen sensor 2.
This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates volt-
age from approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner condi-
tions.
Under normal conditions the heated oxygen sensor 2 is not used for
engine control operation.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GHJ
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GHK
The heated oxygen sensor 2 has a much longer switching time
between rich and lean than the heated oxygen sensor 1. The oxygen
storage capacity before the three way catalyst causes the longer
switching time. To judge the malfunctions of heated oxygen sensor
2, ECM monitors whether the minimum voltage of sensor is suffi-
ciently low during the various driving condition such as fuel-cut.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GHL
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
G COMPLETED will appear on CONSULT-II screen when all tests COND1, COND2 and
COND3 are completed.
G If DTC confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and
wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Never stop engine during this procedure. If the engine is stopped, retry procedure from step 2 in Pro-
cedure for COND1
SEF327R
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S2 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S2 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
LEAN RICH
PBIB0554E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1146
1146
Heated oxygen sensor 2
minimum voltage monitoring
The minimum voltage from the sensor is not
reached to the specified voltage.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 2
G Fuel pressure
G Injectors
DTC P1146 HO2S2
EC-1279
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
WITH CONSULT-II
Procedure for COND1
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select HO2S2 (B1) P1146 of HO2S2 in DTC WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch START.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 30 seconds.
6. Rev engine up to 2,000 rpm 2 or 3 times quickly under no load.
If COMPLETED appears on CONSULT-II screen, go to step 2 in Procedure for COND3.
If COMPLETED does not appear on CONSULT-II screen, go to the following step.
7. Drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
8. When the following conditions are met, TESTING will be displayed at COND1 on the CONSULT-II
screen. Maintain the conditions continuously until TESTING changes to COMPLETED. (It will take
approximately 60 seconds.)
NOTE:
G If TESTING is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from step 2 in Procedure for COND1.
G If COMPLETED already appears at COND2 on CONSULT-II screen before Procedure for
COND2 is conducted, it is unnecessary to conduct step 1 in Procedure for COND2.
Procedure for COND2
1. While driving, release accelerator pedal completed from the
above condition [step 8] until INCOMPLETE at COND2 on
CONSULT-II screen has turned to COMPLETED (It will take
approximately 4 seconds.)
NOTE:
If COMPLETE already appears at COND3 on CONSULT-
II screen before Procedure for COND3 is conducted, it is
unnecessary to conduct step 1 in Procedure for COND3.
ENG SPEED More than 1,000 rpm
B/FUEL SCHDL More than 1.0 msec
COOLANT TEMP/S 70 - 105C
Selector lever Suitable position
PBIB0555E
PBIB0556E
EC-1280
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1146 HO2S2
Procedure for COND3
1. Stop vehicle and let it idle until INCOMPLETE of COND3 on
CONSULT-II screen has turned to COMPLETED. (It will take a
maximum of approximately 6 minutes.)
2. Make sure that OK is displayed after touching SELF-DIAG
RESULTS.
If NG is displayed, refer to EC-1282, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00GHM
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 2 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 (HO2S2 signal) and engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be below 0.50V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage can be confirmed in step 4, step 5 is not nec-
essary.
5. Keep vehicle at idling for 10 minutes, then check the voltage. Or
check the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D
position (CVT), 3rd gear position (M/T).
The voltage should be below 0.50V at least once during this
procedure.
6. If NG, go to EC-1282, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEC775C
MBIB0020E
DTC P1146 HO2S2
EC-1281
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GHN
MBWA0010E
EC-1282
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1146 HO2S2
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GHO
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
16 W/Y Heated oxygen sensor 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
74 B Sensors' ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0142E
DTC P1146 HO2S2
EC-1283
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure that DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-1015, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure that DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0172 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0172. Refer to EC-1163 .
No >> GO TO 3.
3. CHECK HO2S2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S2
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
SEF215Z
MBIB0131E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0151E
EC-1284
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1146 HO2S2
4. CHECK HO2S2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 16 and HO2S2 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 16 or HO2S2 terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EC-1284, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GHP
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Select FUEL INJECTION in ACTIVE TEST mode, and select
HO2S2 (B1) as the monitor item with CONSULT-II.
4. Check HO2S2 (B1) at idle speed when adjusting FUEL INJECTION to 25%.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
SEF662Y
PBIB0551E
DTC P1146 HO2S2
EC-1285
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
HO2S2 (B1) should be above 0.68V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is +25%.
HO2S2 (B1) should be below 0.50V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is 25%.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 (HO2S2 signal) and engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.68V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage is above 0.68V at step 4, step 5 is not neces-
sary.
5. Keep vehicle at idling for 10 minutes, then check voltage. Or
check the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D
position (CVT), 3rd gear position (M/T).
The voltage should be below 0.50V at least once during this
procedure.
6. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00GHQ
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EX-3, "EXHAUST SYSTEM" .
MBIB0020E
EC-1286
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1147 HO2S2
DTC P1147 HO2S2 PFP:226A0
Component Description EBS00GHR
The heated oxygen sensor 2, after three way catalyst (manifold),
monitors the oxygen level in the exhaust gas on each bank.
Even if switching characteristics of the heated oxygen sensor 1 are
shifted, the air fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal
from the heated oxygen sensor 2.
This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates volt-
age from approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner condi-
tions.
Under normal conditions the heated oxygen sensor 2 is not used for
engine control operation.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GHS
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GHT
The heated oxygen sensor 2 has a much longer switching time
between rich and lean than the heated oxygen sensor 1. The oxygen
storage capacity before the three way catalyst causes the longer
switching time. To judge the malfunctions of heated oxygen sensor
2, ECM monitors whether the maximum voltage of the sensor is suf-
ficiently high during the various driving condition such as fuel-cut.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GHU
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
G COMPLETED will appear on CONSULT-II screen when all tests COND1, COND2 and
COND3 are completed.
G If DTC confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and
wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Never stop engine during this procedure. If the engine is stopped, retry procedure from step 2 in Pro-
cedure for COND1
SEF327R
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S2 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S2 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
LEAN RICH
SEF259VA
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1147
1147
Heated oxygen sensor 2
maximum voltage monitoring
The maximum voltage from the sensor is
not reached to the specified voltage.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 2
G Fuel pressure
G Injectors
G Intake air leaks
DTC P1147 HO2S2
EC-1287
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
WITH CONSULT-II
Procedure for COND1
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON and select HO2S2 (B1) P1147 of HO2S2 in DTC WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
4. Touch START.
5. Start engine and let it idle for at least 30 seconds.
6. Rev engine up to 2,000 rpm 2 or 3 times quickly under no load.
If COMPLETED appears on CONSULT-II screen, go to step 2 in Procedure for COND3.
If COMPLETED does not appear on CONSULT-II screen, go to the following step.
7. Drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
8. When the following conditions are met, TESTING will be displayed at COND1 on the CONSULT-II
screen. Maintain the conditions continuously until TESTING changes to COMPLETED. (It will take
approximately 60 seconds.)
NOTE:
G If TESTING is not displayed after 5 minutes, retry from step 2 in Procedure for COND1.
G If COMPLETED already appears at COND2 on CONSULT-II screen before Procedure for
COND2 is conducted, it is unnecessary to conduct step 1 in Procedure for COND2.
Procedure for COND2
1. While driving, release accelerator pedal completed from the
above condition [step 8] until INCOMPLETE at COND2 on
CONSULT-II screen has turned to COMPLETED (It will take
approximately 4 seconds.)
NOTE:
If COMPLETE already appears at COND3 on CONSULT-
II screen before Procedure for COND3 is conducted, it is
unnecessary to conduct step 1 in Procedure for COND3.
ENG SPEED More than 1,000 rpm
B/FUEL SCHDL More than 1.0 msec
COOLANT TEMP/S 70 - 105C
Selector lever Suitable position
PBIB0557E
PBIB0558E
EC-1288
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1147 HO2S2
Procedure for COND3
1. Stop vehicle and let it idle until INCOMPLETE of COND3 on
CONSULT-II screen has turned to COMPLETED. (It will take a
maximum of approximately 6 minutes.)
2. Make sure that OK is displayed after touching SELF-DIAG
RESULTS.
If NG is displayed, refer to EC-1290, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00GHV
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 2 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 (HO2S2 signal) and engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.68V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage can be confirmed in step 4, step 5 is not nec-
essary.
5. Keep vehicle idling for 10 minutes, then check the voltage. Or
check the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D
position (CVT), 3rd gear position (M/T).
The voltage should be above 0.68V at least once during this
procedure.
6. If NG, go to EC-1290, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEC778C
MBIB0020E
DTC P1147 HO2S2
EC-1289
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GHW
MBWA0010E
EC-1290
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1147 HO2S2
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GHX
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
16 W/Y Heated oxygen sensor 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
74 B Sensors' ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0142E
DTC P1147 HO2S2
EC-1291
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CLEAR THE SELF-LEARNING DATA
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select SELF-LEARNING CONT in WORK SUPPORT mode
with CONSULT-II.
3. Clear the self-learning control coefficient by touching CLEAR.
4. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector, and restart
and run engine for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
4. Stop engine and reconnect mass air flow sensor harness con-
nector.
5. Make sure that DTC P0102 is displayed.
6. Erase the DTC memory. Refer to EC-1015, "HOW TO ERASE
EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
7. Make sure that DTC P0000 is displayed.
8. Run engine for at least 10 minutes at idle speed.
Is the 1st trip DTC P0171 detected?
Is it difficult to start engine?
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnosis for DTC P0171. Refer to EC-1157 .
No >> GO TO 3.
3. CHECK HO2S2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S2
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
SEF215Z
MBIB0131E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0151E
EC-1292
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1147 HO2S2
4. CHECK HO2S2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 16 and HO2S2 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 16 or HO2S2 terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EC-1292, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GHY
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Select FUEL INJECTION in ACTIVE TEST mode, and select
HO2S2 (B1) as the monitor item with CONSULT-II.
4. Check HO2S2 (B1) at idle speed when adjusting FUEL INJECTION to 25%.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
SEF662Y
PBIB0551E
DTC P1147 HO2S2
EC-1293
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
HO2S2 (B1) should be above 0.68V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is +25%.
HO2S2 (B1) should be below 0.50V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is 25%.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 (HO2S2 signal) and engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.68V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage is above 0.68V at step 4, step 5 is not neces-
sary.
5. Keep vehicle idling for 10 minutes, then check voltage. Or check
the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D posi-
tion (CVT), 3rd gear position (M/T).
The voltage should be below 0.50V at least once during this
procedure.
6. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00GHZ
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EX-3, "EXHAUST SYSTEM" .
MBIB0020E
EC-1294
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1212 ESP/TCS/ABS COMMUNICATION LINE
DTC P1212 ESP/TCS/ABS COMMUNICATION LINE PFP:47850
Description EBS00GWG
NOTE:
If DTC P1212 is displayed with DTC U1000 or U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-1083, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
This CAN communication line is used to control the smooth engine operation during ESP/TCS/ABS operation.
Pulse signals are exchanged between ECM and ESP/ABS/TCS control unit.
Be sure to erase the malfunction information such as DTC not only in ESP/TCS/ABS control unit but
also ECM after the ESP/TCS/ABS related repair.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GWH
Freeze frame data is not stored in the ECM for this self-diagnosis. The MI will not light up for this self-
diagnosis.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GWI
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10.5V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for at least 10 seconds.
4. If a 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1294, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GWJ
1. CHECK ESP/TCS/ABS CONTROL UNIT FUNCTION
Refer to BRC-60, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS" .
>> INSPECTION END
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1212
1212
ESP/TCS/ABS commu-
nication line
ECM can not receive the information from
ESP/TCS/ABS control unit continuously.
G Harness or connectors
(The CAN communication line between
ECM and ESP/TCS/ABS control unit is
open or shorted.)
G ESP/TCS/ABS control unit
G Dead (Weak) battery
SEF058Y
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-1295
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE PFP:00000
System Description EBS00GI0
NOTE:
If DTC P1217 is displayed with DTC U1000, U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-1083, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
COOLING FAN CONTROL
*1: These signals are sent to ECM through CAN communication line.
*2: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
The ECM controls the cooling fan corresponding to the vehicle speed, engine coolant temperature, refrigerant
pressure, and air conditioner ON signal. The control system has 3-step control [HIGH/LOW/OFF].
The ECM sends a cooling fan control signal to the smart entrance control unit through CAN communication
line, and the smart entrance control unit controls cooling fan relays.
OPERATION
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GI1
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Vehicle speed signal
Vehicle speed*
1
Cooling fan
control
Cooling fan relay(s)
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Air conditioner switch Air conditioner ON signal*
1
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed*
2
Battery Battery voltage*
2
Refrigerant pressure sensor Refrigerant pressure
PBIB0576E
EC-1296
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GI2
If the cooling fan or another component in the cooling system malfunctions, engine coolant temperature will
rise. When the engine coolant temperature reaches an abnormally high temperature condition, a malfunction
is indicated.
CAUTION:
When a malfunction is indicated, be sure to replace the coolant. Refer to MA-20, "Changing Engine
Coolant" . Also, replace the engine oil. Refer to MA-24, "Changing Engine Oil" .
1. Fill radiator with coolant up to specified level with a filling speed of 2 liters per minute. Be sure to
use coolant with the proper mixture ratio. Refer to MA-18, "Engine Coolant Mixture Ratio" .
2. After refilling coolant, run engine to ensure that no water-flow noise is emitted.
Overall Function Check EBS00GI3
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the cooling fan. During this check, a DTC might not be con-
firmed.
WARNING:
Never remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could be caused by high pres-
sure fluid escaping from the radiator.
Wrap a thick cloth around cap. Carefully remove the cap by turning it a quarter turn to allow built-up
pressure to escape. Then turn the cap all the way off.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Check the coolant level in the reservoir tank and radiator.
Allow engine to cool before checking coolant level.
If the coolant level in the reservoir tank and/or radiator is below
the proper range, skip the following steps and go to EC-1300,
"Diagnostic Procedure" .
2. Confirm whether customer filled the coolant or not. If customer
filled the coolant, skip the following steps and go to EC-1300,
"Diagnostic Procedure" .
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
AIR COND SIG
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Air conditioner switch: OFF OFF
Air conditioner switch: ON
(Compressor operates.)
ON
COOLING FAN
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
Engine coolant temperature is 99C
(210F) or less
OFF
Engine coolant temperature is 100C
(212F) or more
ON
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1217
1217
Engine over tempera-
ture (Overheat)
G Cooling fan does not operate properly (Over-
heat).
G Cooling fan system does not operate prop-
erly (Overheat).
G Engine coolant was not added to the system
using the proper filling method.
G Harness or connectors
(The cooling fan circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Cooling fan
G Radiator hose
G Radiator
G Radiator cap
G Water pump
G Thermostat
For more information, refer to EC-1310,
"Main 12 Causes of Overheating" .
SEF621W
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-1297
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. Perform COOLING FAN in ACTIVE TEST mode with CON-
SULT-II.
5. If the results are NG, go to EC-1300, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
1. Check the coolant level in the reservoir tank and radiator.
Allow engine to cool before checking coolant level.
If the coolant level in the reservoir tank and/or radiator is below
the proper range, skip the following steps and go to EC-1300,
"Diagnostic Procedure" .
2. Confirm whether customer filled the coolant or not. If customer
filled the coolant, skip the following steps and go to EC-1300,
"Diagnostic Procedure" .
3. Start engine.
Be careful not to overheat engine.
4. Set temperature control lever to full cold position.
5. Turn air conditioner switch ON.
6. Turn blower fan switch ON.
7. Run engine at idle for a few minutes with air conditioner operating.
Be careful not to overheat engine.
8. Make sure that cooling fans operates at low speed.
If NG, go to EC-1300, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If OK, go to the following step.
9. Turn ignition switch OFF.
10. Turn air conditioner switch and blower fan switch OFF.
11. Disconnect engine coolant temperature sensor harness connec-
tor.
12. Connect 150 resistor to engine coolant temperature sensor
harness connector.
13. Restart engine and make sure that cooling fan operates at
higher speed than low speed.
Be careful not to overheat engine.
14. If NG, go to EC-1300, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
MBIB0037E
SEF621W
SEC163BA
MEC475B
EC-1298
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
Wiring Diagram EBS00GI4
LHD MODELS
MBWA0018E
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-1299
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
RHD MODELS
MBWA0146E
EC-1300
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GRN
1. INSPECTION START
Do you have CONSULT-II?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> GO TO 5.
2. CHECK COOLING FAN LOW SPEED OPERATION
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Perform COOLING FAN in ACTIVE TEST mode with CON-
SULT-II and touch LOW on the CONSULT-II screen.
3. Make sure that cooling fans-1 and -2 operate at low speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Check cooling fan low speed control circuit. (Go to EC-
1304, "PROCEDURE A" .)
3. CHECK COOLING FAN HIGH SPEED OPERATION-I
With CONSULT-II
1. Touch HIGHon the CONSULT-II screen.
2. Make sure that cooling fan-1 operates at higher speed than low
speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Check cooling fan high speed control circuit-1. (Go to
EC-1306, "PROCEDURE B" .)
4. CHECK COOLING FAN HIGH SPEED OPERATION-II
With CONSULT-II
Make sure that cooling fan-2 operates at higher speed than low speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Check cooling fan high speed control circuit-2. (Go to EC-1308, "PROCEDURE C" .)
SEF784Z
SEF785Z
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-1301
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. CHECK COOLING FAN LOW SPEED OPERATION
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle.
2. Turn air conditioner switch ON.
3. Turn blower fan switch ON.
4. Make sure that cooling fans-1 and -2 operate at low speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Check cooling fan low speed control circuit. (Go to EC-
1304, "PROCEDURE A" .)
6. CHECK COOLING FAN HIGH SPEED OPERATION-I
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Turn air conditioner switch and blower fan switch OFF.
3. Disconnect engine coolant temperature sensor harness connector.
4. Connect 150 resistor to engine coolant temperature sensor harness connector.
5. Restart engine and make sure that cooling fan-1 operates at
higher speed than low speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Check cooling fan high speed control circuit-1. (Go to
EC-1306, "PROCEDURE B" .)
7. CHECK COOLING FAN HIGH SPEED OPERATION-II
Without CONSULT-II
Make sure that cooling fan-2 operates higher speed than lower speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Check cooling fan high speed control circuit-2. (Go to EC-1308, "PROCEDURE C" .)
SEC163BA
MEC475B
EC-1302
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
8. CHECK COOLING SYSTEM FOR LEAK
Apply pressure to the cooling system with a tester, and check if the pressure drops.
CAUTION:
Higher than the specified pressure may cause radiator damage.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> GO TO 8.
9. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following for leak.
G Hose
G Radiator
G Water pump (Refer toCO-38, "WATER PUMP" .)
>> Repair or replace.
10. CHECK RADIATOR CAP
Apply pressure to cap with a tester and check radiator cap relief
pressure.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> Replace radiator cap.
Testing pressure: 157 kPa (1.57 bar, 1.6 kg/cm
2
, 23psi)
Pressure should not drop.
SLC754A
Radiator cap relief pressure:
78 - 98 kPa (0.59 - 0.98 bar, 0.6 - 1.0 kg/cm
2
, 9 - 14 psi)
SLC755A
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-1303
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
11. CHECK THERMOSTAT
1. Remove thermostat.
2. Check valve seating condition at normal room temperatures.
It should seat tightly.
3. Check valve opening temperature and valve lift.
4. Check if valve is closed at 5C (9F) below valve opening tem-
perature. For details, refer to CO-40, "THERMOSTAT AND
WATER CONTROL VALVE" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Replace thermostat.
12. CHECK ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Refer to EC-1115, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> Replace engine coolant temperature sensor.
13. CHECK MAIN 12 CAUSES
If the cause cannot be isolated, go to EC-1310, "Main 12 Causes of Overheating" .
>> INSPECTION END
Valve opening temperature:
80.5 - 83.5 C (177 - 182 F)
Valve lift:
More than 8 mm/95 C (0.31 in/203 F)
SLC343
EC-1304
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
PROCEDURE A
1. CHECK COOLING FAN POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect cooling fan relay-1.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between cooling fan relay-1 terminals 2, 3 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Fuse block (J/B) connector E106
G 10A fuse
G 40A fusible link
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-1 and fuse
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-1 and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0137E
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0055E
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-1305
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTORS CONTROL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect cooling fan motor-1 harness connector and cooling
fan motor-2 harness connector.
3. Disconnect cooling fan relay-2 and cooling fan relay-4.
4. Check harness continuity between the following.
Cooling fan relay-1 terminal 5 and cooling fan motor-1 terminal 1
Cooling fan motor-1 terminal 2 and cooling fan relay-2 terminal 3
Cooling fan motor-1 terminal 2 and cooling fan relay-4 terminal 3
Cooling fan relay-2 terminal 4 and cooling fan motor-2 terminal 1
Cooling fan relay-4 terminal 4 and cooling fan motor-2 terminal 1
Cooling fan motor-2 terminal 2 and ground
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect smart entrance control unit harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between cooling fan relay-1 terminal 1
and smart entrance control unit terminal 33. Refer to Wiring Dia-
gram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E123, M17 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E110, M94 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-1 and smart entrance control unit
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK COOLING FAN RELAY-1, -2 AND 4
Refer to EC-1311, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace cooling fan relay.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0136E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0173E
EC-1306
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
7. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTORS-1 AND -2
Refer to EC-1311, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace cooling fan motors.
8. CHECK SMART ENTRANCE CONTROL UNIT
Refer to BCS-39, "Trouble Diagnoses" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace smart entrance control unit.
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Perform EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
PROCEDURE B
1. CHECK COOLING FAN RELAY GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect cooling fan relay-2 and cooling fan relay-4.
3. Check harness continuity between cooling fan relay-2 terminal 5
and ground, cooling fan relay-4 terminal 5 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
2. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect smart entrance control unit harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between cooling fan relay-2 terminal 2
and smart entrance control unit terminal 32, cooling fan relay-4
terminal 2 and smart entrance control unit terminal 32.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0137E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0173E
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-1307
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E123, M17 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E110, M94 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-2 and smart entrance control unit
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-4 and smart entrance control unit
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK COOLING FAN RELAYS-2 AND -4
Refer to EC-1311, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace cooling fan relays.
5. CHECK SMART ENTRANCE CONTROL UNIT
Refer to BCS-39, "Trouble Diagnoses" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace smart entrance control unit.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Perform EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
EC-1308
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
PROCEDURE C
1. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTOR-2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect cooling fan relay-3.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between cooling fan relay-3 terminals 2, 3 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Fuse block (J/B) connector E106
G 10A fuse
G 40A fusible link
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-3 and fuse
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-3 and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTOR CONTROL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect cooling fan motor-2 harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between cooling fan relay-3 terminal 5
and cooling fan motor-2 terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or con-
nectors.
MBIB0137E
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0055E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0136E
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-1309
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTOR CONTROL CIRCUIT FOR SHORT TO GROUND
Check harness continuity between cooling fan relay-3 terminal 5 or cooling fan motor-2 terminal 1 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Cooling fan relays-2 and -4 (Refer to EC-1311, "Component Inspection" )
G Harness for short to ground between cooling fan relay-2 and cooling fan motor-2
G Harness for short to ground between cooling fan relay-3 and cooling fan motor-2
G Harness for short to ground between cooling fan relay-4 and cooling fan motor-2
>> Repair or replace.
6. CHECK COOLING FAN OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect smart entrance control unit harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between cooling fan relay-3 terminal 1
and smart entrance control unit terminal 32.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E123, M17 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E110, M94 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-3 and smart entrance control unit
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK COOLING FAN RELAY-3
Refer to EC-1311, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace cooling fan relay.
9. CHECK SMART ENTRANCE CONTROL UNIT
Refer to BCS-39, "Trouble Diagnoses" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> Replace smart entrance control unit.
Continuity should not exist.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0173E
EC-1310
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
10. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Perform EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Main 12 Causes of Overheating EBS00GI6
*1: Turn the ignition switch ON.
*2: Engine running at 3,000 rpm for 10 minutes.
*3: Drive at 90 km/h (55 MPH) for 30 minutes and then let idle for 10 minutes.
*4: After 60 minutes of cool down time.
For more information, refer to CO-25, "OVERHEATING CAUSE ANALYSIS" .
Engine Step Inspection item Equipment Standard Reference page
OFF 1 G Blocked radiator
G Blocked condenser
G Blocked radiator grille
G Blocked bumper
G Visual No blocking
2 G Coolant mixture G Coolant tester 50 - 50% coolant mixture See MA-18, "Engine
Coolant Mixture Ratio" .
3 G Coolant level G Visual Coolant up to MAX level
in reservoir tank and radi-
ator filler neck
See CO-29, "LEVEL
CHECK" .
4 G Radiator cap G Pressure tester 59 - 98 kPa
(0.59 - 0.98 bar, 0.6 - 1.0
kg/cm
2
, 9 - 14 psi) (Limit)
See CO-32, "CHECKING
RADIATOR CAP" .
ON*
2 5 G Coolant leaks G Visual No leaks See CO-29, "LEAK
CHECK" .
ON*
2
6 G Thermostat G Touch the upper and
lower radiator hoses
Both hoses should be hot See CO-40, "THERMO-
STAT AND WATER CON-
TROL VALVE" , and CO-
31, "RADIATOR" .
ON*
1
7 G Cooling fan G CONSULT-II Operating See trouble diagnosis for
DTC P1217 (EC-1295 ).
OFF 8 G Combustion gas leak G Color checker chemical
tester 4 Gas analyzer
Negative
ON*
3
9 G Coolant temperature
gauge
G Visual Gauge less than 3/4
when driving

G Coolant overflow to
reservoir tank
G Visual No overflowduring driving
and idling
See MA-20, "Changing
Engine Coolant" .
OFF*
4 10 G Coolant return from
reservoir tank to radia-
tor
G Visual Should be initial level in
reservoir tank
See CO-29, "LEVEL
CHECK" .
OFF 11 G Cylinder head G Straight gauge feeler
gauge
0.1 mm (0.004 in) Maxi-
mum distortion (warping)
See EM-152, "CYLIN-
DER HEAD" .
12 G Cylinder block and pis-
tons
G Visual No scuffing on cylinder
walls or piston
See EM-165, "CYLIN-
DER BLOCK" .
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-1311
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Component Inspection EBS00GI7
COOLING FAN RELAY-1 AND -3
Check continuity between terminals 3 and 5 under the following con-
ditions.
COOLING FAN RELAY-2 AND -4
Check continuity between terminals 3 and 4, 3 and 5 under the fol-
lowing conditions.
COOLING FAN MOTOR-1 AND -2
1. Disconnect cooling fan motor harness connectors.
2. Supply cooling fan motor terminals with battery voltage and
check operation.
Conditions Continuity
12V direct current supply between ter-
minals 1 and 2
Yes
No current supply No
MBIB0057E
Conditions Terminals Continuity
12V direct current supply
between terminals 1 and 2
3 and 4 No
3 and 5 Yes
No current supply
3 and 4 Yes
3 and 5 No
MBIB0056E
Terminals
(+) (-)
Cooling fan motor 1 2
SEF721Q
EC-1312
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00GI8
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor,
throttle position sensor, etc. The throttle position sensor responds to
the throttle valve movement.
The throttle position sensor has the two sensors. These sensors are
a kind of potentiometers which transform the throttle valve position
into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM. In addi-
tion, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of the
throttle valve and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM
judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these sig-
nals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the
throttle valve opening angle properly in response to driving condi-
tion.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GI9
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GIA
These self-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GIB
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0145E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
THRTL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released More than 0.36V
G Shift lever:
D (CVT model)
1st (M/T model)
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1223
1223
Throttle position sensor 2
circuit low input
An excessively low voltage from the TP sensor 2
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The TP sensor 2 circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 2)
P1224
1224
Throttle position sensor 2
circuit high input
An excessively high voltage from the TP sensor 2
is sent to ECM.
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
EC-1313
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1315, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
SEF058Y
EC-1314
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00GIC
MBWA0126E
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
EC-1315
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GID
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
47 G
Throttle position sensor
power supply
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
49 W Throttle position sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
More than 0.36V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
Less than 4.75V
66 B Sensors' ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
68 R Throttle position sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
Less than 4.75V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 0.36V
MBIB0142E
EC-1316
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
2. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between electric throttle control actuator terminal
1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 66 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 68 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
Refer to EC-1317, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
MBIB0133E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0082E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
EC-1317
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GIE
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Set selector lever to D position (CVT models) or 1st position (M/T models).
5. Check voltage between ECM terminals 49 (TP sensor 1 signal),
68 (TP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the following
conditions.
6. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to the next
step.
7. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
8. Perform EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00GIF
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-116, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
49
(Throttle position sensor 1)
Fully released More than 0.36V
Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
68
(Throttle position sensor 2)
Fully released Less than 4.75V
Fully depressed More than 0.36V
MBIB0022E
EC-1318
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1225 TP SENSOR
DTC P1225 TP SENSOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00GIG
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor,
throttle position sensor, etc. The throttle position sensor responds to
the throttle valve movement.
The throttle position sensor has the two sensors. These sensors are
a kind of potentiometers which transform the throttle valve position
into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM. In addi-
tion, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of the
throttle valve and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM
judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these sig-
nals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the
throttle valve opening angle properly in response to driving condi-
tion.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GIH
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GII
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1319, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
PBIB0145E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1225
1225
Closed throttle position
learning performance
problem
Closed throttle position learning value is excessively
low.
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 1 and 2)
SEF058Y
DTC P1225 TP SENSOR
EC-1319
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GIJ
1. CHECK ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR VISUALLY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Remove the intake air duct.
3. Check if foreign matter is caught between the throttle valve and
the housing.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Remove the foreign matter and clean the electric throttle
control actuator inside.
2. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
Remove and Installation EBS00GIK
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-116, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
MBIB0143E
EC-1320
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1226 TP SENSOR
DTC P1226 TP SENSOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00GIL
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor,
throttle position sensor, etc. The throttle position sensor responds to
the throttle valve movement.
The throttle position sensor has the two sensors. These sensors are
a kind of potentiometers which transform the throttle valve position
into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM. In addi-
tion, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of the
throttle valve and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM
judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these sig-
nals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the
throttle valve opening angle properly in response to driving condi-
tion.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GIM
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GIN
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4, 32 times.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1321, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure With CONSULT-II above.
PBIB0145E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1226
1226
Closed throttle position
learning performance
problem
Closed throttle position learning is not performed
successfully, repeatedly.
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 1 and 2)
SEF058Y
DTC P1226 TP SENSOR
EC-1321
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GIO
1. CHECK ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR VISUALLY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Remove the intake air duct.
3. Check if foreign matter is caught between the throttle valve and
the housing.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Remove the foreign matter and clean the electric throttle
control actuator inside.
2. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
Remove and Installation EBS00GIP
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-116, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
MBIB0143E
EC-1322
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR PFP:18002
Component Description EBS00GIQ
The accelerator pedal position sensor is installed on the upper end
of the accelerator pedal assembly. The sensor detects the accelera-
tor position and sends a signal to the ECM.
Accelerator pedal position sensor has two sensors. These sensors
are a kind of potentiometers which transform the accelerator pedal
position into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM.
In addition, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of
the accelerator pedal and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The
ECM judges the current opening angle of the accelerator pedal from
these signals and controls the throttle control motor based on these
signals.
Idle position of the accelerator pedal is determined by the ECM
receiving the signal from the accelerator pedal position sensor. The ECM uses this signal for the engine oper-
ation such as fuel cut.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GIR
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GIS
These half-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GIT
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0146E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
ACCEL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed More than 3.9V
CLSD THL POS G Ignition switch: ON
Accelerator pedal: Fully released ON
Accelerator pedal: Slightly depressed OFF
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1227
1227
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2 circuit low input
An excessively low voltage from the APP sensor 2
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The APP sensor 2 circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Accelerator pedal position sensor
(Accelerator pedal position sensor 2)
P1228
1228
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2 circuit high input
An excessively high voltage from the APP sensor 2
is sent to ECM.
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of throttle valve to be shower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
EC-1323
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1325, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
SEF058Y
EC-1324
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00GIU
MBWA0130E
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
EC-1325
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GIV
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
45 R Sensors power supply [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
47 G Sensors power supply [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
55 B Sensors ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
66 B Sensors ground
[Ignition switch ON]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
98 LG
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.175 - 0.335V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 1.95V
106 L
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.35 - 0.67V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.9V
MBIB0142E
EC-1326
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
2. CHECK APP SENSOR 2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor harness
connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between APP sensor terminal 1 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK APP SENSOR 2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 66 and APP sensor terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0152E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0812E
Continuity should exist.
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
EC-1327
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK APP SENSOR 2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 98 and APP sensor terminal 6.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK APP SENSOR
Refer to EC-1327, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 9.
9. REPLACE APP SENSOR
1. Replace the accelerator pedal position sensor.
2. Perform EC-998, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
10. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GIW
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminals 106 (APP sensor 1 sig-
nal), 98 (APP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the fol-
lowing conditions.
Continuity should exist.
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
106
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Fully depressed More than 3.9V
98
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
Fully released 0.175 - 0.335V
Fully depressed More than 1.95V
MBIB0023E
EC-1328
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
4. If NG, replace accelerator pedal assembly and go to the next step.
5. Perform EC-998, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
6. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
7. Perform EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00GIX
ACCELERATOR PEDAL
Refer to ACC-2, "ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM" .
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY
EC-1329
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY PFP:16119
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GIY
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GIZ
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1331, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1229
1229
Sensor power supply circuit
short
ECM detects a voltage of power source
for sensor is excessively low or high.
G Harness or connectors
(The TP sensor 1 and 2 circuit is shorted.)
(APP sensor 2 circuit is shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 1 and 2)
G Accelerator pedal position sensor
(APP sensor 2)
G ECM pin terminal
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return
spring.
SEF058Y
EC-1330
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY
Wiring Diagram EBS00GJ0
MBWA0128E
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY
EC-1331
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GJ1
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between electric throttle control actuator terminal
1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 3.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
47 G Sensor's power supply [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
MBIB0142E
MBIB0133E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0082E
EC-1332
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY
3. CHECK SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUITS FOR SHORT
Check the following.
G Harness for short to power and short to ground between following terminals.
G ECM pin terminal.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITON SENSOR
Refer to EC-1327, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. REPLACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
1. Replace accelerator pedal position sensor.
2. Perform EC-998, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
6. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
Refer to EC-1174, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
7. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-998, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-999, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
ECM terminal Sensor terminals Reference Wiring Diagram
47
Electric throttle control actuator terminal 1 EC-1330
Accelerator pedal position sensor terminal 1 EC-1324
DTC P1564 ICC STEERING SWITCH
EC-1333
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1564 ICC STEERING SWITCH PFP:25551
Component Description EBS00GTV
ICC steering switch has variant values of electrical resistance for
each button. ECM reads voltage variation of switch, and determines
which button is operated.
Refer to ACS-5, "DESCRIPTION" for the ICC function.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GTW
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GTX
NOTE:
If DTC P1564 is displayed with DTC P0605, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0605. Refer to
EC-1235 .
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GTY
NOTE:
If "DTC Confirmation Procedure" has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch "OFF" and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch "ON".
MBIB0160E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
MAIN SW G Ignition switch: ON
G ON/OFF switch pressed ON
G ON/OFF switch released OFF
CANCEL G Ignition switch: ON
G CANCEL switch pressed ON
G CANCEL switch released OFF
RESUME/ACC SW G Ignition switch: ON
G ACCEL RES switch pressed ON
G ACCEL RES switch released OFF
SET SW G Ignition switch: ON
G COAST/SET switch pressed ON
G COAST/SET switch released OFF
DIST SW G Ignition switch: ON
G DISTANCE switch pressed ON
G DISTANCE switch released OFF
DTC No.
Trouble Diagnosis
Name
DTC Detecting Condition Possible Cause
P1564
1564
ICC steering switch
G An excessively high voltage signal from the
ICC steering switch is sent to ECM.
G ECM detects that input signal from the ICC
steering switch is out of the specified range.
G ECM detects that the ICC steering switch is
stuck ON.
G Harness or connectors
(The switch circuit is open or shorted.)
G ICC steering switch
G ECM
EC-1334
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1564 ICC STEERING SWITCH
2. Select "DATA MONITOR" mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Press "CRUISE" switch for at least 10 seconds, then release it
and wait at least 10 seconds.
5. Press "ACCEL/RES" switch for at least 10 seconds, then
release it and wait at least 10 seconds.
6. Press "COAST/SET" switch for at least 10 seconds, then
release it and wait at least 10 seconds.
7. Press DISTANCE switch for at least 10 seconds, then release
it and wait at least 10 seconds.
8. Press "CANCEL" switch for at least 10 seconds, then release it
and wait at least 10 seconds.
9. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1337, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
SEF058Y
DTC P1564 ICC STEERING SWITCH
EC-1335
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GTZ
MBWA0153E
EC-1336
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1564 ICC STEERING SWITCH
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
82 B
Sensor's ground
(ICC steering switch)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
99 PU ICC steering switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G ICC steering switch is OFF.
Approximately 4.3V
[Ignition switch ON]
G ON/OFF switch is ON.
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G CANCEL switch is ON.
Approximately 1.3V
[Ignition switch ON]
G DISTANCE switch is ON.
Approximately 2.2V
[Ignition switch ON]
G SET/COAST switch is ON.
Approximately 3V
[Ignition switch ON]
G RESUME/ACCEL switch is ON.
Approximately 3.7V
DTC P1564 ICC STEERING SWITCH
EC-1337
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GU0
1. CHECK ICC STEERING SWITCH CIRCUIT
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch "ON".
2. Select "MAIN SW", "RESUME/ACC SW", "SET SW", DIST SW
and "CANCEL SW" in "DATA MONITOR" mode with CONSULT-
II.
3. Check each item indication under the following conditions.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch "ON".
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 99 and ground with press-
ing each button.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 2.
Switch Monitor item Condition Indication
ON/OFF MAIN SW
Pressed ON
Released OFF
COAST/SET SET SW
Pressed ON
Released OFF
ACCEL/RES RESUME/ACC SW
Pressed ON
Released OFF
DISTANCE DIST SW
Pressed ON
Released OFF
CANCEL CANCEL SW
Pressed ON
Released OFF
MBIB0064E
Switch Condition Voltage [V]
ON/OFF
Pressed Approx. 0
Released Approx. 4.3
COAST/SET
Pressed Approx. 3.0
Released Approx. 4.3
ACCEL RES
Pressed Approx. 3.7
Released Approx. 4.3
DISTANCE
Pressed Approx. 2.2
Released Approx. 4.3
CANCEL
Pressed Approx. 1.3
Released Approx. 4.3
PBIB0311E
EC-1338
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1564 ICC STEERING SWITCH
2. CHECK ICC STEERING SWITCH GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch "OFF".
2. Disconnect ICC steering switch harness connector and ECM
harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ICC steering switch terminal
2 and ECM terminal 82.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Spiral cable
G Harness for open and short between ECM and ICC steering switch
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK ICC STEERING SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 99 and ICC steering switch terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Spiral cable
G Harness for open and short between ECM and ICC steering switch
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK ICC STEERING SWITCH
Refer to EC-1339, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace ICC steering switch.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0160E
Continuity should exist.
DTC P1564 ICC STEERING SWITCH
EC-1339
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GU1
ICC STEERING SWITCH
1. Disconnect ICC steering switch.
2. Check continuity between ICC steering switch terminals 1 and 2
with pushing each switch.
If NG, replace ICC steering switch.
Switch Condition Resistance []
ON/OFF SW
Pressed Approx. 0
Released Approx. 5,500
COAST/SET SW
Pressed Approx. 1,400
Released Approx. 5,500
ACCEL RES SW
Pressed Approx. 2,600
Released Approx. 5,500
DISTANCE SW
Pressed Approx. 740
Released Approx. 5,500
CANCEL SW
Pressed Approx. 310
Released Approx. 5,500
SEC008D
EC-1340
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1568 ICC FUNCTION
DTC P1568 ICC FUNCTION PFP:18995
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GTS
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic
NOTE:
G If DTC P1568 is displayed with DTC U1000, U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC
U1000, U1001. Refer to EC-1083, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
G If DTC P1568 is displayed with DTC P0605, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0605.
Refer to EC-1235, "DTC P0605 ECM"
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GTT
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
Step 4 may be conducted with the drive wheels lifted in the shop or by driving the vehicle. If a road test
is expected to be easier, it is unnecessary to lift the vehicle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Press ON/OFF switch on ICC steering switch.
4. Drive the vehicle at more than 40 km/h (25 MPH).
5. Press COAST/SET switch.
6. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1340, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GTU
1. REPLACE ICC UNIT
1. Replace ICC unit.
2. Perform ACS-13, "ACTION TEST" .
3. Check DTC of ICC unit. Refer to ACS-44, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR SELF-DIAGNOSTIC ITEMS" .
>> INSPECTION END
DTC No.
Trouble Diagnosis
Name
DTC Detecting Condition Possible Cause
P1568
1568
ICC function
ECM detects a difference between signals
from ICC unit is out of specified range.
G Harness or connectors
(The CAN communication line is open or
shorted.)
G ICC unit
G ECM
SEF058Y
DTC P1572 ICC BRAKE SWITCH
EC-1341
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1572 ICC BRAKE SWITCH PFP:25320
Component Description EBS00GU2
When the brake pedal is depressed, ICC brake switch is turned OFF
and stop lamp switch is turned ON. ECM detects the state of the
brake pedal by this input of two kinds (ON/OFF signal).
Refer to ACS-5, "DESCRIPTION" for the ICC function.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GU3
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GU4
NOTE:
If DTC P1572 is displayed with DTC P0605, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0605. Refer to
EC-1235 .
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GU5
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Steps 3 and 4 may be conducted with the drive wheels lifted in the shop or by driving the vehicle. If a
road test is expected to be easier, it is unnecessary to lift the vehicle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
MBIB0176E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
BRAKE SW1
(ICC brake switch)
G Ignition switch: ON
G Brake pedal fully released ON
G Brake pedal depressed OFF
BRAKE SW2
(stop lamp switch)
G Ignition switch: ON
G Brake pedal fully released OFF
G Brake pedal depressed ON
DTC No.
Trouble Diagnosis
Name
DTC Detecting Condition Possible Cause
P1572
1572
ICC brake switch
ON signals from the stop lamp switch and the
ICC brake switch are sent to ECM at the same
time.
G Harness or connectors
(The stop lamp switch circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Harness or connectors
(The ICC brake switch circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Stop lamp switch
G ICC brake switch
G ICC brake hold relay
G Incorrect stop lamp switch installation
G Incorrect ICC brake switch installation
G ECM
EC-1342
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1572 ICC BRAKE SWITCH
3. Drive the vehicle for at least 5 consecutive seconds under the following condition.
If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1344, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If 1st trip DTC is not detected, go to the following step.
4. Drive the vehicle for at least 5 consecutive seconds under the following condition.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1344, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
VHCL SPEED SE More than 30 km/h (19 MPH)
Selector lever Suitable position
VHCL SPEED SE More than 30 km/h (19 MPH)
Selector lever Suitable position
Driving location
Depress the brake pedal for more than
five seconds so as not to come off from
the above-mentioned condition.
DTC P1572 ICC BRAKE SWITCH
EC-1343
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GU6
MBWA0154E
EC-1344
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1572 ICC BRAKE SWITCH
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GU7
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION-I
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select BRAKE SW1 in DATA MONITOR mode with CON-
SULT-II.
3. Check BRAKE SW1 indication under the following conditions.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 108 and ground under the
following conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> GO TO 3.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
101 R/G Stop lamp switch
[Engine is running]
G Brake pedal fully released
Approximately 0V
[Engine is running]
G Brake pedal depressed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
108 R ICC brake switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Brake pedal is depressed
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Brake pedal is fully released
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
CONDITION INDICATION
When brake pedal is depress OFF
When brake pedal is fully released ON
SEC011D
CONDITION VOLTAGE
When brake pedal is depress Approximately 0V
When brake pedal is fully released Battery voltage
MBIB0061E
DTC P1572 ICC BRAKE SWITCH
EC-1345
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION-II
With CONSULT-II
Check BRAKE SW2 indication in DATA MONITOR mode.
Without CONSULT-II
Check voltage between ECM terminal 101 and ground under the fol-
lowing conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 18.
NG >> GO TO 11.
CONDITION INDICATION
When brake pedal is released OFF
When brake pedal is depressed ON
SEC013D
CONDITION VOLTAGE
When brake pedal is released Approximately 0V
When brake pedal is depressed Battery voltage
MBIB0060E
EC-1346
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1572 ICC BRAKE SWITCH
3. CHECK ICC BRAKE SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-I
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ICC brake switch harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between ICC brake switch terminal 1 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. CHECK ICC BRAKE SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-II
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ICC brake hold relay.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between ICC brake hold relay terminal 4 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
MBIB0176E
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0058E
MBIB0177E
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0059E
DTC P1572 ICC BRAKE SWITCH
EC-1347
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Fuse block (J/B) connector M1
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between ICC brake hold relay and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK ICC BRAKE SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-III
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between ICC brake hold relay terminal 3 and ICC brake switch terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK ICC BRAKE HOLD RELAY
Refer to EC-1349, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 18.
NG >> Replace ICC brake hold relay.
8. CHECK ICC BRAKE SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ICC brake switch terminal 2 and ECM terminal 108.
Refer Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 9.
9. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ICC brake switch and ECM
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
10. CHECK ICC BRAKE SWITCH
Refer to EC-1349, "Component Inspection" .
OK >> GO TO 18.
NG >> Replace ICC brake switch.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
EC-1348
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1572 ICC BRAKE SWITCH
11. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect stop lamp switch harness connector.
3. Check voltage between stop lamp switch terminal 1 and ground
with CONSULT -II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> GO TO 12.
12. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Fuse block (J/B) connector M2
G 15A fuse
G Harness for open or short between stop lamp switch and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
13. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 101 and stop lamp switch terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 15.
NG >> GO TO 14.
14. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and stop lamp switch
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0176E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0117E
Continuity should exist.
DTC P1572 ICC BRAKE SWITCH
EC-1349
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
15. CHECK ICC BRAKE HOLD RELAY CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ICC brake hold relay.
2. Check harness continuity between stop lamp switch terminal 1 and ICC brake hold relay terminal 7, stop
lamp switch terminal 2 and ICC brake hold relay terminal 6.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 16.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
16. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH
Refer to EC-1349, "Component Inspection"
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> Replace stop lamp switch.
17. CHECK ICC BRAKE HOLD RELAY
Refer to EC-1349, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 18.
NG >> Replace ICC brake hold relay.
18. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GU8
ICC BRAKE SWITCH
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ICC brake switch harness connector.
3. Check continuity between ICC brake switch terminals 1 and 2
under the following conditions.
If NG, adjust ICC brake switch installation, refer to BR-6,
"BRAKE PEDAL" , and perform step 3 again.
STOP LAMP SWITCH
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect stop lamp switch harness connector.
Continuity should exist.
Condition Continuity
When brake pedal is fully released. Should exist.
When brake pedal is depressed. Should not exist.
MBIB0062E
EC-1350
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1572 ICC BRAKE SWITCH
3. Check continuity between stop lamp switch terminals 1 and 2
under the following conditions.
If NG, adjust stop lamp switch installation, refer to BR-6,
"BRAKE PEDAL" , and perform step 3 again.
ICC BRAKE HOLD RELAY
1. Apply 12V direct current between ICC brake hold relay terminals 1 and 2.
2. Check continuity between relay terminals 3 and 4, 6 and 7 under
the following conditions.
3. If NG, replace ICC brake hold relay.
Condition Continuity
When brake pedal is fully released. Should not exist.
When brake pedal is depressed. Should exist.
PBIB0118E
Condition Between terminals Continuity
12V direct current supply
between terminals 1 and 2
3 and 4 Should not exist
6 and 7 Should exist
No current supply
3 and 4 Should exist
6 and 7 Should not exist
MBIB0063E
DTC P1574 ICC VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
EC-1351
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1574 ICC VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR PFP:31036
Component Description EBS00GTN
The ECM receives two vehicle speed signals via CAN communication line. One is sent from combination
meter, and the other is from TCM (Transmission control module). The ECM uses these signals for ICC control.
Refer to ACS-5, "DESCRIPTION" for ICC functions.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GTO
NOTE:
G If DTC P1574 is displayed with DTC U1000, U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC
U1000, U1001. Refer to EC-1083, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
G If DTC P1574 is displayed with DTC P0500, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P0500.
Refer to EC-1228, "DTC P0500 VSS" .
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GTP
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If "DTC Confirmation Procedure" has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch "OFF" and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Step 3 may be conducted with the drive wheels lifted in the shop or by driving the vehicle. If a road test
is expected to be easier, it is unnecessary to lift the vehicle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Select "DATA MONITOR" mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Drive the vehicle at more than 40 km/h (25MPH).
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1352, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
DTC No.
Trouble Diagnosis
Name
DTC Detecting Condition Possible Cause
P1574
1574
ICC vehicle speed
sensor
ECM detects a difference between two vehicle
speed signals is out of the specified range.
G Harness or connectors
(The CAN communication line is open or
shorted.)
G TCM
G Secondary speed sensor
G ESP/TCS/ABS control unit
G Wheel sensor
G Combination meter
G ECM
SEF058Y
EC-1352
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1574 ICC VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GTQ
1. CHECK DTC WITH TCM
Check DTC with TCM. Refer to CVT-20, "ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEM DESCRIPTION" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Perform trouble shooting relevant to DTC indicated.
2. CHECK VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CIRCUIT
Refer to BRC-17, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS" (Models without ESP) or BRC-60, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS"
(Models with ESP).
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
3. CHECK COMBINATION METER
Check combination meter function.
Refer to DI-5, "COMBINATION METERS (LHD MODELS)" or DI-34, "COMBINATION METERS (RHD MOD-
ELS)" .
>> INSPECTION END
DTC P1706 PNP SWITCH
EC-1353
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1706 PNP SWITCH PFP:32006
Component Description EBS00GJ2
When the shift lever position is P (CVT models only) or N, park/neutral position (PNP) switch is ON.
ECM detects the position because the continuity of the line (the ON signal) exists.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GJ3
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GJ4
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GJ5
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select P/N POSI SW in DATA MONITOR mode with CON-
SULT-II. Then check the P/N POSI SW signal under the follow-
ing conditions.
If NG, go to EC-1356, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If OK, go to following step.
3. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
5. Maintain the following conditions for at least 60 consecutive sec-
onds.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1356, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
P/N POSI SW G Ignition switch: ON
Shift lever:
P or N (CVT model)
Neutral (M/T model)
ON
Shift lever: Except above OFF
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1706
1706
Park/neutral position switch
The signal of the park/neutral position (PNP)
switch is not changed in the process of
engine starting and driving.
G Harness or connectors
(PNP switch circuit is open or shorted.)
G Park/neutral position (PNP) switch
Position (Selector lever) Known-good signal
N and P position ON
Except the above position OFF
ENG SPEED 1,500 - 3,000 rpm
COOLAN TEMP/S More than 70C (158F)
B/FUEL SCHDL 3.0 - 31.8 msec
VHCL SPEED SE More than 64 km/h (40 MPH)
Selector lever Suitable position
SEF212Y
SEF213Y
EC-1354
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1706 PNP SWITCH
Overall Function Check EBS00GJ6
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the park/neutral position (PNP) switch circuit. During this
check, a 1st trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH GST
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 102 (PNP switch signal)
and body ground under the following conditions.
3. If NG, go to EC-1356, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Condition (Gear position) Voltage V (Known good data)
P (CVT models only) and N position Approx. 0
Except the above position
CVT models: Battery voltage
M/T models: Approximately 5V
MBIB0029E
DTC P1706 PNP SWITCH
EC-1355
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GJ7
MBWA0019E
EC-1356
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1706 PNP SWITCH
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GJ8
1. CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect PNP switch harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between PNP switch terminal 2 and
ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open and short between PNP switch and ECM (CVT models)
G Harness for open and short between PNP switch and ground (M/T models)
>> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 102 and PNP switch terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
74
(CVT
mod-
els)
B Sensors' ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
102
P (CVT)
L (M/T)
PNP switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is P (CVT models) or N,
Neutral (M/T models).
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Except the above gear position
CVT models
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
M/T models
Approximately 5V
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0171E
Continuity should exist.
DTC P1706 PNP SWITCH
EC-1357
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. CHECK PNP SWITCH
Refer to CVT-71, "Component Inspection" (CVT models) or MT-126, "PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH"
(M/T models).
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace PNP switch.
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
EC-1358
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1720 VSS
DTC P1720 VSS PFP:31036
Description EBS00GVN
NOTE:
If DTC P1720 is displayed with DTC U1000, U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-1083, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
ECM receives two vehicle speed signals via CAN communication line. One is sent from ESP/TCS/ABS control
unit (models with ESP), ABS actuator and electric unit (models without ESP) via combination meter, and the
other is from TCM (Transmission control module). ECM uses these signals for engine control.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GVO
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GVP
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GVR
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch "ON".
2. Select "DATA MONITOR" mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine.
4. Drive vehicle at a speed of 20 km/h (12 MPH) or more for at least 5 seconds without brake pedal depress-
ing.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1358, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GVS
1. CHECK DTC WITH TCM
Check DTC with TCM. Refer to CVT-20, "ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEM DESCRIPTION" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Perform trouble shooting relevant to DTC indicated.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
VEH SPEED SE
G Turn drive wheels and compare speedometer indication with the CON-
SULT-II value.
Almost the same speed as the
CONSULT-II value
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1720
1720
Vehicle speed sensor
(TCM output)
A difference between two vehicle speed sig-
nals is out of the specified range.
G Harness or connectors
(Revolution sensor circuit is open or
shorted)
G Harness or connectors
(Wheel sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G TCM
G Secondary speed sensor
G ESP/TCS/ABS control unit
G ABS actuator and electric unit
G Wheel sensor
G Combination meter
DTC P1720 VSS
EC-1359
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK DTC WITH ABS
Check DTC with ABS actuator and electric unit (Models without ESP) or ESP/TCS/ABS control unit (Models
with ESP). Refer to BRC-17, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS" or BRC-60, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Perform trouble shooting relevant to DTC indicated.
3. CHECK COMBINATION METER
Check combination meter function.
Refer to DI-5, "COMBINATION METERS (LHD MODELS)" or DI-34, "COMBINATION METERS (RHD MOD-
ELS)" .
>> INSPECTION END
EC-1360
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH PFP:25320
Description EBS00GJ9
Brake switch signal is applied to the ECM through the stop lamp switch when the brake pedal is depressed.
This signal is used mainly to decrease the engine speed when the vehicle is driving.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GJA
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GJB
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GJC
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Fully depress the brake pedal for at least 5 seconds.
3. Erase the DTC with CONSULT-II.
4. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1362, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
WITH GST
Follow the procedure WITH CONSULT-II above.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
BRAKE SW G Ignition switch: ON
Brake pedal: Fully released OFF
Brake pedal: Slightly depressed ON
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1805
1805
Brake switch
A brake switch signal is not sent to ECM for
an extremely long time while the vehicle is
driving.
G Harness or connectors
(Stop lamp switch circuit is open or shorted.)
G Stop lamp switch
SEF058Y
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH
EC-1361
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GJD
MBWA0034E
EC-1362
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GJE
1. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check the stop lamp when depressing and releasing the brake pedal.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect stop lamp switch harness connector.
2. Check voltage between stop lamp switch terminal 1 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
101 R/G Stop lamp switch
[Engine is running]
G Brake pedal fully released
Approximately 0V
[Engine is running]
G Brake pedal depressed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
Brake pedal Stop lamp
Fully released Not illuminated
Depressed Illuminated
MBIB0152E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0117E
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH
EC-1363
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G 15A fuse
G Fuse block (J/B) connector M2
G Harness for open and short between stop lamp switch and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 101 and stop lamp switch terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and stop lamp switch
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH
Refer to EC-1363, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace stop lamp switch.
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GJF
STOP LAMP SWITCH
1. Disconnect stop lamp switch harness connector.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0152E
EC-1364
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH
2. Check continuity between stop lamp switch terminals 1 and 2
under the following conditions.
If NG, adjust brake pedal installation, refer to BR-6, "BRAKE
PEDAL" , and perform step 2 again.
Conditions Continuity
Brake pedal fully released Should not exist.
Brake pedal depressed Should exist.
PBIB0118E
IGNITION SIGNAL
EC-1365
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
IGNITION SIGNAL PFP:22448
Component Description EBS00GJG
IGNITION COIL & POWER TRANSISTOR
The ignition signal from the ECM is sent to and amplified by the
power transistor. The power transistor turns on and off the ignition
coil primary circuit. This on-off operation induces the proper high
voltage in the coil secondary circuit.
MBIB0132E
EC-1366
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
IGNITION SIGNAL
Wiring Diagram EBS00GJH
MBWA0029E
IGNITION SIGNAL
EC-1367
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
111 W/G
ECM relay
(Self shut-off)
[Engine is running]
[Ignition switch OFF]
G For a few seconds after turning ignition
switch OFF
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch OFF]
G More than a few seconds passed after turn-
ing ignition switch OFF
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
119
120
W/R
W/R
Power supply for ECM [Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
121 W/L
Power supply for ECM
(Buck-up)
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
EC-1368
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
IGNITION SIGNAL
MBWA0030E
IGNITION SIGNAL
EC-1369
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GJI
1. CHECK ENGINE START
Turn ignition switch OFF, and restart engine.
Is engine running?
Yes or No
Yes (With CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 2.
Yes (Without CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 3.
No >> GO TO 4.
2. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
With CONSULT-II
1. Perform POWER BALANCE in ACTIVE TEST mode with CONSULT-II.
2. Make sure that each circuit produces a momentary engine
speed drop.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 12.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
60
61
79
80
L/Y
Y/R
GY/L
PU/G
Ignition signal No. 3
Ignition signal No. 1
Ignition signal No. 4
Ignition signal No. 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0 - 0.1V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - 0.2V
PBIB0521E
PBIB0522E
PBIB0133E
EC-1370
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
IGNITION SIGNAL
3. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
Without CONSULT-II
1. Let engine idle.
2. Read the voltage signal between ECM terminals 60, 61, 79, 80
and ground with an oscilloscope.
3. Verify that the oscilloscope screen shows the signal wave as
shown below.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 12.
4. CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-I
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminals 119, 120 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Go to EC-1077, "POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR
ECM" .
5. CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-II
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect condenser harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between condenser terminal 1 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 6.
MBIB0033E
PBIB0521E
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0034E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0624E
IGNITION SIGNAL
EC-1371
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-III
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM relay.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM relay terminal 7 and condenser terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-IV
Check voltage between ECM relay terminal 6 and ground with CON-
SULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> GO TO 8.
8. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E70, F13 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E63, F31 (RHD models)
G 20A fuse
G Harness for open or short between ECM relay and battery
>> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
9. CHECK ECM RELAY
Refer to EC-1373, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> Replace ECM relay.
10. CHECK CONDENSER GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect condenser harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between condenser terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connector.
Continuity should exist.
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0625E
Continuity should exist.
EC-1372
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
IGNITION SIGNAL
11. CHECK CONDENSER
Refer to EC-1373, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Replace condenser.
12. CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-V
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
3. Disconnect ignition coil harness connector.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
5. Check voltage between ignition coil terminal 1 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14.
NG >> GO TO 13.
13. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check harness for open or short between ignition coil and ECM relay.
>> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
14. CHECK IGNITION COIL GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between ignition coil terminal 2 and engine ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 15.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0132E
Voltage: Battery voltage
SEF107S
Continuity should exist.
IGNITION SIGNAL
EC-1373
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
15. CHECK IGNITION COIL OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals 60, 61, 79, 80 and ignition coil terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 16.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
16. CHECK IGNITION COIL WITH POWER TRANSISTOR
Refer to EC-1373, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> Replace ignition coil with power transistor.
17. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GJJ
ECM RELAY
1. Apply 12V direct current between ECM relay terminals 1 and 2.
2. Check continuity between relay terminals 3 and 5, 6 and 7.
3. If NG, replace ECM relay.
CONDENSER
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect condenser harness connector.
3. Check resistance between condenser terminals 1 and 2.
IGNITION COIL WITH POWER TRANSISTOR
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ignition coil harness connector.
Continuity should exist.
Condition Continuity
12V direct current supply between ter-
minals 1 and 2
Yes
OFF No
PBIB0077E
Resistance: Above 1 M at 25C (77F)
MBIB0031E
EC-1374
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
IGNITION SIGNAL
3. Check resistance between ignition coil terminals as follows.
Removal and Installation EBS00GJK
IGNITION COIL WITH POWER TRANSISTOR
Refer to EM-126, "IGNITION COIL" .
Terminal No. Resistance [at 25C (77F)]
2 and 3 Except 0 or
1 and 2
Except 0
1 and 3
MBIB0032E
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
EC-1375
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
INJECTOR CIRCUIT PFP:16600
Component Description EBS00GJR
The fuel injector is a small, precise solenoid valve. When the ECM
supplies a ground to the injector circuit, the coil in the injector is
energized. The energized coil pulls the needle valve back and allows
fuel to flow through the injector into the intake manifold. The amount
of fuel injected depends upon the injection pulse duration. Pulse
duration is the length of time the injector remains open. The ECM
controls the injection pulse duration based on engine fuel needs.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GJS
Specification data are reference values.
SEF375Z
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
B/FUEL SCHDL
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 2.5 - 3.5 msec
2,000 rpm 2.5 - 3.5 msec
INJ PULSE-B1
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 2.0 - 3.0 msec
2,000 rpm 1.9 - 2.9 msec
EC-1376
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
Wiring Diagram EBS00GJT
MBWA0028E
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
EC-1377
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GJU
1. INSPECTION START
Turn ignition switch to START.
Is any cylinder ignited?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> GO TO 3.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
22
23
41
42
G/B
SB
L
R/W
Injector No. 3
Injector No. 1
Injector No. 4
Injector No. 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
PBIB0529E
PBIB0530E
EC-1378
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
2. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Perform POWER BALANCE in ACTIVE TEST mode with
CONSULT-II.
3. Make sure that each circuit produces a momentary engine
speed drop.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Listen to each injector operating sound.
Clicking noise should be heard.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 3.
PBIB0133E
MEC703B
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
EC-1379
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK INJECTOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect injector harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between injector terminal 1 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness connectors F24, F81
G Fuse block (J/B) connector M1
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between injector and fuse
>> Repair harness or connectors.
5. CHECK INJECTOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between injector terminal 2 and ECM terminals 22, 23, 41, 42.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
MBIB0146E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0582E
Continuity should exist.
EC-1380
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
6. DETECT MALFONCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors F81, F24
G Harness for open or short between injector and ECM
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK INJECTOR
Refer to EC-1380, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace injector.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GJV
INJECTOR
1. Disconnect injector harness connector.
2. Check resistance between terminals as shown in the figure.
Removal and Installation EBS00GJW
INJECTOR
Refer to EM-128, "FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE" .
Resistance: 12.1 - 12.9 [at 20C (68F)]
PBIB0181E
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
EC-1381
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT PFP:17042
Description EBS00GK0
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
*: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
The ECM activates the fuel pump for several seconds after the ignition switch is turned on to improve engine
startability. If the ECM receives a engine speed signal from the crankshaft position sensor (POS) and cam-
shaft position sensor (PHASE), it knows that the engine is rotating, and causes the pump to operate. If the
engine speed signal is not received when the ignition switch is ON, the engine stalls. The ECM stops pump
operation and prevents battery discharging, thereby improving safety. The ECM does not directly drive the fuel
pump. It controls the ON/OFF fuel pump relay, which in turn controls the fuel pump.
COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
A turbine type design fuel pump is used in the fuel tank.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GK1
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed*
Fuel pump control Fuel pump relay
Battery Battery voltage*
Condition Fuel pump operation
Ignition switch is turned to ON. Operates for 1 second.
Engine running and cranking Operates.
When engine is stopped Stops in 1.5 seconds.
Except as shown above Stops.
MBIB0046E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
FUEL PUMP RLY
G For 1 seconds after turning ignition switch ON
G Engine running or cranking
ON
G Except above conditions OFF
EC-1382
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
Wiring Diagram EBS00GK2
MBWA0031E
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
EC-1383
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GK3
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Pinch fuel feed hose with two fingers.
Fuel pressure pulsation should be felt on the fuel hose for 1
second after ignition switch is turned ON.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK FUEL PUMP RELAY POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect fuel pump relay.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between fuel pump relay terminals 1, 5 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
113 B/P Fuel pump relay
[Ignition switch ON]
G For 1 seconds after turning ignition switch ON
[Engine is running]
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G More than 1 seconds after turning ignition switch
ON.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
MBIB0069E
MBIB0154E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0657E
EC-1384
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Fuse block (J/B) connector B1
G 10A fuse
G 15A fuse
G Harness for open or short between fuel pump relay and fuse
>> Repair harness or connectors.
4. CHECK FUEL PUMP POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump harness con-
nector.
3. Check harness continuity between fuel pump relay terminal 3
and fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump terminal 5, fuel level
sensor unit and fuel pump terminal 3 and body ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors B37, D83 (Wagon)
G Harness for open or short between fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump and fuel pump relay
G Harness for open or short between fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump and body ground
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK FUEL PUMP RELAY OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 113 and fuel pump relay terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0115E
Continuity should exist.
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
EC-1385
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness connectors B5, M23 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors B42, M95 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between ECM and fuel pump relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK FUEL PUMP RELAY
Refer to EC-1385, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace fuel pump relay.
9. CHECK FUEL PUMP
Refer to EC-1385, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> Replace fuel pump.
10. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GK4
FUEL PUMP RELAY
Check continuity between terminals 3 and 5 under the following con-
ditions.
FUEL PUMP
1. Disconnect fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump harness connector.
2. Check resistance between fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump
terminals 3 and 5.
Conditions Continuity
12V direct current supply between ter-
minals 1 and 2
Yes
No current supply No
PBIB0098E
Resistance: Approximately 1.0 [at 25C (77F)]
PBIB0658E
EC-1386
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
Removal and Installation EBS00GK5
FUEL PUMP
Refer to FL-6, "FUEL LEVEL SENSOR UNIT, FUEL FILTER AND FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY (EXCEPT
YD22DDTi)" .
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
EC-1387
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR PFP:92136
Component Description EBS00GK6
The refrigerant pressure sensor is installed at the liquid tank of the
air conditioner system. The sensor uses an electrostatic volume
pressure transducer to convert refrigerant pressure to voltage. The
voltage signal is sent to ECM, and ECM controls cooling fan system.
MBIB0135E
SEF099X
EC-1388
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00GK7
MBWA0033E
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
EC-1389
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GK8
1. CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR OVERALL FUNCTION
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn A/C switch and blower switch ON.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminal 69 and ground with CON-
SULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
55 B Sensor's ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
46 R
Sensor's power supply
(Refrigerant pressure sen-
sor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
69 L Refrigerant pressure sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Both A/C switch and blower switch are ON.
(Compressor operates.)
1.0 - 4.0V
Voltage: 1.0 - 4.0V
MBIB0035E
EC-1390
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
2. CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn A/C switch and blower switch OFF.
2. Stop engine.
3. Disconnect refrigerant pressure sensor harness connector.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
5. Check voltage between refrigerant pressure sensor terminal 3
and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E70, F13 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E63, F31 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between ECM and refrigerant pressure sensor
>> Repair harness or connectors.
4. CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 55 and refrigerant pressure sensor terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
MBIB0135E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
SEF479Y
Continuity should exist.
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
EC-1391
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness for open or short between ECM and refrigerant pressure sensor
G Harness for open or short between TCM and refrigerant pressure sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 69 and refrigerant pressure sensor terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness for open or short between ECM and refrigerant pressure sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
OK or NG
OK >> Replace refrigerant pressure sensor.
NG >> Repair or replace.
Removal and Installation EBS00GK9
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
Refer to ATC-127, "REFRIGERANT LINES" .
Continuity should exist.
EC-1392
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL PFP:25350
Description EBS00GKA
The electrical load signals except headlamp switch signal are transferred through the CAN communication
line.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GVI
Specification data are reference values.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
LOAD SIGNAL G Ignition switch: ON
Rear window defogger switch is ON and/or
lighting switch is 2nd.
ON
Rear window defogger switch is OFF and light-
ing switch is OFF.
OFF
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL
EC-1393
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GVJ
MBWA0147E
EC-1394
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GKB
1. CHECK LOAD SIGNAL CIRCUIT OVERALL FUNCTION-I
With CONSULT-II
With GST
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Connect CONSULT-II or GST and select "DATA MONITOR" mode.
3. Select "LOAD SIGNAL" and check indication under the following
conditions.
OK or NG
OK (With CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 2.
OK (Without CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 4.
2. CHECK LOAD SIGNAL CIRCUIT OVERALL FUNCTION-II
With CONSULT-II
Check "LOAD SIGNAL" indication under the following conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 5.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
84 R/Y
Electrical load signal
(Headlamp signal)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Lighting switch is 2ND position
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Lighting switch is OFF
Approximately 0V
Condition Indication
Rear window defogger switch "ON" ON
Rear window defogger switch "OFF" OFF
PBIB0103E
Condition Indication
Lighting switch "ON" at 2nd position ON
Lighting switch "OFF" OFF
PBIB0103E
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL
EC-1395
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK LOAD SIGNAL CIRCUIT OVERALL FUNCTION-II
Without CONSULT-II
Check voltage between ECM terminal 84 and ground under the fol-
lowing conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 5.
4. CHECK REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
Refer to GW-40, "REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER" .
>> INSPECTION END
5. CHECK HEADLAMP FUNCTION
1. Turn lighting switch ON at 2nd position.
2. Check that headlamps are illuminated.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Refer to LT-5, "HEADLAMP -CONVENTIONAL TYPE-" , LT-10, "HEADLAMP - XENON TYPE -" ,
LT-18, "HEADLAMP (WITH DAYTIME) - CONVENTIONAL TYPE -" or LT-25, "HEADLAMP
(WITH DAYTIME) - XENON TYPE -" .
Condition Voltage
Lighting switch "ON" at 2nd position Battery voltage
Lighting switch "OFF" Approximately 0V
MBIB0158E
EC-1396
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL
6. CHECK HEADLAMP INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
CONVENTIONAL TYPE HEADLAMP WITHOUT DAYTIME LIGHT SYSTEM
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM hraness connector.
3. Disconnect lighting switch harness connector .
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 84 and lighting switch terminal 10.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
CONVENTIONAL TYPE HEADLAMP WITH DAYTIME LIGHT SYSTEM
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM hraness connector.
3. Disconnect daytime light relay.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 84 and daytime light relay terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
XENON TYPE HEADLAMP
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM hraness connector.
3. Disconnect headlamp LH relay.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 84 and headlamp LH relay terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G harness for open and short between ECM and lighting switch
G harness for open and short between ECM and daytime light relay
G harness for open and short between ECM and headlamp LH relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
ICC BRAKE SWITCH
EC-1397
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
ICC BRAKE SWITCH PFP:25320
Component Description EBS00GU9
When depress on the brake pedal, ICC brake switch is turned OFF
and stop lamp switch is turned ON. ECM detects the state of the
brake pedal by this input of two kinds (ON/OFF signal)
Refer to ACS-5, "DESCRIPTION" for the ICC function.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GUA
Specification data are reference values.
MBIB0176E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
BRAKE SW1
(ICC brake switch)
G Ignition switch: ON
G Brake pedal fully released ON
G Brake pedal depressed OFF
BRAKE SW2
(stop lamp switch)
G Ignition switch: ON
G Brake pedal fully released OFF
G Brake pedal depressed ON
EC-1398
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ICC BRAKE SWITCH
Wiring Diagram EBS00GUB
MBWA0155E
ICC BRAKE SWITCH
EC-1399
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GUC
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION-I
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select BRAKE SW1 in DATA MONITOR mode with CON-
SULT-II.
3. Check BRAKE SW1 indication under the following conditions.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 108 and ground under the
following conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> GO TO 3.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
101 R/G Stop lamp switch
[Engine is running]
G Brake pedal fully released
Approximately 0V
[Engine is running]
G Brake pedal depressed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
108 R ICC brake switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Brake pedal is depressed
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Brake pedal is fully released
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
CONDITION INDICATION
When brake pedal is depress OFF
When brake pedal is fully released ON
SEC011D
CONDITION VOLTAGE
When brake pedal is depress Approximately 0V
When brake pedal is fully released Battery voltage
MBIB0061E
EC-1400
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ICC BRAKE SWITCH
2. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION-II
With CONSULT-II
Check BRAKE SW2 indication in DATA MONITOR mode.
Without CONSULT-II
Check voltage between ECM terminal 101 and ground under the fol-
lowing conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END.
NG >> GO TO 11.
CONDITION INDICATION
When brake pedal is released OFF
When brake pedal is depressed ON
SEC013D
CONDITION VOLTAGE
When brake pedal is released Approximately 0V
When brake pedal is depressed Battery voltage
MBIB0060E
ICC BRAKE SWITCH
EC-1401
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK ICC BRAKE SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-I
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ICC brake switch harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between ICC brake switch terminal 1 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. CHECK ICC BRAKE SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-II
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ICC brake hold relay.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between ICC brake hold relay terminal 4 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
MBIB0176E
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0058E
MBIB0177E
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0059E
EC-1402
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ICC BRAKE SWITCH
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Fuse block (J/B) connector M1
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between ICC brake hold relay and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK ICC BRAKE SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-III
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between ICC brake hold relay terminal 3 and ICC brake switch terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK ICC BRAKE HOLD RELAY
Refer to EC-1404, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 18.
NG >> Replace ICC brake hold relay.
8. CHECK ICC BRAKE SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ICC brake switch terminal 2 and ECM terminal 108.
Refer Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 9.
9. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ICC brake switch and ECM
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
10. CHECK ICC BRAKE SWITCH
Refer to EC-1404, "Component Inspection" .
OK >> GO TO 18.
NG >> Replace ICC brake switch.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
ICC BRAKE SWITCH
EC-1403
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
11. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect stop lamp switch harness connector.
3. Check voltage between stop lamp switch terminal 1 and ground
with CONSULT -II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> GO TO 12.
12. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Fuse block (J/B) connector M2
G 15A fuse
G Harness for open or short between stop lamp switch and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
13. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 101 and stop lamp switch terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 15.
NG >> GO TO 14.
14. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and stop lamp switch
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0176E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0117E
Continuity should exist.
EC-1404
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
ICC BRAKE SWITCH
15. CHECK ICC BRAKE HOLD RELAY CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ICC brake hold relay.
2. Check harness continuity between stop lamp switch terminal 1 and ICC brake hold relay terminal 7, stop
lamp switch terminal 2 and ICC brake hold relay terminal 6.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 16.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
16. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH
Refer to EC-1404, "Component Inspection"
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> Replace stop lamp switch.
17. CHECK ICC BRAKE HOLD RELAY
Refer to EC-1404, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 18.
NG >> Replace ICC brake hold relay.
18. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1076, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GXB
ICC BRAKE SWITCH
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ICC brake switch harness connector.
3. Check continuity between ICC brake switch terminals 1 and 2
under the following conditions.
If NG, adjust ICC brake switch installation, refer to BR-6,
"BRAKE PEDAL" , and perform step 3 again.
STOP LAMP SWITCH
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect stop lamp switch harness connector.
Continuity should exist.
Condition Continuity
When brake pedal is fully released. Should exist.
When brake pedal is depressed. Should not exist.
MBIB0062E
ICC BRAKE SWITCH
EC-1405
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. Check continuity between stop lamp switch terminals 1 and 2
under the following conditions.
If NG, adjust stop lamp switch installation, refer to BR-6,
"BRAKE PEDAL" , and perform step 3 again.
ICC BRAKE HOLD RELAY
1. Apply 12V direct current between ICC brake hold relay terminals 1 and 2.
2. Check continuity between relay terminals 3 and 4, 6 and 7 under
the following conditions.
3. If NG, replace ICC brake hold relay.
Condition Continuity
When brake pedal is fully released. Should not exist.
When brake pedal is depressed. Should exist.
PBIB0118E
Condition Between terminals Continuity
12V direct current supply
between terminals 1 and 2
3 and 4 Should not exist
6 and 7 Should exist
No current supply
3 and 4 Should exist
6 and 7 Should not exist
MBIB0063E
EC-1406
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
MI & DATA LINK CONNECTORS
MI & DATA LINK CONNECTORS PFP:24814
Wiring Diagram (LHD Models) EBS00FDA
MBWA0039E
MI & DATA LINK CONNECTORS
EC-1407
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram (RHD Models) EBS00GTM
MBWA0148E
EC-1408
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM PFP:14950
Description EBS00FDB
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The evaporative emission system is used to reduce hydrocarbons emitted into the atmosphere from the fuel
system. This reduction of hydrocarbons is accomplished by activated charcoals in the EVAP canister.
The fuel vapor in the sealed fuel tank is led into the EVAP canister which contains activated carbon and the
vapor is stored there when the engine is not operating or when refueling to the fuel tank.
The vapor in the EVAP canister is purged by the air through the purge line to the intake manifold when the
engine is operating. EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve is controlled by ECM. When the
engine operates, the flow rate of vapor controlled by EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve is
proportionally regulated as the air flow increases.
EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve also shuts off the vapor purge line during decelerating and
idling.
PBIB0491E
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM
EC-1409
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION LINE DRAWING
MBIB0144E
EC-1410
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM
Component Inspection EBS00FDC
EVAP CANISTER
Check EVAP canister as follows:
1. Block port B . Orally blow air through port A .
Check that air flows freely through port C .
2. Block port A . Orally blow air through port B .
Check that air flows freely through port C .
FUEL CHECK VALVE
1. Blow air through connector on fuel tank side.
A considerable resistance should be felt and a portion of air flow
should be directed toward the EVAP canister side.
2. Blow air through connector on EVAP canister side.
Air flow should be smoothly directed toward fuel tank side.
3. If fuel check valve is suspected of not properly functioning in
steps 1 and 2 above, replace it.
FUEL TANK VACUUM RELIEF VALVE (BUILT INTO FUEL FILLER CAP)
1. Wipe clean valve housing.
2. Check valve opening pressure and vacuum.
3. If out of specification, replace fuel filler cap as an assembly.
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Refer to EC-1227, "Component Inspection" .
PBIB0663E
SEF552Y
SEF989X
Pressure: 15.3 - 20.0 kPa (0.153 - 0.200 bar,
0.156 - 0.204 kg/cm
2
, 2.22 - 2.90 psi)
Vacuum: 6.0 to 3.4 kPa (0.060 to 0.034 bar,
0.061 to 0.035 kg/cm
2
, 0.87 to 0.49 psi)
SEF943S
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION
EC-1411
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION PFP:11810
Description EBS00FDD
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
This system returns blow-by gas to the intake manifold.
The positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) valve is provided to conduct crankcase blow-by gas to the intake
manifold. During partial throttle operation of the engine, the intake manifold sucks the blow-by gas through the
PCV valve. Normally, the capacity of the valve is sufficient to handle any blow-by and a small amount of venti-
lating air. The ventilating air is then drawn from the air inlet tubes into the crankcase. In this process the air
passes through the hose connecting air inlet tubes to rocker cover. Under full-throttle condition, the manifold
vacuum is insufficient to draw the blow-by flow through the valve. The flow goes through the hose connection
in the reverse direction.
On vehicles with an excessively high blow-by, the valve does not
meet the requirement. This is because some of the flow will go
through the hose connection to the air inlet tubes under all condi-
tions.
Component Inspection EBS00FDE
PCV (POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION) VALVE
With engine running at idle, remove PCV valve from rocker cover. A
properly working valve makes a hissing noise as air passes through
it. A strong vacuum should be felt immediately when a finger is
placed over valve inlet.
PBIB0492E
SEF559A
SEC137A
EC-1412
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION
PCV VALVE VENTILATION HOSE
1. Check hoses and hose connections for leaks.
2. Disconnect all hoses and clean with compressed air. If any hose
cannot be freed of obstructions, replace.
S-ET277
SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
EC-1413
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS) PFP:00030
Fuel Pressure EBS00FDH
Idle Speed and Ignition Timing EBS00FDI
*1: Under the following conditions:
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Electric load: OFF (Lights, heater fan & rear window defogger)
G Steering wheel: Kept in straight-ahead position
Calculated Load Value EBS00FDJ
Mass Air Flow Sensor EBS00FDK
*: Engine is warmed up to normal operating temperature and running under no-load.
Intake Air Temperature Sensor EBS00FDL
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor EBS00FDM
Heated Oxygen Sensor 1 Heater EBS00FDN
Heated Oxygen sensor 2 Heater EBS00FDO
Crankshaft Position Sensor (POS) EBS00FDP
Refer to EC-1210, "Component Inspection" .
Camshaft Position Sensor (PHASE) EBS00FDQ
Refer to EC-1216, "Component Inspection" .
Fuel pressure at idle
Approximately 350 kPa (3.7kg/cm
2
, 51psi)
Target idle speed No-load*1 (in P or N position)
M/T: 60050 rpm
CVT: 65050 rpm
Air conditioner: ON In P or N position 725 rpm or more
Ignition timing In P or N position
M/T: 145 BTDC
CVT:155 BTDC
Calculated load value % (Using CONSULT-II or GST)
At idle 10 - 35
At 2,500 rpm 10 - 35
Supply voltage Battery voltage (11 - 14V)
Output voltage at idle 1.1 - 1.5*V
Mass air flow (Using CONSULT-II or GST)
1.4 - 4.0 gm/sec at idle*
4.0 - 10.0 gm/sec at 2,500 rpm*
Temperature C (F) Resistance k
25 (77) 1.9 - 2.1
80 (176) 0.31 - 0.37
Temperature C (F) Resistance k
20 (68) 2.1 - 2.9
50 (122) 0.68 - 1.00
90 (194) 0.236 - 0.260
Resistance [at 25C (77F)] 2.3 - 4.3
Resistance [at 25C (77F)] 2.3 - 4.3
EC-1414
[QR (WITH EURO-OBD)]
SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
Throttle Control Motor EBS00FDR
Injector EBS00FDS
Fuel Pump EBS00FDT
Resistance [at 25C (77F)] Approximately 1 - 15
Resistance [at 20C (68F)] 13.5 - 17.5
Resistance [at 25C (77F)] Approximately 1.0
INDEX FOR DTC
EC-1415
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
INDEX FOR DTC PFP:00024
Alphabetical Index EBS00GXE
Check if the vehicle is a model with Euro-OBD (E-OBD) system or not by the Type approval number on the
identification plate. Refer to GI-46, "IDENTIFICATION PLATE" .
NOTE:
If DTC U1000 or U1001 is displayed with other DTC, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-1505, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC*
1
Reference page
CONSULT-II*
2
ECM*
3
APP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
P0227 0227 EC-1544
APP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
P0228 0228 EC-1544
APP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
P1227 1227 EC-1630
APP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
P1228 1228 EC-1630
APP SENSOR*
5
P0226 0226 EC-1537
BRAKE SW/CIRCUIT P1805 1805 EC-1641
CAN COMM CIRCUIT U1000
1000*
6
EC-1505
CAN COMM CIRCUIT U1001 1001*
6
EC-1505
CKP SEN/CIRCUIT P0335 0335 EC-1555
CMP SEN/CIRC-B1 P0340 0340 EC-1562
CTP LEARNING P1225 1225 EC-1626
CTP LEARNING P1226 1226 EC-1628
ECM P0605 0605 EC-1576
ECM BACK UP/CIRC P1065 1065 EC-1579
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
P0117 0117 EC-1514
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
P0118 0118 EC-1514
ENG OVER TEMP P1217 1217 EC-1603
ETC ACTR*
5
P1121 1121 EC-1583
ETC FUNCTION/CIRC*
5
P1122 1122 EC-1585
ETC MOT*
5
P1128 1128 EC-1598
ETC MOT PWR*
5
P1124 1124 EC-1592
ETC MOT PWR*
5
P1126 1126 EC-1592
HO2S1 (B1) P0134 0134 EC-1519
KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 P0327 0327 EC-1551
KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 P0328 0328 EC-1551
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
P0102 0102 EC-1508
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
P0103 0103 EC-1508
NATS MALFUNCTION P1610 - P1615 1610 - 1615 EC-1447
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.
No DTC
Flashing*
4
EC-1448
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.
P0000 0000
PW ST P SEN/CIRC P0550 0550 EC-1571
EC-1416
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
INDEX FOR DTC
*1: 1st trip DTC No. is the same as DTC No.
*2: These numbers are prescribed by ISO 15031-5.
*3: In Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results), these numbers are controlled by NISSAN.
*4: When engine is running.
*5: When the fail-safe operation occurs, the MI illuminates.
*6: The troubleshooting for these DTCs needs CONSULT-II.
DTC No. Index EBS00GXF
NOTE:
If DTC U1000 or U1001 is displayed with other DTC, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-1505, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
SENSOR POWER/CIRC*
5
P1229 1229 EC-1637
TP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
P0222 0222 EC-1531
TP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
P0223 0223 EC-1531
TP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
P1223 1223 EC-1620
TP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
P1224 1224 EC-1620
TP SENSOR*
5
P0221 0221 EC-1525
VEH SPEED SEN/CIRC P0500 0500 EC-1569
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC*
1
Reference page
CONSULT-II*
2
ECM*
3
DTC*
1
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
Reference page
CONSULT-II*
2
ECM*
3
No DTC
Flashing*
4
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.
EC-1448
U1000
1000*
6
CAN COMM CIRCUIT EC-1505
U1001 1001*
6
CAN COMM CIRCUIT EC-1505
P0000 0000
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING
MAY BE REQUIRED.

P0102 0102 MAF SEN/CIRCUIT*


5
EC-1508
P0103 0103
MAF SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
EC-1508
P0117 0117
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
EC-1514
P0118 0118
ECT SEN/CIRCUIT*
5
EC-1514
P0134 0134 HO2S1 (B1) EC-1519
P0221 0221 TP SENSOR*
5
EC-1525
P0222 0222 TP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
EC-1531
P0223 0223 TP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
EC-1531
P0226 0226
APP SENSOR*
5
EC-1537
P0227 0227
APP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
EC-1544
P0228 0228
APP SEN 1/CIRC*
5
EC-1544
P0327 0327 KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 EC-1551
P0328 0328 KNOCK SEN/CIRC-B1 EC-1551
P0335 0335 CKP SEN/CIRCUIT EC-1555
P0340 0340 CMP SEN/CIRC-B1 EC-1562
INDEX FOR DTC
EC-1417
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
*1: 1st trip DTC No. is the same as DTC No.
*2: These numbers are prescribed by ISO 15031-5.
*3: In Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results), these numbers are controlled by NISSAN.
*4: When engine is running.
*5: When the fail-safe operation occurs, the MI illuminates.
*6: The troubleshooting for these DTCs needs CONSULT-II.
P0500 0500 VEH SPEED SEN/CIRC EC-1569
P0550 0550 PW ST P SEN/CIRC EC-1571
P0605 0605 ECM EC-1576
P1065 1065 ECM BACK UP/CIRC EC-1579
P1121 1121
ETC ACTR*
5
EC-1583
P1122 1122
ETC FUNCTION/CIRC*
5
EC-1585
P1124 1124
ETC MOT PWR*
5
EC-1592
P1126 1126 ETC MOT PWR*
5
EC-1592
P1128 1128 ETC MOT*
5
EC-1598
P1217 1217 ENG OVER TEMP EC-1603
P1223 1223
TP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
EC-1620
P1224 1224
TP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
EC-1620
P1225 1225 CTP LEARNING EC-1626
P1226 1226 CTP LEARNING EC-1628
P1227 1227
APP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
EC-1630
P1228 1228
APP SEN 2/CIRC*
5
EC-1630
P1229 1229 SENSOR POWER/CIRC*
5
EC-1637
P1610 - P1615 1610 - 1615 NATS MALFUNCTION EC-1447
P1805 1805 BRAKE SW/CIRCUIT EC-1641
DTC*
1
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
Reference page
CONSULT-II*
2
ECM*
3
EC-1418
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
PRECAUTIONS
PRECAUTIONS PFP:00001
Precautions for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) AIR BAG and SEAT
BELT PRE-TENSIONER EBS00GXG
The Supplemental Restraint System such as "AIR BAG" and "SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER", used along
with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SRS and SB section of
this Service Manual.
WARNING:
G To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death
in the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be per-
formed by an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
G Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to per-
sonal injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air
Bag Module, see the SRS section.
G Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harness connec-
tors.
On Board Diagnostic (OBD) System of Engine EBS00GXH
The ECM has an on board diagnostic system. It will light up the malfunction indicator (MI) to warn the driver of
a malfunction causing emission deterioration.
CAUTION:
G Be sure to turn the ignition switch OFF and disconnect the battery ground cable before any repair
or inspection work. The open/short circuit of related switches, sensors, solenoid valves, etc. will
cause the MI to light up.
G Be sure to connect and lock the connectors securely after work. A loose (unlocked) connector will
cause the MI to light up due to the open circuit. (Be sure the connector is free from water, grease,
dirt, bent terminals, etc.)
G Certain systems and components, especially those related to OBD, may use a new style slide-
locking type harness connector. For description and how to disconnect, refer to PG-86, "HAR-
NESS CONNECTOR" .
G Be sure to route and secure the harnesses properly after work. The interference of the harness
with a bracket, etc. may cause the MI to light up due to the short circuit.
G Be sure to connect rubber tubes properly after work. A misconnected or disconnected rubber tube
may cause the MI to light up due to the malfunction of the fuel injection system, etc.
G Be sure to erase the unnecessary malfunction information (repairs completed) from the ECM.
Precaution EBS00GXI
G Always use a 12 volt battery as power source.
G Do not attempt to disconnect battery cables while engine is
running.
G Before connecting or disconnecting the ECM harness con-
nector, turn ignition switch OFF and disconnect battery
ground cable. Failure to do so may damage the ECM
because battery voltage is applied to ECM even if ignition
switch is turned off.
G Before removing parts, turn ignition switch OFF and then
disconnect battery ground cable.
SEF289H
PRECAUTIONS
EC-1419
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
G Do not disassemble ECM.
G If battery cable is disconnected, the memory will return to
the initial ECM values.
The ECM will now start to self-control at its initial values.
Engine operation can vary slightly when the cable is dis-
connected. However, this is not an indication of a problem.
Do not replace parts because of a slight variation.
G When connecting ECM harness connector, fasten it
securely with levers as far as they will go as shown at right.
G When connecting or disconnecting pin connectors into or
from ECM, take care not to damage pin terminals (bend or
break).
Make sure that there are not any bends or breaks on ECM
pin terminal, when connecting pin connectors.
G Securely connect ECM harness connectors.
A poor connection can cause an extremely high (surge)
voltage to develop in coil and condenser, thus resulting in
damage to ICs.
G Keep engine control system harness at least 10 cm (4 in)
away from adjacent harness, to prevent engine control sys-
tem malfunctions due to receiving external noise, degraded
operation of ICs, etc.
G Keep engine control system parts and harness dry.
G Before replacing ECM, perform ECM Terminals and Refer-
ence Value inspection and make sure ECM functions prop-
erly. Refer to EC-1472 .
G Handle mass air flow sensor carefully to avoid damage.
G Do not disassemble mass air flow sensor.
G Do not clean mass air flow sensor with any type of deter-
gent.
G Do not disassemble electric throttle control actuator.
G Even a slight leak in the air intake system can cause seri-
ous problems.
G Do not shock or jar the camshaft position sensor (PHASE),
crankshaft position sensor (POS).
SEF707Y
MBIB0145E
PBIB0090E
MEF040D
EC-1420
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
PRECAUTIONS
G After performing each TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS, perform
DTC Confirmation Procedure or Overall Function
Check.
The DTC should not be displayed in the DTC Confirmation
Procedure if the repair is completed. The Overall Func-
tion Check should be a good result if the repair is com-
pleted.
G When measuring ECM signal with a circuit tester, connect
break-out box (SST) and Y-cable adapter (SST) between the
ECM and ECM harness connector.
G When measuring ECM signals with a circuit tester, never
allow the two tester probes to contact.
Accidental contact of probes will cause a short circuit and
damage the ECM power transistor.
G Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/
output voltage. Doing so may result in damage to the ECM's
transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as
the ground.
G Do not operate fuel pump when there is no fuel in lines.
G Tighten fuel hose clamps to the specified torque.
SAT652J
SEF348N
MBIB0046E
PRECAUTIONS
EC-1421
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
G Do not depress accelerator pedal when starting.
G Immediately after starting, do not rev up engine unneces-
sarily.
G Do not rev up engine just prior to shutdown.
G When installing C.B. ham radio or a mobile phone, be sure
to observe the following as it may adversely affect elec-
tronic control systems depending on installation location.
Keep the antenna as far as possible from the electronic
control units.
Keep the antenna feeder line more than 20 cm (8 in) away
from the harness of electronic controls.
Do not let them run parallel for a long distance.
Adjust the antenna and feeder line so that the standing-
wave radio can be kept smaller.
Be sure to ground the radio to vehicle body.
Wiring Diagrams and Trouble Diagnosis EBS00GXJ
When you read wiring diagrams, refer to the following:
G GI-14, "How to Read Wiring Diagrams"
G PG-3, "POWER SUPPLY ROUTING" for power distribution circuit
When you perform trouble diagnosis, refer to the following:
G GI-11, "HOW TO FOLLOW TEST GROUPS IN TROUBLE DIAGNOSES"
G GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident"
SEF709Y
SEF708Y
EC-1422
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
PREPARATION
PREPARATION PFP:00002
Special Service Tools EBS00GXK
Commercial Service Tools EBS00GXL
Tool number
Tool name
Description
KV10117100
Heated oxygen
sensor wrench
Loosening or tightening heated oxygen sensors
with 22 mm (0.87 in) hexagon nut
KV10114400
Heated oxygen
sensor wrench
Loosening or tightening heated oxygen sensors
a: 22 mm (0.87 in)
KV109E0010
Break-out box
Measuring ECM signals with a circuit tester
KV109E0080
Y-cable adapter
Measuring ECM signals with a circuit tester
S-NT379
S-NT636
NT825
NT826
Tool name Description
Quick connector
release
Removing fuel tube quick connectors in engine
room
(Available in SEC. 164 of PARTS CATALOG:
Part No. 16441 6N210)
Fuel filler cap adapter Checking fuel tank vacuum relief valve opening
pressure
PBIC0198E
S-NT653
PREPARATION
EC-1423
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Socket wrench Removing and installing engine coolant
temperature sensor
Oxygen sensor
thread cleaner
ie: (J-43897-18)
(J-43897-12)
Reconditioning the exhaust system threads
before installing a new oxygen sensor. Use with
anti-seize lubricant shown below.
a: 18 mm diameter with pitch 1.5 mm for
Zirconia Oxygen Sensor
b: 12 mm diameter with pitch 1.25 mm for
Titania Oxygen Sensor
Anti-seize lubricant
i.e.: (Permatex
TM
133AR or equivalent
meeting MIL
specification MIL-A-
907)
Lubricating oxygen sensor thread cleaning tool
when reconditioning exhaust system threads.
Tool name Description
S-NT705
AEM488
S-NT779
EC-1424
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM PFP:23710
System Diagram EBS00GXM
MBIB0051E
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-1425
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Vacuum Hose Drawing EBS00GXN
Refer to EC-1424, "System Diagram" for Vacuum Control System.
PBIB0489E
EC-1426
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
System Chart EBS00GXO
*1: This sensor is not used to control the engine system under normal conditions.
*2: These input signals are sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
*3: These output signals are sent from the ECM through CAN communication line.
Multiport Fuel Injection (MFI) System EBS00GXP
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
*1: Under normal conditions, this sensor is not for engine control operation.
*2: These signals are sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
*3: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
Input (Sensor) ECM Function Output (Actuator)
G Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
G Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
G Mass air flow sensor
G Engine coolant temperature sensor
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
G Throttle position sensor
G Accelerator pedal position sensor
G Park/neutral position (PNP) switch
G Intake air temperature sensor
G Power steering pressure sensor
G Ignition switch
G Battery voltage
G Knock sensor
G Refrigerant pressure sensor
G Stop lamp switch
G Heated oxygen sensor 2 *
1
G TCM (Transmission control module) *
2
G Air conditioner switch *
2
G Vehicle speed signal *
2
G Electrical load signal *
2
Fuel injection & mixture ratio control Fuel injectors
Electronic ignition system Power transistor
Fuel pump control Fuel pump relay
On board diagnostic system
MI (On the instrument panel) *
3
Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater control Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater control Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
EVAP canister purge flow control
EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve
Air conditioning cut control
Air conditioner relay *
3
Cooling fan control
Cooling fan relays *
3
Sensor Input Signal to ECM
ECM
function
Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed *
3
and piston position
Fuel injec-
tion & mix-
ture ratio
control
Fuel injectors
Mass air flow sensor Amount of intake air
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Heated oxygen sensor 1 Density of oxygen in exhaust gas
Throttle position sensor Throttle position
Accelerator pedal position sensor Accelerator pedal position
Park/neutral position (PNP) switch Gear position
Knock sensor Engine knocking condition
Battery
Battery voltage *
3
Power steering pressure sensor Power steering operation
Heated oxygen sensor 2 *
1
Density of oxygen in exhaust gas
Vehicle speed signal *
2
Vehicle speed
Air conditioner switch *
2
Air conditioner operation
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-1427
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The amount of fuel injected from the fuel injector is determined by the ECM. The ECM controls the length of
time the valve remains open (injection pulse duration). The amount of fuel injected is a program value in the
ECM memory. The program value is preset by engine operating conditions. These conditions are determined
by input signals (for engine speed and intake air) from both the crankshaft position sensor and the mass air
flow sensor.
VARIOUS FUEL INJECTION INCREASE/DECREASE COMPENSATION
In addition, the amount of fuel injected is compensated to improve engine performance under various operat-
ing conditions as listed below.
<Fuel increase>
G During warm-up
G When starting the engine
G During acceleration
G Hot-engine operation
G When selector lever is changed from N to D (CVT models)
G High-load, high-speed operation
<Fuel decrease>
G During deceleration
G During high engine speed operation
MIXTURE RATIO FEEDBACK CONTROL (CLOSED LOOP CONTROL)
The mixture ratio feedback system provides the best air-fuel mixture ratio for driveability and emission control.
The three way catalyst (manifold) can then better reduce CO, HC and NOx emissions. This system uses
heated oxygen sensor 1 in the exhaust manifold to monitor if the engine operation is rich or lean. The ECM
adjusts the injection pulse width according to the sensor voltage signal. For more information about heated
oxygen sensor 1, refer to EC-1119 . This maintains the mixture ratio within the range of stoichiometric (ideal
air-fuel mixture).
This stage is referred to as the closed loop control condition.
Heated oxygen sensor 2 is located downstream of the three way catalyst (manifold). Even if the switching
characteristics of heated oxygen sensor 1 shift, the air-fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric by the signal
from heated oxygen sensor 2.
Open Loop Control
The open loop system condition refers to when the ECM detects any of the following conditions. Feedback
control stops in order to maintain stabilized fuel combustion.
G Deceleration and acceleration
G High-load, high-speed operation
G Malfunction of heated oxygen sensor 1 or its circuit
G Insufficient activation of heated oxygen sensor 1 at low engine coolant temperature
G High engine coolant temperature
G During warm-up
G After shifting from N to D (CVT models)
G When starting the engine
PBIB0121E
EC-1428
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
MIXTURE RATIO SELF-LEARNING CONTROL
The mixture ratio feedback control system monitors the mixture ratio signal transmitted from heated oxygen
sensor 1. This feedback signal is then sent to the ECM. The ECM controls the basic mixture ratio as close to
the theoretical mixture ratio as possible. However, the basic mixture ratio is not necessarily controlled as orig-
inally designed. Both manufacturing differences (i.e., mass air flow sensor hot film) and characteristic changes
during operation (i.e., injector clogging) directly affect mixture ratio.
Accordingly, the difference between the basic and theoretical mixture ratios is monitored in this system. This is
then computed in terms of injection pulse duration to automatically compensate for the difference between
the two ratios.
Fuel trim refers to the feedback compensation value compared against the basic injection duration. Fuel trim
includes short term fuel trim and long term fuel trim.
Short term fuel trim is the short-term fuel compensation used to maintain the mixture ratio at its theoretical
value. The signal from heated oxygen sensor 1 indicates whether the mixture ratio is RICH or LEAN compared
to the theoretical value. The signal then triggers a reduction in fuel volume if the mixture ratio is rich, and an
increase in fuel volume if it is lean.
Long term fuel trim is overall fuel compensation carried out long-term to compensate for continual deviation
of the short term fuel trim from the central value. Such deviation will occur due to individual engine differences,
wear over time and changes in the usage environment.
FUEL INJECTION TIMING
Two types of systems are used.
Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection System
Fuel is injected into each cylinder during each engine cycle according to the firing order. This system is used
when the engine is running.
Simultaneous Multiport Fuel Injection System
Fuel is injected simultaneously into all four cylinders twice each engine cycle. In other words, pulse signals of
the same width are simultaneously transmitted from the ECM.
The four injectors will then receive the signals two times for each engine cycle.
This system is used when the engine is being started and/or if the fail-safe system (CPU) is operating.
FUEL SHUT-OFF
Fuel to each cylinder is cut off during deceleration or operation of the engine at excessively high speeds.
SEF337W
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-1429
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Electronic Ignition (EI) System EBS00GXQ
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
*1: This signal is sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
*2: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ignition timing is controlled by the ECM to maintain the best air-
fuel ratio for every running condition of the engine. The ignition tim-
ing data is stored in the ECM. This data forms the map shown.
The ECM receives information such as the injection pulse width and
camshaft position sensor signal. Computing this information, ignition
signals are transmitted to the power transistor.
e.g., N: 1,800 rpm, Tp: 1.50 msec
A BTDC
During the following conditions, the ignition timing is revised by the
ECM according to the other data stored in the ECM.
G At starting
G During warm-up
G At idle
G At low battery voltage
G During acceleration
The knock sensor retard system is designed only for emergencies. The basic ignition timing is programmed
within the anti-knocking zone, if recommended fuel is used under dry conditions. The retard system does not
operate under normal driving conditions. If engine knocking occurs, the knock sensor monitors the condition.
The signal is transmitted to the ECM. The ECM retards the ignition timing to eliminate the knocking condition.
Air Conditioning Cut Control EBS00GXR
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
*1: These signals are sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
*2: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM
ECM func-
tion
Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed *
2
and piston position
Ignition
timing con-
trol
Power transistor
Mass air flow sensor Amount of intake air
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Throttle position sensor Throttle position
Accelerator pedal position sensor Accelerator pedal position
Knock sensor Engine knocking
Park/neutral position (PNP) switch Gear position
Battery Battery voltage *
2
Vehicle speed signal *
1
Vehicle speed
SEF742M
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Air conditioner switch *
1
Air conditioner ON signal
Air conditioner
cut control
Air conditioner relay
Throttle position sensor Throttle valve opening angle
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed *
2
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Refrigerant pressure sensor Refrigerant pressure
Power steering pressure sensor Power steering operation
Vehicle speed signal *
1
Vehicle speed
EC-1430
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
This system improves engine operation when the air conditioner is used.
Under the following conditions, the air conditioner is turned off.
G When the accelerator pedal is fully depressed.
G When cranking the engine.
G At high engine speeds.
G When the engine coolant temperature becomes excessively high.
G When operating power steering during low engine speed or low vehicle speed.
G When engine speed is excessively low.
G When refrigerant pressure is excessively low or high.
Fuel Cut Control (at No Load and High Engine Speed) EBS00GXS
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
*1: This signal is sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
If the engine speed is above 1,800 rpm with no load (for example, in neutral and engine speed over 1,800
rpm) fuel will be cut off after some time. The exact time when the fuel is cut off varies based on engine speed.
Fuel cut will operate until the engine speed reaches 1,500 rpm, then fuel cut is cancelled.
NOTE:
This function is different from deceleration control listed under Multiport Fuel Injection (MFI) System, EC-
1426 .
CAN communication EBS00GXT
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real time application. It is an on-vehicle mul-
tiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent error detection ability. Many elec-
tronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links with other
control units during operation (not independent). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2
communication lines (CAN H line, CAN L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission with less wiring.
Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM
ECM func-
tion
Actuator
Park/neutral position (PNP) switch Neutral position
Fuel cut
control
Fuel injectors
Throttle position sensor Throttle position
Accelerator pedal position sensor Accelerator pedal position
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
Vehicle speed signal*
1
Vehicle speed
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-1431
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
CAN COMMUNICATION UNIT FOR LHD MODELS WITH TYRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYS-
TEM
CVT Models
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
SKIA1521E
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actua-
tor and elec-
tric unit
(control unit)
Smart
entrance
control unit
Tyre pres-
sure moni-
toring
control unit
Combina-
tion meter
Engine speed signal T R R
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
Primary pulley revolution signal R T
Secondary pulley revolution signal R T
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
EC-1432
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
M/T Models
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
Signals ECM
ABS actuator
and electric
unit (control
unit)
Smart
entrance con-
trol unit
Tyre pres-
sure monitor-
ing control
unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
SKIA1525E
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-1433
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
CAN COMMUNICATION UNIT FOR LHD MODELS WITHOUT TYRE PRESSURE MONITORING
SYSTEM
CVT Models
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
SKIA1528E
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actuator
and electric
unit (control
unit)
Smart
entrance con-
trol unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R R
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
Primary pulley revolution signal R T
Secondary pulley revolution signal R T
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
EC-1434
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
M/T Models
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
CAN COMMUNICATION UNIT FOR RHD MODELS WITH TYRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYS-
TEM
CVT Models
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
SKIA1532E
Signals ECM
ABS actuator and
electric unit (con-
trol unit)
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
SKIA1535E
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-1435
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
M/T Models
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actua-
tor and
electricunit
(control
unit)
Tyre pres-
sure moni-
toring
control unit
Smart
entrance
control unit
Combina-
tion meter
Engine speed signal T R R
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
Primary pulley revolution signal R T
Secondary pulley revolution signal R T
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
SKIA1539E
Signals ECM
ABS actuator
and electric unit
(control unit)
Tyre pressure
monitoring con-
trol unit
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R
Rear window defogger signal R T
EC-1436
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
CAN COMMUNICATION UNIT FOR RHD MODELS WITHOUT TYRE PRESSURE MONITORING
SYSTEM
CVT Models
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
Signals ECM
ABS actuator
and electric unit
(control unit)
Tyre pressure
monitoring con-
trol unit
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actuator
and electric unit
(control unit)
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R R
Stop lamp switch signal R T
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
Primary pulley revolution signal R T
Secondary pulley revolution signal R T
MI signal T R
Current gear position signal T R
SKIA1542E
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-1437
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
M/T Models
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
T: Transmit R: Receive
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Signals ECM TCM
ABS actuator
and electric unit
(control unit)
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
SKIA1546E
Signals ECM
ABS actuator and
electric unit (con-
trol unit)
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R
Rear window defogger signal R T
Heater fan switch signal R T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
EC-1438
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Signals ECM
ABS actuator and
electric unit (con-
trol unit)
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
EC-1439
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE PFP:00018
Idle Speed and Ignition Timing Check EBS00GXU
IDLE SPEED
With CONSULT-II
Check idle speed in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
IGNITION TIMING
Any of following two methods may be used.
Method A
1. Slide the harness protector of ignition coil No.1 to clear the
wires.
2. Attach timing light to the wires as shown in the figure.
3. Check ignition timing.
Method B
1. Remove No. 1 ignition coil.
2. Connect No. 1 ignition coil and No. 1 spark plug with suitable
high-tension wire as shown, and attach timing light clamp to this
wire.
SEF058Y
MBIB0065E
MBIB0132E
MBIB0066E
EC-1440
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
3. Check ignition timing.
Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning EBS00GXV
DESCRIPTION
Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning is an operation to learn the fully released position of the accel-
erator pedal by monitoring the accelerator pedal position sensor output signal. It must be performed each time
harness connector of accelerator pedal position sensor or ECM is disconnected.
OPERATION PROCEDURE
1. Make sure that accelerator pedal is fully released.
2. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF wait at least 10 seconds.
Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning EBS00GXW
DESCRIPTION
Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning is an operation to learn the fully closed position of the throttle valve
by monitoring the throttle position sensor output signal. It must be performed each time harness connector of
electric throttle control actuator or ECM is disconnected.
OPERATION PROCEDURE
1. Make sure that accelerator pedal is fully released.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
Make sure that throttle valve moves during above 10 seconds by confirming the operating sound.
Idle Air Volume Learning EBS00GXX
DESCRIPTION
Idle Air Volume Learning is an operation to learn the idle air volume that keeps each engine within the spe-
cific range. It must be performed under any of the following conditions:
G Each time electric throttle control actuator or ECM is replaced.
G Idle speed or ignition timing is out of specification.
PREPARATION
Before performing Idle Air Volume Learning, make sure that all of the following conditions are satisfied.
SEF166Y
MBIB0067E
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
EC-1441
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Learning will be cancelled if any of the following conditions are missed for even a moment.
G Battery voltage: More than 12.9V (At idle)
G Engine coolant temperature: 70 - 95C (158 - 203F)
G PNP switch: ON
G Electric load switch: OFF
(Air conditioner, headlamp, rear window defogger)
On vehicles equipped with daytime light systems, set lighting switch to the 1st position to light
only small lamps.
G Steering wheel: Neutral (Straight-ahead position)
G Vehicle speed: Stopped
G Transmission: Warmed-up
For CVT models with CONSULT-II, drive vehicle until FLUID TEMP SE in DATA MONITOR mode of
CVT system indicates less than 0.9V.
For CVT models without CONSULT-II and M/T models, drive vehicle for 10 minutes.
OPERATION PROCEDURE
With CONSULT-II
1. Perform EC-1440, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
2. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
4. Check that all items listed under the topic PRE-CONDITIONING (previously mentioned) are in good
order.
5. Select IDLE AIR VOL LEARN in WORK SUPPORT mode.
6. Touch START and wait 20 seconds.
SEF217Z
SEF454Y
EC-1442
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
7. Make sure that CMPLT is displayed on CONSULT-II screen. If
INCMP is displayed, Idle Air Volume Learning will not be car-
ried out successfully. In this case, find the cause of the problem
by referring to the Diagnostic Procedure below.
8. Rev up the engine two or three times and make sure that idle
speed and ignition timing are within the specifications.
Without CONSULT-II
NOTE:
G It is better to count the time accurately with a clock.
G It is impossible to switch the diagnostic mode when an accelerator pedal position sensor circuit
has a malfunction.
1. Perform EC-1440, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
2. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
4. Check that all items listed under the topic PRE-CONDITIONING (previously mentioned) are in good
order.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
6. Confirm that accelerator pedal is fully released, turn ignition switch ON and wait 3 seconds.
7. Repeat the following procedure quickly five times within 5 seconds.
a. Fully depress the accelerator pedal.
b. Fully release the accelerator pedal.
8. Wait 7 seconds, fully depress the accelerator pedal and keep it for approx. 20 seconds until the MI stops
blinking and turned ON.
9. Fully release the accelerator pedal within 3 seconds after the MI goes off.
10. Start engine and let it idle.
11. Wait 20 seconds.
12. Rev up the engine two or three times and make sure that idle speed and ignition timing are within the
specifications.
13. If idle speed and ignition timing are not within the specification, the result will be incomplete. In this case,
find the cause of the problem by referring to the Diagnostic Procedure below.
ITEM SPECIFICATION
Idle speed M/T: 60050 rpm
CVT: 65050 rpm (in P or N position)
Ignition timing M/T: 145 BTDC
CVT: 155 BTDC (in P or N position)
SEF455Y
ITEM SPECIFICATION
Idle speed M/T: 60050 rpm
CVT: 65050 rpm (in P or N position)
Ignition timing M/T: 145 BTDC
CVT: 155 BTDC (in P or N position)
PBIB0665E
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
EC-1443
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE
If idle air volume learning cannot be performed successfully, proceed as follows:
1. Check that throttle valve is fully closed.
2. Check PCV valve operation.
3. Check that downstream of throttle valve is free from air leakage.
4. When the above three items check out OK, engine component parts and their installation condi-
tion are questionable. Check and eliminate the cause of the problem.
It is useful to perform EC-1494, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE" .
5. If any of the following conditions occur after the engine has started, eliminate the cause of the
problem and perform Idle air volume learning all over again:
G Engine stalls.
G Erroneous idle.
Fuel Pressure Check EBS00GXY
FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE
Before disconnecting fuel line, release fuel pressure from fuel line to eliminate danger.
NOTE:
Prepare pans or saucers under the disconnected fuel line because the fuel may spill out. The fuel pres-
sure cannot be completely released because QR engine models do not have fuel return system.
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Perform FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE in WORK SUPPORT
mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine.
4. After engine stalls, crank it two or three times to release all fuel
pressure.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Remove fuel pump fuse located in fuse box.
2. Start engine.
3. After engine stalls, crank it two or three times to release all fuel
pressure.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF.
5. Reinstall fuel pump fuse after servicing fuel system.
FUEL PRESSURE CHECK
CAUTION:
G The fuel hose connection method used when taking fuel pressure check must not be used for
other purposes.
G Be careful not to scratch or put debris around connection area when servicing, so that the quick
connector maintains sealability with O-rings inside.
G When installing fuel hose quick connetor, refer to EM-116, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
1. Release fuel pressure to zero. Refer to EC-1443, "FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE" .
2. Prepare fuel hose and fuel hose clamp for fuel pressure check, and connect fuel pressure gauge.
SEF214Y
MBIB0141E
EC-1444
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
G Use suitable fuel hose for fuel pressure check (genuine NISSAN fuel hose without quick connector).
G To avoid unnecessary force or tension to hose, use moderately long fuel hose for fuel pressure check.
G Do not use the fuel hose for checking fuel pressure with damage or cracks on it.
G Use Pressure Gauge to check fuel pressure.
3. Remove fuel hose. Refer to EM-116, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
G Do not twist or kink fuel hose because it is plastic hose.
G Do not remove fuel hose from quick connector.
G Keep the original fuel hose to be free from intrusion of dust or foreign substances with a suitable cover.
4. Install the fuel pressure gauge as shown in the figure.
G Wipe off oil or dirt from hose insertion part using cloth moist-
ened with gasoline.
G Apply proper amount of gasoline between top of the fuel tube
and No.1 spool.
G Insert fuel hose for fuel pressure check until it touches the
No.1 spool on fuel tube.
G Use NISSAN genuine hose clamp (part number: 16439
N4710 or 16439 40U00).
G When reconnecting fuel line, always use new clamps.
G When reconnecting fuel hose, check the original fuel hose for
damage and abnormality.
G Use a torque driver to tighten clamps.
G Install hose clamp to the position within 1 - 2 mm (0.04 - 0.08
in).
G Make sure that clamp screw does not contact adjacent parts.
5. After connecting fuel hose for fuel pressure check, pull the hose
with a force of approximately 98 N (10 kg, 22 lb) to confirm fuel
tube does not come off.
6. Turn ignition switch "ON", and check for fuel leakage.
7. Start engine and check for fuel leakage.
8. Read the indication of fuel pressure gauge.
G Do not perform fuel pressure check with system operating. Fuel pressure gauge may indicate false
readings.
G During fuel pressure check, confirm for fuel leakage from fuel connection every 3 minutes.
9. If result is unsatisfactory, go to next step.
10. Check the following.
G Fuel hoses and fuel tubes for clogging
G Fuel filter for clogging
G Fuel pump
G Fuel pressure regulator for clogging
If OK, replace fuel pressure regulator.
If NG, repair or replace.
Tightening torque:
1 - 1.5 Nm (0.1 - 0.15 kg-m, 9 - 13 in-lb)
At idling: Approximately 350 kPa (3.5 bar, 3.7 kg/cm
2
, 51 psi)
PBIB0669E
MBIB0068E
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-1445
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM PFP:00028
Introduction EBS00GXZ
The ECM has an on board diagnostic system, which detects malfunctions related to engine sensors or actua-
tors. The ECM also records various emission-related diagnostic information including:
The above information can be checked using procedures listed in the table below.
: Applicable : Not applicable
*: When DTC and 1st trip DTC simultaneously appear on the display, they cannot be clearly distinguished from each other.
The malfunction indicator (MI) on the instrument panel lights up when the same malfunction is detected in two
consecutive trips (Two trip detection logic), or when the ECM enters fail-safe mode. (Refer to EC-1456 .)
Two Trip Detection Logic EBS00GY0
When a malfunction is detected for the first time, 1st trip DTC and 1st trip Freeze Frame data are stored in the
ECM memory. The MI will not light up at this stage. <1st trip>
If the same malfunction is detected again during the next drive, the DTC and Freeze Frame data are stored in
the ECM memory, and the MI lights up. The MI lights up at the same time when the DTC is stored. <2nd trip>
The trip in the Two Trip Detection Logic means a driving mode in which self-diagnosis is performed during
vehicle operation. When the ECM enters fail-safe mode (Refer to EC-1456 .), the DTC is stored in the ECM
memory even in the 1st trip.
Emission-related Diagnostic Information EBS00GY1
DTC AND 1ST TRIP DTC
The 1st trip DTC (whose number is the same as the DTC number) is displayed for the latest self-diagnostic
result obtained. If the ECM memory was cleared previously, and the 1st trip DTC did not reoccur, the 1st trip
DTC will not be displayed.
If a malfunction is detected during the 1st trip, the 1st trip DTC is stored in the ECM memory. The MI will not
light up (two trip detection logic). If the same malfunction is not detected in the 2nd trip (meeting the required
driving pattern), the 1st trip DTC is cleared from the ECM memory. If the same malfunction is detected in the
2nd trip, both the 1st trip DTC and DTC are stored in the ECM memory and the MI lights up. In other words,
the DTC is stored in the ECM memory and the MI lights up when the same malfunction occurs in two consec-
utive trips. If a 1st trip DTC is stored and a non-diagnostic operation is performed between the 1st and 2nd
trips, only the 1st trip DTC will continue to be stored. For fail-safe items, DTC is stored in the ECM memory
even in the 1st trip.
Procedures for clearing the DTC and the 1st trip DTC from the ECM memory are described in EC-1446, "HOW
TO ERASE EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
When a 1st trip DTC is detected, check, print out or write down and erase (1st trip) DTC and Freeze Frame
data as specified in Work Flow procedure Step II, refer to EC-1452 . Then perform DTC Confirmation Proce-
dure or Overall Function Check to try to duplicate the problem. If the malfunction is duplicated, the item
requires repair.
How to Read DTC and 1st Trip DTC
DTC and 1st trip DTC can be read by the following methods.
With CONSULT-II
CONSULT-II displays the DTC in SELF-DIAG RESULTS mode. Examples: P0117, P0340, P1065, etc.
(CONSULT-II also displays the malfunctioning component or system.)
Without CONSULT-II
Emission-related diagnostic information
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC)
Freeze Frame data
1st Trip Diagnostic Trouble Code (1st Trip DTC)
1st Trip Freeze Frame data
DTC 1st trip DTC Freeze Frame data
1st trip Freeze Frame
data
CONSULT-II
ECM
*
1

EC-1446
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
The number of blinks of the MI in the Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-Diagnostic Results) indicates the DTC.
Example: 0117, 0340, 1065 etc.
G 1st trip DTC No. is the same as DTC No.
G Output of a DTC indicates a malfunction. However, the Diagnostic Test Mode II do not indicate
whether the malfunction is still occurring or has occurred in the past and has returned to normal.
CONSULT-II can identify malfunction status as shown below. Therefore, using CONSULT-II (if avail-
able) is recommended.
A sample of CONSULT-II display for DTC and 1st trip DTC is shown below. DTC or 1st trip DTC of a malfunc-
tion is displayed in SELF-DIAGNOSTIC RESULTS mode of CONSULT-II. Time data indicates how many times
the vehicle was driven after the last detection of a DTC.
If the DTC is being detected currently, the time data will be 0.
If a 1st trip DTC is stored in the ECM, the time data will be [1t].
FREEZE FRAME DATA AND 1ST TRIP FREEZE FRAME DATA
The ECM records the driving conditions such as fuel system status, calculated load value, engine coolant tem-
perature, short term fuel trim, long term fuel trim, engine speed, vehicle speed, base fuel schedule and intake
air temperature at the moment a malfunction is detected.
Data which are stored in the ECM memory, along with the 1st trip DTC, are called 1st trip freeze frame data.
The data, stored together with the DTC data, are called freeze frame data and displayed on CONSULT-II. For
details, see EC-1482 .
Only one set of freeze frame data (either 1st trip freeze frame data or freeze frame data) can be stored in the
ECM. 1st trip freeze frame data is stored in the ECM memory along with the 1st trip DTC. There is no priority
for 1st trip freeze frame data and it is updated each time a different 1st trip DTC is detected. However, once
freeze frame data (2nd trip detection/MI on) is stored in the ECM memory, 1st trip freeze frame data is no
longer stored. Remember, only one set of freeze frame data can be stored in the ECM.
Both 1st trip freeze frame data and freeze frame data (along with the DTCs) are cleared when the ECM mem-
ory is erased. Procedures for clearing the ECM memory are described in EC-1446, "HOW TO ERASE EMIS-
SION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .
HOW TO ERASE EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION
How to Erase DTC ( With CONSULT-II)
The emission related diagnostic information in the ECM can be erased by selecting ERASE in the SELF-
DIAG RESULTS mode with CONSULT-II.
1. If the ignition switch stays ON after repair work, be sure to turn ignition switch OFF once. Wait at least
10 seconds and then turn it ON (engine stopped) again.
2. Touch ENGINE.
3. Touch SELF-DIAG RESULTS.
PBIB0911E
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-1447
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. Touch ERASE. (The DTC in the ECM will be erased.)
How to Erase DTC ( Without CONSULT-II)
1. If the ignition switch stays ON after repair work, be sure to turn ignition switch OFF once.
2. Wait at least 10 seconds and then turn it ON (engine stopped) again.
3. Change the diagnostic test mode from Mode II to Mode I by depressing the accelerator pedal. Refer to
EC-1449, "HOW TO SWITCH DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE" .
G If the battery is disconnected, the emission-related diagnostic information will be lost after
approx. 24 hours.
G The following data are cleared when the ECM memory is erased.
Diagnostic trouble codes
1st trip diagnostic trouble codes
Freeze frame data
1st trip freeze frame data
Others
Actual work procedures are explained using a DTC as an example. Be careful so that not only the DTC, but all
of the data listed above, are cleared from the ECM memory during work procedures.
NATS (Nissan Anti-theft System) EBS00GY2
G If the security indicator lights up with the ignition switch in
the ON position or NATS MALFUNCTION is displayed
on SELF-DIAG RESULTS screen, perform self-diagnostic
results mode with CONSULT-II using NATS program card.
Refer to BL-156, "NATS (NISSAN ANTI-THEFT SYSTEM)" .
G Confirm no self-diagnostic results of NATS is displayed
before touching ERASE in SELF-DIAG RESULTS mode
with CONSULT-II.
G When replacing ECM, initialization of NATS system and reg-
istration of all NATS ignition key IDs must be carried out
with CONSULT-II using NATS program card.
Therefore, be sure to receive all keys from vehicle owner.
Regarding the procedures of NATS initialization and NATS ignition key ID registration, refer to
CONSULT-II operation manual, NATS.
PBIB0671E
SEF515Y
EC-1448
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
Malfunction Indicator (MI) EBS00GY3
DESCRIPTION
The MI is located on the instrument panel.
1. The MI will light up when the ignition switch is turned ON without
the engine running. This is a bulb check.
G If the MI does not light up, refer to DI-95, "WARNING LAMPS"
or see EC-1721 .
2. When the engine is started, the MI should go off.
If the MI remains on, the on board diagnostic system has
detected an engine system malfunction.
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEM FUNCTION
The on board diagnostic system has the following four functions.
MI Flashing without DTC
If the ECM is in Diagnostic Test Mode II, MI may flash when engine is running. In this case, check ECM diag-
nostic test mode. EC-1449, "HOW TO SWITCH DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE" .
How to switch the diagnostic test (function) modes, and details of the above functions are described later, EC-
1449 .
The following emission-related diagnostic information is cleared when the ECM memory is erased.
G Diagnostic trouble codes
G 1st trip diagnostic trouble codes
G Freeze frame data
SAT652J
Diagnostic Test
Mode
KEY and ENG.
Status
Function Explanation of Function
Mode I Ignition switch in
ON position
Engine stopped
BULB CHECK This function checks the MI bulb for damage (blown, open
circuit, etc.).
If the MI does not come on, check MI circuit.
Engine running MALFUNCTION
WARNING
This is a usual driving condition. When a malfunction is
detected twice in two consecutive driving cycles (two trip
detection logic), the MI will light up to inform the driver that
a malfunction has been detected.
The following malfunctions will light up or blink the MI in
the 1st trip.
G Fail-safe mode
Mode II Ignition switch in
ON position
Engine stopped
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC
RESULTS
This function allows DTCs and 1st trip DTCs to be read.
Engine running HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
MONITOR
This function allows the fuel mixture condition (lean or
rich), monitored by heated oxygen sensor 1, to be read.
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-1449
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
G 1st trip freeze frame data
G Others
HOW TO SWITCH DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE
NOTE:
G It is better to count the time accurately with a clock.
G It is impossible to switch the diagnostic mode when an accelerator pedal position sensor circuit
has a malfunction.
G Always ECM returns to Diagnostic Test Mode I after ignition switch is turned OFF.
How to Set Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)
1. Confirm that accelerator pedal is fully released, turn ignition switch ON and wait 3 seconds.
2. Repeat the following procedure quickly five times within 5 seconds.
a. Fully depress the accelerator pedal.
b. Fully release the accelerator pedal.
3. Wait 7 seconds, fully depress the accelerator pedal and keep it for approx. 10 seconds until the MI starts
blinking.
4. Fully release the accelerator pedal.
ECM has entered to Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results).
How to Set Diagnostic Test Mode II (Heated Oxygen Sensor 1 Monitor)
1. Set the ECM in Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results). Refer to EC-1449, "How to Set Diagnos-
tic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)" .
2. Start Engine.
ECM has entered to Diagnostic Test Mode II (Heated oxygen sensor 1 monitor).
How to Erase Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)
1. Set ECM in Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results). Refer to EC-1449, "How to Set Diagnostic
Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)" .
2. Fully depress the accelerator pedal and keep it for more than 10 seconds.
The emission-related diagnostic information has been erased from the backup memory in the ECM.
3. Fully release the accelerator pedal, and confirm the DTC 0000 is displayed.
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE I BULB CHECK
In this mode, the MI on the instrument panel should stay ON. If it remains OFF, check the bulb. Refer to DI-95,
"WARNING LAMPS" or see EC-1721 .
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE I MALFUNCTION WARNING
G These DTC numbers are clarified in Diagnostic Test Mode II (SELF-DIAGNOSTIC RESULTS)
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE II SELF-DIAGNOSTIC RESULTS
In this mode, the DTC and 1st trip DTC are indicated by the number of blinks of the MI as shown below.
PBIB0092E
MI Condition
ON When the malfunction is detected.
OFF No malfunction.
EC-1450
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
The DTC and 1st trip DTC are displayed at the same time. If the MI does not illuminate in diagnostic test mode
I (Malfunction warning), all displayed items are 1st trip DTCs. If only one code is displayed when the MI illumi-
nates in diagnostic test mode II (SELF-DIAGNOSTIC RESULTS), it is a DTC; if two or more codes are dis-
played, they may be either DTCs or 1st trip DTCs. DTC No. is same as that of 1st trip DTC. These unidentified
codes can be identified by using the CONSULT-II. A DTC will be used as an example for how to read a code.
A particular trouble code can be identified by the number of four-digit numeral flashes. The zero is indicated
by the number of ten flashes. The length of time the 1,000th-digit numeral flashes on and off is 1.2 seconds
consisting of an ON (0.6-second) - OFF (0.6-second) cycle.
The 100th-digit numeral and lower digit numerals consist of a 0.3-second ON and 0.3-second OFF cycle.
A change from one digit numeral to another occurs at an interval of 1.0-second OFF. In other words, the later
numeral appears on the display 1.3 seconds after the former numeral has disappeared.
A change from one trouble code to another occurs at an interval of 1.8-second OFF.
In this way, all the detected malfunctions are classified by their DTC numbers. The DTC 0000 refers to no
malfunction. (See EC-1415, "INDEX FOR DTC" )
How to Erase Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)
The DTC can be erased from the back up memory in the ECM by depressing accelerator pedal. Refer to EC-
1449, "HOW TO SWITCH DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE" .
G If the battery is disconnected, the DTC will be lost from the backup memory after approx 24 hours.
G Be careful not to erase the stored memory before starting trouble diagnoses.
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE II HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 MONITOR
In this mode, the MI displays the condition of the fuel mixture (lean or rich) which is monitored by the heated
oxygen sensor 1.
*: Maintains conditions just before switching to open loop.
To check the heated oxygen sensor 1 function, start engine in the Diagnostic Test Mode II and warm it up until
engine coolant temperature indicator points to the middle of the gauge.
Next run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no-load conditions. Then make sure that the MI
comes ON more than 5 times within 10 seconds with engine running at 2,000 rpm under no-load.
SEF952W
MI Fuel mixture condition in the exhaust gas Air fuel ratio feedback control condition
ON Lean
Closed loop system
OFF Rich
*Remains ON or OFF Any condition Open loop system
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1451
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS PFP:00004
Trouble Diagnosis Introduction EBS00GY5
INTRODUCTION
The engine has an ECM to control major systems such as fuel con-
trol, ignition control, idle air control system, etc. The ECM accepts
input signals from sensors and instantly drives actuators. It is essen-
tial that both input and output signals are proper and stable. At the
same time, it is important that there are no problems such as vac-
uum leaks, fouled spark plugs, or other problems with the engine.
It is much more difficult to diagnose a problem that occurs intermit-
tently rather than continuously. Most intermittent problems are
caused by poor electric connections or improper wiring. In this case,
careful checking of suspected circuits may help prevent the replace-
ment of good parts.
A visual check only may not find the cause of the problems. A road
test with CONSULT-II or a circuit tester connected should be per-
formed. Follow the Work Flow on EC-1452 .
Before undertaking actual checks, take a few minutes to talk with a
customer who approaches with a driveability complaint. The cus-
tomer can supply good information about such problems, especially
intermittent ones. Find out what symptoms are present and under
what conditions they occur. A Diagnostic Worksheet like the exam-
ple on EC-1455 should be used.
Start your diagnosis by looking for conventional problems first. This
will help troubleshoot driveability problems on an electronically con-
trolled engine vehicle.
MEF036D
SEF233G
SEF234G
EC-1452
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
WORK FLOW
Flow Chart
*1 If time data of SELF-DIAG
RESULTS is other than 0 or [1t],
perform EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAG-
NOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCI-
DENT" .
*2 If the incident cannot be verified, per-
form EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNO-
SISFOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT"
.
*3 If the on board diagnostic system can-
not be performed, check main power
supply and ground circuit. Refer to
EC-1499, "POWER SUPPLY CIR-
CUIT FOR ECM" .
*4 If malfunctioning part cannot be
detected, perform EC-1498, "TROU-
BLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMIT-
TENT INCIDENT" .
*5 EC-1494
MBIB0178E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1453
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Description for Work Flow
STEP DESCRIPTION
STEP I
Get detailed information about the conditions and the environment when the incident/symptom occurred using the
DIAGNOSTIC WORK SHEET, EC-1454 .
STEP II
Before confirming the concern, check and write down (print out using CONSULT-II) the (1st trip) DTC and the (1st
trip) freeze frame data, then erase the DTC and the data. (Refer to EC-1446 .) The (1st trip) DTC and the (1st trip)
freeze frame data can be used when duplicating the incident at STEP III & IV.
If the incident cannot be verified, perform EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
Study the relationship between the cause, specified by (1st trip) DTC, and the symptom described by the customer.
(The Symptom Matrix Chart will be useful. See EC-1462 .)
Also check related service bulletins for information.
STEP III
Try to confirm the symptom and under what conditions the incident occurs.
The DIAGNOSTIC WORK SHEET and the freeze frame data are useful to verify the incident. Connect CONSULT-II
to the vehicle in DATA MONITOR (AUTO TRIG) mode and check real time diagnosis results.
If the incident cannot be verified, perform EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
If the malfunction code is detected, skip STEP IV and perform STEP V.
STEP IV
Try to detect the (1st trip) DTC by driving in (or performing) the DTC Confirmation Procedure. Check and read the
(1st trip) DTC and (1st trip) freeze frame data by using CONSULT-II.
During the (1st trip) DTC verification, be sure to connect CONSULT-II to the vehicle in DATA MONITOR (AUTO TRIG)
mode and check real time diagnosis results.
If the incident cannot be verified, perform EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
In case the DTC Confirmation Procedure is not available, perform the Overall Function Check instead. The (1st
trip) DTC cannot be displayed by this check, however, this simplified check is an effective alternative.
The NG result of the Overall Function Check is the same as the (1st trip) DTC detection.
STEP V
Take the appropriate action based on the results of STEP I through IV.
If the malfunction code is indicated, proceed to TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR DTC PXXXX.
If the normal code is indicated, proceed to the BASIC INSPECTION. (Refer to EC-1457 .) If COSULT-II is available,
perform "DATA MONITOR (SPEC)" mode with CONSULT-II and proceed to the "TOROUBLE DIAGNOSIS SPECI-
FICATION VALUE". (Refer to EC-1494 .) (If malfunction is detected, proceed to "PERAIR/REPLACE".) Then perform
inspections according to the Symptom Matrix Chart. (Refer to EC-1462 .)
STEP VI
Identify where to begin diagnosis based on the relationship study between symptom and possible causes. Inspect the
system for mechanical binding, loose connectors or wiring damage using (tracing) Harness Layouts.
Gently shake the related connectors, components or wiring harness with CONSULT-II set in DATA MONITOR
(AUTO TRIG) mode.
Check the voltage of the related ECM terminals or monitor the output data from the related sensors with CONSULT-II.
Refer to EC-1472 , EC-1489 .
The Diagnostic Procedure in EC section contains a description based on open circuit inspection. A short circuit
inspection is also required for the circuit check in the Diagnostic Procedure. For details, refer to Circuit Inspection in
GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident" .
Repair or replace the malfunction parts.
If malfunctioning part cannot be detected, perform EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCI-
DENT" .
STEP VII
Once you have repaired the circuit or replaced a component, you need to run the engine in the same conditions and
circumstances which resulted in the customer's initial complaint.
Perform the DTC Confirmation Procedure and confirm the normal code [DTC No. P0000] is detected. If the incident
is still detected in the final check, perform STEP VI by using a method different from the previous one.
Before returning the vehicle to the customer, be sure to erase the unnecessary (already fixed) (1st trip) DTC in ECM.
(Refer to EC-1446, "HOW TO ERASE EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMATION" .)
EC-1454
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
DIAGNOSTIC WORKSHEET
Description
There are many operating conditions that lead to the malfunction of
engine components. A good grasp of such conditions can make trou-
bleshooting faster and more accurate.
In general, each customer feels differently about a problem. It is
important to fully understand the symptoms or conditions for a cus-
tomer complaint.
Utilize a diagnostic worksheet like the one on the next page in order
to organize all the information for troubleshooting.
Some conditions may cause the MIL to come on steady or blink and
DTC to be detected. Examples:
G Vehicle ran out of fuel, which caused the engine to misfire.
G Fuel filler cap was left off or incorrectly screwed on, allowing fuel
to evaporate into the atmosphere.
SEF907L
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1455
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Worksheet Sample
DTC Inspection Priority Chart EBS00GY6
If some DTCs are displayed at the same time, perform inspections one by one based on the following priority
chart.
NOTE:
If DTC U1000 and/or U1001 is displayed with other DTC, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC
U1000 and U1001. Refer to EC-1505 .
MTBL0017
EC-1456
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Fail-safe Chart EBS00GY7
When the DTC listed bellow is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
Priority Detected items (DTC)
1 G U1000 U1001 CAN communication line
G P0102 P0103 Mass air flow sensor
G P0117 P0118 Engine coolant temperature sensor
G P0221 P0222 P0223 P1223 P1224 P1225 P1226 Throttle position sensor
G P0226 P0227 P0228 P1227 P1228 Accelerator pedal position sensor
G P0327 P0328 Knock sensor
G P0335 Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
G P0340 Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
G P0500 Vehicle speed sensor
G P0605 ECM
G P1229 Sensor power supply
G P1610-P1615 NATS
2 G P0134 Heated oxygen sensor 1
G P0550 Power steering pressure sensor
G P1065 ECM power supply
G P1122 Electric throttle control function
G P1124 P1126 Throttle control moter relay
G P1128 Throttle control moter
G P1805 Brake switch
3 G P1121 Electric throttle control actuator
G P1217 Engine over temperature (OVERHEAT)
DTC No. Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
P0102
P0103
Mass air flow sensor circuit Engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm due to the fuel cut.
P0117
P0118
Engine coolant tempera-
ture sensor circuit
Engine coolant temperature will be determined by ECM based on the time after turning
ignition switch ON or START.
CONSULT-II displays the engine coolant temperature decided by ECM.
Condition
Engine coolant temperature decided (CONSULT-
II display)
Just as ignition switch is turned
ON or Start
40C (104F)
More than approx. 4 minutes after
ignition ON or Start
80C (176F)
Except as shown above
40 - 80C (104 - 176F)
(Depends on the time)
When the fail-safe system for engine coolant temperature sensor is activated, the cool-
ing fan operates while engine is running.
P0221
P0222
P0223
P1223
P1224
Throttle position sensor The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening
in order for the idle position to be within +10 degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the nor-
mal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
P0226
P0227
P0228
P1227
P1228
Accelerator pedal position
sensor
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening
in order for the idle position to be within +10 degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the nor-
mal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1457
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Basic Inspection EBS00GY8
1. INSPECTION START
1. Check service records for any recent repairs that may indicate a related problem, or a current need for
scheduled maintenance.
2. Open engine hood and check the following:
Harness connectors for improper connections
Wiring harness for improper connections, pinches and cut
Vacuum hoses for splits, kinks and improper connections
Hoses and ducts for leaks
Air cleaner clogging
Gasket
3. Confirm that electrical or mechanical loads are not applied.
Headlamp switch is OFF.
Air conditioner switch is OFF.
Rear window defogger switch is OFF.
Steering wheel is in the straight-ahead position, etc.
4. Start engine and warm it up until engine coolant temperature
indicator points the middle of gauge.
Ensure engine stays below 1,000 rpm.
5. Run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no-
load.
6. Make sure that no DTC is displayed with CONSULT-II.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
P1121 Electric throttle control actu-
ator
(ECM detect the throttle
valve is stuck open.)
While the vehicle is driving, it slows down gradually by fuel cut. After the vehicle stops,
the engine stalls.
The engine can restart in N or P position, and engine speed will not exceed 1,000
rpm or more.
P1122 Electric throttle control func-
tion
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.
P1124
P1126
Throttle control motor relay ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.
P1128 Throttle control motor ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.
P1229 Sensor power supply ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a
fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return spring.
DTC No. Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
SEF983U
SEF976U
SEF977U
EC-1458
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
2. REPAIR OR REPLACE
Repair or replace components as necessary according to corresponding Diagnostic Procedure.
>> GO TO 3
3. CHECK TARGET IDLE SPEED
With CONSULT-II
1. Run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no-load.
2. Rev engine (2,000 to 3,000 rpm) two or three times under no-
load, then run engine at idle speed for about 1 minute.
3. Read idle speed in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Run engine at about 2,000 rpm for about 2 minutes under no-load.
2. Rev engine (2,000 to 3,000 rpm) two or three times under no-load, then run engine at idle speed for about
1 minute.
3. Check idle speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. PERFORM ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION LEARNING
1. Stop engine.
2. Perform EC-1440, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
>> GO TO 5.
SEF978U
M/T: 600 50 rpm
CVT: 650 50 rpm (in "P" or "N" position)
SEF058Y
M/T: 600 50 rpm
CVT: 650 50 rpm (in "P" or "N" position)
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1459
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. PERFORM THROTTLE VALVE CLOSED POSITION LEARNING
Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
>> GO TO 6.
6. PERFORM IDLE AIR VOLUME LEARNING
Refer to EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
CMPLT or INCMP
CMPLT>> GO TO 7.
INCMP >> 1. Follow the construction of Idle Air Volume Learning.
2. GO TO 4.
7. CHECK TARGET IDLE SPEED AGAIN
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Read idle speed in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Check idle speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 8.
8. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the Following.
G Check camshaft position sensor (PHASE) and circuit. Refer to EC-1562 .
G Check crankshaft position sensor (POS) and circuit. Refer to EC-1555 .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> 1. Repair or replace.
2. GO TO 4.
9. CHECK ECM FUNCTION
1. Substitute another known-good ECM to check ECM function. (ECM may be the cause of a problem, but
this is the rarely the case.)
2. Perform initialization of NATS system and registration of NATS ignition key IDs. Refer to EC-1447, "NATS
(Nissan Anti-theft System)" .
>> GO TO 4.
Which is the result CMPLT or INCMP ?
M/T: 600 50 rpm
CVT: 650 50 rpm (in "P" or "N" position)
M/T: 600 50 rpm
CVT: 650 50 rpm (in "P" or "N" position)
EC-1460
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
10. CHECK IGNITION TIMING
1. Run engine at idle.
2. Check ignition timing with a timing light.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 11.
11. PERFORM ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION LEARNING
1. Stop engine.
2. Perform EC-1440, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
>> GO TO 12.
12. PERFORM THROTTLE VALVE CLOSED POSITION LEARNING
Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
>> GO TO 13.
13. PERFORM IDLE AIR VOLUME LEARNING
Refer to EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
CMPLT or INCMP
CMPLT>> GO TO 14.
INCMP >> 1. Follow the construction of Idle Air Volume Learning.
2. GO TO 4.
14. CHECK TARGET IDLE SPEED AGAIN
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Read idle speed in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Check idle speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 15.
NG >> GO TO 17.
M/T: 14 5 BTDC
CVT: 15 5 BTDC (in "P" or "N" position)
Which is the result CMPLT or INCMP ?
M/T: 600 50 rpm
CVT: 650 50 rpm (in "P" or "N" position)
M/T: 600 50 rpm
CVT: 650 50 rpm (in "P" or "N" position)
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1461
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
15. CHECK IGNITION TIMING AGAIN
1. Run engine at idle.
2. Check ignition timing with a timing light.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 16.
16. CHECK TIMING CHAIN INSTALLATION
Check timing chain installation. Refer to EM-143, "TIMING CHAIN" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> 1. Repair the timing chain installation.
2. GO TO 4.
17. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Check camshaft position sensor (PHASE) and circuit. Refer to EC-1562 .
G Check crankshaft position sensor (POS) and circuit. Refer to EC-1555 .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 18.
NG >> 1. Repair or replace.
2. GO TO 4.
18. CHECK ECM FUNCTION
1. Substitute another known-good ECM to check ECM function. (ECM may be the cause of a problem, but
this is the rarely the case.)
2. Perform initialization of NATS system and registration of NATS ignition key IDs. Refer to EC-1447, "NATS
(Nissan Anti-theft System)" .
>> GO TO 4.
M/T: 14 5 BTDC
CVT: 15 5 BTDC (in "P" or "N" position)
EC-1462
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Symptom Matrix Chart EBS00GY9
SYSTEM BASIC ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
SYMPTOM
Reference
page
H
A
R
D
/
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
/
R
E
S
T
A
R
T
(
E
X
C
P
.
H
A
)
E
N
G
I
N
E
S
T
A
L
L
H
E
S
I
T
A
T
I
O
N
/
S
U
R
G
I
N
G
/
F
L
A
T
S
P
O
T
S
P
A
R
K
K
N
O
C
K
/
D
E
T
O
N
A
T
I
O
N
L
A
C
K
O
F
P
O
W
E
R
/
P
O
O
R
A
C
C
E
L
E
R
A
T
I
O
N
H
I
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
L
O
W
I
D
L
E
R
O
U
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
H
U
N
T
I
N
G
I
D
L
I
N
G
V
I
B
R
A
T
I
O
N
S
L
O
W
/
N
O
R
E
T
U
R
N
T
O
I
D
L
E
O
V
E
R
H
E
A
T
S
/
W
A
T
E
R
T
E
M
P
E
R
A
T
U
R
E
H
I
G
H
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
F
U
E
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
O
I
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
B
A
T
T
E
R
Y
D
E
A
D
(
U
N
D
E
R
C
H
A
R
G
E
)
Warranty symptom code AA AB AC AD AE AF AG AH AJ AK AL AM HA
Fuel Fuel pump circuit 1 1 2 3 2 2 2 3 2 EC-1705
Fuel pressure regulator system 3 3 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 EC-1443
Injector circuit 1 1 2 3 2 2 2 2 EC-1699
Evaporative emission system 3 3 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 EC-1723
Air Positive crankcase ventilation sys-
tem
3 3 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 1 EC-1726
Incorrect idle speed adjustment 3 3 1 1 1 1 1 EC-1457
Electric throttle control actuator 1 1 2 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 2
EC-1583,
EC-1585 ,
EC-1592 ,
EC-1598
Ignition Incorrect ignition timing adjustment 3 3 1 1 1 1 1 1 EC-1457
Ignition circuit 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 EC-1672
Main power supply and ground circuit 2 2 3 3 3 3 3 2 3 EC-1499
Mass air flow sensor circuit 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 EC-1508
Engine coolant temperature sensor circuit 1 1 2 2 2 3 2 2 3 1 2 EC-1514
Throttle position sensor circuit 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
EC-1525,
EC-1531 ,
EC-1620 ,
EC-1626 ,
EC-1628 ,
EC-1637
Accelerator pedal position sensor circuit 3 2 1 2 2
EC-1537,
EC-1544 ,
EC-1630
Heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit 1 2 3 2 2 2 2
EC-1519,
EC-1660
Knock sensor circuit 2 2 3 EC-1551
Crankshaft position sensor (POS) circuit 2 2 EC-1555
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE) circuit 2 2 EC-1562
Vehicle speed signal circuit 2 3 3 3 EC-1569
Power steering pressure sensor circuit 2 3 3 3 3 EC-1571
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1463
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
1 - 6: The numbers refer to the order of inspection.
(continued on next page)
SYSTEM ENGINE MECHANICAL & OTHER
ECM 2 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3
EC-1576,
EC-1579
Intake valve timing control solenoid valve cir-
cuit
3 3 2 1 3 2 2 3 3 EC-1689
PNP switch circuit 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 EC-1695
Refrigerant pressure sensor circuit 2 3 3 3 3 4 EC-1711
Electrical load signal circuit 3 3 3 3 EC-1716
Air conditioner circuit 2 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 ATC-30
SYMPTOM
Reference
page
H
A
R
D
/
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
/
R
E
S
T
A
R
T
(
E
X
C
P
.
H
A
)
E
N
G
I
N
E
S
T
A
L
L
H
E
S
I
T
A
T
I
O
N
/
S
U
R
G
I
N
G
/
F
L
A
T
S
P
O
T
S
P
A
R
K
K
N
O
C
K
/
D
E
T
O
N
A
T
I
O
N
L
A
C
K
O
F
P
O
W
E
R
/
P
O
O
R
A
C
C
E
L
E
R
A
T
I
O
N
H
I
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
L
O
W
I
D
L
E
R
O
U
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
H
U
N
T
I
N
G
I
D
L
I
N
G
V
I
B
R
A
T
I
O
N
S
L
O
W
/
N
O
R
E
T
U
R
N
T
O
I
D
L
E
O
V
E
R
H
E
A
T
S
/
W
A
T
E
R
T
E
M
P
E
R
A
T
U
R
E
H
I
G
H
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
F
U
E
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
O
I
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
B
A
T
T
E
R
Y
D
E
A
D
(
U
N
D
E
R
C
H
A
R
G
E
)
Warranty symptom code AA AB AC AD AE AF AG AH AJ AK AL AM HA
SYMPTOM
Reference
page
H
A
R
D
/
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
/
R
E
S
T
A
R
T
(
E
X
C
P
.
H
A
)
E
N
G
I
N
E
S
T
A
L
L
H
E
S
I
T
A
T
I
O
N
/
S
U
R
G
I
N
G
/
F
L
A
T
S
P
O
T
S
P
A
R
K
K
N
O
C
K
/
D
E
T
O
N
A
T
I
O
N
L
A
C
K
O
F
P
O
W
E
R
/
P
O
O
R
A
C
C
E
L
E
R
A
T
I
O
N
H
I
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
L
O
W
I
D
L
E
R
O
U
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
H
U
N
T
I
N
G
I
D
L
I
N
G
V
I
B
R
A
T
I
O
N
S
L
O
W
/
N
O
R
E
T
U
R
N
T
O
I
D
L
E
O
V
E
R
H
E
A
T
S
/
W
A
T
E
R
T
E
M
P
E
R
A
T
U
R
E
H
I
G
H
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
F
U
E
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
O
I
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
B
A
T
T
E
R
Y
D
E
A
D
(
U
N
D
E
R
C
H
A
R
G
E
)
Warranty symptom code AA AB AC AD AE AF AG AH AJ AK AL AM HA
Fuel Fuel tank
5
5
FL-13
Fuel piping 5 5 5 5 5 5
MA-23,
EM-128
Vapor lock
Valve deposit
5 5 5 5 5 5 5

Poor fuel (Heavy weight gaso-


line, Low octane)

EC-1464
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Air Air duct
5 5 5 5 5 5
EM-114
Air cleaner EM-114
Air leakage from air duct
(Mass air flow sensor electric
throttle control actuator)
5 5 5 5
EM-114
Electric throttle control actuator EM-116
Air leakage from intake manifold/
Collector/Gasket
EM-116
Cranking Battery
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
SC-3
Alternator circuit SC-12
Starter circuit 3 SC-22
Signal plate/Flywheel/Drive plate 6 EM-165
PNP switch
4
MT-126 or
CVT-67
Engine Cylinder head
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 EM-152
Cylinder head gasket 4 3
Cylinder block
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6
4
EM-165
Piston
Piston ring
Connecting rod
Bearing
Crankshaft
Valve
mecha-
nism
Timing chain
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
EM-143
Camshaft EM-133
Intake valve timing control EM-143
Intake valve
3 EM-152
Exhaust valve
Exhaust Exhaust manifold/Tube/Muffler/
Gasket
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
EM-121,
EX-3
Three way catalyst
SYMPTOM
Reference
page
H
A
R
D
/
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
/
R
E
S
T
A
R
T
(
E
X
C
P
.
H
A
)
E
N
G
I
N
E
S
T
A
L
L
H
E
S
I
T
A
T
I
O
N
/
S
U
R
G
I
N
G
/
F
L
A
T
S
P
O
T
S
P
A
R
K
K
N
O
C
K
/
D
E
T
O
N
A
T
I
O
N
L
A
C
K
O
F
P
O
W
E
R
/
P
O
O
R
A
C
C
E
L
E
R
A
T
I
O
N
H
I
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
L
O
W
I
D
L
E
R
O
U
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
H
U
N
T
I
N
G
I
D
L
I
N
G
V
I
B
R
A
T
I
O
N
S
L
O
W
/
N
O
R
E
T
U
R
N
T
O
I
D
L
E
O
V
E
R
H
E
A
T
S
/
W
A
T
E
R
T
E
M
P
E
R
A
T
U
R
E
H
I
G
H
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
F
U
E
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
O
I
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
B
A
T
T
E
R
Y
D
E
A
D
(
U
N
D
E
R
C
H
A
R
G
E
)
Warranty symptom code AA AB AC AD AE AF AG AH AJ AK AL AM HA
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1465
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
1 - 6: The numbers refer to the order of inspection.
Lubrica-
tion
Oil pan/Oil strainer/Oil pump/Oil
filter/Oil gallery
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 2
EM-123,
LU-18 , LU-
19 , LU-14
Oil level (Low)/Filthy oil LU-16
Cooling Radiator/Hose/Radiator filler cap
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 2 5
CO-31
Thermostat 5 CO-40
Water pump CO-38
Water gallery CO-27
Cooling fan 5 CO-31
Coolant level (low)/Contaminated
coolant
CO-29
NATS (Nissan Anti-theft System) 1 1
EC-1448or
BL-156
SYMPTOM
Reference
page
H
A
R
D
/
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
/
R
E
S
T
A
R
T
(
E
X
C
P
.
H
A
)
E
N
G
I
N
E
S
T
A
L
L
H
E
S
I
T
A
T
I
O
N
/
S
U
R
G
I
N
G
/
F
L
A
T
S
P
O
T
S
P
A
R
K
K
N
O
C
K
/
D
E
T
O
N
A
T
I
O
N
L
A
C
K
O
F
P
O
W
E
R
/
P
O
O
R
A
C
C
E
L
E
R
A
T
I
O
N
H
I
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
L
O
W
I
D
L
E
R
O
U
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
H
U
N
T
I
N
G
I
D
L
I
N
G
V
I
B
R
A
T
I
O
N
S
L
O
W
/
N
O
R
E
T
U
R
N
T
O
I
D
L
E
O
V
E
R
H
E
A
T
S
/
W
A
T
E
R
T
E
M
P
E
R
A
T
U
R
E
H
I
G
H
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
F
U
E
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
O
I
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
B
A
T
T
E
R
Y
D
E
A
D
(
U
N
D
E
R
C
H
A
R
G
E
)
Warranty symptom code AA AB AC AD AE AF AG AH AJ AK AL AM HA
EC-1466
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Engine Control Component Parts Location EBS00GYA
MBIB0070E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1467
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
MBIB0147E
EC-1468
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
MBIB0148E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1469
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
MBIB0149E
EC-1470
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Circuit Diagram EBS00GYB
MBWA0156E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1471
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
MBWA0157E
EC-1472
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
ECM Harness Connector Terminal Layout EBS00GYC
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00GYD
PREPARATION
1. ECM is located behind the glove box. For this inspection,
remove glove box.
2. Remove ECM harness protector.
3. When disconnecting ECM harness connector, loosen it with
levers as far as they will go as shown at right.
4. Connect a break-out box (SST) and Y-cable adapter (SST)
between the ECM and ECM harness connector.
G Use extreme care not to touch 2 pins at one time.
G Data is for comparison and may not be exact.
ECM INSPECTION TABLE
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
MBIB0045E
MBIB0155E
MBIB0145E
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
1 B ECM ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Engine ground
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1473
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2 R/W
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is below 3,800 rpm.
G After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of 70
km/h (43 MPH) or more
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,800 rpm
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
3 R
Throttle control motor
relay power supply
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
4 BR
Throttle control motor
(Close)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is releasing
0 - 14V
5 Y
Throttle control motor
(Open)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is depressing
0 - 14V
12 Y
Power steering pres-
sure sensor
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is being turned
0.5 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is not being turned
0.4 - 0.8V
13 L
Crankshaft position
sensor (POS)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 3.0V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
Approximately 3.0V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0534E
PBIB0533E
PBIB0527E
PBIB0528E
EC-1474
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
14 L
Camshaft position sen-
sor (PHASE)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.0 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
1.0 - 4.0V
15 W Knock sensor
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 2.5V
16 W/Y Heated oxygen sensor 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
19 P
EVAP canister purge
volume control solenoid
valve
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is about 2,000 rpm (More than
100 seconds after starting engine)
Approximately 10V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0525E
PBIB0526E
PBIB0050E
PBIB0520E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1475
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
22
23
41
42
G/B
SB
L
R/W
Injector No. 3
Injector No. 1
Injector No. 4
Injector No. 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
24 P/L
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm.
Approximately 7.0V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
34 G
Intake air temperature
sensor
[Engine is running]
Approximately 0 - 4.8V
Output voltage varies with
intake air temperature.
35 PU Heated oxygen sensor 1
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
45 R Sensor's power supply [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
46 R
Sensor's power supply
(Refrigerant pressure
sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
47 G Sensor's power supply [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
49 W
Throttle position
sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
More than 0.36V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
Less than 4.75V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0529E
PBIB0530E
PBIB0519E
EC-1476
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
50 B Mass air flow sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.1 - 1.5V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,500 rpm.
1.6 - 2.0V
54 W
Sensors' ground
(Mass air flow sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
55 B Sensors' ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
60
61
79
80
L/Y
Y/R
GY/L
PU/G
Ignition signal No. 3
Ignition signal No. 1
Ignition signal No. 4
Ignition signal No. 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0 - 0.1V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - 0.2V
62 Y
Intake valve timing
control solenoid valve
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G When revving engine up to 2,000 rpm
quickly
Approximately 4V - BATTERY
VOLTAGE (11 - 14V)
65 R
Sensor's power supply
(Power steering pres-
sure sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
66 B Sensors' ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0521E
PBIB0522E
MBIB0052E
PBIB0532E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1477
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
68 R
Throttle position
sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
Less than 4.75V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 0.36V
69 L
Refrigerant pressure
sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Both A/C switch and blower switch are ON
(Compressor operates.)
1.0 - 4.0V
72 L/OR
Engine coolant tempera-
ture sensor
[Engine is running]
Approximately 0 - 4.8V
Output voltage varies with
engine coolant temperature.
74 B Sensors' ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
84 R/Y
Electrical load signal
(Headlamp signal)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Lighting switch is 2ND position
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Lighting switch is OFF
Approximately 0V
85 LG DATA link connector
[Ignition switch ON]
G CONSULT-II or GST is disconnected.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
86 R CAN communication line [Ignition switch ON] 1.0 - 2.5V
92* GY
Accelerator pedal posi-
tion sensor signal output
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
Approximately 0.5V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
Approximately 4.2V
94 L CAN communication line [Ignition switch ON] 2.5 - 4.0V
98 LG
Accelerator pedal
position sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.175 - 0.335V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 1.95V
101 R/G Stop lamp switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Brake pedal fully released
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Brake pedal fully depressed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
EC-1478
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
102
P (CVT)
L (M/T)
PNP switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Gear position is P or N
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Except the above gear position
CVT models
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
M/T models
Approximately 5V
103* L/OR
Tachometer signal
output
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
10 - 11V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
10 - 11V
104 OR
Throttle control motor
relay
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch ON] 0 - 1.0V
106 L
Accelerator pedal posi-
tion sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.35 - 0.67V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.9V
109 B/R Ignition switch
[Ignition switch OFF] 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
111 W/G
ECM relay
(Self shut-off)
[Engine is running]
[Ignition switch OFF]
G For 5 seconds after turning ignition switch
OFF
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch OFF]
G 5 seconds passed after turning ignition
switch OFF
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
113 B/P Fuel pump relay
[Ignition switch ON]
G For 1 seconds after turning ignition switch
ON
[Engine is running]
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G More than 1 seconds after turning ignition
switch ON.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
MBIB0053E
MBIB0054E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1479
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
*: CVT models
CONSULT-II Function EBS00GYE
FUNCTION
*: The following emission-related diagnostic information is cleared when the ECM memory is erased.
G Diagnostic trouble codes
G 1st trip diagnostic trouble codes
G Freeze frame data
G 1st trip freeze frame data
G Others
115
116
B
B
ECM ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Engine ground
119
120
W/R
W/R
Power supply for ECM [Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
121 W/L
Power supply for ECM
(Buck-up)
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
Diagnostic test mode Function
Work support
This mode enables a technician to adjust some devices faster and more accurately by following the
indications on the CONSULT-II unit.
Self-diagnostic results
Self-diagnostic results such as 1st trip DTC, DTCs and 1st trip freeze frame data or freeze frame data
can be read and erased quickly.*
Data monitor Input/Output data in the ECM can be read.
Data monitor (SPEC)
Input/Output of the specification for Basic fuel schedule, AFM, A/F feedback control value and the
other data monitor items can be read.
Active test
Diagnostic Test Mode in which CONSULT-II drives some actuators apart from the ECMs and also
shifts some parameters in a specified range.
Function test This mode is used to inform customers when their vehicle condition requires periodic maintenance.
ECM part number ECM part number can be read.
EC-1480
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
ENGINE CONTROL COMPONENT PARTS/CONTROL SYSTEMS APPLICATION
X: Applicable
*1: This item includes 1st trip DTCs.
*2: This mode includes 1st trip freeze frame data or freeze frame data. The items appear on CONSULT-II screen in freeze frame data
mode only if a 1st trip DTC or DTC is detected. For details, refer to EC-1446 .
CONSULT-II INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
Item
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE
WORK
SUPPORT
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC
RESULTS
DATA
MONI-
TOR
DATA
MONI-
TOR
(SPEC)
ACTIVE
TEST
DTC*1
FREEZE
FRAME
DATA*2
E
N
G
I
N
E
C
O
N
T
R
O
L
C
O
M
P
O
N
E
N
T
P
A
R
T
S
I
N
P
U
T
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Mass air flow sensor
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Heated oxygen sensor 1
Heated oxygen sensor 2
Vehicle speed signal
Accelerator pedal position sensor
Throttle position sensor
Intake air temperature sensor
Knock sensor
Refrigerant pressure sensor
Closed throttle position switch (accelerator
pedal position sensor signal)

Air conditioner switch
Park/neutral position (PNP) switch
Stop lamp switch
Power steering pressure sensor
Battery voltage
Electrical load signal
E
N
G
I
N
E
C
O
N
T
R
O
L
C
O
M
P
O
N
E
N
T
P
A
R
T
S
O
U
T
P
U
T
Injectors
Power transistor (Ignition timing)
Throttle control motor relay
Throttle control motor
EVAP canister purge volume control sole-
noid valve

Air conditioner relay
Fuel pump relay
Cooling fan relay
Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
Intake valve timing control solenoid valve
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1481
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Connect CONSULT-II to data link connector, which is located
under drivers side dash panel.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Touch START.
5. Touch ENGINE.
6. Perform each diagnostic test mode according to each service
procedure.
For further information, see the CONSULT-II Operation Manual.
WORK SUPPORT MODE
Work Item
MBIB0156E
PBR455D
SEF995X
SEF838Z
WORK ITEM CONDITION USAGE
FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE G FUEL PUMP WILL STOP BY TOUCHING START DUR-
ING IDLING.
CRANK A FEW TIMES AFTER ENGINE STALLS.
When releasing fuel pressure
from fuel line
IDLE AIR VOL LEARN G THE IDLE AIR VOLUME THAT KEEPS THE ENGINE
WITHIN THE SPECIFIED RANGE IS MEMORIZED IN
ECM.
When learning the idle air volume
EC-1482
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
*: This function is not necessary in the usual service procedure.
SELF-DIAG RESULTS MODE
Self Diagnostic Item
Regarding items of DTC and 1st trip DTC, refer to EC-1415, "INDEX FOR DTC" .)
Freeze Frame Data and 1st Trip Freeze Frame Data
*: The items are the same as those of 1st trip freeze frame data.
SELF-LEARNING CONT G THE COEFFICIENT OF SELF-LEARNING CONTROL
MIXTURE RATIO RETURNS TO THE ORIGINAL COEF-
FICIENT.
When clearing the coefficient of
self-learning control value
TARGET IDLE RPM ADJ* G IDLE CONDITION When setting target idle speed
TARGET IGN TIM ADJ* G IDLE CONDITION When adjusting target ignition tim-
ing
After adjustment, confirm target
ignition timing with a timing light.
WORK ITEM CONDITION USAGE
Freeze frame data
item*
Description
DIAG TROUBLE
CODE
[PXXXX]
G The engine control component part/control system has a trouble code, it is displayed as PXXXX. (Refer
to EC-1415, "INDEX FOR DTC" .)
FUEL SYS-B1
G Fuel injection system status at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
G One mode in the following is displayed.
MODE 2: Open loop due to detected system malfunction
MODE 3: Open loop due to driving conditions (power enrichment, deceleration enrichment)
MODE 4: Closed loop - using oxygen sensor(s) as feedback for fuel control
MODE 5: Open loop - has not yet satisfied condition to go to closed loop
COOLANT TEMP [C]
or [F]
G The engine coolant temperature at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
L-FUEL TRIM-B1 [%]
G Long-term fuel trim at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
G The long-term fuel trim indicates much more gradual feedback compensation to the base fuel schedule
than short-term fuel trim.
S-FUEL TRIM-B1 [%]
G Short-term fuel trim at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
G The short-term fuel trim indicates dynamic or instantaneous feedback compensation to the base fuel
schedule.
ENGINE SPEED
[rpm]
G The engine speed at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
VHCL SPEED [km/h]
or [mph]
G The vehicle speed at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
B/FUEL SCHDL
[msec]
G The base fuel schedule at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
INT/A TEMP SE [C]
or [F]
G The intake air temperature at the moment a malfunction is detected is displayed.
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1483
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DATA MONITOR MODE
Monitored Item
: Applicable
Monitored item
[Unit]
ECM
INPUT
SIG-
NALS
MAIN
SIG-
NALS
CAN
DIAG
SUP-
PORT
MNTR
Description Remarks
ENG SPEED [rpm]
G Indicates the engine speed computed
from the signals of the crankshaft posi-
tion sensor (POS) and camshaft posi-
tion sensor (PHASE).
G Accuracy becomes poor if engine
speed drops below the idle rpm.
G If the signal is interrupted while the
engine is running, an abnormal
value may be indicated.
MAS A/F SE-B1 [V]
G The signal voltage of the mass air flow
sensor is displayed.
G When the engine is stopped, a
certain value is indicated.
B/FUEL SCHDL
[msec]

G Base fuel schedule indicates the fuel
injection pulse width programmed into
ECM, prior to any learned on board cor-
rection.
A/F ALPHA-B1 [%]
G The mean value of the air-fuel ratio
feedback correction factor per cycle is
indicated.
G When the engine is stopped, a
certain value is indicated.
G This data also includes the data
for the air-fuel ratio learning con-
trol.
COOLAN TEMP/S
[C] or [F]

G The engine coolant temperature (deter-
mined by the signal voltage of the
engine coolant temperature sensor) is
displayed.
G When the engine coolant tempera-
ture sensor is open or short-cir-
cuited, ECM enters fail-safe mode.
The engine coolant temperature
determined by the ECM is dis-
played.
HO2S1 (B1) [V]
G The signal voltage of the heated oxygen
sensor 1 is displayed.
HO2S2 (B1) [V]
G The signal voltage of the heated oxygen
sensor 2 is displayed.
HO2S1 MNTR(B1)
[RICH/LEAN]

G Display of heated oxygen sensor 1 sig-
nal during air-fuel ratio feedback control:
RICH ... means the mixture became
rich, and control is being affected
toward a leaner mixture.
LEAN ... means the mixture became
lean, and control is being affected
toward a rich mixture.
G After turning ON the ignition
switch, RICH is displayed until
air-fuel mixture ratio feedback
control begins.
G When the air-fuel ratio feedback is
clamped, the value just before the
clamping is displayed continu-
ously.
HO2S2 MNTR(B1)
[RICH/LEAN]

G Display of heated oxygen sensor 2 sig-
nal:
RICH ... means the amount of oxygen
after three way catalyst is relatively
small.
LEAN ... means the amount of oxygen
after three way catalyst is relatively
large.
G When the engine is stopped, a
certain value is indicated.
VHCL SPEED SE
[km/h] or [mph]

G The vehicle speed computed from the
vehicle speed signal is displayed.
BATTERY VOLT
[V]

G The power supply voltage of ECM is dis-
played.
ACCEL SEN 1 [V]
G The accelerator pedal position sensor
signal voltage is displayed.
ACCEL SEN 2 [V]
EC-1484
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
THRTL SEN 1 [V]
G The throttle position sensor signal volt-
age is displayed.
THRTL SEN 2 [V]
INT/A TEMP SE
[C] or [F]

G The intake air temperature (determined
by the signal voltage of the intake air
temperature sensor) is indicated.
START SIGNAL
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates start signal status [ON/OFF]
computed by the ECM according to the
signals of engine speed and battery volt-
age.
G After starting the engine, [OFF] is
displayed regardless of the starter
signal.
CLSD THL POS
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates idle position [ON/OFF] com-
puted by ECM according to the acceler-
ator pedal position sensor signal.
AIR COND SIG
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition of the air
conditioner switch as determined by the
air conditioner signal.
P/N POSI SW
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from the
park/neutral position (PNP) switch sig-
nal.
PW/ST SIGNAL
[ON/OFF]

G [ON/OFF] condition of the power steer-
ing oil pressure switch as determined by
the power steering oil pressure signal is
indicated.
LOAD SIGNAL
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from the
electrical load signal.
ON ... Rear window defogger switch is
ON and/or lighting switch is in 2nd posi-
tion.
OFF ... Both rear window defogger
switch and lighting switch are OFF.
IGNITION SW
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from igni-
tion switch.
HEATER FAN SW
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from the
heater fan switch signal.
BRAKE SW
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from the
stop lamp switch signal.
INJ PULSE-B1
[msec]

G Indicates the actual fuel injection pulse
width compensated by ECM according
to the input signals.
G When the engine is stopped, a
certain computed value is indi-
cated.
IGN TIMING
[BTDC]

G Indicates the ignition timing computed
by ECM according to the input signals.
G When the engine is stopped, a
certain value is indicated.
PURG VOL C/V
[%]
G Indicates the EVAP canister purge vol-
ume control solenoid valve control value
computed by the ECM according to the
input signals.
G The opening becomes larger as the
value increases.
INT/V TIM (B1)
[CA]
G Indicates [CA] of intake camshaft
advanced angle.
Monitored item
[Unit]
ECM
INPUT
SIG-
NALS
MAIN
SIG-
NALS
CAN
DIAG
SUP-
PORT
MNTR
Description Remarks
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1485
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
INT/V SOL (B1) [%]
G The control condition of the intake valve
timing control solenoid valve (deter-
mined by ECM according to the input
signals) is indicated.
ON ... intake valve timing control is oper-
ating.
OFF ... Intake valve timing control is not
operating.
AIR COND RLY
[ON/OFF]

G The air conditioner relay control condi-
tion (determined by ECM according to
the input signals) is indicated.
FUEL PUMP RLY
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates the fuel pump relay control
condition determined by ECM according
to the input signals.
THRTL RELAY
[ON/OFF]

G Indicates the throttle control motor relay
control condition determined by the
ECM according to the input signals.
COOLING FAN
[HI/LOW/OFF]
G Indicates the condition of the cooling fan
(determined by ECM according to the
input signals).
HI ... High speed operation
LOW ... Low speed operation
OFF ... Stop
HO2S1 HTR (B1)
[ON/OFF]
G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition of heated
oxygen sensor 1 heater determined by
ECM according to the input signals.
HO2S2 HTR (B1)
[ON/OFF]
G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition of heated
oxygen sensor 2 heater determined by
ECM according to the input signals.
I/P PULLY SPD
[rpm]

G Indicates the engine speed computed
from the primary speed sensor signal.
VEHICLE SPEED
[km/h] or [mph]

G Indicates the vehicle speed computed
from the secondary speed sensor sig-
nal.
IDL A/V LEARN
[YET/CMPLT/
INCMP]
G Display the condition of idle air volume
learning
YET ... Idle air volume learning has not
been performed yet.
CMPLT ... Idle air volume learning has
already been performed successfully.
INCMP ... Idle air volume learning has
not been performed successfully.
AC PRESS SEN
[V]
G The signal voltage from the refrigerant
pressure sensor is displayed.
Voltage [V]
G Voltage, frequency, duty cycle or pulse
width measured by the probe.
G Only # is displayed if item is
unable to be measured.
G Figures with #s are temporary
ones. They are the same figures
as an actual piece of data which
was just previously measured.
Frequency
[msec], [Hz] or [%]
DUTY-HI
DUTY-LOW
PLS WIDTH-HI
PLS WIDTH-LOW
Monitored item
[Unit]
ECM
INPUT
SIG-
NALS
MAIN
SIG-
NALS
CAN
DIAG
SUP-
PORT
MNTR
Description Remarks
EC-1486
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
NOTE:
G Any monitored item that does not match the vehicle being diagnosed is deleted from the display automatically.
DATA MONITOR (SPEC) MODE
Monitored Item
NOTE:
G Any monitored item that does not match the vehicle being diagnosed is deleted from the display automatically.
CAN COMM
[OK/NG]

G Indicates the communication condition
of CAN communication line.
G These items are not displayed in
"SELECTION FROM MENU"
mode.
CAN CIRC 1
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 2
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 3
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 4
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 5
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 6
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 7
[OK/UNKWN]

Monitored item
[Unit]
ECM
INPUT
SIG-
NALS
MAIN
SIG-
NALS
CAN
DIAG
SUP-
PORT
MNTR
Description Remarks
Monitored item [Unit]
ECM
input
signals
Main
signals
Description Remarks
ENG SPEED [rpm]
G Indicates the engine speed computed
from the signal of the crankshaft position
sensor (POS).
MAS A/F SE-B1 [V]
G The signal voltage of the mass air flow
sensor specification is displayed.
G When engine is running specification
range is indicated.
B/FUEL SCHDL
[msec]
G Base fuel schedule indicates the fuel
injection pulse width programmed into
ECM, prior to any learned on board cor-
rection.
G When engine is running specification
range is indicated.
A/F ALPHA-B1 [%]
G The mean value of the air-fuel ratio feed-
back correction factor per cycle is indi-
cated.
G When engine is running specification
range is indicated.
G This data also includes the data for the
air-fuel ratio learning control.
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1487
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
ACTIVE TEST MODE
Test Item
REAL TIME DIAGNOSIS IN DATA MONITOR MODE (RECORDING VEHICLE DATA)
Description
CONSULT-II has two kinds of triggers and they can be selected by touching SETTING in DATA MONITOR
mode.
1. AUTO TRIG (Automatic trigger):
TEST ITEM CONDITION JUDGEMENT CHECK ITEM (REMEDY)
FUEL INJEC-
TION
G Engine: Return to the original
trouble condition
G Change the amount of fuel injec-
tion using CONSULT-II.
If trouble symptom disappears, see
CHECK ITEM.
G Harness and connectors
G Fuel injectors
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
IGNITION TIM-
ING
G Engine: Return to the original
trouble condition
G Timing light: Set
G Retard the ignition timing using
CONSULT-II.
If trouble symptom disappears, see
CHECK ITEM.
G Perform Idle Air Volume Learn-
ing.
POWER BAL-
ANCE
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine.
G A/C switch OFF
G Shift lever N
G Cut off each injector signal one at
a time using CONSULT-II.
Engine runs rough or dies.
G Harness and connectors
G Compression
G Fuel injectors
G Power transistor
G Spark plugs
G Ignition coils
COOLING FAN
G Ignition switch: ON
G Turn the cooling fan ON and
OFF with CONSULT-II.
Cooling fan moves and stops.
G Harness and connectors
G Cooling fan relay
G Cooling fan motor
ENG COOLANT
TEMP
G Engine: Return to the original
trouble condition
G Change the engine coolant tem-
perature using CONSULT-II.
If trouble symptom disappears, see
CHECK ITEM.
G Harness and connectors
G Engine coolant temperature sen-
sor
G Fuel injectors
FUEL PUMP
RELAY
G Ignition switch: ON (Engine
stopped)
G Turn the fuel pump relay ON
and OFF using CONSULT-II
and listen to operating sound.
Fuel pump relay makes the operat-
ing sound.
G Harness and connectors
G Fuel pump relay
PURG VOL
CONT/V
G Engine: After warming up, run
engine at 1,500 rpm.
G Change the EVAP canister purge
volume control solenoid valve
opening percent using CON-
SULT-II.
Engine speed changes according to
the opening percent.
G Harness and connectors
G Solenoid valve
V/T ASSIGN
ANGLE
G Engine: Return to the original
trouble condition
G Change intake valve timing using
CONSULT-II.
If trouble symptom disappears, see
CHECK ITEM.
G Harness and connectors
G Intake valve timing control sole-
noid valve
EC-1488
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
G The malfunction will be identified on the CONSULT-II screen
in real time.
In other words, DTC/1st trip DTC and malfunction item will be
displayed if the malfunction is detected by ECM.
At the moment a malfunction is detected by ECM, MONI-
TOR in DATA MONITOR screen is changed to Recording
Data ... xx% as shown at right, and the data after the mal-
function detection is recorded. Then when the percentage
reached 100%, REAL-TIME DIAG screen is displayed. If
STOP is touched on the screen during Recording Data ...
xx%, REAL-TIME DIAG screen is also displayed.
The recording time after the malfunction detection and the
recording speed can be changed by TRIGGER POINT and
Recording Speed. Refer to CONSULT-II OPERATION MAN-
UAL.
2. MANU TRIG (Manual trigger):
G DTC/1st trip DTC and malfunction item will not be displayed
automatically on CONSULT-II screen even though a malfunc-
tion is detected by ECM.
DATA MONITOR can be performed continuously even though
a malfunction is detected.
Operation
1. AUTO TRIG
G While trying to detect the DTC/1st trip DTC by performing the DTC Confirmation Procedure, be sure
to select to DATA MONITOR (AUTO TRIG) mode. You can confirm the malfunction at the moment it is
detected.
G While narrowing down the possible causes, CONSULT-II should be set in DATA MONITOR (AUTO
TRIG) mode, especially in case the incident is intermittent.
When you are inspecting the circuit by gently shaking (or twisting) the suspicious connectors, compo-
nents and harness in the DTC Confirmation Procedure, the moment a malfunction is found the DTC/
1st trip DTC will be displayed. (Refer to Incident Simulation Tests in GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient
Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident" .)
2. MANU TRIG
G If the malfunction is displayed as soon as DATA MONITOR is selected, reset CONSULT-II to MANU
TRIG. By selecting MANU TRIG you can monitor and store the data. The data can be utilized for fur-
ther diagnosis, such as a comparison with the value for the normal operating condition.
SEF705Y
SEF707X
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1489
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GYG
Remarks:
G Specification data are reference values.
G Specification data are output/input values which are detected or supplied by the ECM at the connector.
* Specification data may not be directly related to their components signals/values/operations.
i.e. Adjust ignition timing with a timing light before monitoring IGN TIMING, because the monitor may show the specification data in
spite of the ignition timing not being adjusted to the specification data. This IGN TIMING monitors the data calculated by the ECM
according to the signals input from the camshaft position sensor and other ignition timing related sensors.
PBIB0197E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
ENG SPEED
G Tachometer: Connect
G Run engine and compare tachometer indication with the CONSULT-II
value.
Almost the same speed as the
CONSULT-II value.
MAS A/F SE-B1
G Engine: After warming up
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Shift lever: N
G No-load
Idle Approx. 1.1 - 1.5V
2,500 rpm Approx. 1.6 - 2.0V
B/FUEL SCHDL
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 2.5 - 3.5 msec
2,000 rpm 2.5 - 3.5 msec
A/F ALPHA-B1 G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
54% - 155%
COOLAN TEMP/S G Engine: After warming up More than 70C (158F)
HO2S1 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S2 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
EC-1490
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
HO2S1 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times dur-
ing 10 seconds.
HO2S2 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
LEAN RICH
VEH SPEED SE
G Turn drive wheels and compare speedometer indication with the CON-
SULT-II value.
Almost the same speed as the
CONSULT-II value
BATTERY VOLT G Ignition switch: ON (Engine stopped) 11 - 14V
ACCEL SEN1
ACCEL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed More than 3.9V
THRTL SEN1
THRTL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released More than 0.36V
G Shift lever:
D (CVTCVT model)
1st (M/T model)
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
START SIGNAL G Ignition switch: ON START ON OFF ON OFF
CLSD THL POS G Ignition switch: ON
Accelerator pedal: Fully released ON
Accelerator pedal: Slightly depressed OFF
AIR COND SIG
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Air conditioner switch: OFF OFF
Air conditioner switch: ON
(Compressor operates.)
ON
P/N POSI SW G Ignition switch: ON
Shift lever:
P or N (CVT model)
Neutral (M/T model)
ON
Shift lever: Except above OFF
PW/ST SIGNAL
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Steering wheel is in neutral position.
(Forward direction)
OFF
Steering wheel is turned. ON
LOAD SIGNAL G Ignition switch: ON
Rear window defogger switch is ON
and/or lighting switch is in 2nd.
ON
Rear window defogger switch is OFF
and lighting switch is OFF.
OFF
IGNITION SW G Ignition switch: ON OFF ON ON OFF ON
HEATER FAN SW
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Heater fan is operating. ON
Heater fan is not operating OFF
BRAKE SW G Ignition switch: ON
Brake pedal: Fully released OFF
Brake pedal: Slightly depressed ON
INJ PULSE-B1
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 2.0 - 3.0 msec
2,000 rpm 1.9 - 2.9 msec
IGN TIMING
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle
M/T 12 - 16 BTDC
CVT 13 - 17 BTDC
2,000 rpm 25 - 45 BTDC
PURG VOL C/V
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 0%
2,000 rpm 20 - 30%
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1491
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
INT/V TIM (B1)
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 5 - 5CA
When revving up to 2,000 rpm quickly Approx. 0 - 20CA
INT/V SOL (B1)
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 0% - 2%
When revving up to 2,000 rpm quickly Approx. 0% - 50%
AIR COND RLY
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Air conditioner switch: OFF OFF
Air conditioner switch: ON
(Compressor operates)
ON
FUEL PUMP RLY
G For 1 seconds after turning ignition switch ON
G Engine running or cranking
ON
G Except above conditions OFF
THRTL RELAY G Ignition switch: ON ON
COOLING FAN
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
Engine coolant temperature is 94C
(201F) or less
OFF
Engine coolant temperature is
between 95C (203F) and 99C
(210F)
LOW
Engine coolant temperature is 100C
(212F) or more
HIGH
HO2S1 HTR (B1)
G Engine: After warming up
G Engine speed: Below 3,600 rpm
ON
G Engine speed: Above 3,600 rpm OFF
HO2S2 HTR (B1)
G Engine speed: Below 3,800 rpm [After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of
70 km/h (43 MPH) or more]
ON
G Engine speed: Above 3,800 rpm OFF
I/P PULLY SPD G Vehicle speed: More than 20 km/h
Almost the same speed as the
CONSULT-II value
VEHICLE SPEED
G Turn drive wheels and compare speedometer indication with the CON-
SULT-II value.
Almost the same speed as the
CONSULT-II value
O2SEN HTR DTY
G Engine coolant temperature when engine started: More than 80C
(176F)
G Engine speed: below 3,600 rpm
Approx. 50 %
AC PRESS SEN
G Ignition switch: ON (Engine stopped) Approx. 0V
G Engine: Idle
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
1.0 - 4.0V
CAN COMM
G Ignition switch: ON
OK
CAN CIRC 1 OK
CAN CIRC 2 OK or ONKWN
CAN CIRC 3 OK
CAN CIRC 4 OK
CAN CIRC 5 OK or UNKWN
CAN CIRC 6 OK
CAN CIRC 7 UNKWN
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
EC-1492
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Major Sensor Reference Graph in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GYH
The following are the major sensor reference graphs in DATA MONITOR mode.
CLSD THL POS, ACCEL SEN 1, THRTL SEN 1
Below is the data for CLSD THL POS, ACCEL SEN 1 and THRTL SEN 1 when depressing the accelera-
tor pedal with the ignition switch ON and with selector lever in "D" position (CVT models) or with shift lever in
"1st" position (M/T models).
The signal of ACCEL SEN 1 and THRTL SEN 1 should rise gradually without any intermittent drop or rise
after CLSD THL POS is changed from ON to OFF.
ENG SPEED, MAS A/F SE-B1, THRTL SEN 1, HO2S2 (B1), HO2S1 (B1), INJ PULSE-B1
Below is the data for ENG SPEED, MAS A/F SE-B1, THRTL SEN 1, HO2S2 (B1), HO2S1 (B1) and
INJ PULSE-B1 when revving engine quickly up to 4,800 rpm under no load after warming up engine suffi-
ciently.
Each value is for reference, the exact value may vary.
PBIB0198E
SEF241Y
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1493
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
PBIB0668E
EC-1494
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE PFP:00031
Description EBS00GYI
The specification (SP) value indicates the tolerance of the value that is displayed in DATA MONITOR (SPEC)
mode of CONSULT-II during normal operation of the Engine Control System. When the value in DATA MONI-
TOR (SPEC) mode is within the SP value, the Engine Control System is confirmed OK. When the value in
DATA MONITOR (SPEC) mode is NOT within the SP value, the Engine Control System may have one or
more malfunctions.
The SP value is used to detect malfunctions that may affect the Engine Control System, but will not light the
MIL.
The SP value will be displayed for the following three items:
G B/FUEL SCHDL (The fuel injection pulse width programmed into ECM prior to any learned on board cor-
rection)
G A/F ALPHA-B1 (The mean value of air-fuel ratio feedback correction factor per cycle)
G MAS A/F SE-B1 (The signal voltage of the mass air flow sensor)
Testing Condition EBS00GYJ
G Vehicle driven distance: More than 5,000 km (3,017 miles)
G Barometric pressure: 98.3 - 104.3 kPa (0.983 - 1.043 bar, 1.003 - 1.064 kg/cm
2
, 14.25 - 15.12 psi)
G Atmospheric temperature: 20 - 30C (68 - 86F)
G Engine coolant temperature: 75 - 95C (167 - 203F)
G Transmission: Warmed-up*
1
G Electrical load: Not applied*
2
G Engine speed: Idle
*1: For CVT models with CONSULT-II, after the engine is warmed up to normal operating temperature, drive
vehicle until FLUID TEMP SE (CVT fluid temperature sensor signal) indicates more than 60C (140F).
For CVT models without CONSUT-II and M/T models, after the engine is warmed up to normal operating tem-
perature, drive vehicle for 5 minutes.
*2: Rear window defogger switch, air conditioner switch, lighting switch are OFF. Steering wheel is straight
ahead.
Inspection Procedure EBS00GYK
NOTE:
Perform DATA MONITOR (SPEC) mode in maximum scale display.
1. Perform EC-1457, "Basic Inspection" .
2. Confirm that the testing conditions indicated above are met.
3. Select B/FUEL SCHDL, A/F ALPHA-B1 and MAS A/F SE-
B1 in DATA MONITOR (SPEC) mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Make sure that monitor items are within the SP value.
5. If NG, go to EC-1495, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF601Z
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE
EC-1495
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GYL
SEF613ZD
EC-1496
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE
SEF768Z
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS - SPECIFICATION VALUE
EC-1497
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
SEF615ZA
EC-1498
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT PFP:00006
Description EBS00GYM
Intermittent incidents (I/I) may occur. In many cases, the problem resolves itself (the part or circuit function
returns to normal without intervention). It is important to realize that the symptoms described in the customer's
complaint often do not recur on (1st trip) DTC visits. Realize also that the most frequent cause of I/I occur-
rences is poor electrical connections. Because of this, the conditions under which the incident occurred may
not be clear. Therefore, circuit checks made as part of the standard diagnostic procedure may not indicate the
specific problem area.
Common I/I Report Situations
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GYN
1. INSPECTION START
Erase (1st trip) DTCs. Refer to EC-1446, "HOW TO ERASE EMISSION-RELATED DIAGNOSTIC INFORMA-
TION" .
>> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK GROUND TERMINALS
Check ground terminals for corroding or loose connection.
Refer to GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident" , "Incident Simulation Tests",
Ground Inspection.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
3. SEARCH FOR ELECTRICAL INCIDENT
Perform GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident" , "Incident Simulation Tests".
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> Repair or replace.
STEP in Work Flow Situation
II The CONSULT-II is used. The SELF-DIAG RESULTS screen shows time data other than 0 or [1t].
III The symptom described by the customer does not recur.
IV (1st trip) DTC does not appear during the DTC Confirmation Procedure.
VI The Diagnostic Procedure for PXXXX does not indicate the problem area.
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
EC-1499
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM PFP:24110
Wiring Diagram EBS00GYO
MBWA0003E
EC-1500
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GYP
1. INSPECTION START
Start engine.
Is engine running?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 8.
No >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-I
1. Turn ignition switch OFF and then ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 109 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Fuse block (J/B) connector M1
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between ECM and fuse
>> Repair harness or connectors.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
1
115
116
B
B
B
ECM ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Engine ground
109 B/R Ignition switch
[Ignition switch OFF] 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
111 W/G
ECM relay
(Self shut-off)
[Engine is running]
[Ignition switch OFF]
G For 5 seconds after turning ignition switch OFF
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch OFF]
G 5 seconds passed after turning ignition switch
OFF
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
119
120
W/R
W/R
Power supply for
ECM
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0015E
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
EC-1501
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. CHECK ECM GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT-I
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals 1, 115, 116 and engine ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-II
1. Disconnect ECM relay.
2. Check voltage between ECM relay terminals 1 and 6 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
6. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness connectors E70, F13 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E63, F31 (RHD models)
G 10A fuse
G 20A fuse
G Harness for open or short between ECM relay and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0155E
Voltage: Battery voltage
SEF420X
EC-1502
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
7. CHECK OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 111 and ECM relay terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> Go to EC-1672, "IGNITION SIGNAL" .
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-III
1. Stop engine and wait at least 10 seconds.
2. Turn ignition switch ON and then OFF.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminals 119, 120 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG (Battery voltage does not exist.)>>GO TO 9.
NG (Battery voltage exists for more than a few seconds.)>>GO TO 11.
9. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-IV
1. Disconnect ECM relay.
2. Check voltage between ECM relay terminal 3 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> GO TO 10.
Continuity should exist.
Voltage: After turning ignition switch OFF, battery
voltage will exist for a few seconds, then
drop approximately 0V.
MBIB0016E
MBIB0155E
Voltage: Battery voltage
SEF860T
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
EC-1503
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
10. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness for open or short between ECM relay and 10A fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
11. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-V
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals 119, 120 and ECM relay terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
12. CHECK ECM RELAY
Refer to EC-1504, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> Replace ECM relay.
13. CHECK ECM GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT-II
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals 1, 115, 116 and engine ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
14. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
EC-1504
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
Component Inspection EBS00GYQ
ECM RELAY
1. Apply 12V direct current between ECM relay terminals 1 and 2.
2. Check continuity between relay terminals 3 and 5, 6 and 7.
3. If NG, replace ECM relay.
Condition Continuity
12V direct current supply between ter-
minals 1 and 2
Yes
OFF No
PBIB0077E
DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE
EC-1505
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE PFP:23710
Description EBS00GYR
CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real time application. It is an on-vehicle mul-
tiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent error detection ability. Many elec-
tronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links with other
control units during operation (not independent). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2
communication lines (CAN H line, CAN L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission with less wiring.
Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GYS
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GYT
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 3 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1507, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
DTC No.
Trouble diagnosis
name
DTC detecting condition Possible cause
U1000
1000
CAN communication
line
G ECM cannot communicate to other control
unit.
G ECM cannot communicate for more than the
specified time.
G Harness or connectors
(CAN communication line is open or
shorted)
U1001
1001
EC-1506
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE
Wiring Diagram EBS00GYU
MBWA0038E
DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE
EC-1507
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GYV
1. INSPECTION START
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Print out the CONSULT-II screen.
CVT Models
M/T Models
>> Go to LAN-8, "CAN COMMUNICATION" .
MBIB0180E
MBIB0179E
EC-1508
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR PFP:22680
Component Description EBS00GYW
The mass air flow sensor is placed in the stream of intake air. It mea-
sures the intake flow rate by measuring a part of the entire intake
flow. It consists of a hot film that is supplied with electric current from
the ECM. The temperature of the hot film is controlled by the ECM a
certain amount. The heat generated by the hot film is reduced as the
intake air flows around it. The more air, the greater the heat loss.
Therefore, the ECM must supply more electric current to maintain
the temperature of the hot film as air flow increases. The ECM
detects the air flow by means of this current change.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GYX
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GYY
These self-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GYZ
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
SEC266C
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
MAS A/F SE-B1
G Engine: After warming up
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Shift lever: N
G No-load
Idle Approx. 1.1 - 1.5V
2,500 rpm Approx. 1.6 - 2.0V
CAL/LD VALUE
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 10% - 35%
2,500 rpm 10% - 35%
MASS AIRFLOW
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 1.0 - 4.0 gm/s
2,500 rpm 4.0 - 10.0 gm/s
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0102
0102
Mass air flow sensor circuit
low input
An excessively low voltage from the sensor
is sent to ECM when engine is running.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Intake air leaks
G Mass air flow sensor
P0103
0103
Mass air flow sensor circuit
high input
An excessively high voltage from the sensor
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Mass air flow sensor
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
Mass air flow sensor circuit Engine speed will not rise more than 2,400 rpm due to the fuel cut.
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
EC-1509
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
PROCEDURE FOR DTC P0102
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and wait 5 seconds at most.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1511, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and wait 5 seconds at most.
2. Tarn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1511, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
PROCEDURE FOR DTC P0103
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Wait at least 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1511, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If DTC is not detected, go to next step.
5. Start engine and wait at least 5 seconds.
6. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1511, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 5 seconds.
2. Tarn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1511, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If DTC is not detected, go to next step.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
6. Start engine and wait at least 5 seconds.
7. Tarn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
8. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
9. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1511, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
SEF058Y
EC-1510
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00GZ0
MBWA0004E
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
EC-1511
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GZ1
1. INSPECTION START
Which malfunction (P0102 or P0103) is duplicated?
P0102 or P0103
P0102 >> GO TO 2.
P0103 >> GO TO 3.
2. CHECK INTAKE SYSTEM
Check the following for connection.
G Air duct
G Vacuum hoses
G Intake air passage between air duct to intake manifold
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Reconnect the parts.
3. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 4.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
45 R Sensor's power supply [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
50 B Mass air flow sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.1 - 1.5V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,500 rpm.
1.6 - 2.0V
54 W
Sensor's ground
(Mass air flow sensor)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0142E
EC-1512
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
4. CHECK MAF SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect MAF sensor harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between MAF sensor terminals 2, 4 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between mass air flow sensor and ECM
G Harness for open or short between mass air flow sensor and ECM relay
>> Repair harness or connectors.
6. CHECK MAF SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between MAF sensor terminal 3 and ECM terminal 54.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK MAF SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between MAF sensor terminal 1 and ECM terminal 50.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0131E
Terminal Voltage
2 Approximately 5V
4 Battery voltage
PBIB0076E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0102, P0103 MAF SENSOR
EC-1513
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
8. CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EC-1513, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace mass air flow sensor.
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GZ2
MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
1. Reconnect harness connectors disconnected.
2. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminal 50 (Mass air flow sensor
signal) and ground.
*: Check for liner voltage rise in response to engine being increased to about
4,000 rpm.
4. If the voltage is out of specification, proceed the following.
a. Turn ignition switch OFF.
b. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector and reconnect it again.
c. Perform steps 2 and 3 again.
5. If NG, remove mass air flow sensor from air duct. Check hot film for damage or dust.
6. If NG, clean or replace mass air flow sensor.
Removal and Installation EBS00GZ3
MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EM-114, "AIR CLEANER AND AIR DUCT" .
Condition Voltage V
Ignition switch ON (Engine stopped.) Approx. 1.0
Idle (Engine is warmed-up to normal operating
temperature.)
1.1 - 1.5
2,500 rpm (Engine is warmed-up to normal
operating temperature.)
1.6 - 2.0
Idle to about 4,000 rpm* 1.5 - 2.0 to Approx. 4.0
MBIB0017E
EC-1514
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR PFP:22630
Component Description EBS00GZ4
The engine coolant temperature sensor is used to detect the engine
coolant temperature. The sensor modifies a voltage signal from the
ECM. The modified signal returns to the ECM as the engine coolant
temperature input. The sensor uses a thermistor which is sensitive to
the change in temperature. The electrical resistance of the ther-
mistor decreases as temperature increases.
<Reference data>
*: These data are reference values and are measured between ECM terminal 72
(Engine coolant temperature sensor) and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GZ5
These self-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When this malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
SEF594K
Engine coolant
temperature C (F)
Voltage* V Resistance k
10 (14) 4.4 7.0 - 11.4
20 (68) 3.5 2.1 - 2.9
50 (122) 2.2 0.68 - 1.00
90 (194) 0.9 0.236 - 0.260
SEF012P
DTC No.
Trouble Diagnosis
Name
DTC Detecting Condition Possible Cause
P0117
0117
Engine coolant
temperature sen-
sor circuit low input
An excessively low voltage from the sensor is
sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Engine coolant temperature sensor P0118
0118
Engine coolant
temperature sen-
sor circuit high
input
An excessively high voltage from the sensor is
sent to ECM.
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR
EC-1515
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GZ6
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Wait at least 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1517, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 5 seconds.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1517, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
Engine coolant temper-
ature sensor circuit
Engine coolant temperature will be determined by ECM based on the time after turning ignition switch ON
or START. CONSULT-II displays the engine coolant temperature decided by ECM.
Condition
Engine coolant temperature decided
(CONSULT-II display)
Just as ignition switch is turned ON or Start 40C (104F)
More than approx. 4 minutes after ignition ON or
Start
80C (176F)
Except as shown above
40 - 80C (104 - 176F)
(Depends on the time)
When the fail-safe system for engine coolant temperature sensor is activated, the cooling fan operates
while engine is running.
SEF058Y
EC-1516
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00GZ7
MBWA0006E
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR
EC-1517
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GZ8
1. CHECK ECT SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor harness
connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between ECT sensor terminal 1 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
2. CHECK ECT SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between ECT sensor terminal 2 and engine ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between engine coolant temperature sensor and ECM
G Harness for open or short between engine coolant temperature sensor and TCM
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Refer to EC-1518, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace engine coolant temperature sensor.
MBIB0134E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0080E
Continuity should exist.
EC-1518
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0117, P0118 ECT SENSOR
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GZ9
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Check resistance between engine coolant temperature sensor
terminals 1 and 2 as shown in the figure.
<Reference data>
*: These data are reference values and are measured between ECM terminal
72 (Engine coolant temperature sensor) and ground.
2. If NG, replace engine coolant temperature sensor.
Removal and Installation EBS00GZA
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Refer to CO-40, "THERMOSTAT AND WATER CONTROL VALVE" .
PBIB0081E
Engine coolant
temperature C (F)
Voltage* V Resistance k
10 (14) 4.4 7.0 - 11.4
20 (68) 3.5 2.1 - 2.9
50 (122) 2.2 0.68 - 1.00
90 (194) 0.9 0.236 - 0.260
SEF012P
DTC P0134 HO2S1
EC-1519
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0134 HO2S1 PFP:22690
Component Description EBS00GZB
The heated oxygen sensor 1 is placed into the exhaust manifold. It
detects the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas compared to the
outside air. The heated oxygen sensor 1 has a closed-end tube
made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from
approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner conditions. The
heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM adjusts
the injection pulse duration to achieve the ideal air-fuel ratio. The
ideal air-fuel ratio occurs near the radical change from 1V to 0V.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GZC
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GZD
Under the condition in which the heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is
not input, the ECM circuits will read a continuous approximately
0.3V. Therefore, for this diagnosis, the time that output voltage is
within 200 to 400 mV range is monitored, and the diagnosis checks
that this time is not inordinately long.
SEF463R
SEF288D
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Maintaining engine speed at 2,000
rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times dur-
ing 10 seconds.
SEF237U
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0134
0134
Heated oxygen sensor 1
circuit no activity detected
The voltage from the sensor is constantly
approx. 0.3V.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Heated oxygen sensor 1
EC-1520
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0134 HO2S1
Overall Function Check EBS00GZF
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the heated oxygen sensor 1 circuit. During this check, a 1st
trip DTC might not be confirmed.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG in DATA MONITOR mode with CON-
SULT-II, and select H02S1 (B1).
3. Hdd engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load.
4. Make sure that the indications do not remain in the range
between 0.2V to 0.4V.
5. If NG, go to EC-1522, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage does not remain in the range of 0.2 - 0.4V.
4. If NG, go to EC-1522, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF646Y
MBIB0018E
DTC P0134 HO2S1
EC-1521
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GZG
MBWA0008E
EC-1522
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0134 HO2S1
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GZH
1. INSPECTION START
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK HO2S1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S1
terminal 3. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
35 PU Heated oxygen sensor 1
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
74 B Sensors' ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0142E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0151E
DTC P0134 HO2S1
EC-1523
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK HO2S1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 and HO2S1 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 or HO2S1 terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-1523, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GZI
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG and adjust TRIGGER POINT to 100% in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-
II.
3. Select HO2S1 (B1) and HO2S1 MNTR (B1).
4. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load during the follow-
ing steps.
5. Touch RECORD on CONSULT-II screen.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
SEF646Y
EC-1524
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0134 HO2S1
6. Check the following.
G HO2S1 MNTR (B1) in DATA MONITOR mode changes
from RICH to LEAN to RICH 5 times in 10 seconds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes below 0.3V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 (HO2S1 signal) and engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
G The voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new
one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00GZJ
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-121, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND THREE WAY CATALYST" .
SEF217YA
SEF648Y
MBIB0018E
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
EC-1525
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00GZK
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor,
throttle position sensor, etc. The throttle position sensor responds to
the throttle valve movement.
The throttle position sensor has the two sensors. These sensors are
a kind of potentiometers which transform the throttle valve position
into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM. In addi-
tion, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of the
throttle valve and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM
judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these sig-
nals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the
throttle valve opening angle properly in response to driving condi-
tion.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GZL
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GZM
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GZN
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0145E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
THRTL SEN1
THRTL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released More than 0.36V
G Shift lever:
D (CVT model)
1st (M/T model)
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0221
0221
Throttle position sensor
circuit range/performance
problem
Rationally incorrect voltage is sent to ECM
compared with the signals from TP sensor 1
and TP sensor 2.
G Harness or connector
(The TP sensor 1 and 2 circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 1 and 2)
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
EC-1526
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1528, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1528, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
EC-1527
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GZO
MBWA0127E
EC-1528
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GZP
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
47 G
Throttle position sensor
power supply
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
49 W Throttle position sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
More than 0.36V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
Less than 4.75V
66 B Sensors ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
68 R Throttle position sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
Less than 4.75V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 0.36V
MBIB0142E
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
EC-1529
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between electric throttle control actuator terminal
1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 66 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 49 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 4, ECM
terminal 68 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
Refer to EC-1530, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
MBIB0133E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0082E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
EC-1530
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0221 TP SENSOR
6. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GZQ
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Set selector lever to D position (CVT models) or 1st position (M/T models).
5. Check voltage between ECM terminals 49 (TP sensor 1 signal),
68 (TP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the following
conditions.
6. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to the next
step.
7. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
8. Perform EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00GZR
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-116, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
49
(Throttle position sensor 1)
Fully released More than 0.36V
Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
68
(Throttle position sensor 2)
Fully released Less than 4.75V
Fully depressed More than 0.36V
MBIB0022E
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
EC-1531
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00GZS
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor,
throttle position sensor, etc. The throttle position sensor responds to
the throttle valve movement.
The throttle position sensor has the two sensors. These sensors are
a kind of potentiometers which transform the throttle valve position
into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM. In addi-
tion, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of the
throttle valve and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM
judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these sig-
nals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the
throttle valve opening angle properly in response to driving condi-
tion.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00GZT
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00GZU
These self-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00GZV
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0145E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
THRTL SEN1
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released More than 0.36V
G Shift lever:
D (CVT model)
1st (M/T model)
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0222
0222
Throttle position sensor 1
circuit low input
An excessively low voltage from the TP sensor 1
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The TP sensor 1 circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 1)
P0223
0223
Throttle position sensor 1
circuit high input
An excessively high voltage from the TP sensor
1 is sent to ECM.
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
EC-1532
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1534, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1534, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
EC-1533
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00GZW
MBWA0125E
EC-1534
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GZX
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
47 G
Throttle position sensor
power supply
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
49 W Throttle position sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
More than 0.36V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
Less than 4.75V
66 B Sensors ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
68 R Throttle position sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
Less than 4.75V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 0.36V
MBIB0142E
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
EC-1535
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 1 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between electric throttle control actuator terminal
1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 66 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 49 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 4.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
Refer to EC-1536, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
MBIB0133E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0082E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
EC-1536
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0222, P0223 TP SENSOR
6. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00GZY
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Set selector lever to D position (CVT models) or 1st position (M/T models).
5. Check voltage between ECM terminals 49 (TP sensor 1 signal),
68 (TP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the following
conditions.
6. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to the next
step.
7. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
8. Perform EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00GZZ
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-116, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
49
(Throttle position sensor 1)
Fully released More than 0.36V
Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
68
(Throttle position sensor 2)
Fully released Less than 4.75V
Fully depressed More than 0.36V
MBIB0022E
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
EC-1537
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR PFP:18002
Component Description EBS00H00
The accelerator pedal position sensor is installed on the upper end
of the accelerator pedal assembly. The sensor detects the accelera-
tor position and sends a signal to the ECM.
Accelerator pedal position sensor has two sensors. These sensors
are a kind of potentiometers which transform the accelerator pedal
position into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM.
In addition, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of
the accelerator pedal and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The
ECM judges the current opening angle of the accelerator pedal from
these signals and controls the throttle control motor based on these
signals.
Idle position of the accelerator pedal is determined by the ECM
receiving the signal from the accelerator pedal position sensor. The ECM uses this signal for the engine oper-
ation such as fuel cut.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H01
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H02
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H03
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0146E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
ACCEL SEN1
ACCEL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed More than 3.9V
CLSD THL POS G Ignition switch: ON
Accelerator pedal: Fully released ON
Accelerator pedal: Slightly depressed OFF
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0226
0226
Accelerator pedal position sensor
circuit range/performance problem
Rationally incorrect voltage is sent to ECM
compared with the signals from APP sensor
1 and APP sensor 2.
G Harness or connector
(The APP sensor 1 and 2 circuit is
open or shorted.)
G Accelerator pedal position sensor 1
and 2
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
EC-1538
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1540, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1540, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
EC-1539
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00H04
MBWA0131E
EC-1540
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H05
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
45 R Sensors power supply [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
47 G Sensors power supply [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
55 B Sensors ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
66 B Sensors ground
[Ignition switch ON]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
98 LG
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is Ist (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.175 - 0.335V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is Ist (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 1.95V
106 L
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is Ist (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.35 - 0.67V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is Ist (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.9V
MBIB0142E
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
EC-1541
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK APP SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor harness
connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between APP sensor terminals 1, 2 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness connectors M79, F108
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK APP SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 55 and APP sensor terminal 4, ECM terminal 66 and
APP sensor terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
MBIB0152E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0782E
Continuity should exist.
EC-1542
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness connectors M79, F108
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
G Harness for open or short between TCM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK APP SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 106 and APP sensor terminal 3, ECM terminal 98 and
APP sensor terminal 6.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness connectors M79, F108
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK APP SENSOR
Refer to EC-1543, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 9.
9. REPLACE APP SENSOR
1. Replace the accelerator pedal position sensor.
2. Perform EC-1440, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
10. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0226 APP SENSOR
EC-1543
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Component Inspection EBS00H06
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminals 106 (APP sensor 1 sig-
nal), 98 (APP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the fol-
lowing conditions.
4. If NG, replace accelerator pedal assembly and go to the next
step.
5. Perform EC-1440, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
6. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
7. Perform EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00H07
ACCELERATOR PEDAL
Refer to ACC-2, "ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM" .
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
106
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Fully depressed More than 3.9V
98
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
Fully released 0.175 - 0.335V
Fully depressed More than 1.95V
MBIB0023E
EC-1544
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR PFP:18002
Component Description EBS00H08
The accelerator pedal position sensor is installed on the upper end
of the accelerator pedal assembly. The sensor detects the accelera-
tor position and sends a signal to the ECM.
Accelerator pedal position sensor has two sensors. These sensors
are a kind of potentiometers which transform the accelerator pedal
position into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM.
In addition, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of
the accelerator pedal and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The
ECM judges the current opening angle of the accelerator pedal from
these signals and controls the throttle control motor based on these
signals.
Idle position of the accelerator pedal is determined by the ECM
receiving the signal from the accelerator pedal position sensor. The ECM uses this signal for the engine oper-
ation such as fuel cut.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H09
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H0A
These self-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H0B
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0146E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
ACCEL SEN1
G Ignition switch: ON
(engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed More than 3.9V
CLSD THL POS G Ignition switch: ON
Accelerator pedal: Fully released ON
Accelerator pedal: Slightly depressed OFF
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0227
0227
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1 circuit low input
An excessively low voltage from the APP sensor 1
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The APP sensor 1 circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Accelerator pedal position sensor
(Accelerator pedal position sensor 1)
P0228
0228
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1 circuit high input
An excessively high voltage from the APP sensor 1
is sent to ECM.
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
EC-1545
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1547, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1547, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
EC-1546
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00H0C
MBWA0129E
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
EC-1547
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H0D
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
45 R Sensors power supply [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
47 G Sensors power supply [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
55 B Sensors ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
66 B Sensors ground
[Ignition switch ON]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
98 LG
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is Ist (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.175 - 0.335V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is Ist (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 1.95V
106 L
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is Ist (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.35 - 0.67V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is Ist (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.9V
MBIB0142E
EC-1548
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
2. CHECK APP SENSOR 1 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor harness
connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between APP sensor terminal 2 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M79, F108
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK APP SENSOR 1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 55 and APP sensor terminal 4.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M79, F108
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
G Harness for open or short between TCM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0152E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0811E
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
EC-1549
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK APP SENSOR 1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 106 and APP sensor terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M79, F108
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK APP SENSOR
Refer to EC-1549, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 9.
9. REPLACE APP SENSOR
1. Replace the accelerator pedal position sensor.
2. Perform EC-1440, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
10. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H0E
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminals 106 (APP sensor 1 sig-
nal), 98 (APP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the fol-
lowing conditions.
Continuity should exist.
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
106
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Fully depressed More than 3.9V
98
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
Fully released 0.175 - 0.335V
Fully depressed More than 1.95V
MBIB0023E
EC-1550
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0227, P0228 APP SENSOR
4. If NG, replace accelerator pedal assembly and go to the next step.
5. Perform EC-1440, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
6. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
7. Perform EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00H0F
ACCELERATOR PEDAL
Refer to ACC-2, "ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM" .
DTC P0327, P0328 KS
EC-1551
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0327, P0328 KS PFP:22060
Component Description EBS00H0G
The knock sensor is attached to the cylinder block. It senses engine
knocking using a piezoelectric element. A knocking vibration from
the cylinder block is sensed as vibrational pressure. This pressure is
converted into a voltage signal and sent to the ECM.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H0H
The MI will not light for knock sensor malfunction.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H0I
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
2. Start engine and run it for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1553, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and run it for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1553, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
MBIB0139E
DTC No. Trouble Diagnosis Name DTC Detected Condition Possible Cause
P0327
0327
Knock sensor circuit low
input
An excessively low voltage from the sensor is
sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Knock sensor
P0328
0328
Knock sensor circuit high
input
An excessively high voltage from the sensor is
sent to ECM.
SEF058Y
EC-1552
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0327, P0328 KS
Wiring Diagram EBS00H0J
MBWA0013E
DTC P0327, P0328 KS
EC-1553
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H0K
1. CHECK KNOCK SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT-I
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check resistance between ECM terminal 15 and engine ground. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
NOTE:
It is necessary to use an ohmmeter which can measure more than 10 M.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK KNOCK SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT-II
1. Disconnect knock sensor harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 15 and knock
sensor terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK KNOCK SENSOR
Refer to EC-1554, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace knock sensor.
4. CHECK KNOCK SENSOR SHIELD CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between knock sensor terminal 2 and engine ground.
2. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
15 W Knock sensor
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 2.5V
Resistance: Approximately 530 - 590k [at 20C (68F)]
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0139E
Continuity should exist
EC-1554
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0327, P0328 KS
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H0L
KNOCK SENSOR
Check resistance between knock sensor terminal 1 and ground.
NOTE:
It is necessary to use an ohmmeter which can measure more
than 10 M.
CAUTION:
Do not use any knock sensors that have been dropped or phys-
ically damaged. Use only new ones.
Removal and Installation EBS00H0M
KNOCK SENSOR
Refer to EM-165, "CYLINDER BLOCK" .
Resistance: Approximately 530 - 590k [at 20C (68F)]
SEF227W
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
EC-1555
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS) PFP:23731
Component Description EBS00H0N
The crankshaft position sensor (POS) is located on the cylinder
block rear housing facing the gear teeth (cogs) of the signal plate at
the end of the crankshaft. It detects the fluctuation of the engine rev-
olution.
The sensor consists of a permanent magnet and Hall IC.
When the engine is running, the high and low parts of the teeth
cause the gap with the sensor change.
The changing gap causes the magnetic field near the sensor to
change.
Due to the changing magnetic field, the voltage from the sensor
changes.
The ECM receives the voltage signal and detects the fluctuation of
the engine revolution.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H0O
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H0P
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H0Q
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10.5V with igni-
tion switch ON.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select DATA MONITOR mode
with CONSULT-II.
2. Crank engine for at least 2 seconds and run it for at least 5 sec-
onds at idle speed.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1558, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
PBIB0562E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
ENG SPEED
G Tachometer: Connect
G Run engine and compare tachometer indication with the CONSULT-II
value.
Almost the same speed as the
CONSULT-II value.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0335
0335
Crankshaft position
sensor (POS) circuit
G The crankshaft position sensor (POS) signal is not
detected by the ECM during the first few seconds of
engine cranking.
G The proper pulse signal from the crankshaft position
sensor (POS) is not sent to ECM while the engine is
running.
G The crankshaft position sensor (POS) signal is not in
the normal pattern during engine running.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
G Signal plate
SEF058Y
EC-1556
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Crank engine for at least 2 seconds and run it for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1558, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
EC-1557
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00H0R
MBWA0014E
EC-1558
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H0S
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
13 L
Crankshaft position
sensor (POS)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 3V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
Approximately 3V
PBIB0527E
PBIB0528E
MBIB0142E
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
EC-1559
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR (POS) POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect crankshaft position (CKP) sensor (POS) harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between CKP sensor (POS) terminal 1 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between crankshaft position sensor (POS) and ECM
G Harness for open or short between crankshaft position sensor (POS) and ECM relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK CKP SENSOR (POS) GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between CKP sensor (POS) terminal 3 and engine ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB0512E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0664E
Continuity should exist.
EC-1560
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
5. CHECK CKP SENSOR (POS) INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 13 and CKP sensor (POS) terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (POS)
Refer to EC-1560, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace crankshaft position sensor (POS).
7. CHECK GEAR TOOTH
Visually check for chipping signal plate gear tooth.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace the signal plate.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H0T
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (POS)
1. Loosen the fixing bolt of the sensor.
2. Disconnect crankshaft position sensor (POS) harness connector.
3. Remove the sensor.
4. Visually check the sensor for chipping.
Continuity should exist.
PBIB0563E
DTC P0335 CKP SENSOR (POS)
EC-1561
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. Check resistance as shown in the figure.
6. If NG, replace crankshaft position sensor (POS).
Removal and Installation EBS00H0U
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (POS)
Refer to EM-165, "CYLINDER BLOCK" .
Terminal No. (Polarity) Resistance [at 25C (77F)]
3 (+) - 1 (-)
Except 0 or 3 (+) - 2 (-)
2 (+) - 1 (-)
MBIB0024E
EC-1562
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE) PFP:23731
Component Description EBS00H0V
The camshaft position sensor (PHASE) senses the retraction with
intake valve camshaft to identify a particular cylinder. The camshaft
position sensor (PHASE) senses the piston position.
When the crankshaft position sensor (POS) system becomes inoper-
ative, the camshaft position sensor (PHASE) provides various con-
trols of engine parts instead, utilizing timing of cylinder identification
signals.
The sensor consists of a permanent magnet and Hall IC.
When engine is running, the high and low parts of the teeth cause
the gap with the sensor to change.
The changing gap causes the magnetic field near the sensor to
change.
Due to the changing magnetic field, the voltage from the sensor changes.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H0W
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H0X
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10.5V with igni-
tion switch ON.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Crank engine for at least 2 seconds and run it for at least 5 sec-
onds at idle speed.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1565, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
If 1st trip DTC is not detected, go to next step.
5. Maintain engine speed at more than 800 rpm for at least 5 sec-
onds.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1565, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Crank engine for at least 2 seconds and run it for at least 5 seconds at idle speed.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1565, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If 1st trip DTC is not detected, go to next step.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
PBIB0562E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0340
0340
Camshaft position sensor
(PHASE) circuit
G The cylinder No. signal is not sent to ECM
for the first few seconds during engine
cranking.
G The cylinder No. signal is not set to ECM
during engine running.
G The cylinder No. signal is not in the normal
pattern during engine running.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
G Camshaft (Intake)
G Starter motor (Refer to SC-22 .)
G Starting system circuit (Refer to SC-22 .)
G Dead (Weak) battery
SEF013Y
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
EC-1563
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. Start engine and maintain engine speed at more than 800 rpm for at least 5 seconds.
7. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
8. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
9. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1565, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
EC-1564
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
Wiring Diagram EBS00H0Y
MBWA0015E
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
EC-1565
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H0Z
1. CHECK STARTING SYSTEM
Turn ignition switch to START position.
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> Check starting system. (Refer to SC-22, "STARTING SYSTEM" .)
2. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 3.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
14 L
Camshaft position
sensor (PHASE)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.0 - 4.0V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
1.0 - 4.0V
PBIB0525E
PBIB0526E
Does the engine turn over?
Does the starter motor operate?
MBIB0142E
EC-1566
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
3. CHECK CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR (PHASE) POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect camshaft position (CMP) sensor (PHASE) harness
connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between CMP sensor (PHASE) terminal 1 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between camshaft position sensor (PHASE) and ECM
G Harness for open or short between camshaft position sensor (PHASE) and ECM relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK CMP SENSOR (PHASE) GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between CMP sensor (PHASE) terminal 3 and engine ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0134E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0664E
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
EC-1567
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK CMP SENSOR (PHASE) INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 14 and CMP sensor (PHASE) terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground or short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (PHASE)
Refer to EC-1567, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace camshaft position sensor (PHASE).
8. CHECK CAMSHAFT (INTAKE)
Check the following.
G Accumulation of debris to the signal plate of camshaft rear end
G Chipping signal plate of camshaft rear end
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Remove debris and clean the signal plate of camshaft
rear end or replace camshaft.
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H10
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (PHASE)
1. Loosen the fixing bolt of the sensor.
2. Disconnect camshaft position sensor (PHASE) harness connector.
3. Remove the sensor.
4. Visually check the sensor for chipping.
Continuity should exist.
PBIB0565E
PBIB0563E
EC-1568
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0340 CMP SENSOR (PHASE)
5. Check resistance as shown in the figure.
Removal and Installation EBS00H11
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (PHASE)
Refer to EM-133, "CAMSHAFT" .
Terminal No. (Polarity) Resistance [at 25C (77F)]
3 (+) - 1 (-)
Except 0 or 3 (+) - 2 (-)
2 (+) - 1 (-)
MBIB0024E
DTC P0500 VSS
EC-1569
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0500 VSS PFP:32702
Description EBS00H12
NOTE:
If DTC P0500 is displayed with DTC U1000 or U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-1505, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
The vehicle speed signal is sent to the combination meter from the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
through CAN communication line. The combination meter then sends a signal to the ECM through CAN com-
munication line.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H13
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H14
CAUTION:
Always drive vehicle at a safe speed.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Steps 1 and 2 may be conducted with the drive wheels lifted in the shop or by driving the vehicle. If a
road test is expected to be easier, it is unnecessary to lift the vehicle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Read VHCL SPEED SE in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II. The vehicle speed on CONSULT-
II should exceed 10 km/h (6 MPH) when rotating wheels with suitable gear position.
If NG, go to EC-1570, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If OK, go to following step.
3. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Warm engine up to normal operating temperature.
5. Maintain the following conditions for at least 60 consecutive sec-
onds.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1570, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
Overall Function Check EBS00H15
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the vehicle speed signal circuit. During this check, a 1st trip
DTC might not be confirmed.
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Lift up drive wheels.
2. Start engine.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0500
0500
Vehicle speed sensor
The almost 0 km/h (0 MPH) signal from
vehicle speed sensor is sent to ECM
even when vehicle is being driven.
G Harness or connectors
(The CAN communication line is open or
shorted.)
G ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
G Wheel sensor
G Combination meter
ENG SPEED 2,000 - 6,000 rpm
COOLAN TEMP/S More than 70C (158F)
B/FUEL SCHDL 4.9 - 31.8 msec
Selector lever Suitable position
PW/ST SIGNAL OFF
SEF196Y
EC-1570
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0500 VSS
3. Read vehicle speed with combination meter.
The vehicle speed indication should be able to exceed 10 km/h (6 MPH) when rotating wheels with suit-
able gear position.
4. If NG, go to EC-1570, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H16
1. CHECK DTC
Refer to BRC-17, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS" (Models without ESP) or BRC-60, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS"
(Models with ESP).
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace.
2. CHECK COMBINATION METER
Check combination meter function.
Refer to DI-5, "COMBINATION METERS (LHD MODELS)" or DI-34, "COMBINATION METERS (RHD MOD-
ELS)" .
>> INSPECTION END
DTC P0550 PSP SENSOR
EC-1571
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0550 PSP SENSOR PFP:49763
Component Description EBS00H17
Power steering pressure (PSP) sensor is installed to the power
steering high-pressure tube and detects a power steering load. This
sensor is a potentiometer which transforms the power steering load
into output voltage, and emits the voltage signal to the ECM. The
ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator and adjusts the
throttle valve opening angle to increase the engine speed and
adjusts the idle speed for the increased load.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H18
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H19
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H1A
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for at least 5 seconds.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1573, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle for at least 5 seconds.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1573, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
MBIB0153E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
PW/ST SIGNAL
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Steering wheel is in neutral position.
(Forward direction)
OFF
Steering wheel is turned. ON
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0550
0550
Power steering pressure
sensor circuit
An excessively low or high voltage from the
sensor is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Power steering pressure sensor
EC-1572
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0550 PSP SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00H1B
MBWA0032E
DTC P0550 PSP SENSOR
EC-1573
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H1C
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
12 Y
Power steering pressure
sensor
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is being turned.
Approximately 3.6V
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is not being turned.
Approximately 0.6V
55 B Sensors' ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
65 R
Sensor's power supply
(Power steering pres-
sure sensor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
MBIB0142E
EC-1574
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0550 PSP SENSOR
2. CHECK PSP SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect PSP sensor harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between PSP sensor terminal 3 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair harness or connectors.
3. CHECK PSP SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 55 and PSP sensor terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between power steering pressure sensor and ECM
G Harness for open or short between power steering pressure sensor and TCM
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK PSP SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 12 and PSP sensor terminal 2.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0153E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
SEF509Y
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0550 PSP SENSOR
EC-1575
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK PSP SENSOR
Refer to EC-1575, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace PSP sensor.
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H1D
POWER STEERING PRESSURE SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Start engine and let it idle.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminal 12 and ground under the
following conditions.
Condition Voltage
Steering wheel is being turned fully. Approximately 3.6V
Steering wheel is not being turned. Approximately 0.6V
MBIB0025E
EC-1576
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0605 ECM
DTC P0605 ECM PFP:23710
Component Description EBS00H1E
The ECM consists of a microcomputer and connectors for signal
input and output and for power supply. The ECM controls the engine.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H1F
FAIL-SAFE MODE
ECM enters fail-safe mode when malfunction A is detected.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H1G
Perform PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A first. If the DTC cannot be confirmed, perform PRO-
CEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION B. If there is no problem on PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION B,
perform PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C.
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1578, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1578, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF093X
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0605
0605
Engine control module
A) ECM calculation function is malfunctioning.
G ECM B) ECM EEP-ROM system is malfunctioning.
C) ECM self shut-off function is malfunctioning.
Detected items Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
Malfunction A
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5
degrees) by the return spring.
SEF058Y
DTC P0605 ECM
EC-1577
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION B
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then
turn ON.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1578, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1578, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then
turn ON.
4. Repeat step 3 procedure, 32 times.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1578, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Repeat step 2 procedure, 32 times.
4. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1578, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
SEF058Y
EC-1578
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P0605 ECM
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H1H
1. INSPECTION START
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select SELF DIAG RESULTS mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Touch ERASE.
4. Perform DTC Confirmation Procedure.
See EC-1576 .
5. Is the 1st trip DTC P0605 displayed again?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Erase the Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) memory. Refer to EC-1449 .
3. Perform DTC Confirmation Procedure.
See EC-1576 .
4. Is the 1st trip DTC P0605 displayed again?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> INSPECTION END
2. REPLACE ECM
1. Replace ECM.
2. Perform initialization of NATS system and registration of all NATS ignition key IDs. Refer to EC-1447,
"NATS (Nissan Anti-theft System)" .
3. Perform EC-1440, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
5. Perform EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY
EC-1579
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY PFP:23710
Component Description EBS00H1I
Battery voltage is supplied to the ECM even when the ignition switch
is turned OFF for the ECM memory function of the DTC memory, the
air fuel ratio feedback compensation value memory, the idle air vol-
ume learning value memory, etc.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H1J
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H1K
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then
turn ON.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 four times.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1581, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 four times.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
6. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
7. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1581, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF093X
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1065
1065
ECM power supply circuit
ECM back up RAM system does not function
properly.
G Harness or connectors
[ECM power supply (back-up) circuit is
open or shorted.]
G ECM
SEF058Y
EC-1580
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY
Wiring Diagram EBS00H1L
MBWA0040E
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY
EC-1581
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H1M
1. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminal 121 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between ECM and battery
>> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
3. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
121 W/L
Power supply for ECM
(Buck-up)
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0026E
EC-1582
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1065 ECM POWER SUPPLY
4. PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select SELF DIAG RESULTS mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Touch ERASE.
4. Perform DTC Confirmation Procedure.
See EC-1579 .
5. Is the 1st trip DTC P1065 displayed again?
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Erase the Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) memory. Refer to EC-1449 .
3. Perform DTC Confirmation Procedure.
See EC-1579 .
4. Is the 1st trip DTC P1065 displayed again?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 5.
No >> INSPECTION END
5. REPLACE ECM
1. Replace ECM.
2. Perform initialization of NATS system and registration of all NATS ignition key IDs. Refer to EC-1447,
"NATS (Nissan Anti-theft System)" .
3. Perform EC-1440, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
5. Perform EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
DTC P1121 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
EC-1583
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1121 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00H1O
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor, throttle position sensor, etc.
The throttle control motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve.
The throttle position sensor detects the throttle valve position, and the opening and closing speed of the throt-
tle valve and feeds the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM judges the current opening angle of the throttle
valve from these signals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the throttle valve opening
angle properly in response to driving condition.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H1P
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction A or B is detected in the two consecutive trips, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and MI
lights up.
When the malfunction C is detected even in the 1st trip, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H1Q
NOTE:
G Perform PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A AND B first. If the 1st trip DTC cannot be con-
firmed, perform PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C.
G If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and
wait at least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A AND B
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition witch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Shift selector lever to D position (CVT), 1st position (M/T) and
wait at least 2 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds, and then
turn ON.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1584, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1121
1121
Electric throttle control
actuator
A)
Electric throttle control actuator does not function
properly due to the return spring malfunction.
G Electric throttle control actuator
B)
Throttle valve opening angle in fail-safe mode is
not in specified range.
C)
ECM detect the throttle valve is stuck open.
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection
logic.
Detected items Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
Malfunction A
The ECM controls the electric throttle actuator by regulating the throttle opening around the idle position.
The engine speed will not rise more than 2,000 rpm.
Malfunction B ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator by regulating the throttle opening to 20 degrees or less.
Malfunction C
While the vehicle is driving, it slows down gradually by fuel cut. After the vehicle stops, the engine stalls.
The engine can restart in N or P position, and engine speed will not exceed 1,000 rpm or more.
SEF058Y
EC-1584
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1121 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
2. Shift selector lever to D position (CVT), 1st position (M/T) and wait at least 2 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
4. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1584, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION C
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Shift selector lever to D position (CVT), 1st position (M/T) and
wait at least 2 seconds.
4. Shift selector lever to N or P position.
5. Start engine and let it idle for 3 seconds.
6. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1584, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Shift selector lever to D position (CVT), 1st position (M/T) and wait at least 2 seconds.
3. Shift selector lever to N or P position.
4. Start engine and let it idle for the 3 seconds.
5. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
6. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
7. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1584, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H1R
1. CHECK ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR VISUALLY
1. Remove the intake air duct.
2. Check if a foreign matter is caught between the throttle valve
and the housing.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Remove the foreign matter and clean the electric throttle
control actuator inside.
2. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
Removal and Installation EBS00HC6
Refer to EM-116, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
SEF058Y
MBIB0143E
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
EC-1585
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION PFP:16119
Description EBS00H1S
NOTE:
If DTC P1122 is displayed with DTC P1121 or 1126, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC P1121 or
P1126. Refer to EC-1585 or EC-1592 .
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor, throttle position sensor, etc.
The throttle control motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve.
The current opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the throttle position sensor and it provides feed-
back to the ECM to control the throttle control motor to make the throttle valve opening angle properly in
response to driving condition.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H1T
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H1U
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1587, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
2. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
4. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
5. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1587, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1122
1122
Electric throttle control
performance problem
Electric throttle control function does not
operate properly.
G Harness or connectors
(Throttle control motor circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Harness or connectors
(Throttle control motor relay circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
G Throttle control motor relay
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return
spring.
SEF058Y
EC-1586
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
Wiring Diagram EBS00H1V
MBWA0132E
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
EC-1587
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H1W
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
3 R
Throttle control motor relay
power supply
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
4 BR
Throttle control motor
(Close)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is releasing
0 - 14V
5 Y
Throttle control motor
(Open)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is depressing
0 - 14V
104 OR Throttle control motor relay
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch ON] 0 - 1.0V
PBIB0534E
PBIB0533E
MBIB0142E
EC-1588
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
2. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY SIGNAL CIRCUIT
Check voltage between ECM terminal 3 and ground under the fol-
lowing conditions with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect throttle control motor relay.
3. Check voltage between throttle control motor relay terminals 2, 5
and ground.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G 15A fuse
G Harness for open or short between throttle control motor relay and fuse
>> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
Ignition switch Voltage
OFF Approximately 0V
ON
Battery voltage
(11 - 14V)
MBIB0028E
MBIB0140E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0575E
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
EC-1589
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 3 and throttle control motor relay terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
6. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E70, F13 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E63, F31 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between ECM and throttle control motor relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Check continuity between ECM terminal 104 and throttle control motor relay terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> GO TO 8.
8. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness for open or short between ECM and throttle control motor relay
>> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
9. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
Refer to EC-1591, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> Replace throttle control motor relay.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
EC-1590
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
10. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN OR SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between the following terminals.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> Repair or replace.
11. CHECK ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR VISUALLY
1. Remove the intake air duct.
2. Check if foreign matter is caught between the throttle valve and
the housing.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Remove the foreign matter and clean the electric throttle
control actuator inside.
12. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
Refer to EC-1591, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> GO TO 14.
13. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14.
NG >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
14. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
Electric throttle control
actuator terminal
ECM terminal Continuity
3
4 Should exist
5 Should not exist
6
4 Should not exist
5 Should exist
MBIB0133E
MBIB0143E
DTC P1122 ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL FUNCTION
EC-1591
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Component Inspection EBS00H1X
THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
1. Apply 12V direct current between relay terminals 1 and 2.
2. Check continuity between relay terminals 3 and 5.
3. If NG, replace throttle control motor relay.
THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Check resistance between terminals 3 and 6.
3. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to next
step.
4. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
5. Perform EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00H1Y
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-116, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
Conditions Continuity
12V direct current supply between terminals
1 and 2
Yes
No current supply No
PBIB0098E
Resistance: Approximately 1 - 15 [at 25 C (77F)]
PBIB0095E
EC-1592
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00H1Z
Power supply for the Throttle Control motor is provided to the ECM via throttle control motor relay. The throttle
control motor relay is ON/OFF controlled by the ECM. When the ignition switch is turned ON, the ECM sends
an ON signal to throttle control motor relay and battery voltage is provided to the ECM. When the ignition
switch is turned OFF, the ECM sends an OFF signal to throttle control motor relay and battery voltage is not
provided to the ECM.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H20
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H21
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the DTC P1124 is detected in the two consecutive trips, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and MI lights up.
When the DTC P1126 is detected even in the 1st trip, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H22
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
PROCEDURE FOR DTC P1124
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1595, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 1 second.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
THRTL RELAY G Ignition switch: ON ON
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1124
1124
Throttle control motor
relay circuit short
ECM detect the throttle control motor relay
is stuck ON.
G Harness or connectors
(Throttle control motor relay circuit is shorted.)
G Throttle control motor relay
P1126
1126
Throttle control motor
relay circuit open
ECM detects a voltage of power source for
throttle control motor is excessively low.
This self-diagnosis has the one trip
detection logic.
G Harness or connectors
(Throttle control motor relay circuit is open.)
G Throttle control motor relay
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return
spring.
SEF058Y
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
EC-1593
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1595, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
PROCEDURE FOR DTC P1126
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1595, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 second.
2. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
4. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
5. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1595, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
EC-1594
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
Wiring Diagram EBS00H23
MBWA0133E
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
EC-1595
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H24
1. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect throttle control motor relay.
3. Check voltage between throttle control motor relay terminals 2, 5
and ground.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G 15A fuse
G Harness for open or short between throttle control motor relay and fuse
>> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
3 R
Throttle control motor relay
power supply
[Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
104 OR Throttle control motor relay
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch ON] 0 - 1.0V
MBIB0140E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0575E
EC-1596
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
3. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 3 and throttle control motor relay terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E70, F13 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E63, F31 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between ECM and throttle control motor relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Check continuity between ECM terminal 104 and throttle control motor relay terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
6. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness for open or short between ECM and throttle control motor relay
>> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
7. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
Refer to EC-1596, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace throttle control motor relay.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H25
THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
1. Apply 12V direct current between relay terminals 1 and 2.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
DTC P1124, P1126 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR RELAY
EC-1597
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Check continuity between relay terminals 3 and 5.
3. If NG, replace throttle control motor relay.
Conditions Continuity
12V direct current supply between terminals
1 and 2
Yes
No current supply No
PBIB0098E
EC-1598
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00H26
The throttle control motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve.
The current opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the throttle position sensor and it provides feed-
back to the ECM to control the throttle control motor to make the throttle valve opening angle properly in
response to driving condition.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H27
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H28
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1600, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 second.
2. Start engine and let it idle for 5 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
4. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
5. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1600, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1128
1128
Throttle control motor
circuit short
ECM detects short both circuits between ECM
and throttle control motor.
G Harness or connectors
(Throttle control motor circuit is shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
(Throttle control motor)
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return
spring.
SEF058Y
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
EC-1599
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00H29
MBWA0134E
EC-1600
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H2A
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
4 BR
Throttle control motor
(Close)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is releasing
0 - 14V
5 Y
Throttle control motor
(Open)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal is depressing
0 - 14V
PBIB0534E
PBIB0533E
MBIB0142E
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
EC-1601
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN OR SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between the following terminals.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
3. CHECK THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
Refer to EC-1601, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 5.
4. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
5. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H2B
THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Check resistance between terminals 3 and 6.
3. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to next
step.
4. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
5. Perform EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Electric throttle control
actuator terminal
ECM terminal Continuity
3
4 Should exist
5 Should not exist
6
4 Should not exist
5 Should exist
MBIB0133E
Resistance: Approximately 1 - 15 [at 25 C (77F)]
PBIB0095E
EC-1602
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1128 THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
Remove and Installation EBS00H2C
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-116, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-1603
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE PFP:00000
System Description EBS00H2D
NOTE:
If DTC P1217 is displayed with DTC U1000, U1001, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000,
U1001. Refer to EC-1505, "DTC U1000, U1001 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
COOLING FAN CONTROL
*1: These signals are sent to ECM through CAN communication line.
*2: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
The ECM controls the cooling fan corresponding to the vehicle speed, engine coolant temperature, refrigerant
pressure, and air conditioner ON signal. The control system has 3-step control [HIGH/LOW/OFF].
The ECM sends a cooling fan control signal to the smart entrance control unit through CAN communication
line, and the smart entrance control unit controls cooling fan relays.
OPERATION
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H2E
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Vehicle speed signal
Vehicle speed*
1
Cooling fan
control
Cooling fan relay(s)
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Air conditioner switch Air conditioner ON signal*
1
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed*
2
Battery Battery voltage*
2
Refrigerant pressure sensor Refrigerant pressure
PBIB0576E
EC-1604
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H2F
If the cooling fan or another component in the cooling system malfunctions, engine coolant temperature will
rise. When the engine coolant temperature reaches an abnormally high temperature condition, a malfunction
is indicated.
CAUTION:
When a malfunction is indicated, be sure to replace the coolant. Refer to MA-20, "Changing Engine
Coolant" . Also, replace the engine oil. Refer to MA-24, "Changing Engine Oil" .
1. Fill radiator with coolant up to specified level with a filling speed of 2 liters per minute. Be sure to
use coolant with the proper mixture ratio. Refer to MA-18, "Engine Coolant Mixture Ratio" .
2. After refilling coolant, run engine to ensure that no water-flow noise is emitted.
Overall Function Check EBS00H2G
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the cooling fan. During this check, a DTC might not be con-
firmed.
WARNING:
Never remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could be caused by high pres-
sure fluid escaping from the radiator.
Wrap a thick cloth around cap. Carefully remove the cap by turning it a quarter turn to allow built-up
pressure to escape. Then turn the cap all the way off.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Check the coolant level in the reservoir tank and radiator.
Allow engine to cool before checking coolant level.
If the coolant level in the reservoir tank and/or radiator is below
the proper range, skip the following steps and go to EC-1608,
"Diagnostic Procedure" .
2. Confirm whether customer filled the coolant or not. If customer
filled the coolant, skip the following steps and go to EC-1608,
"Diagnostic Procedure" .
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
AIR COND SIG
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Air conditioner switch: OFF OFF
Air conditioner switch: ON
(Compressor operates.)
ON
COOLING FAN
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
Engine coolant temperature is 99C
(210F) or less
OFF
Engine coolant temperature is 100C
(212F) or more
ON
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1217
1217
Engine over tempera-
ture (Overheat)
G Cooling fan does not operate properly (Over-
heat).
G Cooling fan system does not operate prop-
erly (Overheat).
G Engine coolant was not added to the system
using the proper filling method.
G Harness or connectors
(The cooling fan circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Cooling fan
G Radiator hose
G Radiator
G Radiator cap
G Water pump
G Thermostat
For more information, refer to EC-1618,
"Main 12 Causes of Overheating" .
SEF621W
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-1605
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. Perform COOLING FAN in ACTIVE TEST mode with CON-
SULT-II.
5. If the results are NG, go to EC-1608, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Check the coolant level in the reservoir tank and radiator.
Allow engine to cool before checking coolant level.
If the coolant level in the reservoir tank and/or radiator is below
the proper range, skip the following steps and go to EC-1608,
"Diagnostic Procedure" .
2. Confirm whether customer filled the coolant or not. If customer
filled the coolant, skip the following steps and go to EC-1608,
"Diagnostic Procedure" .
3. Start engine.
Be careful not to overheat engine.
4. Set temperature control lever to full cold position.
5. Turn air conditioner switch ON.
6. Turn blower fan switch ON.
7. Run engine at idle for a few minutes with air conditioner operating.
Be careful not to overheat engine.
8. Make sure that cooling fans operates at low speed.
If NG, go to EC-1608, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If OK, go to the following step.
9. Turn ignition switch OFF.
10. Turn air conditioner switch and blower fan switch OFF.
11. Disconnect engine coolant temperature sensor harness connec-
tor.
12. Connect 150 resistor to engine coolant temperature sensor
harness connector.
13. Restart engine and make sure that cooling fan operates at
higher speed than low speed.
Be careful not to overheat engine.
14. If NG, go to EC-1608, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
MBIB0037E
SEF621W
SEC163BA
MEC475B
EC-1606
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
Wiring Diagram EBS00H2H
LHD MODELS
MBWA0018E
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-1607
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
RHD MODELS
MBWA0146E
EC-1608
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H2I
1. INSPECTION START
Do you have CONSULT-II?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> GO TO 5.
2. CHECK COOLING FAN LOW SPEED OPERATION
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Perform COOLING FAN in ACTIVE TEST mode with CON-
SULT-II and touch LOW on the CONSULT-II screen.
3. Make sure that cooling fans-1 and -2 operate at low speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Check cooling fan low speed control circuit. (Go to EC-
1612, "PROCEDURE A" .)
3. CHECK COOLING FAN HIGH SPEED OPERATION-I
With CONSULT-II
1. Touch HIGHon the CONSULT-II screen.
2. Make sure that cooling fan-1 operates at higher speed than low
speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Check cooling fan high speed control circuit-1. (Go to
EC-1614, "PROCEDURE B" .)
4. CHECK COOLING FAN HIGH SPEED OPERATION-II
With CONSULT-II
Make sure that cooling fan-2 operates at higher speed than low speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Check cooling fan high speed control circuit-2. (Go to EC-1616, "PROCEDURE C" .)
SEF784Z
SEF785Z
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-1609
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. CHECK COOLING FAN LOW SPEED OPERATION
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle.
2. Turn air conditioner switch ON.
3. Turn blower fan switch ON.
4. Make sure that cooling fans-1 and -2 operate at low speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Check cooling fan low speed control circuit. (Go to EC-
1612, "PROCEDURE A" .)
6. CHECK COOLING FAN HIGH SPEED OPERATION-I
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Turn air conditioner switch and blower fan switch OFF.
3. Disconnect engine coolant temperature sensor harness connector.
4. Connect 150 resistor to engine coolant temperature sensor harness connector.
5. Restart engine and make sure that cooling fan-1 operates at
higher speed than low speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Check cooling fan high speed control circuit-1. (Go to
EC-1614, "PROCEDURE B" .)
7. CHECK COOLING FAN HIGH SPEED OPERATION-II
Without CONSULT-II
Make sure that cooling fan-2 operates higher speed than lower speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Check cooling fan high speed control circuit-2. (Go to EC-1616, "PROCEDURE C" .)
SEC163BA
MEC475B
EC-1610
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
8. CHECK COOLING SYSTEM FOR LEAK
Apply pressure to the cooling system with a tester, and check if the pressure drops.
CAUTION:
Higher than the specified pressure may cause radiator damage.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> GO TO 8.
9. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following for leak.
G Hose
G Radiator
G Water pump (Refer toCO-38, "WATER PUMP" .)
>> Repair or replace.
10. CHECK RADIATOR CAP
Apply pressure to cap with a tester and check radiator cap relief
pressure.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> Replace radiator cap.
Testing pressure: 157 kPa (1.57 bar, 1.6 kg/cm
2
, 23psi)
Pressure should not drop.
SLC754A
Radiator cap relief pressure:
78 - 98 kPa (0.59 - 0.98 bar, 0.6 - 1.0 kg/cm
2
, 9 - 14 psi)
SLC755A
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-1611
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
11. CHECK THERMOSTAT
1. Remove thermostat.
2. Check valve seating condition at normal room temperatures.
It should seat tightly.
3. Check valve opening temperature and valve lift.
4. Check if valve is closed at 5C (9F) below valve opening tem-
perature. For details, refer to CO-40, "THERMOSTAT AND
WATER CONTROL VALVE" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Replace thermostat.
12. CHECK ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Refer to EC-1518, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> Replace engine coolant temperature sensor.
13. CHECK MAIN 12 CAUSES
If the cause cannot be isolated, go to EC-1618, "Main 12 Causes of Overheating" .
>> INSPECTION END
Valve opening temperature:
80.5 - 83.5 C (177 - 182 F)
Valve lift:
More than 8 mm/95 C (0.31 in/203 F)
SLC343
EC-1612
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
PROCEDURE A
1. CHECK COOLING FAN POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect cooling fan relay-1.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between cooling fan relay-1 terminals 2, 3 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Fuse block (J/B) connector E106
G 10A fuse
G 40A fusible link
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-1 and fuse
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-1 and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0137E
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0055E
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-1613
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTORS CONTROL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect cooling fan motor-1 harness connector and cooling
fan motor-2 harness connector.
3. Disconnect cooling fan relay-2 and cooling fan relay-4.
4. Check harness continuity between the following.
Cooling fan relay-1 terminal 5 and cooling fan motor-1 terminal 1
Cooling fan motor-1 terminal 2 and cooling fan relay-2 terminal 3
Cooling fan motor-1 terminal 2 and cooling fan relay-4 terminal 3
Cooling fan relay-2 terminal 4 and cooling fan motor-2 terminal 1
Cooling fan relay-4 terminal 4 and cooling fan motor-2 terminal 1
Cooling fan motor-2 terminal 2 and ground
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect smart entrance control unit harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between cooling fan relay-1 terminal 1
and smart entrance control unit terminal 33. Refer to Wiring Dia-
gram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E123, M17 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E110, M94 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-1 and smart entrance control unit
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK COOLING FAN RELAY-1, -2 AND 4
Refer to EC-1619, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace cooling fan relay.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0136E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0173E
EC-1614
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
7. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTORS-1 AND -2
Refer to EC-1619, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace cooling fan motors.
8. CHECK SMART ENTRANCE CONTROL UNIT
Refer to BCS-39, "Trouble Diagnoses" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace smart entrance control unit.
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Perform EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
PROCEDURE B
1. CHECK COOLING FAN RELAY GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect cooling fan relay-2 and cooling fan relay-4.
3. Check harness continuity between cooling fan relay-2 terminal 5
and ground, cooling fan relay-4 terminal 5 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
2. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect smart entrance control unit harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between cooling fan relay-2 terminal 2
and smart entrance control unit terminal 32, cooling fan relay-4
terminal 2 and smart entrance control unit terminal 32.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0137E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0173E
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-1615
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E123, M17 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E110, M94 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-2 and smart entrance control unit
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-4 and smart entrance control unit
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK COOLING FAN RELAYS-2 AND -4
Refer to EC-1619, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace cooling fan relays.
5. CHECK SMART ENTRANCE CONTROL UNIT
Refer to BCS-39, "Trouble Diagnoses" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace smart entrance control unit.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Perform EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
EC-1616
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
PROCEDURE C
1. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTOR-2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect cooling fan relay-3.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between cooling fan relay-3 terminals 2, 3 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Fuse block (J/B) connector E106
G 10A fuse
G 40A fusible link
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-3 and fuse
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-3 and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTOR CONTROL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect cooling fan motor-2 harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between cooling fan relay-3 terminal 5
and cooling fan motor-2 terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or con-
nectors.
MBIB0137E
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0055E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0136E
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-1617
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTOR CONTROL CIRCUIT FOR SHORT TO GROUND
Check harness continuity between cooling fan relay-3 terminal 5 or cooling fan motor-2 terminal 1 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Cooling fan relays-2 and -4 (Refer to EC-1619, "Component Inspection" )
G Harness for short to ground between cooling fan relay-2 and cooling fan motor-2
G Harness for short to ground between cooling fan relay-3 and cooling fan motor-2
G Harness for short to ground between cooling fan relay-4 and cooling fan motor-2
>> Repair or replace.
6. CHECK COOLING FAN OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect smart entrance control unit harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between cooling fan relay-3 terminal 1
and smart entrance control unit terminal 32.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E123, M17 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E110, M94 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-3 and smart entrance control unit
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK COOLING FAN RELAY-3
Refer to EC-1619, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace cooling fan relay.
9. CHECK SMART ENTRANCE CONTROL UNIT
Refer to BCS-39, "Trouble Diagnoses" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> Replace smart entrance control unit.
Continuity should not exist.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0173E
EC-1618
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
10. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Perform EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Main 12 Causes of Overheating EBS00H2J
*1: Turn the ignition switch ON.
*2: Engine running at 3,000 rpm for 10 minutes.
*3: Drive at 90 km/h (55 MPH) for 30 minutes and then let idle for 10 minutes.
*4: After 60 minutes of cool down time.
For more information, refer to CO-25, "OVERHEATING CAUSE ANALYSIS" .
Engine Step Inspection item Equipment Standard Reference page
OFF 1 G Blocked radiator
G Blocked condenser
G Blocked radiator grille
G Blocked bumper
G Visual No blocking
2 G Coolant mixture G Coolant tester 50 - 50% coolant mixture See MA-18, "Engine
Coolant Mixture Ratio" .
3 G Coolant level G Visual Coolant up to MAX level
in reservoir tank and radi-
ator filler neck
See CO-29, "LEVEL
CHECK" .
4 G Radiator cap G Pressure tester 59 - 98 kPa
(0.59 - 0.98 bar, 0.6 - 1.0
kg/cm
2
, 9 - 14 psi) (Limit)
See MA-22, "CHECKING
RADIATOR CAP" .
ON*
2 5 G Coolant leaks G Visual No leaks See CO-29, "LEAK
CHECK" .
ON*
2
6 G Thermostat G Touch the upper and
lower radiator hoses
Both hoses should be hot See CO-40, "THERMO-
STAT AND WATER CON-
TROL VALVE" , and CO-
31, "RADIATOR" .
ON*
1
7 G Cooling fan G CONSULT-II Operating See trouble diagnosis for
DTC P1217 (EC-1603 ).
OFF 8 G Combustion gas leak G Color checker chemical
tester 4 Gas analyzer
Negative
ON*
3
9 G Coolant temperature
gauge
G Visual Gauge less than 3/4
when driving

G Coolant overflow to
reservoir tank
G Visual No overflowduring driving
and idling
See MA-20, "Changing
Engine Coolant" .
OFF*
4 10 G Coolant return from
reservoir tank to radia-
tor
G Visual Should be initial level in
reservoir tank
See CO-29, "LEVEL
CHECK" .
OFF 11 G Cylinder head G Straight gauge feeler
gauge
0.1 mm (0.004 in) Maxi-
mum distortion (warping)
See EM-152, "CYLIN-
DER HEAD" .
12 G Cylinder block and pis-
tons
G Visual No scuffing on cylinder
walls or piston
See EM-165, "CYLIN-
DER BLOCK" .
DTC P1217 ENGINE OVER TEMPERATURE
EC-1619
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Component Inspection EBS00H2K
COOLING FAN RELAY-1 AND -3
Check continuity between terminals 3 and 5 under the following con-
ditions.
COOLING FAN RELAY-2 AND -4
Check continuity between terminals 3 and 4, 3 and 5 under the fol-
lowing conditions.
COOLING FAN MOTOR-1 AND -2
1. Disconnect cooling fan motor harness connectors.
2. Supply cooling fan motor terminals with battery voltage and
check operation.
Conditions Continuity
12V direct current supply between ter-
minals 1 and 2
Yes
No current supply No
MBIB0057E
Conditions Terminals Continuity
12V direct current supply
between terminals 1 and 2
3 and 4 No
3 and 5 Yes
No current supply
3 and 4 Yes
3 and 5 No
MBIB0056E
Terminals
(+) (-)
Cooling fan motor 1 2
SEF721Q
EC-1620
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00H2L
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor,
throttle position sensor, etc. The throttle position sensor responds to
the throttle valve movement.
The throttle position sensor has the two sensors. These sensors are
a kind of potentiometers which transform the throttle valve position
into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM. In addi-
tion, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of the
throttle valve and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM
judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these sig-
nals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the
throttle valve opening angle properly in response to driving condi-
tion.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H2M
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H2N
These self-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H2O
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0145E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
THRTL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released More than 0.36V
G Shift lever:
D (CVT model)
1st (M/T model)
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1223
1223
Throttle position sensor 2
circuit low input
An excessively low voltage from the TP sensor 2
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The TP sensor 2 circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 2)
P1224
1224
Throttle position sensor 2
circuit high input
An excessively high voltage from the TP sensor 2
is sent to ECM.
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of the throttle valve to be slower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
EC-1621
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1623, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle for 1 seconds.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1623, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
EC-1622
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00H2P
MBWA0126E
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
EC-1623
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H2Q
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
47 G
Throttle position sensor
power supply
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
49 W Throttle position sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
More than 0.36V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
Less than 4.75V
66 B Sensors' ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
68 R Throttle position sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
Less than 4.75V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT model)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T model)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 0.36V
MBIB0142E
EC-1624
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
2. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between electric throttle control actuator terminal
1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 66 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 68 and electric throttle control actuator terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
Refer to EC-1625, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
MBIB0133E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0082E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
DTC P1223, P1224 TP SENSOR
EC-1625
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H2R
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Set selector lever to D position (CVT models) or 1st position (M/T models).
5. Check voltage between ECM terminals 49 (TP sensor 1 signal),
68 (TP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the following
conditions.
6. If NG, replace electric throttle control actuator and go to the next
step.
7. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
8. Perform EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00H2S
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-116, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
49
(Throttle position sensor 1)
Fully released More than 0.36V
Fully depressed Less than 4.75V
68
(Throttle position sensor 2)
Fully released Less than 4.75V
Fully depressed More than 0.36V
MBIB0022E
EC-1626
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1225 TP SENSOR
DTC P1225 TP SENSOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00H2T
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor,
throttle position sensor, etc. The throttle position sensor responds to
the throttle valve movement.
The throttle position sensor has the two sensors. These sensors are
a kind of potentiometers which transform the throttle valve position
into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM. In addi-
tion, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of the
throttle valve and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM
judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these sig-
nals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the
throttle valve opening angle properly in response to driving condi-
tion.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H2U
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H2V
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1627, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1627, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
PBIB0145E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1225
1225
Closed throttle position
learning performance
problem
Closed throttle position learning value is excessively
low.
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 1 and 2)
SEF058Y
DTC P1225 TP SENSOR
EC-1627
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H2W
1. CHECK ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR VISUALLY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Remove the intake air duct.
3. Check if foreign matter is caught between the throttle valve and
the housing.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Remove the foreign matter and clean the electric throttle
control actuator inside.
2. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
Remove and Installation EBS00H2X
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-116, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
MBIB0143E
EC-1628
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1226 TP SENSOR
DTC P1226 TP SENSOR PFP:16119
Component Description EBS00H2Y
Electric Throttle Control Actuator consists of throttle control motor,
throttle position sensor, etc. The throttle position sensor responds to
the throttle valve movement.
The throttle position sensor has the two sensors. These sensors are
a kind of potentiometers which transform the throttle valve position
into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM. In addi-
tion, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of the
throttle valve and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The ECM
judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these sig-
nals and the ECM controls the throttle control motor to make the
throttle valve opening angle properly in response to driving condi-
tion.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H2Z
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H30
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4, 32 times.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1629, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Repeat step 2, 32 times.
4. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1629, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
PBIB0145E
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1226
1226
Closed throttle position
learning performance
problem
Closed throttle position learning is not performed
successfully, repeatedly.
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 1 and 2)
SEF058Y
DTC P1226 TP SENSOR
EC-1629
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H31
1. CHECK ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR VISUALLY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Remove the intake air duct.
3. Check if foreign matter is caught between the throttle valve and
the housing.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Remove the foreign matter and clean the electric throttle
control actuator inside.
2. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace the electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
Remove and Installation EBS00H32
ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-116, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
MBIB0143E
EC-1630
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR PFP:18002
Component Description EBS00H33
The accelerator pedal position sensor is installed on the upper end
of the accelerator pedal assembly. The sensor detects the accelera-
tor position and sends a signal to the ECM.
Accelerator pedal position sensor has two sensors. These sensors
are a kind of potentiometers which transform the accelerator pedal
position into output voltage, and emit the voltage signal to the ECM.
In addition, these sensors detect the opening and closing speed of
the accelerator pedal and feed the voltage signals to the ECM. The
ECM judges the current opening angle of the accelerator pedal from
these signals and controls the throttle control motor based on these
signals.
Idle position of the accelerator pedal is determined by the ECM
receiving the signal from the accelerator pedal position sensor. The ECM uses this signal for the engine oper-
ation such as fuel cut.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H34
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H35
These half-diagnoses have the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H36
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0146E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
ACCEL SEN2
G Ignition switch: ON
(engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Accelerator pedal: Fully depressed More than 3.9V
CLSD THL POS G Ignition switch: ON
Accelerator pedal: Fully released ON
Accelerator pedal: Slightly depressed OFF
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1227
1227
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2 circuit low input
An excessively low voltage from the APP sensor 2
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The APP sensor 2 circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Accelerator pedal position sensor
(Accelerator pedal position sensor 2)
P1228
1228
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2 circuit high input
An excessively high voltage from the APP sensor 2
is sent to ECM.
Engine operating condition in fail-safe mode
The ECM controls the electric throttle control actuator in regulating the throttle opening in order for the idle position to be within +10
degrees.
The ECM regulates the opening speed of throttle valve to be shower than the normal condition.
So, the acceleration will be poor.
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
EC-1631
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1633, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle for 1 seconds.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1633, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF058Y
EC-1632
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00H37
MBWA0130E
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
EC-1633
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H38
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
45 R Sensors power supply [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
47 G Sensors power supply [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
55 B Sensors ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
66 B Sensors ground
[Ignition switch ON]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
98 LG
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.175 - 0.335V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 1.95V
106 L
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.35 - 0.67V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is D (CVT models)
G Shift lever position is 1st (M/T models)
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.9V
MBIB0142E
EC-1634
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
2. CHECK APP SENSOR 2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor harness
connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between APP sensor terminal 1 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK APP SENSOR 2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 66 and APP sensor terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0152E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0812E
Continuity should exist.
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
EC-1635
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK APP SENSOR 2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 98 and APP sensor terminal 6.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator pedal position sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK APP SENSOR
Refer to EC-1635, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 9.
9. REPLACE APP SENSOR
1. Replace the accelerator pedal position sensor.
2. Perform EC-1440, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
10. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H39
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminals 106 (APP sensor 1 sig-
nal), 98 (APP sensor 2 signal) and engine ground under the fol-
lowing conditions.
Continuity should exist.
Terminal Accelerator pedal Voltage
106
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1)
Fully released 0.35 - 0.67V
Fully depressed More than 3.9V
98
(Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2)
Fully released 0.175 - 0.335V
Fully depressed More than 1.95V
MBIB0023E
EC-1636
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1227, P1228 APP SENSOR
4. If NG, replace accelerator pedal assembly and go to the next step.
5. Perform EC-1440, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
6. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
7. Perform EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
Remove and Installation EBS00H3A
ACCELERATOR PEDAL
Refer to ACC-2, "ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM" .
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY
EC-1637
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY PFP:16119
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H3B
This self-diagnosis has the one trip detection logic.
FAIL-SAFE MODE
When the malfunction is detected, the ECM enters in fail-safe mode and the MI lights up.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H3C
NOTE:
If DTC Confirmation Procedure has been previously conducted, always turn ignition switch OFF and wait at
least 10 seconds before conducting the next test.
TESTING CONDITION:
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V at idle.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and let it idle for 1 second.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1639, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle for 1 seconds.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
3. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1639, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1229
1229
Sensor power supply circuit
short
ECM detects a voltage of power source
for sensor is excessively low or high.
G Harness or connectors
(The TP sensor 1 and 2 circuit is shorted.)
(APP sensor 2 circuit is shorted.)
G Electric throttle control actuator
(TP sensor 1 and 2)
G Accelerator pedal position sensor
(APP sensor 2)
G ECM pin terminal
Engine operation condition in fail-safe mode
ECM stops the electric throttle control actuator control, throttle valve is maintained at a fixed opening (approx. 5 degrees) by the return
spring.
SEF058Y
EC-1638
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY
Wiring Diagram EBS00H3D
MBWA0128E
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY
EC-1639
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H3E
1. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect electric throttle control actuator harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Check voltage between electric throttle control actuator terminal
1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 3.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
47 G Sensor's power supply [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
MBIB0142E
MBIB0133E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0082E
EC-1640
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1229 SENSOR POWER SUPPLY
3. CHECK SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUITS FOR SHORT
Check the following.
G Harness for short to power and short to ground between following terminals.
G ECM pin terminal.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITON SENSOR
Refer to EC-1635, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. REPLACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
1. Replace accelerator pedal position sensor.
2. Perform EC-1440, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
4. Perform EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
6. CHECK THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
Refer to EC-1530, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
7. REPLACE ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Replace electric throttle control actuator.
2. Perform EC-1440, "Throttle Valve Closed Position Learning" .
3. Perform EC-1440, "Idle Air Volume Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
ECM terminal Sensor terminals Reference Wiring Diagram
47
Electric throttle control actuator terminal 1 EC-1638
Accelerator pedal position sensor terminal 1 EC-1632
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH
EC-1641
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH PFP:25320
Description EBS00H3F
Brake switch signal is applied to the ECM through the stop lamp switch when the brake pedal is depressed.
This signal is used mainly to decrease the engine speed when the vehicle is driving.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H3G
Specification data are reference values.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00H3H
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00H3I
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Fully depress the brake pedal for at least 5 seconds.
3. Erase the DTC with CONSULT-II.
4. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
5. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1643, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
WITHOUT CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Fully depress the brake pedal at least 5 seconds.
3. Erase the Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) memory. Refer to EC-1450, "How to Erase
Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic Results)" .
4. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 10 seconds and then turn ON.
5. Perform Diagnostic Test Mode II (Self-diagnostic results) with ECM.
6. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1643, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
BRAKE SW G Ignition switch: ON
Brake pedal: Fully released OFF
Brake pedal: Slightly depressed ON
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P1805
1805
Brake switch
A brake switch signal is not sent to ECM for
an extremely long time while the vehicle is
driving.
G Harness or connectors
(Stop lamp switch circuit is open or shorted.)
G Stop lamp switch
SEF058Y
EC-1642
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH
Wiring Diagram EBS00H3J
MBWA0034E
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH
EC-1643
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H3K
1. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check the stop lamp when depressing and releasing the brake pedal.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect stop lamp switch harness connector.
2. Check voltage between stop lamp switch terminal 1 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
101 R/G Stop lamp switch
[Engine is running]
G Brake pedal fully released
Approximately 0V
[Engine is running]
G Brake pedal depressed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
Brake pedal Stop lamp
Fully released Not illuminated
Depressed Illuminated
MBIB0152E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0117E
EC-1644
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G 15A fuse
G Fuse block (J/B) connector M2
G Harness for open and short between stop lamp switch and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 101 and stop lamp switch terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness for open or short between ECM and stop lamp switch
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH
Refer to EC-1644, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace stop lamp switch.
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H3L
STOP LAMP SWITCH
1. Disconnect stop lamp switch harness connector.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0152E
DTC P1805 BRAKE SWITCH
EC-1645
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Check continuity between stop lamp switch terminals 1 and 2
under the following conditions.
If NG, adjust brake pedal installation, refer to BR-6, "BRAKE
PEDAL" , and perform step 2 again.
Conditions Continuity
Brake pedal fully released Should not exist.
Brake pedal depressed Should exist.
PBIB0118E
EC-1646
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S1 HEATER
HO2S1 HEATER PFP:22690
Description EBS00H3M
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM performs ON/OFF duty control of the heated oxygen sensor 1 heater corresponding to the engine
speed and engine coolant temperature. The duty percent varies with engine coolant temperature when engine
is started.
OPERATION
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H3N
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Engine speed
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater control
Heated oxygen sensor 1
heater
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Engine speed rpm Heated oxygen sensor 1 heater
Above 3,600 OFF
Below 3,600 ON
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 HTR (B1)
G Engine: After warming up
G Engine speed: Below 3,600 rpm
ON
G Engine speed: Above 3,600 rpm OFF
HO2S1 HEATER
EC-1647
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00H3O
MBWA0021E
EC-1648
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S1 HEATER
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H3P
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Set tester prove between ECM terminal 24 (HO2S1 heater signal) and ground.
5. Start engine and let it idle.
6. Check the voltage under the following conditions.
Verify that the oscilloscope screen shows the signal waves as
shown below.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
24 P/L
Heated oxygen sen-
sor 1 heater
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition.
G Engine speed is below 3,600 rpm.
Approximately 7.0V
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
PBIB0519E
Conditions Voltage
At idle
Approximately 7.0V
Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
MBIB0038E
PBIB0519E
HO2S1 HEATER
EC-1649
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK HO2S1 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between HO2S1 terminal 4 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Fuse block (J/B) connector E106
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between heated oxygen sensor 1 and fuse
>> Repair harness or connectors.
4. CHECK HO2S1 OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 24 and HO2S1 terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 HEATER
Refer to EC-1650, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
MBIB0151E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0541E
Continuity should exist.
EC-1650
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S1 HEATER
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H3Q
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1 HEATER
1. Check resistance between HO2S1 terminals as follows.
2. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard sur-
face such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system
threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread Cleaner tool J-43897-
18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00H3R
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-121, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND THREE WAY CATALYST" .
Terminal No. Resistance
1 and 4 2.3 - 4.3 at 25C (77F)
2 and 1, 3, 4

(Continuity should not exist)
3 and 1, 2, 4
PBIB0542E
HO2S2 HEATER
EC-1651
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
HO2S2 HEATER PFP:226A0
Description EBS00H3S
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The ECM performs ON/OFF control of the heated oxygen sensor 2 heater corresponding to the engine speed.
OPERATION
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H3T
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater control
Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Engine speed rpm Heated oxygen sensor 2 heater
Above 3,800 OFF
Below 3,800 ON
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S2 HTR (B1)
G Engine speed: Below 3,800 rpm [After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of
70 km/h (43 MPH) or more]
ON
G Engine speed: Above 3,800 rpm OFF
EC-1652
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S2 HEATER
Wiring Diagram EBS00H3U
MBWA0023E
HO2S2 HEATER
EC-1653
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H3V
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
1. Stop engine and drive the vehicle at over 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle and keep the engine running.
3. Set voltmeter proves between ECM terminal 2 (HO2S2 heater signal) and ground.
4. Check the voltage under the following conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
2 R/W
Heated oxygen sensor 2
heater
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is below 3,800 rpm.
G After driving for 2 minutes at a speed of 70 km/h
(43 MPH) or more.
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Engine stopped
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is above 3,800 rpm.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
Conditions Voltage
At idle 0 - 1V
Engine speed is above 3,600 rpm. Battery voltage
PBIB0673E
EC-1654
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S2 HEATER
2. CHECK HO2S2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between HO2S2 terminal 4 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Fuse block (J/B) connector E106
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between heated oxygen sensor 2 and fuse
>> Repair harness or connectors.
4. CHECK HO2S2 OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 2 and HO2S2 terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2 HEATER
Refer to EC-1655, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
MBIB0151E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0541E
Continuity should exist.
HO2S2 HEATER
EC-1655
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H3W
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2 HEATER
1. Check resistance between HO2S2 terminals as follows.
2. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard sur-
face such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system
threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread Cleaner tool J-43897-
18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00H3X
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EX-3, "EXHAUST SYSTEM" .
Terminal No. Resistance
1 and 4 2.3 - 4.3 at 25C (77F)
2 and 1, 3, 4

(Continuity should not exist)
3 and 1, 2, 4
PBIB0542E
EC-1656
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
IAT SENSOR
IAT SENSOR PFP:22630
Component Description EBS00H3Y
The intake air temperature sensor is built into mass air flow sensor.
The sensor detects intake air temperature and transmits a signal to
the ECM.
The temperature sensing unit uses a thermistor which is sensitive to
the change in temperature. Electrical resistance of the thermistor
decreases in response to the temperature rise.
<Reference data>
*: These data are reference values and are measured between ECM terminal 34
(Intake air temperature sensor) and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output
voltage. Doing so may result in damage to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM termi-
nals, such as the ground.
SEC266C
Intake air
temperature C (F)
Voltage* V Resistance k
10 (14) 4.43 7.9 - 9.3
25 (77) 3.32 1.9 - 2.1
80 (176) 1.23 0.31 - 0.37
SEF012P
IAT SENSOR
EC-1657
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00H3Z
MBWA0020E
EC-1658
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
IAT SENSOR
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H40
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 34 and ground with CON-
SULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect mass air flow sensor (intake air temperature sensor
is built-into) harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between MAF sensor terminal 5 and ground.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair harness or connectors.
3. CHECK INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between MAF sensor terminal 3 and ECM terminal 54.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair harness or connectors.
Voltage: 0.04 - 4.84V
MBIB0041E
MBIB0131E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0066E
Continuity should exist.
IAT SENSOR
EC-1659
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. CHECK INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Refer to EC-1513, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace mass air flow sensor (with intake air temperature sensor).
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H41
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Check resistance between mass air flow sensor terminals 3 and
5 under the following conditions.
2. If NG, replace mass air flow sensor (with intake air temperature
sensor).
Removal and Installation EBS00H42
MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EM-114, "AIR CLEANER AND AIR DUCT" .
Intake air temperature C (F) Resistance k
25 (77) 1.9 - 2.1
SEC266C
SEF012P
EC-1660
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S1
HO2S1 PFP:22690
Component Description EBS00H43
The heated oxygen sensor 1 is placed into the exhaust manifold. It
detects the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas compared to the
outside air. The heated oxygen sensor 1 has a closed-end tube
made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates voltage from
approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner conditions. The
heated oxygen sensor 1 signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM adjusts
the injection pulse duration to achieve the ideal air-fuel ratio. The
ideal air-fuel ratio occurs near the radical change from 1V to 0V.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H44
Specification data are reference values.
SEF463R
SEF288D
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S1 (B1) G Engine: After warming up Maintaining engine speed at 2,000 rpm 0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S1 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up Maintaining engine speed at 2,000 rpm
LEAN RICH
Changes more than 5 times during
10 seconds.
HO2S1
EC-1661
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00H45
MBWA0021E
EC-1662
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S1
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H46
1. INSPECTION START
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
35 PU Heated oxygen sensor 1
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
(Periodically change)
74 B Sensors' ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
MBIB0142E
HO2S1
EC-1663
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select HO2S1 MNTR (B1) in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Keep the engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load, and make
sure that the monitors fluctuates between LEAN and RICH more
than five times in 10 seconds.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Stop engine and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Set ECM in Diagnostic test mode - II (Heated oxygen sensor 1 monitor).
Refer to EC-1449, "HOW TO SWITCH DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE" .
4. Keep the engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load, and make
sure that the MI comes ON more than five times in 10 seconds.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. CHECK HO2S1 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 1 harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S1
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
1 time: RICH LEAN RICH
2 times: RICH LEAN RICH LEAN RICH
SEF820Y
SAT652J
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0151E
EC-1664
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S1
4. CHECK HO2S1 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 and HO2S1 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 35 or HO2S1 terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EC-1664, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 1.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H47
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Select MANU TRIG and adjust TRIGGER POINT to 100% in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-
II.
3. Select HO2S1 (B1) and HO2S1 MNTR (B1).
4. Hold engine speed at 2,000 rpm under no load during the follow-
ing steps.
5. Touch RECORD on CONSULT-II screen.
6. Check the following.
G HO2S1 MNTR (B1) in DATA MONITOR mode changes
from RICH to LEAN to RICH 5 times in 10 seconds.
5 times (cycles) are counted as shown at right.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes above 0.6V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage goes below 0.3V at least once.
G HO2S1 (B1) voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
SEF646Y
SEF217YA
HO2S1
EC-1665
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 35 [HO2S1 (B1) signal] and engine ground.
3. Check the following with engine speed held at 2,000 rpm con-
stant under no load.
G The voltage fluctuates between 0 to 0.3V and 0.6 to 1.0V
more than 5 times within 10 seconds.
G The maximum voltage is over 0.6V at least one time.
G The minimum voltage is below 0.3V at least one time.
G The voltage never exceeds 1.0V.
1 time: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V
2 times: 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V 0 - 0.3V 0.6 - 1.0V
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped
from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7 in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new
one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Removal and Installation EBS00H48
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 1
Refer to EM-121, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND THREE WAY CATALYST" .
SEF648Y
MBIB0018E
EC-1666
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S2
HO2S2 PFP:226A0
Component Description EBS00H49
The heated oxygen sensor 2, after three way catalyst (manifold),
monitors the oxygen level in the exhaust gas on each bank.
Even if switching characteristics of the heated oxygen sensor 1 are
shifted, the air fuel ratio is controlled to stoichiometric, by the signal
from the heated oxygen sensor 2.
This sensor is made of ceramic zirconia. The zirconia generates volt-
age from approximately 1V in richer conditions to 0V in leaner condi-
tions.
Under normal conditions the heated oxygen sensor 2 is not used for
engine control operation.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H4A
Specification data are reference values.
SEF327R
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
HO2S2 (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
0 - 0.3V Approx. 0.6 - 1.0V
HO2S2 MNTR (B1) G Engine: After warming up
Revving engine from idle to 3,000
rpm quickly.
LEAN RICH
HO2S2
EC-1667
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00H4B
MBWA0023E
EC-1668
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S2
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H4C
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION-I
1. Start engine and drive the vehicle at over 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle and keep the engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 (HO2S2 signal) and ground.
4. Check the voltage while revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times. (Depress and release the accelerator pedal as
quickly as possible.)
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION-II
Keep engine at idle for 10 minutes, then check the voltage between ECM terminal 16 and ground, or check
voltage when coasting 80 km/h (50 MPH) in 3rd gear (M/T) or D position (CVT).
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. RETIGHTEN GROUND SCREWS
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
>> GO TO 4.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
16 W/Y Heated oxygen sensor 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - Approximately 1.0V
74 B Sensors' ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
The voltage does not remain in the range of 0.2 -0.4V
MBIB0020E
The voltage does not remain in the range of 0.2 -0.4V
MBIB0142E
HO2S2
EC-1669
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. CHECK HO2S2 GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect heated oxygen sensor 2 harness connector.
3. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 74 and HO2S2
terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK HO2S2 INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 16 and HO2S2 terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 16 or HO2S2 terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EC-1669, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H4D
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0151E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should not exist.
EC-1670
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
HO2S2
3. Select FUEL INJECTION in ACTIVE TEST mode, and select
HO2S2 (B1) as the monitor item with CONSULT-II.
4. Check HO2S2 (B1) at idle speed when adjusting FUEL INJECTION to 25%.
HO2S2 (B1) should be above 0.68V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is +25%.
HO2S2 (B1) should be below 0.50V at least once when the FUEL INJECTION is 25%.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and drive vehicle at a speed of more than 70 km/h (43 MPH) for 2 consecutive minutes.
2. Stop vehicle with engine running.
3. Set voltmeter probes between ECM terminal 16 [HO2S2 (B1) signal] and engine ground.
4. Check the voltage when revving up to 4,000 rpm under no load
at least 10 times.
(Depress and release accelerator pedal as soon as possible.)
The voltage should be above 0.68V at least once during this
procedure.
If the voltage is above 0.68V at step 4, step 5 is not neces-
sary.
5. Keep vehicle idling for 10 minutes, then check voltage. Or check
the voltage when coasting from 80 km/h (50 MPH) in D posi-
tion (CVT), 3rd gear position (M/T).
The voltage should be below 0.50V at least once during this
procedure.
6. If NG, replace heated oxygen sensor 2.
CAUTION:
G Discard any heated oxygen sensor which has been dropped from a height of more than 0.5 m (19.7
in) onto a hard surface such as a concrete floor; use a new one.
G Before installing new oxygen sensor, clean exhaust system threads using Oxygen Sensor Thread
Cleaner tool J-43897-18 or J-43897-12 and approved anti-seize lubricant.
SEF662Y
PBIB0551E
MBIB0020E
HO2S2
EC-1671
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Removal and Installation EBS00H4E
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR 2
Refer to EX-3, "EXHAUST SYSTEM" .
EC-1672
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
IGNITION SIGNAL
IGNITION SIGNAL PFP:22448
Component Description EBS00H4F
IGNITION COIL & POWER TRANSISTOR
The ignition signal from the ECM is sent to and amplified by the
power transistor. The power transistor turns on and off the ignition
coil primary circuit. This on-off operation induces the proper high
voltage in the coil secondary circuit.
MBIB0132E
IGNITION SIGNAL
EC-1673
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00H4G
MBWA0029E
EC-1674
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
IGNITION SIGNAL
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
111 W/G
ECM relay
(Self shut-off)
[Engine is running]
[Ignition switch OFF]
G For a few seconds after turning ignition
switch OFF
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch OFF]
G More than a few seconds passed after turn-
ing ignition switch OFF
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
119
120
W/R
W/R
Power supply for ECM [Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
121 W/L
Power supply for ECM
(Buck-up)
[Ignition switch OFF]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
IGNITION SIGNAL
EC-1675
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
MBWA0030E
EC-1676
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
IGNITION SIGNAL
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H4H
1. CHECK ENGINE START
Turn ignition switch OFF, and restart engine.
Is engine running?
Yes or No
Yes (With CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 2.
Yes (Without CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 3.
No >> GO TO 4.
2. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
With CONSULT-II
1. Perform POWER BALANCE in ACTIVE TEST mode with CONSULT-II.
2. Make sure that each circuit produces a momentary engine
speed drop.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 12.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
60
61
79
80
L/Y
Y/R
GY/L
PU/G
Ignition signal No. 3
Ignition signal No. 1
Ignition signal No. 4
Ignition signal No. 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0 - 0.1V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm.
0 - 0.2V
PBIB0521E
PBIB0522E
PBIB0133E
IGNITION SIGNAL
EC-1677
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
Without CONSULT-II
1. Let engine idle.
2. Read the voltage signal between ECM terminals 60, 61, 79, 80
and ground with an oscilloscope.
3. Verify that the oscilloscope screen shows the signal wave as
shown below.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 12.
4. CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-I
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminals 119, 120 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Go to EC-1499, "POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR
ECM" .
5. CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-II
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect condenser harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between condenser terminal 1 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 6.
MBIB0033E
PBIB0521E
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0034E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0624E
EC-1678
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
IGNITION SIGNAL
6. CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-III
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM relay.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM relay terminal 7 and condenser terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-IV
Check voltage between ECM relay terminal 6 and ground with CON-
SULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> GO TO 8.
8. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E70, F13 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E63, F31 (RHD models)
G 20A fuse
G Harness for open or short between ECM relay and battery
>> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
9. CHECK ECM RELAY
Refer to EC-1680, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> Replace ECM relay.
10. CHECK CONDENSER GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect condenser harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between condenser terminal 2 and ground.
Refer to Wiring diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connector.
Continuity should exist.
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0625E
Continuity should exist.
IGNITION SIGNAL
EC-1679
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
11. CHECK CONDENSER
Refer to EC-1680, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Replace condenser.
12. CHECK IGNITION COIL POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-V
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
3. Disconnect ignition coil harness connector.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
5. Check voltage between ignition coil terminal 1 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14.
NG >> GO TO 13.
13. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check harness for open or short between ignition coil and ECM relay.
>> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
14. CHECK IGNITION COIL GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between ignition coil terminal 2 and engine ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 15.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0132E
Voltage: Battery voltage
SEF107S
Continuity should exist.
EC-1680
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
IGNITION SIGNAL
15. CHECK IGNITION COIL OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals 60, 61, 79, 80 and ignition coil terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 16.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
16. CHECK IGNITION COIL WITH POWER TRANSISTOR
Refer to EC-1680, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 17.
NG >> Replace ignition coil with power transistor.
17. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H4I
ECM RELAY
1. Apply 12V direct current between ECM relay terminals 1 and 2.
2. Check continuity between relay terminals 3 and 5, 6 and 7.
3. If NG, replace ECM relay.
CONDENSER
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect condenser harness connector.
3. Check resistance between condenser terminals 1 and 2.
IGNITION COIL WITH POWER TRANSISTOR
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ignition coil harness connector.
Continuity should exist.
Condition Continuity
12V direct current supply between ter-
minals 1 and 2
Yes
OFF No
PBIB0077E
Resistance: Above 1 M at 25C (77F)
MBIB0031E
IGNITION SIGNAL
EC-1681
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. Check resistance between ignition coil terminals as follows.
Removal and Installation EBS00H4J
IGNITION COIL WITH POWER TRANSISTOR
Refer to EM-126, "IGNITION COIL" .
Terminal No. Resistance [at 25C (77F)]
2 and 3 Except 0 or
1 and 2
Except 0
1 and 3
MBIB0032E
EC-1682
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE PFP:14920
Description EBS00H4K
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
*1: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
*2: This signal is sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
This system controls flow rate of fuel vapor from the EVAP canister. The opening of the vapor by-pass pas-
sage in the EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve changes to control the flow rate. The EVAP
canister purge volume control solenoid valve repeats ON/OFF operation according to the signal sent from the
ECM. The opening of the valve varies for optimum engine control. The optimum value stored in the ECM is
determined by considering various engine conditions. When the engine is operating, the flow rate of fuel vapor
from the EVAP canister is regulated as the air flow changes.
COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
The EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve uses a ON/
OFF duty to control the flow rate of fuel vapor from the EVAP canis-
ter. The EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve is
moved by ON/OFF pulses from the ECM. The longer the ON pulse,
the greater the amount of fuel vapor that will flow through the valve.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H4L
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed*
1
EVAP canister
purge flow control
EVAP canister purge volume
control solenoid valve
Mass air flow sensor Amount of intake air
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Battery
Battery voltage*
1
Throttle position sensor Throttle position
Accelerator pedal position sensor Closed throttle position
Heated oxygen sensors 1
Density of oxygen in exhaust gas
(Mixture ratio feedback signal)
Vehicle speed signal*
2
Vehicle speed
SEF337U
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
PURG VOL C/V
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 0%
2,000 rpm 20 - 30%
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
EC-1683
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00H4M
MBWA0025E
EC-1684
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
19 P
EVAP canister purge
volume control solenoid
valve
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Engine speed is about 2,000 rpm
(More than 100 seconds after starting engine)
Approximately 10V
PBIB0050E
PBIB0520E
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
EC-1685
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H4N
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect the EVAP purge hose connected to the EVAP canister.
3. Turn ignition switch ON, and select PURG VOL CONT/V in ACTIVE TEST mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Start engine and let it idle.
5. Change the valve opening percentage with touching Qu or
Qd on CONSULT-II screen, and check for vacuum existence at
the EVAP purge hose under the following conditions.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect the EVAP purge hose connected to the EVAP canis-
ter.
3. Start engine and let it idle for at least 80 seconds.
4. Check for vacuum existence at the EVAP purge hose under the
following conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> GO TO 3.
2. CHECK EVAP CANISTER
Refer to EC-1688, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> Replace EVAP canister.
PBIB0569E
Conditions Vacuum
At idle Should not exist.
Engine speed is about 2,000 rpm. Should exist.
MBIB0172E
Conditions Vacuum
At idle Should not exist.
Engine speed is about 2,000 rpm. Should exist.
MBIB0172E
EC-1686
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
3. CHECK EVAP PURGE LINE
Check EVAP purge line (pipe, rubber tube, fuel tank and EVAP canister) for cracks or improper connection.
Refer to EC-1724, "EVAPORATIVE EMISSION LINE DRAWING" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair or reconnect the hose.
4. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE POWER SUPPLY CIR-
CUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve
harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve terminal 1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness for open or short between EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve and ECM
>> Repair harness or connectors.
MBIB0133E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0148E
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
EC-1687
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OUTPUT SIGNAL CIR-
CUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 19 and EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid
valve terminal 2. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK (With CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 7.
OK (Without CONSULT-II)>>GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground and short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OPERATION
With CONSULT-II
1. Reconnect all harness connectors disconnected.
2. Start engine.
3. Perform PURG VOL CONT/V in ACTIVE TEST mode with
CONSULT-II. Check that engine speed varies according to the
valve opening.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> GO TO 8.
8. CHECK EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Refer to EC-1688, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve.
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Continuity should exist.
PBIB0569E
EC-1688
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Component Inspection EBS00H4O
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
With CONSULT-II
Check air passage continuity of EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve under the following conditions.
Without CONSULT-II
Check air passage continuity of EVAP canister purge volume control
solenoid valve under the following conditions.
Removal and Installation EBS00H4P
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Refer to EM-116, "INTAKE MANIFOLD" .
Condition
(PURG VOL CONT/V value)
Air passage continuity
between A and B
100.0% Yes
0.0% No
PBIB0149E
Condition
Air passage continuity
between A and B
12V direct current supply between termi-
nals 1 and 2
Yes
No supply No
PBIB0150E
IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
EC-1689
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE PFP:23796
Description EBS00H9N
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
*: This signal is sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
This mechanism hydraulically controls cam phases continuously with the fixed operating angle of the intake
valve.
The ECM receives signals such as crankshaft position, camshaft position, engine speed, and engine coolant
temperature. Then, the ECM sends ON/OFF pulse duty signals to the intake valve timing control solenoid
valve depending on driving status. This makes it possible to control the shut/open timing of the intake valve to
increase engine torque in low/mid speed range and output in high-speed range.
COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
Intake valve timing control solenoid valve is activated by ON/OFF
pulse duty (ratio) signals from the ECM.
The intake valve timing control solenoid valve changes the oil
amount and direction of flow through intake valve timing control unit
or stops oil flow.
The longer pulse width advances valve angle.
The shorter pulse width retards valve angle.
When ON and OFF pulse widths become equal, the solenoid valve
stops oil pressure flow to fix the intake valve angle at the control
position.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H4R
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Engine speed
Intake valve
timing control
Intake valve timing control
solenoid valve
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Vehicle speed signal* Vehicle speed
PBIB0540E
PBIB0195E
EC-1690
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
INT/V SOL (B1)
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 0% - 2%
When revving engine up to 2,000 rpm
quickly
Approx. 0% - 50%
IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
EC-1691
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00H4S
MBWA0026E
EC-1692
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H4T
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION CHECK
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch "OFF" and wait at least 10 seconds.
3. Turn ignition switch "ON".
4. Set the tester probe between ECM terminals 62 (IVT control solenoid valve signal) and ground.
5. Start engine and let it idle.
6. Check the voltage under the following conditions.
Verify that the oscilloscope screen shows the signal wave as
shown below.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
62 Y
Intake valve timing
control solenoid valve
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G When revving engine up to 2,000 rpm quickly
Approximately 4V - BATTERY
VOLTAGE (11 - 14V)
MBIB0052E
PBIB0532E
Conditions Voltage
At idle
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
When revving engine up
to 2,000 rpm quickly
Approximately 4V - BATTERY VOLTAGE (11 - 14V)
SEF955V
PBIB0532E
IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
EC-1693
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. CHECK POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect intake valve timing control solenoid valve harness
connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between intake valve timing control solenoid
valve terminal 1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTION PART
Check harness for open or short between intake valve timing control solenoid valve and ECM relay.
>> Repair or replace harness or connectors.
4. CHECK INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR
OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 62 and intake valve timing control solenoid valve termi-
nal 2. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Refer to EC-1694, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace intake valve timing control solenoid valve.
MBIB0138E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0285E
Continuity should exist.
EC-1694
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
IVT CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
6. CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (POS)
Refer to EC-1560, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace crankshaft position sensor (POS).
7. CHECK CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (PHASE)
Refer to EC-1567, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace camshaft position sensor (PHASE).
8. CHECK CAMSHAFT (INTAKE)
Check the following.
G Accumulation of debris to the signal plate of camshaft rear end
G Chipping signal plate of camshaft rear end
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Remove debris and clean the signal plate of camshaft
rear end or replace camshaft.
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H4U
INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
1. Disconnect intake valve timing control solenoid valve harness connector.
2. Check resistance between intake valve timing control solenoid
valve terminals 1 and 2 under the following conditions.
Removal and Installation EBS00H4V
INTAKE VALVE TIMING CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Refer to EM-143, "TIMING CHAIN" .
PBIB0565E
Terminals Resistance
1 and 2 Approximately 8 at 20C (68F)
1 or 2 and ground

(Continuity should not exist)
MBIB0027E
PNP SWITCH
EC-1695
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
PNP SWITCH PFP:32006
Component Description EBS00H4W
When the shift lever position is P (CVT models only) or N, park/neutral position (PNP) switch is ON.
ECM detects the position because the continuity of the line (the ON signal) exists.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H4X
Specification data are reference values.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
P/N POSI SW G Ignition switch: ON
Shift lever:
P or N (CVT model)
Neutral (M/T model)
ON
Shift lever: Except above OFF
EC-1696
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
PNP SWITCH
Wiring Diagram EBS00H4Y
MBWA0027E
PNP SWITCH
EC-1697
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H4Z
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select P/N POSI SW in DATA MONITOR mode with CON-
SULT-II.
3. Check the P/N POSI SW signal under the following conditions.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal 102 and ground under the
following conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
74
(CVT
models)
B Sensors' ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
102
P (CVT)
L (M/T)
PNP switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Shift lever position is P (CVT models) or N,
Neutral (M/T models).
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Except the above gear position
CVT models
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
M/T models
Approximately 5V
Selector lever position P/N POSI SW signal
P and N position ON
Except the above position OFF
PBIB0102E
Selector lever position Voltage
P and N position Approximately 0V
Except the above position
CVT models: Battery voltage
M/T models: Approximately 5V
MBIB0043E
EC-1698
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
PNP SWITCH
2. CHECK GROUND CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect PNP switch harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between PNP switch terminal 2 and
ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 4.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the foloowing.
G Harness for open and short between PNP switch and ECM (CVT models)
G Harness for open and short between PNP switch and gound (M/T models)
>> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 102 and PNP switch terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK PNP SWITCH
Refer to CVT-204, "PNP Switch, Stop Lamp Switch and Throttle Position Switch" (CVT models) or MT-126,
"PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH" (M/T models).
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace PNP switch.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0171E
Continuity should exist.
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
EC-1699
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
INJECTOR CIRCUIT PFP:16600
Component Description EBS00H50
The fuel injector is a small, precise solenoid valve. When the ECM
supplies a ground to the injector circuit, the coil in the injector is
energized. The energized coil pulls the needle valve back and allows
fuel to flow through the injector into the intake manifold. The amount
of fuel injected depends upon the injection pulse duration. Pulse
duration is the length of time the injector remains open. The ECM
controls the injection pulse duration based on engine fuel needs.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H51
Specification data are reference values.
SEF375Z
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
B/FUEL SCHDL
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 2.5 - 3.5 msec
2,000 rpm 2.5 - 3.5 msec
INJ PULSE-B1
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: N
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G No-load
Idle 2.0 - 3.0 msec
2,000 rpm 1.9 - 2.9 msec
EC-1700
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
Wiring Diagram EBS00H52
MBWA0028E
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
EC-1701
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H53
1. INSPECTION START
Turn ignition switch to START.
Is any cylinder ignited?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> GO TO 3.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
22
23
41
42
G/B
SB
L
R/W
Injector No. 3
Injector No. 1
Injector No. 4
Injector No. 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
PBIB0529E
PBIB0530E
EC-1702
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
2. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Perform POWER BALANCE in ACTIVE TEST mode with
CONSULT-II.
3. Make sure that each circuit produces a momentary engine
speed drop.
Without CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Listen to each injector operating sound.
Clicking noise should be heard.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 3.
PBIB0133E
MEC703B
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
EC-1703
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
3. CHECK INJECTOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect injector harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between injector terminal 1 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness connectors F24, F81
G Fuse block (J/B) connector M1
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between injector and fuse
>> Repair harness or connectors.
5. CHECK INJECTOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between injector terminal 2 and ECM terminals 22, 23, 41, 42.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
MBIB0146E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0582E
Continuity should exist.
EC-1704
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
INJECTOR CIRCUIT
6. DETECT MALFONCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors F81, F24
G Harness for open or short between injector and ECM
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK INJECTOR
Refer to EC-1704, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace injector.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H54
INJECTOR
1. Disconnect injector harness connector.
2. Check resistance between terminals as shown in the figure.
Removal and Installation EBS00H55
INJECTOR
Refer to EM-128, "FUEL INJECTOR AND FUEL TUBE" .
Resistance: 12.1 - 12.9 [at 20C (68F)]
PBIB0181E
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
EC-1705
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT PFP:17042
Description EBS00H56
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
*: ECM determines the start signal status by the signals of engine speed and battery voltage.
The ECM activates the fuel pump for several seconds after the ignition switch is turned on to improve engine
startability. If the ECM receives a engine speed signal from the crankshaft position sensor (POS) and cam-
shaft position sensor (PHASE), it knows that the engine is rotating, and causes the pump to operate. If the
engine speed signal is not received when the ignition switch is ON, the engine stalls. The ECM stops pump
operation and prevents battery discharging, thereby improving safety. The ECM does not directly drive the fuel
pump. It controls the ON/OFF fuel pump relay, which in turn controls the fuel pump.
COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
A turbine type design fuel pump is used in the fuel tank.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H57
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (POS)
Camshaft position sensor (PHASE)
Engine speed*
Fuel pump control Fuel pump relay
Battery Battery voltage*
Condition Fuel pump operation
Ignition switch is turned to ON. Operates for 1 second.
Engine running and cranking Operates.
When engine is stopped Stops in 1.5 seconds.
Except as shown above Stops.
MBIB0046E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
FUEL PUMP RLY
G For 1 seconds after turning ignition switch ON
G Engine running or cranking
ON
G Except above conditions OFF
EC-1706
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
Wiring Diagram EBS00H58
MBWA0031E
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
EC-1707
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H59
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Pinch fuel feed hose with two fingers.
Fuel pressure pulsation should be felt on the fuel hose for 1
second after ignition switch is turned ON.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK FUEL PUMP RELAY POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect fuel pump relay.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between fuel pump relay terminals 1, 5 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
113 B/P Fuel pump relay
[Ignition switch ON]
G For 1 seconds after turning ignition switch ON
[Engine is running]
0 - 1.0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G More than 1 seconds after turning ignition switch
ON.
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
MBIB0069E
MBIB0154E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0657E
EC-1708
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Fuse block (J/B) connector B1
G 10A fuse
G 15A fuse
G Harness for open or short between fuel pump relay and fuse
>> Repair harness or connectors.
4. CHECK FUEL PUMP POWER SUPPLY AND GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump harness con-
nector.
3. Check harness continuity between fuel pump relay terminal 3
and fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump terminal 5, fuel level
sensor unit and fuel pump terminal 3 and body ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors B37, D83 (Wagon)
G Harness for open or short between fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump and fuel pump relay
G Harness for open or short between fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump and body ground
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK FUEL PUMP RELAY OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 113 and fuel pump relay terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0115E
Continuity should exist.
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
EC-1709
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Harness connectors B5, M23 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors B42, M95 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between ECM and fuel pump relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK FUEL PUMP RELAY
Refer to EC-1709, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace fuel pump relay.
9. CHECK FUEL PUMP
Refer to EC-1709, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> Replace fuel pump.
10. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00H5A
FUEL PUMP RELAY
Check continuity between terminals 3 and 5 under the following con-
ditions.
FUEL PUMP
1. Disconnect fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump harness connector.
2. Check resistance between fuel level sensor unit and fuel pump
terminals 3 and 5.
Conditions Continuity
12V direct current supply between ter-
minals 1 and 2
Yes
No current supply No
PBIB0098E
Resistance: Approximately 1.0 [at 25C (77F)]
PBIB0658E
EC-1710
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
FUEL PUMP CIRCUIT
Removal and Installation EBS00H5B
FUEL PUMP
Refer to FL-6, "FUEL LEVEL SENSOR UNIT, FUEL FILTER AND FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY (EXCEPT
YD22DDTi)" .
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
EC-1711
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR PFP:92136
Component Description EBS00H5C
The refrigerant pressure sensor is installed at the liquid tank of the
air conditioner system. The sensor uses an electrostatic volume
pressure transducer to convert refrigerant pressure to voltage. The
voltage signal is sent to ECM, and ECM controls cooling fan system.
MBIB0135E
SEF099X
EC-1712
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00H5D
MBWA0033E
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
EC-1713
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H5E
1. CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR OVERALL FUNCTION
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn A/C switch and blower switch ON.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminal 69 and ground with CON-
SULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
55 B Sensor's ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
46 R
Sensor's power supply
(Refrigerant pressure sen-
sor)
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
69 L Refrigerant pressure sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Both A/C switch and blower switch are ON.
(Compressor operates.)
1.0 - 4.0V
Voltage: 1.0 - 4.0V
MBIB0035E
EC-1714
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
2. CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn A/C switch and blower switch OFF.
2. Stop engine.
3. Disconnect refrigerant pressure sensor harness connector.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
5. Check voltage between refrigerant pressure sensor terminal 3
and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E70, F13 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E63, F31 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between ECM and refrigerant pressure sensor
>> Repair harness or connectors.
4. CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 55 and refrigerant pressure sensor terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
MBIB0135E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
SEF479Y
Continuity should exist.
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
EC-1715
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness for open or short between ECM and refrigerant pressure sensor
G Harness for open or short between TCM and refrigerant pressure sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 69 and refrigerant pressure sensor terminal 2.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness for open or short between ECM and refrigerant pressure sensor
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
OK or NG
OK >> Replace refrigerant pressure sensor.
NG >> Repair or replace.
Removal and Installation EBS00H5F
REFRIGERANT PRESSURE SENSOR
Refer to ATC-127, "REFRIGERANT LINES" .
Continuity should exist.
EC-1716
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL PFP:25350
Description EBS00H5G
The electrical load signals except headlamp switch signal are transferred through the CAN communication
line.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00H5H
Specification data are reference values.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
LOAD SIGNAL G Ignition switch: ON
Rear window defogger switch is ON and/or
lighting switch is 2nd.
ON
Rear window defogger switch is OFF and light-
ing switch is OFF.
OFF
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL
EC-1717
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00H5I
MBWA0147E
EC-1718
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00H5J
1. INSPECTION START
Do you have CONSULT-II?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> GO TO 3.
2. CHECK LOAD SIGNAL CIRCUIT OVERALL FUNCTION-I
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Connect CONSULT-II and select "DATA MONITOR" mode.
3. Select "LOAD SIGNAL" and check indication under the following
conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 6.
3. CHECK LOAD SIGNAL CIRCUIT OVERALL FUNCTION-I
Without CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Turn rear window defogger switch ON.
3. Make sure that rear window defogger system operates normally.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 6.
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
84 R/Y
Electrical load signal
(Headlamp signal)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Lighting switch is 2ND position
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Lighting switch is OFF
Approximately 0V
Condition Indication
Rear window defogger switch "ON" ON
Rear window defogger switch "OFF" OFF
PBIB0103E
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL
EC-1719
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. CHECK LOAD SIGNAL CIRCUIT OVERALL FUNCTION-II
With CONSULT-II
Check "LOAD SIGNAL" indication under the following conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 7.
5. CHECK LOAD SIGNAL CIRCUIT OVERALL FUNCTION-II
Without CONSULT-II
Check voltage between ECM terminal 84 and ground under the fol-
lowing conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 7.
6. CHECK REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
Refer to GW-40, "REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER" .
>> INSPECTION END
7. CHECK HEADLAMP FUNCTION
1. Turn lighting switch ON at 2nd position.
2. Check that headlamps are illuminated.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Refer to LT-5, "HEADLAMP -CONVENTIONAL TYPE-" , LT-10, "HEADLAMP - XENON TYPE -" ,
LT-18, "HEADLAMP (WITH DAYTIME) - CONVENTIONAL TYPE -" or LT-25, "HEADLAMP
(WITH DAYTIME) - XENON TYPE -" .
Condition Indication
Lighting switch "ON" at 2nd position ON
Lighting switch "OFF" OFF
PBIB0103E
Condition Voltage
Lighting switch "ON" at 2nd position Battery voltage
Lighting switch "OFF" Approximately 0V
MBIB0158E
EC-1720
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
ELECTRICAL LOAD SIGNAL
8. CHECK HEADLAMP INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
CONVENTIONAL TYPE HEADLAMP WITHOUT DAYTIME LIGHT SYSTEM
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM hraness connector.
3. Disconnect lighting switch harness connector .
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 84 and lighting switch terminal 10.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
CONVENTIONAL TYPE HEADLAMP WITH DAYTIME LIGHT SYSTEM
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM hraness connector.
3. Disconnect daytime light relay.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 84 and daytime light relay terminal 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
XENON TYPE HEADLAMP
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM hraness connector.
3. Disconnect headlamp LH relay.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal 84 and headlamp LH relay terminal 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> GO TO 9.
9. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G harness for open and short between ECM and lighting switch
G harness for open and short between ECM and daytime light relay
G harness for open and short between ECM and headlamp LH relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
10. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1498, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
MI & DATA LINK CONNECTORS
EC-1721
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
MI & DATA LINK CONNECTORS PFP:24814
Wiring Diagram (LHD Models) EBS00H5K
MBWA0039E
EC-1722
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
MI & DATA LINK CONNECTORS
Wiring Diagram (RHD Models) EBS00H5L
MBWA0148E
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM
EC-1723
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM PFP:14950
Description EBS00H5M
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The evaporative emission system is used to reduce hydrocarbons emitted into the atmosphere from the fuel
system. This reduction of hydrocarbons is accomplished by activated charcoals in the EVAP canister.
The fuel vapor in the sealed fuel tank is led into the EVAP canister which contains activated carbon and the
vapor is stored there when the engine is not operating or when refueling to the fuel tank.
The vapor in the EVAP canister is purged by the air through the purge line to the intake manifold when the
engine is operating. EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve is controlled by ECM. When the
engine operates, the flow rate of vapor controlled by EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve is
proportionally regulated as the air flow increases.
EVAP canister purge volume control solenoid valve also shuts off the vapor purge line during decelerating and
idling.
PBIB0491E
EC-1724
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION LINE DRAWING
MBIB0144E
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION SYSTEM
EC-1725
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Component Inspection EBS00H5N
EVAP CANISTER
Check EVAP canister as follows:
1. Block port B . Orally blow air through port A .
Check that air flows freely through port C .
2. Block port A . Orally blow air through port B .
Check that air flows freely through port C .
FUEL CHECK VALVE
1. Blow air through connector on fuel tank side.
A considerable resistance should be felt and a portion of air flow
should be directed toward the EVAP canister side.
2. Blow air through connector on EVAP canister side.
Air flow should be smoothly directed toward fuel tank side.
3. If fuel check valve is suspected of not properly functioning in
steps 1 and 2 above, replace it.
FUEL TANK VACUUM RELIEF VALVE (BUILT INTO FUEL FILLER CAP)
1. Wipe clean valve housing.
2. Check valve opening pressure and vacuum.
3. If out of specification, replace fuel filler cap as an assembly.
EVAP CANISTER PURGE VOLUME CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Refer to EC-1688, "Component Inspection" .
PBIB0663E
SEF552Y
SEF989X
Pressure: 15.3 - 20.0 kPa (0.153 - 0.200 bar,
0.156 - 0.204 kg/cm
2
, 2.22 - 2.90 psi)
Vacuum: 6.0 to 3.4 kPa (0.060 to 0.034 bar,
0.061 to 0.035 kg/cm
2
, 0.87 to 0.49 psi)
SEF943S
EC-1726
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION PFP:11810
Description EBS00H5O
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
This system returns blow-by gas to the intake manifold.
The positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) valve is provided to conduct crankcase blow-by gas to the intake
manifold. During partial throttle operation of the engine, the intake manifold sucks the blow-by gas through the
PCV valve. Normally, the capacity of the valve is sufficient to handle any blow-by and a small amount of venti-
lating air. The ventilating air is then drawn from the air inlet tubes into the crankcase. In this process the air
passes through the hose connecting air inlet tubes to rocker cover. Under full-throttle condition, the manifold
vacuum is insufficient to draw the blow-by flow through the valve. The flow goes through the hose connection
in the reverse direction.
On vehicles with an excessively high blow-by, the valve does not
meet the requirement. This is because some of the flow will go
through the hose connection to the air inlet tubes under all condi-
tions.
Component Inspection EBS00H5P
PCV (POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION) VALVE
With engine running at idle, remove PCV valve from rocker cover. A
properly working valve makes a hissing noise as air passes through
it. A strong vacuum should be felt immediately when a finger is
placed over valve inlet.
PBIB0492E
SEF559A
SEC137A
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION
EC-1727
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
PCV VALVE VENTILATION HOSE
1. Check hoses and hose connections for leaks.
2. Disconnect all hoses and clean with compressed air. If any hose
cannot be freed of obstructions, replace.
S-ET277
EC-1728
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS) PFP:00030
Fuel Pressure EBS00H5Q
Idle Speed and Ignition Timing EBS00H5R
*1: Under the following conditions:
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Electric load: OFF (Lights, heater fan & rear window defogger)
G Steering wheel: Kept in straight-ahead position
Calculated Load Value EBS00H5S
Mass Air Flow Sensor EBS00H5T
*: Engine is warmed up to normal operating temperature and running under no-load.
Intake Air Temperature Sensor EBS00H5U
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor EBS00H5V
Heated Oxygen Sensor 1 Heater EBS00H5W
Heated Oxygen sensor 2 Heater EBS00H5X
Crankshaft Position Sensor (POS) EBS00H5Y
Refer to EC-1560, "Component Inspection" .
Camshaft Position Sensor (PHASE) EBS00H5Z
Refer to EC-1567, "Component Inspection" .
Fuel pressure at idle
Approximately 350 kPa (3.7kg/cm
2
, 51psi)
Target idle speed No-load*1 (in P or N position)
M/T: 60050 rpm
CVT: 65050 rpm
Air conditioner: ON In P or N position 725 rpm or more
Ignition timing In P or N position
M/T: 145 BTDC
CVT:155 BTDC
Calculated load value % (Using CONSULT-II or GST)
At idle 10 - 35
At 2,500 rpm 10 - 35
Supply voltage Battery voltage (11 - 14V)
Output voltage at idle 1.1 - 1.5*V
Mass air flow (Using CONSULT-II)
1.4 - 4.0 gm/sec at idle*
4.0 - 10.0 gm/sec at 2,500 rpm*
Temperature C (F) Resistance k
25 (77) 1.9 - 2.1
80 (176) 0.31 - 0.37
Temperature C (F) Resistance k
20 (68) 2.1 - 2.9
50 (122) 0.68 - 1.00
90 (194) 0.236 - 0.260
Resistance [at 25C (77F)] 2.3 - 4.3
Resistance [at 25C (77F)] 2.3 - 4.3
SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
EC-1729
[QR (WITHOUT EURO-OBD)]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Throttle Control Motor EBS00H60
Injector EBS00H61
Fuel Pump EBS00H62
Resistance [at 25C (77F)] Approximately 1 - 15
Resistance [at 20C (68F)] 13.5 - 17.5
Resistance [at 25C (77F)] Approximately 1.0
EC-1730
[YD]
INDEX FOR DTC
[YD]
INDEX FOR DTC PFP:00024
Alphabetical Index EBS00DY1
X: Applicable : Not applicable
DTC No. Index EBS00DY2
X: Applicable : Not applicable
Items
(CONSULT-II screen terms)
DTC MI illumination Reference page
ACCEL POS SENSOR P0120 EC-1802
ACCEL POS SW (F/C) P1510 EC-1876
BATTERY VOLTAGE P1660 EC-1887
CAM POS SEN/CIR P0340 EC-1832
CAN COMM CIRCUIT U1000 EC-1790
COOLANT TEMP SEN P0115 EC-1798
CR PRES SEN P0190 EC-1810
CRANK POS SEN (TDC) P0335 EC-1827
CYL1 INJECTOR P0201 EC-1814
CYL2 INJECTOR P0202 EC-1814
CYL3 INJECTOR P0203 EC-1814
CYL4 INJECTOR P0204 EC-1814
ECM 1 P1606 EC-1881
ECM 10 P1107 EC-1838
ECM 15 P1621 EC-1883
FUEL LEAK FNCTN P1305 EC-1874
INJ DRIVE UNIT P1216 EC-1843
INJ1 CORREC R P1301 EC-1870
INJ2 CORREC R P1302 EC-1870
INJ3 CORREC R P1303 EC-1870
INJ4 CORREC R P1304 EC-1870
MAS AIR FLOW SEN P0100 EC-1793
NATS MALFUNCTION P1610 - P1617 EC-1748
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING MAY BE REQUIRED.
P0000
OVER HEAT P1217 EC-1850
P9FUEL TEMP SEN P1180 EC-1840
SUCTION CONT/V1 P1233 EC-1865
SUCTION CONT/V2 P1234 EC-1865
TURBO PRESSURE P0235 EC-1821
VEHICLE SPEED SEN P0500 EC-1837
DTC
Items
(CONSULT-II screen item)
MI illumination Reference page
U1000 CAN COMM CIRCUIT EC-1790
P0000
NO DTC IS DETECTED.
FURTHER TESTING MAY BE REQUIRED.

P0100 MASS AIR FLOW SEN EC-1793
P0115 COOLANT TEMP SEN EC-1798
P0120 ACCEL POS SENSOR EC-1802
INDEX FOR DTC
EC-1731
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
P0190 CR PRES SEN EC-1810
P0201 CYL1 INJECTOR EC-1814
P0202 CYL2 INJECTOR EC-1814
P0203 CYL3 INJECTOR EC-1814
P0204 CYL4 INJECTOR EC-1814
P0235 TURBO PRESSURE EC-1821
P0335 CRANK POS SEN (TDC) EC-1827
P0340 CAM POS SEN/CIR EC-1832
P0500 VEHICLE SPEED SEN EC-1837
P1107 ECM 10 EC-1838
P1180 P9FUEL TEMP SEN EC-1840
P1216 INJ DRIVE UNIT EC-1843
P1217 OVER HEAT EC-1850
P1233 SUCTION CONT/V1 EC-1865
P1234 SUCTION CONT/V2 EC-1865
P1301 INJ1 CORREC R EC-1870
P1302 INJ2 CORREC R EC-1870
P1303 INJ3 CORREC R EC-1870
P1304 INJ4 CORREC R EC-1870
P1305 FUEL LEAK FNCTN EC-1874
P1510 ACCEL POS SW (F/C) EC-1876
P1606 ECM 1 EC-1881
P1610 - P1617 NATS MALFUNTION EC-1748
P1621 ECM 15 EC-1883
P1660 BATTERY VOLTAGE EC-1887
DTC
Items
(CONSULT-II screen item)
MI illumination Reference page
EC-1732
[YD]
PRECAUTIONS
PRECAUTIONS PFP:00001
Precautions for Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) AIR BAG and SEAT
BELT PRE-TENSIONER EBS00DY3
The Supplemental Restraint System such as "AIR BAG" and "SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONER", used along
with a front seat belt, helps to reduce the risk or severity of injury to the driver and front passenger for certain
types of collision. Information necessary to service the system safely is included in the SRS and SB section of
this Service Manual.
WARNING:
G To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could increase the risk of personal injury or death
in the event of a collision which would result in air bag inflation, all maintenance must be per-
formed by an authorized NISSAN/INFINITI dealer.
G Improper maintenance, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, can lead to per-
sonal injury caused by unintentional activation of the system. For removal of Spiral Cable and Air
Bag Module, see the SRS section.
G Do not use electrical test equipment on any circuit related to the SRS unless instructed to in this
Service Manual. SRS wiring harnesses can be identified by yellow and/or orange harness connec-
tors.
Precautions EBS00DY4
G Before connecting or disconnecting the ECM harness con-
nector, turn ignition switch OFF and disconnect negative
battery terminal. Failure to do so may damage the ECM
because battery voltage is applied to ECM even if ignition
switch is turned off.
G Do not disassemble ECM.
G When connecting or disconnecting pin connectors into or
from ECM, take care not to damage pin terminals (bend or
break).
Make sure that there are not any bends or breaks on ECM
pin terminal, when connecting pin connectors.
G Securely connect ECM harness connectors.
A poor connection can cause an extremely high (surge)
voltage to develop in coil and condenser, thus resulting in
damage to ICs.
G Keep engine control system harness at least 10cm (4 in)
away from adjacent harness, to prevent engine control sys-
tem malfunctions due to receiving external noise, degraded
operation of ICs, etc.
SEF289H
PBIB0378E
SEF291H
PRECAUTIONS
EC-1733
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
G Keep engine control system parts and harness dry.
G Before replacing ECM, perform Terminals and Reference
Value inspection and make sure ECM functions properly.
Refer to EC-1767 .
G After performing each TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS, perform
DTC Confirmation Procedure or Overall Function
Check.
The DTC should not be displayed in the DTC Confirmation
Procedure if the repair is completed. The Overall Func-
tion Check should be a good result if the repair is com-
pleted.
G When measuring ECM signals with a circuit tester, never
allow the two tester probes to contact.
Accidental contact of probes will cause a short circuit and
damage the ECM power transistor.
G Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/
output voltage. Doing so may result in damage to the ECM's
transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as
the ground.
G Do not disconnect fuel supply pump harness connector
with engine running.
G Do not disassemble fuel supply pump.
If NG, take proper action.
G Do not disassemble fuel injector.
If NG, replace fuel injector.
G Even a slight leak in the air intake system can cause seri-
ous problems.
G Do not shock or jar the crankshaft position sensor (TDC)
and the camshaft position sensor.
G Do not depress accelerator pedal when staring.
G Immediately after staring, do not rev up engine unnecessar-
ily.
G Do not rev up engine just prior to shutdown.
MEF040D
SEF348N
SEF709Y
EC-1734
[YD]
PRECAUTIONS
G When installing C.B. ham radio or a mobile phone, be sure
to observe the following as it may adversely affect elec-
tronic control systems depending on installation location.
Keep the antenna as far as possible from the electronic
control units.
Keep the antenna feeder line more than 20 cm (8 in) away
from the harness of electronic controls.
Do not let them run parallel for a long distance.
Adjust the antenna and feeder line so that the standingwave
radio can be kept smaller.
Be sure to ground the radio to vehicle body.
Wiring Diagrams and Trouble Diagnosis EBS00DY5
When you read Wiring diagrams, refer to the following:
G GI-14, "How to Read Wiring Diagrams".
G PG-3, "POWER SUPPLY ROUTING" for power distribution circuit
When you perform trouble diagnosis, refer to the following:
G GI-11, "HOW TO FOLLOW TEST GROUPS IN TROUBLE DIAGNOSES".
G GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident".
SEF708Y
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-1735
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM PFP:23710
System Diagram EBS00DY6
MBIB0008E
EC-1736
[YD]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
Vacuum Hose Drawing EBS00GNW
Refer to EC-1735, "System Diagram" for vacuum control system.
1. Variable nozzle turbocharger control
actuator to vacuum gallery
2. Vacuum pump to vacuum gallery 3. Intake air duct to vacuum gallery
4. Variable nozzle turbocharger control
solenoid valve to vacuum gallery
MBIB0002E
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-1737
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
System Chart EBS00DY7
*1: The input signals are sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
*2: The output signals are sent from the ECM through CAN communication line.
Fuel Injection Control System EBS00DY8
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
Three types of fuel injection control are provided to accommodate engine operating conditions; normal control,
idle control and start control. The ECM determines the appropriate fuel injection control. Under each control,
the amount of fuel injected is adjusted to improve engine performance.
Pulse signals are exchanged between ECM and Electronic Drive Unit (EDU). EDU controls fuel injectors
according to the input signals to adjust the amount of fuel injected to the preset value.
START CONTROL
Input/Output Signal Chart
When the ECM receives a start signal from the ignition switch, the
ECM adapts the fuel injection system for the start control. The
amount of fuel injected at engine starting is a preset program value
in the ECM. The program is determined by the engine speed, engine
coolant temperature and common rail fuel pressure.
For better startability under cool engine conditions, the lower the
coolant temperature becomes, the greater the amount of fuel
injected. The ECM ends the start control when the engine speed
reaches the specific value, and shifts the control to the normal or idle
control.
Input (Sensor) ECM Function Output (Actuator)
G Accelerator pedal position sensor
G Accelerator pedal released position switch
G Common rail fuel pressure sensor
G Fuel temperature sensor
G Engine coolant temperature sensor
G Crankshaft position sensor (TDC)
G Camshaft position sensor
G Vehicle speed sensor*
1
G Ignition switch
G Stop Lamp switch
G Air conditioner switch*
1
G Mass air flow sensor
G Charge air pressure sensor
G Park/neutral position switch
G Battery voltage
G Power steering oil pressure switch
Fuel injection control
EDU, Fuel injectors and Suction control
valve
Fuel injection timing control
EDU, Fuel injectors and Suction control
valve
Fuel cut control
EDU, Fuel injectors and Suction control
valve
Glow control system
G Glow relay
G Glow indicator lamp*
2
On board diagnostic system
Malfunction indicator (MI)*
2
EGR volume control EGR volume control valve
Cooling fan control
Cooling fan relay*
2
Air conditioning cut control
Air conditioner relay*
2
Variable nozzle turbocharger control
Variable nozzle turbocharger control
solenoid valve
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Fuel injection
control (start
control)
EDU
Fuel injectors
Suction control valve
Crankshaft position sensor (TDC) Engine speed
Camshaft position sensor Piston position
Ignition switch Start signal
Common rail fuel pressure sensor Common rail fuel pressure
SEF648S
EC-1738
[YD]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
IDLE CONTROL
Input/Output Signal Chart
*1: These signals are sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
When the ECM determines that the engine speed is at idle, the fuel injection system is adapted for the idle
control. The ECM regulates the amount of fuel injected corresponding to changes in load applied to the engine
to keep engine speed constant. The ECM also provides the system with a fast idle control in response to the
engine coolant temperature signal.
NORMAL CONTROL
Input/Output Signal Chart
The amount of fuel injected under normal driving conditions is deter-
mined according to sensor signals. The crankshaft position sensor
(TDC) detects engine speed, the accelerator pedal position sensor
detects accelerator pedal position and common rail fuel pressure
sensor detects common rail fuel pressure. These sensors send sig-
nals to the ECM.
The fuel injection data, predetermined by correlation between vari-
ous engine speeds, accelerator pedal positions and common rail fuel
pressure are stored in the ECM memory, forming a map. The ECM
determines the optimal amount of fuel to be injected using the sen-
sor signals in comparison with the map.
MAXIMUM AMOUNT CONTROL
Input/Output Signal Chart
The maximum injection amount is controlled to an optimum by the engine speed, intake air amount, engine
coolant temperature, and accelerator opening in accordance with the driving conditions.
This prevents the oversupply of the injection amount caused by decreased air density at a high altitude or dur-
ing a system failure.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Fuel injection
control (Idle
control)
EDU
Fuel injectors
Suction control valve
Crankshaft position sensor (TDC) Engine speed
Battery Battery voltage
Accelerator pedal position sensor Accelerator pedal position
Accelerator pedal released position switch Accelerator pedal released position
Vehicle speed sensor*
1
Vehicle speed
Air conditioner switch*
1
Air conditioner signal
Common rail fuel pressure sensor Common rail fuel pressure
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (TDC) Engine speed
Fuel injection
control (Nor-
mal control)
EDU
Fuel injectors
Suction control valve
Accelerator pedal position sensor Accelerator position
Common rail fuel pressure sensor Common rail fuel pressure
SEF649S
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Mass air flow sensor Amount of intake air
Fuel injection
control (Maxi-
mum amount
control)
EDU
Fuel Injectors
Suction control valve
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Crankshaft position sensor (TDC) Engine speed
Accelerator pedal position sensor Accelerator position
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-1739
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DECELERATION CONTROL
Input/Output Signal Chart
The ECM sends a fuel cut signal to the fuel injector and suction control valve during deceleration for better fuel
efficiency. The ECM determines the time of deceleration according to signals from the accelerator pedal
released position switch and crankshaft position sensor (TDC).
Fuel Injection Timing Control System EBS00DY9
DESCRIPTION
The target fuel injection timing in accordance with the engine speed and the fuel injection amount are recorded
as a map in the ECM beforehand. The ECM determines the optimum injection timing using sensor signals
accordance with the map.
Air Conditioning Cut Control EBS00DYA
INPUT / OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
*1: These signals are sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
This system improves acceleration when the air conditioner is used.
When the accelerator pedal is fully depressed, the air conditioner is turned off for a few seconds.
When engine coolant temperature becomes excessively high, the air conditioner is turned off. This continues
until the engine coolant temperature returns to normal.
Fuel Cut Control (At No Load & High Engine Speed) EBS00DYB
INPUT/OUTPUT SIGNAL CHART
*1: These signals are sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
If the engine speed is above 2,800 rpm with no load (for example, in neutral and engine speed over 2,800
rpm) fuel will be cut off after some time. The exact time when the fuel is cut off varies based on engine speed.
Fuel cut will operate until the engine speed reaches 1,500 rpm, then fuel cut is cancelled.
NOTE:
This function is different from deceleration control listed under EC-1737, "Fuel Injection Control Sys-
tem" .
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Accelerator pedal released position switch Accelerator pedal position Fuel injection
control (Decel-
eration control)
EDU
Fuel injectors
Suction control valve
Crankshaft position sensor (TDC) Engine speed
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Air conditioner switch*
1
Air conditioner ON signal
Air conditioner
cut control
Air conditioner relay
Accelerator pedal position sensor Accelerator pedal opening angle
Vehicle speed sensor*
1
Vehicle speed
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Vehicle speed sensor*
1
Vehicle speed
Fuel cut control
EDU
Fuel injectors
Suction control valve
Accelerator pedal released position switch Accelerator position
Crankshaft position sensor (TDC) Engine speed
EC-1740
[YD]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
Crankcase Ventilation System EBS00DYC
DESCRIPTION
In this system, blow-by gas is sucked into the air duct after oil separation by oil separator in the rocker cover.
INSPECTION
Ventilation Hose
1. Check hoses and hose connections for leaks.
2. Disconnect all hoses and clean with compressed air. If any hose
cannot be freed of obstructions, replace.
CAN communication EBS00HBY
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real time application. It is an on-vehicle mul-
tiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent error detection ability. Many elec-
tronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links with other
control units during operation (not independent). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2
communication lines (CAN H line, CAN L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission with less wiring.
Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.
PBIB0590E
SEC692
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-1741
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
LHD MODELS WITH TYRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM
System Diagram
Input/Output Signal Chart
T: Transmit R: Receive
*1: Except YD22DDTi engine model
*2: YD22DDTi engine model only
SKIA1525E
Signals ECM
ABS actuator
and electric
unit (control
unit)
Smart
entrance con-
trol unit
Tyre pres-
sure monitor-
ing control
unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R
Rear window defogger signal
R
*1
T
Heater fan switch signal
R
*1
T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Glow lamp signal
*2
T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
EC-1742
[YD]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
LHD MODELS WITHOUT TYRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM
System Diagram
Input/Output Signal Chart
T: Transmit R: Receive
*1: Except YD22DDTi engine model
*2:YD22DDTi engine model only
SKIA1532E
Signals ECM
ABS actuator and
electric unit (con-
trol unit)
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R
Rear window defogger signal
R
*1
T
Heater fan switch signal
R
*1
T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Glow lamp signal
*2
T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-1743
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
RHD MODELS WITH TYRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM
System Diagram
Input/Output Signal Chart
T: Transmit R: Receive
*1: Except YD22DDTi engine model
*2: YD22DDTi engine model only
SKIA1539E
Signals ECM
ABS actua-
tor and elec-
tric unit
(control unit)
Tyre pres-
sure monitor-
ing control
unit
Smart
entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R
Rear window defogger signal
R
*1
T
Heater fan switch signal
R
*1
T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Glow lamp signal
*2
T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
Tire pressure signal T R
EC-1744
[YD]
ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
RHD MODELS WITHOUT TYRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM
System Diagram
Input/Output Signal Chart
T: Transmit R: Receive
*1: Except YD22DDTi engine model
*2: YD22DDTi engine model only
SKIA1546E
Signals ECM
ABS actuator and
electric unit (con-
trol unit)
Smart entrance
control unit
Combination
meter
Engine speed signal T R
Rear window defogger signal
R
*1
T
Heater fan switch signal
R
*1
T
Air conditioner switch signal R T
MI signal T R
Glow lamp signal
*2
T R
Engine coolant temperature signal T R
Fuel consumption signal T R
Vehicle speed signal
T R
R T
Seat belt reminder signal R T
Headlamp switch signal T R
Flashing indicator signal T R
Engine cooling fan speed signal T R
Child lock indicator signal T R
Door switches state signal T R
Key ID signal
R T
T R
A/C compressor signal T R
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
EC-1745
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE PFP:00018
Fuel Filter EBS00DYD
DESCRIPTION
A water draining cock is on the lower side and a priming pump for bleeding air is on the upper side.
AIR BLEEDING
Pump the priming pump to bleed air.
G When air is bled completely, the pumping of the priming pump
suddenly becomes heavy. Stop the operation at that time.
G If it is difficult to bleed air by the pumping of the priming pump
(the pumping of the priming pump does not become heavy), dis-
connect the fuel supply hose between the fuel filter and the fuel
gallery. Then, perform the operation described above, and make
sure that fuel comes out. (Use a pan, etc. so as not to spill fuel.
Do not let fuel get on engine and other parts.) After that, connect
the hose, then bleed air again.
G Start engine and let it idle for at least one minute after perform-
ing air bleeding.
WATER DRAINING
1. Remove the fuel filter, filter bracket, protector assembly from the dash panel as follows.
a. Remove the air cleaner case (upper), air duct assembly, and vacuum hose for brake booster (between the
vacuum pump and vacuum pipe).
CAUTION:
After the duct is removed, cover the opening with gum tape, etc. to prevent foreign object from
getting into the engine during the operation.
b. Remove the mounting nuts on the dash panel, then remove the fuel filter, filter bracket, and protector
assembly from the dash panel.
G It is not necessary to disconnect the fuel hose.
2. Using a tool such as a pliers, loosen the water draining cock at
the bottom of the fuel filter.
Loosening drain cock four to five turns causes water to
start draining.
Do not remove drain cock by loosening it excessively.
If water dose not drain properly, move the priming up and down.
CAUTION:
When the water is drained, the fuel is also drained. Use a
pan, etc. to avoid fuel adherence to the rubber parts such as
the engine mount insulator.
Do not over-tighten the water draining cock. This will dam-
age the cock thread, resulting in water or fuel leak.
3. Bleed air of the fuel filter. Refer to EC-1745, "AIR BLEEDING" .
4. Start the engine, then check that the MI goes off.
Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning EBS00DYE
DESCRIPTION
Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning is an operating to learn the fully released position of the accel-
erator pedal by monitoring the accelerator pedal position sensor output signal. It must be performed when
accelerator work unit or ECM is replaced.
OPERATION PROCEDURE
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
MBIB0074E
SMA825B
EC-1746
[YD]
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
2. Select OFF ACCEL PO SIG in ACTIVE TEST mode with
CONSULT-II
3. Make sure that accelerator pedal is released.
4. Touch CLEAR and wait a few seconds.
5. Make sure that CMPLT is displayed on CONSULT-II screen.
Fuel Pressure Relief Valve EBS00DYF
DESCRIPTION
When the fuel pressure in common rail increases to excessively high, fuel pressure relief valve opens to carry
excess fuel to the return hose.
FUEL PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE CHECK
WARNING:
Confirm that the engine is cooled down and there are no fire hazards near the vehicle.
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Remove fuel hose from fuel pressure relief valve.
3. Attach a blind cap or plug to removed hose.
4. Turn ignition switch ON.
PBIB0411E
PBIB0412E
PBIB0413E
PBIB0467E
BASIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
EC-1747
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. Select PRES REGULATOR in ACTIVE TEST MODE with
CONSULT-II.
6. Start engine and keep engine speed 2,000 rpm.
7. Raise fuel pressure to 135 MPa with touching UP or Qu on
the CONSULT-II screen.
8. Confirm that the fuel does not come out from the fuel pressure
relief valve.
WARNING:
If the fuel comes out, stop the engine immediately.
9. If NG, replace common rail assembly. PBIB0587E
EC-1748
[YD]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM PFP:00028
DTC and MI Detection Logic EBS00DYG
When a malfunction is detected, the malfunction (DTC) is stored in the ECM memory.
The MI will light up each time the ECM detects malfunction. For diagnostic items causing the MI to light up,
refer to EC-1730, "INDEX FOR DTC" .
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) EBS00DYH
HOW TO READ DTC
The DTC can be read by CONSULT-II only.
With CONSULT-II
CONSULT-II displays the DTC in SELF-DIAG RESULTS mode. Example: P0115, P0335, P1233, etc. These
DTCs are prescribed by ISO15031-5.
(CONSULT-II also displays the malfunctioning component or system.)
HOW TO ERASE DTC
How to Erase DTC ( With CONSULT-II)
1. If the ignition switch stays ON after repair work, be sure to turn ignition switch OFF once. Wait at least
5 seconds and then turn it ON (engine stopped) again.
2. Touch ENGINE.
3. Touch SELF-DIAG RESULTS.
4. Touch ERASE. (The DTC in the ECM will be erased.)
The emission related diagnostic information in the ECM can be erased by selecting ERASE in the SELF-
DIAG RESULTS mode with CONSULT-II.
NATS (Nissan Anti-theft System) EBS00DYI
G If the security indicator lights up with the ignition switch in
the ON position or NATS MALFUNCTION is displayed
on SELF-DIAG RESULTS screen, perform self-diagnostic
results mode with CONSULT-II using NATS program card.
Refer to NATS (Nissan Anti-Theft System) in BL section.
G Confirm no self-diagnostic results of NATS is displayed
before touching ERASE in SELF-DAIG RESULTS mode
with CONSULT-II.
G When replacing ECM, initialization of NATS system and reg-
istration of all NATS ignition key IDs must be carried out
with CONSULT-II using NATS program card.
PBIB0476E
SEF543X
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
EC-1749
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Therefore, be sure to receive all keys from vehicle owner. Regarding the procedure of NATS initial-
ization and NATS ignition key ID registration, refer to CONSULT-II operation manual, NATS.
Malfunction Indicator (MI) EBS00DYJ
DESCRIPTION
The MI is located on the instrument panel.
1. The MI will light up when the ignition switch is turned ON without
the engine running. This is a bulb check.
G If the MI does not light up, refer to DI-95, "WARNING LAMPS"
or see EC-1922 .
2. When the engine is started, the MI should go off.
If the MI remains on, the on board diagnostic system has
detected an engine system malfunction.
On Board Diagnostic System Function
The on board diagnostic system has the following two functions.
Diagnostic Test Mode I - Bulb Check
In this mode, the MI on the instrument panel should stay ON. If it remains OFF, check the bulb. Refer to DI-95,
"WARNING LAMPS" or see EC-1922 .
Diagnostic Test Mode I - Malfunction Warning
SAT652J
Diagnostic Test
Mode
KEY and ENG.
Status
Function Explanation of Function
Mode I Ignition switch in
ON position
Engine stopped
BULB CHECK This function checks the MI bulb for damage (blown, open
circuit, etc.).
If the MI does not come on, check MI circuit. (See EC-
1922, "MI & DATA LINK CONNECTORS" .)
Engine running MALFUNCTION
WARNING
This is a usual driving condition. When ECM detects a mal-
function, the MI will light up to inform the driver that a mal-
function has been detected.
MI Condition
ON When the malfunction is detected or the ECM's CPU is malfunctioning.
OFF No malfunction.
EC-1750
[YD]
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTIC (OBD) SYSTEM
Relationship Between MI, DTC, CONSULT-II and Driving Patterns
*1: When a malfunction is detected, MI
will light up.
*2: MI will not light up after ignition switch
is turned OFF.
*3: When a malfunction is detected for
the first time, the DTC will be stored in
ECM.
*4: The DTC will not be displayed any
longer after vehicle is driven 40 times
without the same malfunction. (The
DTC still remain in ECM.)
*5: Other screens except SELF-DIAG-
NOSTIC RESULTS & DATA MONI-
TOR (AUTOTRIG) cannot display the
malfunction. DATA MONITOR (AUTO
TRIG) can display the malfunction at
the moment it is detected.
PBIB0589E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1751
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS PFP:00004
Trouble Diagnosis Introduction EBS00DYK
INTRODUCTION
The engine has an ECM to control major systems such as fuel injec-
tion control, fuel injection timing control, glow control system, etc.
The ECM accepts input signals from sensors and instantly actuators.
It is essential that both input and output signals are proper and sta-
ble. At the same time, it is important that there are no problems such
as vacuum leaks, or other problems with the engine.
It is much more difficult to diagnose a problem that occurs intermit-
tently rather than continuously. Most intermittent problems are
caused by poor electric connections or improper wiring. In this case,
careful checking of suspected circuits may help prevent the replace-
ment of good parts.
A visual check only may not find the cause of the problems. A road
test with CONSULT-II or a circuit tester connected should be per-
formed. Follow the EC-1752, "WORK FLOW" .
Before undertaking actual checks, take a few minutes to talk with a
customer who approaches with a driveability complaint. The cus-
tomer can supply good information about such problems, especially
intermittent ones. Find out what symptoms are present and under
what conditions they occur. A Diagnostic Worksheet like the exam-
ple on EC-1753, "DIAGNOSTIC WORK SHEET" should be used.
Start your diagnosis by looking for conventional problems first. This
will help troubleshoot driveability problems on an electronically con-
trolled engine vehicle.
MEF036D
SEF233G
SEF234G
EC-1752
[YD]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
WORK FLOW
*1 If time data of SELF-DIAG
RESULTS is other than 0, perform
EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
*2 If the incident cannot be verified, per-
form EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNO-
SIS FOR INTERMITTENT
INCIDENT" .
*3 If the on board diagnostic system
cannot be performed, check main
power supply and ground circuit.
Refer to EC-1784, "POWER SUPPLY
CIRCUIT FOR ECM" .
*4 If malfunctioning part cannot be
detected, perform EC-1783, "TROU-
BLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMIT-
TENT INCIDENT" .
PBIB0477E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1753
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Description for Work Flow
DIAGNOSTIC WORK SHEET
There are many operating conditions that lead to the malfunction of
engine components. A good grasp of such conditions can make trou-
bleshooting faster and more accurate.
In general, each customer feels differently about a problem. It is
important to fully understand the symptoms or conditions for a cus-
tomer complaint.
Utilize a diagnostic worksheet like the one shown below in order to
organize all the information for troubleshooting.
STEP DESCRIPTION
STEP I
Get detailed information about the conditions and the environment when the incident/symptom occurred using the
EC-1753, "DIAGNOSTIC WORK SHEET" .
STEP II
Before confirming the concern, check and write down (print out using CONSULT-II) the DTC, then erase the DTC.
Refer to EC-1748 .
If the incident cannot be verified, perform EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
Study the relationship between the cause, specified by DTC, and the symptom described by the customer. (The
Symptom Matrix Chart will be useful. Refer to EC-1758 .) Also check related service bulletins for information.
STEP III
Try to confirm the symptom and under what conditions the incident occurs.
The DIAGNOSTIC WORK SHEET is useful to verify the incident. Connect CONSULT-II to the vehicle in DATA
MONITOR (AUTO TRIG) mode and check real time diagnosis results.
If the incident cannot be verified, perform EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
If the malfunction code is detected, skip STEP IV and perform STEP V.
STEP IV
Try to detect the DTC by driving in (or performing) the DTC Confirmation Procedure. Check and read the DTC by
using CONSULT-II.
During the DTC verification, be sure to connect CONSULT-II to the vehicle in DATA MONITOR (AUTO TRIG) mode
and check real time diagnosis results.
If the incident cannot be verified, perform EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
In case the DTC Confirmation Procedure is not available, perform the Overall Function Check instead. The DTC
cannot be displayed by this check, however, this simplified check is an effective alternative.
The NG result of the Overall Function Check is the same as the DTC detection.
STEP V
Take the appropriate action based on the results of STEP I through IV.
If the malfunction code is indicated, proceed to Trouble Diagnosis for DTC PXXXX.
If the normal code is indicated, proceed to the Basic Inspection, EC-1754 . Then perform inspections according to the
Symptom Matrix Chart. Refer to EC-1758 .
STEP VI
Identify where to begin diagnosis based on the relationship study between symptom and possible causes. Inspect the
system for mechanical binding, loose connectors or wiring damage using (tracing) Harness Layouts.
Gently shake the related connectors, components or wiring harness with CONSULT-II set in DATA MONITOR (AUTO
TRIG) mode.
Check the voltage of the related ECM terminals or monitor the output data from the related sensors with CONSULT-II.
Refer to EC-1767 or EC-1779 .
The Diagnostic Procedure in EC section contains a description based on open circuit inspection. A short circuit
inspection is also required for the circuit check in the Diagnostic Procedure. For details, refer to GI-24, "How to Per-
form Efficient Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident" , Circuit Inspection.
Repair or replace the malfunction parts.
If the malfunctioning part cannot be detected, perform EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT
INCIDENT" .
STEP VII
Once you have repaired the circuit or replaced a component, you need to run the engine in the same conditions and
circumstances which resulted in the customer's initial complaint.
Perform the DTC Confirmation Procedure and confirm the normal code (DTC P0000) is detected. If the incident is
still detected in the final check, perform STEP VI by using a different method from the previous one.
Before returning the vehicle to the customer, be sure to erase the unnecessary (already fixed) DTC in ECM. (Refer to
EC-1748 .)
SEF907L
EC-1754
[YD]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Worksheet Sample
Basic Inspection EBS00DYL
Precaution:
Perform Basic Inspection without electrical or mechanical loads applied;
G Headlamp switch is OFF.
G On vehicles equipped with daytime light systems, set lighting switch to the 1st position to light
only small lamps.
G Air conditioner switch is OFF.
G Rear defogger switch is OFF.
G Steering wheel is in the straight-ahead position, etc.
MTBL0533
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1755
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
1. INSPECTION START
1. Check service records for any recent repairs that may indicate a related problem.
2. Check the current need for scheduled maintenance, especially for fuel filter and air cleaner filter. Refer to
MA-7, "PERIODIC MAINTENANCE" .
3. Open engine hood and check the following:
Harness connectors for improper connections
Vacuum hoses for splits, kinks, or improper connections
Wiring for improper connections, pinches, or cuts
4. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating tempera-
ture.
>> GO TO 2.
2. PREPARATION FOR CHECKING IDLE SPEED
With CONSULT-II
Connect CONSULT-II to the data link connector.
>> GO TO 3.
3. CHECK IDLE SPEED
With CONSULT-II
1. Select CKPSRPM (TDC) in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
2. Read idle speed.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. CHECK FOR INTAKE AIR LEAK
Listen for an intake air leak after the mass air flow sensor.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair or replace.
SEF142I
72525 rpm
SEF817Y
EC-1756
[YD]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
5. BLEED AIR FROM FUEL SYSTEM
1. Stop engine.
2. Use priming pump to bleed air from fuel system. Refer to EC-1745, "AIR BLEEDING" .
>> GO TO 6.
6. CHECK IDLE SPEED AGAIN
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle.
2. Select CKPSRPM (TDC) in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Read idle speed.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 7.
7. DRAIN WATER FROM FUEL FILTER
Drain water from fuel filter. Refer to EC-1745, "WATER DRAINING" .
>> GO TO 8.
8. CHECK IDLE SPEED AGAIN
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle.
2. Select CKPSRPM (TDC) in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Read idle speed.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 9.
9. CHECK AIR CLEANER FILTER
Check air cleaner filter for clogging or breaks.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> Replace air cleaner filter.
72525 rpm
SEF817Y
72525 rpm
SEF817Y
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1757
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
10. CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE
Check battery voltage.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> GO TO 11.
11. CHECK BATTERY
Refer to SC-3, "BATTERY" .
OK or NG
OK >> Check charging system. Refer to SC-12, "CHARGING SYSTEM" .
NG >> Repair or replace.
12. CHECK COMPRESSION PRESSURE
Check compression pressure. Refer to EM-274, "CHECKING COMPRESSION PRESSURE" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> Follow the instruction of CHECKING COMPRESSION PRESSURE.
13. CHECK IDLE SPEED AGAIN
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and let it idle.
2. Select CKPSRPM (TDC) in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Read idle speed.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> 1. Replace fuel injector.
2. GO TO 3.
Voltage: More than 12.13V
72525 rpm
SEF817Y
EC-1758
[YD]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Symptom Matrix Chart EBS00DYM
SYSTEM Basic engine control system
SYMPTOM
R
e
f
e
r
e
n
c
e
p
a
g
e
H
A
R
D
/
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
/
R
E
S
T
A
R
T
(
E
X
C
P
.
H
A
)
E
N
G
I
N
E
S
T
A
L
L
H
E
S
I
T
A
T
I
O
N
/
S
U
R
G
I
N
G
/
F
L
A
T
S
P
O
T
K
N
O
C
K
/
D
E
T
O
N
A
T
I
O
N
L
A
C
K
O
F
P
O
W
E
R
P
O
O
R
A
C
C
E
L
E
R
A
T
I
O
N
H
I
I
D
L
E
L
O
W
I
D
L
E
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
(
w
i
t
h
f
i
r
s
t
f
i
r
i
n
g
)
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
(
w
i
t
h
o
u
t
f
i
r
s
t
f
i
r
i
n
g
)
H
A
R
D
T
O
S
T
A
R
T
W
H
E
N
E
N
G
I
N
E
I
S
C
O
L
D
H
A
R
D
T
O
S
T
A
R
T
W
H
E
N
E
N
G
I
N
E
I
S
H
O
T
A
T
I
D
L
E
D
U
R
I
N
G
D
R
I
V
I
N
G
W
H
E
N
D
E
C
E
L
E
R
A
T
I
N
G
Warranty symptom code AA AB AC AD AE AF
Fuel supply pump 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
Fuel injector 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 4 4 3 3 EC-1814
EDU (Electronic drive unit) 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 5 5 4 4 EC-1843
Glow control system 1 1 1 1 1 EC-1889
Engine body 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 4 4 3 EM-285
EGR system 3 3 EC-1896
Air cleaner and duct 3 3 MA-7
Fuel pressure relief valve EC-1746
E
N
G
I
N
E
C
O
N
T
R
O
L
Suction control valve circuit 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 EC-1865
Fuel injector circuit 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 EC-1814
EDU circuit 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 EC-1843
Mass air flow sensor circuit 1 1 1 EC-1793
Engine coolant temperature circuit 1 1 1 1 EC-1798
Vehicle speed signal circuit 1 EC-1837
Accelerator pedal position sensor circuit 1 1 1 EC-1802
Accelerator pedal released position
switch circuit
1 1 1 1 1 1 EC-1876
Common rail fuel pressure sensor
circuit
EC-1810
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1759
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
1 - 5: The numbers refer to the order of inspection.
(continued on next page)
E
N
G
I
N
E
C
O
N
T
R
O
L
Crankshaft position sensor (TDC)
circuit
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 EC-1827
Camshaft position sensor circuit 3 3 EC-1832
Charge air pressure sensor circuit 1 1 1 EC-1821
Variable nozzle turbocharger control
solenoid valve circuit
1 1 1 EC-1903
Start signal circuit 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 EC-1916
Ignition switch circuit 1 1 1 1 EC-1784
Power supply for ECM circuit 1 1 1 1 EC-1784
Cooling fan relay circuit EC-1850
EGR volume control valve circuit 1 1 1 EC-1896
Glow relay circuit 1 1 1 1 EC-1889
ECM relay (Self-shutoff) circuit 1 1 1 1 EC-1883
ECM, connector circuit 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
EC-1838,
EC-1881
NATS (Nissan Anti-theft System) 1 EC-1748
SYSTEM Basic engine control system
SYMPTOM
R
e
f
e
r
e
n
c
e
p
a
g
e
H
A
R
D
/
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
/
R
E
S
T
A
R
T
(
E
X
C
P
.
H
A
)
E
N
G
I
N
E
S
T
A
L
L
H
E
S
I
T
A
T
I
O
N
/
S
U
R
G
I
N
G
/
F
L
A
T
S
P
O
T
K
N
O
C
K
/
D
E
T
O
N
A
T
I
O
N
L
A
C
K
O
F
P
O
W
E
R
P
O
O
R
A
C
C
E
L
E
R
A
T
I
O
N
H
I
I
D
L
E
L
O
W
I
D
L
E
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
(
w
i
t
h
f
i
r
s
t
f
i
r
i
n
g
)
N
O
S
T
A
R
T
(
w
i
t
h
o
u
t
f
i
r
s
t
f
i
r
i
n
g
)
H
A
R
D
T
O
S
T
A
R
T
W
H
E
N
E
N
G
I
N
E
I
S
C
O
L
D
H
A
R
D
T
O
S
T
A
R
T
W
H
E
N
E
N
G
I
N
E
I
S
H
O
T
A
T
I
D
L
E
D
U
R
I
N
G
D
R
I
V
I
N
G
W
H
E
N
D
E
C
E
L
E
R
A
T
I
N
G
Warranty symptom code AA AB AC AD AE AF
EC-1760
[YD]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
SYSTEM Basic engine control system
SYMPTOM
R
e
f
e
r
e
n
c
e
p
a
g
e
R
O
U
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
H
U
N
T
I
N
G
I
D
L
I
N
G
V
I
B
R
A
T
I
O
N
S
L
O
W
/
N
O
R
E
T
U
R
N
T
O
I
D
L
E
O
V
E
R
H
E
A
T
/
H
I
G
H
E
N
G
I
N
E
C
O
O
L
A
N
T
T
E
M
P
E
R
A
T
U
R
E
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
F
U
E
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
O
I
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
A
B
N
O
R
M
A
L
S
M
O
K
E
C
O
L
O
R
D
E
A
D
B
A
T
T
E
R
Y
(
U
N
D
E
R
C
H
A
R
G
E
)
M
a
l
f
u
n
c
t
i
o
n
i
n
d
i
c
a
t
o
r
i
l
l
u
m
i
n
a
t
e
s
.
C
a
n
b
e
d
e
t
e
c
t
e
d
b
y
C
O
N
S
U
L
T
-
I
I
? B
L
A
C
K
S
M
O
K
E
W
H
I
T
E
S
M
O
K
E
Warranty symptom code AG AH AJ AK AL AM AP HA
Fuel supply pump 5 5 5 5 1 1
Fuel injector 3 3 3 4 4 4 1 1 EC-1814
EDU (Electronic drive unit) 4 4 4 5 5 5 1 1 EC-1843
Glow system 1 EC-1889
Engine body 3 3 3 3 1 3 EM-285
EGR system 3 EC-1896
Air cleaner and duct 3 MA-7
Fuel pressure relief valve EC-1746
E
N
G
I
N
E
C
O
N
T
R
O
L
Suction control valve circuit 4 4 4 4 1 1 EC-1865
Fuel injector circuit 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 EC-1814
EDU circuit 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 EC-1843
Mass air flow sensor circuit 1 1 1 EC-1793
Engine coolant temperature circuit 1 1 1 1 1 EC-1798
Vehicle speed signal circuit 1 1 EC-1837
Accelerator pedal position sensor circuit 1 1 1 EC-1802
Accelerator pedal released position switch
circuit
1 1 EC-1876
Common rail fuel pressure sensor
circuit
1 1 EC-1810
Crankshaft position sensor (TDC)
circuit
1 1 1 1 EC-1827
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1761
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
1 - 5: The numbers refer to the order of inspection.
(continued on next page)
E
N
G
I
N
E
C
O
N
T
R
O
L
Camshaft position sensor circuit 1 1 EC-1832
Charge air pressure sensor circuit 1 1 EC-1821
Variable nozzle turbocharger control solenoid
valve circuit
1 1 EC-1903
Start signal circuit EC-1916
Ignition switch circuit EC-1784
Power supply for ECM circuit 1 1 EC-1784
Cooling fan relay circuit 2 EC-1850
EGR volume control valve circuit 1 EC-1896
Glow relay circuit 1 EC-1889
ECM relay (Self-shutoff) circuit 1 EC-1883
ECM, connector circuit 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
EC-
1838,EC-
1881
NATS (Nissan Anti-theft System) 1 EC-1748
SYSTEM Basic engine control system
SYMPTOM
R
e
f
e
r
e
n
c
e
p
a
g
e
R
O
U
G
H
I
D
L
E
/
H
U
N
T
I
N
G
I
D
L
I
N
G
V
I
B
R
A
T
I
O
N
S
L
O
W
/
N
O
R
E
T
U
R
N
T
O
I
D
L
E
O
V
E
R
H
E
A
T
/
H
I
G
H
E
N
G
I
N
E
C
O
O
L
A
N
T
T
E
M
P
E
R
A
T
U
R
E
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
F
U
E
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
E
X
C
E
S
S
I
V
E
O
I
L
C
O
N
S
U
M
P
T
I
O
N
A
B
N
O
R
M
A
L
S
M
O
K
E
C
O
L
O
R
D
E
A
D
B
A
T
T
E
R
Y
(
U
N
D
E
R
C
H
A
R
G
E
)
M
a
l
f
u
n
c
t
i
o
n
i
n
d
i
c
a
t
o
r
i
l
l
u
m
i
n
a
t
e
s
.
C
a
n
b
e
d
e
t
e
c
t
e
d
b
y
C
O
N
S
U
L
T
-
I
I
? B
L
A
C
K
S
M
O
K
E
W
H
I
T
E
S
M
O
K
E
Warranty symptom code AG AH AJ AK AL AM AP HA
EC-1762
[YD]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Engine Control Component Parts Location EBS00DYN
MBIB0164E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1763
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
MBIB0168E
EC-1764
[YD]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
MBIB0169E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1765
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Circuit Diagram EBS00DYO
MBWA0095E
EC-1766
[YD]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
MBWA0096E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1767
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
ECM Harness Connector Terminal Layout EBS00DYP
ECM Terminals And Reference Value EBS00DYQ
PREPARATION
1. ECM is located behind the glove box. For this inspection,
remove glove box.
2. Perform all voltage measurements with the connector con-
nected. Extend tester probe as shown to perform tests easily.
G Open harness securing clip to make testing easier.
G Use extreme care not to touch 2 pins at one time.
G Data is for comparison and may not be exact.
ECM INSPECTION TABLE
Remarks: Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
PBIB0473E
MBIB0081E
MEC486B
EC-1768
[YD]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION
DATA
(DC Voltage and Pulse Signal)
A1
A2
A3
A4
L/W
Y/PU
PU
Y
EDU drive No. 2
EDU drive No. 4
EDU drive No. 3
EDU drive No. 1
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0 - 4V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
0 - 4V
A5
A6
A7
B
B
B
ECM ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
A8
A9
R
R
Power supply for ECM [Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
A10 R Mass air flow sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0.5 - 2.5V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
1.5 - 3.5V
A11 L/OR
Engine coolant tempera-
ture sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
Approximately 0 - 4.8V
Output voltage varies with engine
coolant temperature
A12 PU Fuel temperature sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
Approximately 0 - 4.8V
Output voltage varies with fuel
temperature
A21 B
Accelerator pedal
released position switch
ground
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 0V
A22 LG
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1 ground
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 0V
A23 B Sensor's ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
PBIB0387E
PBIB0388E
PBIB0389E
PBIB0390E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1769
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC A24 B
Mass air flow sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
A25 PU/W Injector's ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
A26 LG/R
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2 ground
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 0V
A27 W Sensor's power supply [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
A28 PU/R
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1 power supply
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
A29 W/PU EDU injector check signal
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1 - 5V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
1 - 5V
A31 W/L Power supply for ECM [Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
B2 Y
Charge air pressure sen-
sor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 2.0V
B3
B4
B5
B6
GY/B
OR/B
W/L
GY
EGR volume control valve
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0.1 - 14V
(Voltage signals of each ECM ter-
minals differ according to the con-
trol position of EGR volume
control valve.)
B9 Y/B
Fuel injector adjustment
resistor No.2
[Ignition switch ON]
0.2 - 4.8V
(There are individual differences
between fuel injector adjustment
resistors.)
B10 R/B
Fuel injector adjustment
resistor No.4
B11 G/B
Fuel injector adjustment
resistor No.3
B12 W/B
Fuel injector adjustment
resistor No.1
B13
B14
Y/R
Y/R
Common rail fuel pressure
sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.6 - 1.8V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
1.8 - 2.0V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION
DATA
(DC Voltage and Pulse Signal)
PBIB0391E
PBIB0392E
EC-1770
[YD]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
B15 W
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.8 - 1.3V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.5V
B16 L
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.3 - 1.8V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.0V
B17 L
Variable nozzle turbo-
charger control solenoid
valve
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
4.5 - 6.5V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,500 rpm
7 - 9V
B18 G
Camshaft position sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
B19 R Camshaft position sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0 - 3V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
0 - 8V
B20 L/R
Crankshaft position sen-
sor (TDC) ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION
DATA
(DC Voltage and Pulse Signal)
PBIB0393E
PBIB0394E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1771
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
B21 L/G
Crankshaft position sen-
sor (TDC)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0 - 12.5V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
0 - 30.0V
B23 GY/L
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2 power supply
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
D14 G/Y
Accelerator pedal
released position switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal slightly depressed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully released
Approximately 0V
D18
D19
W/R
W/R
Ignition switch [Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
D24
D26
G
G
ECM relay (self-shutoff)
[Ignition switch ON]
[Ignition switch OFF]
G For a few seconds after turning ignition
switch OFF
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch OFF]
G A few seconds passed after turning ignition
switch OFF
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
D25 R/G Stop lamp switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Brake pedal fully released
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Brake pedal depressed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
D27 B/Y Start signal
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch START]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION
DATA
(DC Voltage and Pulse Signal)
PBIB0395E
PBIB0396E
EC-1772
[YD]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
E1 L
Suction control valve
power supply
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0 - 12.5V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
0 - 12.5V
E8 Y/L Suction control valve 1
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0 - 12.5V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
0 - 12.5V
E9 W/R Glow relay Refer to EC-1889, "GLOW CONTROL SYSTEM" .
E10 R CAN communication line [Ignition switch ON]
Approximately 1.7 - 2.3V
Output voltage varies with the
communication status.
E11 L CAN communication line [Ignition switch ON]
Approximately 2.6 - 3.2V
Output voltage varies with the
communication status.
E12 P/B
Power steering oil pres-
sure switch
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is being turned
Approximately 0V
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is not being turned
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
E13 G/OR
Park/Neutral position
switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Gear position is Neutral
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Except the above gear position
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION
DATA
(DC Voltage and Pulse Signal)
PBIB0399E
PBIB0400E
PBIB0401E
PBIB0402E
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1773
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
CONSULT-II Function EBS00DYR
CONSULT-II INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Connect CONSULT-II to data link connector, which is located
under the driver side dash panel.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Touch START.
5. Touch ENGINE.
E16 G/W Suction control valve 2
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0 - 12.5V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
0 - 12.5V
E18 LG/W Data Link connector
[Ignition switch ON]
CONSULT-II or GST is disconnected
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION
DATA
(DC Voltage and Pulse Signal)
PBIB0401E
PBIB0402E
MBIB0156E
SEF995X
EC-1774
[YD]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
6. Perform each diagnostic test mode according to each service
procedure.
For further information, see the CONSULT-II Operation Manual.
ENGINE CONTROL COMPONENT PARTS/CONTROL SYSTEMS APPLICATION
X: Applicable
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
Regarding items detected in SELF-DIAG RESULTS mode, refer to EC-1730, "INDEX FOR DTC" .
PBIB0410E
Item
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MODE
SELF-DIAG
RESULTS
DATA MONI-
TOR
ACTIVE
TEST
E
N
G
I
N
E
C
O
N
T
R
O
L
C
O
M
P
O
N
E
N
T
P
A
R
T
S
INPUT
Crankshaft position sensor (TDC)
Camshaft position sensor
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Vehicle speed signal
Fuel temperature sensor
Accelerator pedal position sensor 1
Accelerator pedal position sensor 2
Accelerator pedal released position switch
Common rail fuel pressure sensor
Park/neutral position (PNP) switch
Mass air flow sensor
Battery voltage
Power steering oil pressure switch
Stop lamp switch
Absolute pressure sensor
Fuel injector adjustment resistor
Charge air pressure sensor
OUTPUT
Suction control valve
Fuel injector
Glow relay
Cooling fan relay
EGR volume control valve
Variable nozzle turbocharger control solenoid valve
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1775
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DATA MONITOR MODE
MONITOR ITEM
ECM
IPUT
SIG-
NAL
MAIN
SIG-
NALS
CAN
DIAG
SUP-
PORT
MNTR
CONDITION SPECIFICATION
CKPSRPM (TDC) [rpm]
G The engine speed computed from
the crankshaft position sensor
(TDC) signal is displayed.
COOLAN TEMP/S
[C] or [F]

G The engine coolant temperature
(determined by the signal voltage
of the engine coolant temperature
sensor) is displayed.
When the engine coolant tempera-
ture circuit is open or short, ECM
enters fail-safe mode. The engine
coolant temperature determined by
the ECM is displayed.
VHCL SPEED SE
[km/h] or [mph]

G The vehicle speed computed form
the vehicle speed signal is dis-
played.
FUEL TEMP SEN [C] or
[F]

G The fuel temperature (determined
by the signal voltage of the fuel
temperature sensor) is displayed.
ACCEL POS SEN [V]
G The accelerator pedal position
sensor 1 signal voltage is dis-
played.
ACCEL SEN 2 [V]
G The accelerator pedal position
sensor 2 signal voltage is dis-
played.
OFF ACCEL SW [ON/OFF]
G indicates [ON/OFF] condition from
the accelerator pedal released
position switch signal.
ACT CR PRESS [MPa]
G The common rail fuel pressure
(determined by the signal voltage
of the common rail fuel pressure
sensor) is displayed.
BATTERY VOLT [V]
G The power supply voltage of ECM
is displayed.
P/N POSI SW [ON/OFF]
G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from
the park/neutral position switch
signal.
START SIGNAL [ON/OFF]
G indicates [ON/OFF] condition from
the starter signal.
PW/ST SIGNAL [ON/OFF]
G indicates [ON/OFF] condition from
the power steering oil pressure
switch signal.
BRAKE SW [ON/OFF]
G indicates [ON/OFF] condition from
the stop lamp switch signal.
IGN SW [ON/OFF]
G Indicates [ON/OFF] condition from
ignition switch signal.
MAS AIR/FL SE [V]
G The signal voltage of the mass air
flow sensor is displayed.
SUCTION CV [CA]
G Indicates [CA] of suction control
valve operating angle.
MAIN INJ WID [msec]
G Indicates the actual fuel injection
pulse width compensated by ECM
according to the input signals.
EC-1776
[YD]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
GLOW RLY [ON/OFF]
G The glow relay control condition
(determined by ECM according to
the input signal) is displayed.
COOLING FAN
[LOW/HI/OFF]

G Indicates the control condition of
the cooling fans (determined by
ECM according to the input sig-
nal).
LOW ... Operates at low speed.
HI ... Operates at high speed.
OFF ... Stopped
EGR VOL CON/V [step]
G Indicates the EGR volume control
value computed by the ECM
according to the input signals.
G The opening becomes larger as
the value increases.
INT/A VOLUME [mg/]
G The intake air volume computed
from the mass air flow sensor sig-
nal is displayed.
BARO SEN [kPa]
G The barometric pressure (deter-
mined by the signal voltage from
the absolute pressure sensor built
into the ECM) is displayed.
CYL COUNT [0/1/2/3]
G The cylinder being injected is dis-
played.
0 ... Cylinder No.1 is injected.
1 ... Cylinder No.3 is injected.
2 ... Cylinder No.4 is injected.
3 ... Cylinder No.2 is injected.
TURBO BST SEN
G Engine: After warming up
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Shift lever: Neutral position
G No-load
Voltage [V]
Voltage, frequency, duty cycle or
pulse width measured by the probe.
Only # is displayed if item is unable
to be measured.
Figures with #s are temporary
ones.
They are the same figures as an
actual piece of data which was just
previously measured. [Hz] or [%]
Frequency [msec], [Hz] or
[%]
DUTY-HI
DUTY-LOW
PLS WIDTH-HI
PLS WIDTH-LOW
MONITOR ITEM
ECM
IPUT
SIG-
NAL
MAIN
SIG-
NALS
CAN
DIAG
SUP-
PORT
MNTR
CONDITION SPECIFICATION
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1777
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
NOTE:
Any monitored item that does not match the vehicle being diagnosed is deleted from the display automatically.
ACTIVE TEST MODE
REAL TIME DIAGNOSIS IN DATA MONITOR MODE
CONSULT-II has two kinds of triggers and they can be selected by touching SETTING in DATA MONITOR
mode.
CAN COMM
[OK/NG]

G Indicates the communication con-
dition of CAN communication line.
G These items are not displayed in
SELECTION FROM MENU
mode.
CAN CIRC 1
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 2
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 3
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 4
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 5
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 6
[OK/UNKWN]

CAN CIRC 7
[OK/UNKWN]

MONITOR ITEM
ECM
IPUT
SIG-
NAL
MAIN
SIG-
NALS
CAN
DIAG
SUP-
PORT
MNTR
CONDITION SPECIFICATION
TEST ITEM CONDITION JUDGEMENT CHECK ITEM (REMEDY)
POWER BAL-
ANCE
G Engine: After warming up, idle the
engine.
G A/C switch OFF
G Shift lever N
G Cut off each injector signal one at
a time using CONSULT-II
Engine runs rough or dies.
G Harness and connectors
G Compression
G Fuel injectors
COOLING FAN
G Ignition switch: ON
G Operate the cooling fan at LOW,
HI speed and turn OFF using
CONSULT-II.
Cooling fan moves at LOW, HI
speed and stops.
G Harness and connector
G Cooling fan motor
G Cooling fan relay
OFF ACCEL PO
SIG
G This mode is used for ECM to learn accelerator pedal released positions.
GLOW RELAY
G Ignition switch: ON (Engine
stopped)
G Turn the glow relay ON and
OFF using CONSULT-II and lis-
ten to operating sound.
Glow relay makes the operating
sound.
G Harness and connector
G Glow relay
EGR VOL CONT/
V
G Ignition switch: ON
G Change EGR volume control
valve opening step using CON-
SULT-II.
EGR volume control valve makes
an operating sound.
G Harness and connector
G EGR volume control valve
PRES REGULA-
TOR
G Ignition switch: ON
G Change fuel pressure in common
rail using CONSULT-II
Fuel leaks.
G Fuel line
G Fuel pressure relief valve
EC-1778
[YD]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
1. AUTO TRIG (Automatic trigger):
The malfunction will be identified on the CONSULT-II screen in
real time.
In other words, DTC will be displayed if the malfunction is
detected by ECM.
At the moment a malfunction is detected by ECM, MONITOR
in DATA MONITOR screen is changed to Recording Data ...
xx% as shown in the figure, and the data after the malfunction
detection is recorded. Then when the percentage reached
100%, REAL-TIME DIAG screen is displayed. If STOP is
touched on the screen during Recording Data ... xx%, REAL-
TIME DIAG screen is also displayed.
The recording time after the malfunction detection and the recording speed can be changed by TRIG-
GER POINT and Recording Speed. Refer to CONSULT-II OPERATION MANUAL.
2. MANU TRIG (Manual trigger):
DTC will not be displayed automatically on CONSULT-II screen
even though a malfunction is detected by ECM.
DATA MONITOR can be performed continuously even though a
malfunction is detected.
Use these triggers as follows:
1. AUTO TRIG
While trying to detect the DTC by performing the DTC Confir-
mation Procedure, be sure to select to DATA MONITOR
(AUTO TRIG) mode. You can confirm the malfunction at the
moment it is detected.
While narrowing down the possible causes, CONSULT-II should be set in DATA MONITOR (AUTO
TRIG) mode, especially in case the incident is intermittent.
When you are inspecting the circuit by gently shaking (or twisting) the suspicious connectors, components
and harness in the DTC Confirmation Procedure, the moment a malfunction is found the DTC will be dis-
played. Refer to GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident" , INCIDENT SIMU-
LATION TESTS.
2. MANU TRIG
PBIB0480E
SEF707X
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1779
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
If the malfunction is displayed as soon as DATA MONITOR is selected, reset CONSULT-II to MANU
TRIG. By selecting MANU TRIG you can monitor and store the data. The data can be utilized for further
diagnosis, such as a comparison with the value for the normal operating condition.
FUNCTION TEST
This mode is used to inform customers of their vehicle condition of periodic maintenance.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00DYS
Remarks:
G Specification data are reference values.
G Specification data are output/input values which are detected or supplied by the ECM at the connector.
* Specification data may not be directly related to their components signals/values/operations.
SEF720X
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
CKPS-RPM (TDC)
G Tachometer: Connect
G Run engine and compare tachometer indication with the CONSULT-
II value
Almost the same speed as the
CONSULT-II value
COOLAN TEMP/S G Engine: After warming up More than 70C (158F)
VHCL SPEED SE
G Turn drive wheels and compare speedometer indication with the
CONSULT-II value
Almost the same speed as the
CONSUT-II value
FUEL TEMP SEN G Engine: After warming up More than 40C (104F)
ACCEL POS SEN
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: fully released 0.8 - 1.3V
Accelerator pedal: fully depressed More than 3.5V
ACCEL SEN 2
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: fully released 0.3 - 1.8V
Accelerator pedal: fully depressed More than 3.0V
OFF ACCEL SW
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: fully released ON
Accelerator pedal: slightly
depressed
OFF
EC-1780
[YD]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
MAS AIR/FL SE
G Engine: After warming up
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Shift lever: Neutral position
G No-load
Idle 1.0 - 2.5V
2,000 rpm 2.1 - 2.7V
BATTERY VOLT G Ignition switch: ON (Engine stopped) 11 - 14V
P/N POSI SW G Ignition switch: ON
Shift lever: Neutral position ON
Except above OFF
START SIGNAL G Ignition switch: ON START ON OFF ON OFF
PW/ST SIGNAL
G Engine: After warming up, idle
the engine
Steering wheel is in neutral posi-
tion. (Forward direction)
OFF
Steering wheel is turned. ON
BRAKE SW G Ignition switch: ON
Brake pedal: Fully released OFF
Brake pedal: Slightly depressed ON
IGN SW G Ignition switch: ON OFF ON OFF
ACT CR PRESS
G Engine: After warming up
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Shift lever: Neutral position
G No-load
Idle 30 - 40 MPa
2,000 rpm 40 - 50 MPa
SUCTION CV
G Engine: After warming up
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Shift lever: Neutral position
G No-load
Idle 70.0 - 71.5CA
2,000 rpm 73.5 - 75.0CA
MAIN INJ WID
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: Neutral position
G Idle speed
No-load 0.68 - 0.78 msec
Air conditioner switch: ON
Rear window defogger switch: ON
0.78 - 0.88 msec
GLOW RLY Refer to EC-1889, "GLOW CONTROL SYSTEM" .
COOLING FAN
G When cooling fan is stopped. OFF
G When cooling fans operate at low speed. LOW
G When cooling fans operate at high speed. HIGH
EGR VOL CON/V
G Engine: After warming up
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Shift lever: Neutral position
G No-load
After one minute at idle More than 10 steps
Revving engine from idle to 3,600
rpm
0 step
INT/A VOLUME G Engine: After warming up, idle the engine 150 - 450 mg/st
BARO SEN G Ignition switch: ON
Altitude
Approx. 0m: Approx. 100.62 kPa
(1.0062 bar, 1.026 kg/cm
2
, 14.59
psi)
Approx. 1,000 m: Approx. 88.95
kPa (0.8895 bar, 0.907 kg/cm
2
,
12.90 psi)
Approx. 1,500 m: Approx. 83.16
kPa (0.8316 bar, 0.848 kg/cm
2
,
12.06 psi)
Approx. 2,000 m: Approx. 78.36
kPa (0.7836 bar, 0.799 kg/cm
2
,
11.36 psi)
CYL COUNT G Engine is running 0 1 2 3
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
EC-1781
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
NOTE:
Any monitored item that does not match the vehicle being diagnosed is deleted from the display automatically.
Major Sensor Reference Graph in Data Monitor Mode EBS00DYT
The following are the major sensor reference graphs in DATA MONITOR mode.
ACCEL POS SEN, CKPSRPM (TDC), MAS AIR/FL SE
Below is the data for ACCEL POS SEN, CKPSRPM (TDC) and MAS AIR/FL SE when revving engine
quickly up to 3,000 rpm under no load after warming up engine to the normal operating temperature.
TURBO BST SEN
G Engine: After warming up
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Shift lever: Neutral position
G No-load
Idle Approx. 100kPa
2,500 rpm Approx. 114 kPa
3,000 rpm Approx. 100 - 104 kPa
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
EC-1782
[YD]
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS
Each value is for reference, the exact value may vary.
SEF321Y
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
EC-1783
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT PFP:00006
Description EBS00DYU
Intermittent incidents (I/I) may occur. In many cases, the problem resolves itself (the part or circuit function
returns to normal without intervention). It is important to realize that the symptoms described in the customer's
complaint often do not recur on DTC visits. Realize also that the most frequent cause of I/I occurrences is poor
electrical connections. Because of this, the conditions under which the incident occurred may not be clear.
Therefore, circuit checks made as part of the standard diagnostic procedure may not indicate the specific
problem area.
COMMON I/I REPORT SITUATIONS
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00DYV
1. INSPECTION START
Erase DTCs. Refer to EC-1748, "HOW TO ERASE DTC" .
>> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK GROUND TERMINALS
Check ground terminals for corroding or loose connection.
Refer to GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident" , CIRCUIT INSPECTION,
Ground Inspection.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair or replace.
3. SEARCH FOR ELECTRICAL INCIDENT
Perform GI-24, "How to Perform Efficient Diagnosis for an Electrical Incident" , INCIDENT SIMULATION
TESTS.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> Repair or replace.
STEP in Work Flow Situation
II The CONSULT-II is used. The SELF-DIAG RESULTS screen shows time data other than 0.
III The symptom described by the customer does not recur.
IV DTC does not appear during the DTC Confirmation Procedure.
VI The Diagnostic Procedure for XXXX does not indicate the problem area.
EC-1784
[YD]
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM PFP:24110
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00DYW
Remarks: Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION
DATA
(DC Voltage and Pulse Signal)
A5
A6
A7
B
B
B
ECM ground
[Engine is running]
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
A8
A9
R
R
Power supply for ECM [Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
A31 W/L Power supply for ECM [Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
D18
D19
W/R
W/R
Ignition switch [Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
D24
D26
G
G
ECM relay (self-shutoff)
[Ignition switch ON]
[Ignition switch OFF]
G For a few seconds after turning ignition
switch OFF
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch OFF]
G A few seconds passed after turning ignition
switch OFF
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
EC-1785
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00DYX
MBWA0097E
EC-1786
[YD]
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00DYY
1. INSPECTION START
Start engine.
Is engine running?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 6.
No >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-I
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminals D18, D19 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G Fuse block (J/B) connector M1
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between ECM and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK ECM GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals A5, A6, A7 and engine ground. Refer to Wiring Dia-
gram.
4. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0356E
Continuity should exist.
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
EC-1787
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-II
1. Reconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Turn ignition switch ON and then OFF.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminals A8, A9 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> Check EDU power supply circuit. Refer to EC-1847,
"Diagnostic Procedure" .
NG >> GO TO 6.
6. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-III
1. Disconnect ECM relay.
2. Check voltage between relay terminals 1, 6 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G 20A fuse
G Harness for open or short between ECM relay and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
Voltage:
After turning ignition switch OFF, battery
voltage will exist for a few seconds, then
drop to approximately 0V.
MBIB0183E
MBIB0081E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0359E
EC-1788
[YD]
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
8. CHECK OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals D24, D26 and ECM relay terminal 2. Refer to Wiring
Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
9. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-IV
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals A8, A9 and ECM relay terminal 7. Refer to Wiring Dia-
gram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
10. CHECK ECM RELAY
Refer to EC-1789, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> Replace ECM relay.
11. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-V
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check voltage between ECM terminal A31 and ground.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> GO TO 12.
12. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G 20A fuse
G Harness for open or short between ECM and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0184E
POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR ECM
EC-1789
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
13. CHECK ECM GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals A5, A6, A7 and engine ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
14. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00DYZ
ECM RELAY
1. Apply 12V direct current between ECM relay terminals 1 and 2.
2. Check continuity between relay terminals 3 and 5, 6 and 7.
3. If NG, replace ECM relay.
Continuity should exist.
Condition Continuity
12V direct current supply between
terminals 1 and 2
Yes
OFF No
PBIB0077E
EC-1790
[YD]
DTC U1000 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE
DTC U1000 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE PFP:23710
Description EBS00G9W
CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial communication line for real time application. It is an on-vehicle mul-
tiplex communication line with high data communication speed and excellent error detection ability. Many elec-
tronic control units are equipped onto a vehicle, and each control unit shares information and links with other
control units during operation (not independent). In CAN communication, control units are connected with 2
communication lines (CAN H line, CAN L line) allowing a high rate of information transmission with less wiring.
Each control unit transmits/receives data but selectively reads required data only.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00G9X
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00G9Y
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 3 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. If 1st trip DTC is detected, go to EC-1792, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
DTC No.
Trouble diagnosis
name
DTC detecting condition Possible cause
U1000
1000
CAN communication
line
G ECM can not communicate to other control
unit.
G ECM can not communicate for more than the
specified time.
G Harness or connectors
(CAN communication line is open or
shorted)
DTC U1000 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE
EC-1791
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00G9Z
MBWA0124E
EC-1792
[YD]
DTC U1000 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00GA0
1. INSPECTION START
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select CAN DIAG SUPPORT MNTR in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Print out the CONSULT-II screen.
>> Go to LAN-8, "CAN COMMUNICATION" .
MBIB0009E
DTC P0100 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR (MAFS)
EC-1793
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0100 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR (MAFS) PFP:22680
Component Description EBS00DZ0
The mass air flow sensor (MAFS) is placed in the stream of intake
air. It measures the intake air flow rate by measuring a part of the
entire intake air flow. It consists of a hot film that is supplied with
electric current from the ECM. The temperature of the hot film is con-
trolled by the ECM a certain amount. The heat generated by the hot
film is reduced as the intake air flows around it. The more air, the
greater the heat loss.
Therefore, the ECM must supply more electric current to maintain
the temperature of the hot film as air flow increases. The ECM
detects the air flow by means of this current change.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00DZ1
Specification data are reference values.
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00DZ2
Specification data are reference values, and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
SEF987W
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
MAS AIR/FL SE
G Engine: After warming up
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Shift lever: Neutral position
G No-load
Idle 1.0 - 2.5V
2,000 rpm 2.1 - 2.7V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION
DATA
(DC Voltage and Pulse Signal)
A8
A9
R
R
Power supply for ECM [Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
A10 R Mass air flow sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0.5 - 2.5V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
1.5 - 3.5V
A24 B
Mass air flow sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
A27 W Sensor's power supply [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
PBIB0389E
PBIB0390E
EC-1794
[YD]
DTC P0100 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR (MAFS)
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00DZ3
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00DZ4
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON, and wait at least 6 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and wait at least 3 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1796, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
D24
D26
G
G
ECM relay (self-shutoff)
[Ignition switch ON]
[Ignition switch OFF]
G For a few seconds after turning ignition
switch OFF
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch OFF]
G A few seconds passed after turning ignition
switch OFF
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION
DATA
(DC Voltage and Pulse Signal)
DTC Malfunction is detected when ... Check Items (Possible Cause)
P0100 G An excessively high or low voltage from the sensor
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Mass air flow sensor
SEF817Y
DTC P0100 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR (MAFS)
EC-1795
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00DZ5
MBWA0098E
EC-1796
[YD]
DTC P0100 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR (MAFS)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00DZ6
1. CHECK MAFS POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect mass air flow sensor harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between mass air flow sensor terminals 2, 4 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between mass air flow sensor and ECM
G Harness for open or short between mass air flow sensor and ECM relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK MAFS GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
3. Check harness continuity between mass air flow sensor terminal
3 and engine ground. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check harness for open or short between mass air flow sensor and ECM.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0082E
Terminal Voltage
2 Approximately 5V
4 Battery voltage
PBIB0360E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0083E
DTC P0100 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR (MAFS)
EC-1797
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. CHECK MAFS INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between mass air flow sensor terminal 1 and ECM terminal A10. Refer to Wiring
Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EC-1797, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace mass air flow sensor.
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00DZ7
MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
1. Reconnect harness connectors disconnected.
2. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminal A10 (Mass air flow sensor
signal) and ground.
4. If the voltage is out of specification, disconnect MAFS harness
connector and connect it again.
Then repeat above check.
Removal and Installation EBS00DZ8
MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR
Refer to EM-213, "AIR CLEANER AND AIR DUCT" .
Continuity should exist.
Condition Voltage V
Ignition switch ON (Engine stopped.) Approx. 1.0
Idle (Engine is warmed up to normal
operating temperature.)
1.0 - 2.5
2,000 rpm (Engine is warmed up to nor-
mal operating temperature.)
2.1 - 2.7
PBIB0361E
EC-1798
[YD]
DTC P0115 ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR (CIRCUIT)
DTC P0115 ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR (CIRCUIT)
PFP:22630
Description EBS00DZ9
The engine coolant temperature sensor is used to detect the engine
coolant temperature. The sensor modifies a voltage signal from the
ECM. The modified signal returns to the ECM as the engine coolant
temperature input. The sensor uses a thermistor which is sensitive to
the change in temperature. The electrical resistance of the ther-
mistor decreases as temperature increases.
<Reference data>
*: These data are reference values and measured between ECM terminal A11
(Engine coolant temperature sensor) and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00DZA
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00DZB
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Wait at least 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1800, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF594K
Engine coolant tempera-
ture C (F)
Voltage* (V) Resistance (k)
10 (14) 4.4 7.0 - 11.4
20 (68) 3.5 2.1 - 2.9
50 (122) 2.3 0.68 - 1.00
90 (194) 1.0 0.236 - 0.260
SEF012P
DTC Malfunction is detected when ... Check Items (Possible Cause)
P0115 G An excessively high or low voltage from the sensor
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Engine coolant temperature sensor
SEF817Y
DTC P0115 ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR (CIRCUIT)
EC-1799
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00DZC
MBWA0099E
EC-1800
[YD]
DTC P0115 ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR (CIRCUIT)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00DZD
1. CHECK ECTS POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect engine coolant temperature sensor harness connec-
tor.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between ECTS terminal 1 and ground with CON-
SULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check harness for open or short between ECM and engine coolant temperature sensor.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK ECTS GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between ECTS terminal 2 and engine ground. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check harness for open or short between ECM and engine coolant temperature sensor.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
PBIB0374E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0080E
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0115 ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR (CIRCUIT)
EC-1801
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. CHECK ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Refer to EC-1801, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace engine coolant temperature sensor.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00DZE
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1. Check resistance between engine coolant temperature sensor
terminals 1 and 2 as shown in the figure.
<Reference data>
*: These data are measured between ECM terminal A11 (Engine coolant tem-
perature sensor) and body ground.
2. If NG, replace engine coolant temperature sensor.
Removal and Installation EBS00DZF
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Refer to EM-274, "CYLINDER HEAD" .
PBIB0081E
Engine coolant temperature C (F) Resistance k
20 (68) 2.1 - 2.9
50 (122) 0.68 - 1.00
90 (194) 0.236 - 0.260
SEF012P
EC-1802
[YD]
DTC P0120 ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
DTC P0120 ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR PFP:18002
Description EBS00DZG
The accelerator work unit is installed on the upper end of the accelerator pedal assembly. The accelerator
pedal position sensor 1, 2 and accelerator pedal released position switch are built into the accelerator work
unit. The sensors detect the accelerator pedal position and sends a signal to the ECM. The ECM uses the sig-
nal to determine the amount of fuel to be injected.
The accelerator pedal released position switch detects accelerator pedal released position and sends the sig-
nal to the ECM. The ECM will then determine engine idle conditions. The signal is also used for diagnosing the
accelerator pedal position sensor.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00DZH
Specification data are reference values.
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00DZI
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
MBIB0006E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
ACCEL POS SEN
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: fully released 0.8 - 1.3V
Accelerator pedal: fully depressed More than 3.5V
ACCEL SEN 2
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: fully released 0.3 - 1.8V
Accelerator pedal: fully depressed More than 3.0V
OFF ACCEL SW
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: fully released ON
Accelerator pedal: slightly
depressed
OFF
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION
DATA
(DC Voltage and Pulse Signal)
A21 B
Accelerator pedal
released position switch
ground
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 0V
A22 LG
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1 ground
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 0V
DTC P0120 ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
EC-1803
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00DZJ
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00DZK
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Depress and release fully accelerator pedal slowly.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1805, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
A26 LG/R
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2 ground
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 0V
A28 PU/R
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1 power supply
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
B15 W
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.8 - 1.3V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.5V
B16 L
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.3 - 1.8V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.0V
B23 GY/L
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2 power supply
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
D14 G/Y
Accelerator pedal
released position switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal slightly depressed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully released
Approximately 0V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION
DATA
(DC Voltage and Pulse Signal)
DTC Malfunction is detected when ... Check Items (Possible Cause)
P0120 G An improper voltage signal from accelerator pedal
position sensor 1 and/or 2 is send to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Accelerator pedal position sensor 1
G Accelerator pedal position sensor 2
G Accelerator pedal released position switch
SEF817Y
EC-1804
[YD]
DTC P0120 ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00DZL
MBWA0104E
DTC P0120 ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
EC-1805
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00DZM
1. CHECK ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR FUNCTION
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select ACCEL POS SEN and ACCEL SEN 2 in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Check ACCEL POS SEN and ACCEL SEN 2 signal under
the following conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> GO TO 3.
2. CHECK ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION SWITCH FUNCTION
With CONSULT-II
1. Select OFF ACCEL SW in DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
2. Check OFF ACCEL SW signal under the following conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 16.
NG >> GO TO 10.
Conditions ACCEL POS SEN ACCEL SEN 2
Accelerator pedal fully
released
0.8 - 1.3V 0.3 - 1.8V
Accelerator pedal fully
depressed
More than 3.5V More than 3.0V
PBIB0403E
Conditions OFF ACCEL SW
Accelerator pedal fully released ON
Accelerator pedal depressed OFF
PBIB0404E
EC-1806
[YD]
DTC P0120 ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
3. CHECK ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect accelerator work unit harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between accelerator work unit terminals 7, 1 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
4. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors F109, M77
G Harness connectors F110, M80
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator work unit
>> Repair harness or connectors.
5. CHECK ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screw.
3. Check harness continuity between accelerator work unit termi-
nals 2, 8 and engine ground. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
MBIB0080E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
MBIB0003E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0083E
DTC P0120 ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
EC-1807
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
6. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors F109, M70
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator work unit
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND
SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal B15 and accelerator work unit terminal 6, ECM terminal
B16 and accelerator work unit terminal 3. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> GO TO 8.
8. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors F109, M77
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator work unit
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
9. CHECK ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
Refer to EC-1809, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 16.
NG >> GO TO 15.
Continuity should exist.
EC-1808
[YD]
DTC P0120 ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
10. CHECK ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect accelerator work unit harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between accelerator work unit terminal 5 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> GO TO 11.
11. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors F109, M77
G Harness for open or short between accelerator work unit and ECM
>> Repair harness or connectors.
12. CHECK ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION SWITCH GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN
AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between accelerator work unit terminal 4 and ECM terminal A21. Refer to Wir-
ing Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14.
NG >> GO TO 13.
13. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors F109, M77
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator work unit
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0080E
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0004E
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0120 ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
EC-1809
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
14. CHECK ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION SWITCH
Refer to EC-1809, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 16.
NG >> GO TO 15.
15. REPLEACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ASSEMBLY
1. Replace accelerator work unit.
2. Perform EC-1745, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
16. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00DZN
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR
With CONSULT-II
1. Reconnect all disconnected harness connectors.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
4. Check the indication of ACCEL POS SEN and ACCEL SEN 2
under the following conditions.
ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION SWITCH
Check continuity between accelerator position switch terminals 4
and 5 under the following conditions.
Removal and Installation EBS00DZO
ACCELERATOR WORK UNIT
Refer to ACC-2, "ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM" .
Conditions ACCEL POS SEN ACCEL SEN 2
Accelerator pedal fully
released
0.8 - 1.3V 0.3 - 1.8V
Accelerator pedal fully
depressed
More than 3.5V More than 3.0V
PBIB0403E
Conditions Continuity
Accelerator pedal fully released Should exist.
Accelerator pedal depressed Should not exist.
MBIB0005E
EC-1810
[YD]
DTC P0190 COMMON RAIL FUEL PRESSURE SENSOR
DTC P0190 COMMON RAIL FUEL PRESSURE SENSOR PFP:16638
Description EBS00DZP
The common rail fuel pressure sensor is placed to the common rail. It measures the fuel pressure in the com-
mon rail. The sensor sends voltage signal to the ECM. As the pressure increases, the voltage rises.
The ECM controls the fuel pressure in the common rail by the suction control valve. The ECM uses the signal
from common rail fuel pressure sensor as a feedback signal.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00DZQ
Specification data are reference values.
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00DZR
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00DZS
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00DZT
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Wait at least 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1812, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
MONITOR CONDITION SPECIFICATOIN
ACT CR PRESS
G Engine: After warming up
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Shift lever: Neutral position
G No-load
Idle 30 - 40 MPa
2,000 rpm 40 - 50 MPa
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION
DATA
(DC Voltage and Pulse Signal)
A24 B Sensor's ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
A27 W Sensor's power supply [Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
B13
B14
Y/R
Y/R
Common rail fuel pressure
sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1.6 - 1.8V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
1.8 - 2.0V
DTC Malfunction is detected when ... Check Items (Possible Cause)
P0190 G An excessively high or low voltage from the sensor
is entered to ECM.
G Harness or connectors (The sensor circuit is open
or shorted.)
G Common rail fuel pressure sensor
SEF817Y
DTC P0190 COMMON RAIL FUEL PRESSURE SENSOR
EC-1811
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00DZU
MBWA0114E
EC-1812
[YD]
DTC P0190 COMMON RAIL FUEL PRESSURE SENSOR
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00DZV
1. CHECK COMMON RAIL FUEL PRESSURE SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect common rail fuel pressure sensor harness connec-
tor.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between common rail fuel pressure sensor termi-
nal 1 and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
2. CHECK COMMON RAIL FUEL PRESSURE SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between common rail fuel pressure sensor terminal 3 and engine ground. Refer
to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check harness for open or short between ECM and common rail fuel pressure sensor.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0075E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
PBIB0405E
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0190 COMMON RAIL FUEL PRESSURE SENSOR
EC-1813
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. CHECK COMMON RAIL FUEL PRESSURE SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND
SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals B13, B14 and common rail fuel pressure sensor termi-
nal 2. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness connectors.
5. CHECK COMMON RAIL FUEL PRESSURE SENSOR
Refer to EC-1813, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace common rail assembly.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00DZW
COMMON RAIL FUEL PRESSURE SENSOR
1. Reconnect harness connector disconnected.
2. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
3. Check voltage between ECM terminals B13, B14 (Common rail
fuel pressure sensor signal) and ground under the following con-
ditions.
4. If the voltage is out of specification, disconnect common rail fuel
pressure sensor harness connector and connect it again. Then
repeat above check.
5. If NG, replace common rail.
Removal and Installation EBS00DZX
COMMON RAIL
Refer to EM-236, "INJECTION TUBE AND FUEL INJECTOR" .
Continuity should exist.
Condition Voltage V
Idle 1.6 - 1.8
2,000 rpm 1.8 - 2.0
PBIB0588E
EC-1814
[YD]
DTC P0201 - P0204 FUEL INJECTOR
DTC P0201 - P0204 FUEL INJECTOR PFP:16600
Description EBS00DZY
The ECM sends the fuel injection signal to EDU (Electronic Drive Unit). Then the EDU sends ON signals to
fuel injectors to operate them.
The EDU monitors injector ground circuit and sends the feedback signal to the ECM.
COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
The fuel injector is a small, precise solenoid valve. When fuel injec-
tor receives ON signal from EDU, the coil in the fuel injector is ener-
gized. The energized coil pulls the needle valve back and allows fuel
to flow through the fuel injector into the cylinder. The amount of fuel
injected depends upon the injection pulse duration. Pulse duration is
the length of time the fuel injector remains open. The ECM controls
the injection pulse duration based on engine fuel needs.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00DZZ
Remarks: Specification data are reference values.
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00E00
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
PBIB0482E
PBIB0465E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
MAIN INJ WID
G Engine: After warming up
G Shift lever: Neutral position
G Idle speed
No-load 0.68 - 0.78 msec
Air conditioner switch: ON
Rear window defogger switch: ON
0.78 - 0.88 msec
DTC P0201 - P0204 FUEL INJECTOR
EC-1815
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00E01
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION
DATA
(DC Voltage and Pulse Signal)
A1
A2
A3
A4
L/W
Y/PU
PU
Y
EDU drive No. 2
EDU drive No. 4
EDU drive No. 3
EDU drive No. 1
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0 - 4V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
0 - 4V
A8
A9
R
R
Power supply for ECM [Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
A29 W/PU EDU injector check signal
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1 - 5V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
1 - 5V
D24
D26
G
G
ECM relay (self-shutoff)
[Ignition switch ON]
[Ignition switch OFF]
G For a few seconds after turning ignition
switch OFF
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch OFF]
G A few seconds passed after turning ignition
switch OFF
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
PBIB0387E
PBIB0388E
PBIB0391E
PBIB0392E
DTC Malfunction is detected when .... Check Items (Possible cause)
P0201 G Injector No.1 does not operate normally. G Harness or connectors
(Injector circuit is open or shorted.)
G Electronic drive unit
G Fuel injector
P0202 G Injector No.2 does not operate normally.
P0203 G Injector No.3 does not operate normally.
P0204 G Injector No.4 does not operate normally.
EC-1816
[YD]
DTC P0201 - P0204 FUEL INJECTOR
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00E02
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and run it for at least 2 seconds at idle speed.
(If engine does not run, turn ignition switch to START for at
least 2 seconds.)
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1819, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF817Y
DTC P0201 - P0204 FUEL INJECTOR
EC-1817
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00E03
MBWA0117E
EC-1818
[YD]
DTC P0201 - P0204 FUEL INJECTOR
MBWA0118E
DTC P0201 - P0204 FUEL INJECTOR
EC-1819
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00E04
1. CHECK ECM OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector and EDU harness con-
netor.
3. Check harness continuity between the following terminals corre-
sponding to the malfunctioning cylinder. Refer to Wiring Dia-
gram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
2. CHECK EDU OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect fuel injector harness connector of malfunctioning
cylinder.
2. Check harness continuity between the following terminals corre-
sponding to the malfunctioning cylinder. Refer to Wiring Dia-
gram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
DTC
Terminals
Cylinder
ECM EDU
P0201 A4 4 No.1
P0202 A1 1 No.2
P0203 A3 3 No.3
P0204 A2 2 No.4
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0084E
DTC
Terminals
Cylinder
EDU Fuel injector
P0201 9 4 No.1
P0202 12 4 No.2
P0203 10 4 No.3
P0204 11 4 No.4
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0085E
EC-1820
[YD]
DTC P0201 - P0204 FUEL INJECTOR
3. CHECK FUEL INJECOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity fuel injector terminal 3 of malfunctioning cylinder and EDU terminal 13.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK FUEL INJECTOR-I
Refer to EC-1820, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace fuel injector.
5. CHECK FUEL INJECTOR-II
1. Remove two fuel injectors of malfunctioning cylinder and another cylinder.
2. Install fuel injectors to different cylinder.
3. Reconnect ECM harness connector, EDU harness connector and fuel injector harness connector.
4. Erase DTC. Refer to EC-1748, "HOW TO ERASE DTC" .
5. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
6. Start engine and warm it up to the normal operating temperature.
7. Check DTC.
Same DTC is detected. >>Replace EDU.
Another DTC is detected. >>Replace fuel injector of malfunctioning cylinder.
No DTC is detected. >>GO TO 6.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00E05
FUEL INJECTOR
1. Disconnect fuel injector.
2. Check continuity between terminals as shown in the figure.
3. If NG, replace fuel injector.
Removal and Installation EBS00E06
FUEL INJECTOR
Refer to EM-236, "INJECTION TUBE AND FUEL INJECTOR" .
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
PBIB0406E
DTC P0235 CHARGE AIR PRESSURE SENSOR
EC-1821
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0235 CHARGE AIR PRESSURE SENSOR PFP:22365
Component Description EBS00G9B
The charge air pressure sensor detects pressure in the exit side of
the charge air cooler. The sensor output voltage to the ECM
increases as pressure increases.
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00G9D
Specification data are reference values, and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may damage the
ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00G9E
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00G9F
PROCEDURE FOR MALFUNCTION A
WITH CONSULT-II
SEF340VA
SEF627RA
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION
DATA
(DC Voltage)
46 L
Charge air pressure sen-
sor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 2.0V
DTC Malfunction is detected when ... Check Items (Possible Cause)
P0235
A
G An excessively high or low voltage from the sensor is
sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Charge air pressure sensor
B
G The ECM detects the variable nozzle turbocharger
control actuator is stuck. MI will not light up for this
malfunction .
G Harness or connectors
(The solenoid valve circuit is shorted.)
G Variable nozzle turbocharger control actuator
EC-1822
[YD]
DTC P0235 CHARGE AIR PRESSURE SENSOR
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Wait at least 5 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected and MI lights up, go to EC-1821, "PROCE-
DURE FOR MALFUNCTION A" .
OVERALL FUNCTION CHECK FOR MALFUNCTION B
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Start engine and warm it up to normal operating temperature.
2. Turn ignition switch OFF.
3. Make sure that variable nozzle turbocharger control actuator rod moves while performing the following
procedure.
a. Start engine and let it idle.
b. Turn ignition switch OFF.
4. If NG, go to EC-1822, "OVERALL FUNCTION CHECK FOR MALFUNCTION B" .
SEF817Y
DTC P0235 CHARGE AIR PRESSURE SENSOR
EC-1823
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00G9G
MBWA0123E
EC-1824
[YD]
DTC P0235 CHARGE AIR PRESSURE SENSOR
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00G9H
PROCEDURE A
1. CHECK CHARGE AIR PRESSURE SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect charge air pressure sensor harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between charge air pressure sensor terminal 1
and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
2. CHECK CHARGE AIR PRESSURE SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between charge air pressure sensor terminal 3 and engine ground. Refer to
Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check harness for open or short between ECM and charge air pressure sensor.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0182E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
MBIB0072E
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0235 CHARGE AIR PRESSURE SENSOR
EC-1825
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
4. CHECK CHARGE AIR PRESSURE SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals B2 and charge air pressure sensor terminal 2. Refer to
Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness connectors.
5. CHECK CHARGE AIR PRESSURE SENSOR
Refer to EC-1826, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace charge air pressure sensor.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
PROCEDURE B
1. CHECK VARIABLE NOZZLE TURBOCHARGER CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OUTPUT SIGNAL
CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal B17 and variable nozzle turbocharger control solenoid
valve terminal 1. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
2. CHECK CHARGE AIR PRESSURE SENSOR
Refer to EC-1826, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Replace charge air pressure sensor.
3. CHECK VARIABLE NOZZLE TURBOCHARGER CONTROL ACTUATOR
Refer to EM-224, "VARIABLE NOZZLE TURBOCHARGER CONTROL ACTUATOR" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Replace variable nozzle turbocharger.
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
EC-1826
[YD]
DTC P0235 CHARGE AIR PRESSURE SENSOR
4. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00G9I
CHECK CHARGE AIR PRESSURE SENSOR
1. Remove charge air pressure sensor with its harness connected.
2. Turn ignition switch ON.
3. Use pump to apply pressure sensor as shown in the figure.
CAUTION:
G Always calibrate the pressure pump gauge when using it.
G Inspection should be done at room temperature [10-30C (50-86F)].
4. Check the output voltage between charge air pressure sensor terminal 2 and engine ground.
Removal and Installation EBS00G9J
CHARGE AIR PRESSURE SENSOR
Refer to EM-220, "Removal and Installation" .
Pressure (Relative to atmospheric pressure) Voltage V
0 kPa (0 mbar, 0 mmHg, 0 inHg) Approximately 2.0V
+40 kPa (400 mbar, 300mmHg, 11.81 inHg) Approximately 2.6V
MBIB0071E
DTC P0335 CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (TDC)
EC-1827
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0335 CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (TDC) PFP:23731
Description EBS00E07
The crankshaft position sensor (TDC) monitors engine speed by
means of signals from the sensing plate (with 23 protrusions)
installed to the fly wheel. The datum signal output is detected 15
signal and sent to the ECM. The sensor signal is used for fuel injec-
tion control and fuel injection timing control.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00E08
Specification data are reference values.
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00E09
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
PBIB0368E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
CKPSRPM (TDC)
G Tachometer: Connect
G Run engine and compare tachometer indication with the CONSULT-II
value.
Almost the same speed as the
CONSULT-II value.
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION
DATA(DC Voltage and Pulse Sig-
nal)
B20 L/R
Crankshaft position sen-
sor (TDC) ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
B21 L/G
Crankshaft position sen-
sor (TDC)
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0 - 12.5V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
0 - 30V
PBIB0395E
PBIB0396E
EC-1828
[YD]
DTC P0335 CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (TDC)
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00E0A
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00E0B
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select DATA MONITOR mode
with CONSULT-II.
2. Crank engine for at least 1 second.
3. Start engine and run it for at least 2 seconds at idle speed.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1830, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
DTC Malfunction is detected when ... Check Items (Possible Cause)
P0335 G An improper voltage signal from the sensor is sent
to ECM during running and cranking.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Crankshaft position sensor (TDC)
SEF817Y
DTC P0335 CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (TDC)
EC-1829
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00E0C
MBWA0112E
EC-1830
[YD]
DTC P0335 CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (TDC)
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00E0D
1. CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (TDC) GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
3. Disconnect crankshaft position sensor (TDC) harness connector
and ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal B20 and
crankshaft position sensor (TDC) terminal 1. Refer to Wiring
Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
2. CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (TDC) INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between crankshaft position sensor (TDC) terminal 2 and ECM terminal B21.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (TDC)
Refer to EC-1830, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Replace crankshaft position sensor (TDC).
4. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00E0E
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (TDC)
1. Loosen the fixing bolt of the sensor.
MBIB0083E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0079E
Continuity should exist.
DTC P0335 CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (TDC)
EC-1831
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Disconnect crankshaft position sensor (TDC) harness connector.
3. Remove the sensor.
4. Visually check the sensor for chipping.
5. Check resistance as shown in the figure.
Removal and Installation EBS00E0F
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (TDC)
When installing crankshaft position sensor (TDC), tighten it with spe-
cific torque.
PBIB0419E
Resistance: 1,850 - 2,450
PBIB0417E
Tightening torque:
4.9 - 7.9 Nm (0.50 - 0.81 kg-m, 43 - 70 in-lb)
PBIB0416E
EC-1832
[YD]
DTC P0340 CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
DTC P0340 CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR PFP:23731
Description EBS00E0G
The camshaft position sensor identifies a particular cylinder by
means of signals from the sensing plate (with five protrusions)
installed to the camshaft. The datum signal output is detected 90
signal and sent to the ECM. The sensor signal is used for fuel injec-
tion control and fuel injection timing control.
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00E0H
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00E0I
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00E0J
Before performing the following procedure, confirm that battery voltage is more than 10V.
PBIB0367E
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION
DATA(DC Voltage and Pulse Sig-
nal)
B18 G
Camshaft position sensor
ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
B19 R Camshaft position sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0 - 3V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
0 - 8V
PBIB0393E
PBIB0394E
DTC Malfunction is detected when ... Check Items (Possible Cause)
P0340 G An improper voltage signal from the sensor is send
to ECM during running and cranking.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Camshaft position sensor
DTC P0340 CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
EC-1833
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and select DATA MONITOR mode
with CONSULT-II.
2. Crank engine for at least 1 second.
3. Start engine and run it for at least 2 seconds at idle speed.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1835, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF817Y
EC-1834
[YD]
DTC P0340 CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Wiring Diagram EBS00E0K
MBWA0113E
DTC P0340 CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
EC-1835
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00E0L
1. CHECK CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Loosen and retighten engine ground screws.
3. Disconnect camshaft position sensor harness connector and
ECM harness connector.
4. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal B18 and cam-
shaft position sensor terminal 1. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
2. CHECK CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between camshaft position sensor terminal 2 and ECM terminal B19. Refer to
Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Refer to EC-1835, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Replace camshaft position sensor.
4. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00E0M
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
1. Loosen the fixing bolt of the sensor.
MBIB0083E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0076E
Continuity should exist.
EC-1836
[YD]
DTC P0340 CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
2. Disconnect camshaft position sensor harness connector.
3. Remove the sensor.
4. Visually check the sensor for chipping.
5. Check resistance as shown in the figure.
Removal and Installation EBS00E0N
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
Refer to EM-232, "VACUUM PUMP" .
PBIB0418E
Resistance: 1,850 - 2,450
PBIB0417E
DTC P0500 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (VSS)
EC-1837
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P0500 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (VSS) PFP:32702
Description EBS00E0O
NOTE:
If DTC P0500 is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to
EC-1790, "DTC U1000 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE".
The vehicle speed signal is sent to the combination meter from the ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit)
through CAN communication line. The combination meter then sends a signal to the ECM through CAN com-
munication line.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00E0Q
Overall Function Check EBS00E0R
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the vehicle speed signal circuit. During this check, a DTC
might not be confirmed.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Lift up the vehicle.
2. Start engine.
3. Read VHCL SPEED SE in DATA MONITOR mode with CON-
SULT-II. The vehicle speed on CONSULT-II should exceed 10
km/h (6MPH) when rotating wheels with suitable gear position.
4. If NG, go to EC-1837, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00E0T
1. CHECK DTC
Check DTC with ABS actuator and electric unit (control unit),
Refer to LAN-246, "ABS Actuator and Electric Unit (control unit) Circuit Check" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair or replace.
2. CHECK COMBINATION METER
Check combination meter function.
Refer to LAN-247, "Combination Meter Circuit Check" .
>> INSPECHION END
DTC No. Trouble diagnosis name DTC detecting condition Possible cause
P0500 Vehicle speed sensor
The almost 0 km/h (0 MPH) signal from
vehicle speed sensor is sent to ECM
even when vehicle is being driven.
G Harness or connectors
(The CAN communication line is open or
shorted.)
G Wheel sensor
G Combination meter
G ABS actuator and electric unit
(control unit)
SEF864Y
EC-1838
[YD]
DTC P1107 ABSOLUTE PRESSURE SENSOR
DTC P1107 ABSOLUTE PRESSURE SENSOR PFP:23710
Description EBS00E0U
The absolute pressure sensor is built into ECM. The sensor detects
ambient barometric pressure and sends the voltage signal to the
microcomputer.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00E0V
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00E0W
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and wait at least 2 seconds.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1838, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00E0X
1. INSPECTION START
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select SELF DIAG RESULTS mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Touch ERASE.
4. Perform EC-1838, "DTC Confirmation Procedure" , again.
5. Is the DTC P1107 displayed again?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> INSPECTION END
PBIB0378E
DTC Malfunction is detected when ... Check Items (Possible Cause)
P1107 G An excessively high or low voltage from the abso-
lute pressure sensor (built-into ECM) is sent to
ECM.
G ECM
SEF817Y
DTC P1107 ABSOLUTE PRESSURE SENSOR
EC-1839
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. REPLACE ECM
1. Replace ECM.
2. Perform initialization of NATS system and registration of all NATS ignition key IDs. Refer to EC-1748,
"NATS (Nissan Anti-theft System)" .
3. Perform Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning. Refer to EC-1745 .
>> INSPECTION END
EC-1840
[YD]
DTC P1180 FUEL TEMPERATURE SENSOR
DTC P1180 FUEL TEMPERATURE SENSOR PFP:16700
Description EBS00E0Y
Fuel temperature sensor is built in the fuel supply pump. The sensor detects the fuel temperature in the fuel
supply pump and calibrates the fuel injection amount change by fuel temperature.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00E0Z
Remarks: Specification data are reference values.
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00E10
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00E11
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00E12
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and run it for at least 2 seconds at idle speed.
(If engine does not run, turn ignition switch to START for at
least 2 seconds.)
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1842, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
FUEL TEMP SEN G Engine: After warming up More than 40C (104F)
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
A12 PU Fuel temperature sensor
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
Approximately 0 - 4.8V
Output voltage varies with fuel
temperature
A23 B Sensor's ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
DTC Malfunction is detected when .... Check Items (Possible cause)
P1180 G An excessively high or low voltage from the sensor
is sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors
(The sensor circuit is open or shorted.)
G Fuel temperature sensor
SEF817Y
DTC P1180 FUEL TEMPERATURE SENSOR
EC-1841
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00E13
MBWA0107E
EC-1842
[YD]
DTC P1180 FUEL TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00E14
1. CHECK FUEL TEMPERATURE SENSOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect fuel temperature sensor harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between fuel temperature sensor terminal 2 and
engine ground.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
2. CHECK FUEL TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check harness continuity between fuel temperature sensor terminal 1 and ground. Refer to Wiring Dia-
gram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check harness for open or short to between ECM and fuel temperature sensor.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
OK or NG
OK >> Replace fuel supply pump.
NG >> Repair or replace.
Removal and Installation EBS00E15
FUEL SUPPLY PUMP
Refer to EM-239, "FUEL SUPPLY PUMP" .
PBIB0464E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
MBIB0185E
Continuity should exist.
DTC P1216 EDU
EC-1843
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1216 EDU PFP:22710
Description EBS00E16
The ECM sends the fuel injection signal to EDU (Electronic Drive Unit). Then the EDU sends ON signals to
fuel injectors to operate them.
The EDU monitors injector ground circuit and sends the feed back signal to the ECM.
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00E17
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
PBIB0482E
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION
DATA
(DC Voltage and Pulse Signal)
A1
A2
A3
A4
L/W
Y/PU
PU
Y
EDU drive No. 2
EDU drive No. 4
EDU drive No. 3
EDU drive No. 1
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0 - 4V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
0 - 4V
A8
A9
R
R
Power supply for ECM [Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
A29 W/PU EDU injector check signal
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
1 - 5V
PBIB0387E
PBIB0388E
PBIB0391E
EC-1844
[YD]
DTC P1216 EDU
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00E18
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00E19
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and run it for at least 2 seconds at idle speed.
(If engine does not run, turn ignition switch to START for at
least 2 seconds.)
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1847, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
1 - 5V
D24
D26
G
G
ECM relay (self-shutoff)
[Ignition switch ON]
[Ignition switch OFF]
G For a few seconds after turning ignition
switch OFF
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch OFF]
G A few seconds passed after turning ignition
switch OFF
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION
DATA
(DC Voltage and Pulse Signal)
PBIB0392E
DTC Malfunction is detected when .... Check Items (Possible cause)
P1216 G EDU feed back signal is not normal pattern. G Harness or connectors
(Injector drive circuit is open or shorted.)
G Electronic drive unit
G Fuel injectors
SEF817Y
DTC P1216 EDU
EC-1845
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00E1A
MBWA0108E
EC-1846
[YD]
DTC P1216 EDU
MBWA0109E
DTC P1216 EDU
EC-1847
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00E1B
1. INSPECTION START
1. Turn ignition switch START.
2. Is any cylinder ignited?
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK EDU POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect EDU harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between EDU terminal 6 and ground with CON-
SULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between EDU and ECM
G Harness for open or short between EDU and ECM relay
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK EDU GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between EDU terminal 8 and ground. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0084E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0421E
Continuity should exist.
EC-1848
[YD]
DTC P1216 EDU
5. CHECK ECM OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between the following terminals. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK EDU OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect fuel injector harness connectors.
2. Check harness continuity between the following terminals. Refer
to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
7. CHECK FUEL INJECTOR GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between fuel injector terminal 3 of each cylinder and EDU terminal 13. Refer to
Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK FUEL INJECTOR
Refer to EC-1820, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace fuel injector.
ECM terminal EDU terminal
A4 4
A3 3
A2 2
A1 1
Continuity should exist
EDU terminal Fuel injector terminal
9 4
10 4
11 4
12 4
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0085E
Continuity should exist.
DTC P1216 EDU
EC-1849
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
9. CHECK ECM INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector and EDU harness connector.
3. Check continuity between ECM terminal A29 and EDU terminal 5. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
10. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
OK or NG
OK >> Replace EDU.
NG >> Repair or replace.
Removal and Installation EBS00E1C
FUEL INJECTOR
Refer to EM-236, "INJECTION TUBE AND FUEL INJECTOR" .
Continuity should exist.
EC-1850
[YD]
DTC P1217 OVERHEAT (COOLING SYSTEM)
DTC P1217 OVERHEAT (COOLING SYSTEM) PFP:00021
Description EBS00E1D
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
NOTE:
If DTC P1217 is displayed with DTC U1000, first perform the trouble diagnosis for DTC U1000. Refer to
EC-1790, "DTC U1000 CAN COMMUNICATION LINE" .
COOLING FAN CONTROL
The ECM controls the cooling fan corresponding to the vehicle speed, engine coolant temperature, air condi-
tioner ON signal. The control system has 3-step control [HIGH/LOW/OFF].
OPERATION
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00E1E
Specification data are reference values.
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00E1F
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Sensor Input signal to ECM ECM function Actuator
Vehicle speed signal Vehicle speed
Cooling fan
control
Cooling fan relay (s) Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Air conditioner switch Air conditioner ON signal
SEF421Z
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
COOLING FAN
When cooling fan is stopped. OFF
When cooling fans operate at low speed. LOW
When cooling fans operate at high speed. HIGH
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
E2 LG Cooling fan relay (Low)
[Engine is running]
G Cooling fan is not operating
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Cooling fan is operating
Approximately 0.1V
E7 LG/B Cooling fan relay (High)
[Engine is running]
G Cooling fan is not operating
G Cooling fan is operating at low speed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Engine is running]
G Cooling fan is operating at high speed
Approximately 0.1V
DTC P1217 OVERHEAT (COOLING SYSTEM)
EC-1851
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00E1G
This diagnosis continuously monitors the engine coolant temperature.
If the cooling fan or another component in the cooling system malfunctions, engine coolant temperature will
rise.
When the engine coolant temperature reaches an abnormally high temperature condition, a malfunction is
indicated.
CAUTION:
When a malfunction is indicated, be sure to replace the coolant following the procedure in the CO-49,
"Changing Engine Coolant" . Also, replace the engine oil.
1. Fill radiator with coolant up to specified level with a filling speed of 2 liters per minute. Be sure to
use coolant with the proper mixture ratio. Refer to MA-18, "Engine Coolant Mixture Ratio" .
2. After refilling coolant, run engine to ensure that no water-flow noise is emitted.
Overall Function Check EBS00E1H
Use this procedure to check the overall function of the cooling fan. During this check, a DTC might not be con-
firmed.
WARNING:
Never remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could be caused by high pres-
sure fluid escaping from the radiator.
Wrap a thick cloth around the cap. Carefully remove the cap by turning it a quarter turn to allow built-
up pressure to escape. Then turn the cap all the way off.
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Check the coolant level in the reservoir tank and radiator.
Allow engine to cool before checking coolant level.
If the coolant level in the reservoir tank and/or radiator is below
the proper range, skip the following steps and go to EC-1855,
"Diagnostic Procedure" .
2. Confirm whether customer filled the coolant or not. If customer filled the coolant, skip the following steps
and go to EC-1855, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
DTC Malfunction is detected when ... Check Items (Possible Cause)
P1217 G Cooling fan does not operate properly (Overheat).
G Cooling fan system does not operate properly
(Overheat).
G Engine coolant was not added to the system using
the proper filling method.
G Harness or connectors
(The cooling fan circuit is open or shorted.)
G Harness or connectors
(The CAN communication line is open or shorted.)
G Cooling fan
G Radiator hose
G Radiator
G Radiator cap
G Water pump
G Thermostat
G Engine coolant temperature sensor
For more information, refer to EC-1863, "Main 12
Causes of Overheating" .
AEC640
EC-1852
[YD]
DTC P1217 OVERHEAT (COOLING SYSTEM)
4. Perform COOLING FAN in ACTIVE TEST mode with CON-
SULT-II and make sure that cooling fans operate when touching
HIGH or LOW.
If NG, go to EC-1855, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
SEF111X
DTC P1217 OVERHEAT (COOLING SYSTEM)
EC-1853
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00E1I
LHD MODELS
MBWA0149E
EC-1854
[YD]
DTC P1217 OVERHEAT (COOLING SYSTEM)
RHD MODELS
MBWA0150E
DTC P1217 OVERHEAT (COOLING SYSTEM)
EC-1855
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00E1J
1. CHECK COOLING FAN LOW SPEED OPERATION
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select COOLING FAN in ACTIVE TEST mode with CON-
SULT-II.
3. Touch LOW.
4. Make sure that cooling fans-1 and -2 operate at low speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Check cooling fan low speed control circuit. (Go to EC-
1857, "PROCEDURE A" .)
2. CHECK COOLING FAN HIGH SPEED OPERATION-I
With CONSULT-II
1. Touch HIGH.
2. Make sure that cooling fan-1 operates at higher speed than low
speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Check cooling fan high speed control circuit. (Go to EC-
1859, "PROCEDURE B" .)
3. CHECK COOLING FAN HIGH SPEED OPERATION-II
With CONSULT-II
Make sure that cooling fan-2 operates at higher speed than low speed.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Check cooling fan high speed control circuit. (Go to EC-1861, "PROCEDURE C" .)
4. CHECK COOLING SYSTEM FOR LEAK
Apply pressure to the cooling system with a tester, and check if the pressure drops.
CAUTION:
Higher than the specified pressure may cause radiator damage.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
SEF784Z
SEF785Z
Testing pressure: 157 kPa (1.57 bar, 1.6 kg/cm
2
, 23psi)
Pressure should not drop.
SLC754A
EC-1856
[YD]
DTC P1217 OVERHEAT (COOLING SYSTEM)
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following for leak.
G Hose
G Radiator
G Water pump (Refer to CO-59, "WATER PUMP" .)
>> Repair or replace.
6. CHECK RADIATOR CAP
Apply pressure to cap with a tester and check radiator cap relief
pressure.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace radiator cap.
7. CHECK THERMOSTAT
1. Remove thermostat.
2. Check valve seating condition at normal room temperatures.
It should seat tightly.
3. Check valve opening temperature and valve lift.
4. Check if valve is closed at 5C (9F) below valve opening tem-
perature. For details, refer to CO-61, "THERMOSTAT AND
WATER PIPING" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace thermostat.
8. CHECK ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Refer to EC-1801, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace engine coolant temperature sensor.
9. CHECK MAIN 12 CAUSES
If the cause cannot be isolated, go to EC-1863, "Main 12 Causes of Overheating" .
>> INSPECTION END
Radiator cap relief pressure:
78 - 98 kPa (0.59 - 0.98 bar, 0.6 - 1.0 kg/cm
2
, 9 - 14 psi)
SLC755A
Valve opening temperature:
80.5 - 83.5 C (177 - 182 F)
Valve lift:
More than 8 mm/95 C (0.31 in/203 F)
SLC343
DTC P1217 OVERHEAT (COOLING SYSTEM)
EC-1857
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
PROCEDURE A
1. CHECK COOLING FAN POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect cooling fan relay-1.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between cooling fan relay-1 terminals 2, 3 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Fuse block (J/B) connector E106
G 10A fuse
G 40A fusible link
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-1 and fuse
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-1 and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0086E
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0055E
EC-1858
[YD]
DTC P1217 OVERHEAT (COOLING SYSTEM)
3. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTORS CONTROL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect cooling fan motor-1 harness connector and cooling
fan motor-2 harness connector.
3. Disconnect cooling fan relay-2 and cooling fan relay-4.
4. Check harness continuity between the following.
Cooling fan relay-1 terminal 5 and cooling fan motor-1 terminal 1
Cooling fan motor-1 terminal 2 and cooling fan relay-2 terminal 3
Cooling fan motor-1 terminal 2 and cooling fan relay-4 terminal 3
Cooling fan relay-2 terminal 4 and cooling fan motor-2 terminal 1
Cooling fan relay-4 terminal 4 and cooling fan motor-2 terminal 1
Cooling fan motor-2 terminal 2 and ground
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
5. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect smart entrance control unit harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between cooling fan relay-1 terminal 1
and smart entrance control unit terminal 33. Refer to Wiring Dia-
gram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E123, M17 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E110, M94 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-1 and smart entrance control unit
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK COOLING FAN RELAY-1, -2 AND 4
Refer to EC-1864, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace cooling fan relay.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0087E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0173E
DTC P1217 OVERHEAT (COOLING SYSTEM)
EC-1859
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
7. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTORS-1 AND -2
Refer to EC-1864, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace cooling fan motors.
8. CHECK SMART ENTRANCE CONTROL UNIT
Refer to BCS-39, "Trouble Diagnoses" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace smart entrance control unit.
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Perform EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
PROCEDURE B
1. CHECK COOLING FAN RELAY GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect cooling fan relay-2 and cooling fan relay-4.
3. Check harness continuity between cooling fan relay-2 terminal 5
and ground, cooling fan relay-4 terminal 5 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
2. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTOR OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect smart entrance control unit harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between cooling fan relay-2 terminal 2
and smart entrance control unit terminal 32, cooling fan relay-4
terminal 2 and smart entrance control unit terminal 32.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0086E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0173E
EC-1860
[YD]
DTC P1217 OVERHEAT (COOLING SYSTEM)
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E123, M17 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E110, M94 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-2 and smart entrance control unit
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-4 and smart entrance control unit
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK COOLING FAN RELAYS-2 AND -4
Refer to EC-1864, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace cooling fan relays.
5. CHECK SMART ENTRANCE CONTROL UNIT
Refer to BCS-39, "Trouble Diagnoses" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace smart entrance control unit.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Perform EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
DTC P1217 OVERHEAT (COOLING SYSTEM)
EC-1861
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
PROCEDURE C
1. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTOR-2 POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect cooling fan relay-3.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between cooling fan relay-3 terminals 2, 3 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Fuse block (J/B) connector E106
G 10A fuse
G 40A fusible link
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-3 and fuse
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-3 and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0086E
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0055E
EC-1862
[YD]
DTC P1217 OVERHEAT (COOLING SYSTEM)
3. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTOR CONTROL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect cooling fan motor-2 harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between cooling fan relay-3 terminal 5 and cooling fan motor-2 terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK COOLING FAN MOTOR CONTROL CIRCUIT FOR SHORT TO GROUND
Check harness continuity between cooling fan relay-3 terminal 5 or cooling fan motor-2 terminal 1 and ground.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Cooling fan relays-2 and -4 (Refer to EC-1864 )
G Harness for short to ground between cooling fan relay-2 and cooling fan motor-2
G Harness for short to ground between cooling fan relay-3 and cooling fan motor-2
G Harness for short to ground between cooling fan relay-4 and cooling fan motor-2
>> Repair or replace.
6. CHECK COOLING FAN OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect smart entrance control unit harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between cooling fan relay-3 terminal 1
and smart entrance control unit terminal 32.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> GO TO 7.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0087E
Continuity should not exist.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0173E
DTC P1217 OVERHEAT (COOLING SYSTEM)
EC-1863
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
7. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E123, M17 (LHD models)
G Harness connectors E110, M94 (RHD models)
G Harness for open or short between cooling fan relay-3 and smart entrance control unit
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK COOLING FAN RELAY-3
Refer to EC-1864, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace cooling fan relay.
9. CHECK SMART ENTRANCE CONTROL UNIT
Refer to BCS-39, "Trouble Diagnoses" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 10.
NG >> Replace smart entrance control unit.
10. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Perform EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Main 12 Causes of Overheating EBS00E1K
Engine Step Inspection item Equipment Condition Reference page
OFF 1 G Blocked radiator
G Blocked radiator grille
G Blocked bumper
G Visual No blocking
2 G Coolant mixture G Coolant tester 50 - 50% coolant mixture See MA-16, "RECOM-
MENDED FLUIDS AND
LUBRICANTS" .
3 G Coolant level G Visual Coolant up to MAX level
in reservoir tank and radi-
ator filler neck
See CO-49, "Changing
Engine Coolant" .
4 G Radiator cap G Pressure tester 78 - 98 kPa (0.78 - 0.98
bar, 0.8 - 1.0 kg/cm
2
, 11 -
14 psi)
See CO-53, "Checking
Radiator Cap" .
ON*
2
5 G Coolant leaks G Visual No leaks See CO-49, "LEAK
CHECK" .
ON*
2
6 G Thermostat G Touch the upper and
lower radiator hoses
Both hoses should be hot See CO-61, "THERMO-
STAT AND WATER PIP-
ING" .
ON*
1
7 G Cooling fan G CONSULT-II Operating See Trouble Diagnosis for
DTC P1217, EC-1800 .
OFF 8 G Combustion gas leak G Color checker chemi-
cal tester 4 Gas ana-
lyzer
Negative
EC-1864
[YD]
DTC P1217 OVERHEAT (COOLING SYSTEM)
*1: Turn the ignition switch ON.
*2: Engine running at 3,000 rpm for 10 minutes.
*3: Drive at 90 km/h (55 MPH) for 30 minutes and then let idle for 10 minutes.
*4: After 60 minutes of cool down time.
For more information, refer to CO-45, "OVERHEATING CAUSE ANALYSIS" .
Component Inspection EBS00E1L
COOLING FAN RELAY-1 AND -3
Check continuity between terminals 3 and 5 under the following con-
ditions.
COOLING FAN RELAY-2 AND -4
Check continuity between terminals 3 and 5, 3 and 5 under the fol-
lowing conditions.
COOLING FAN MOTOR-1 AND -2
1. Disconnect cooling fan motor harness connectors.
2. Supply cooling fan motor terminals with battery voltage and
check operation.
ON*
3
9 G Coolant temperature
gauge
G Visual Gauge less than 3/4
when driving

G Coolant overflow to
reservoir tank
G Visual No overflow during driv-
ing and idling
See CO-49, "Changing
Engine Coolant" .
OFF*
4
10 G Coolant return from
reservoir tank to radia-
tor
G Visual Should be initial level in
reservoir tank
See CO-50, "REFILLING
ENGINE COOLANT" .
OFF 11 G Cylinder head G Straight gauge feeler
gauge
0.1mm (0.004 in) Maxi-
mum distortion (warping)
See EM-274, "CYLIN-
DER HEAD" .
12 G Cylinder block and pis-
tons
G Visual No scuffing on cylinder
walls or piston
See EM-288, "CYLIN-
DER BLOCK" .
Engine Step Inspection item Equipment Condition Reference page
Conditions Continuity
12V direct current supply between ter-
minals 1 and 2
Yes
No current supply No
MBIB0057E
Conditions Terminals Continuity
12V direct current supply
between terminals 1 and 2
3 and 4 No
3 and 5 Yes
No current supply
3 and 4 Yes
3 and 5 No
MBIB0056E
Terminals
(+) (-)
Cooling fan motor 1 2
SEF721Q
DTC P1233 - P1234 SUCTION CONTROL VALVE
EC-1865
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1233 - P1234 SUCTION CONTROL VALVE PFP:16700
Description EBS00E1M
To control the amount of the fuel inhalation of the fuel supply pump, a suction control valve is built into the fuel
supply pump. When the amount of the fuel inhalation of fuel supply pump increases, the fuel supply pump
raises the fuel exhalation pressure. As a result, the fuel injection pressure is raised. When the load of the
engine increases, the ECM sends a signal to the suction control valve to raise the injection pressure.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00E1N
Remarks: Specification data are reference values.
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00E1O
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
SUCTION CV
G Engine: After warming up
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Shift lever: Neutral position
G No-load
Idle 70.0 - 71.5CA
2,000 rpm 73.5 - 75.0CA
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
E1 L
Suction control valve
power supply
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0 - 12.5V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
0 - 12.5V
E8 Y/G Suction control valve 1 signal
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0 - 12.5V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
0 - 12.5V
PBIB0399E
PBIB0400E
PBIB0401E
PBIB0402E
EC-1866
[YD]
DTC P1233 - P1234 SUCTION CONTROL VALVE
: Average voltage for pulse signal (Actual pulse signal can be confirmed by oscilloscope.)
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00E1P
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00E1Q
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and run it for at least 2 seconds at idle speed.
(If engine does not run, turn ignition switch to START for at
least 2 seconds.)
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1868, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
E16 G/W Suction control valve 2 signal
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0 - 12.5V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine speed is 2,000 rpm
0 - 12.5V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
PBIB0401E
PBIB0402E
DTC Malfunction is detected when .... Check Items (Possible cause)
P1233 G Suction control valve 1 and/or 2 dose not operate
normally.
G Harness or connectors
(Fuel supply pump suction control valve circuit is
open or shorted.)
G Suction control valve 1
G Suction control valve 2
P1234
SEF817Y
DTC P1233 - P1234 SUCTION CONTROL VALVE
EC-1867
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00E1R
MBWA0111E
EC-1868
[YD]
DTC P1233 - P1234 SUCTION CONTROL VALVE
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00E1S
1. CHECK ECM OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector and fuel supply pump har-
ness connectors.
3. Check continuity between ECM terminal E1 and fuel supply
pump terminals 1, 3.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
2. CHECK SUCTION CONTROL VALVE GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check continuity between ECM terminal E8 and fuel supply pump terminal 2, ECM terminal E16 and fuel
supply pump terminal 4.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK SUCTION CONTROL VALVE
Refer to EC-1868, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Replace fuel supply pump.
4. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00E1T
SUCTION CONTROL VALVE
1. Check continuity between fuel supply pump terminals 1 and 2, 3
and 4.
2. If NG, replace fuel supply pump.
Continuity should exist.
PBIB0464E
Continuity should exist.
Continuity should exist.
PBIB0466E
DTC P1233 - P1234 SUCTION CONTROL VALVE
EC-1869
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Removal and Installation EBS00E1U
FUEL SUPPLY PUMP
Refer to EM-239, "FUEL SUPPLY PUMP" .
EC-1870
[YD]
DTC P1301 - P1304 FUEL INJECTOR ADJUSTMENT RESISTOR
DTC P1301 - P1304 FUEL INJECTOR ADJUSTMENT RESISTOR PFP:16600
Description EBS00E1V
The fuel injector adjustment resistor is built into the fuel injector. The resistance is constant and individual.
ECM uses the individual resistance to determine the fuel injection pulse.
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00E1W
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00E1X
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00E1Y
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and run it for at least 2 seconds at idle speed.
(If engine does not run, turn ignition switch to START for at
least 2 seconds.)
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1872, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
A25 PU/W Fuel injector's ground
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
Approximately 0V
B9 Y/B
Fuel injector adjustment
resistor No.2
[Ignition switch ON]
0.2 - 4.8V
(There is an individual differ-
ence in fuel injector adjust-
ment resistor.)
B10 R/B
Fuel injector adjustment
resistor No.4
B11 G/B
Fuel injector adjustment
resistor No.3
B12 W/B
Fuel injector adjustment
resistor No.1
DTC Malfunction is detected when .... Check Items (Possible cause)
P1301 G An excessively high or low voltage from fuel injector
No.1 adjustment resistor is sent to ECM
G Harness or connectors
(Injector adjustment resister circuit is open or
shorted.)
G Fuel injector adjustment resistor
P1302
G An excessively high or low voltage from fuel injector
No.2 adjustment resistor is sent to ECM
P1303
G An excessively high or low voltage from fuel injector
No.3 adjustment resistor is sent to ECM
P1304
G An excessively high or low voltage from fuel injector
No.4 adjustment resistor is sent to ECM
SEF817Y
DTC P1301 - P1304 FUEL INJECTOR ADJUSTMENT RESISTOR
EC-1871
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00E1Z
MBWA0115E
EC-1872
[YD]
DTC P1301 - P1304 FUEL INJECTOR ADJUSTMENT RESISTOR
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00E20
1. CHECK FUEL INJECTOR ADJUSTMENT RESISTOR POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect fuel injector harness connector of malfunctioning
cylinder.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between fuel injector terminal 2 and ground with
CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check harness continuity for open and short between ECM and fuel injector.
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK FUEL INJECTOR ADJUSTMENT RESISTOR GROUND CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check harness continuity between fuel injector terminal 1 and ECM terminal A25.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK FUEL INJECTOR ADJUSTMENT RESISTOR
Refer to EC-1873, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace fuel injector.
MBIB0085E
Voltage: Approximately 5V
MBIB0186E
Continuity should exist.
DTC P1301 - P1304 FUEL INJECTOR ADJUSTMENT RESISTOR
EC-1873
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00E21
FUEL INJECTOR ADJUSTMENT RESISTOR
1. Disconnect fuel injector harness connector.
2. Check continuity between terminals as shown in the figure.
If NG, replace fuel injector.
Removal and Installation EBS00E22
FUEL INJECTOR
Refer to EM-236, "INJECTION TUBE AND FUEL INJECTOR" .
Continuity should exist.
PBIB0415E
EC-1874
[YD]
DTC P1305 FUEL LEAK
DTC P1305 FUEL LEAK PFP:17520
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00E23
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00E24
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON and wait at least 2 seconds.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Start engine and run it for at least 2 seconds at idle speed.
(If engine does not run, turn ignition switch to START for at
least 2 seconds.)
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1874, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00E25
1. INSPECTION START
1. Start engine.
2. Visually check the following for fuel leak.
Fuel tube from fuel supply pump to common rail
Common rail
Fuel tube from common rail to fuel injector
3. Also check for improper connection or pinches.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Repair malfunctioning part.
2. CEHCK FUEL PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE
Refer to EC-1746, "Fuel Pressure Relief Valve" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Replace common rail.
3. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
OK or NG
OK >> Replace fuel supply pump.
NG >> Repair or replace.
Removal and Installation EBS00E26
COMMON RAIL
Refer to EM-236, "INJECTION TUBE AND FUEL INJECTOR" .
DTC Malfunction is detected when .... Check Items (Possible cause)
P1305 G The relation between the output signal to suction
control valve and input signal from common rail fuel
pressure sensor is not in normal range.
G Suction control valve
G Fuel tube
G Common rail
G Fuel pressure relief valve
SEF817Y
DTC P1305 FUEL LEAK
EC-1875
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
FUEL SUPPLY PUMP
Refer to EM-239, "FUEL SUPPLY PUMP" .
EC-1876
[YD]
DTC P1510 ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION SWITCH
DTC P1510 ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION SWITCH PFP:18002
Description EBS00E27
The accelerator work unit is installed on the upper end of the accelerator pedal assembly. The accelerator
pedal position sensor 1, 2 and accelerator pedal released position switch are built into the accelerator work
unit. The sensor detects the accelerator pedal position and sends a signal to the ECM. The ECM uses the sig-
nal to determine the amount of fuel to be injected.
The accelerator pedal released position switch detects accelerator pedal released position signal and sends
this signal to the ECM. The ECM will then determine engine idle conditions. This signal is also used for diag-
nosing the accelerator pedal position sensor.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00E28
Specification data are reference values.
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00E29
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
MBIB0006E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
ACCEL POS SEN
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: fully released 0.8 - 1.3V
Accelerator pedal: fully depressed More than 3.5V
ACCEL SEN 2
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: fully released 0.3 - 1.8V
Accelerator pedal: fully depressed More than 3.0V
OFF ACCEL SW
G Ignition switch: ON
(Engine stopped)
Accelerator pedal: fully released ON
Accelerator pedal: slightly
depressed
OFF
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION
DATA
(DC Voltage and Pulse Signal)
A21 B
Accelerator pedal
released position switch
ground
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 0V
A22 LG
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1 ground
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 0V
DTC P1510 ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION SWITCH
EC-1877
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00E2A
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00E2B
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Depress and release fully accelerator pedal slowly.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1879, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
A26 LG/R
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2 ground
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 0V
A28 PU/R
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1 power supply
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
B15 W
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 1
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.8 - 1.3V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.5V
B16 G
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully released
0.3 - 1.8V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully depressed
More than 3.0V
B23 GY/L
Accelerator pedal position
sensor 2 power supply
[Ignition switch ON] Approximately 5V
D14 G/Y
Accelerator pedal
released position switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal slightly depressed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
[Ignition switch ON]
G Accelerator pedal fully released
Approximately 0V
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION
DATA
(DC Voltage and Pulse Signal)
DTC Malfunction is detected when ... Check Items (Possible Cause)
P1510 G The relation between accelerator pedal position
sensor 1, 2 signals and accelerator pedal position
switch signal is not in the normal range during the
specified accelerator pedal positions.
G Harness or connectors
(Accelerator pedal released position switch circuit is
open or shorted.)
G Accelerator pedal released position switch
SEF817Y
EC-1878
[YD]
DTC P1510 ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION SWITCH
Wiring Diagram EBS00E2C
MBWA0116E
DTC P1510 ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION SWITCH
EC-1879
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00E2D
1. CHECK ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect accelerator work unit harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between accelerator work unit terminal 5 and
ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors F109, M77
G Harness for open or short between accelerator work unit and ECM
>> Repair harness or connectors.
3. CHECK ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION SWITCH GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN
AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between accelerator work unit terminal 4 and ECM terminal A21. Refer to Wir-
ing Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> GO TO 4.
MBIB0080E
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0004E
Continuity should exist.
EC-1880
[YD]
DTC P1510 ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION SWITCH
4. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors F109, M77
G Harness for open or short between ECM and accelerator work unit
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION SWITCH
Refer to EC-1880, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
6. REPLEACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ASSEMBLY
1. Replace accelerator pedal assembly.
2. Perform EC-1745, "Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00E2E
ACCELERATOR PEDAL RELEASED POSITION SWITCH
Check continuity between accelerator position switch terminals 4
and 5 under the following conditions.
Removal and Installation EBS00E2F
ACCELERATOR WORK UNIT
Refer to ACC-2, "ACCELERATOR CONTROL SYSTEM" .
Conditions Continuity
Accelerator pedal fully released Should exist.
Accelerator pedal depressed Should not exist.
MBIB0005E
DTC P1606 ECM
EC-1881
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1606 ECM PFP:23710
Description EBS00E2G
The ECM consists of a microcomputer and connectors for signal
input and output and for power supply. The ECM controls the engine.
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00E2H
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00E2I
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1881, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00E2J
1. INSPECTION START
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select SELF DIAG RESULTS mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Touch ERASE.
4. Perform EC-1881, "DTC Confirmation Procedure" , again.
5. Is DTC P1606 displayed again?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 2.
No >> INSPECTION END
PBIB0378E
DTC Malfunction is detected when ... Check Items (Possible Cause)
P1606 G ECM calculation function is malfunctioning. G ECM
SEF817Y
EC-1882
[YD]
DTC P1606 ECM
2. REPLACE ECM
1. Replace ECM.
2. Perform initialization of NATS system and registration of all NATS ignition key IDs. Refer to EC-1748,
"NATS (Nissan Anti-theft System)" .
3. Perform Accelerator Pedal Released Position Learning. Refer to EC-1745, "Accelerator Pedal Released
Position Learning" .
>> INSPECTION END
DTC P1621 ECM RELAY
EC-1883
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1621 ECM RELAY PFP:25230
ECM Terminals and Reference valve EBS00E2K
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00E2L
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00E2M
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 20 seconds and then
turn ON.
4. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1885, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION
DATA
(DC Voltage and Pulse Signal)
A8
A9
R
R
Power supply for ECM [Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
D18
D19
W/R
W/R
Ignition switch [Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
D24
D26
G
G
ECM relay (self-shutoff)
[Ignition switch ON]
[Ignition switch OFF]
G For a few seconds after turning ignition switch
OFF
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch OFF]
G A few seconds passed after turning ignition
switch OFF
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
DTC Malfunction is detected when ... Check Items (Possible Cause)
P1621 G An irregular voltage signal from the ECM relay is
sent to ECM.
G Harness or connectors (ECM relay circuit is open or
shorted.)
G ECM relay
SEF817Y
EC-1884
[YD]
DTC P1621 ECM RELAY
Wiring Diagram EBS00E2N
MBWA0110E
DTC P1621 ECM RELAY
EC-1885
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00E2O
1. CHECK ECM POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM relay.
3. Check voltage between ECM relay terminals 1, 6 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G 20A fuse
G Harness for open and short between ECM relay and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
3. CHECK ECM INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals A8, A9 and ECM relay terminal 7.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0081E
PBIB0359E
Continuity should exist.
EC-1886
[YD]
DTC P1621 ECM RELAY
4. CHECK ECM OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals D24, D26 and ECM relay terminal 2. Refer to Wiring
Diagram.
2. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
5. CHECK ECM RELAY
Refer to EC-1886, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace ECM relay.
6. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDET
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00E2P
ECM RELAY
1. Apply 12V direct current between ECM relay terminals 1 and 2.
2. Check continuity between relay terminals 3 and 5, 6 and 7.
3. If NG, replace ECM relay.
Continuity should exist.
Condition Continuity
12V direct current supply between
terminals 1 and 2
Yes
OFF No
PBIB0077E
DTC P1660 BATTERY VOLTAGE
EC-1887
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
DTC P1660 BATTERY VOLTAGE PFP:AYBGL
On Board Diagnosis Logic EBS00E2Q
The ECM checks if battery voltage is within the tolerance range for the engine control system.
DTC Confirmation Procedure EBS00E2R
WITH CONSULT-II
1. Check the following.
Jumper cables are connected for jump starting.
Battery or alternator has been replaced.
If the result is Yes for one item or more, skip the following steps and go to EC-1887, "Diagnostic Proce-
dure" .
2. Check that the positive battery terminal is connected to battery properly. If NG, reconnect it properly.
3. Check that the alternator functions properly. Refer to SC-12, "CHARGING SYSTEM" .
4. Turn ignition switch ON and select DATA MONITOR mode with CONSULT-II.
5. Wait one minute.
6. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1887, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
If DTC is not detected, go to next step.
7. Start engine and wait one minute at idle.
8. If DTC is detected, go to EC-1887, "Diagnostic Procedure" .
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00E2S
1. INSPECTION START
Are jumper cables connected for the jump starting?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 3.
No >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK BATTERY AND ALTERNATOR
Check that the proper type of battery and alternator is installed.
Refer to SC-3, "BATTERY" , SC-12, "CHARGING SYSTEM" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace with a proper one.
DTC Malfunction is detected when ... Check Items (Possible Cause)
P1660 G An abnormally high or low voltage from the battery
is sent to ECM.
G Incorrect jump starting
G Battery
G Alternator
G ECM
EC-1888
[YD]
DTC P1660 BATTERY VOLTAGE
3. CHECK JUMPER CABLES INSTALLATION
Check that the jumper cables are connected in the correct sequence.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Reconnect jumper cables properly.
4. CHECK BATTERY FOR BOOSTER
Check that the battery for the booster is a 12V battery.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Change the vehicle for booster.
5. PERFORM DTC CONFIRMATION PROCEDURE AGAIN
Perform EC-1887, "DTC Confirmation Procedure" , again.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> Replace ECM.
6. CHECK ELECTRICAL PARTS DAMAGE
Check the following for damage.
G Wiring harness and harness connectors for burn
G Fuses for short
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> Repair or replace malfunctioning part.
SEF439Z
GLOW CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-1889
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
GLOW CONTROL SYSTEM PFP:25230
Description EBS00E2T
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
When engine coolant temperature is more than approximately 80C (176F), the glow relay turns off.
When coolant temperature is lower than approximately 80C (176F):
G Ignition switch ON
After ignition switch has turned to ON, the glow relay turns ON for a certain period of time in relation to
engine coolant temperature, allowing current to flow through glow plug.
G Cranking
The glow relay turns ON, allowing current to flow through glow plug.
G Starting
After engine has started, current continues to flow through glow plug (after-glow mode) for a certain period
in relation to engine coolant temperature.
The glow indicator lamp turns ON for a certain period of time in relation to engine coolant temperature at the
time glow relay is turned ON.
ECM controls glow indicator lamp through CAN communication line.
COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
Glow Plug
The glow plug is provided with a ceramic heating element to obtain a
high-temperature resistance. It glows in response to a signal sent
from the ECM, allowing current to flow through the glow plug via the
glow relay.
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00E2U
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (TDC) Engine speed
Glow control
Glow lamp
Glow relay
Glow plugs
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
SEF376Y
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
E9 W/R Glow relay Refer to EC-1889, "SYSTEM DESCRIPTION"
EC-1890
[YD]
GLOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Wiring Diagram EBS00E2V
MBWA0101E
GLOW CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-1891
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00E2W
1. INSPECTION START
Check fuel level, fuel supplying system, starter motor, etc.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 2.
NG >> Correct.
2. CHECK INSTALLATION
Check that glow plug nut and all glow plug connecting plate nuts are
installed properly.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Install properly.
3. CHECK GLOW INDICATOR LAMP OPERATION
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select COOLAN TEMP/S in DATA MONITOR mode with
CONSULT-II.
3. Confirm that COOLAN TEMP/S indicates below 80C (176F).
If it indicates above 80C (176F), cool down engine.
4. Turn ignition switch OFF, wait at least 5 seconds and then turn
ON.
5. Make sure that glow indicator lamp is turned ON for 1.5 sec-
onds or more after turning ignition switch ON, and then glow
indicator lamp turned OFF.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 5.
SEF392YA
SEF013Y
EC-1892
[YD]
GLOW CONTROL SYSTEM
4. CHECK GLOW CONTROL SYSTEM OVERALL FUNCTION
1. Select COOLAN TEMP/S in DATA MONITOR mode with
CONSULT-II.
2. Confirm that COOLAN TEMP/S indicates approximately 25C
(77F). If NG, cool down engine.
3. Turn ignition switch OFF.
4. Set voltmeter probe between glow plug and engine body.
5. Turn ignition switch ON.
6. Check the voltage between glow plug and engine body under
the following conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 7.
5. CHECK DTC
Check that DTC U1000 is not displayed.
Yes or No
Yes >> Perform trouble diagnoses for DTC U1000, refer to EC-1790, "DTC U1000 CAN COMMUNICA-
TION LINE" .
No >> GO TO 6.
6. CHECK COMBINATON METER OPERATION
Does combination meter operate normally?
Yes or No
Yes >> GO TO 14.
No >> Check combination meter circuit. Refer to DI-5, "COMBINATION METERS (LHD MODELS)" or
DI-34, "COMBINATION METERS (RHD MODELS)" .
SEF013Y
Conditions Voltage
For 20 seconds after turning ignition switch ON Battery voltage
More than 20 seconds after turning ignition
switch ON
Approx. 0V
PBIB0425E
GLOW CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-1893
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
7. CHECK GLOW RELAY POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect glow relay.
3. Check voltage between glow relay terminals 1, 3 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> GO TO 8.
8. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G 60A fusible link
G Harness for open or short between glow relay and battery
>> Repair harness or connectors.
9. CHECK GLOW RELAY OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal E9 and glow relay terminal 2. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 11.
NG >> GO TO 10.
10. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G Harness for open or short between glow relay and ECM
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
MBIB0078E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0427E
Continuity should exist.
EC-1894
[YD]
GLOW CONTROL SYSTEM
11. CHECK HARNESS CONTINUITY BETWEEN GLOW RELAY AND GLOW PLUG FOR OPEN AND
SHORT
1. Disconnect glow plug harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between glow relay terminal 5 and glow plug harness connector.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 12.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
12. CHECK GLOW RELAY
Refer to EC-1894, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 13.
NG >> Replace glow relay.
13. CHECK GLOW PLUG
Refer to EC-1894, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 14.
NG >> Replace glow plug.
14. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00E2X
GLOW RELAY
Check continuity between glow relay terminals 3 and 5 under the fol-
lowing conditions.
Operation takes less than 1 second.
GLOW PLUG
1. Remove glow plug connecting plate.
Continuity should exist.
Conditions Continuity
12V direct current supply between terminals 1 and 2 Yes
No current supply No
PBIB0428E
GLOW CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-1895
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
2. Check glow plug resistance.
NOTE:
G Do not bump glow plug heating element. If it is bumped,
replace glow plug with a new one.
G If glow plug is dropped from a height of 10 cm (3.94 in) or
higher, replace with a new one.
G If glow plug installation hole is contaminated with car-
bon, remove it with a reamer or suitable tool.
G Hand-tighten glow plug by turning it two or three times,
then tighten using a tool to specified torque.
Removal and Installation EBS00E2Y
GLOW PLUG
Refer to EM-231, "GLOW PLUG" .
Resistance: Approximately 0.8 [at 25C (77F)]
: 17.7 - 22.5 N-m (1.8 - 2.3 kg-m, 13 - 16 ft-lb)
PBIB0429E
EC-1896
[YD]
EGR VOLUME CONTROL SYSTEM
EGR VOLUME CONTROL SYSTEM PFP:14710
Description EBS00E2Z
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
*: These signals are sent to the ECM through CAN communication line.
This system controls flow rate of EGR led from exhaust manifold to intake manifold. The opening of the EGR
by-pass passage in the EGR volume control valve changes to control the flow rate. A built-in step motor
moves the valve in steps corresponding to the ECM output pulses. The opening of the valve varies for opti-
mum engine control. The optimum value stored in the ECM is determined by considering various engine con-
ditions.
The EGR volume control valve remains close under the following conditions.
G Engine stopped
G Engine starting
G Low engine coolant temperature
G Excessively high engine coolant temperature
G High engine speed
G Wide open throttle
COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
EGR Volume Control Valve
The EGR volume control valve uses a step motor to control the flow
rate of EGR from exhaust manifold. This motor has four winding
phases. It operates according to the output pulse signal of the ECM.
Two windings are turned ON and OFF in sequence. Each time an
ON pulse is issued, the valve opens or closes, changing the flow
rate. When no change in the flow rate is needed, the ECM does not
issue the pulse signal. A certain voltage signal is issued so that the
valve remains at that particular opening.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00E30
Specification data are reference values.
Sensor Input Signal to ECM ECM Function Actuator
Crankshaft position sensor (TDC) Engine speed
EGR volume
control
EGR volume control
valve
Vehicle speed signal* Vehicle speed
Engine coolant temperature sensor Engine coolant temperature
Ignition switch Start signal
Accelerator pedal position sensor Accelerator pedal position
Mass air flow sensor Amount of intake air
Air conditioner switch * Air conditioner operation
SEF908Y
SEF411Y
EGR VOLUME CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-1897
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00E31
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
EGR VOL CON/V
G Engine: After warming up
G Air conditioner switch: OFF
G Shift lever: Neutral position
G No-load
After one minute at idle More than 10 steps
Revving engine from idle to 3,600
rpm
0 step
TERMI-
NAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION
DATA
(DC Voltage and Pulse Signal)
A8
A9
R
R
Power supply for ECM [Ignition switch ON]
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
B3
B4
B5
B6
GY/B
OR/B
W/L
GY
EGR volume control valve
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
0.1 - 14V
(Voltage signals of each ECM ter-
minals differ according to the con-
trol position of EGR volume
control valve.)
D24
D26
G
G
ECM relay (self-shutoff)
[Ignition switch ON]
[Ignition switch OFF]
G For a few seconds after turning ignition
switch OFF
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch OFF]
G A few seconds passed after turning ignition
switch OFF
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
EC-1898
[YD]
EGR VOLUME CONTROL SYSTEM
Wiring Diagram EBS00E32
MBWA0102E
EGR VOLUME CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-1899
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00E33
1. CHECK EGR VOLUME CONTROL SYSTEM OVERALL FUNCTION
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Set the oscilloscope probe between ECM terminals B3, B4, B5, B6 and ground.
3. Start engine and let it idle.
4. Check the oscilloscope screen when revving engine up to 3,200 rpm and return to idle.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK EGR VOLUME CONTROL VALVE POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-I
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect EGR volume control valve harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between EGR volume control valve terminals 2, 5
and ground with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 3.
The pulse signal as shown in the figure should appear.
PBIB0430E
MBIB0088E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0431E
EC-1900
[YD]
EGR VOLUME CONTROL SYSTEM
3. CHECK EGR VOLUME CONTROL VALVE POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-II
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM relay.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM relay terminal 5 and
EGR volume control valve terminals 2, 5.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power
in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK EGR VOLUME CONTROL VALVE POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT-III
Check voltage between ECM relay terminal 3 and ground with CON-
SULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors E62, F12
G 10A fuse
G Harness for open or short between ECM relay and fuse
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK ECM RELAY
Refer to EC-1789, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> Replace ECM relay.
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0081E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0432E
EGR VOLUME CONTROL SYSTEM
EC-1901
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
7. CHECK EGR VOLUME CONTROL VALVE OUTPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals and EGR volume control valve terminals as follows.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK EGR VOLUME CONTROL VALVE
Refer to EC-1901, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace EGR volume control valve.
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00E34
EGR VOLUME CONTROL VALVE
With CONSULT-II
1. Disconnect EGR volume control valve harness connector.
ECM terminal EGR volume control valve terminal
B3 4
B4 3
B5 6
B6 1
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0088E
EC-1902
[YD]
EGR VOLUME CONTROL SYSTEM
2. Check resistance between the following terminals.
G terminal 2 and terminals 1, 3
G terminal 5 and terminals 4, 6
If NG, replace EGR volume control valve.
If OK, go to next step.
3. Reconnect EGR volume control valve harness connector.
4. Remove EGR volume control valve from cylinder head.
(The EGR volume control valve harness connector should
remain connected.)
5. Turn ignition switch ON.
6. Perform EGR VOL CONT/V in ACTIVE TEST mode with CONSULT-II. Check that EGR volume control
valve shaft moves smoothly forward and backward according to the valve opening.
If NG, replace the EGR volume control valve.
Removal and Installation EBS00E35
EGR VOLUME CONTROL VALVE
Refer to EM-220, "EXHAUST MANIFOLD AND TURBOCHARGER" .
Temperature C (F) Resistance
20 (68) 13 - 17
MBIB0007E
SEF819Y
VARIABLE NOZZLE TURBOCHARGER CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
EC-1903
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
VARIABLE NOZZLE TURBOCHARGER CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE PFP:14956
Description EBS00G9Q
The load from the variable nozzle turbocharger control solenoid
valve controls the actuator. By changing the variable nozzle vane
opening through the rods, the intake air volume is adjusted.
The variable nozzle turbocharger control solenoid valve is moved by
ON/OFF pulse from the ECM. The longer the ON pulse, the charge
air pressure rises.
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00G9R
Specification data are reference valves, and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may damage the
ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
SEF453Z
MBIB0161E
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC voltage)
B17 L
Variable nozzle turbo-
charger control solenoid
valve
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Idle speed
4.5 - 6.5V
[Engine is running]
G Warm-up condition
G Engine sped is 2,500 rpm
7 - 9V
EC-1904
[YD]
VARIABLE NOZZLE TURBOCHARGER CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Wiring Diagram EBS00G9S
MBWA0121E
VARIABLE NOZZLE TURBOCHARGER CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
EC-1905
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00G9U
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
1. Start engine and let it idle.
2. Make sure that variable nozzle turbocharger control actuator rod
moves when revving engine up to 3,000 rpm and returning to
idle.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK VACUUM SOURCE
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect vacuum hose connected to variable nozzle turbocharger control actuator.
3. Start engine and let it idle.
4. Check vacuum hose for vacuum existence.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> GO TO 4.
3. CHECK VARIABLE NOZZLE TURBOCHARGER CONTROL ACTUATOR
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Install a vacuum pump to variable nozzle turbocharger control actuator.
3. Make sure that the variable nozzle turbocharger control actuator
rod moves smoothly when applying vacuum of -53.3kPa (-
533mbar, -400mmHg, -15.75inHg) and releasing it.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace turbocharger assembly.
MBIB0162E
Vacuum should exist.
MBIB0163E
MBIB0165E
EC-1906
[YD]
VARIABLE NOZZLE TURBOCHARGER CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
4. CHECK VACUUM HOSES AND VACUUM GALLERY
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Check vacuum hoses and vacuum gallery for clogging, cracks or improper connection.
Refer to Vacuum Hose Drawing.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Repair or replace vacuum hoses and vacuum gallery.
5. CHECK VARIABLE NOZZLE TURBOCHARGER CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE POWER SUPPLY CIR-
CUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect variable nozzle turbocharger control solenoid valve harness connector.
3. Turn ignition switch ON.
4. Check voltage between variable nozzle turbocharger control
solenoid valve terminals 2 and ground with CONSULT-II or
tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 7.
NG >> GO TO 6.
6. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness for open or short between ECM relay and variable nozzle turbocharger control solenoid valve
G Harness for open or short between variable turbocharger control solenoid valve
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
SEF109L
MBIB0088E
Voltage: Battery voltage
MBIB0010E
VARIABLE NOZZLE TURBOCHARGER CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
EC-1907
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
7. CHECK VARIABLE NOZZLE TURBOCHARGER CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE OUTPUT SIGNAL
CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminals B17 and variable nozzle turbocharger control solenoid
valve terminals 1. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
8. CHECK VARIABLE NOZZLE TURBOCHARGER CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Refer to EC-1901, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 9.
NG >> Replace variable nozzle turbocharger control solenoid valve.
9. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00G9V
VARIABLE NOZZLE TURBOCHARGER CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
1. Disconnect variable nozzle turbocharger control solenoid valve
harness connector.
2. Apply 12V direct current between variable nozzle turbocharger control solenoid valve terminals.
3. Check air passage continuity of variable nozzle turbocharger
control solenoid valve under the following conditions.
Operation takes less than 1 second.
If NG, replace variable nozzle turbocharger control solenoid
valve.
Continuity should exist.
SEF287Z
CONDITIONS
Air passage continuity
between A and B
Air passage continuity
between A and C
12V direct current supply
between terminals 1 and 2
Yes No
No supply No Yes
SEF454Z
EC-1908
[YD]
VARIABLE NOZZLE TURBOCHARGER CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Removal and Installation EBS00GNU
VARIABLE NOZZLE TURBOCHARGER CONTROL SOLENOID VALVE
Refer to EM-220, "Removal and Installation" .
BRAKE SWITCH
EC-1909
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
BRAKE SWITCH PFP:25230
Description EBS00E36
The stop lamp switch is installed to brake pedal bracket. The switch
senses brake pedal position and sends an ON-OFF signal to the
ECM. The ECM uses the signal to control the fuel injection control
system.
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00E37
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
MBIB0080E
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
D25 R/G Stop lamp switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Brake pedal fully released
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Brake pedal depressed
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
EC-1910
[YD]
BRAKE SWITCH
Wiring Diagram EBS00E38
MBWA0100E
BRAKE SWITCH
EC-1911
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00E39
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select BRAKE SW in DATA MONITOR mode with CON-
SULT-II.
3. Check BRAKE SW signal under the following conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH POWER SUPPLY CIRUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect stop lamp switch harness connector.
3. Check voltage between stop lamp switch terminal 1 and ground
with CONSULT-II or tester.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTION PART
Check the following
G 15A fuse
G Fuse block (J/B) connector M2
G Harness for open and short between stop lamp switch and battery
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
Conditions BRAKE SW
Brake pedal released OFF
Brake pedal slightly depressed ON
PBIB0472E
MBIB0080E
Voltage: Battery voltage
PBIB0117E
EC-1912
[YD]
BRAKE SWITCH
4. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal D25 and stop lamp switch terminal 2. Refer to Wiring
Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 6.
NG >> GO TO 5.
5. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following
G Harness connectors F110, M80
G Harness for open and short between stop lamp switch and ECM
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
6. CHECK STOP LAMP SWITCH
Refer to EC-1912, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 8.
NG >> Replace stop lamp switch.
7. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00E3A
STOP LAMP SWITCH
Check continuity between stop lamp switch terminals 1 and 2 under
the following conditions.
Continuity should exist.
Conditions Continuity
Brake pedal fully released Should not exist.
Brake pedal depressed Should exist.
PBIB0118E
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION (PNP) SWITCH
EC-1913
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION (PNP) SWITCH PFP:31918
Description EBS00E3B
When the gear position is in Neutral, neutral position is ON. ECM detects the position because the continu-
ity of the line (the ON signal) exists.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00E3C
Specification data are reference values.
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00E3D
Specification data are reference values and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
P/N POSI SW G Ignition switch: ON
Shift lever: Neutral ON
Except above OFF
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
E13 G/OR
Park/Neutral position
switch
[Ignition switch ON]
G Gear position is Neutral
Approximately 0V
[Ignition switch ON]
G Except the above gear position
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
EC-1914
[YD]
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION (PNP) SWITCH
Wiring Diagram EBS00E3E
MBWA0105E
PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION (PNP) SWITCH
EC-1915
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00E3F
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Select P/N POSI SW in DATA MONITOR mode with CON-
SULT-II.
3. Check P/N POSI SW signal under the following conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK PNP SWITCH GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect park/neutral position (PNP) switch harness connec-
tor.
3. Check harness continuity between PNP switch terminal 2 and
body ground. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or con-
nectors.
3. CHECK PNP SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal E13 and PNP switch terminal 1. Refer to Wiring Dia-
gram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SWITCH
Refer to MT-126, "POSITION SWITCH" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace park/neutral position switch.
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Shift lever position P/N POSI SW
Neutral position ON
Except the above position OFF
SEF212Y
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0077E
Continuity should exist.
EC-1916
[YD]
START SIGNAL
START SIGNAL PFP:48750
Wiring Diagram EBS00E3G
MBWA0103E
START SIGNAL
EC-1917
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00E3H
1. CHECK START SIGNAL OVERALL FUNCTION
With CONSULT-II
1. Turn ignition switch ON.
2. Check START SIGNAL in DATA MONITOR mode with CON-
SULT-II under the following conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK START SIGNAL INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect ECM harness connector and ignition switch harness connector.
3. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal D27 and ignition switch terminal 6. Refer to Wiring Dia-
gram.
4. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> GO TO 3.
3. DETECT MALFUNCTIONING PART
Check the following.
G Harness connectors M77, F109
G 10A fuse
G Fuse block (J/B) connectors M2, E106
G Harness for open or short between ECM and ignition switch
>> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Condition START SIGNAL
Ignition switch ON OFF
Ignition switch START ON
PBIB0433E
Continuity should exist.
EC-1918
[YD]
POWER STEERING OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
POWER STEERING OIL PRESSURE SWITCH PFP:49761
Component Description EBS00E3I
The power steering oil pressure switch is attached to the power
steering high-pressure tube and detects a power steering load.
When a power steering load is detected, it signals the ECM. The
ECM adjusts the fuel injector pulse width to increase the idle speed
and adjust for the increased load.
CONSULT-II Reference Value in Data Monitor Mode EBS00E3J
Specification data are reference values.
ECM Terminals and Reference Value EBS00E3K
Specification data are reference values, and are measured between each terminal and ground.
CAUTION:
Do not use ECM ground terminals when measuring input/output voltage. Doing so may result in dam-
age to the ECM's transistor. Use a ground other than ECM terminals, such as the ground.
MBIB0090E
MONITOR ITEM CONDITION SPECIFICATION
PW/ST SIGNAL
G Engine: After warming up, idle the
engine
Steering wheel is in neutral position.
(Forward direction)
OFF
Steering wheel is turned. ON
TER-
MINAL
NO.
WIRE
COLOR
ITEM CONDITION DATA (DC Voltage)
E12 P/B
Power steering oil pressure
switch
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is being turned
Approximately 0V
[Engine is running]
G Steering wheel is not being turned
BATTERY VOLTAGE
(11 - 14V)
POWER STEERING OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
EC-1919
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
Wiring Diagram EBS00E3L
MBWA0106E
EC-1920
[YD]
POWER STEERING OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
Diagnostic Procedure EBS00E3M
1. CHECK OVERALL FUNCTION
With CONSULT-II
1. Start engine.
2. Check PW/ST SIGNAL in DATA MONITOR mode with CON-
SULT-II under the following conditions.
OK or NG
OK >> INSPECTION END
NG >> GO TO 2.
2. CHECK POWER STEERING OIL PRESSURE SWITCH GROUND CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND SHORT
1. Turn ignition switch OFF.
2. Disconnect power steering oil pressure switch harness connec-
tor.
3. Check harness continuity between power steering oil pressure
switch terminal 2 and engine ground. Refer to Wiring Diagram.
4. Also check harness for short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 3.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to power in harness or con-
nectors.
3. CHECK POWER STEERING OIL PRESSURE SWITCH INPUT SIGNAL CIRCUIT FOR OPEN AND
SHORT
1. Disconnect ECM harness connector.
2. Check harness continuity between ECM terminal E12 and power steering oil pressure switch terminal 1.
Refer to Wiring Diagram.
3. Also check harness for short to ground and short to power.
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 4.
NG >> Repair open circuit or short to ground or short to power in harness or connectors.
4. CHECK POWER STEERING OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
Refer to EC-1921, "Component Inspection" .
OK or NG
OK >> GO TO 5.
NG >> Replace power steering oil pressure switch.
Conditions PW/ST SIGNAL
Steering in neutral position OFF
Steering is turned ON
PBIB0434E
Continuity should exist.
MBIB0090E
Continuity should exist.
POWER STEERING OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
EC-1921
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
5. CHECK INTERMITTENT INCIDENT
Refer to EC-1783, "TROUBLE DIAGNOSIS FOR INTERMITTENT INCIDENT" .
>> INSPECTION END
Component Inspection EBS00E3N
POWER STEERING OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
1. Disconnect power steering oil pressure switch harness connector and then start engine.
2. Check continuity between power steering oil pressure switch ter-
minal 1 and 2 under the following conditions.
Removal and Installation EBS00E3O
POWER STEERING OIL PRESSURE SWITCH
Refer to PS-24, "HYDRAULIC LINE" .
Conditions Continuity
Steering wheel is being fully turned. Yes
Steering wheel is not being turned. No
PBIB0435E
EC-1922
[YD]
MI & DATA LINK CONNECTORS
MI & DATA LINK CONNECTORS PFP:24814
Wiring Diagram EBS00E3Q
MBWA0119E
SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)
EC-1923
[YD]
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
EC
SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS) PFP:00100
General Specifications EBS00E3R
Mass Air Flow Sensor EBS00E3S
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor EBS00E3T
Common Rail Fuel Pressure Sensor EBS00E3U
Crankshaft Position Sensor (TDC) EBS00E3V
Camshaft Position Sensor EBS00E3W
Glow Plug EBS00E3X
EGR Volume Control Valve EBS00E3Y
Engine YD22DDTi
Idle speed 725 25 rpm
Maximum engine speed 4,900 rpm
Supply voltage 5V
Ignition switch "ON" (Engine stopped.) Approx. 1.0V
Idle (Engine is warmed up to normal operating temperature.) 1.0 - 2.5V
2,000 rpm (Engine is warmed up to normal operating tempera-
ture.)
2.1 - 2.7V
Temperature C (F) Resistance k
20 (68) 2.1 - 2.9
50 (122) 0.68 - 1.00
90 (194) 0.236 - 0.260
Supply voltage Approximately 5V
Idle (Engine is warmed up to normal operating temperature.) 1.6 - 1.8V
2,000 rpm (Engine is warmed up to normal operating tempera-
ture.)
1.8 - 2.0V
Resistance [at 20C (68F)] 1,850 - 2,450
Resistance [at 20C (68F)] 1,850 - 2,450
Resistance [at 25C (77F)] Approximately 0.8
Resistance [at 25C (77F)] 13 - 17
EC-1924
[YD]
SERVICE DATA AND SPECIFICATIONS (SDS)

You might also like